2011-12-16 Phil Muldoon <pmuldoon@redhat.com>
[binutils-gdb.git] / gdb / doc / gdb.texinfo
1 \input texinfo @c -*-texinfo-*-
2 @c Copyright (C) 1988, 1989, 1990, 1991, 1992, 1993, 1994, 1995, 1996,
3 @c 1998, 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002, 2003, 2004, 2005, 2006, 2007, 2008, 2009,
4 @c 2010, 2011 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
5 @c
6 @c %**start of header
7 @c makeinfo ignores cmds prev to setfilename, so its arg cannot make use
8 @c of @set vars. However, you can override filename with makeinfo -o.
9 @setfilename gdb.info
10 @c
11 @include gdb-cfg.texi
12 @c
13 @settitle Debugging with @value{GDBN}
14 @setchapternewpage odd
15 @c %**end of header
16
17 @iftex
18 @c @smallbook
19 @c @cropmarks
20 @end iftex
21
22 @finalout
23 @syncodeindex ky cp
24 @syncodeindex tp cp
25
26 @c readline appendices use @vindex, @findex and @ftable,
27 @c annotate.texi and gdbmi use @findex.
28 @syncodeindex vr cp
29 @syncodeindex fn cp
30
31 @c !!set GDB manual's edition---not the same as GDB version!
32 @c This is updated by GNU Press.
33 @set EDITION Tenth
34
35 @c !!set GDB edit command default editor
36 @set EDITOR /bin/ex
37
38 @c THIS MANUAL REQUIRES TEXINFO 4.0 OR LATER.
39
40 @c This is a dir.info fragment to support semi-automated addition of
41 @c manuals to an info tree.
42 @dircategory Software development
43 @direntry
44 * Gdb: (gdb). The GNU debugger.
45 @end direntry
46
47 @copying
48 Copyright @copyright{} 1988, 1989, 1990, 1991, 1992, 1993, 1994, 1995, 1996,
49 1998, 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002, 2003, 2004, 2005, 2006, 2007, 2008, 2009, 2010
50 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
51
52 Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
53 under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.3 or
54 any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with the
55 Invariant Sections being ``Free Software'' and ``Free Software Needs
56 Free Documentation'', with the Front-Cover Texts being ``A GNU Manual,''
57 and with the Back-Cover Texts as in (a) below.
58
59 (a) The FSF's Back-Cover Text is: ``You are free to copy and modify
60 this GNU Manual. Buying copies from GNU Press supports the FSF in
61 developing GNU and promoting software freedom.''
62 @end copying
63
64 @ifnottex
65 This file documents the @sc{gnu} debugger @value{GDBN}.
66
67 This is the @value{EDITION} Edition, of @cite{Debugging with
68 @value{GDBN}: the @sc{gnu} Source-Level Debugger} for @value{GDBN}
69 @ifset VERSION_PACKAGE
70 @value{VERSION_PACKAGE}
71 @end ifset
72 Version @value{GDBVN}.
73
74 @insertcopying
75 @end ifnottex
76
77 @titlepage
78 @title Debugging with @value{GDBN}
79 @subtitle The @sc{gnu} Source-Level Debugger
80 @sp 1
81 @subtitle @value{EDITION} Edition, for @value{GDBN} version @value{GDBVN}
82 @ifset VERSION_PACKAGE
83 @sp 1
84 @subtitle @value{VERSION_PACKAGE}
85 @end ifset
86 @author Richard Stallman, Roland Pesch, Stan Shebs, et al.
87 @page
88 @tex
89 {\parskip=0pt
90 \hfill (Send bugs and comments on @value{GDBN} to @value{BUGURL}.)\par
91 \hfill {\it Debugging with @value{GDBN}}\par
92 \hfill \TeX{}info \texinfoversion\par
93 }
94 @end tex
95
96 @vskip 0pt plus 1filll
97 Published by the Free Software Foundation @*
98 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor,
99 Boston, MA 02110-1301, USA@*
100 ISBN 978-0-9831592-3-0 @*
101
102 @insertcopying
103 @end titlepage
104 @page
105
106 @ifnottex
107 @node Top, Summary, (dir), (dir)
108
109 @top Debugging with @value{GDBN}
110
111 This file describes @value{GDBN}, the @sc{gnu} symbolic debugger.
112
113 This is the @value{EDITION} Edition, for @value{GDBN}
114 @ifset VERSION_PACKAGE
115 @value{VERSION_PACKAGE}
116 @end ifset
117 Version @value{GDBVN}.
118
119 Copyright (C) 1988-2010 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
120
121 This edition of the GDB manual is dedicated to the memory of Fred
122 Fish. Fred was a long-standing contributor to GDB and to Free
123 software in general. We will miss him.
124
125 @menu
126 * Summary:: Summary of @value{GDBN}
127 * Sample Session:: A sample @value{GDBN} session
128
129 * Invocation:: Getting in and out of @value{GDBN}
130 * Commands:: @value{GDBN} commands
131 * Running:: Running programs under @value{GDBN}
132 * Stopping:: Stopping and continuing
133 * Reverse Execution:: Running programs backward
134 * Process Record and Replay:: Recording inferior's execution and replaying it
135 * Stack:: Examining the stack
136 * Source:: Examining source files
137 * Data:: Examining data
138 * Optimized Code:: Debugging optimized code
139 * Macros:: Preprocessor Macros
140 * Tracepoints:: Debugging remote targets non-intrusively
141 * Overlays:: Debugging programs that use overlays
142
143 * Languages:: Using @value{GDBN} with different languages
144
145 * Symbols:: Examining the symbol table
146 * Altering:: Altering execution
147 * GDB Files:: @value{GDBN} files
148 * Targets:: Specifying a debugging target
149 * Remote Debugging:: Debugging remote programs
150 * Configurations:: Configuration-specific information
151 * Controlling GDB:: Controlling @value{GDBN}
152 * Extending GDB:: Extending @value{GDBN}
153 * Interpreters:: Command Interpreters
154 * TUI:: @value{GDBN} Text User Interface
155 * Emacs:: Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs
156 * GDB/MI:: @value{GDBN}'s Machine Interface.
157 * Annotations:: @value{GDBN}'s annotation interface.
158 * JIT Interface:: Using the JIT debugging interface.
159
160 * GDB Bugs:: Reporting bugs in @value{GDBN}
161
162 @ifset SYSTEM_READLINE
163 * Command Line Editing: (rluserman). Command Line Editing
164 * Using History Interactively: (history). Using History Interactively
165 @end ifset
166 @ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
167 * Command Line Editing:: Command Line Editing
168 * Using History Interactively:: Using History Interactively
169 @end ifclear
170 * In Memoriam:: In Memoriam
171 * Formatting Documentation:: How to format and print @value{GDBN} documentation
172 * Installing GDB:: Installing GDB
173 * Maintenance Commands:: Maintenance Commands
174 * Remote Protocol:: GDB Remote Serial Protocol
175 * Agent Expressions:: The GDB Agent Expression Mechanism
176 * Target Descriptions:: How targets can describe themselves to
177 @value{GDBN}
178 * Operating System Information:: Getting additional information from
179 the operating system
180 * Trace File Format:: GDB trace file format
181 * Index Section Format:: .gdb_index section format
182 * Copying:: GNU General Public License says
183 how you can copy and share GDB
184 * GNU Free Documentation License:: The license for this documentation
185 * Index:: Index
186 @end menu
187
188 @end ifnottex
189
190 @contents
191
192 @node Summary
193 @unnumbered Summary of @value{GDBN}
194
195 The purpose of a debugger such as @value{GDBN} is to allow you to see what is
196 going on ``inside'' another program while it executes---or what another
197 program was doing at the moment it crashed.
198
199 @value{GDBN} can do four main kinds of things (plus other things in support of
200 these) to help you catch bugs in the act:
201
202 @itemize @bullet
203 @item
204 Start your program, specifying anything that might affect its behavior.
205
206 @item
207 Make your program stop on specified conditions.
208
209 @item
210 Examine what has happened, when your program has stopped.
211
212 @item
213 Change things in your program, so you can experiment with correcting the
214 effects of one bug and go on to learn about another.
215 @end itemize
216
217 You can use @value{GDBN} to debug programs written in C and C@t{++}.
218 For more information, see @ref{Supported Languages,,Supported Languages}.
219 For more information, see @ref{C,,C and C++}.
220
221 Support for D is partial. For information on D, see
222 @ref{D,,D}.
223
224 @cindex Modula-2
225 Support for Modula-2 is partial. For information on Modula-2, see
226 @ref{Modula-2,,Modula-2}.
227
228 Support for OpenCL C is partial. For information on OpenCL C, see
229 @ref{OpenCL C,,OpenCL C}.
230
231 @cindex Pascal
232 Debugging Pascal programs which use sets, subranges, file variables, or
233 nested functions does not currently work. @value{GDBN} does not support
234 entering expressions, printing values, or similar features using Pascal
235 syntax.
236
237 @cindex Fortran
238 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Fortran, although
239 it may be necessary to refer to some variables with a trailing
240 underscore.
241
242 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Objective-C,
243 using either the Apple/NeXT or the GNU Objective-C runtime.
244
245 @menu
246 * Free Software:: Freely redistributable software
247 * Contributors:: Contributors to GDB
248 @end menu
249
250 @node Free Software
251 @unnumberedsec Free Software
252
253 @value{GDBN} is @dfn{free software}, protected by the @sc{gnu}
254 General Public License
255 (GPL). The GPL gives you the freedom to copy or adapt a licensed
256 program---but every person getting a copy also gets with it the
257 freedom to modify that copy (which means that they must get access to
258 the source code), and the freedom to distribute further copies.
259 Typical software companies use copyrights to limit your freedoms; the
260 Free Software Foundation uses the GPL to preserve these freedoms.
261
262 Fundamentally, the General Public License is a license which says that
263 you have these freedoms and that you cannot take these freedoms away
264 from anyone else.
265
266 @unnumberedsec Free Software Needs Free Documentation
267
268 The biggest deficiency in the free software community today is not in
269 the software---it is the lack of good free documentation that we can
270 include with the free software. Many of our most important
271 programs do not come with free reference manuals and free introductory
272 texts. Documentation is an essential part of any software package;
273 when an important free software package does not come with a free
274 manual and a free tutorial, that is a major gap. We have many such
275 gaps today.
276
277 Consider Perl, for instance. The tutorial manuals that people
278 normally use are non-free. How did this come about? Because the
279 authors of those manuals published them with restrictive terms---no
280 copying, no modification, source files not available---which exclude
281 them from the free software world.
282
283 That wasn't the first time this sort of thing happened, and it was far
284 from the last. Many times we have heard a GNU user eagerly describe a
285 manual that he is writing, his intended contribution to the community,
286 only to learn that he had ruined everything by signing a publication
287 contract to make it non-free.
288
289 Free documentation, like free software, is a matter of freedom, not
290 price. The problem with the non-free manual is not that publishers
291 charge a price for printed copies---that in itself is fine. (The Free
292 Software Foundation sells printed copies of manuals, too.) The
293 problem is the restrictions on the use of the manual. Free manuals
294 are available in source code form, and give you permission to copy and
295 modify. Non-free manuals do not allow this.
296
297 The criteria of freedom for a free manual are roughly the same as for
298 free software. Redistribution (including the normal kinds of
299 commercial redistribution) must be permitted, so that the manual can
300 accompany every copy of the program, both on-line and on paper.
301
302 Permission for modification of the technical content is crucial too.
303 When people modify the software, adding or changing features, if they
304 are conscientious they will change the manual too---so they can
305 provide accurate and clear documentation for the modified program. A
306 manual that leaves you no choice but to write a new manual to document
307 a changed version of the program is not really available to our
308 community.
309
310 Some kinds of limits on the way modification is handled are
311 acceptable. For example, requirements to preserve the original
312 author's copyright notice, the distribution terms, or the list of
313 authors, are ok. It is also no problem to require modified versions
314 to include notice that they were modified. Even entire sections that
315 may not be deleted or changed are acceptable, as long as they deal
316 with nontechnical topics (like this one). These kinds of restrictions
317 are acceptable because they don't obstruct the community's normal use
318 of the manual.
319
320 However, it must be possible to modify all the @emph{technical}
321 content of the manual, and then distribute the result in all the usual
322 media, through all the usual channels. Otherwise, the restrictions
323 obstruct the use of the manual, it is not free, and we need another
324 manual to replace it.
325
326 Please spread the word about this issue. Our community continues to
327 lose manuals to proprietary publishing. If we spread the word that
328 free software needs free reference manuals and free tutorials, perhaps
329 the next person who wants to contribute by writing documentation will
330 realize, before it is too late, that only free manuals contribute to
331 the free software community.
332
333 If you are writing documentation, please insist on publishing it under
334 the GNU Free Documentation License or another free documentation
335 license. Remember that this decision requires your approval---you
336 don't have to let the publisher decide. Some commercial publishers
337 will use a free license if you insist, but they will not propose the
338 option; it is up to you to raise the issue and say firmly that this is
339 what you want. If the publisher you are dealing with refuses, please
340 try other publishers. If you're not sure whether a proposed license
341 is free, write to @email{licensing@@gnu.org}.
342
343 You can encourage commercial publishers to sell more free, copylefted
344 manuals and tutorials by buying them, and particularly by buying
345 copies from the publishers that paid for their writing or for major
346 improvements. Meanwhile, try to avoid buying non-free documentation
347 at all. Check the distribution terms of a manual before you buy it,
348 and insist that whoever seeks your business must respect your freedom.
349 Check the history of the book, and try to reward the publishers that
350 have paid or pay the authors to work on it.
351
352 The Free Software Foundation maintains a list of free documentation
353 published by other publishers, at
354 @url{http://www.fsf.org/doc/other-free-books.html}.
355
356 @node Contributors
357 @unnumberedsec Contributors to @value{GDBN}
358
359 Richard Stallman was the original author of @value{GDBN}, and of many
360 other @sc{gnu} programs. Many others have contributed to its
361 development. This section attempts to credit major contributors. One
362 of the virtues of free software is that everyone is free to contribute
363 to it; with regret, we cannot actually acknowledge everyone here. The
364 file @file{ChangeLog} in the @value{GDBN} distribution approximates a
365 blow-by-blow account.
366
367 Changes much prior to version 2.0 are lost in the mists of time.
368
369 @quotation
370 @emph{Plea:} Additions to this section are particularly welcome. If you
371 or your friends (or enemies, to be evenhanded) have been unfairly
372 omitted from this list, we would like to add your names!
373 @end quotation
374
375 So that they may not regard their many labors as thankless, we
376 particularly thank those who shepherded @value{GDBN} through major
377 releases:
378 Andrew Cagney (releases 6.3, 6.2, 6.1, 6.0, 5.3, 5.2, 5.1 and 5.0);
379 Jim Blandy (release 4.18);
380 Jason Molenda (release 4.17);
381 Stan Shebs (release 4.14);
382 Fred Fish (releases 4.16, 4.15, 4.13, 4.12, 4.11, 4.10, and 4.9);
383 Stu Grossman and John Gilmore (releases 4.8, 4.7, 4.6, 4.5, and 4.4);
384 John Gilmore (releases 4.3, 4.2, 4.1, 4.0, and 3.9);
385 Jim Kingdon (releases 3.5, 3.4, and 3.3);
386 and Randy Smith (releases 3.2, 3.1, and 3.0).
387
388 Richard Stallman, assisted at various times by Peter TerMaat, Chris
389 Hanson, and Richard Mlynarik, handled releases through 2.8.
390
391 Michael Tiemann is the author of most of the @sc{gnu} C@t{++} support
392 in @value{GDBN}, with significant additional contributions from Per
393 Bothner and Daniel Berlin. James Clark wrote the @sc{gnu} C@t{++}
394 demangler. Early work on C@t{++} was by Peter TerMaat (who also did
395 much general update work leading to release 3.0).
396
397 @value{GDBN} uses the BFD subroutine library to examine multiple
398 object-file formats; BFD was a joint project of David V.
399 Henkel-Wallace, Rich Pixley, Steve Chamberlain, and John Gilmore.
400
401 David Johnson wrote the original COFF support; Pace Willison did
402 the original support for encapsulated COFF.
403
404 Brent Benson of Harris Computer Systems contributed DWARF 2 support.
405
406 Adam de Boor and Bradley Davis contributed the ISI Optimum V support.
407 Per Bothner, Noboyuki Hikichi, and Alessandro Forin contributed MIPS
408 support.
409 Jean-Daniel Fekete contributed Sun 386i support.
410 Chris Hanson improved the HP9000 support.
411 Noboyuki Hikichi and Tomoyuki Hasei contributed Sony/News OS 3 support.
412 David Johnson contributed Encore Umax support.
413 Jyrki Kuoppala contributed Altos 3068 support.
414 Jeff Law contributed HP PA and SOM support.
415 Keith Packard contributed NS32K support.
416 Doug Rabson contributed Acorn Risc Machine support.
417 Bob Rusk contributed Harris Nighthawk CX-UX support.
418 Chris Smith contributed Convex support (and Fortran debugging).
419 Jonathan Stone contributed Pyramid support.
420 Michael Tiemann contributed SPARC support.
421 Tim Tucker contributed support for the Gould NP1 and Gould Powernode.
422 Pace Willison contributed Intel 386 support.
423 Jay Vosburgh contributed Symmetry support.
424 Marko Mlinar contributed OpenRISC 1000 support.
425
426 Andreas Schwab contributed M68K @sc{gnu}/Linux support.
427
428 Rich Schaefer and Peter Schauer helped with support of SunOS shared
429 libraries.
430
431 Jay Fenlason and Roland McGrath ensured that @value{GDBN} and GAS agree
432 about several machine instruction sets.
433
434 Patrick Duval, Ted Goldstein, Vikram Koka and Glenn Engel helped develop
435 remote debugging. Intel Corporation, Wind River Systems, AMD, and ARM
436 contributed remote debugging modules for the i960, VxWorks, A29K UDI,
437 and RDI targets, respectively.
438
439 Brian Fox is the author of the readline libraries providing
440 command-line editing and command history.
441
442 Andrew Beers of SUNY Buffalo wrote the language-switching code, the
443 Modula-2 support, and contributed the Languages chapter of this manual.
444
445 Fred Fish wrote most of the support for Unix System Vr4.
446 He also enhanced the command-completion support to cover C@t{++} overloaded
447 symbols.
448
449 Hitachi America (now Renesas America), Ltd. sponsored the support for
450 H8/300, H8/500, and Super-H processors.
451
452 NEC sponsored the support for the v850, Vr4xxx, and Vr5xxx processors.
453
454 Mitsubishi (now Renesas) sponsored the support for D10V, D30V, and M32R/D
455 processors.
456
457 Toshiba sponsored the support for the TX39 Mips processor.
458
459 Matsushita sponsored the support for the MN10200 and MN10300 processors.
460
461 Fujitsu sponsored the support for SPARClite and FR30 processors.
462
463 Kung Hsu, Jeff Law, and Rick Sladkey added support for hardware
464 watchpoints.
465
466 Michael Snyder added support for tracepoints.
467
468 Stu Grossman wrote gdbserver.
469
470 Jim Kingdon, Peter Schauer, Ian Taylor, and Stu Grossman made
471 nearly innumerable bug fixes and cleanups throughout @value{GDBN}.
472
473 The following people at the Hewlett-Packard Company contributed
474 support for the PA-RISC 2.0 architecture, HP-UX 10.20, 10.30, and 11.0
475 (narrow mode), HP's implementation of kernel threads, HP's aC@t{++}
476 compiler, and the Text User Interface (nee Terminal User Interface):
477 Ben Krepp, Richard Title, John Bishop, Susan Macchia, Kathy Mann,
478 Satish Pai, India Paul, Steve Rehrauer, and Elena Zannoni. Kim Haase
479 provided HP-specific information in this manual.
480
481 DJ Delorie ported @value{GDBN} to MS-DOS, for the DJGPP project.
482 Robert Hoehne made significant contributions to the DJGPP port.
483
484 Cygnus Solutions has sponsored @value{GDBN} maintenance and much of its
485 development since 1991. Cygnus engineers who have worked on @value{GDBN}
486 fulltime include Mark Alexander, Jim Blandy, Per Bothner, Kevin
487 Buettner, Edith Epstein, Chris Faylor, Fred Fish, Martin Hunt, Jim
488 Ingham, John Gilmore, Stu Grossman, Kung Hsu, Jim Kingdon, John Metzler,
489 Fernando Nasser, Geoffrey Noer, Dawn Perchik, Rich Pixley, Zdenek
490 Radouch, Keith Seitz, Stan Shebs, David Taylor, and Elena Zannoni. In
491 addition, Dave Brolley, Ian Carmichael, Steve Chamberlain, Nick Clifton,
492 JT Conklin, Stan Cox, DJ Delorie, Ulrich Drepper, Frank Eigler, Doug
493 Evans, Sean Fagan, David Henkel-Wallace, Richard Henderson, Jeff
494 Holcomb, Jeff Law, Jim Lemke, Tom Lord, Bob Manson, Michael Meissner,
495 Jason Merrill, Catherine Moore, Drew Moseley, Ken Raeburn, Gavin
496 Romig-Koch, Rob Savoye, Jamie Smith, Mike Stump, Ian Taylor, Angela
497 Thomas, Michael Tiemann, Tom Tromey, Ron Unrau, Jim Wilson, and David
498 Zuhn have made contributions both large and small.
499
500 Andrew Cagney, Fernando Nasser, and Elena Zannoni, while working for
501 Cygnus Solutions, implemented the original @sc{gdb/mi} interface.
502
503 Jim Blandy added support for preprocessor macros, while working for Red
504 Hat.
505
506 Andrew Cagney designed @value{GDBN}'s architecture vector. Many
507 people including Andrew Cagney, Stephane Carrez, Randolph Chung, Nick
508 Duffek, Richard Henderson, Mark Kettenis, Grace Sainsbury, Kei
509 Sakamoto, Yoshinori Sato, Michael Snyder, Andreas Schwab, Jason
510 Thorpe, Corinna Vinschen, Ulrich Weigand, and Elena Zannoni, helped
511 with the migration of old architectures to this new framework.
512
513 Andrew Cagney completely re-designed and re-implemented @value{GDBN}'s
514 unwinder framework, this consisting of a fresh new design featuring
515 frame IDs, independent frame sniffers, and the sentinel frame. Mark
516 Kettenis implemented the @sc{dwarf 2} unwinder, Jeff Johnston the
517 libunwind unwinder, and Andrew Cagney the dummy, sentinel, tramp, and
518 trad unwinders. The architecture-specific changes, each involving a
519 complete rewrite of the architecture's frame code, were carried out by
520 Jim Blandy, Joel Brobecker, Kevin Buettner, Andrew Cagney, Stephane
521 Carrez, Randolph Chung, Orjan Friberg, Richard Henderson, Daniel
522 Jacobowitz, Jeff Johnston, Mark Kettenis, Theodore A. Roth, Kei
523 Sakamoto, Yoshinori Sato, Michael Snyder, Corinna Vinschen, and Ulrich
524 Weigand.
525
526 Christian Zankel, Ross Morley, Bob Wilson, and Maxim Grigoriev from
527 Tensilica, Inc.@: contributed support for Xtensa processors. Others
528 who have worked on the Xtensa port of @value{GDBN} in the past include
529 Steve Tjiang, John Newlin, and Scott Foehner.
530
531 Michael Eager and staff of Xilinx, Inc., contributed support for the
532 Xilinx MicroBlaze architecture.
533
534 @node Sample Session
535 @chapter A Sample @value{GDBN} Session
536
537 You can use this manual at your leisure to read all about @value{GDBN}.
538 However, a handful of commands are enough to get started using the
539 debugger. This chapter illustrates those commands.
540
541 @iftex
542 In this sample session, we emphasize user input like this: @b{input},
543 to make it easier to pick out from the surrounding output.
544 @end iftex
545
546 @c FIXME: this example may not be appropriate for some configs, where
547 @c FIXME...primary interest is in remote use.
548
549 One of the preliminary versions of @sc{gnu} @code{m4} (a generic macro
550 processor) exhibits the following bug: sometimes, when we change its
551 quote strings from the default, the commands used to capture one macro
552 definition within another stop working. In the following short @code{m4}
553 session, we define a macro @code{foo} which expands to @code{0000}; we
554 then use the @code{m4} built-in @code{defn} to define @code{bar} as the
555 same thing. However, when we change the open quote string to
556 @code{<QUOTE>} and the close quote string to @code{<UNQUOTE>}, the same
557 procedure fails to define a new synonym @code{baz}:
558
559 @smallexample
560 $ @b{cd gnu/m4}
561 $ @b{./m4}
562 @b{define(foo,0000)}
563
564 @b{foo}
565 0000
566 @b{define(bar,defn(`foo'))}
567
568 @b{bar}
569 0000
570 @b{changequote(<QUOTE>,<UNQUOTE>)}
571
572 @b{define(baz,defn(<QUOTE>foo<UNQUOTE>))}
573 @b{baz}
574 @b{Ctrl-d}
575 m4: End of input: 0: fatal error: EOF in string
576 @end smallexample
577
578 @noindent
579 Let us use @value{GDBN} to try to see what is going on.
580
581 @smallexample
582 $ @b{@value{GDBP} m4}
583 @c FIXME: this falsifies the exact text played out, to permit smallbook
584 @c FIXME... format to come out better.
585 @value{GDBN} is free software and you are welcome to distribute copies
586 of it under certain conditions; type "show copying" to see
587 the conditions.
588 There is absolutely no warranty for @value{GDBN}; type "show warranty"
589 for details.
590
591 @value{GDBN} @value{GDBVN}, Copyright 1999 Free Software Foundation, Inc...
592 (@value{GDBP})
593 @end smallexample
594
595 @noindent
596 @value{GDBN} reads only enough symbol data to know where to find the
597 rest when needed; as a result, the first prompt comes up very quickly.
598 We now tell @value{GDBN} to use a narrower display width than usual, so
599 that examples fit in this manual.
600
601 @smallexample
602 (@value{GDBP}) @b{set width 70}
603 @end smallexample
604
605 @noindent
606 We need to see how the @code{m4} built-in @code{changequote} works.
607 Having looked at the source, we know the relevant subroutine is
608 @code{m4_changequote}, so we set a breakpoint there with the @value{GDBN}
609 @code{break} command.
610
611 @smallexample
612 (@value{GDBP}) @b{break m4_changequote}
613 Breakpoint 1 at 0x62f4: file builtin.c, line 879.
614 @end smallexample
615
616 @noindent
617 Using the @code{run} command, we start @code{m4} running under @value{GDBN}
618 control; as long as control does not reach the @code{m4_changequote}
619 subroutine, the program runs as usual:
620
621 @smallexample
622 (@value{GDBP}) @b{run}
623 Starting program: /work/Editorial/gdb/gnu/m4/m4
624 @b{define(foo,0000)}
625
626 @b{foo}
627 0000
628 @end smallexample
629
630 @noindent
631 To trigger the breakpoint, we call @code{changequote}. @value{GDBN}
632 suspends execution of @code{m4}, displaying information about the
633 context where it stops.
634
635 @smallexample
636 @b{changequote(<QUOTE>,<UNQUOTE>)}
637
638 Breakpoint 1, m4_changequote (argc=3, argv=0x33c70)
639 at builtin.c:879
640 879 if (bad_argc(TOKEN_DATA_TEXT(argv[0]),argc,1,3))
641 @end smallexample
642
643 @noindent
644 Now we use the command @code{n} (@code{next}) to advance execution to
645 the next line of the current function.
646
647 @smallexample
648 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
649 882 set_quotes((argc >= 2) ? TOKEN_DATA_TEXT(argv[1])\
650 : nil,
651 @end smallexample
652
653 @noindent
654 @code{set_quotes} looks like a promising subroutine. We can go into it
655 by using the command @code{s} (@code{step}) instead of @code{next}.
656 @code{step} goes to the next line to be executed in @emph{any}
657 subroutine, so it steps into @code{set_quotes}.
658
659 @smallexample
660 (@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
661 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<QUOTE>", rq=0x34c88 "<UNQUOTE>")
662 at input.c:530
663 530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
664 @end smallexample
665
666 @noindent
667 The display that shows the subroutine where @code{m4} is now
668 suspended (and its arguments) is called a stack frame display. It
669 shows a summary of the stack. We can use the @code{backtrace}
670 command (which can also be spelled @code{bt}), to see where we are
671 in the stack as a whole: the @code{backtrace} command displays a
672 stack frame for each active subroutine.
673
674 @smallexample
675 (@value{GDBP}) @b{bt}
676 #0 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<QUOTE>", rq=0x34c88 "<UNQUOTE>")
677 at input.c:530
678 #1 0x6344 in m4_changequote (argc=3, argv=0x33c70)
679 at builtin.c:882
680 #2 0x8174 in expand_macro (sym=0x33320) at macro.c:242
681 #3 0x7a88 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=209696, td=0xf7fffa30)
682 at macro.c:71
683 #4 0x79dc in expand_input () at macro.c:40
684 #5 0x2930 in main (argc=0, argv=0xf7fffb20) at m4.c:195
685 @end smallexample
686
687 @noindent
688 We step through a few more lines to see what happens. The first two
689 times, we can use @samp{s}; the next two times we use @code{n} to avoid
690 falling into the @code{xstrdup} subroutine.
691
692 @smallexample
693 (@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
694 0x3b5c 532 if (rquote != def_rquote)
695 (@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
696 0x3b80 535 lquote = (lq == nil || *lq == '\0') ? \
697 def_lquote : xstrdup(lq);
698 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
699 536 rquote = (rq == nil || *rq == '\0') ? def_rquote\
700 : xstrdup(rq);
701 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
702 538 len_lquote = strlen(rquote);
703 @end smallexample
704
705 @noindent
706 The last line displayed looks a little odd; we can examine the variables
707 @code{lquote} and @code{rquote} to see if they are in fact the new left
708 and right quotes we specified. We use the command @code{p}
709 (@code{print}) to see their values.
710
711 @smallexample
712 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p lquote}
713 $1 = 0x35d40 "<QUOTE>"
714 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p rquote}
715 $2 = 0x35d50 "<UNQUOTE>"
716 @end smallexample
717
718 @noindent
719 @code{lquote} and @code{rquote} are indeed the new left and right quotes.
720 To look at some context, we can display ten lines of source
721 surrounding the current line with the @code{l} (@code{list}) command.
722
723 @smallexample
724 (@value{GDBP}) @b{l}
725 533 xfree(rquote);
726 534
727 535 lquote = (lq == nil || *lq == '\0') ? def_lquote\
728 : xstrdup (lq);
729 536 rquote = (rq == nil || *rq == '\0') ? def_rquote\
730 : xstrdup (rq);
731 537
732 538 len_lquote = strlen(rquote);
733 539 len_rquote = strlen(lquote);
734 540 @}
735 541
736 542 void
737 @end smallexample
738
739 @noindent
740 Let us step past the two lines that set @code{len_lquote} and
741 @code{len_rquote}, and then examine the values of those variables.
742
743 @smallexample
744 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
745 539 len_rquote = strlen(lquote);
746 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
747 540 @}
748 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_lquote}
749 $3 = 9
750 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_rquote}
751 $4 = 7
752 @end smallexample
753
754 @noindent
755 That certainly looks wrong, assuming @code{len_lquote} and
756 @code{len_rquote} are meant to be the lengths of @code{lquote} and
757 @code{rquote} respectively. We can set them to better values using
758 the @code{p} command, since it can print the value of
759 any expression---and that expression can include subroutine calls and
760 assignments.
761
762 @smallexample
763 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_lquote=strlen(lquote)}
764 $5 = 7
765 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_rquote=strlen(rquote)}
766 $6 = 9
767 @end smallexample
768
769 @noindent
770 Is that enough to fix the problem of using the new quotes with the
771 @code{m4} built-in @code{defn}? We can allow @code{m4} to continue
772 executing with the @code{c} (@code{continue}) command, and then try the
773 example that caused trouble initially:
774
775 @smallexample
776 (@value{GDBP}) @b{c}
777 Continuing.
778
779 @b{define(baz,defn(<QUOTE>foo<UNQUOTE>))}
780
781 baz
782 0000
783 @end smallexample
784
785 @noindent
786 Success! The new quotes now work just as well as the default ones. The
787 problem seems to have been just the two typos defining the wrong
788 lengths. We allow @code{m4} exit by giving it an EOF as input:
789
790 @smallexample
791 @b{Ctrl-d}
792 Program exited normally.
793 @end smallexample
794
795 @noindent
796 The message @samp{Program exited normally.} is from @value{GDBN}; it
797 indicates @code{m4} has finished executing. We can end our @value{GDBN}
798 session with the @value{GDBN} @code{quit} command.
799
800 @smallexample
801 (@value{GDBP}) @b{quit}
802 @end smallexample
803
804 @node Invocation
805 @chapter Getting In and Out of @value{GDBN}
806
807 This chapter discusses how to start @value{GDBN}, and how to get out of it.
808 The essentials are:
809 @itemize @bullet
810 @item
811 type @samp{@value{GDBP}} to start @value{GDBN}.
812 @item
813 type @kbd{quit} or @kbd{Ctrl-d} to exit.
814 @end itemize
815
816 @menu
817 * Invoking GDB:: How to start @value{GDBN}
818 * Quitting GDB:: How to quit @value{GDBN}
819 * Shell Commands:: How to use shell commands inside @value{GDBN}
820 * Logging Output:: How to log @value{GDBN}'s output to a file
821 @end menu
822
823 @node Invoking GDB
824 @section Invoking @value{GDBN}
825
826 Invoke @value{GDBN} by running the program @code{@value{GDBP}}. Once started,
827 @value{GDBN} reads commands from the terminal until you tell it to exit.
828
829 You can also run @code{@value{GDBP}} with a variety of arguments and options,
830 to specify more of your debugging environment at the outset.
831
832 The command-line options described here are designed
833 to cover a variety of situations; in some environments, some of these
834 options may effectively be unavailable.
835
836 The most usual way to start @value{GDBN} is with one argument,
837 specifying an executable program:
838
839 @smallexample
840 @value{GDBP} @var{program}
841 @end smallexample
842
843 @noindent
844 You can also start with both an executable program and a core file
845 specified:
846
847 @smallexample
848 @value{GDBP} @var{program} @var{core}
849 @end smallexample
850
851 You can, instead, specify a process ID as a second argument, if you want
852 to debug a running process:
853
854 @smallexample
855 @value{GDBP} @var{program} 1234
856 @end smallexample
857
858 @noindent
859 would attach @value{GDBN} to process @code{1234} (unless you also have a file
860 named @file{1234}; @value{GDBN} does check for a core file first).
861
862 Taking advantage of the second command-line argument requires a fairly
863 complete operating system; when you use @value{GDBN} as a remote
864 debugger attached to a bare board, there may not be any notion of
865 ``process'', and there is often no way to get a core dump. @value{GDBN}
866 will warn you if it is unable to attach or to read core dumps.
867
868 You can optionally have @code{@value{GDBP}} pass any arguments after the
869 executable file to the inferior using @code{--args}. This option stops
870 option processing.
871 @smallexample
872 @value{GDBP} --args gcc -O2 -c foo.c
873 @end smallexample
874 This will cause @code{@value{GDBP}} to debug @code{gcc}, and to set
875 @code{gcc}'s command-line arguments (@pxref{Arguments}) to @samp{-O2 -c foo.c}.
876
877 You can run @code{@value{GDBP}} without printing the front material, which describes
878 @value{GDBN}'s non-warranty, by specifying @code{-silent}:
879
880 @smallexample
881 @value{GDBP} -silent
882 @end smallexample
883
884 @noindent
885 You can further control how @value{GDBN} starts up by using command-line
886 options. @value{GDBN} itself can remind you of the options available.
887
888 @noindent
889 Type
890
891 @smallexample
892 @value{GDBP} -help
893 @end smallexample
894
895 @noindent
896 to display all available options and briefly describe their use
897 (@samp{@value{GDBP} -h} is a shorter equivalent).
898
899 All options and command line arguments you give are processed
900 in sequential order. The order makes a difference when the
901 @samp{-x} option is used.
902
903
904 @menu
905 * File Options:: Choosing files
906 * Mode Options:: Choosing modes
907 * Startup:: What @value{GDBN} does during startup
908 @end menu
909
910 @node File Options
911 @subsection Choosing Files
912
913 When @value{GDBN} starts, it reads any arguments other than options as
914 specifying an executable file and core file (or process ID). This is
915 the same as if the arguments were specified by the @samp{-se} and
916 @samp{-c} (or @samp{-p}) options respectively. (@value{GDBN} reads the
917 first argument that does not have an associated option flag as
918 equivalent to the @samp{-se} option followed by that argument; and the
919 second argument that does not have an associated option flag, if any, as
920 equivalent to the @samp{-c}/@samp{-p} option followed by that argument.)
921 If the second argument begins with a decimal digit, @value{GDBN} will
922 first attempt to attach to it as a process, and if that fails, attempt
923 to open it as a corefile. If you have a corefile whose name begins with
924 a digit, you can prevent @value{GDBN} from treating it as a pid by
925 prefixing it with @file{./}, e.g.@: @file{./12345}.
926
927 If @value{GDBN} has not been configured to included core file support,
928 such as for most embedded targets, then it will complain about a second
929 argument and ignore it.
930
931 Many options have both long and short forms; both are shown in the
932 following list. @value{GDBN} also recognizes the long forms if you truncate
933 them, so long as enough of the option is present to be unambiguous.
934 (If you prefer, you can flag option arguments with @samp{--} rather
935 than @samp{-}, though we illustrate the more usual convention.)
936
937 @c NOTE: the @cindex entries here use double dashes ON PURPOSE. This
938 @c way, both those who look for -foo and --foo in the index, will find
939 @c it.
940
941 @table @code
942 @item -symbols @var{file}
943 @itemx -s @var{file}
944 @cindex @code{--symbols}
945 @cindex @code{-s}
946 Read symbol table from file @var{file}.
947
948 @item -exec @var{file}
949 @itemx -e @var{file}
950 @cindex @code{--exec}
951 @cindex @code{-e}
952 Use file @var{file} as the executable file to execute when appropriate,
953 and for examining pure data in conjunction with a core dump.
954
955 @item -se @var{file}
956 @cindex @code{--se}
957 Read symbol table from file @var{file} and use it as the executable
958 file.
959
960 @item -core @var{file}
961 @itemx -c @var{file}
962 @cindex @code{--core}
963 @cindex @code{-c}
964 Use file @var{file} as a core dump to examine.
965
966 @item -pid @var{number}
967 @itemx -p @var{number}
968 @cindex @code{--pid}
969 @cindex @code{-p}
970 Connect to process ID @var{number}, as with the @code{attach} command.
971
972 @item -command @var{file}
973 @itemx -x @var{file}
974 @cindex @code{--command}
975 @cindex @code{-x}
976 Execute commands from file @var{file}. The contents of this file is
977 evaluated exactly as the @code{source} command would.
978 @xref{Command Files,, Command files}.
979
980 @item -eval-command @var{command}
981 @itemx -ex @var{command}
982 @cindex @code{--eval-command}
983 @cindex @code{-ex}
984 Execute a single @value{GDBN} command.
985
986 This option may be used multiple times to call multiple commands. It may
987 also be interleaved with @samp{-command} as required.
988
989 @smallexample
990 @value{GDBP} -ex 'target sim' -ex 'load' \
991 -x setbreakpoints -ex 'run' a.out
992 @end smallexample
993
994 @item -directory @var{directory}
995 @itemx -d @var{directory}
996 @cindex @code{--directory}
997 @cindex @code{-d}
998 Add @var{directory} to the path to search for source and script files.
999
1000 @item -r
1001 @itemx -readnow
1002 @cindex @code{--readnow}
1003 @cindex @code{-r}
1004 Read each symbol file's entire symbol table immediately, rather than
1005 the default, which is to read it incrementally as it is needed.
1006 This makes startup slower, but makes future operations faster.
1007
1008 @end table
1009
1010 @node Mode Options
1011 @subsection Choosing Modes
1012
1013 You can run @value{GDBN} in various alternative modes---for example, in
1014 batch mode or quiet mode.
1015
1016 @table @code
1017 @item -nx
1018 @itemx -n
1019 @cindex @code{--nx}
1020 @cindex @code{-n}
1021 Do not execute commands found in any initialization files. Normally,
1022 @value{GDBN} executes the commands in these files after all the command
1023 options and arguments have been processed. @xref{Command Files,,Command
1024 Files}.
1025
1026 @item -quiet
1027 @itemx -silent
1028 @itemx -q
1029 @cindex @code{--quiet}
1030 @cindex @code{--silent}
1031 @cindex @code{-q}
1032 ``Quiet''. Do not print the introductory and copyright messages. These
1033 messages are also suppressed in batch mode.
1034
1035 @item -batch
1036 @cindex @code{--batch}
1037 Run in batch mode. Exit with status @code{0} after processing all the
1038 command files specified with @samp{-x} (and all commands from
1039 initialization files, if not inhibited with @samp{-n}). Exit with
1040 nonzero status if an error occurs in executing the @value{GDBN} commands
1041 in the command files. Batch mode also disables pagination, sets unlimited
1042 terminal width and height @pxref{Screen Size}, and acts as if @kbd{set confirm
1043 off} were in effect (@pxref{Messages/Warnings}).
1044
1045 Batch mode may be useful for running @value{GDBN} as a filter, for
1046 example to download and run a program on another computer; in order to
1047 make this more useful, the message
1048
1049 @smallexample
1050 Program exited normally.
1051 @end smallexample
1052
1053 @noindent
1054 (which is ordinarily issued whenever a program running under
1055 @value{GDBN} control terminates) is not issued when running in batch
1056 mode.
1057
1058 @item -batch-silent
1059 @cindex @code{--batch-silent}
1060 Run in batch mode exactly like @samp{-batch}, but totally silently. All
1061 @value{GDBN} output to @code{stdout} is prevented (@code{stderr} is
1062 unaffected). This is much quieter than @samp{-silent} and would be useless
1063 for an interactive session.
1064
1065 This is particularly useful when using targets that give @samp{Loading section}
1066 messages, for example.
1067
1068 Note that targets that give their output via @value{GDBN}, as opposed to
1069 writing directly to @code{stdout}, will also be made silent.
1070
1071 @item -return-child-result
1072 @cindex @code{--return-child-result}
1073 The return code from @value{GDBN} will be the return code from the child
1074 process (the process being debugged), with the following exceptions:
1075
1076 @itemize @bullet
1077 @item
1078 @value{GDBN} exits abnormally. E.g., due to an incorrect argument or an
1079 internal error. In this case the exit code is the same as it would have been
1080 without @samp{-return-child-result}.
1081 @item
1082 The user quits with an explicit value. E.g., @samp{quit 1}.
1083 @item
1084 The child process never runs, or is not allowed to terminate, in which case
1085 the exit code will be -1.
1086 @end itemize
1087
1088 This option is useful in conjunction with @samp{-batch} or @samp{-batch-silent},
1089 when @value{GDBN} is being used as a remote program loader or simulator
1090 interface.
1091
1092 @item -nowindows
1093 @itemx -nw
1094 @cindex @code{--nowindows}
1095 @cindex @code{-nw}
1096 ``No windows''. If @value{GDBN} comes with a graphical user interface
1097 (GUI) built in, then this option tells @value{GDBN} to only use the command-line
1098 interface. If no GUI is available, this option has no effect.
1099
1100 @item -windows
1101 @itemx -w
1102 @cindex @code{--windows}
1103 @cindex @code{-w}
1104 If @value{GDBN} includes a GUI, then this option requires it to be
1105 used if possible.
1106
1107 @item -cd @var{directory}
1108 @cindex @code{--cd}
1109 Run @value{GDBN} using @var{directory} as its working directory,
1110 instead of the current directory.
1111
1112 @item -data-directory @var{directory}
1113 @cindex @code{--data-directory}
1114 Run @value{GDBN} using @var{directory} as its data directory.
1115 The data directory is where @value{GDBN} searches for its
1116 auxiliary files. @xref{Data Files}.
1117
1118 @item -fullname
1119 @itemx -f
1120 @cindex @code{--fullname}
1121 @cindex @code{-f}
1122 @sc{gnu} Emacs sets this option when it runs @value{GDBN} as a
1123 subprocess. It tells @value{GDBN} to output the full file name and line
1124 number in a standard, recognizable fashion each time a stack frame is
1125 displayed (which includes each time your program stops). This
1126 recognizable format looks like two @samp{\032} characters, followed by
1127 the file name, line number and character position separated by colons,
1128 and a newline. The Emacs-to-@value{GDBN} interface program uses the two
1129 @samp{\032} characters as a signal to display the source code for the
1130 frame.
1131
1132 @item -epoch
1133 @cindex @code{--epoch}
1134 The Epoch Emacs-@value{GDBN} interface sets this option when it runs
1135 @value{GDBN} as a subprocess. It tells @value{GDBN} to modify its print
1136 routines so as to allow Epoch to display values of expressions in a
1137 separate window.
1138
1139 @item -annotate @var{level}
1140 @cindex @code{--annotate}
1141 This option sets the @dfn{annotation level} inside @value{GDBN}. Its
1142 effect is identical to using @samp{set annotate @var{level}}
1143 (@pxref{Annotations}). The annotation @var{level} controls how much
1144 information @value{GDBN} prints together with its prompt, values of
1145 expressions, source lines, and other types of output. Level 0 is the
1146 normal, level 1 is for use when @value{GDBN} is run as a subprocess of
1147 @sc{gnu} Emacs, level 3 is the maximum annotation suitable for programs
1148 that control @value{GDBN}, and level 2 has been deprecated.
1149
1150 The annotation mechanism has largely been superseded by @sc{gdb/mi}
1151 (@pxref{GDB/MI}).
1152
1153 @item --args
1154 @cindex @code{--args}
1155 Change interpretation of command line so that arguments following the
1156 executable file are passed as command line arguments to the inferior.
1157 This option stops option processing.
1158
1159 @item -baud @var{bps}
1160 @itemx -b @var{bps}
1161 @cindex @code{--baud}
1162 @cindex @code{-b}
1163 Set the line speed (baud rate or bits per second) of any serial
1164 interface used by @value{GDBN} for remote debugging.
1165
1166 @item -l @var{timeout}
1167 @cindex @code{-l}
1168 Set the timeout (in seconds) of any communication used by @value{GDBN}
1169 for remote debugging.
1170
1171 @item -tty @var{device}
1172 @itemx -t @var{device}
1173 @cindex @code{--tty}
1174 @cindex @code{-t}
1175 Run using @var{device} for your program's standard input and output.
1176 @c FIXME: kingdon thinks there is more to -tty. Investigate.
1177
1178 @c resolve the situation of these eventually
1179 @item -tui
1180 @cindex @code{--tui}
1181 Activate the @dfn{Text User Interface} when starting. The Text User
1182 Interface manages several text windows on the terminal, showing
1183 source, assembly, registers and @value{GDBN} command outputs
1184 (@pxref{TUI, ,@value{GDBN} Text User Interface}). Alternatively, the
1185 Text User Interface can be enabled by invoking the program
1186 @samp{@value{GDBTUI}}. Do not use this option if you run @value{GDBN} from
1187 Emacs (@pxref{Emacs, ,Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs}).
1188
1189 @c @item -xdb
1190 @c @cindex @code{--xdb}
1191 @c Run in XDB compatibility mode, allowing the use of certain XDB commands.
1192 @c For information, see the file @file{xdb_trans.html}, which is usually
1193 @c installed in the directory @code{/opt/langtools/wdb/doc} on HP-UX
1194 @c systems.
1195
1196 @item -interpreter @var{interp}
1197 @cindex @code{--interpreter}
1198 Use the interpreter @var{interp} for interface with the controlling
1199 program or device. This option is meant to be set by programs which
1200 communicate with @value{GDBN} using it as a back end.
1201 @xref{Interpreters, , Command Interpreters}.
1202
1203 @samp{--interpreter=mi} (or @samp{--interpreter=mi2}) causes
1204 @value{GDBN} to use the @dfn{@sc{gdb/mi} interface} (@pxref{GDB/MI, ,
1205 The @sc{gdb/mi} Interface}) included since @value{GDBN} version 6.0. The
1206 previous @sc{gdb/mi} interface, included in @value{GDBN} version 5.3 and
1207 selected with @samp{--interpreter=mi1}, is deprecated. Earlier
1208 @sc{gdb/mi} interfaces are no longer supported.
1209
1210 @item -write
1211 @cindex @code{--write}
1212 Open the executable and core files for both reading and writing. This
1213 is equivalent to the @samp{set write on} command inside @value{GDBN}
1214 (@pxref{Patching}).
1215
1216 @item -statistics
1217 @cindex @code{--statistics}
1218 This option causes @value{GDBN} to print statistics about time and
1219 memory usage after it completes each command and returns to the prompt.
1220
1221 @item -version
1222 @cindex @code{--version}
1223 This option causes @value{GDBN} to print its version number and
1224 no-warranty blurb, and exit.
1225
1226 @end table
1227
1228 @node Startup
1229 @subsection What @value{GDBN} Does During Startup
1230 @cindex @value{GDBN} startup
1231
1232 Here's the description of what @value{GDBN} does during session startup:
1233
1234 @enumerate
1235 @item
1236 Sets up the command interpreter as specified by the command line
1237 (@pxref{Mode Options, interpreter}).
1238
1239 @item
1240 @cindex init file
1241 Reads the system-wide @dfn{init file} (if @option{--with-system-gdbinit} was
1242 used when building @value{GDBN}; @pxref{System-wide configuration,
1243 ,System-wide configuration and settings}) and executes all the commands in
1244 that file.
1245
1246 @item
1247 Reads the init file (if any) in your home directory@footnote{On
1248 DOS/Windows systems, the home directory is the one pointed to by the
1249 @code{HOME} environment variable.} and executes all the commands in
1250 that file.
1251
1252 @item
1253 Processes command line options and operands.
1254
1255 @item
1256 Reads and executes the commands from init file (if any) in the current
1257 working directory. This is only done if the current directory is
1258 different from your home directory. Thus, you can have more than one
1259 init file, one generic in your home directory, and another, specific
1260 to the program you are debugging, in the directory where you invoke
1261 @value{GDBN}.
1262
1263 @item
1264 If the command line specified a program to debug, or a process to
1265 attach to, or a core file, @value{GDBN} loads any auto-loaded
1266 scripts provided for the program or for its loaded shared libraries.
1267 @xref{Auto-loading}.
1268
1269 If you wish to disable the auto-loading during startup,
1270 you must do something like the following:
1271
1272 @smallexample
1273 $ gdb -ex "set auto-load-scripts off" -ex "file myprogram"
1274 @end smallexample
1275
1276 The following does not work because the auto-loading is turned off too late:
1277
1278 @smallexample
1279 $ gdb -ex "set auto-load-scripts off" myprogram
1280 @end smallexample
1281
1282 @item
1283 Reads command files specified by the @samp{-x} option. @xref{Command
1284 Files}, for more details about @value{GDBN} command files.
1285
1286 @item
1287 Reads the command history recorded in the @dfn{history file}.
1288 @xref{Command History}, for more details about the command history and the
1289 files where @value{GDBN} records it.
1290 @end enumerate
1291
1292 Init files use the same syntax as @dfn{command files} (@pxref{Command
1293 Files}) and are processed by @value{GDBN} in the same way. The init
1294 file in your home directory can set options (such as @samp{set
1295 complaints}) that affect subsequent processing of command line options
1296 and operands. Init files are not executed if you use the @samp{-nx}
1297 option (@pxref{Mode Options, ,Choosing Modes}).
1298
1299 To display the list of init files loaded by gdb at startup, you
1300 can use @kbd{gdb --help}.
1301
1302 @cindex init file name
1303 @cindex @file{.gdbinit}
1304 @cindex @file{gdb.ini}
1305 The @value{GDBN} init files are normally called @file{.gdbinit}.
1306 The DJGPP port of @value{GDBN} uses the name @file{gdb.ini}, due to
1307 the limitations of file names imposed by DOS filesystems. The Windows
1308 ports of @value{GDBN} use the standard name, but if they find a
1309 @file{gdb.ini} file, they warn you about that and suggest to rename
1310 the file to the standard name.
1311
1312
1313 @node Quitting GDB
1314 @section Quitting @value{GDBN}
1315 @cindex exiting @value{GDBN}
1316 @cindex leaving @value{GDBN}
1317
1318 @table @code
1319 @kindex quit @r{[}@var{expression}@r{]}
1320 @kindex q @r{(@code{quit})}
1321 @item quit @r{[}@var{expression}@r{]}
1322 @itemx q
1323 To exit @value{GDBN}, use the @code{quit} command (abbreviated
1324 @code{q}), or type an end-of-file character (usually @kbd{Ctrl-d}). If you
1325 do not supply @var{expression}, @value{GDBN} will terminate normally;
1326 otherwise it will terminate using the result of @var{expression} as the
1327 error code.
1328 @end table
1329
1330 @cindex interrupt
1331 An interrupt (often @kbd{Ctrl-c}) does not exit from @value{GDBN}, but rather
1332 terminates the action of any @value{GDBN} command that is in progress and
1333 returns to @value{GDBN} command level. It is safe to type the interrupt
1334 character at any time because @value{GDBN} does not allow it to take effect
1335 until a time when it is safe.
1336
1337 If you have been using @value{GDBN} to control an attached process or
1338 device, you can release it with the @code{detach} command
1339 (@pxref{Attach, ,Debugging an Already-running Process}).
1340
1341 @node Shell Commands
1342 @section Shell Commands
1343
1344 If you need to execute occasional shell commands during your
1345 debugging session, there is no need to leave or suspend @value{GDBN}; you can
1346 just use the @code{shell} command.
1347
1348 @table @code
1349 @kindex shell
1350 @kindex !
1351 @cindex shell escape
1352 @item shell @var{command-string}
1353 @itemx !@var{command-string}
1354 Invoke a standard shell to execute @var{command-string}.
1355 Note that no space is needed between @code{!} and @var{command-string}.
1356 If it exists, the environment variable @code{SHELL} determines which
1357 shell to run. Otherwise @value{GDBN} uses the default shell
1358 (@file{/bin/sh} on Unix systems, @file{COMMAND.COM} on MS-DOS, etc.).
1359 @end table
1360
1361 The utility @code{make} is often needed in development environments.
1362 You do not have to use the @code{shell} command for this purpose in
1363 @value{GDBN}:
1364
1365 @table @code
1366 @kindex make
1367 @cindex calling make
1368 @item make @var{make-args}
1369 Execute the @code{make} program with the specified
1370 arguments. This is equivalent to @samp{shell make @var{make-args}}.
1371 @end table
1372
1373 @node Logging Output
1374 @section Logging Output
1375 @cindex logging @value{GDBN} output
1376 @cindex save @value{GDBN} output to a file
1377
1378 You may want to save the output of @value{GDBN} commands to a file.
1379 There are several commands to control @value{GDBN}'s logging.
1380
1381 @table @code
1382 @kindex set logging
1383 @item set logging on
1384 Enable logging.
1385 @item set logging off
1386 Disable logging.
1387 @cindex logging file name
1388 @item set logging file @var{file}
1389 Change the name of the current logfile. The default logfile is @file{gdb.txt}.
1390 @item set logging overwrite [on|off]
1391 By default, @value{GDBN} will append to the logfile. Set @code{overwrite} if
1392 you want @code{set logging on} to overwrite the logfile instead.
1393 @item set logging redirect [on|off]
1394 By default, @value{GDBN} output will go to both the terminal and the logfile.
1395 Set @code{redirect} if you want output to go only to the log file.
1396 @kindex show logging
1397 @item show logging
1398 Show the current values of the logging settings.
1399 @end table
1400
1401 @node Commands
1402 @chapter @value{GDBN} Commands
1403
1404 You can abbreviate a @value{GDBN} command to the first few letters of the command
1405 name, if that abbreviation is unambiguous; and you can repeat certain
1406 @value{GDBN} commands by typing just @key{RET}. You can also use the @key{TAB}
1407 key to get @value{GDBN} to fill out the rest of a word in a command (or to
1408 show you the alternatives available, if there is more than one possibility).
1409
1410 @menu
1411 * Command Syntax:: How to give commands to @value{GDBN}
1412 * Completion:: Command completion
1413 * Help:: How to ask @value{GDBN} for help
1414 @end menu
1415
1416 @node Command Syntax
1417 @section Command Syntax
1418
1419 A @value{GDBN} command is a single line of input. There is no limit on
1420 how long it can be. It starts with a command name, which is followed by
1421 arguments whose meaning depends on the command name. For example, the
1422 command @code{step} accepts an argument which is the number of times to
1423 step, as in @samp{step 5}. You can also use the @code{step} command
1424 with no arguments. Some commands do not allow any arguments.
1425
1426 @cindex abbreviation
1427 @value{GDBN} command names may always be truncated if that abbreviation is
1428 unambiguous. Other possible command abbreviations are listed in the
1429 documentation for individual commands. In some cases, even ambiguous
1430 abbreviations are allowed; for example, @code{s} is specially defined as
1431 equivalent to @code{step} even though there are other commands whose
1432 names start with @code{s}. You can test abbreviations by using them as
1433 arguments to the @code{help} command.
1434
1435 @cindex repeating commands
1436 @kindex RET @r{(repeat last command)}
1437 A blank line as input to @value{GDBN} (typing just @key{RET}) means to
1438 repeat the previous command. Certain commands (for example, @code{run})
1439 will not repeat this way; these are commands whose unintentional
1440 repetition might cause trouble and which you are unlikely to want to
1441 repeat. User-defined commands can disable this feature; see
1442 @ref{Define, dont-repeat}.
1443
1444 The @code{list} and @code{x} commands, when you repeat them with
1445 @key{RET}, construct new arguments rather than repeating
1446 exactly as typed. This permits easy scanning of source or memory.
1447
1448 @value{GDBN} can also use @key{RET} in another way: to partition lengthy
1449 output, in a way similar to the common utility @code{more}
1450 (@pxref{Screen Size,,Screen Size}). Since it is easy to press one
1451 @key{RET} too many in this situation, @value{GDBN} disables command
1452 repetition after any command that generates this sort of display.
1453
1454 @kindex # @r{(a comment)}
1455 @cindex comment
1456 Any text from a @kbd{#} to the end of the line is a comment; it does
1457 nothing. This is useful mainly in command files (@pxref{Command
1458 Files,,Command Files}).
1459
1460 @cindex repeating command sequences
1461 @kindex Ctrl-o @r{(operate-and-get-next)}
1462 The @kbd{Ctrl-o} binding is useful for repeating a complex sequence of
1463 commands. This command accepts the current line, like @key{RET}, and
1464 then fetches the next line relative to the current line from the history
1465 for editing.
1466
1467 @node Completion
1468 @section Command Completion
1469
1470 @cindex completion
1471 @cindex word completion
1472 @value{GDBN} can fill in the rest of a word in a command for you, if there is
1473 only one possibility; it can also show you what the valid possibilities
1474 are for the next word in a command, at any time. This works for @value{GDBN}
1475 commands, @value{GDBN} subcommands, and the names of symbols in your program.
1476
1477 Press the @key{TAB} key whenever you want @value{GDBN} to fill out the rest
1478 of a word. If there is only one possibility, @value{GDBN} fills in the
1479 word, and waits for you to finish the command (or press @key{RET} to
1480 enter it). For example, if you type
1481
1482 @c FIXME "@key" does not distinguish its argument sufficiently to permit
1483 @c complete accuracy in these examples; space introduced for clarity.
1484 @c If texinfo enhancements make it unnecessary, it would be nice to
1485 @c replace " @key" by "@key" in the following...
1486 @smallexample
1487 (@value{GDBP}) info bre @key{TAB}
1488 @end smallexample
1489
1490 @noindent
1491 @value{GDBN} fills in the rest of the word @samp{breakpoints}, since that is
1492 the only @code{info} subcommand beginning with @samp{bre}:
1493
1494 @smallexample
1495 (@value{GDBP}) info breakpoints
1496 @end smallexample
1497
1498 @noindent
1499 You can either press @key{RET} at this point, to run the @code{info
1500 breakpoints} command, or backspace and enter something else, if
1501 @samp{breakpoints} does not look like the command you expected. (If you
1502 were sure you wanted @code{info breakpoints} in the first place, you
1503 might as well just type @key{RET} immediately after @samp{info bre},
1504 to exploit command abbreviations rather than command completion).
1505
1506 If there is more than one possibility for the next word when you press
1507 @key{TAB}, @value{GDBN} sounds a bell. You can either supply more
1508 characters and try again, or just press @key{TAB} a second time;
1509 @value{GDBN} displays all the possible completions for that word. For
1510 example, you might want to set a breakpoint on a subroutine whose name
1511 begins with @samp{make_}, but when you type @kbd{b make_@key{TAB}} @value{GDBN}
1512 just sounds the bell. Typing @key{TAB} again displays all the
1513 function names in your program that begin with those characters, for
1514 example:
1515
1516 @smallexample
1517 (@value{GDBP}) b make_ @key{TAB}
1518 @exdent @value{GDBN} sounds bell; press @key{TAB} again, to see:
1519 make_a_section_from_file make_environ
1520 make_abs_section make_function_type
1521 make_blockvector make_pointer_type
1522 make_cleanup make_reference_type
1523 make_command make_symbol_completion_list
1524 (@value{GDBP}) b make_
1525 @end smallexample
1526
1527 @noindent
1528 After displaying the available possibilities, @value{GDBN} copies your
1529 partial input (@samp{b make_} in the example) so you can finish the
1530 command.
1531
1532 If you just want to see the list of alternatives in the first place, you
1533 can press @kbd{M-?} rather than pressing @key{TAB} twice. @kbd{M-?}
1534 means @kbd{@key{META} ?}. You can type this either by holding down a
1535 key designated as the @key{META} shift on your keyboard (if there is
1536 one) while typing @kbd{?}, or as @key{ESC} followed by @kbd{?}.
1537
1538 @cindex quotes in commands
1539 @cindex completion of quoted strings
1540 Sometimes the string you need, while logically a ``word'', may contain
1541 parentheses or other characters that @value{GDBN} normally excludes from
1542 its notion of a word. To permit word completion to work in this
1543 situation, you may enclose words in @code{'} (single quote marks) in
1544 @value{GDBN} commands.
1545
1546 The most likely situation where you might need this is in typing the
1547 name of a C@t{++} function. This is because C@t{++} allows function
1548 overloading (multiple definitions of the same function, distinguished
1549 by argument type). For example, when you want to set a breakpoint you
1550 may need to distinguish whether you mean the version of @code{name}
1551 that takes an @code{int} parameter, @code{name(int)}, or the version
1552 that takes a @code{float} parameter, @code{name(float)}. To use the
1553 word-completion facilities in this situation, type a single quote
1554 @code{'} at the beginning of the function name. This alerts
1555 @value{GDBN} that it may need to consider more information than usual
1556 when you press @key{TAB} or @kbd{M-?} to request word completion:
1557
1558 @smallexample
1559 (@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble( @kbd{M-?}
1560 bubble(double,double) bubble(int,int)
1561 (@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble(
1562 @end smallexample
1563
1564 In some cases, @value{GDBN} can tell that completing a name requires using
1565 quotes. When this happens, @value{GDBN} inserts the quote for you (while
1566 completing as much as it can) if you do not type the quote in the first
1567 place:
1568
1569 @smallexample
1570 (@value{GDBP}) b bub @key{TAB}
1571 @exdent @value{GDBN} alters your input line to the following, and rings a bell:
1572 (@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble(
1573 @end smallexample
1574
1575 @noindent
1576 In general, @value{GDBN} can tell that a quote is needed (and inserts it) if
1577 you have not yet started typing the argument list when you ask for
1578 completion on an overloaded symbol.
1579
1580 For more information about overloaded functions, see @ref{C Plus Plus
1581 Expressions, ,C@t{++} Expressions}. You can use the command @code{set
1582 overload-resolution off} to disable overload resolution;
1583 see @ref{Debugging C Plus Plus, ,@value{GDBN} Features for C@t{++}}.
1584
1585 @cindex completion of structure field names
1586 @cindex structure field name completion
1587 @cindex completion of union field names
1588 @cindex union field name completion
1589 When completing in an expression which looks up a field in a
1590 structure, @value{GDBN} also tries@footnote{The completer can be
1591 confused by certain kinds of invalid expressions. Also, it only
1592 examines the static type of the expression, not the dynamic type.} to
1593 limit completions to the field names available in the type of the
1594 left-hand-side:
1595
1596 @smallexample
1597 (@value{GDBP}) p gdb_stdout.@kbd{M-?}
1598 magic to_fputs to_rewind
1599 to_data to_isatty to_write
1600 to_delete to_put to_write_async_safe
1601 to_flush to_read
1602 @end smallexample
1603
1604 @noindent
1605 This is because the @code{gdb_stdout} is a variable of the type
1606 @code{struct ui_file} that is defined in @value{GDBN} sources as
1607 follows:
1608
1609 @smallexample
1610 struct ui_file
1611 @{
1612 int *magic;
1613 ui_file_flush_ftype *to_flush;
1614 ui_file_write_ftype *to_write;
1615 ui_file_write_async_safe_ftype *to_write_async_safe;
1616 ui_file_fputs_ftype *to_fputs;
1617 ui_file_read_ftype *to_read;
1618 ui_file_delete_ftype *to_delete;
1619 ui_file_isatty_ftype *to_isatty;
1620 ui_file_rewind_ftype *to_rewind;
1621 ui_file_put_ftype *to_put;
1622 void *to_data;
1623 @}
1624 @end smallexample
1625
1626
1627 @node Help
1628 @section Getting Help
1629 @cindex online documentation
1630 @kindex help
1631
1632 You can always ask @value{GDBN} itself for information on its commands,
1633 using the command @code{help}.
1634
1635 @table @code
1636 @kindex h @r{(@code{help})}
1637 @item help
1638 @itemx h
1639 You can use @code{help} (abbreviated @code{h}) with no arguments to
1640 display a short list of named classes of commands:
1641
1642 @smallexample
1643 (@value{GDBP}) help
1644 List of classes of commands:
1645
1646 aliases -- Aliases of other commands
1647 breakpoints -- Making program stop at certain points
1648 data -- Examining data
1649 files -- Specifying and examining files
1650 internals -- Maintenance commands
1651 obscure -- Obscure features
1652 running -- Running the program
1653 stack -- Examining the stack
1654 status -- Status inquiries
1655 support -- Support facilities
1656 tracepoints -- Tracing of program execution without
1657 stopping the program
1658 user-defined -- User-defined commands
1659
1660 Type "help" followed by a class name for a list of
1661 commands in that class.
1662 Type "help" followed by command name for full
1663 documentation.
1664 Command name abbreviations are allowed if unambiguous.
1665 (@value{GDBP})
1666 @end smallexample
1667 @c the above line break eliminates huge line overfull...
1668
1669 @item help @var{class}
1670 Using one of the general help classes as an argument, you can get a
1671 list of the individual commands in that class. For example, here is the
1672 help display for the class @code{status}:
1673
1674 @smallexample
1675 (@value{GDBP}) help status
1676 Status inquiries.
1677
1678 List of commands:
1679
1680 @c Line break in "show" line falsifies real output, but needed
1681 @c to fit in smallbook page size.
1682 info -- Generic command for showing things
1683 about the program being debugged
1684 show -- Generic command for showing things
1685 about the debugger
1686
1687 Type "help" followed by command name for full
1688 documentation.
1689 Command name abbreviations are allowed if unambiguous.
1690 (@value{GDBP})
1691 @end smallexample
1692
1693 @item help @var{command}
1694 With a command name as @code{help} argument, @value{GDBN} displays a
1695 short paragraph on how to use that command.
1696
1697 @kindex apropos
1698 @item apropos @var{args}
1699 The @code{apropos} command searches through all of the @value{GDBN}
1700 commands, and their documentation, for the regular expression specified in
1701 @var{args}. It prints out all matches found. For example:
1702
1703 @smallexample
1704 apropos reload
1705 @end smallexample
1706
1707 @noindent
1708 results in:
1709
1710 @smallexample
1711 @c @group
1712 set symbol-reloading -- Set dynamic symbol table reloading
1713 multiple times in one run
1714 show symbol-reloading -- Show dynamic symbol table reloading
1715 multiple times in one run
1716 @c @end group
1717 @end smallexample
1718
1719 @kindex complete
1720 @item complete @var{args}
1721 The @code{complete @var{args}} command lists all the possible completions
1722 for the beginning of a command. Use @var{args} to specify the beginning of the
1723 command you want completed. For example:
1724
1725 @smallexample
1726 complete i
1727 @end smallexample
1728
1729 @noindent results in:
1730
1731 @smallexample
1732 @group
1733 if
1734 ignore
1735 info
1736 inspect
1737 @end group
1738 @end smallexample
1739
1740 @noindent This is intended for use by @sc{gnu} Emacs.
1741 @end table
1742
1743 In addition to @code{help}, you can use the @value{GDBN} commands @code{info}
1744 and @code{show} to inquire about the state of your program, or the state
1745 of @value{GDBN} itself. Each command supports many topics of inquiry; this
1746 manual introduces each of them in the appropriate context. The listings
1747 under @code{info} and under @code{show} in the Index point to
1748 all the sub-commands. @xref{Index}.
1749
1750 @c @group
1751 @table @code
1752 @kindex info
1753 @kindex i @r{(@code{info})}
1754 @item info
1755 This command (abbreviated @code{i}) is for describing the state of your
1756 program. For example, you can show the arguments passed to a function
1757 with @code{info args}, list the registers currently in use with @code{info
1758 registers}, or list the breakpoints you have set with @code{info breakpoints}.
1759 You can get a complete list of the @code{info} sub-commands with
1760 @w{@code{help info}}.
1761
1762 @kindex set
1763 @item set
1764 You can assign the result of an expression to an environment variable with
1765 @code{set}. For example, you can set the @value{GDBN} prompt to a $-sign with
1766 @code{set prompt $}.
1767
1768 @kindex show
1769 @item show
1770 In contrast to @code{info}, @code{show} is for describing the state of
1771 @value{GDBN} itself.
1772 You can change most of the things you can @code{show}, by using the
1773 related command @code{set}; for example, you can control what number
1774 system is used for displays with @code{set radix}, or simply inquire
1775 which is currently in use with @code{show radix}.
1776
1777 @kindex info set
1778 To display all the settable parameters and their current
1779 values, you can use @code{show} with no arguments; you may also use
1780 @code{info set}. Both commands produce the same display.
1781 @c FIXME: "info set" violates the rule that "info" is for state of
1782 @c FIXME...program. Ck w/ GNU: "info set" to be called something else,
1783 @c FIXME...or change desc of rule---eg "state of prog and debugging session"?
1784 @end table
1785 @c @end group
1786
1787 Here are three miscellaneous @code{show} subcommands, all of which are
1788 exceptional in lacking corresponding @code{set} commands:
1789
1790 @table @code
1791 @kindex show version
1792 @cindex @value{GDBN} version number
1793 @item show version
1794 Show what version of @value{GDBN} is running. You should include this
1795 information in @value{GDBN} bug-reports. If multiple versions of
1796 @value{GDBN} are in use at your site, you may need to determine which
1797 version of @value{GDBN} you are running; as @value{GDBN} evolves, new
1798 commands are introduced, and old ones may wither away. Also, many
1799 system vendors ship variant versions of @value{GDBN}, and there are
1800 variant versions of @value{GDBN} in @sc{gnu}/Linux distributions as well.
1801 The version number is the same as the one announced when you start
1802 @value{GDBN}.
1803
1804 @kindex show copying
1805 @kindex info copying
1806 @cindex display @value{GDBN} copyright
1807 @item show copying
1808 @itemx info copying
1809 Display information about permission for copying @value{GDBN}.
1810
1811 @kindex show warranty
1812 @kindex info warranty
1813 @item show warranty
1814 @itemx info warranty
1815 Display the @sc{gnu} ``NO WARRANTY'' statement, or a warranty,
1816 if your version of @value{GDBN} comes with one.
1817
1818 @end table
1819
1820 @node Running
1821 @chapter Running Programs Under @value{GDBN}
1822
1823 When you run a program under @value{GDBN}, you must first generate
1824 debugging information when you compile it.
1825
1826 You may start @value{GDBN} with its arguments, if any, in an environment
1827 of your choice. If you are doing native debugging, you may redirect
1828 your program's input and output, debug an already running process, or
1829 kill a child process.
1830
1831 @menu
1832 * Compilation:: Compiling for debugging
1833 * Starting:: Starting your program
1834 * Arguments:: Your program's arguments
1835 * Environment:: Your program's environment
1836
1837 * Working Directory:: Your program's working directory
1838 * Input/Output:: Your program's input and output
1839 * Attach:: Debugging an already-running process
1840 * Kill Process:: Killing the child process
1841
1842 * Inferiors and Programs:: Debugging multiple inferiors and programs
1843 * Threads:: Debugging programs with multiple threads
1844 * Forks:: Debugging forks
1845 * Checkpoint/Restart:: Setting a @emph{bookmark} to return to later
1846 @end menu
1847
1848 @node Compilation
1849 @section Compiling for Debugging
1850
1851 In order to debug a program effectively, you need to generate
1852 debugging information when you compile it. This debugging information
1853 is stored in the object file; it describes the data type of each
1854 variable or function and the correspondence between source line numbers
1855 and addresses in the executable code.
1856
1857 To request debugging information, specify the @samp{-g} option when you run
1858 the compiler.
1859
1860 Programs that are to be shipped to your customers are compiled with
1861 optimizations, using the @samp{-O} compiler option. However, some
1862 compilers are unable to handle the @samp{-g} and @samp{-O} options
1863 together. Using those compilers, you cannot generate optimized
1864 executables containing debugging information.
1865
1866 @value{NGCC}, the @sc{gnu} C/C@t{++} compiler, supports @samp{-g} with or
1867 without @samp{-O}, making it possible to debug optimized code. We
1868 recommend that you @emph{always} use @samp{-g} whenever you compile a
1869 program. You may think your program is correct, but there is no sense
1870 in pushing your luck. For more information, see @ref{Optimized Code}.
1871
1872 Older versions of the @sc{gnu} C compiler permitted a variant option
1873 @w{@samp{-gg}} for debugging information. @value{GDBN} no longer supports this
1874 format; if your @sc{gnu} C compiler has this option, do not use it.
1875
1876 @value{GDBN} knows about preprocessor macros and can show you their
1877 expansion (@pxref{Macros}). Most compilers do not include information
1878 about preprocessor macros in the debugging information if you specify
1879 the @option{-g} flag alone. Version 3.1 and later of @value{NGCC},
1880 the @sc{gnu} C compiler, provides macro information if you are using
1881 the DWARF debugging format, and specify the option @option{-g3}.
1882
1883 @xref{Debugging Options,,Options for Debugging Your Program or GCC,
1884 gcc.info, Using the @sc{gnu} Compiler Collection (GCC)}, for more
1885 information on @value{NGCC} options affecting debug information.
1886
1887 You will have the best debugging experience if you use the latest
1888 version of the DWARF debugging format that your compiler supports.
1889 DWARF is currently the most expressive and best supported debugging
1890 format in @value{GDBN}.
1891
1892 @need 2000
1893 @node Starting
1894 @section Starting your Program
1895 @cindex starting
1896 @cindex running
1897
1898 @table @code
1899 @kindex run
1900 @kindex r @r{(@code{run})}
1901 @item run
1902 @itemx r
1903 Use the @code{run} command to start your program under @value{GDBN}.
1904 You must first specify the program name (except on VxWorks) with an
1905 argument to @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Invocation, ,Getting In and Out of
1906 @value{GDBN}}), or by using the @code{file} or @code{exec-file} command
1907 (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}).
1908
1909 @end table
1910
1911 If you are running your program in an execution environment that
1912 supports processes, @code{run} creates an inferior process and makes
1913 that process run your program. In some environments without processes,
1914 @code{run} jumps to the start of your program. Other targets,
1915 like @samp{remote}, are always running. If you get an error
1916 message like this one:
1917
1918 @smallexample
1919 The "remote" target does not support "run".
1920 Try "help target" or "continue".
1921 @end smallexample
1922
1923 @noindent
1924 then use @code{continue} to run your program. You may need @code{load}
1925 first (@pxref{load}).
1926
1927 The execution of a program is affected by certain information it
1928 receives from its superior. @value{GDBN} provides ways to specify this
1929 information, which you must do @emph{before} starting your program. (You
1930 can change it after starting your program, but such changes only affect
1931 your program the next time you start it.) This information may be
1932 divided into four categories:
1933
1934 @table @asis
1935 @item The @emph{arguments.}
1936 Specify the arguments to give your program as the arguments of the
1937 @code{run} command. If a shell is available on your target, the shell
1938 is used to pass the arguments, so that you may use normal conventions
1939 (such as wildcard expansion or variable substitution) in describing
1940 the arguments.
1941 In Unix systems, you can control which shell is used with the
1942 @code{SHELL} environment variable.
1943 @xref{Arguments, ,Your Program's Arguments}.
1944
1945 @item The @emph{environment.}
1946 Your program normally inherits its environment from @value{GDBN}, but you can
1947 use the @value{GDBN} commands @code{set environment} and @code{unset
1948 environment} to change parts of the environment that affect
1949 your program. @xref{Environment, ,Your Program's Environment}.
1950
1951 @item The @emph{working directory.}
1952 Your program inherits its working directory from @value{GDBN}. You can set
1953 the @value{GDBN} working directory with the @code{cd} command in @value{GDBN}.
1954 @xref{Working Directory, ,Your Program's Working Directory}.
1955
1956 @item The @emph{standard input and output.}
1957 Your program normally uses the same device for standard input and
1958 standard output as @value{GDBN} is using. You can redirect input and output
1959 in the @code{run} command line, or you can use the @code{tty} command to
1960 set a different device for your program.
1961 @xref{Input/Output, ,Your Program's Input and Output}.
1962
1963 @cindex pipes
1964 @emph{Warning:} While input and output redirection work, you cannot use
1965 pipes to pass the output of the program you are debugging to another
1966 program; if you attempt this, @value{GDBN} is likely to wind up debugging the
1967 wrong program.
1968 @end table
1969
1970 When you issue the @code{run} command, your program begins to execute
1971 immediately. @xref{Stopping, ,Stopping and Continuing}, for discussion
1972 of how to arrange for your program to stop. Once your program has
1973 stopped, you may call functions in your program, using the @code{print}
1974 or @code{call} commands. @xref{Data, ,Examining Data}.
1975
1976 If the modification time of your symbol file has changed since the last
1977 time @value{GDBN} read its symbols, @value{GDBN} discards its symbol
1978 table, and reads it again. When it does this, @value{GDBN} tries to retain
1979 your current breakpoints.
1980
1981 @table @code
1982 @kindex start
1983 @item start
1984 @cindex run to main procedure
1985 The name of the main procedure can vary from language to language.
1986 With C or C@t{++}, the main procedure name is always @code{main}, but
1987 other languages such as Ada do not require a specific name for their
1988 main procedure. The debugger provides a convenient way to start the
1989 execution of the program and to stop at the beginning of the main
1990 procedure, depending on the language used.
1991
1992 The @samp{start} command does the equivalent of setting a temporary
1993 breakpoint at the beginning of the main procedure and then invoking
1994 the @samp{run} command.
1995
1996 @cindex elaboration phase
1997 Some programs contain an @dfn{elaboration} phase where some startup code is
1998 executed before the main procedure is called. This depends on the
1999 languages used to write your program. In C@t{++}, for instance,
2000 constructors for static and global objects are executed before
2001 @code{main} is called. It is therefore possible that the debugger stops
2002 before reaching the main procedure. However, the temporary breakpoint
2003 will remain to halt execution.
2004
2005 Specify the arguments to give to your program as arguments to the
2006 @samp{start} command. These arguments will be given verbatim to the
2007 underlying @samp{run} command. Note that the same arguments will be
2008 reused if no argument is provided during subsequent calls to
2009 @samp{start} or @samp{run}.
2010
2011 It is sometimes necessary to debug the program during elaboration. In
2012 these cases, using the @code{start} command would stop the execution of
2013 your program too late, as the program would have already completed the
2014 elaboration phase. Under these circumstances, insert breakpoints in your
2015 elaboration code before running your program.
2016
2017 @kindex set exec-wrapper
2018 @item set exec-wrapper @var{wrapper}
2019 @itemx show exec-wrapper
2020 @itemx unset exec-wrapper
2021 When @samp{exec-wrapper} is set, the specified wrapper is used to
2022 launch programs for debugging. @value{GDBN} starts your program
2023 with a shell command of the form @kbd{exec @var{wrapper}
2024 @var{program}}. Quoting is added to @var{program} and its
2025 arguments, but not to @var{wrapper}, so you should add quotes if
2026 appropriate for your shell. The wrapper runs until it executes
2027 your program, and then @value{GDBN} takes control.
2028
2029 You can use any program that eventually calls @code{execve} with
2030 its arguments as a wrapper. Several standard Unix utilities do
2031 this, e.g.@: @code{env} and @code{nohup}. Any Unix shell script ending
2032 with @code{exec "$@@"} will also work.
2033
2034 For example, you can use @code{env} to pass an environment variable to
2035 the debugged program, without setting the variable in your shell's
2036 environment:
2037
2038 @smallexample
2039 (@value{GDBP}) set exec-wrapper env 'LD_PRELOAD=libtest.so'
2040 (@value{GDBP}) run
2041 @end smallexample
2042
2043 This command is available when debugging locally on most targets, excluding
2044 @sc{djgpp}, Cygwin, MS Windows, and QNX Neutrino.
2045
2046 @kindex set disable-randomization
2047 @item set disable-randomization
2048 @itemx set disable-randomization on
2049 This option (enabled by default in @value{GDBN}) will turn off the native
2050 randomization of the virtual address space of the started program. This option
2051 is useful for multiple debugging sessions to make the execution better
2052 reproducible and memory addresses reusable across debugging sessions.
2053
2054 This feature is implemented only on certain targets, including @sc{gnu}/Linux.
2055 On @sc{gnu}/Linux you can get the same behavior using
2056
2057 @smallexample
2058 (@value{GDBP}) set exec-wrapper setarch `uname -m` -R
2059 @end smallexample
2060
2061 @item set disable-randomization off
2062 Leave the behavior of the started executable unchanged. Some bugs rear their
2063 ugly heads only when the program is loaded at certain addresses. If your bug
2064 disappears when you run the program under @value{GDBN}, that might be because
2065 @value{GDBN} by default disables the address randomization on platforms, such
2066 as @sc{gnu}/Linux, which do that for stand-alone programs. Use @kbd{set
2067 disable-randomization off} to try to reproduce such elusive bugs.
2068
2069 On targets where it is available, virtual address space randomization
2070 protects the programs against certain kinds of security attacks. In these
2071 cases the attacker needs to know the exact location of a concrete executable
2072 code. Randomizing its location makes it impossible to inject jumps misusing
2073 a code at its expected addresses.
2074
2075 Prelinking shared libraries provides a startup performance advantage but it
2076 makes addresses in these libraries predictable for privileged processes by
2077 having just unprivileged access at the target system. Reading the shared
2078 library binary gives enough information for assembling the malicious code
2079 misusing it. Still even a prelinked shared library can get loaded at a new
2080 random address just requiring the regular relocation process during the
2081 startup. Shared libraries not already prelinked are always loaded at
2082 a randomly chosen address.
2083
2084 Position independent executables (PIE) contain position independent code
2085 similar to the shared libraries and therefore such executables get loaded at
2086 a randomly chosen address upon startup. PIE executables always load even
2087 already prelinked shared libraries at a random address. You can build such
2088 executable using @command{gcc -fPIE -pie}.
2089
2090 Heap (malloc storage), stack and custom mmap areas are always placed randomly
2091 (as long as the randomization is enabled).
2092
2093 @item show disable-randomization
2094 Show the current setting of the explicit disable of the native randomization of
2095 the virtual address space of the started program.
2096
2097 @end table
2098
2099 @node Arguments
2100 @section Your Program's Arguments
2101
2102 @cindex arguments (to your program)
2103 The arguments to your program can be specified by the arguments of the
2104 @code{run} command.
2105 They are passed to a shell, which expands wildcard characters and
2106 performs redirection of I/O, and thence to your program. Your
2107 @code{SHELL} environment variable (if it exists) specifies what shell
2108 @value{GDBN} uses. If you do not define @code{SHELL}, @value{GDBN} uses
2109 the default shell (@file{/bin/sh} on Unix).
2110
2111 On non-Unix systems, the program is usually invoked directly by
2112 @value{GDBN}, which emulates I/O redirection via the appropriate system
2113 calls, and the wildcard characters are expanded by the startup code of
2114 the program, not by the shell.
2115
2116 @code{run} with no arguments uses the same arguments used by the previous
2117 @code{run}, or those set by the @code{set args} command.
2118
2119 @table @code
2120 @kindex set args
2121 @item set args
2122 Specify the arguments to be used the next time your program is run. If
2123 @code{set args} has no arguments, @code{run} executes your program
2124 with no arguments. Once you have run your program with arguments,
2125 using @code{set args} before the next @code{run} is the only way to run
2126 it again without arguments.
2127
2128 @kindex show args
2129 @item show args
2130 Show the arguments to give your program when it is started.
2131 @end table
2132
2133 @node Environment
2134 @section Your Program's Environment
2135
2136 @cindex environment (of your program)
2137 The @dfn{environment} consists of a set of environment variables and
2138 their values. Environment variables conventionally record such things as
2139 your user name, your home directory, your terminal type, and your search
2140 path for programs to run. Usually you set up environment variables with
2141 the shell and they are inherited by all the other programs you run. When
2142 debugging, it can be useful to try running your program with a modified
2143 environment without having to start @value{GDBN} over again.
2144
2145 @table @code
2146 @kindex path
2147 @item path @var{directory}
2148 Add @var{directory} to the front of the @code{PATH} environment variable
2149 (the search path for executables) that will be passed to your program.
2150 The value of @code{PATH} used by @value{GDBN} does not change.
2151 You may specify several directory names, separated by whitespace or by a
2152 system-dependent separator character (@samp{:} on Unix, @samp{;} on
2153 MS-DOS and MS-Windows). If @var{directory} is already in the path, it
2154 is moved to the front, so it is searched sooner.
2155
2156 You can use the string @samp{$cwd} to refer to whatever is the current
2157 working directory at the time @value{GDBN} searches the path. If you
2158 use @samp{.} instead, it refers to the directory where you executed the
2159 @code{path} command. @value{GDBN} replaces @samp{.} in the
2160 @var{directory} argument (with the current path) before adding
2161 @var{directory} to the search path.
2162 @c 'path' is explicitly nonrepeatable, but RMS points out it is silly to
2163 @c document that, since repeating it would be a no-op.
2164
2165 @kindex show paths
2166 @item show paths
2167 Display the list of search paths for executables (the @code{PATH}
2168 environment variable).
2169
2170 @kindex show environment
2171 @item show environment @r{[}@var{varname}@r{]}
2172 Print the value of environment variable @var{varname} to be given to
2173 your program when it starts. If you do not supply @var{varname},
2174 print the names and values of all environment variables to be given to
2175 your program. You can abbreviate @code{environment} as @code{env}.
2176
2177 @kindex set environment
2178 @item set environment @var{varname} @r{[}=@var{value}@r{]}
2179 Set environment variable @var{varname} to @var{value}. The value
2180 changes for your program only, not for @value{GDBN} itself. @var{value} may
2181 be any string; the values of environment variables are just strings, and
2182 any interpretation is supplied by your program itself. The @var{value}
2183 parameter is optional; if it is eliminated, the variable is set to a
2184 null value.
2185 @c "any string" here does not include leading, trailing
2186 @c blanks. Gnu asks: does anyone care?
2187
2188 For example, this command:
2189
2190 @smallexample
2191 set env USER = foo
2192 @end smallexample
2193
2194 @noindent
2195 tells the debugged program, when subsequently run, that its user is named
2196 @samp{foo}. (The spaces around @samp{=} are used for clarity here; they
2197 are not actually required.)
2198
2199 @kindex unset environment
2200 @item unset environment @var{varname}
2201 Remove variable @var{varname} from the environment to be passed to your
2202 program. This is different from @samp{set env @var{varname} =};
2203 @code{unset environment} removes the variable from the environment,
2204 rather than assigning it an empty value.
2205 @end table
2206
2207 @emph{Warning:} On Unix systems, @value{GDBN} runs your program using
2208 the shell indicated
2209 by your @code{SHELL} environment variable if it exists (or
2210 @code{/bin/sh} if not). If your @code{SHELL} variable names a shell
2211 that runs an initialization file---such as @file{.cshrc} for C-shell, or
2212 @file{.bashrc} for BASH---any variables you set in that file affect
2213 your program. You may wish to move setting of environment variables to
2214 files that are only run when you sign on, such as @file{.login} or
2215 @file{.profile}.
2216
2217 @node Working Directory
2218 @section Your Program's Working Directory
2219
2220 @cindex working directory (of your program)
2221 Each time you start your program with @code{run}, it inherits its
2222 working directory from the current working directory of @value{GDBN}.
2223 The @value{GDBN} working directory is initially whatever it inherited
2224 from its parent process (typically the shell), but you can specify a new
2225 working directory in @value{GDBN} with the @code{cd} command.
2226
2227 The @value{GDBN} working directory also serves as a default for the commands
2228 that specify files for @value{GDBN} to operate on. @xref{Files, ,Commands to
2229 Specify Files}.
2230
2231 @table @code
2232 @kindex cd
2233 @cindex change working directory
2234 @item cd @var{directory}
2235 Set the @value{GDBN} working directory to @var{directory}.
2236
2237 @kindex pwd
2238 @item pwd
2239 Print the @value{GDBN} working directory.
2240 @end table
2241
2242 It is generally impossible to find the current working directory of
2243 the process being debugged (since a program can change its directory
2244 during its run). If you work on a system where @value{GDBN} is
2245 configured with the @file{/proc} support, you can use the @code{info
2246 proc} command (@pxref{SVR4 Process Information}) to find out the
2247 current working directory of the debuggee.
2248
2249 @node Input/Output
2250 @section Your Program's Input and Output
2251
2252 @cindex redirection
2253 @cindex i/o
2254 @cindex terminal
2255 By default, the program you run under @value{GDBN} does input and output to
2256 the same terminal that @value{GDBN} uses. @value{GDBN} switches the terminal
2257 to its own terminal modes to interact with you, but it records the terminal
2258 modes your program was using and switches back to them when you continue
2259 running your program.
2260
2261 @table @code
2262 @kindex info terminal
2263 @item info terminal
2264 Displays information recorded by @value{GDBN} about the terminal modes your
2265 program is using.
2266 @end table
2267
2268 You can redirect your program's input and/or output using shell
2269 redirection with the @code{run} command. For example,
2270
2271 @smallexample
2272 run > outfile
2273 @end smallexample
2274
2275 @noindent
2276 starts your program, diverting its output to the file @file{outfile}.
2277
2278 @kindex tty
2279 @cindex controlling terminal
2280 Another way to specify where your program should do input and output is
2281 with the @code{tty} command. This command accepts a file name as
2282 argument, and causes this file to be the default for future @code{run}
2283 commands. It also resets the controlling terminal for the child
2284 process, for future @code{run} commands. For example,
2285
2286 @smallexample
2287 tty /dev/ttyb
2288 @end smallexample
2289
2290 @noindent
2291 directs that processes started with subsequent @code{run} commands
2292 default to do input and output on the terminal @file{/dev/ttyb} and have
2293 that as their controlling terminal.
2294
2295 An explicit redirection in @code{run} overrides the @code{tty} command's
2296 effect on the input/output device, but not its effect on the controlling
2297 terminal.
2298
2299 When you use the @code{tty} command or redirect input in the @code{run}
2300 command, only the input @emph{for your program} is affected. The input
2301 for @value{GDBN} still comes from your terminal. @code{tty} is an alias
2302 for @code{set inferior-tty}.
2303
2304 @cindex inferior tty
2305 @cindex set inferior controlling terminal
2306 You can use the @code{show inferior-tty} command to tell @value{GDBN} to
2307 display the name of the terminal that will be used for future runs of your
2308 program.
2309
2310 @table @code
2311 @item set inferior-tty /dev/ttyb
2312 @kindex set inferior-tty
2313 Set the tty for the program being debugged to /dev/ttyb.
2314
2315 @item show inferior-tty
2316 @kindex show inferior-tty
2317 Show the current tty for the program being debugged.
2318 @end table
2319
2320 @node Attach
2321 @section Debugging an Already-running Process
2322 @kindex attach
2323 @cindex attach
2324
2325 @table @code
2326 @item attach @var{process-id}
2327 This command attaches to a running process---one that was started
2328 outside @value{GDBN}. (@code{info files} shows your active
2329 targets.) The command takes as argument a process ID. The usual way to
2330 find out the @var{process-id} of a Unix process is with the @code{ps} utility,
2331 or with the @samp{jobs -l} shell command.
2332
2333 @code{attach} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} a second time after
2334 executing the command.
2335 @end table
2336
2337 To use @code{attach}, your program must be running in an environment
2338 which supports processes; for example, @code{attach} does not work for
2339 programs on bare-board targets that lack an operating system. You must
2340 also have permission to send the process a signal.
2341
2342 When you use @code{attach}, the debugger finds the program running in
2343 the process first by looking in the current working directory, then (if
2344 the program is not found) by using the source file search path
2345 (@pxref{Source Path, ,Specifying Source Directories}). You can also use
2346 the @code{file} command to load the program. @xref{Files, ,Commands to
2347 Specify Files}.
2348
2349 The first thing @value{GDBN} does after arranging to debug the specified
2350 process is to stop it. You can examine and modify an attached process
2351 with all the @value{GDBN} commands that are ordinarily available when
2352 you start processes with @code{run}. You can insert breakpoints; you
2353 can step and continue; you can modify storage. If you would rather the
2354 process continue running, you may use the @code{continue} command after
2355 attaching @value{GDBN} to the process.
2356
2357 @table @code
2358 @kindex detach
2359 @item detach
2360 When you have finished debugging the attached process, you can use the
2361 @code{detach} command to release it from @value{GDBN} control. Detaching
2362 the process continues its execution. After the @code{detach} command,
2363 that process and @value{GDBN} become completely independent once more, and you
2364 are ready to @code{attach} another process or start one with @code{run}.
2365 @code{detach} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after
2366 executing the command.
2367 @end table
2368
2369 If you exit @value{GDBN} while you have an attached process, you detach
2370 that process. If you use the @code{run} command, you kill that process.
2371 By default, @value{GDBN} asks for confirmation if you try to do either of these
2372 things; you can control whether or not you need to confirm by using the
2373 @code{set confirm} command (@pxref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional Warnings and
2374 Messages}).
2375
2376 @node Kill Process
2377 @section Killing the Child Process
2378
2379 @table @code
2380 @kindex kill
2381 @item kill
2382 Kill the child process in which your program is running under @value{GDBN}.
2383 @end table
2384
2385 This command is useful if you wish to debug a core dump instead of a
2386 running process. @value{GDBN} ignores any core dump file while your program
2387 is running.
2388
2389 On some operating systems, a program cannot be executed outside @value{GDBN}
2390 while you have breakpoints set on it inside @value{GDBN}. You can use the
2391 @code{kill} command in this situation to permit running your program
2392 outside the debugger.
2393
2394 The @code{kill} command is also useful if you wish to recompile and
2395 relink your program, since on many systems it is impossible to modify an
2396 executable file while it is running in a process. In this case, when you
2397 next type @code{run}, @value{GDBN} notices that the file has changed, and
2398 reads the symbol table again (while trying to preserve your current
2399 breakpoint settings).
2400
2401 @node Inferiors and Programs
2402 @section Debugging Multiple Inferiors and Programs
2403
2404 @value{GDBN} lets you run and debug multiple programs in a single
2405 session. In addition, @value{GDBN} on some systems may let you run
2406 several programs simultaneously (otherwise you have to exit from one
2407 before starting another). In the most general case, you can have
2408 multiple threads of execution in each of multiple processes, launched
2409 from multiple executables.
2410
2411 @cindex inferior
2412 @value{GDBN} represents the state of each program execution with an
2413 object called an @dfn{inferior}. An inferior typically corresponds to
2414 a process, but is more general and applies also to targets that do not
2415 have processes. Inferiors may be created before a process runs, and
2416 may be retained after a process exits. Inferiors have unique
2417 identifiers that are different from process ids. Usually each
2418 inferior will also have its own distinct address space, although some
2419 embedded targets may have several inferiors running in different parts
2420 of a single address space. Each inferior may in turn have multiple
2421 threads running in it.
2422
2423 To find out what inferiors exist at any moment, use @w{@code{info
2424 inferiors}}:
2425
2426 @table @code
2427 @kindex info inferiors
2428 @item info inferiors
2429 Print a list of all inferiors currently being managed by @value{GDBN}.
2430
2431 @value{GDBN} displays for each inferior (in this order):
2432
2433 @enumerate
2434 @item
2435 the inferior number assigned by @value{GDBN}
2436
2437 @item
2438 the target system's inferior identifier
2439
2440 @item
2441 the name of the executable the inferior is running.
2442
2443 @end enumerate
2444
2445 @noindent
2446 An asterisk @samp{*} preceding the @value{GDBN} inferior number
2447 indicates the current inferior.
2448
2449 For example,
2450 @end table
2451 @c end table here to get a little more width for example
2452
2453 @smallexample
2454 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
2455 Num Description Executable
2456 2 process 2307 hello
2457 * 1 process 3401 goodbye
2458 @end smallexample
2459
2460 To switch focus between inferiors, use the @code{inferior} command:
2461
2462 @table @code
2463 @kindex inferior @var{infno}
2464 @item inferior @var{infno}
2465 Make inferior number @var{infno} the current inferior. The argument
2466 @var{infno} is the inferior number assigned by @value{GDBN}, as shown
2467 in the first field of the @samp{info inferiors} display.
2468 @end table
2469
2470
2471 You can get multiple executables into a debugging session via the
2472 @code{add-inferior} and @w{@code{clone-inferior}} commands. On some
2473 systems @value{GDBN} can add inferiors to the debug session
2474 automatically by following calls to @code{fork} and @code{exec}. To
2475 remove inferiors from the debugging session use the
2476 @w{@code{remove-inferiors}} command.
2477
2478 @table @code
2479 @kindex add-inferior
2480 @item add-inferior [ -copies @var{n} ] [ -exec @var{executable} ]
2481 Adds @var{n} inferiors to be run using @var{executable} as the
2482 executable. @var{n} defaults to 1. If no executable is specified,
2483 the inferiors begins empty, with no program. You can still assign or
2484 change the program assigned to the inferior at any time by using the
2485 @code{file} command with the executable name as its argument.
2486
2487 @kindex clone-inferior
2488 @item clone-inferior [ -copies @var{n} ] [ @var{infno} ]
2489 Adds @var{n} inferiors ready to execute the same program as inferior
2490 @var{infno}. @var{n} defaults to 1. @var{infno} defaults to the
2491 number of the current inferior. This is a convenient command when you
2492 want to run another instance of the inferior you are debugging.
2493
2494 @smallexample
2495 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
2496 Num Description Executable
2497 * 1 process 29964 helloworld
2498 (@value{GDBP}) clone-inferior
2499 Added inferior 2.
2500 1 inferiors added.
2501 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
2502 Num Description Executable
2503 2 <null> helloworld
2504 * 1 process 29964 helloworld
2505 @end smallexample
2506
2507 You can now simply switch focus to inferior 2 and run it.
2508
2509 @kindex remove-inferiors
2510 @item remove-inferiors @var{infno}@dots{}
2511 Removes the inferior or inferiors @var{infno}@dots{}. It is not
2512 possible to remove an inferior that is running with this command. For
2513 those, use the @code{kill} or @code{detach} command first.
2514
2515 @end table
2516
2517 To quit debugging one of the running inferiors that is not the current
2518 inferior, you can either detach from it by using the @w{@code{detach
2519 inferior}} command (allowing it to run independently), or kill it
2520 using the @w{@code{kill inferiors}} command:
2521
2522 @table @code
2523 @kindex detach inferiors @var{infno}@dots{}
2524 @item detach inferior @var{infno}@dots{}
2525 Detach from the inferior or inferiors identified by @value{GDBN}
2526 inferior number(s) @var{infno}@dots{}. Note that the inferior's entry
2527 still stays on the list of inferiors shown by @code{info inferiors},
2528 but its Description will show @samp{<null>}.
2529
2530 @kindex kill inferiors @var{infno}@dots{}
2531 @item kill inferiors @var{infno}@dots{}
2532 Kill the inferior or inferiors identified by @value{GDBN} inferior
2533 number(s) @var{infno}@dots{}. Note that the inferior's entry still
2534 stays on the list of inferiors shown by @code{info inferiors}, but its
2535 Description will show @samp{<null>}.
2536 @end table
2537
2538 After the successful completion of a command such as @code{detach},
2539 @code{detach inferiors}, @code{kill} or @code{kill inferiors}, or after
2540 a normal process exit, the inferior is still valid and listed with
2541 @code{info inferiors}, ready to be restarted.
2542
2543
2544 To be notified when inferiors are started or exit under @value{GDBN}'s
2545 control use @w{@code{set print inferior-events}}:
2546
2547 @table @code
2548 @kindex set print inferior-events
2549 @cindex print messages on inferior start and exit
2550 @item set print inferior-events
2551 @itemx set print inferior-events on
2552 @itemx set print inferior-events off
2553 The @code{set print inferior-events} command allows you to enable or
2554 disable printing of messages when @value{GDBN} notices that new
2555 inferiors have started or that inferiors have exited or have been
2556 detached. By default, these messages will not be printed.
2557
2558 @kindex show print inferior-events
2559 @item show print inferior-events
2560 Show whether messages will be printed when @value{GDBN} detects that
2561 inferiors have started, exited or have been detached.
2562 @end table
2563
2564 Many commands will work the same with multiple programs as with a
2565 single program: e.g., @code{print myglobal} will simply display the
2566 value of @code{myglobal} in the current inferior.
2567
2568
2569 Occasionaly, when debugging @value{GDBN} itself, it may be useful to
2570 get more info about the relationship of inferiors, programs, address
2571 spaces in a debug session. You can do that with the @w{@code{maint
2572 info program-spaces}} command.
2573
2574 @table @code
2575 @kindex maint info program-spaces
2576 @item maint info program-spaces
2577 Print a list of all program spaces currently being managed by
2578 @value{GDBN}.
2579
2580 @value{GDBN} displays for each program space (in this order):
2581
2582 @enumerate
2583 @item
2584 the program space number assigned by @value{GDBN}
2585
2586 @item
2587 the name of the executable loaded into the program space, with e.g.,
2588 the @code{file} command.
2589
2590 @end enumerate
2591
2592 @noindent
2593 An asterisk @samp{*} preceding the @value{GDBN} program space number
2594 indicates the current program space.
2595
2596 In addition, below each program space line, @value{GDBN} prints extra
2597 information that isn't suitable to display in tabular form. For
2598 example, the list of inferiors bound to the program space.
2599
2600 @smallexample
2601 (@value{GDBP}) maint info program-spaces
2602 Id Executable
2603 2 goodbye
2604 Bound inferiors: ID 1 (process 21561)
2605 * 1 hello
2606 @end smallexample
2607
2608 Here we can see that no inferior is running the program @code{hello},
2609 while @code{process 21561} is running the program @code{goodbye}. On
2610 some targets, it is possible that multiple inferiors are bound to the
2611 same program space. The most common example is that of debugging both
2612 the parent and child processes of a @code{vfork} call. For example,
2613
2614 @smallexample
2615 (@value{GDBP}) maint info program-spaces
2616 Id Executable
2617 * 1 vfork-test
2618 Bound inferiors: ID 2 (process 18050), ID 1 (process 18045)
2619 @end smallexample
2620
2621 Here, both inferior 2 and inferior 1 are running in the same program
2622 space as a result of inferior 1 having executed a @code{vfork} call.
2623 @end table
2624
2625 @node Threads
2626 @section Debugging Programs with Multiple Threads
2627
2628 @cindex threads of execution
2629 @cindex multiple threads
2630 @cindex switching threads
2631 In some operating systems, such as HP-UX and Solaris, a single program
2632 may have more than one @dfn{thread} of execution. The precise semantics
2633 of threads differ from one operating system to another, but in general
2634 the threads of a single program are akin to multiple processes---except
2635 that they share one address space (that is, they can all examine and
2636 modify the same variables). On the other hand, each thread has its own
2637 registers and execution stack, and perhaps private memory.
2638
2639 @value{GDBN} provides these facilities for debugging multi-thread
2640 programs:
2641
2642 @itemize @bullet
2643 @item automatic notification of new threads
2644 @item @samp{thread @var{threadno}}, a command to switch among threads
2645 @item @samp{info threads}, a command to inquire about existing threads
2646 @item @samp{thread apply [@var{threadno}] [@var{all}] @var{args}},
2647 a command to apply a command to a list of threads
2648 @item thread-specific breakpoints
2649 @item @samp{set print thread-events}, which controls printing of
2650 messages on thread start and exit.
2651 @item @samp{set libthread-db-search-path @var{path}}, which lets
2652 the user specify which @code{libthread_db} to use if the default choice
2653 isn't compatible with the program.
2654 @end itemize
2655
2656 @quotation
2657 @emph{Warning:} These facilities are not yet available on every
2658 @value{GDBN} configuration where the operating system supports threads.
2659 If your @value{GDBN} does not support threads, these commands have no
2660 effect. For example, a system without thread support shows no output
2661 from @samp{info threads}, and always rejects the @code{thread} command,
2662 like this:
2663
2664 @smallexample
2665 (@value{GDBP}) info threads
2666 (@value{GDBP}) thread 1
2667 Thread ID 1 not known. Use the "info threads" command to
2668 see the IDs of currently known threads.
2669 @end smallexample
2670 @c FIXME to implementors: how hard would it be to say "sorry, this GDB
2671 @c doesn't support threads"?
2672 @end quotation
2673
2674 @cindex focus of debugging
2675 @cindex current thread
2676 The @value{GDBN} thread debugging facility allows you to observe all
2677 threads while your program runs---but whenever @value{GDBN} takes
2678 control, one thread in particular is always the focus of debugging.
2679 This thread is called the @dfn{current thread}. Debugging commands show
2680 program information from the perspective of the current thread.
2681
2682 @cindex @code{New} @var{systag} message
2683 @cindex thread identifier (system)
2684 @c FIXME-implementors!! It would be more helpful if the [New...] message
2685 @c included GDB's numeric thread handle, so you could just go to that
2686 @c thread without first checking `info threads'.
2687 Whenever @value{GDBN} detects a new thread in your program, it displays
2688 the target system's identification for the thread with a message in the
2689 form @samp{[New @var{systag}]}. @var{systag} is a thread identifier
2690 whose form varies depending on the particular system. For example, on
2691 @sc{gnu}/Linux, you might see
2692
2693 @smallexample
2694 [New Thread 0x41e02940 (LWP 25582)]
2695 @end smallexample
2696
2697 @noindent
2698 when @value{GDBN} notices a new thread. In contrast, on an SGI system,
2699 the @var{systag} is simply something like @samp{process 368}, with no
2700 further qualifier.
2701
2702 @c FIXME!! (1) Does the [New...] message appear even for the very first
2703 @c thread of a program, or does it only appear for the
2704 @c second---i.e.@: when it becomes obvious we have a multithread
2705 @c program?
2706 @c (2) *Is* there necessarily a first thread always? Or do some
2707 @c multithread systems permit starting a program with multiple
2708 @c threads ab initio?
2709
2710 @cindex thread number
2711 @cindex thread identifier (GDB)
2712 For debugging purposes, @value{GDBN} associates its own thread
2713 number---always a single integer---with each thread in your program.
2714
2715 @table @code
2716 @kindex info threads
2717 @item info threads @r{[}@var{id}@dots{}@r{]}
2718 Display a summary of all threads currently in your program. Optional
2719 argument @var{id}@dots{} is one or more thread ids separated by spaces, and
2720 means to print information only about the specified thread or threads.
2721 @value{GDBN} displays for each thread (in this order):
2722
2723 @enumerate
2724 @item
2725 the thread number assigned by @value{GDBN}
2726
2727 @item
2728 the target system's thread identifier (@var{systag})
2729
2730 @item
2731 the thread's name, if one is known. A thread can either be named by
2732 the user (see @code{thread name}, below), or, in some cases, by the
2733 program itself.
2734
2735 @item
2736 the current stack frame summary for that thread
2737 @end enumerate
2738
2739 @noindent
2740 An asterisk @samp{*} to the left of the @value{GDBN} thread number
2741 indicates the current thread.
2742
2743 For example,
2744 @end table
2745 @c end table here to get a little more width for example
2746
2747 @smallexample
2748 (@value{GDBP}) info threads
2749 Id Target Id Frame
2750 3 process 35 thread 27 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
2751 2 process 35 thread 23 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
2752 * 1 process 35 thread 13 main (argc=1, argv=0x7ffffff8)
2753 at threadtest.c:68
2754 @end smallexample
2755
2756 On Solaris, you can display more information about user threads with a
2757 Solaris-specific command:
2758
2759 @table @code
2760 @item maint info sol-threads
2761 @kindex maint info sol-threads
2762 @cindex thread info (Solaris)
2763 Display info on Solaris user threads.
2764 @end table
2765
2766 @table @code
2767 @kindex thread @var{threadno}
2768 @item thread @var{threadno}
2769 Make thread number @var{threadno} the current thread. The command
2770 argument @var{threadno} is the internal @value{GDBN} thread number, as
2771 shown in the first field of the @samp{info threads} display.
2772 @value{GDBN} responds by displaying the system identifier of the thread
2773 you selected, and its current stack frame summary:
2774
2775 @smallexample
2776 (@value{GDBP}) thread 2
2777 [Switching to thread 2 (Thread 0xb7fdab70 (LWP 12747))]
2778 #0 some_function (ignore=0x0) at example.c:8
2779 8 printf ("hello\n");
2780 @end smallexample
2781
2782 @noindent
2783 As with the @samp{[New @dots{}]} message, the form of the text after
2784 @samp{Switching to} depends on your system's conventions for identifying
2785 threads.
2786
2787 @vindex $_thread@r{, convenience variable}
2788 The debugger convenience variable @samp{$_thread} contains the number
2789 of the current thread. You may find this useful in writing breakpoint
2790 conditional expressions, command scripts, and so forth. See
2791 @xref{Convenience Vars,, Convenience Variables}, for general
2792 information on convenience variables.
2793
2794 @kindex thread apply
2795 @cindex apply command to several threads
2796 @item thread apply [@var{threadno} | all] @var{command}
2797 The @code{thread apply} command allows you to apply the named
2798 @var{command} to one or more threads. Specify the numbers of the
2799 threads that you want affected with the command argument
2800 @var{threadno}. It can be a single thread number, one of the numbers
2801 shown in the first field of the @samp{info threads} display; or it
2802 could be a range of thread numbers, as in @code{2-4}. To apply a
2803 command to all threads, type @kbd{thread apply all @var{command}}.
2804
2805 @kindex thread name
2806 @cindex name a thread
2807 @item thread name [@var{name}]
2808 This command assigns a name to the current thread. If no argument is
2809 given, any existing user-specified name is removed. The thread name
2810 appears in the @samp{info threads} display.
2811
2812 On some systems, such as @sc{gnu}/Linux, @value{GDBN} is able to
2813 determine the name of the thread as given by the OS. On these
2814 systems, a name specified with @samp{thread name} will override the
2815 system-give name, and removing the user-specified name will cause
2816 @value{GDBN} to once again display the system-specified name.
2817
2818 @kindex thread find
2819 @cindex search for a thread
2820 @item thread find [@var{regexp}]
2821 Search for and display thread ids whose name or @var{systag}
2822 matches the supplied regular expression.
2823
2824 As well as being the complement to the @samp{thread name} command,
2825 this command also allows you to identify a thread by its target
2826 @var{systag}. For instance, on @sc{gnu}/Linux, the target @var{systag}
2827 is the LWP id.
2828
2829 @smallexample
2830 (@value{GDBN}) thread find 26688
2831 Thread 4 has target id 'Thread 0x41e02940 (LWP 26688)'
2832 (@value{GDBN}) info thread 4
2833 Id Target Id Frame
2834 4 Thread 0x41e02940 (LWP 26688) 0x00000031ca6cd372 in select ()
2835 @end smallexample
2836
2837 @kindex set print thread-events
2838 @cindex print messages on thread start and exit
2839 @item set print thread-events
2840 @itemx set print thread-events on
2841 @itemx set print thread-events off
2842 The @code{set print thread-events} command allows you to enable or
2843 disable printing of messages when @value{GDBN} notices that new threads have
2844 started or that threads have exited. By default, these messages will
2845 be printed if detection of these events is supported by the target.
2846 Note that these messages cannot be disabled on all targets.
2847
2848 @kindex show print thread-events
2849 @item show print thread-events
2850 Show whether messages will be printed when @value{GDBN} detects that threads
2851 have started and exited.
2852 @end table
2853
2854 @xref{Thread Stops,,Stopping and Starting Multi-thread Programs}, for
2855 more information about how @value{GDBN} behaves when you stop and start
2856 programs with multiple threads.
2857
2858 @xref{Set Watchpoints,,Setting Watchpoints}, for information about
2859 watchpoints in programs with multiple threads.
2860
2861 @table @code
2862 @kindex set libthread-db-search-path
2863 @cindex search path for @code{libthread_db}
2864 @item set libthread-db-search-path @r{[}@var{path}@r{]}
2865 If this variable is set, @var{path} is a colon-separated list of
2866 directories @value{GDBN} will use to search for @code{libthread_db}.
2867 If you omit @var{path}, @samp{libthread-db-search-path} will be reset to
2868 its default value (@code{$sdir:$pdir} on @sc{gnu}/Linux and Solaris systems).
2869 Internally, the default value comes from the @code{LIBTHREAD_DB_SEARCH_PATH}
2870 macro.
2871
2872 On @sc{gnu}/Linux and Solaris systems, @value{GDBN} uses a ``helper''
2873 @code{libthread_db} library to obtain information about threads in the
2874 inferior process. @value{GDBN} will use @samp{libthread-db-search-path}
2875 to find @code{libthread_db}.
2876
2877 A special entry @samp{$sdir} for @samp{libthread-db-search-path}
2878 refers to the default system directories that are
2879 normally searched for loading shared libraries.
2880
2881 A special entry @samp{$pdir} for @samp{libthread-db-search-path}
2882 refers to the directory from which @code{libpthread}
2883 was loaded in the inferior process.
2884
2885 For any @code{libthread_db} library @value{GDBN} finds in above directories,
2886 @value{GDBN} attempts to initialize it with the current inferior process.
2887 If this initialization fails (which could happen because of a version
2888 mismatch between @code{libthread_db} and @code{libpthread}), @value{GDBN}
2889 will unload @code{libthread_db}, and continue with the next directory.
2890 If none of @code{libthread_db} libraries initialize successfully,
2891 @value{GDBN} will issue a warning and thread debugging will be disabled.
2892
2893 Setting @code{libthread-db-search-path} is currently implemented
2894 only on some platforms.
2895
2896 @kindex show libthread-db-search-path
2897 @item show libthread-db-search-path
2898 Display current libthread_db search path.
2899
2900 @kindex set debug libthread-db
2901 @kindex show debug libthread-db
2902 @cindex debugging @code{libthread_db}
2903 @item set debug libthread-db
2904 @itemx show debug libthread-db
2905 Turns on or off display of @code{libthread_db}-related events.
2906 Use @code{1} to enable, @code{0} to disable.
2907 @end table
2908
2909 @node Forks
2910 @section Debugging Forks
2911
2912 @cindex fork, debugging programs which call
2913 @cindex multiple processes
2914 @cindex processes, multiple
2915 On most systems, @value{GDBN} has no special support for debugging
2916 programs which create additional processes using the @code{fork}
2917 function. When a program forks, @value{GDBN} will continue to debug the
2918 parent process and the child process will run unimpeded. If you have
2919 set a breakpoint in any code which the child then executes, the child
2920 will get a @code{SIGTRAP} signal which (unless it catches the signal)
2921 will cause it to terminate.
2922
2923 However, if you want to debug the child process there is a workaround
2924 which isn't too painful. Put a call to @code{sleep} in the code which
2925 the child process executes after the fork. It may be useful to sleep
2926 only if a certain environment variable is set, or a certain file exists,
2927 so that the delay need not occur when you don't want to run @value{GDBN}
2928 on the child. While the child is sleeping, use the @code{ps} program to
2929 get its process ID. Then tell @value{GDBN} (a new invocation of
2930 @value{GDBN} if you are also debugging the parent process) to attach to
2931 the child process (@pxref{Attach}). From that point on you can debug
2932 the child process just like any other process which you attached to.
2933
2934 On some systems, @value{GDBN} provides support for debugging programs that
2935 create additional processes using the @code{fork} or @code{vfork} functions.
2936 Currently, the only platforms with this feature are HP-UX (11.x and later
2937 only?) and @sc{gnu}/Linux (kernel version 2.5.60 and later).
2938
2939 By default, when a program forks, @value{GDBN} will continue to debug
2940 the parent process and the child process will run unimpeded.
2941
2942 If you want to follow the child process instead of the parent process,
2943 use the command @w{@code{set follow-fork-mode}}.
2944
2945 @table @code
2946 @kindex set follow-fork-mode
2947 @item set follow-fork-mode @var{mode}
2948 Set the debugger response to a program call of @code{fork} or
2949 @code{vfork}. A call to @code{fork} or @code{vfork} creates a new
2950 process. The @var{mode} argument can be:
2951
2952 @table @code
2953 @item parent
2954 The original process is debugged after a fork. The child process runs
2955 unimpeded. This is the default.
2956
2957 @item child
2958 The new process is debugged after a fork. The parent process runs
2959 unimpeded.
2960
2961 @end table
2962
2963 @kindex show follow-fork-mode
2964 @item show follow-fork-mode
2965 Display the current debugger response to a @code{fork} or @code{vfork} call.
2966 @end table
2967
2968 @cindex debugging multiple processes
2969 On Linux, if you want to debug both the parent and child processes, use the
2970 command @w{@code{set detach-on-fork}}.
2971
2972 @table @code
2973 @kindex set detach-on-fork
2974 @item set detach-on-fork @var{mode}
2975 Tells gdb whether to detach one of the processes after a fork, or
2976 retain debugger control over them both.
2977
2978 @table @code
2979 @item on
2980 The child process (or parent process, depending on the value of
2981 @code{follow-fork-mode}) will be detached and allowed to run
2982 independently. This is the default.
2983
2984 @item off
2985 Both processes will be held under the control of @value{GDBN}.
2986 One process (child or parent, depending on the value of
2987 @code{follow-fork-mode}) is debugged as usual, while the other
2988 is held suspended.
2989
2990 @end table
2991
2992 @kindex show detach-on-fork
2993 @item show detach-on-fork
2994 Show whether detach-on-fork mode is on/off.
2995 @end table
2996
2997 If you choose to set @samp{detach-on-fork} mode off, then @value{GDBN}
2998 will retain control of all forked processes (including nested forks).
2999 You can list the forked processes under the control of @value{GDBN} by
3000 using the @w{@code{info inferiors}} command, and switch from one fork
3001 to another by using the @code{inferior} command (@pxref{Inferiors and
3002 Programs, ,Debugging Multiple Inferiors and Programs}).
3003
3004 To quit debugging one of the forked processes, you can either detach
3005 from it by using the @w{@code{detach inferiors}} command (allowing it
3006 to run independently), or kill it using the @w{@code{kill inferiors}}
3007 command. @xref{Inferiors and Programs, ,Debugging Multiple Inferiors
3008 and Programs}.
3009
3010 If you ask to debug a child process and a @code{vfork} is followed by an
3011 @code{exec}, @value{GDBN} executes the new target up to the first
3012 breakpoint in the new target. If you have a breakpoint set on
3013 @code{main} in your original program, the breakpoint will also be set on
3014 the child process's @code{main}.
3015
3016 On some systems, when a child process is spawned by @code{vfork}, you
3017 cannot debug the child or parent until an @code{exec} call completes.
3018
3019 If you issue a @code{run} command to @value{GDBN} after an @code{exec}
3020 call executes, the new target restarts. To restart the parent
3021 process, use the @code{file} command with the parent executable name
3022 as its argument. By default, after an @code{exec} call executes,
3023 @value{GDBN} discards the symbols of the previous executable image.
3024 You can change this behaviour with the @w{@code{set follow-exec-mode}}
3025 command.
3026
3027 @table @code
3028 @kindex set follow-exec-mode
3029 @item set follow-exec-mode @var{mode}
3030
3031 Set debugger response to a program call of @code{exec}. An
3032 @code{exec} call replaces the program image of a process.
3033
3034 @code{follow-exec-mode} can be:
3035
3036 @table @code
3037 @item new
3038 @value{GDBN} creates a new inferior and rebinds the process to this
3039 new inferior. The program the process was running before the
3040 @code{exec} call can be restarted afterwards by restarting the
3041 original inferior.
3042
3043 For example:
3044
3045 @smallexample
3046 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
3047 (gdb) info inferior
3048 Id Description Executable
3049 * 1 <null> prog1
3050 (@value{GDBP}) run
3051 process 12020 is executing new program: prog2
3052 Program exited normally.
3053 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
3054 Id Description Executable
3055 * 2 <null> prog2
3056 1 <null> prog1
3057 @end smallexample
3058
3059 @item same
3060 @value{GDBN} keeps the process bound to the same inferior. The new
3061 executable image replaces the previous executable loaded in the
3062 inferior. Restarting the inferior after the @code{exec} call, with
3063 e.g., the @code{run} command, restarts the executable the process was
3064 running after the @code{exec} call. This is the default mode.
3065
3066 For example:
3067
3068 @smallexample
3069 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
3070 Id Description Executable
3071 * 1 <null> prog1
3072 (@value{GDBP}) run
3073 process 12020 is executing new program: prog2
3074 Program exited normally.
3075 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
3076 Id Description Executable
3077 * 1 <null> prog2
3078 @end smallexample
3079
3080 @end table
3081 @end table
3082
3083 You can use the @code{catch} command to make @value{GDBN} stop whenever
3084 a @code{fork}, @code{vfork}, or @code{exec} call is made. @xref{Set
3085 Catchpoints, ,Setting Catchpoints}.
3086
3087 @node Checkpoint/Restart
3088 @section Setting a @emph{Bookmark} to Return to Later
3089
3090 @cindex checkpoint
3091 @cindex restart
3092 @cindex bookmark
3093 @cindex snapshot of a process
3094 @cindex rewind program state
3095
3096 On certain operating systems@footnote{Currently, only
3097 @sc{gnu}/Linux.}, @value{GDBN} is able to save a @dfn{snapshot} of a
3098 program's state, called a @dfn{checkpoint}, and come back to it
3099 later.
3100
3101 Returning to a checkpoint effectively undoes everything that has
3102 happened in the program since the @code{checkpoint} was saved. This
3103 includes changes in memory, registers, and even (within some limits)
3104 system state. Effectively, it is like going back in time to the
3105 moment when the checkpoint was saved.
3106
3107 Thus, if you're stepping thru a program and you think you're
3108 getting close to the point where things go wrong, you can save
3109 a checkpoint. Then, if you accidentally go too far and miss
3110 the critical statement, instead of having to restart your program
3111 from the beginning, you can just go back to the checkpoint and
3112 start again from there.
3113
3114 This can be especially useful if it takes a lot of time or
3115 steps to reach the point where you think the bug occurs.
3116
3117 To use the @code{checkpoint}/@code{restart} method of debugging:
3118
3119 @table @code
3120 @kindex checkpoint
3121 @item checkpoint
3122 Save a snapshot of the debugged program's current execution state.
3123 The @code{checkpoint} command takes no arguments, but each checkpoint
3124 is assigned a small integer id, similar to a breakpoint id.
3125
3126 @kindex info checkpoints
3127 @item info checkpoints
3128 List the checkpoints that have been saved in the current debugging
3129 session. For each checkpoint, the following information will be
3130 listed:
3131
3132 @table @code
3133 @item Checkpoint ID
3134 @item Process ID
3135 @item Code Address
3136 @item Source line, or label
3137 @end table
3138
3139 @kindex restart @var{checkpoint-id}
3140 @item restart @var{checkpoint-id}
3141 Restore the program state that was saved as checkpoint number
3142 @var{checkpoint-id}. All program variables, registers, stack frames
3143 etc.@: will be returned to the values that they had when the checkpoint
3144 was saved. In essence, gdb will ``wind back the clock'' to the point
3145 in time when the checkpoint was saved.
3146
3147 Note that breakpoints, @value{GDBN} variables, command history etc.
3148 are not affected by restoring a checkpoint. In general, a checkpoint
3149 only restores things that reside in the program being debugged, not in
3150 the debugger.
3151
3152 @kindex delete checkpoint @var{checkpoint-id}
3153 @item delete checkpoint @var{checkpoint-id}
3154 Delete the previously-saved checkpoint identified by @var{checkpoint-id}.
3155
3156 @end table
3157
3158 Returning to a previously saved checkpoint will restore the user state
3159 of the program being debugged, plus a significant subset of the system
3160 (OS) state, including file pointers. It won't ``un-write'' data from
3161 a file, but it will rewind the file pointer to the previous location,
3162 so that the previously written data can be overwritten. For files
3163 opened in read mode, the pointer will also be restored so that the
3164 previously read data can be read again.
3165
3166 Of course, characters that have been sent to a printer (or other
3167 external device) cannot be ``snatched back'', and characters received
3168 from eg.@: a serial device can be removed from internal program buffers,
3169 but they cannot be ``pushed back'' into the serial pipeline, ready to
3170 be received again. Similarly, the actual contents of files that have
3171 been changed cannot be restored (at this time).
3172
3173 However, within those constraints, you actually can ``rewind'' your
3174 program to a previously saved point in time, and begin debugging it
3175 again --- and you can change the course of events so as to debug a
3176 different execution path this time.
3177
3178 @cindex checkpoints and process id
3179 Finally, there is one bit of internal program state that will be
3180 different when you return to a checkpoint --- the program's process
3181 id. Each checkpoint will have a unique process id (or @var{pid}),
3182 and each will be different from the program's original @var{pid}.
3183 If your program has saved a local copy of its process id, this could
3184 potentially pose a problem.
3185
3186 @subsection A Non-obvious Benefit of Using Checkpoints
3187
3188 On some systems such as @sc{gnu}/Linux, address space randomization
3189 is performed on new processes for security reasons. This makes it
3190 difficult or impossible to set a breakpoint, or watchpoint, on an
3191 absolute address if you have to restart the program, since the
3192 absolute location of a symbol will change from one execution to the
3193 next.
3194
3195 A checkpoint, however, is an @emph{identical} copy of a process.
3196 Therefore if you create a checkpoint at (eg.@:) the start of main,
3197 and simply return to that checkpoint instead of restarting the
3198 process, you can avoid the effects of address randomization and
3199 your symbols will all stay in the same place.
3200
3201 @node Stopping
3202 @chapter Stopping and Continuing
3203
3204 The principal purposes of using a debugger are so that you can stop your
3205 program before it terminates; or so that, if your program runs into
3206 trouble, you can investigate and find out why.
3207
3208 Inside @value{GDBN}, your program may stop for any of several reasons,
3209 such as a signal, a breakpoint, or reaching a new line after a
3210 @value{GDBN} command such as @code{step}. You may then examine and
3211 change variables, set new breakpoints or remove old ones, and then
3212 continue execution. Usually, the messages shown by @value{GDBN} provide
3213 ample explanation of the status of your program---but you can also
3214 explicitly request this information at any time.
3215
3216 @table @code
3217 @kindex info program
3218 @item info program
3219 Display information about the status of your program: whether it is
3220 running or not, what process it is, and why it stopped.
3221 @end table
3222
3223 @menu
3224 * Breakpoints:: Breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints
3225 * Continuing and Stepping:: Resuming execution
3226 * Skipping Over Functions and Files::
3227 Skipping over functions and files
3228 * Signals:: Signals
3229 * Thread Stops:: Stopping and starting multi-thread programs
3230 @end menu
3231
3232 @node Breakpoints
3233 @section Breakpoints, Watchpoints, and Catchpoints
3234
3235 @cindex breakpoints
3236 A @dfn{breakpoint} makes your program stop whenever a certain point in
3237 the program is reached. For each breakpoint, you can add conditions to
3238 control in finer detail whether your program stops. You can set
3239 breakpoints with the @code{break} command and its variants (@pxref{Set
3240 Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}), to specify the place where your program
3241 should stop by line number, function name or exact address in the
3242 program.
3243
3244 On some systems, you can set breakpoints in shared libraries before
3245 the executable is run. There is a minor limitation on HP-UX systems:
3246 you must wait until the executable is run in order to set breakpoints
3247 in shared library routines that are not called directly by the program
3248 (for example, routines that are arguments in a @code{pthread_create}
3249 call).
3250
3251 @cindex watchpoints
3252 @cindex data breakpoints
3253 @cindex memory tracing
3254 @cindex breakpoint on memory address
3255 @cindex breakpoint on variable modification
3256 A @dfn{watchpoint} is a special breakpoint that stops your program
3257 when the value of an expression changes. The expression may be a value
3258 of a variable, or it could involve values of one or more variables
3259 combined by operators, such as @samp{a + b}. This is sometimes called
3260 @dfn{data breakpoints}. You must use a different command to set
3261 watchpoints (@pxref{Set Watchpoints, ,Setting Watchpoints}), but aside
3262 from that, you can manage a watchpoint like any other breakpoint: you
3263 enable, disable, and delete both breakpoints and watchpoints using the
3264 same commands.
3265
3266 You can arrange to have values from your program displayed automatically
3267 whenever @value{GDBN} stops at a breakpoint. @xref{Auto Display,,
3268 Automatic Display}.
3269
3270 @cindex catchpoints
3271 @cindex breakpoint on events
3272 A @dfn{catchpoint} is another special breakpoint that stops your program
3273 when a certain kind of event occurs, such as the throwing of a C@t{++}
3274 exception or the loading of a library. As with watchpoints, you use a
3275 different command to set a catchpoint (@pxref{Set Catchpoints, ,Setting
3276 Catchpoints}), but aside from that, you can manage a catchpoint like any
3277 other breakpoint. (To stop when your program receives a signal, use the
3278 @code{handle} command; see @ref{Signals, ,Signals}.)
3279
3280 @cindex breakpoint numbers
3281 @cindex numbers for breakpoints
3282 @value{GDBN} assigns a number to each breakpoint, watchpoint, or
3283 catchpoint when you create it; these numbers are successive integers
3284 starting with one. In many of the commands for controlling various
3285 features of breakpoints you use the breakpoint number to say which
3286 breakpoint you want to change. Each breakpoint may be @dfn{enabled} or
3287 @dfn{disabled}; if disabled, it has no effect on your program until you
3288 enable it again.
3289
3290 @cindex breakpoint ranges
3291 @cindex ranges of breakpoints
3292 Some @value{GDBN} commands accept a range of breakpoints on which to
3293 operate. A breakpoint range is either a single breakpoint number, like
3294 @samp{5}, or two such numbers, in increasing order, separated by a
3295 hyphen, like @samp{5-7}. When a breakpoint range is given to a command,
3296 all breakpoints in that range are operated on.
3297
3298 @menu
3299 * Set Breaks:: Setting breakpoints
3300 * Set Watchpoints:: Setting watchpoints
3301 * Set Catchpoints:: Setting catchpoints
3302 * Delete Breaks:: Deleting breakpoints
3303 * Disabling:: Disabling breakpoints
3304 * Conditions:: Break conditions
3305 * Break Commands:: Breakpoint command lists
3306 * Save Breakpoints:: How to save breakpoints in a file
3307 * Error in Breakpoints:: ``Cannot insert breakpoints''
3308 * Breakpoint-related Warnings:: ``Breakpoint address adjusted...''
3309 @end menu
3310
3311 @node Set Breaks
3312 @subsection Setting Breakpoints
3313
3314 @c FIXME LMB what does GDB do if no code on line of breakpt?
3315 @c consider in particular declaration with/without initialization.
3316 @c
3317 @c FIXME 2 is there stuff on this already? break at fun start, already init?
3318
3319 @kindex break
3320 @kindex b @r{(@code{break})}
3321 @vindex $bpnum@r{, convenience variable}
3322 @cindex latest breakpoint
3323 Breakpoints are set with the @code{break} command (abbreviated
3324 @code{b}). The debugger convenience variable @samp{$bpnum} records the
3325 number of the breakpoint you've set most recently; see @ref{Convenience
3326 Vars,, Convenience Variables}, for a discussion of what you can do with
3327 convenience variables.
3328
3329 @table @code
3330 @item break @var{location}
3331 Set a breakpoint at the given @var{location}, which can specify a
3332 function name, a line number, or an address of an instruction.
3333 (@xref{Specify Location}, for a list of all the possible ways to
3334 specify a @var{location}.) The breakpoint will stop your program just
3335 before it executes any of the code in the specified @var{location}.
3336
3337 When using source languages that permit overloading of symbols, such as
3338 C@t{++}, a function name may refer to more than one possible place to break.
3339 @xref{Ambiguous Expressions,,Ambiguous Expressions}, for a discussion of
3340 that situation.
3341
3342 It is also possible to insert a breakpoint that will stop the program
3343 only if a specific thread (@pxref{Thread-Specific Breakpoints})
3344 or a specific task (@pxref{Ada Tasks}) hits that breakpoint.
3345
3346 @item break
3347 When called without any arguments, @code{break} sets a breakpoint at
3348 the next instruction to be executed in the selected stack frame
3349 (@pxref{Stack, ,Examining the Stack}). In any selected frame but the
3350 innermost, this makes your program stop as soon as control
3351 returns to that frame. This is similar to the effect of a
3352 @code{finish} command in the frame inside the selected frame---except
3353 that @code{finish} does not leave an active breakpoint. If you use
3354 @code{break} without an argument in the innermost frame, @value{GDBN} stops
3355 the next time it reaches the current location; this may be useful
3356 inside loops.
3357
3358 @value{GDBN} normally ignores breakpoints when it resumes execution, until at
3359 least one instruction has been executed. If it did not do this, you
3360 would be unable to proceed past a breakpoint without first disabling the
3361 breakpoint. This rule applies whether or not the breakpoint already
3362 existed when your program stopped.
3363
3364 @item break @dots{} if @var{cond}
3365 Set a breakpoint with condition @var{cond}; evaluate the expression
3366 @var{cond} each time the breakpoint is reached, and stop only if the
3367 value is nonzero---that is, if @var{cond} evaluates as true.
3368 @samp{@dots{}} stands for one of the possible arguments described
3369 above (or no argument) specifying where to break. @xref{Conditions,
3370 ,Break Conditions}, for more information on breakpoint conditions.
3371
3372 @kindex tbreak
3373 @item tbreak @var{args}
3374 Set a breakpoint enabled only for one stop. @var{args} are the
3375 same as for the @code{break} command, and the breakpoint is set in the same
3376 way, but the breakpoint is automatically deleted after the first time your
3377 program stops there. @xref{Disabling, ,Disabling Breakpoints}.
3378
3379 @kindex hbreak
3380 @cindex hardware breakpoints
3381 @item hbreak @var{args}
3382 Set a hardware-assisted breakpoint. @var{args} are the same as for the
3383 @code{break} command and the breakpoint is set in the same way, but the
3384 breakpoint requires hardware support and some target hardware may not
3385 have this support. The main purpose of this is EPROM/ROM code
3386 debugging, so you can set a breakpoint at an instruction without
3387 changing the instruction. This can be used with the new trap-generation
3388 provided by SPARClite DSU and most x86-based targets. These targets
3389 will generate traps when a program accesses some data or instruction
3390 address that is assigned to the debug registers. However the hardware
3391 breakpoint registers can take a limited number of breakpoints. For
3392 example, on the DSU, only two data breakpoints can be set at a time, and
3393 @value{GDBN} will reject this command if more than two are used. Delete
3394 or disable unused hardware breakpoints before setting new ones
3395 (@pxref{Disabling, ,Disabling Breakpoints}).
3396 @xref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}.
3397 For remote targets, you can restrict the number of hardware
3398 breakpoints @value{GDBN} will use, see @ref{set remote
3399 hardware-breakpoint-limit}.
3400
3401 @kindex thbreak
3402 @item thbreak @var{args}
3403 Set a hardware-assisted breakpoint enabled only for one stop. @var{args}
3404 are the same as for the @code{hbreak} command and the breakpoint is set in
3405 the same way. However, like the @code{tbreak} command,
3406 the breakpoint is automatically deleted after the
3407 first time your program stops there. Also, like the @code{hbreak}
3408 command, the breakpoint requires hardware support and some target hardware
3409 may not have this support. @xref{Disabling, ,Disabling Breakpoints}.
3410 See also @ref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}.
3411
3412 @kindex rbreak
3413 @cindex regular expression
3414 @cindex breakpoints at functions matching a regexp
3415 @cindex set breakpoints in many functions
3416 @item rbreak @var{regex}
3417 Set breakpoints on all functions matching the regular expression
3418 @var{regex}. This command sets an unconditional breakpoint on all
3419 matches, printing a list of all breakpoints it set. Once these
3420 breakpoints are set, they are treated just like the breakpoints set with
3421 the @code{break} command. You can delete them, disable them, or make
3422 them conditional the same way as any other breakpoint.
3423
3424 The syntax of the regular expression is the standard one used with tools
3425 like @file{grep}. Note that this is different from the syntax used by
3426 shells, so for instance @code{foo*} matches all functions that include
3427 an @code{fo} followed by zero or more @code{o}s. There is an implicit
3428 @code{.*} leading and trailing the regular expression you supply, so to
3429 match only functions that begin with @code{foo}, use @code{^foo}.
3430
3431 @cindex non-member C@t{++} functions, set breakpoint in
3432 When debugging C@t{++} programs, @code{rbreak} is useful for setting
3433 breakpoints on overloaded functions that are not members of any special
3434 classes.
3435
3436 @cindex set breakpoints on all functions
3437 The @code{rbreak} command can be used to set breakpoints in
3438 @strong{all} the functions in a program, like this:
3439
3440 @smallexample
3441 (@value{GDBP}) rbreak .
3442 @end smallexample
3443
3444 @item rbreak @var{file}:@var{regex}
3445 If @code{rbreak} is called with a filename qualification, it limits
3446 the search for functions matching the given regular expression to the
3447 specified @var{file}. This can be used, for example, to set breakpoints on
3448 every function in a given file:
3449
3450 @smallexample
3451 (@value{GDBP}) rbreak file.c:.
3452 @end smallexample
3453
3454 The colon separating the filename qualifier from the regex may
3455 optionally be surrounded by spaces.
3456
3457 @kindex info breakpoints
3458 @cindex @code{$_} and @code{info breakpoints}
3459 @item info breakpoints @r{[}@var{n}@dots{}@r{]}
3460 @itemx info break @r{[}@var{n}@dots{}@r{]}
3461 Print a table of all breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints set and
3462 not deleted. Optional argument @var{n} means print information only
3463 about the specified breakpoint(s) (or watchpoint(s) or catchpoint(s)).
3464 For each breakpoint, following columns are printed:
3465
3466 @table @emph
3467 @item Breakpoint Numbers
3468 @item Type
3469 Breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint.
3470 @item Disposition
3471 Whether the breakpoint is marked to be disabled or deleted when hit.
3472 @item Enabled or Disabled
3473 Enabled breakpoints are marked with @samp{y}. @samp{n} marks breakpoints
3474 that are not enabled.
3475 @item Address
3476 Where the breakpoint is in your program, as a memory address. For a
3477 pending breakpoint whose address is not yet known, this field will
3478 contain @samp{<PENDING>}. Such breakpoint won't fire until a shared
3479 library that has the symbol or line referred by breakpoint is loaded.
3480 See below for details. A breakpoint with several locations will
3481 have @samp{<MULTIPLE>} in this field---see below for details.
3482 @item What
3483 Where the breakpoint is in the source for your program, as a file and
3484 line number. For a pending breakpoint, the original string passed to
3485 the breakpoint command will be listed as it cannot be resolved until
3486 the appropriate shared library is loaded in the future.
3487 @end table
3488
3489 @noindent
3490 If a breakpoint is conditional, @code{info break} shows the condition on
3491 the line following the affected breakpoint; breakpoint commands, if any,
3492 are listed after that. A pending breakpoint is allowed to have a condition
3493 specified for it. The condition is not parsed for validity until a shared
3494 library is loaded that allows the pending breakpoint to resolve to a
3495 valid location.
3496
3497 @noindent
3498 @code{info break} with a breakpoint
3499 number @var{n} as argument lists only that breakpoint. The
3500 convenience variable @code{$_} and the default examining-address for
3501 the @code{x} command are set to the address of the last breakpoint
3502 listed (@pxref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}).
3503
3504 @noindent
3505 @code{info break} displays a count of the number of times the breakpoint
3506 has been hit. This is especially useful in conjunction with the
3507 @code{ignore} command. You can ignore a large number of breakpoint
3508 hits, look at the breakpoint info to see how many times the breakpoint
3509 was hit, and then run again, ignoring one less than that number. This
3510 will get you quickly to the last hit of that breakpoint.
3511 @end table
3512
3513 @value{GDBN} allows you to set any number of breakpoints at the same place in
3514 your program. There is nothing silly or meaningless about this. When
3515 the breakpoints are conditional, this is even useful
3516 (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}).
3517
3518 @cindex multiple locations, breakpoints
3519 @cindex breakpoints, multiple locations
3520 It is possible that a breakpoint corresponds to several locations
3521 in your program. Examples of this situation are:
3522
3523 @itemize @bullet
3524 @item
3525 Multiple functions in the program may have the same name.
3526
3527 @item
3528 For a C@t{++} constructor, the @value{NGCC} compiler generates several
3529 instances of the function body, used in different cases.
3530
3531 @item
3532 For a C@t{++} template function, a given line in the function can
3533 correspond to any number of instantiations.
3534
3535 @item
3536 For an inlined function, a given source line can correspond to
3537 several places where that function is inlined.
3538 @end itemize
3539
3540 In all those cases, @value{GDBN} will insert a breakpoint at all
3541 the relevant locations.
3542
3543 A breakpoint with multiple locations is displayed in the breakpoint
3544 table using several rows---one header row, followed by one row for
3545 each breakpoint location. The header row has @samp{<MULTIPLE>} in the
3546 address column. The rows for individual locations contain the actual
3547 addresses for locations, and show the functions to which those
3548 locations belong. The number column for a location is of the form
3549 @var{breakpoint-number}.@var{location-number}.
3550
3551 For example:
3552
3553 @smallexample
3554 Num Type Disp Enb Address What
3555 1 breakpoint keep y <MULTIPLE>
3556 stop only if i==1
3557 breakpoint already hit 1 time
3558 1.1 y 0x080486a2 in void foo<int>() at t.cc:8
3559 1.2 y 0x080486ca in void foo<double>() at t.cc:8
3560 @end smallexample
3561
3562 Each location can be individually enabled or disabled by passing
3563 @var{breakpoint-number}.@var{location-number} as argument to the
3564 @code{enable} and @code{disable} commands. Note that you cannot
3565 delete the individual locations from the list, you can only delete the
3566 entire list of locations that belong to their parent breakpoint (with
3567 the @kbd{delete @var{num}} command, where @var{num} is the number of
3568 the parent breakpoint, 1 in the above example). Disabling or enabling
3569 the parent breakpoint (@pxref{Disabling}) affects all of the locations
3570 that belong to that breakpoint.
3571
3572 @cindex pending breakpoints
3573 It's quite common to have a breakpoint inside a shared library.
3574 Shared libraries can be loaded and unloaded explicitly,
3575 and possibly repeatedly, as the program is executed. To support
3576 this use case, @value{GDBN} updates breakpoint locations whenever
3577 any shared library is loaded or unloaded. Typically, you would
3578 set a breakpoint in a shared library at the beginning of your
3579 debugging session, when the library is not loaded, and when the
3580 symbols from the library are not available. When you try to set
3581 breakpoint, @value{GDBN} will ask you if you want to set
3582 a so called @dfn{pending breakpoint}---breakpoint whose address
3583 is not yet resolved.
3584
3585 After the program is run, whenever a new shared library is loaded,
3586 @value{GDBN} reevaluates all the breakpoints. When a newly loaded
3587 shared library contains the symbol or line referred to by some
3588 pending breakpoint, that breakpoint is resolved and becomes an
3589 ordinary breakpoint. When a library is unloaded, all breakpoints
3590 that refer to its symbols or source lines become pending again.
3591
3592 This logic works for breakpoints with multiple locations, too. For
3593 example, if you have a breakpoint in a C@t{++} template function, and
3594 a newly loaded shared library has an instantiation of that template,
3595 a new location is added to the list of locations for the breakpoint.
3596
3597 Except for having unresolved address, pending breakpoints do not
3598 differ from regular breakpoints. You can set conditions or commands,
3599 enable and disable them and perform other breakpoint operations.
3600
3601 @value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling what
3602 happens when the @samp{break} command cannot resolve breakpoint
3603 address specification to an address:
3604
3605 @kindex set breakpoint pending
3606 @kindex show breakpoint pending
3607 @table @code
3608 @item set breakpoint pending auto
3609 This is the default behavior. When @value{GDBN} cannot find the breakpoint
3610 location, it queries you whether a pending breakpoint should be created.
3611
3612 @item set breakpoint pending on
3613 This indicates that an unrecognized breakpoint location should automatically
3614 result in a pending breakpoint being created.
3615
3616 @item set breakpoint pending off
3617 This indicates that pending breakpoints are not to be created. Any
3618 unrecognized breakpoint location results in an error. This setting does
3619 not affect any pending breakpoints previously created.
3620
3621 @item show breakpoint pending
3622 Show the current behavior setting for creating pending breakpoints.
3623 @end table
3624
3625 The settings above only affect the @code{break} command and its
3626 variants. Once breakpoint is set, it will be automatically updated
3627 as shared libraries are loaded and unloaded.
3628
3629 @cindex automatic hardware breakpoints
3630 For some targets, @value{GDBN} can automatically decide if hardware or
3631 software breakpoints should be used, depending on whether the
3632 breakpoint address is read-only or read-write. This applies to
3633 breakpoints set with the @code{break} command as well as to internal
3634 breakpoints set by commands like @code{next} and @code{finish}. For
3635 breakpoints set with @code{hbreak}, @value{GDBN} will always use hardware
3636 breakpoints.
3637
3638 You can control this automatic behaviour with the following commands::
3639
3640 @kindex set breakpoint auto-hw
3641 @kindex show breakpoint auto-hw
3642 @table @code
3643 @item set breakpoint auto-hw on
3644 This is the default behavior. When @value{GDBN} sets a breakpoint, it
3645 will try to use the target memory map to decide if software or hardware
3646 breakpoint must be used.
3647
3648 @item set breakpoint auto-hw off
3649 This indicates @value{GDBN} should not automatically select breakpoint
3650 type. If the target provides a memory map, @value{GDBN} will warn when
3651 trying to set software breakpoint at a read-only address.
3652 @end table
3653
3654 @value{GDBN} normally implements breakpoints by replacing the program code
3655 at the breakpoint address with a special instruction, which, when
3656 executed, given control to the debugger. By default, the program
3657 code is so modified only when the program is resumed. As soon as
3658 the program stops, @value{GDBN} restores the original instructions. This
3659 behaviour guards against leaving breakpoints inserted in the
3660 target should gdb abrubptly disconnect. However, with slow remote
3661 targets, inserting and removing breakpoint can reduce the performance.
3662 This behavior can be controlled with the following commands::
3663
3664 @kindex set breakpoint always-inserted
3665 @kindex show breakpoint always-inserted
3666 @table @code
3667 @item set breakpoint always-inserted off
3668 All breakpoints, including newly added by the user, are inserted in
3669 the target only when the target is resumed. All breakpoints are
3670 removed from the target when it stops.
3671
3672 @item set breakpoint always-inserted on
3673 Causes all breakpoints to be inserted in the target at all times. If
3674 the user adds a new breakpoint, or changes an existing breakpoint, the
3675 breakpoints in the target are updated immediately. A breakpoint is
3676 removed from the target only when breakpoint itself is removed.
3677
3678 @cindex non-stop mode, and @code{breakpoint always-inserted}
3679 @item set breakpoint always-inserted auto
3680 This is the default mode. If @value{GDBN} is controlling the inferior
3681 in non-stop mode (@pxref{Non-Stop Mode}), gdb behaves as if
3682 @code{breakpoint always-inserted} mode is on. If @value{GDBN} is
3683 controlling the inferior in all-stop mode, @value{GDBN} behaves as if
3684 @code{breakpoint always-inserted} mode is off.
3685 @end table
3686
3687 @cindex negative breakpoint numbers
3688 @cindex internal @value{GDBN} breakpoints
3689 @value{GDBN} itself sometimes sets breakpoints in your program for
3690 special purposes, such as proper handling of @code{longjmp} (in C
3691 programs). These internal breakpoints are assigned negative numbers,
3692 starting with @code{-1}; @samp{info breakpoints} does not display them.
3693 You can see these breakpoints with the @value{GDBN} maintenance command
3694 @samp{maint info breakpoints} (@pxref{maint info breakpoints}).
3695
3696
3697 @node Set Watchpoints
3698 @subsection Setting Watchpoints
3699
3700 @cindex setting watchpoints
3701 You can use a watchpoint to stop execution whenever the value of an
3702 expression changes, without having to predict a particular place where
3703 this may happen. (This is sometimes called a @dfn{data breakpoint}.)
3704 The expression may be as simple as the value of a single variable, or
3705 as complex as many variables combined by operators. Examples include:
3706
3707 @itemize @bullet
3708 @item
3709 A reference to the value of a single variable.
3710
3711 @item
3712 An address cast to an appropriate data type. For example,
3713 @samp{*(int *)0x12345678} will watch a 4-byte region at the specified
3714 address (assuming an @code{int} occupies 4 bytes).
3715
3716 @item
3717 An arbitrarily complex expression, such as @samp{a*b + c/d}. The
3718 expression can use any operators valid in the program's native
3719 language (@pxref{Languages}).
3720 @end itemize
3721
3722 You can set a watchpoint on an expression even if the expression can
3723 not be evaluated yet. For instance, you can set a watchpoint on
3724 @samp{*global_ptr} before @samp{global_ptr} is initialized.
3725 @value{GDBN} will stop when your program sets @samp{global_ptr} and
3726 the expression produces a valid value. If the expression becomes
3727 valid in some other way than changing a variable (e.g.@: if the memory
3728 pointed to by @samp{*global_ptr} becomes readable as the result of a
3729 @code{malloc} call), @value{GDBN} may not stop until the next time
3730 the expression changes.
3731
3732 @cindex software watchpoints
3733 @cindex hardware watchpoints
3734 Depending on your system, watchpoints may be implemented in software or
3735 hardware. @value{GDBN} does software watchpointing by single-stepping your
3736 program and testing the variable's value each time, which is hundreds of
3737 times slower than normal execution. (But this may still be worth it, to
3738 catch errors where you have no clue what part of your program is the
3739 culprit.)
3740
3741 On some systems, such as HP-UX, PowerPC, @sc{gnu}/Linux and most other
3742 x86-based targets, @value{GDBN} includes support for hardware
3743 watchpoints, which do not slow down the running of your program.
3744
3745 @table @code
3746 @kindex watch
3747 @item watch @r{[}-l@r{|}-location@r{]} @var{expr} @r{[}thread @var{threadnum}@r{]} @r{[}mask @var{maskvalue}@r{]}
3748 Set a watchpoint for an expression. @value{GDBN} will break when the
3749 expression @var{expr} is written into by the program and its value
3750 changes. The simplest (and the most popular) use of this command is
3751 to watch the value of a single variable:
3752
3753 @smallexample
3754 (@value{GDBP}) watch foo
3755 @end smallexample
3756
3757 If the command includes a @code{@r{[}thread @var{threadnum}@r{]}}
3758 argument, @value{GDBN} breaks only when the thread identified by
3759 @var{threadnum} changes the value of @var{expr}. If any other threads
3760 change the value of @var{expr}, @value{GDBN} will not break. Note
3761 that watchpoints restricted to a single thread in this way only work
3762 with Hardware Watchpoints.
3763
3764 Ordinarily a watchpoint respects the scope of variables in @var{expr}
3765 (see below). The @code{-location} argument tells @value{GDBN} to
3766 instead watch the memory referred to by @var{expr}. In this case,
3767 @value{GDBN} will evaluate @var{expr}, take the address of the result,
3768 and watch the memory at that address. The type of the result is used
3769 to determine the size of the watched memory. If the expression's
3770 result does not have an address, then @value{GDBN} will print an
3771 error.
3772
3773 The @code{@r{[}mask @var{maskvalue}@r{]}} argument allows creation
3774 of masked watchpoints, if the current architecture supports this
3775 feature (e.g., PowerPC Embedded architecture, see @ref{PowerPC
3776 Embedded}.) A @dfn{masked watchpoint} specifies a mask in addition
3777 to an address to watch. The mask specifies that some bits of an address
3778 (the bits which are reset in the mask) should be ignored when matching
3779 the address accessed by the inferior against the watchpoint address.
3780 Thus, a masked watchpoint watches many addresses simultaneously---those
3781 addresses whose unmasked bits are identical to the unmasked bits in the
3782 watchpoint address. The @code{mask} argument implies @code{-location}.
3783 Examples:
3784
3785 @smallexample
3786 (@value{GDBP}) watch foo mask 0xffff00ff
3787 (@value{GDBP}) watch *0xdeadbeef mask 0xffffff00
3788 @end smallexample
3789
3790 @kindex rwatch
3791 @item rwatch @r{[}-l@r{|}-location@r{]} @var{expr} @r{[}thread @var{threadnum}@r{]} @r{[}mask @var{maskvalue}@r{]}
3792 Set a watchpoint that will break when the value of @var{expr} is read
3793 by the program.
3794
3795 @kindex awatch
3796 @item awatch @r{[}-l@r{|}-location@r{]} @var{expr} @r{[}thread @var{threadnum}@r{]} @r{[}mask @var{maskvalue}@r{]}
3797 Set a watchpoint that will break when @var{expr} is either read from
3798 or written into by the program.
3799
3800 @kindex info watchpoints @r{[}@var{n}@dots{}@r{]}
3801 @item info watchpoints @r{[}@var{n}@dots{}@r{]}
3802 This command prints a list of watchpoints, using the same format as
3803 @code{info break} (@pxref{Set Breaks}).
3804 @end table
3805
3806 If you watch for a change in a numerically entered address you need to
3807 dereference it, as the address itself is just a constant number which will
3808 never change. @value{GDBN} refuses to create a watchpoint that watches
3809 a never-changing value:
3810
3811 @smallexample
3812 (@value{GDBP}) watch 0x600850
3813 Cannot watch constant value 0x600850.
3814 (@value{GDBP}) watch *(int *) 0x600850
3815 Watchpoint 1: *(int *) 6293584
3816 @end smallexample
3817
3818 @value{GDBN} sets a @dfn{hardware watchpoint} if possible. Hardware
3819 watchpoints execute very quickly, and the debugger reports a change in
3820 value at the exact instruction where the change occurs. If @value{GDBN}
3821 cannot set a hardware watchpoint, it sets a software watchpoint, which
3822 executes more slowly and reports the change in value at the next
3823 @emph{statement}, not the instruction, after the change occurs.
3824
3825 @cindex use only software watchpoints
3826 You can force @value{GDBN} to use only software watchpoints with the
3827 @kbd{set can-use-hw-watchpoints 0} command. With this variable set to
3828 zero, @value{GDBN} will never try to use hardware watchpoints, even if
3829 the underlying system supports them. (Note that hardware-assisted
3830 watchpoints that were set @emph{before} setting
3831 @code{can-use-hw-watchpoints} to zero will still use the hardware
3832 mechanism of watching expression values.)
3833
3834 @table @code
3835 @item set can-use-hw-watchpoints
3836 @kindex set can-use-hw-watchpoints
3837 Set whether or not to use hardware watchpoints.
3838
3839 @item show can-use-hw-watchpoints
3840 @kindex show can-use-hw-watchpoints
3841 Show the current mode of using hardware watchpoints.
3842 @end table
3843
3844 For remote targets, you can restrict the number of hardware
3845 watchpoints @value{GDBN} will use, see @ref{set remote
3846 hardware-breakpoint-limit}.
3847
3848 When you issue the @code{watch} command, @value{GDBN} reports
3849
3850 @smallexample
3851 Hardware watchpoint @var{num}: @var{expr}
3852 @end smallexample
3853
3854 @noindent
3855 if it was able to set a hardware watchpoint.
3856
3857 Currently, the @code{awatch} and @code{rwatch} commands can only set
3858 hardware watchpoints, because accesses to data that don't change the
3859 value of the watched expression cannot be detected without examining
3860 every instruction as it is being executed, and @value{GDBN} does not do
3861 that currently. If @value{GDBN} finds that it is unable to set a
3862 hardware breakpoint with the @code{awatch} or @code{rwatch} command, it
3863 will print a message like this:
3864
3865 @smallexample
3866 Expression cannot be implemented with read/access watchpoint.
3867 @end smallexample
3868
3869 Sometimes, @value{GDBN} cannot set a hardware watchpoint because the
3870 data type of the watched expression is wider than what a hardware
3871 watchpoint on the target machine can handle. For example, some systems
3872 can only watch regions that are up to 4 bytes wide; on such systems you
3873 cannot set hardware watchpoints for an expression that yields a
3874 double-precision floating-point number (which is typically 8 bytes
3875 wide). As a work-around, it might be possible to break the large region
3876 into a series of smaller ones and watch them with separate watchpoints.
3877
3878 If you set too many hardware watchpoints, @value{GDBN} might be unable
3879 to insert all of them when you resume the execution of your program.
3880 Since the precise number of active watchpoints is unknown until such
3881 time as the program is about to be resumed, @value{GDBN} might not be
3882 able to warn you about this when you set the watchpoints, and the
3883 warning will be printed only when the program is resumed:
3884
3885 @smallexample
3886 Hardware watchpoint @var{num}: Could not insert watchpoint
3887 @end smallexample
3888
3889 @noindent
3890 If this happens, delete or disable some of the watchpoints.
3891
3892 Watching complex expressions that reference many variables can also
3893 exhaust the resources available for hardware-assisted watchpoints.
3894 That's because @value{GDBN} needs to watch every variable in the
3895 expression with separately allocated resources.
3896
3897 If you call a function interactively using @code{print} or @code{call},
3898 any watchpoints you have set will be inactive until @value{GDBN} reaches another
3899 kind of breakpoint or the call completes.
3900
3901 @value{GDBN} automatically deletes watchpoints that watch local
3902 (automatic) variables, or expressions that involve such variables, when
3903 they go out of scope, that is, when the execution leaves the block in
3904 which these variables were defined. In particular, when the program
3905 being debugged terminates, @emph{all} local variables go out of scope,
3906 and so only watchpoints that watch global variables remain set. If you
3907 rerun the program, you will need to set all such watchpoints again. One
3908 way of doing that would be to set a code breakpoint at the entry to the
3909 @code{main} function and when it breaks, set all the watchpoints.
3910
3911 @cindex watchpoints and threads
3912 @cindex threads and watchpoints
3913 In multi-threaded programs, watchpoints will detect changes to the
3914 watched expression from every thread.
3915
3916 @quotation
3917 @emph{Warning:} In multi-threaded programs, software watchpoints
3918 have only limited usefulness. If @value{GDBN} creates a software
3919 watchpoint, it can only watch the value of an expression @emph{in a
3920 single thread}. If you are confident that the expression can only
3921 change due to the current thread's activity (and if you are also
3922 confident that no other thread can become current), then you can use
3923 software watchpoints as usual. However, @value{GDBN} may not notice
3924 when a non-current thread's activity changes the expression. (Hardware
3925 watchpoints, in contrast, watch an expression in all threads.)
3926 @end quotation
3927
3928 @xref{set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit}.
3929
3930 @node Set Catchpoints
3931 @subsection Setting Catchpoints
3932 @cindex catchpoints, setting
3933 @cindex exception handlers
3934 @cindex event handling
3935
3936 You can use @dfn{catchpoints} to cause the debugger to stop for certain
3937 kinds of program events, such as C@t{++} exceptions or the loading of a
3938 shared library. Use the @code{catch} command to set a catchpoint.
3939
3940 @table @code
3941 @kindex catch
3942 @item catch @var{event}
3943 Stop when @var{event} occurs. @var{event} can be any of the following:
3944 @table @code
3945 @item throw
3946 @cindex stop on C@t{++} exceptions
3947 The throwing of a C@t{++} exception.
3948
3949 @item catch
3950 The catching of a C@t{++} exception.
3951
3952 @item exception
3953 @cindex Ada exception catching
3954 @cindex catch Ada exceptions
3955 An Ada exception being raised. If an exception name is specified
3956 at the end of the command (eg @code{catch exception Program_Error}),
3957 the debugger will stop only when this specific exception is raised.
3958 Otherwise, the debugger stops execution when any Ada exception is raised.
3959
3960 When inserting an exception catchpoint on a user-defined exception whose
3961 name is identical to one of the exceptions defined by the language, the
3962 fully qualified name must be used as the exception name. Otherwise,
3963 @value{GDBN} will assume that it should stop on the pre-defined exception
3964 rather than the user-defined one. For instance, assuming an exception
3965 called @code{Constraint_Error} is defined in package @code{Pck}, then
3966 the command to use to catch such exceptions is @kbd{catch exception
3967 Pck.Constraint_Error}.
3968
3969 @item exception unhandled
3970 An exception that was raised but is not handled by the program.
3971
3972 @item assert
3973 A failed Ada assertion.
3974
3975 @item exec
3976 @cindex break on fork/exec
3977 A call to @code{exec}. This is currently only available for HP-UX
3978 and @sc{gnu}/Linux.
3979
3980 @item syscall
3981 @itemx syscall @r{[}@var{name} @r{|} @var{number}@r{]} @dots{}
3982 @cindex break on a system call.
3983 A call to or return from a system call, a.k.a.@: @dfn{syscall}. A
3984 syscall is a mechanism for application programs to request a service
3985 from the operating system (OS) or one of the OS system services.
3986 @value{GDBN} can catch some or all of the syscalls issued by the
3987 debuggee, and show the related information for each syscall. If no
3988 argument is specified, calls to and returns from all system calls
3989 will be caught.
3990
3991 @var{name} can be any system call name that is valid for the
3992 underlying OS. Just what syscalls are valid depends on the OS. On
3993 GNU and Unix systems, you can find the full list of valid syscall
3994 names on @file{/usr/include/asm/unistd.h}.
3995
3996 @c For MS-Windows, the syscall names and the corresponding numbers
3997 @c can be found, e.g., on this URL:
3998 @c http://www.metasploit.com/users/opcode/syscalls.html
3999 @c but we don't support Windows syscalls yet.
4000
4001 Normally, @value{GDBN} knows in advance which syscalls are valid for
4002 each OS, so you can use the @value{GDBN} command-line completion
4003 facilities (@pxref{Completion,, command completion}) to list the
4004 available choices.
4005
4006 You may also specify the system call numerically. A syscall's
4007 number is the value passed to the OS's syscall dispatcher to
4008 identify the requested service. When you specify the syscall by its
4009 name, @value{GDBN} uses its database of syscalls to convert the name
4010 into the corresponding numeric code, but using the number directly
4011 may be useful if @value{GDBN}'s database does not have the complete
4012 list of syscalls on your system (e.g., because @value{GDBN} lags
4013 behind the OS upgrades).
4014
4015 The example below illustrates how this command works if you don't provide
4016 arguments to it:
4017
4018 @smallexample
4019 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall
4020 Catchpoint 1 (syscall)
4021 (@value{GDBP}) r
4022 Starting program: /tmp/catch-syscall
4023
4024 Catchpoint 1 (call to syscall 'close'), \
4025 0xffffe424 in __kernel_vsyscall ()
4026 (@value{GDBP}) c
4027 Continuing.
4028
4029 Catchpoint 1 (returned from syscall 'close'), \
4030 0xffffe424 in __kernel_vsyscall ()
4031 (@value{GDBP})
4032 @end smallexample
4033
4034 Here is an example of catching a system call by name:
4035
4036 @smallexample
4037 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall chroot
4038 Catchpoint 1 (syscall 'chroot' [61])
4039 (@value{GDBP}) r
4040 Starting program: /tmp/catch-syscall
4041
4042 Catchpoint 1 (call to syscall 'chroot'), \
4043 0xffffe424 in __kernel_vsyscall ()
4044 (@value{GDBP}) c
4045 Continuing.
4046
4047 Catchpoint 1 (returned from syscall 'chroot'), \
4048 0xffffe424 in __kernel_vsyscall ()
4049 (@value{GDBP})
4050 @end smallexample
4051
4052 An example of specifying a system call numerically. In the case
4053 below, the syscall number has a corresponding entry in the XML
4054 file, so @value{GDBN} finds its name and prints it:
4055
4056 @smallexample
4057 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall 252
4058 Catchpoint 1 (syscall(s) 'exit_group')
4059 (@value{GDBP}) r
4060 Starting program: /tmp/catch-syscall
4061
4062 Catchpoint 1 (call to syscall 'exit_group'), \
4063 0xffffe424 in __kernel_vsyscall ()
4064 (@value{GDBP}) c
4065 Continuing.
4066
4067 Program exited normally.
4068 (@value{GDBP})
4069 @end smallexample
4070
4071 However, there can be situations when there is no corresponding name
4072 in XML file for that syscall number. In this case, @value{GDBN} prints
4073 a warning message saying that it was not able to find the syscall name,
4074 but the catchpoint will be set anyway. See the example below:
4075
4076 @smallexample
4077 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall 764
4078 warning: The number '764' does not represent a known syscall.
4079 Catchpoint 2 (syscall 764)
4080 (@value{GDBP})
4081 @end smallexample
4082
4083 If you configure @value{GDBN} using the @samp{--without-expat} option,
4084 it will not be able to display syscall names. Also, if your
4085 architecture does not have an XML file describing its system calls,
4086 you will not be able to see the syscall names. It is important to
4087 notice that these two features are used for accessing the syscall
4088 name database. In either case, you will see a warning like this:
4089
4090 @smallexample
4091 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall
4092 warning: Could not open "syscalls/i386-linux.xml"
4093 warning: Could not load the syscall XML file 'syscalls/i386-linux.xml'.
4094 GDB will not be able to display syscall names.
4095 Catchpoint 1 (syscall)
4096 (@value{GDBP})
4097 @end smallexample
4098
4099 Of course, the file name will change depending on your architecture and system.
4100
4101 Still using the example above, you can also try to catch a syscall by its
4102 number. In this case, you would see something like:
4103
4104 @smallexample
4105 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall 252
4106 Catchpoint 1 (syscall(s) 252)
4107 @end smallexample
4108
4109 Again, in this case @value{GDBN} would not be able to display syscall's names.
4110
4111 @item fork
4112 A call to @code{fork}. This is currently only available for HP-UX
4113 and @sc{gnu}/Linux.
4114
4115 @item vfork
4116 A call to @code{vfork}. This is currently only available for HP-UX
4117 and @sc{gnu}/Linux.
4118
4119 @end table
4120
4121 @item tcatch @var{event}
4122 Set a catchpoint that is enabled only for one stop. The catchpoint is
4123 automatically deleted after the first time the event is caught.
4124
4125 @end table
4126
4127 Use the @code{info break} command to list the current catchpoints.
4128
4129 There are currently some limitations to C@t{++} exception handling
4130 (@code{catch throw} and @code{catch catch}) in @value{GDBN}:
4131
4132 @itemize @bullet
4133 @item
4134 If you call a function interactively, @value{GDBN} normally returns
4135 control to you when the function has finished executing. If the call
4136 raises an exception, however, the call may bypass the mechanism that
4137 returns control to you and cause your program either to abort or to
4138 simply continue running until it hits a breakpoint, catches a signal
4139 that @value{GDBN} is listening for, or exits. This is the case even if
4140 you set a catchpoint for the exception; catchpoints on exceptions are
4141 disabled within interactive calls.
4142
4143 @item
4144 You cannot raise an exception interactively.
4145
4146 @item
4147 You cannot install an exception handler interactively.
4148 @end itemize
4149
4150 @cindex raise exceptions
4151 Sometimes @code{catch} is not the best way to debug exception handling:
4152 if you need to know exactly where an exception is raised, it is better to
4153 stop @emph{before} the exception handler is called, since that way you
4154 can see the stack before any unwinding takes place. If you set a
4155 breakpoint in an exception handler instead, it may not be easy to find
4156 out where the exception was raised.
4157
4158 To stop just before an exception handler is called, you need some
4159 knowledge of the implementation. In the case of @sc{gnu} C@t{++}, exceptions are
4160 raised by calling a library function named @code{__raise_exception}
4161 which has the following ANSI C interface:
4162
4163 @smallexample
4164 /* @var{addr} is where the exception identifier is stored.
4165 @var{id} is the exception identifier. */
4166 void __raise_exception (void **addr, void *id);
4167 @end smallexample
4168
4169 @noindent
4170 To make the debugger catch all exceptions before any stack
4171 unwinding takes place, set a breakpoint on @code{__raise_exception}
4172 (@pxref{Breakpoints, ,Breakpoints; Watchpoints; and Exceptions}).
4173
4174 With a conditional breakpoint (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions})
4175 that depends on the value of @var{id}, you can stop your program when
4176 a specific exception is raised. You can use multiple conditional
4177 breakpoints to stop your program when any of a number of exceptions are
4178 raised.
4179
4180
4181 @node Delete Breaks
4182 @subsection Deleting Breakpoints
4183
4184 @cindex clearing breakpoints, watchpoints, catchpoints
4185 @cindex deleting breakpoints, watchpoints, catchpoints
4186 It is often necessary to eliminate a breakpoint, watchpoint, or
4187 catchpoint once it has done its job and you no longer want your program
4188 to stop there. This is called @dfn{deleting} the breakpoint. A
4189 breakpoint that has been deleted no longer exists; it is forgotten.
4190
4191 With the @code{clear} command you can delete breakpoints according to
4192 where they are in your program. With the @code{delete} command you can
4193 delete individual breakpoints, watchpoints, or catchpoints by specifying
4194 their breakpoint numbers.
4195
4196 It is not necessary to delete a breakpoint to proceed past it. @value{GDBN}
4197 automatically ignores breakpoints on the first instruction to be executed
4198 when you continue execution without changing the execution address.
4199
4200 @table @code
4201 @kindex clear
4202 @item clear
4203 Delete any breakpoints at the next instruction to be executed in the
4204 selected stack frame (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}). When
4205 the innermost frame is selected, this is a good way to delete a
4206 breakpoint where your program just stopped.
4207
4208 @item clear @var{location}
4209 Delete any breakpoints set at the specified @var{location}.
4210 @xref{Specify Location}, for the various forms of @var{location}; the
4211 most useful ones are listed below:
4212
4213 @table @code
4214 @item clear @var{function}
4215 @itemx clear @var{filename}:@var{function}
4216 Delete any breakpoints set at entry to the named @var{function}.
4217
4218 @item clear @var{linenum}
4219 @itemx clear @var{filename}:@var{linenum}
4220 Delete any breakpoints set at or within the code of the specified
4221 @var{linenum} of the specified @var{filename}.
4222 @end table
4223
4224 @cindex delete breakpoints
4225 @kindex delete
4226 @kindex d @r{(@code{delete})}
4227 @item delete @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
4228 Delete the breakpoints, watchpoints, or catchpoints of the breakpoint
4229 ranges specified as arguments. If no argument is specified, delete all
4230 breakpoints (@value{GDBN} asks confirmation, unless you have @code{set
4231 confirm off}). You can abbreviate this command as @code{d}.
4232 @end table
4233
4234 @node Disabling
4235 @subsection Disabling Breakpoints
4236
4237 @cindex enable/disable a breakpoint
4238 Rather than deleting a breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint, you might
4239 prefer to @dfn{disable} it. This makes the breakpoint inoperative as if
4240 it had been deleted, but remembers the information on the breakpoint so
4241 that you can @dfn{enable} it again later.
4242
4243 You disable and enable breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints with
4244 the @code{enable} and @code{disable} commands, optionally specifying
4245 one or more breakpoint numbers as arguments. Use @code{info break} to
4246 print a list of all breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints if you
4247 do not know which numbers to use.
4248
4249 Disabling and enabling a breakpoint that has multiple locations
4250 affects all of its locations.
4251
4252 A breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint can have any of four different
4253 states of enablement:
4254
4255 @itemize @bullet
4256 @item
4257 Enabled. The breakpoint stops your program. A breakpoint set
4258 with the @code{break} command starts out in this state.
4259 @item
4260 Disabled. The breakpoint has no effect on your program.
4261 @item
4262 Enabled once. The breakpoint stops your program, but then becomes
4263 disabled.
4264 @item
4265 Enabled for deletion. The breakpoint stops your program, but
4266 immediately after it does so it is deleted permanently. A breakpoint
4267 set with the @code{tbreak} command starts out in this state.
4268 @end itemize
4269
4270 You can use the following commands to enable or disable breakpoints,
4271 watchpoints, and catchpoints:
4272
4273 @table @code
4274 @kindex disable
4275 @kindex dis @r{(@code{disable})}
4276 @item disable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
4277 Disable the specified breakpoints---or all breakpoints, if none are
4278 listed. A disabled breakpoint has no effect but is not forgotten. All
4279 options such as ignore-counts, conditions and commands are remembered in
4280 case the breakpoint is enabled again later. You may abbreviate
4281 @code{disable} as @code{dis}.
4282
4283 @kindex enable
4284 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
4285 Enable the specified breakpoints (or all defined breakpoints). They
4286 become effective once again in stopping your program.
4287
4288 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} once @var{range}@dots{}
4289 Enable the specified breakpoints temporarily. @value{GDBN} disables any
4290 of these breakpoints immediately after stopping your program.
4291
4292 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} delete @var{range}@dots{}
4293 Enable the specified breakpoints to work once, then die. @value{GDBN}
4294 deletes any of these breakpoints as soon as your program stops there.
4295 Breakpoints set by the @code{tbreak} command start out in this state.
4296 @end table
4297
4298 @c FIXME: I think the following ``Except for [...] @code{tbreak}'' is
4299 @c confusing: tbreak is also initially enabled.
4300 Except for a breakpoint set with @code{tbreak} (@pxref{Set Breaks,
4301 ,Setting Breakpoints}), breakpoints that you set are initially enabled;
4302 subsequently, they become disabled or enabled only when you use one of
4303 the commands above. (The command @code{until} can set and delete a
4304 breakpoint of its own, but it does not change the state of your other
4305 breakpoints; see @ref{Continuing and Stepping, ,Continuing and
4306 Stepping}.)
4307
4308 @node Conditions
4309 @subsection Break Conditions
4310 @cindex conditional breakpoints
4311 @cindex breakpoint conditions
4312
4313 @c FIXME what is scope of break condition expr? Context where wanted?
4314 @c in particular for a watchpoint?
4315 The simplest sort of breakpoint breaks every time your program reaches a
4316 specified place. You can also specify a @dfn{condition} for a
4317 breakpoint. A condition is just a Boolean expression in your
4318 programming language (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). A breakpoint with
4319 a condition evaluates the expression each time your program reaches it,
4320 and your program stops only if the condition is @emph{true}.
4321
4322 This is the converse of using assertions for program validation; in that
4323 situation, you want to stop when the assertion is violated---that is,
4324 when the condition is false. In C, if you want to test an assertion expressed
4325 by the condition @var{assert}, you should set the condition
4326 @samp{! @var{assert}} on the appropriate breakpoint.
4327
4328 Conditions are also accepted for watchpoints; you may not need them,
4329 since a watchpoint is inspecting the value of an expression anyhow---but
4330 it might be simpler, say, to just set a watchpoint on a variable name,
4331 and specify a condition that tests whether the new value is an interesting
4332 one.
4333
4334 Break conditions can have side effects, and may even call functions in
4335 your program. This can be useful, for example, to activate functions
4336 that log program progress, or to use your own print functions to
4337 format special data structures. The effects are completely predictable
4338 unless there is another enabled breakpoint at the same address. (In
4339 that case, @value{GDBN} might see the other breakpoint first and stop your
4340 program without checking the condition of this one.) Note that
4341 breakpoint commands are usually more convenient and flexible than break
4342 conditions for the
4343 purpose of performing side effects when a breakpoint is reached
4344 (@pxref{Break Commands, ,Breakpoint Command Lists}).
4345
4346 Break conditions can be specified when a breakpoint is set, by using
4347 @samp{if} in the arguments to the @code{break} command. @xref{Set
4348 Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}. They can also be changed at any time
4349 with the @code{condition} command.
4350
4351 You can also use the @code{if} keyword with the @code{watch} command.
4352 The @code{catch} command does not recognize the @code{if} keyword;
4353 @code{condition} is the only way to impose a further condition on a
4354 catchpoint.
4355
4356 @table @code
4357 @kindex condition
4358 @item condition @var{bnum} @var{expression}
4359 Specify @var{expression} as the break condition for breakpoint,
4360 watchpoint, or catchpoint number @var{bnum}. After you set a condition,
4361 breakpoint @var{bnum} stops your program only if the value of
4362 @var{expression} is true (nonzero, in C). When you use
4363 @code{condition}, @value{GDBN} checks @var{expression} immediately for
4364 syntactic correctness, and to determine whether symbols in it have
4365 referents in the context of your breakpoint. If @var{expression} uses
4366 symbols not referenced in the context of the breakpoint, @value{GDBN}
4367 prints an error message:
4368
4369 @smallexample
4370 No symbol "foo" in current context.
4371 @end smallexample
4372
4373 @noindent
4374 @value{GDBN} does
4375 not actually evaluate @var{expression} at the time the @code{condition}
4376 command (or a command that sets a breakpoint with a condition, like
4377 @code{break if @dots{}}) is given, however. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
4378
4379 @item condition @var{bnum}
4380 Remove the condition from breakpoint number @var{bnum}. It becomes
4381 an ordinary unconditional breakpoint.
4382 @end table
4383
4384 @cindex ignore count (of breakpoint)
4385 A special case of a breakpoint condition is to stop only when the
4386 breakpoint has been reached a certain number of times. This is so
4387 useful that there is a special way to do it, using the @dfn{ignore
4388 count} of the breakpoint. Every breakpoint has an ignore count, which
4389 is an integer. Most of the time, the ignore count is zero, and
4390 therefore has no effect. But if your program reaches a breakpoint whose
4391 ignore count is positive, then instead of stopping, it just decrements
4392 the ignore count by one and continues. As a result, if the ignore count
4393 value is @var{n}, the breakpoint does not stop the next @var{n} times
4394 your program reaches it.
4395
4396 @table @code
4397 @kindex ignore
4398 @item ignore @var{bnum} @var{count}
4399 Set the ignore count of breakpoint number @var{bnum} to @var{count}.
4400 The next @var{count} times the breakpoint is reached, your program's
4401 execution does not stop; other than to decrement the ignore count, @value{GDBN}
4402 takes no action.
4403
4404 To make the breakpoint stop the next time it is reached, specify
4405 a count of zero.
4406
4407 When you use @code{continue} to resume execution of your program from a
4408 breakpoint, you can specify an ignore count directly as an argument to
4409 @code{continue}, rather than using @code{ignore}. @xref{Continuing and
4410 Stepping,,Continuing and Stepping}.
4411
4412 If a breakpoint has a positive ignore count and a condition, the
4413 condition is not checked. Once the ignore count reaches zero,
4414 @value{GDBN} resumes checking the condition.
4415
4416 You could achieve the effect of the ignore count with a condition such
4417 as @w{@samp{$foo-- <= 0}} using a debugger convenience variable that
4418 is decremented each time. @xref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
4419 Variables}.
4420 @end table
4421
4422 Ignore counts apply to breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints.
4423
4424
4425 @node Break Commands
4426 @subsection Breakpoint Command Lists
4427
4428 @cindex breakpoint commands
4429 You can give any breakpoint (or watchpoint or catchpoint) a series of
4430 commands to execute when your program stops due to that breakpoint. For
4431 example, you might want to print the values of certain expressions, or
4432 enable other breakpoints.
4433
4434 @table @code
4435 @kindex commands
4436 @kindex end@r{ (breakpoint commands)}
4437 @item commands @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
4438 @itemx @dots{} @var{command-list} @dots{}
4439 @itemx end
4440 Specify a list of commands for the given breakpoints. The commands
4441 themselves appear on the following lines. Type a line containing just
4442 @code{end} to terminate the commands.
4443
4444 To remove all commands from a breakpoint, type @code{commands} and
4445 follow it immediately with @code{end}; that is, give no commands.
4446
4447 With no argument, @code{commands} refers to the last breakpoint,
4448 watchpoint, or catchpoint set (not to the breakpoint most recently
4449 encountered). If the most recent breakpoints were set with a single
4450 command, then the @code{commands} will apply to all the breakpoints
4451 set by that command. This applies to breakpoints set by
4452 @code{rbreak}, and also applies when a single @code{break} command
4453 creates multiple breakpoints (@pxref{Ambiguous Expressions,,Ambiguous
4454 Expressions}).
4455 @end table
4456
4457 Pressing @key{RET} as a means of repeating the last @value{GDBN} command is
4458 disabled within a @var{command-list}.
4459
4460 You can use breakpoint commands to start your program up again. Simply
4461 use the @code{continue} command, or @code{step}, or any other command
4462 that resumes execution.
4463
4464 Any other commands in the command list, after a command that resumes
4465 execution, are ignored. This is because any time you resume execution
4466 (even with a simple @code{next} or @code{step}), you may encounter
4467 another breakpoint---which could have its own command list, leading to
4468 ambiguities about which list to execute.
4469
4470 @kindex silent
4471 If the first command you specify in a command list is @code{silent}, the
4472 usual message about stopping at a breakpoint is not printed. This may
4473 be desirable for breakpoints that are to print a specific message and
4474 then continue. If none of the remaining commands print anything, you
4475 see no sign that the breakpoint was reached. @code{silent} is
4476 meaningful only at the beginning of a breakpoint command list.
4477
4478 The commands @code{echo}, @code{output}, and @code{printf} allow you to
4479 print precisely controlled output, and are often useful in silent
4480 breakpoints. @xref{Output, ,Commands for Controlled Output}.
4481
4482 For example, here is how you could use breakpoint commands to print the
4483 value of @code{x} at entry to @code{foo} whenever @code{x} is positive.
4484
4485 @smallexample
4486 break foo if x>0
4487 commands
4488 silent
4489 printf "x is %d\n",x
4490 cont
4491 end
4492 @end smallexample
4493
4494 One application for breakpoint commands is to compensate for one bug so
4495 you can test for another. Put a breakpoint just after the erroneous line
4496 of code, give it a condition to detect the case in which something
4497 erroneous has been done, and give it commands to assign correct values
4498 to any variables that need them. End with the @code{continue} command
4499 so that your program does not stop, and start with the @code{silent}
4500 command so that no output is produced. Here is an example:
4501
4502 @smallexample
4503 break 403
4504 commands
4505 silent
4506 set x = y + 4
4507 cont
4508 end
4509 @end smallexample
4510
4511 @node Save Breakpoints
4512 @subsection How to save breakpoints to a file
4513
4514 To save breakpoint definitions to a file use the @w{@code{save
4515 breakpoints}} command.
4516
4517 @table @code
4518 @kindex save breakpoints
4519 @cindex save breakpoints to a file for future sessions
4520 @item save breakpoints [@var{filename}]
4521 This command saves all current breakpoint definitions together with
4522 their commands and ignore counts, into a file @file{@var{filename}}
4523 suitable for use in a later debugging session. This includes all
4524 types of breakpoints (breakpoints, watchpoints, catchpoints,
4525 tracepoints). To read the saved breakpoint definitions, use the
4526 @code{source} command (@pxref{Command Files}). Note that watchpoints
4527 with expressions involving local variables may fail to be recreated
4528 because it may not be possible to access the context where the
4529 watchpoint is valid anymore. Because the saved breakpoint definitions
4530 are simply a sequence of @value{GDBN} commands that recreate the
4531 breakpoints, you can edit the file in your favorite editing program,
4532 and remove the breakpoint definitions you're not interested in, or
4533 that can no longer be recreated.
4534 @end table
4535
4536 @c @ifclear BARETARGET
4537 @node Error in Breakpoints
4538 @subsection ``Cannot insert breakpoints''
4539
4540 If you request too many active hardware-assisted breakpoints and
4541 watchpoints, you will see this error message:
4542
4543 @c FIXME: the precise wording of this message may change; the relevant
4544 @c source change is not committed yet (Sep 3, 1999).
4545 @smallexample
4546 Stopped; cannot insert breakpoints.
4547 You may have requested too many hardware breakpoints and watchpoints.
4548 @end smallexample
4549
4550 @noindent
4551 This message is printed when you attempt to resume the program, since
4552 only then @value{GDBN} knows exactly how many hardware breakpoints and
4553 watchpoints it needs to insert.
4554
4555 When this message is printed, you need to disable or remove some of the
4556 hardware-assisted breakpoints and watchpoints, and then continue.
4557
4558 @node Breakpoint-related Warnings
4559 @subsection ``Breakpoint address adjusted...''
4560 @cindex breakpoint address adjusted
4561
4562 Some processor architectures place constraints on the addresses at
4563 which breakpoints may be placed. For architectures thus constrained,
4564 @value{GDBN} will attempt to adjust the breakpoint's address to comply
4565 with the constraints dictated by the architecture.
4566
4567 One example of such an architecture is the Fujitsu FR-V. The FR-V is
4568 a VLIW architecture in which a number of RISC-like instructions may be
4569 bundled together for parallel execution. The FR-V architecture
4570 constrains the location of a breakpoint instruction within such a
4571 bundle to the instruction with the lowest address. @value{GDBN}
4572 honors this constraint by adjusting a breakpoint's address to the
4573 first in the bundle.
4574
4575 It is not uncommon for optimized code to have bundles which contain
4576 instructions from different source statements, thus it may happen that
4577 a breakpoint's address will be adjusted from one source statement to
4578 another. Since this adjustment may significantly alter @value{GDBN}'s
4579 breakpoint related behavior from what the user expects, a warning is
4580 printed when the breakpoint is first set and also when the breakpoint
4581 is hit.
4582
4583 A warning like the one below is printed when setting a breakpoint
4584 that's been subject to address adjustment:
4585
4586 @smallexample
4587 warning: Breakpoint address adjusted from 0x00010414 to 0x00010410.
4588 @end smallexample
4589
4590 Such warnings are printed both for user settable and @value{GDBN}'s
4591 internal breakpoints. If you see one of these warnings, you should
4592 verify that a breakpoint set at the adjusted address will have the
4593 desired affect. If not, the breakpoint in question may be removed and
4594 other breakpoints may be set which will have the desired behavior.
4595 E.g., it may be sufficient to place the breakpoint at a later
4596 instruction. A conditional breakpoint may also be useful in some
4597 cases to prevent the breakpoint from triggering too often.
4598
4599 @value{GDBN} will also issue a warning when stopping at one of these
4600 adjusted breakpoints:
4601
4602 @smallexample
4603 warning: Breakpoint 1 address previously adjusted from 0x00010414
4604 to 0x00010410.
4605 @end smallexample
4606
4607 When this warning is encountered, it may be too late to take remedial
4608 action except in cases where the breakpoint is hit earlier or more
4609 frequently than expected.
4610
4611 @node Continuing and Stepping
4612 @section Continuing and Stepping
4613
4614 @cindex stepping
4615 @cindex continuing
4616 @cindex resuming execution
4617 @dfn{Continuing} means resuming program execution until your program
4618 completes normally. In contrast, @dfn{stepping} means executing just
4619 one more ``step'' of your program, where ``step'' may mean either one
4620 line of source code, or one machine instruction (depending on what
4621 particular command you use). Either when continuing or when stepping,
4622 your program may stop even sooner, due to a breakpoint or a signal. (If
4623 it stops due to a signal, you may want to use @code{handle}, or use
4624 @samp{signal 0} to resume execution. @xref{Signals, ,Signals}.)
4625
4626 @table @code
4627 @kindex continue
4628 @kindex c @r{(@code{continue})}
4629 @kindex fg @r{(resume foreground execution)}
4630 @item continue @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
4631 @itemx c @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
4632 @itemx fg @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
4633 Resume program execution, at the address where your program last stopped;
4634 any breakpoints set at that address are bypassed. The optional argument
4635 @var{ignore-count} allows you to specify a further number of times to
4636 ignore a breakpoint at this location; its effect is like that of
4637 @code{ignore} (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}).
4638
4639 The argument @var{ignore-count} is meaningful only when your program
4640 stopped due to a breakpoint. At other times, the argument to
4641 @code{continue} is ignored.
4642
4643 The synonyms @code{c} and @code{fg} (for @dfn{foreground}, as the
4644 debugged program is deemed to be the foreground program) are provided
4645 purely for convenience, and have exactly the same behavior as
4646 @code{continue}.
4647 @end table
4648
4649 To resume execution at a different place, you can use @code{return}
4650 (@pxref{Returning, ,Returning from a Function}) to go back to the
4651 calling function; or @code{jump} (@pxref{Jumping, ,Continuing at a
4652 Different Address}) to go to an arbitrary location in your program.
4653
4654 A typical technique for using stepping is to set a breakpoint
4655 (@pxref{Breakpoints, ,Breakpoints; Watchpoints; and Catchpoints}) at the
4656 beginning of the function or the section of your program where a problem
4657 is believed to lie, run your program until it stops at that breakpoint,
4658 and then step through the suspect area, examining the variables that are
4659 interesting, until you see the problem happen.
4660
4661 @table @code
4662 @kindex step
4663 @kindex s @r{(@code{step})}
4664 @item step
4665 Continue running your program until control reaches a different source
4666 line, then stop it and return control to @value{GDBN}. This command is
4667 abbreviated @code{s}.
4668
4669 @quotation
4670 @c "without debugging information" is imprecise; actually "without line
4671 @c numbers in the debugging information". (gcc -g1 has debugging info but
4672 @c not line numbers). But it seems complex to try to make that
4673 @c distinction here.
4674 @emph{Warning:} If you use the @code{step} command while control is
4675 within a function that was compiled without debugging information,
4676 execution proceeds until control reaches a function that does have
4677 debugging information. Likewise, it will not step into a function which
4678 is compiled without debugging information. To step through functions
4679 without debugging information, use the @code{stepi} command, described
4680 below.
4681 @end quotation
4682
4683 The @code{step} command only stops at the first instruction of a source
4684 line. This prevents the multiple stops that could otherwise occur in
4685 @code{switch} statements, @code{for} loops, etc. @code{step} continues
4686 to stop if a function that has debugging information is called within
4687 the line. In other words, @code{step} @emph{steps inside} any functions
4688 called within the line.
4689
4690 Also, the @code{step} command only enters a function if there is line
4691 number information for the function. Otherwise it acts like the
4692 @code{next} command. This avoids problems when using @code{cc -gl}
4693 on MIPS machines. Previously, @code{step} entered subroutines if there
4694 was any debugging information about the routine.
4695
4696 @item step @var{count}
4697 Continue running as in @code{step}, but do so @var{count} times. If a
4698 breakpoint is reached, or a signal not related to stepping occurs before
4699 @var{count} steps, stepping stops right away.
4700
4701 @kindex next
4702 @kindex n @r{(@code{next})}
4703 @item next @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
4704 Continue to the next source line in the current (innermost) stack frame.
4705 This is similar to @code{step}, but function calls that appear within
4706 the line of code are executed without stopping. Execution stops when
4707 control reaches a different line of code at the original stack level
4708 that was executing when you gave the @code{next} command. This command
4709 is abbreviated @code{n}.
4710
4711 An argument @var{count} is a repeat count, as for @code{step}.
4712
4713
4714 @c FIX ME!! Do we delete this, or is there a way it fits in with
4715 @c the following paragraph? --- Vctoria
4716 @c
4717 @c @code{next} within a function that lacks debugging information acts like
4718 @c @code{step}, but any function calls appearing within the code of the
4719 @c function are executed without stopping.
4720
4721 The @code{next} command only stops at the first instruction of a
4722 source line. This prevents multiple stops that could otherwise occur in
4723 @code{switch} statements, @code{for} loops, etc.
4724
4725 @kindex set step-mode
4726 @item set step-mode
4727 @cindex functions without line info, and stepping
4728 @cindex stepping into functions with no line info
4729 @itemx set step-mode on
4730 The @code{set step-mode on} command causes the @code{step} command to
4731 stop at the first instruction of a function which contains no debug line
4732 information rather than stepping over it.
4733
4734 This is useful in cases where you may be interested in inspecting the
4735 machine instructions of a function which has no symbolic info and do not
4736 want @value{GDBN} to automatically skip over this function.
4737
4738 @item set step-mode off
4739 Causes the @code{step} command to step over any functions which contains no
4740 debug information. This is the default.
4741
4742 @item show step-mode
4743 Show whether @value{GDBN} will stop in or step over functions without
4744 source line debug information.
4745
4746 @kindex finish
4747 @kindex fin @r{(@code{finish})}
4748 @item finish
4749 Continue running until just after function in the selected stack frame
4750 returns. Print the returned value (if any). This command can be
4751 abbreviated as @code{fin}.
4752
4753 Contrast this with the @code{return} command (@pxref{Returning,
4754 ,Returning from a Function}).
4755
4756 @kindex until
4757 @kindex u @r{(@code{until})}
4758 @cindex run until specified location
4759 @item until
4760 @itemx u
4761 Continue running until a source line past the current line, in the
4762 current stack frame, is reached. This command is used to avoid single
4763 stepping through a loop more than once. It is like the @code{next}
4764 command, except that when @code{until} encounters a jump, it
4765 automatically continues execution until the program counter is greater
4766 than the address of the jump.
4767
4768 This means that when you reach the end of a loop after single stepping
4769 though it, @code{until} makes your program continue execution until it
4770 exits the loop. In contrast, a @code{next} command at the end of a loop
4771 simply steps back to the beginning of the loop, which forces you to step
4772 through the next iteration.
4773
4774 @code{until} always stops your program if it attempts to exit the current
4775 stack frame.
4776
4777 @code{until} may produce somewhat counterintuitive results if the order
4778 of machine code does not match the order of the source lines. For
4779 example, in the following excerpt from a debugging session, the @code{f}
4780 (@code{frame}) command shows that execution is stopped at line
4781 @code{206}; yet when we use @code{until}, we get to line @code{195}:
4782
4783 @smallexample
4784 (@value{GDBP}) f
4785 #0 main (argc=4, argv=0xf7fffae8) at m4.c:206
4786 206 expand_input();
4787 (@value{GDBP}) until
4788 195 for ( ; argc > 0; NEXTARG) @{
4789 @end smallexample
4790
4791 This happened because, for execution efficiency, the compiler had
4792 generated code for the loop closure test at the end, rather than the
4793 start, of the loop---even though the test in a C @code{for}-loop is
4794 written before the body of the loop. The @code{until} command appeared
4795 to step back to the beginning of the loop when it advanced to this
4796 expression; however, it has not really gone to an earlier
4797 statement---not in terms of the actual machine code.
4798
4799 @code{until} with no argument works by means of single
4800 instruction stepping, and hence is slower than @code{until} with an
4801 argument.
4802
4803 @item until @var{location}
4804 @itemx u @var{location}
4805 Continue running your program until either the specified location is
4806 reached, or the current stack frame returns. @var{location} is any of
4807 the forms described in @ref{Specify Location}.
4808 This form of the command uses temporary breakpoints, and
4809 hence is quicker than @code{until} without an argument. The specified
4810 location is actually reached only if it is in the current frame. This
4811 implies that @code{until} can be used to skip over recursive function
4812 invocations. For instance in the code below, if the current location is
4813 line @code{96}, issuing @code{until 99} will execute the program up to
4814 line @code{99} in the same invocation of factorial, i.e., after the inner
4815 invocations have returned.
4816
4817 @smallexample
4818 94 int factorial (int value)
4819 95 @{
4820 96 if (value > 1) @{
4821 97 value *= factorial (value - 1);
4822 98 @}
4823 99 return (value);
4824 100 @}
4825 @end smallexample
4826
4827
4828 @kindex advance @var{location}
4829 @itemx advance @var{location}
4830 Continue running the program up to the given @var{location}. An argument is
4831 required, which should be of one of the forms described in
4832 @ref{Specify Location}.
4833 Execution will also stop upon exit from the current stack
4834 frame. This command is similar to @code{until}, but @code{advance} will
4835 not skip over recursive function calls, and the target location doesn't
4836 have to be in the same frame as the current one.
4837
4838
4839 @kindex stepi
4840 @kindex si @r{(@code{stepi})}
4841 @item stepi
4842 @itemx stepi @var{arg}
4843 @itemx si
4844 Execute one machine instruction, then stop and return to the debugger.
4845
4846 It is often useful to do @samp{display/i $pc} when stepping by machine
4847 instructions. This makes @value{GDBN} automatically display the next
4848 instruction to be executed, each time your program stops. @xref{Auto
4849 Display,, Automatic Display}.
4850
4851 An argument is a repeat count, as in @code{step}.
4852
4853 @need 750
4854 @kindex nexti
4855 @kindex ni @r{(@code{nexti})}
4856 @item nexti
4857 @itemx nexti @var{arg}
4858 @itemx ni
4859 Execute one machine instruction, but if it is a function call,
4860 proceed until the function returns.
4861
4862 An argument is a repeat count, as in @code{next}.
4863 @end table
4864
4865 @node Skipping Over Functions and Files
4866 @section Skipping Over Functions and Files
4867 @cindex skipping over functions and files
4868
4869 The program you are debugging may contain some functions which are
4870 uninteresting to debug. The @code{skip} comand lets you tell @value{GDBN} to
4871 skip a function or all functions in a file when stepping.
4872
4873 For example, consider the following C function:
4874
4875 @smallexample
4876 101 int func()
4877 102 @{
4878 103 foo(boring());
4879 104 bar(boring());
4880 105 @}
4881 @end smallexample
4882
4883 @noindent
4884 Suppose you wish to step into the functions @code{foo} and @code{bar}, but you
4885 are not interested in stepping through @code{boring}. If you run @code{step}
4886 at line 103, you'll enter @code{boring()}, but if you run @code{next}, you'll
4887 step over both @code{foo} and @code{boring}!
4888
4889 One solution is to @code{step} into @code{boring} and use the @code{finish}
4890 command to immediately exit it. But this can become tedious if @code{boring}
4891 is called from many places.
4892
4893 A more flexible solution is to execute @kbd{skip boring}. This instructs
4894 @value{GDBN} never to step into @code{boring}. Now when you execute
4895 @code{step} at line 103, you'll step over @code{boring} and directly into
4896 @code{foo}.
4897
4898 You can also instruct @value{GDBN} to skip all functions in a file, with, for
4899 example, @code{skip file boring.c}.
4900
4901 @table @code
4902 @kindex skip function
4903 @item skip @r{[}@var{linespec}@r{]}
4904 @itemx skip function @r{[}@var{linespec}@r{]}
4905 After running this command, the function named by @var{linespec} or the
4906 function containing the line named by @var{linespec} will be skipped over when
4907 stepping. @xref{Specify Location}.
4908
4909 If you do not specify @var{linespec}, the function you're currently debugging
4910 will be skipped.
4911
4912 (If you have a function called @code{file} that you want to skip, use
4913 @kbd{skip function file}.)
4914
4915 @kindex skip file
4916 @item skip file @r{[}@var{filename}@r{]}
4917 After running this command, any function whose source lives in @var{filename}
4918 will be skipped over when stepping.
4919
4920 If you do not specify @var{filename}, functions whose source lives in the file
4921 you're currently debugging will be skipped.
4922 @end table
4923
4924 Skips can be listed, deleted, disabled, and enabled, much like breakpoints.
4925 These are the commands for managing your list of skips:
4926
4927 @table @code
4928 @kindex info skip
4929 @item info skip @r{[}@var{range}@r{]}
4930 Print details about the specified skip(s). If @var{range} is not specified,
4931 print a table with details about all functions and files marked for skipping.
4932 @code{info skip} prints the following information about each skip:
4933
4934 @table @emph
4935 @item Identifier
4936 A number identifying this skip.
4937 @item Type
4938 The type of this skip, either @samp{function} or @samp{file}.
4939 @item Enabled or Disabled
4940 Enabled skips are marked with @samp{y}. Disabled skips are marked with @samp{n}.
4941 @item Address
4942 For function skips, this column indicates the address in memory of the function
4943 being skipped. If you've set a function skip on a function which has not yet
4944 been loaded, this field will contain @samp{<PENDING>}. Once a shared library
4945 which has the function is loaded, @code{info skip} will show the function's
4946 address here.
4947 @item What
4948 For file skips, this field contains the filename being skipped. For functions
4949 skips, this field contains the function name and its line number in the file
4950 where it is defined.
4951 @end table
4952
4953 @kindex skip delete
4954 @item skip delete @r{[}@var{range}@r{]}
4955 Delete the specified skip(s). If @var{range} is not specified, delete all
4956 skips.
4957
4958 @kindex skip enable
4959 @item skip enable @r{[}@var{range}@r{]}
4960 Enable the specified skip(s). If @var{range} is not specified, enable all
4961 skips.
4962
4963 @kindex skip disable
4964 @item skip disable @r{[}@var{range}@r{]}
4965 Disable the specified skip(s). If @var{range} is not specified, disable all
4966 skips.
4967
4968 @end table
4969
4970 @node Signals
4971 @section Signals
4972 @cindex signals
4973
4974 A signal is an asynchronous event that can happen in a program. The
4975 operating system defines the possible kinds of signals, and gives each
4976 kind a name and a number. For example, in Unix @code{SIGINT} is the
4977 signal a program gets when you type an interrupt character (often @kbd{Ctrl-c});
4978 @code{SIGSEGV} is the signal a program gets from referencing a place in
4979 memory far away from all the areas in use; @code{SIGALRM} occurs when
4980 the alarm clock timer goes off (which happens only if your program has
4981 requested an alarm).
4982
4983 @cindex fatal signals
4984 Some signals, including @code{SIGALRM}, are a normal part of the
4985 functioning of your program. Others, such as @code{SIGSEGV}, indicate
4986 errors; these signals are @dfn{fatal} (they kill your program immediately) if the
4987 program has not specified in advance some other way to handle the signal.
4988 @code{SIGINT} does not indicate an error in your program, but it is normally
4989 fatal so it can carry out the purpose of the interrupt: to kill the program.
4990
4991 @value{GDBN} has the ability to detect any occurrence of a signal in your
4992 program. You can tell @value{GDBN} in advance what to do for each kind of
4993 signal.
4994
4995 @cindex handling signals
4996 Normally, @value{GDBN} is set up to let the non-erroneous signals like
4997 @code{SIGALRM} be silently passed to your program
4998 (so as not to interfere with their role in the program's functioning)
4999 but to stop your program immediately whenever an error signal happens.
5000 You can change these settings with the @code{handle} command.
5001
5002 @table @code
5003 @kindex info signals
5004 @kindex info handle
5005 @item info signals
5006 @itemx info handle
5007 Print a table of all the kinds of signals and how @value{GDBN} has been told to
5008 handle each one. You can use this to see the signal numbers of all
5009 the defined types of signals.
5010
5011 @item info signals @var{sig}
5012 Similar, but print information only about the specified signal number.
5013
5014 @code{info handle} is an alias for @code{info signals}.
5015
5016 @kindex handle
5017 @item handle @var{signal} @r{[}@var{keywords}@dots{}@r{]}
5018 Change the way @value{GDBN} handles signal @var{signal}. @var{signal}
5019 can be the number of a signal or its name (with or without the
5020 @samp{SIG} at the beginning); a list of signal numbers of the form
5021 @samp{@var{low}-@var{high}}; or the word @samp{all}, meaning all the
5022 known signals. Optional arguments @var{keywords}, described below,
5023 say what change to make.
5024 @end table
5025
5026 @c @group
5027 The keywords allowed by the @code{handle} command can be abbreviated.
5028 Their full names are:
5029
5030 @table @code
5031 @item nostop
5032 @value{GDBN} should not stop your program when this signal happens. It may
5033 still print a message telling you that the signal has come in.
5034
5035 @item stop
5036 @value{GDBN} should stop your program when this signal happens. This implies
5037 the @code{print} keyword as well.
5038
5039 @item print
5040 @value{GDBN} should print a message when this signal happens.
5041
5042 @item noprint
5043 @value{GDBN} should not mention the occurrence of the signal at all. This
5044 implies the @code{nostop} keyword as well.
5045
5046 @item pass
5047 @itemx noignore
5048 @value{GDBN} should allow your program to see this signal; your program
5049 can handle the signal, or else it may terminate if the signal is fatal
5050 and not handled. @code{pass} and @code{noignore} are synonyms.
5051
5052 @item nopass
5053 @itemx ignore
5054 @value{GDBN} should not allow your program to see this signal.
5055 @code{nopass} and @code{ignore} are synonyms.
5056 @end table
5057 @c @end group
5058
5059 When a signal stops your program, the signal is not visible to the
5060 program until you
5061 continue. Your program sees the signal then, if @code{pass} is in
5062 effect for the signal in question @emph{at that time}. In other words,
5063 after @value{GDBN} reports a signal, you can use the @code{handle}
5064 command with @code{pass} or @code{nopass} to control whether your
5065 program sees that signal when you continue.
5066
5067 The default is set to @code{nostop}, @code{noprint}, @code{pass} for
5068 non-erroneous signals such as @code{SIGALRM}, @code{SIGWINCH} and
5069 @code{SIGCHLD}, and to @code{stop}, @code{print}, @code{pass} for the
5070 erroneous signals.
5071
5072 You can also use the @code{signal} command to prevent your program from
5073 seeing a signal, or cause it to see a signal it normally would not see,
5074 or to give it any signal at any time. For example, if your program stopped
5075 due to some sort of memory reference error, you might store correct
5076 values into the erroneous variables and continue, hoping to see more
5077 execution; but your program would probably terminate immediately as
5078 a result of the fatal signal once it saw the signal. To prevent this,
5079 you can continue with @samp{signal 0}. @xref{Signaling, ,Giving your
5080 Program a Signal}.
5081
5082 @cindex extra signal information
5083 @anchor{extra signal information}
5084
5085 On some targets, @value{GDBN} can inspect extra signal information
5086 associated with the intercepted signal, before it is actually
5087 delivered to the program being debugged. This information is exported
5088 by the convenience variable @code{$_siginfo}, and consists of data
5089 that is passed by the kernel to the signal handler at the time of the
5090 receipt of a signal. The data type of the information itself is
5091 target dependent. You can see the data type using the @code{ptype
5092 $_siginfo} command. On Unix systems, it typically corresponds to the
5093 standard @code{siginfo_t} type, as defined in the @file{signal.h}
5094 system header.
5095
5096 Here's an example, on a @sc{gnu}/Linux system, printing the stray
5097 referenced address that raised a segmentation fault.
5098
5099 @smallexample
5100 @group
5101 (@value{GDBP}) continue
5102 Program received signal SIGSEGV, Segmentation fault.
5103 0x0000000000400766 in main ()
5104 69 *(int *)p = 0;
5105 (@value{GDBP}) ptype $_siginfo
5106 type = struct @{
5107 int si_signo;
5108 int si_errno;
5109 int si_code;
5110 union @{
5111 int _pad[28];
5112 struct @{...@} _kill;
5113 struct @{...@} _timer;
5114 struct @{...@} _rt;
5115 struct @{...@} _sigchld;
5116 struct @{...@} _sigfault;
5117 struct @{...@} _sigpoll;
5118 @} _sifields;
5119 @}
5120 (@value{GDBP}) ptype $_siginfo._sifields._sigfault
5121 type = struct @{
5122 void *si_addr;
5123 @}
5124 (@value{GDBP}) p $_siginfo._sifields._sigfault.si_addr
5125 $1 = (void *) 0x7ffff7ff7000
5126 @end group
5127 @end smallexample
5128
5129 Depending on target support, @code{$_siginfo} may also be writable.
5130
5131 @node Thread Stops
5132 @section Stopping and Starting Multi-thread Programs
5133
5134 @cindex stopped threads
5135 @cindex threads, stopped
5136
5137 @cindex continuing threads
5138 @cindex threads, continuing
5139
5140 @value{GDBN} supports debugging programs with multiple threads
5141 (@pxref{Threads,, Debugging Programs with Multiple Threads}). There
5142 are two modes of controlling execution of your program within the
5143 debugger. In the default mode, referred to as @dfn{all-stop mode},
5144 when any thread in your program stops (for example, at a breakpoint
5145 or while being stepped), all other threads in the program are also stopped by
5146 @value{GDBN}. On some targets, @value{GDBN} also supports
5147 @dfn{non-stop mode}, in which other threads can continue to run freely while
5148 you examine the stopped thread in the debugger.
5149
5150 @menu
5151 * All-Stop Mode:: All threads stop when GDB takes control
5152 * Non-Stop Mode:: Other threads continue to execute
5153 * Background Execution:: Running your program asynchronously
5154 * Thread-Specific Breakpoints:: Controlling breakpoints
5155 * Interrupted System Calls:: GDB may interfere with system calls
5156 * Observer Mode:: GDB does not alter program behavior
5157 @end menu
5158
5159 @node All-Stop Mode
5160 @subsection All-Stop Mode
5161
5162 @cindex all-stop mode
5163
5164 In all-stop mode, whenever your program stops under @value{GDBN} for any reason,
5165 @emph{all} threads of execution stop, not just the current thread. This
5166 allows you to examine the overall state of the program, including
5167 switching between threads, without worrying that things may change
5168 underfoot.
5169
5170 Conversely, whenever you restart the program, @emph{all} threads start
5171 executing. @emph{This is true even when single-stepping} with commands
5172 like @code{step} or @code{next}.
5173
5174 In particular, @value{GDBN} cannot single-step all threads in lockstep.
5175 Since thread scheduling is up to your debugging target's operating
5176 system (not controlled by @value{GDBN}), other threads may
5177 execute more than one statement while the current thread completes a
5178 single step. Moreover, in general other threads stop in the middle of a
5179 statement, rather than at a clean statement boundary, when the program
5180 stops.
5181
5182 You might even find your program stopped in another thread after
5183 continuing or even single-stepping. This happens whenever some other
5184 thread runs into a breakpoint, a signal, or an exception before the
5185 first thread completes whatever you requested.
5186
5187 @cindex automatic thread selection
5188 @cindex switching threads automatically
5189 @cindex threads, automatic switching
5190 Whenever @value{GDBN} stops your program, due to a breakpoint or a
5191 signal, it automatically selects the thread where that breakpoint or
5192 signal happened. @value{GDBN} alerts you to the context switch with a
5193 message such as @samp{[Switching to Thread @var{n}]} to identify the
5194 thread.
5195
5196 On some OSes, you can modify @value{GDBN}'s default behavior by
5197 locking the OS scheduler to allow only a single thread to run.
5198
5199 @table @code
5200 @item set scheduler-locking @var{mode}
5201 @cindex scheduler locking mode
5202 @cindex lock scheduler
5203 Set the scheduler locking mode. If it is @code{off}, then there is no
5204 locking and any thread may run at any time. If @code{on}, then only the
5205 current thread may run when the inferior is resumed. The @code{step}
5206 mode optimizes for single-stepping; it prevents other threads
5207 from preempting the current thread while you are stepping, so that
5208 the focus of debugging does not change unexpectedly.
5209 Other threads only rarely (or never) get a chance to run
5210 when you step. They are more likely to run when you @samp{next} over a
5211 function call, and they are completely free to run when you use commands
5212 like @samp{continue}, @samp{until}, or @samp{finish}. However, unless another
5213 thread hits a breakpoint during its timeslice, @value{GDBN} does not change
5214 the current thread away from the thread that you are debugging.
5215
5216 @item show scheduler-locking
5217 Display the current scheduler locking mode.
5218 @end table
5219
5220 @cindex resume threads of multiple processes simultaneously
5221 By default, when you issue one of the execution commands such as
5222 @code{continue}, @code{next} or @code{step}, @value{GDBN} allows only
5223 threads of the current inferior to run. For example, if @value{GDBN}
5224 is attached to two inferiors, each with two threads, the
5225 @code{continue} command resumes only the two threads of the current
5226 inferior. This is useful, for example, when you debug a program that
5227 forks and you want to hold the parent stopped (so that, for instance,
5228 it doesn't run to exit), while you debug the child. In other
5229 situations, you may not be interested in inspecting the current state
5230 of any of the processes @value{GDBN} is attached to, and you may want
5231 to resume them all until some breakpoint is hit. In the latter case,
5232 you can instruct @value{GDBN} to allow all threads of all the
5233 inferiors to run with the @w{@code{set schedule-multiple}} command.
5234
5235 @table @code
5236 @kindex set schedule-multiple
5237 @item set schedule-multiple
5238 Set the mode for allowing threads of multiple processes to be resumed
5239 when an execution command is issued. When @code{on}, all threads of
5240 all processes are allowed to run. When @code{off}, only the threads
5241 of the current process are resumed. The default is @code{off}. The
5242 @code{scheduler-locking} mode takes precedence when set to @code{on},
5243 or while you are stepping and set to @code{step}.
5244
5245 @item show schedule-multiple
5246 Display the current mode for resuming the execution of threads of
5247 multiple processes.
5248 @end table
5249
5250 @node Non-Stop Mode
5251 @subsection Non-Stop Mode
5252
5253 @cindex non-stop mode
5254
5255 @c This section is really only a place-holder, and needs to be expanded
5256 @c with more details.
5257
5258 For some multi-threaded targets, @value{GDBN} supports an optional
5259 mode of operation in which you can examine stopped program threads in
5260 the debugger while other threads continue to execute freely. This
5261 minimizes intrusion when debugging live systems, such as programs
5262 where some threads have real-time constraints or must continue to
5263 respond to external events. This is referred to as @dfn{non-stop} mode.
5264
5265 In non-stop mode, when a thread stops to report a debugging event,
5266 @emph{only} that thread is stopped; @value{GDBN} does not stop other
5267 threads as well, in contrast to the all-stop mode behavior. Additionally,
5268 execution commands such as @code{continue} and @code{step} apply by default
5269 only to the current thread in non-stop mode, rather than all threads as
5270 in all-stop mode. This allows you to control threads explicitly in
5271 ways that are not possible in all-stop mode --- for example, stepping
5272 one thread while allowing others to run freely, stepping
5273 one thread while holding all others stopped, or stepping several threads
5274 independently and simultaneously.
5275
5276 To enter non-stop mode, use this sequence of commands before you run
5277 or attach to your program:
5278
5279 @smallexample
5280 # Enable the async interface.
5281 set target-async 1
5282
5283 # If using the CLI, pagination breaks non-stop.
5284 set pagination off
5285
5286 # Finally, turn it on!
5287 set non-stop on
5288 @end smallexample
5289
5290 You can use these commands to manipulate the non-stop mode setting:
5291
5292 @table @code
5293 @kindex set non-stop
5294 @item set non-stop on
5295 Enable selection of non-stop mode.
5296 @item set non-stop off
5297 Disable selection of non-stop mode.
5298 @kindex show non-stop
5299 @item show non-stop
5300 Show the current non-stop enablement setting.
5301 @end table
5302
5303 Note these commands only reflect whether non-stop mode is enabled,
5304 not whether the currently-executing program is being run in non-stop mode.
5305 In particular, the @code{set non-stop} preference is only consulted when
5306 @value{GDBN} starts or connects to the target program, and it is generally
5307 not possible to switch modes once debugging has started. Furthermore,
5308 since not all targets support non-stop mode, even when you have enabled
5309 non-stop mode, @value{GDBN} may still fall back to all-stop operation by
5310 default.
5311
5312 In non-stop mode, all execution commands apply only to the current thread
5313 by default. That is, @code{continue} only continues one thread.
5314 To continue all threads, issue @code{continue -a} or @code{c -a}.
5315
5316 You can use @value{GDBN}'s background execution commands
5317 (@pxref{Background Execution}) to run some threads in the background
5318 while you continue to examine or step others from @value{GDBN}.
5319 The MI execution commands (@pxref{GDB/MI Program Execution}) are
5320 always executed asynchronously in non-stop mode.
5321
5322 Suspending execution is done with the @code{interrupt} command when
5323 running in the background, or @kbd{Ctrl-c} during foreground execution.
5324 In all-stop mode, this stops the whole process;
5325 but in non-stop mode the interrupt applies only to the current thread.
5326 To stop the whole program, use @code{interrupt -a}.
5327
5328 Other execution commands do not currently support the @code{-a} option.
5329
5330 In non-stop mode, when a thread stops, @value{GDBN} doesn't automatically make
5331 that thread current, as it does in all-stop mode. This is because the
5332 thread stop notifications are asynchronous with respect to @value{GDBN}'s
5333 command interpreter, and it would be confusing if @value{GDBN} unexpectedly
5334 changed to a different thread just as you entered a command to operate on the
5335 previously current thread.
5336
5337 @node Background Execution
5338 @subsection Background Execution
5339
5340 @cindex foreground execution
5341 @cindex background execution
5342 @cindex asynchronous execution
5343 @cindex execution, foreground, background and asynchronous
5344
5345 @value{GDBN}'s execution commands have two variants: the normal
5346 foreground (synchronous) behavior, and a background
5347 (asynchronous) behavior. In foreground execution, @value{GDBN} waits for
5348 the program to report that some thread has stopped before prompting for
5349 another command. In background execution, @value{GDBN} immediately gives
5350 a command prompt so that you can issue other commands while your program runs.
5351
5352 You need to explicitly enable asynchronous mode before you can use
5353 background execution commands. You can use these commands to
5354 manipulate the asynchronous mode setting:
5355
5356 @table @code
5357 @kindex set target-async
5358 @item set target-async on
5359 Enable asynchronous mode.
5360 @item set target-async off
5361 Disable asynchronous mode.
5362 @kindex show target-async
5363 @item show target-async
5364 Show the current target-async setting.
5365 @end table
5366
5367 If the target doesn't support async mode, @value{GDBN} issues an error
5368 message if you attempt to use the background execution commands.
5369
5370 To specify background execution, add a @code{&} to the command. For example,
5371 the background form of the @code{continue} command is @code{continue&}, or
5372 just @code{c&}. The execution commands that accept background execution
5373 are:
5374
5375 @table @code
5376 @kindex run&
5377 @item run
5378 @xref{Starting, , Starting your Program}.
5379
5380 @item attach
5381 @kindex attach&
5382 @xref{Attach, , Debugging an Already-running Process}.
5383
5384 @item step
5385 @kindex step&
5386 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, step}.
5387
5388 @item stepi
5389 @kindex stepi&
5390 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, stepi}.
5391
5392 @item next
5393 @kindex next&
5394 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, next}.
5395
5396 @item nexti
5397 @kindex nexti&
5398 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, nexti}.
5399
5400 @item continue
5401 @kindex continue&
5402 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, continue}.
5403
5404 @item finish
5405 @kindex finish&
5406 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, finish}.
5407
5408 @item until
5409 @kindex until&
5410 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, until}.
5411
5412 @end table
5413
5414 Background execution is especially useful in conjunction with non-stop
5415 mode for debugging programs with multiple threads; see @ref{Non-Stop Mode}.
5416 However, you can also use these commands in the normal all-stop mode with
5417 the restriction that you cannot issue another execution command until the
5418 previous one finishes. Examples of commands that are valid in all-stop
5419 mode while the program is running include @code{help} and @code{info break}.
5420
5421 You can interrupt your program while it is running in the background by
5422 using the @code{interrupt} command.
5423
5424 @table @code
5425 @kindex interrupt
5426 @item interrupt
5427 @itemx interrupt -a
5428
5429 Suspend execution of the running program. In all-stop mode,
5430 @code{interrupt} stops the whole process, but in non-stop mode, it stops
5431 only the current thread. To stop the whole program in non-stop mode,
5432 use @code{interrupt -a}.
5433 @end table
5434
5435 @node Thread-Specific Breakpoints
5436 @subsection Thread-Specific Breakpoints
5437
5438 When your program has multiple threads (@pxref{Threads,, Debugging
5439 Programs with Multiple Threads}), you can choose whether to set
5440 breakpoints on all threads, or on a particular thread.
5441
5442 @table @code
5443 @cindex breakpoints and threads
5444 @cindex thread breakpoints
5445 @kindex break @dots{} thread @var{threadno}
5446 @item break @var{linespec} thread @var{threadno}
5447 @itemx break @var{linespec} thread @var{threadno} if @dots{}
5448 @var{linespec} specifies source lines; there are several ways of
5449 writing them (@pxref{Specify Location}), but the effect is always to
5450 specify some source line.
5451
5452 Use the qualifier @samp{thread @var{threadno}} with a breakpoint command
5453 to specify that you only want @value{GDBN} to stop the program when a
5454 particular thread reaches this breakpoint. @var{threadno} is one of the
5455 numeric thread identifiers assigned by @value{GDBN}, shown in the first
5456 column of the @samp{info threads} display.
5457
5458 If you do not specify @samp{thread @var{threadno}} when you set a
5459 breakpoint, the breakpoint applies to @emph{all} threads of your
5460 program.
5461
5462 You can use the @code{thread} qualifier on conditional breakpoints as
5463 well; in this case, place @samp{thread @var{threadno}} before or
5464 after the breakpoint condition, like this:
5465
5466 @smallexample
5467 (@value{GDBP}) break frik.c:13 thread 28 if bartab > lim
5468 @end smallexample
5469
5470 @end table
5471
5472 @node Interrupted System Calls
5473 @subsection Interrupted System Calls
5474
5475 @cindex thread breakpoints and system calls
5476 @cindex system calls and thread breakpoints
5477 @cindex premature return from system calls
5478 There is an unfortunate side effect when using @value{GDBN} to debug
5479 multi-threaded programs. If one thread stops for a
5480 breakpoint, or for some other reason, and another thread is blocked in a
5481 system call, then the system call may return prematurely. This is a
5482 consequence of the interaction between multiple threads and the signals
5483 that @value{GDBN} uses to implement breakpoints and other events that
5484 stop execution.
5485
5486 To handle this problem, your program should check the return value of
5487 each system call and react appropriately. This is good programming
5488 style anyways.
5489
5490 For example, do not write code like this:
5491
5492 @smallexample
5493 sleep (10);
5494 @end smallexample
5495
5496 The call to @code{sleep} will return early if a different thread stops
5497 at a breakpoint or for some other reason.
5498
5499 Instead, write this:
5500
5501 @smallexample
5502 int unslept = 10;
5503 while (unslept > 0)
5504 unslept = sleep (unslept);
5505 @end smallexample
5506
5507 A system call is allowed to return early, so the system is still
5508 conforming to its specification. But @value{GDBN} does cause your
5509 multi-threaded program to behave differently than it would without
5510 @value{GDBN}.
5511
5512 Also, @value{GDBN} uses internal breakpoints in the thread library to
5513 monitor certain events such as thread creation and thread destruction.
5514 When such an event happens, a system call in another thread may return
5515 prematurely, even though your program does not appear to stop.
5516
5517 @node Observer Mode
5518 @subsection Observer Mode
5519
5520 If you want to build on non-stop mode and observe program behavior
5521 without any chance of disruption by @value{GDBN}, you can set
5522 variables to disable all of the debugger's attempts to modify state,
5523 whether by writing memory, inserting breakpoints, etc. These operate
5524 at a low level, intercepting operations from all commands.
5525
5526 When all of these are set to @code{off}, then @value{GDBN} is said to
5527 be @dfn{observer mode}. As a convenience, the variable
5528 @code{observer} can be set to disable these, plus enable non-stop
5529 mode.
5530
5531 Note that @value{GDBN} will not prevent you from making nonsensical
5532 combinations of these settings. For instance, if you have enabled
5533 @code{may-insert-breakpoints} but disabled @code{may-write-memory},
5534 then breakpoints that work by writing trap instructions into the code
5535 stream will still not be able to be placed.
5536
5537 @table @code
5538
5539 @kindex observer
5540 @item set observer on
5541 @itemx set observer off
5542 When set to @code{on}, this disables all the permission variables
5543 below (except for @code{insert-fast-tracepoints}), plus enables
5544 non-stop debugging. Setting this to @code{off} switches back to
5545 normal debugging, though remaining in non-stop mode.
5546
5547 @item show observer
5548 Show whether observer mode is on or off.
5549
5550 @kindex may-write-registers
5551 @item set may-write-registers on
5552 @itemx set may-write-registers off
5553 This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to alter the values of
5554 registers, such as with assignment expressions in @code{print}, or the
5555 @code{jump} command. It defaults to @code{on}.
5556
5557 @item show may-write-registers
5558 Show the current permission to write registers.
5559
5560 @kindex may-write-memory
5561 @item set may-write-memory on
5562 @itemx set may-write-memory off
5563 This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to alter the contents
5564 of memory, such as with assignment expressions in @code{print}. It
5565 defaults to @code{on}.
5566
5567 @item show may-write-memory
5568 Show the current permission to write memory.
5569
5570 @kindex may-insert-breakpoints
5571 @item set may-insert-breakpoints on
5572 @itemx set may-insert-breakpoints off
5573 This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to insert breakpoints.
5574 This affects all breakpoints, including internal breakpoints defined
5575 by @value{GDBN}. It defaults to @code{on}.
5576
5577 @item show may-insert-breakpoints
5578 Show the current permission to insert breakpoints.
5579
5580 @kindex may-insert-tracepoints
5581 @item set may-insert-tracepoints on
5582 @itemx set may-insert-tracepoints off
5583 This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to insert (regular)
5584 tracepoints at the beginning of a tracing experiment. It affects only
5585 non-fast tracepoints, fast tracepoints being under the control of
5586 @code{may-insert-fast-tracepoints}. It defaults to @code{on}.
5587
5588 @item show may-insert-tracepoints
5589 Show the current permission to insert tracepoints.
5590
5591 @kindex may-insert-fast-tracepoints
5592 @item set may-insert-fast-tracepoints on
5593 @itemx set may-insert-fast-tracepoints off
5594 This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to insert fast
5595 tracepoints at the beginning of a tracing experiment. It affects only
5596 fast tracepoints, regular (non-fast) tracepoints being under the
5597 control of @code{may-insert-tracepoints}. It defaults to @code{on}.
5598
5599 @item show may-insert-fast-tracepoints
5600 Show the current permission to insert fast tracepoints.
5601
5602 @kindex may-interrupt
5603 @item set may-interrupt on
5604 @itemx set may-interrupt off
5605 This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to interrupt or stop
5606 program execution. When this variable is @code{off}, the
5607 @code{interrupt} command will have no effect, nor will
5608 @kbd{Ctrl-c}. It defaults to @code{on}.
5609
5610 @item show may-interrupt
5611 Show the current permission to interrupt or stop the program.
5612
5613 @end table
5614
5615 @node Reverse Execution
5616 @chapter Running programs backward
5617 @cindex reverse execution
5618 @cindex running programs backward
5619
5620 When you are debugging a program, it is not unusual to realize that
5621 you have gone too far, and some event of interest has already happened.
5622 If the target environment supports it, @value{GDBN} can allow you to
5623 ``rewind'' the program by running it backward.
5624
5625 A target environment that supports reverse execution should be able
5626 to ``undo'' the changes in machine state that have taken place as the
5627 program was executing normally. Variables, registers etc.@: should
5628 revert to their previous values. Obviously this requires a great
5629 deal of sophistication on the part of the target environment; not
5630 all target environments can support reverse execution.
5631
5632 When a program is executed in reverse, the instructions that
5633 have most recently been executed are ``un-executed'', in reverse
5634 order. The program counter runs backward, following the previous
5635 thread of execution in reverse. As each instruction is ``un-executed'',
5636 the values of memory and/or registers that were changed by that
5637 instruction are reverted to their previous states. After executing
5638 a piece of source code in reverse, all side effects of that code
5639 should be ``undone'', and all variables should be returned to their
5640 prior values@footnote{
5641 Note that some side effects are easier to undo than others. For instance,
5642 memory and registers are relatively easy, but device I/O is hard. Some
5643 targets may be able undo things like device I/O, and some may not.
5644
5645 The contract between @value{GDBN} and the reverse executing target
5646 requires only that the target do something reasonable when
5647 @value{GDBN} tells it to execute backwards, and then report the
5648 results back to @value{GDBN}. Whatever the target reports back to
5649 @value{GDBN}, @value{GDBN} will report back to the user. @value{GDBN}
5650 assumes that the memory and registers that the target reports are in a
5651 consistant state, but @value{GDBN} accepts whatever it is given.
5652 }.
5653
5654 If you are debugging in a target environment that supports
5655 reverse execution, @value{GDBN} provides the following commands.
5656
5657 @table @code
5658 @kindex reverse-continue
5659 @kindex rc @r{(@code{reverse-continue})}
5660 @item reverse-continue @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
5661 @itemx rc @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
5662 Beginning at the point where your program last stopped, start executing
5663 in reverse. Reverse execution will stop for breakpoints and synchronous
5664 exceptions (signals), just like normal execution. Behavior of
5665 asynchronous signals depends on the target environment.
5666
5667 @kindex reverse-step
5668 @kindex rs @r{(@code{step})}
5669 @item reverse-step @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
5670 Run the program backward until control reaches the start of a
5671 different source line; then stop it, and return control to @value{GDBN}.
5672
5673 Like the @code{step} command, @code{reverse-step} will only stop
5674 at the beginning of a source line. It ``un-executes'' the previously
5675 executed source line. If the previous source line included calls to
5676 debuggable functions, @code{reverse-step} will step (backward) into
5677 the called function, stopping at the beginning of the @emph{last}
5678 statement in the called function (typically a return statement).
5679
5680 Also, as with the @code{step} command, if non-debuggable functions are
5681 called, @code{reverse-step} will run thru them backward without stopping.
5682
5683 @kindex reverse-stepi
5684 @kindex rsi @r{(@code{reverse-stepi})}
5685 @item reverse-stepi @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
5686 Reverse-execute one machine instruction. Note that the instruction
5687 to be reverse-executed is @emph{not} the one pointed to by the program
5688 counter, but the instruction executed prior to that one. For instance,
5689 if the last instruction was a jump, @code{reverse-stepi} will take you
5690 back from the destination of the jump to the jump instruction itself.
5691
5692 @kindex reverse-next
5693 @kindex rn @r{(@code{reverse-next})}
5694 @item reverse-next @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
5695 Run backward to the beginning of the previous line executed in
5696 the current (innermost) stack frame. If the line contains function
5697 calls, they will be ``un-executed'' without stopping. Starting from
5698 the first line of a function, @code{reverse-next} will take you back
5699 to the caller of that function, @emph{before} the function was called,
5700 just as the normal @code{next} command would take you from the last
5701 line of a function back to its return to its caller
5702 @footnote{Unless the code is too heavily optimized.}.
5703
5704 @kindex reverse-nexti
5705 @kindex rni @r{(@code{reverse-nexti})}
5706 @item reverse-nexti @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
5707 Like @code{nexti}, @code{reverse-nexti} executes a single instruction
5708 in reverse, except that called functions are ``un-executed'' atomically.
5709 That is, if the previously executed instruction was a return from
5710 another function, @code{reverse-nexti} will continue to execute
5711 in reverse until the call to that function (from the current stack
5712 frame) is reached.
5713
5714 @kindex reverse-finish
5715 @item reverse-finish
5716 Just as the @code{finish} command takes you to the point where the
5717 current function returns, @code{reverse-finish} takes you to the point
5718 where it was called. Instead of ending up at the end of the current
5719 function invocation, you end up at the beginning.
5720
5721 @kindex set exec-direction
5722 @item set exec-direction
5723 Set the direction of target execution.
5724 @itemx set exec-direction reverse
5725 @cindex execute forward or backward in time
5726 @value{GDBN} will perform all execution commands in reverse, until the
5727 exec-direction mode is changed to ``forward''. Affected commands include
5728 @code{step, stepi, next, nexti, continue, and finish}. The @code{return}
5729 command cannot be used in reverse mode.
5730 @item set exec-direction forward
5731 @value{GDBN} will perform all execution commands in the normal fashion.
5732 This is the default.
5733 @end table
5734
5735
5736 @node Process Record and Replay
5737 @chapter Recording Inferior's Execution and Replaying It
5738 @cindex process record and replay
5739 @cindex recording inferior's execution and replaying it
5740
5741 On some platforms, @value{GDBN} provides a special @dfn{process record
5742 and replay} target that can record a log of the process execution, and
5743 replay it later with both forward and reverse execution commands.
5744
5745 @cindex replay mode
5746 When this target is in use, if the execution log includes the record
5747 for the next instruction, @value{GDBN} will debug in @dfn{replay
5748 mode}. In the replay mode, the inferior does not really execute code
5749 instructions. Instead, all the events that normally happen during
5750 code execution are taken from the execution log. While code is not
5751 really executed in replay mode, the values of registers (including the
5752 program counter register) and the memory of the inferior are still
5753 changed as they normally would. Their contents are taken from the
5754 execution log.
5755
5756 @cindex record mode
5757 If the record for the next instruction is not in the execution log,
5758 @value{GDBN} will debug in @dfn{record mode}. In this mode, the
5759 inferior executes normally, and @value{GDBN} records the execution log
5760 for future replay.
5761
5762 The process record and replay target supports reverse execution
5763 (@pxref{Reverse Execution}), even if the platform on which the
5764 inferior runs does not. However, the reverse execution is limited in
5765 this case by the range of the instructions recorded in the execution
5766 log. In other words, reverse execution on platforms that don't
5767 support it directly can only be done in the replay mode.
5768
5769 When debugging in the reverse direction, @value{GDBN} will work in
5770 replay mode as long as the execution log includes the record for the
5771 previous instruction; otherwise, it will work in record mode, if the
5772 platform supports reverse execution, or stop if not.
5773
5774 For architecture environments that support process record and replay,
5775 @value{GDBN} provides the following commands:
5776
5777 @table @code
5778 @kindex target record
5779 @kindex record
5780 @kindex rec
5781 @item target record
5782 This command starts the process record and replay target. The process
5783 record and replay target can only debug a process that is already
5784 running. Therefore, you need first to start the process with the
5785 @kbd{run} or @kbd{start} commands, and then start the recording with
5786 the @kbd{target record} command.
5787
5788 Both @code{record} and @code{rec} are aliases of @code{target record}.
5789
5790 @cindex displaced stepping, and process record and replay
5791 Displaced stepping (@pxref{Maintenance Commands,, displaced stepping})
5792 will be automatically disabled when process record and replay target
5793 is started. That's because the process record and replay target
5794 doesn't support displaced stepping.
5795
5796 @cindex non-stop mode, and process record and replay
5797 @cindex asynchronous execution, and process record and replay
5798 If the inferior is in the non-stop mode (@pxref{Non-Stop Mode}) or in
5799 the asynchronous execution mode (@pxref{Background Execution}), the
5800 process record and replay target cannot be started because it doesn't
5801 support these two modes.
5802
5803 @kindex record stop
5804 @kindex rec s
5805 @item record stop
5806 Stop the process record and replay target. When process record and
5807 replay target stops, the entire execution log will be deleted and the
5808 inferior will either be terminated, or will remain in its final state.
5809
5810 When you stop the process record and replay target in record mode (at
5811 the end of the execution log), the inferior will be stopped at the
5812 next instruction that would have been recorded. In other words, if
5813 you record for a while and then stop recording, the inferior process
5814 will be left in the same state as if the recording never happened.
5815
5816 On the other hand, if the process record and replay target is stopped
5817 while in replay mode (that is, not at the end of the execution log,
5818 but at some earlier point), the inferior process will become ``live''
5819 at that earlier state, and it will then be possible to continue the
5820 usual ``live'' debugging of the process from that state.
5821
5822 When the inferior process exits, or @value{GDBN} detaches from it,
5823 process record and replay target will automatically stop itself.
5824
5825 @kindex record save
5826 @item record save @var{filename}
5827 Save the execution log to a file @file{@var{filename}}.
5828 Default filename is @file{gdb_record.@var{process_id}}, where
5829 @var{process_id} is the process ID of the inferior.
5830
5831 @kindex record restore
5832 @item record restore @var{filename}
5833 Restore the execution log from a file @file{@var{filename}}.
5834 File must have been created with @code{record save}.
5835
5836 @kindex set record insn-number-max
5837 @item set record insn-number-max @var{limit}
5838 Set the limit of instructions to be recorded. Default value is 200000.
5839
5840 If @var{limit} is a positive number, then @value{GDBN} will start
5841 deleting instructions from the log once the number of the record
5842 instructions becomes greater than @var{limit}. For every new recorded
5843 instruction, @value{GDBN} will delete the earliest recorded
5844 instruction to keep the number of recorded instructions at the limit.
5845 (Since deleting recorded instructions loses information, @value{GDBN}
5846 lets you control what happens when the limit is reached, by means of
5847 the @code{stop-at-limit} option, described below.)
5848
5849 If @var{limit} is zero, @value{GDBN} will never delete recorded
5850 instructions from the execution log. The number of recorded
5851 instructions is unlimited in this case.
5852
5853 @kindex show record insn-number-max
5854 @item show record insn-number-max
5855 Show the limit of instructions to be recorded.
5856
5857 @kindex set record stop-at-limit
5858 @item set record stop-at-limit
5859 Control the behavior when the number of recorded instructions reaches
5860 the limit. If ON (the default), @value{GDBN} will stop when the limit
5861 is reached for the first time and ask you whether you want to stop the
5862 inferior or continue running it and recording the execution log. If
5863 you decide to continue recording, each new recorded instruction will
5864 cause the oldest one to be deleted.
5865
5866 If this option is OFF, @value{GDBN} will automatically delete the
5867 oldest record to make room for each new one, without asking.
5868
5869 @kindex show record stop-at-limit
5870 @item show record stop-at-limit
5871 Show the current setting of @code{stop-at-limit}.
5872
5873 @kindex set record memory-query
5874 @item set record memory-query
5875 Control the behavior when @value{GDBN} is unable to record memory
5876 changes caused by an instruction. If ON, @value{GDBN} will query
5877 whether to stop the inferior in that case.
5878
5879 If this option is OFF (the default), @value{GDBN} will automatically
5880 ignore the effect of such instructions on memory. Later, when
5881 @value{GDBN} replays this execution log, it will mark the log of this
5882 instruction as not accessible, and it will not affect the replay
5883 results.
5884
5885 @kindex show record memory-query
5886 @item show record memory-query
5887 Show the current setting of @code{memory-query}.
5888
5889 @kindex info record
5890 @item info record
5891 Show various statistics about the state of process record and its
5892 in-memory execution log buffer, including:
5893
5894 @itemize @bullet
5895 @item
5896 Whether in record mode or replay mode.
5897 @item
5898 Lowest recorded instruction number (counting from when the current execution log started recording instructions).
5899 @item
5900 Highest recorded instruction number.
5901 @item
5902 Current instruction about to be replayed (if in replay mode).
5903 @item
5904 Number of instructions contained in the execution log.
5905 @item
5906 Maximum number of instructions that may be contained in the execution log.
5907 @end itemize
5908
5909 @kindex record delete
5910 @kindex rec del
5911 @item record delete
5912 When record target runs in replay mode (``in the past''), delete the
5913 subsequent execution log and begin to record a new execution log starting
5914 from the current address. This means you will abandon the previously
5915 recorded ``future'' and begin recording a new ``future''.
5916 @end table
5917
5918
5919 @node Stack
5920 @chapter Examining the Stack
5921
5922 When your program has stopped, the first thing you need to know is where it
5923 stopped and how it got there.
5924
5925 @cindex call stack
5926 Each time your program performs a function call, information about the call
5927 is generated.
5928 That information includes the location of the call in your program,
5929 the arguments of the call,
5930 and the local variables of the function being called.
5931 The information is saved in a block of data called a @dfn{stack frame}.
5932 The stack frames are allocated in a region of memory called the @dfn{call
5933 stack}.
5934
5935 When your program stops, the @value{GDBN} commands for examining the
5936 stack allow you to see all of this information.
5937
5938 @cindex selected frame
5939 One of the stack frames is @dfn{selected} by @value{GDBN} and many
5940 @value{GDBN} commands refer implicitly to the selected frame. In
5941 particular, whenever you ask @value{GDBN} for the value of a variable in
5942 your program, the value is found in the selected frame. There are
5943 special @value{GDBN} commands to select whichever frame you are
5944 interested in. @xref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}.
5945
5946 When your program stops, @value{GDBN} automatically selects the
5947 currently executing frame and describes it briefly, similar to the
5948 @code{frame} command (@pxref{Frame Info, ,Information about a Frame}).
5949
5950 @menu
5951 * Frames:: Stack frames
5952 * Backtrace:: Backtraces
5953 * Selection:: Selecting a frame
5954 * Frame Info:: Information on a frame
5955
5956 @end menu
5957
5958 @node Frames
5959 @section Stack Frames
5960
5961 @cindex frame, definition
5962 @cindex stack frame
5963 The call stack is divided up into contiguous pieces called @dfn{stack
5964 frames}, or @dfn{frames} for short; each frame is the data associated
5965 with one call to one function. The frame contains the arguments given
5966 to the function, the function's local variables, and the address at
5967 which the function is executing.
5968
5969 @cindex initial frame
5970 @cindex outermost frame
5971 @cindex innermost frame
5972 When your program is started, the stack has only one frame, that of the
5973 function @code{main}. This is called the @dfn{initial} frame or the
5974 @dfn{outermost} frame. Each time a function is called, a new frame is
5975 made. Each time a function returns, the frame for that function invocation
5976 is eliminated. If a function is recursive, there can be many frames for
5977 the same function. The frame for the function in which execution is
5978 actually occurring is called the @dfn{innermost} frame. This is the most
5979 recently created of all the stack frames that still exist.
5980
5981 @cindex frame pointer
5982 Inside your program, stack frames are identified by their addresses. A
5983 stack frame consists of many bytes, each of which has its own address; each
5984 kind of computer has a convention for choosing one byte whose
5985 address serves as the address of the frame. Usually this address is kept
5986 in a register called the @dfn{frame pointer register}
5987 (@pxref{Registers, $fp}) while execution is going on in that frame.
5988
5989 @cindex frame number
5990 @value{GDBN} assigns numbers to all existing stack frames, starting with
5991 zero for the innermost frame, one for the frame that called it,
5992 and so on upward. These numbers do not really exist in your program;
5993 they are assigned by @value{GDBN} to give you a way of designating stack
5994 frames in @value{GDBN} commands.
5995
5996 @c The -fomit-frame-pointer below perennially causes hbox overflow
5997 @c underflow problems.
5998 @cindex frameless execution
5999 Some compilers provide a way to compile functions so that they operate
6000 without stack frames. (For example, the @value{NGCC} option
6001 @smallexample
6002 @samp{-fomit-frame-pointer}
6003 @end smallexample
6004 generates functions without a frame.)
6005 This is occasionally done with heavily used library functions to save
6006 the frame setup time. @value{GDBN} has limited facilities for dealing
6007 with these function invocations. If the innermost function invocation
6008 has no stack frame, @value{GDBN} nevertheless regards it as though
6009 it had a separate frame, which is numbered zero as usual, allowing
6010 correct tracing of the function call chain. However, @value{GDBN} has
6011 no provision for frameless functions elsewhere in the stack.
6012
6013 @table @code
6014 @kindex frame@r{, command}
6015 @cindex current stack frame
6016 @item frame @var{args}
6017 The @code{frame} command allows you to move from one stack frame to another,
6018 and to print the stack frame you select. @var{args} may be either the
6019 address of the frame or the stack frame number. Without an argument,
6020 @code{frame} prints the current stack frame.
6021
6022 @kindex select-frame
6023 @cindex selecting frame silently
6024 @item select-frame
6025 The @code{select-frame} command allows you to move from one stack frame
6026 to another without printing the frame. This is the silent version of
6027 @code{frame}.
6028 @end table
6029
6030 @node Backtrace
6031 @section Backtraces
6032
6033 @cindex traceback
6034 @cindex call stack traces
6035 A backtrace is a summary of how your program got where it is. It shows one
6036 line per frame, for many frames, starting with the currently executing
6037 frame (frame zero), followed by its caller (frame one), and on up the
6038 stack.
6039
6040 @table @code
6041 @kindex backtrace
6042 @kindex bt @r{(@code{backtrace})}
6043 @item backtrace
6044 @itemx bt
6045 Print a backtrace of the entire stack: one line per frame for all
6046 frames in the stack.
6047
6048 You can stop the backtrace at any time by typing the system interrupt
6049 character, normally @kbd{Ctrl-c}.
6050
6051 @item backtrace @var{n}
6052 @itemx bt @var{n}
6053 Similar, but print only the innermost @var{n} frames.
6054
6055 @item backtrace -@var{n}
6056 @itemx bt -@var{n}
6057 Similar, but print only the outermost @var{n} frames.
6058
6059 @item backtrace full
6060 @itemx bt full
6061 @itemx bt full @var{n}
6062 @itemx bt full -@var{n}
6063 Print the values of the local variables also. @var{n} specifies the
6064 number of frames to print, as described above.
6065 @end table
6066
6067 @kindex where
6068 @kindex info stack
6069 The names @code{where} and @code{info stack} (abbreviated @code{info s})
6070 are additional aliases for @code{backtrace}.
6071
6072 @cindex multiple threads, backtrace
6073 In a multi-threaded program, @value{GDBN} by default shows the
6074 backtrace only for the current thread. To display the backtrace for
6075 several or all of the threads, use the command @code{thread apply}
6076 (@pxref{Threads, thread apply}). For example, if you type @kbd{thread
6077 apply all backtrace}, @value{GDBN} will display the backtrace for all
6078 the threads; this is handy when you debug a core dump of a
6079 multi-threaded program.
6080
6081 Each line in the backtrace shows the frame number and the function name.
6082 The program counter value is also shown---unless you use @code{set
6083 print address off}. The backtrace also shows the source file name and
6084 line number, as well as the arguments to the function. The program
6085 counter value is omitted if it is at the beginning of the code for that
6086 line number.
6087
6088 Here is an example of a backtrace. It was made with the command
6089 @samp{bt 3}, so it shows the innermost three frames.
6090
6091 @smallexample
6092 @group
6093 #0 m4_traceon (obs=0x24eb0, argc=1, argv=0x2b8c8)
6094 at builtin.c:993
6095 #1 0x6e38 in expand_macro (sym=0x2b600, data=...) at macro.c:242
6096 #2 0x6840 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=177664, td=0xf7fffb08)
6097 at macro.c:71
6098 (More stack frames follow...)
6099 @end group
6100 @end smallexample
6101
6102 @noindent
6103 The display for frame zero does not begin with a program counter
6104 value, indicating that your program has stopped at the beginning of the
6105 code for line @code{993} of @code{builtin.c}.
6106
6107 @noindent
6108 The value of parameter @code{data} in frame 1 has been replaced by
6109 @code{@dots{}}. By default, @value{GDBN} prints the value of a parameter
6110 only if it is a scalar (integer, pointer, enumeration, etc). See command
6111 @kbd{set print frame-arguments} in @ref{Print Settings} for more details
6112 on how to configure the way function parameter values are printed.
6113
6114 @cindex optimized out, in backtrace
6115 @cindex function call arguments, optimized out
6116 If your program was compiled with optimizations, some compilers will
6117 optimize away arguments passed to functions if those arguments are
6118 never used after the call. Such optimizations generate code that
6119 passes arguments through registers, but doesn't store those arguments
6120 in the stack frame. @value{GDBN} has no way of displaying such
6121 arguments in stack frames other than the innermost one. Here's what
6122 such a backtrace might look like:
6123
6124 @smallexample
6125 @group
6126 #0 m4_traceon (obs=0x24eb0, argc=1, argv=0x2b8c8)
6127 at builtin.c:993
6128 #1 0x6e38 in expand_macro (sym=<optimized out>) at macro.c:242
6129 #2 0x6840 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=<optimized out>, td=0xf7fffb08)
6130 at macro.c:71
6131 (More stack frames follow...)
6132 @end group
6133 @end smallexample
6134
6135 @noindent
6136 The values of arguments that were not saved in their stack frames are
6137 shown as @samp{<optimized out>}.
6138
6139 If you need to display the values of such optimized-out arguments,
6140 either deduce that from other variables whose values depend on the one
6141 you are interested in, or recompile without optimizations.
6142
6143 @cindex backtrace beyond @code{main} function
6144 @cindex program entry point
6145 @cindex startup code, and backtrace
6146 Most programs have a standard user entry point---a place where system
6147 libraries and startup code transition into user code. For C this is
6148 @code{main}@footnote{
6149 Note that embedded programs (the so-called ``free-standing''
6150 environment) are not required to have a @code{main} function as the
6151 entry point. They could even have multiple entry points.}.
6152 When @value{GDBN} finds the entry function in a backtrace
6153 it will terminate the backtrace, to avoid tracing into highly
6154 system-specific (and generally uninteresting) code.
6155
6156 If you need to examine the startup code, or limit the number of levels
6157 in a backtrace, you can change this behavior:
6158
6159 @table @code
6160 @item set backtrace past-main
6161 @itemx set backtrace past-main on
6162 @kindex set backtrace
6163 Backtraces will continue past the user entry point.
6164
6165 @item set backtrace past-main off
6166 Backtraces will stop when they encounter the user entry point. This is the
6167 default.
6168
6169 @item show backtrace past-main
6170 @kindex show backtrace
6171 Display the current user entry point backtrace policy.
6172
6173 @item set backtrace past-entry
6174 @itemx set backtrace past-entry on
6175 Backtraces will continue past the internal entry point of an application.
6176 This entry point is encoded by the linker when the application is built,
6177 and is likely before the user entry point @code{main} (or equivalent) is called.
6178
6179 @item set backtrace past-entry off
6180 Backtraces will stop when they encounter the internal entry point of an
6181 application. This is the default.
6182
6183 @item show backtrace past-entry
6184 Display the current internal entry point backtrace policy.
6185
6186 @item set backtrace limit @var{n}
6187 @itemx set backtrace limit 0
6188 @cindex backtrace limit
6189 Limit the backtrace to @var{n} levels. A value of zero means
6190 unlimited.
6191
6192 @item show backtrace limit
6193 Display the current limit on backtrace levels.
6194 @end table
6195
6196 @node Selection
6197 @section Selecting a Frame
6198
6199 Most commands for examining the stack and other data in your program work on
6200 whichever stack frame is selected at the moment. Here are the commands for
6201 selecting a stack frame; all of them finish by printing a brief description
6202 of the stack frame just selected.
6203
6204 @table @code
6205 @kindex frame@r{, selecting}
6206 @kindex f @r{(@code{frame})}
6207 @item frame @var{n}
6208 @itemx f @var{n}
6209 Select frame number @var{n}. Recall that frame zero is the innermost
6210 (currently executing) frame, frame one is the frame that called the
6211 innermost one, and so on. The highest-numbered frame is the one for
6212 @code{main}.
6213
6214 @item frame @var{addr}
6215 @itemx f @var{addr}
6216 Select the frame at address @var{addr}. This is useful mainly if the
6217 chaining of stack frames has been damaged by a bug, making it
6218 impossible for @value{GDBN} to assign numbers properly to all frames. In
6219 addition, this can be useful when your program has multiple stacks and
6220 switches between them.
6221
6222 On the SPARC architecture, @code{frame} needs two addresses to
6223 select an arbitrary frame: a frame pointer and a stack pointer.
6224
6225 On the MIPS and Alpha architecture, it needs two addresses: a stack
6226 pointer and a program counter.
6227
6228 On the 29k architecture, it needs three addresses: a register stack
6229 pointer, a program counter, and a memory stack pointer.
6230
6231 @kindex up
6232 @item up @var{n}
6233 Move @var{n} frames up the stack. For positive numbers @var{n}, this
6234 advances toward the outermost frame, to higher frame numbers, to frames
6235 that have existed longer. @var{n} defaults to one.
6236
6237 @kindex down
6238 @kindex do @r{(@code{down})}
6239 @item down @var{n}
6240 Move @var{n} frames down the stack. For positive numbers @var{n}, this
6241 advances toward the innermost frame, to lower frame numbers, to frames
6242 that were created more recently. @var{n} defaults to one. You may
6243 abbreviate @code{down} as @code{do}.
6244 @end table
6245
6246 All of these commands end by printing two lines of output describing the
6247 frame. The first line shows the frame number, the function name, the
6248 arguments, and the source file and line number of execution in that
6249 frame. The second line shows the text of that source line.
6250
6251 @need 1000
6252 For example:
6253
6254 @smallexample
6255 @group
6256 (@value{GDBP}) up
6257 #1 0x22f0 in main (argc=1, argv=0xf7fffbf4, env=0xf7fffbfc)
6258 at env.c:10
6259 10 read_input_file (argv[i]);
6260 @end group
6261 @end smallexample
6262
6263 After such a printout, the @code{list} command with no arguments
6264 prints ten lines centered on the point of execution in the frame.
6265 You can also edit the program at the point of execution with your favorite
6266 editing program by typing @code{edit}.
6267 @xref{List, ,Printing Source Lines},
6268 for details.
6269
6270 @table @code
6271 @kindex down-silently
6272 @kindex up-silently
6273 @item up-silently @var{n}
6274 @itemx down-silently @var{n}
6275 These two commands are variants of @code{up} and @code{down},
6276 respectively; they differ in that they do their work silently, without
6277 causing display of the new frame. They are intended primarily for use
6278 in @value{GDBN} command scripts, where the output might be unnecessary and
6279 distracting.
6280 @end table
6281
6282 @node Frame Info
6283 @section Information About a Frame
6284
6285 There are several other commands to print information about the selected
6286 stack frame.
6287
6288 @table @code
6289 @item frame
6290 @itemx f
6291 When used without any argument, this command does not change which
6292 frame is selected, but prints a brief description of the currently
6293 selected stack frame. It can be abbreviated @code{f}. With an
6294 argument, this command is used to select a stack frame.
6295 @xref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}.
6296
6297 @kindex info frame
6298 @kindex info f @r{(@code{info frame})}
6299 @item info frame
6300 @itemx info f
6301 This command prints a verbose description of the selected stack frame,
6302 including:
6303
6304 @itemize @bullet
6305 @item
6306 the address of the frame
6307 @item
6308 the address of the next frame down (called by this frame)
6309 @item
6310 the address of the next frame up (caller of this frame)
6311 @item
6312 the language in which the source code corresponding to this frame is written
6313 @item
6314 the address of the frame's arguments
6315 @item
6316 the address of the frame's local variables
6317 @item
6318 the program counter saved in it (the address of execution in the caller frame)
6319 @item
6320 which registers were saved in the frame
6321 @end itemize
6322
6323 @noindent The verbose description is useful when
6324 something has gone wrong that has made the stack format fail to fit
6325 the usual conventions.
6326
6327 @item info frame @var{addr}
6328 @itemx info f @var{addr}
6329 Print a verbose description of the frame at address @var{addr}, without
6330 selecting that frame. The selected frame remains unchanged by this
6331 command. This requires the same kind of address (more than one for some
6332 architectures) that you specify in the @code{frame} command.
6333 @xref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}.
6334
6335 @kindex info args
6336 @item info args
6337 Print the arguments of the selected frame, each on a separate line.
6338
6339 @item info locals
6340 @kindex info locals
6341 Print the local variables of the selected frame, each on a separate
6342 line. These are all variables (declared either static or automatic)
6343 accessible at the point of execution of the selected frame.
6344
6345 @kindex info catch
6346 @cindex catch exceptions, list active handlers
6347 @cindex exception handlers, how to list
6348 @item info catch
6349 Print a list of all the exception handlers that are active in the
6350 current stack frame at the current point of execution. To see other
6351 exception handlers, visit the associated frame (using the @code{up},
6352 @code{down}, or @code{frame} commands); then type @code{info catch}.
6353 @xref{Set Catchpoints, , Setting Catchpoints}.
6354
6355 @end table
6356
6357
6358 @node Source
6359 @chapter Examining Source Files
6360
6361 @value{GDBN} can print parts of your program's source, since the debugging
6362 information recorded in the program tells @value{GDBN} what source files were
6363 used to build it. When your program stops, @value{GDBN} spontaneously prints
6364 the line where it stopped. Likewise, when you select a stack frame
6365 (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}), @value{GDBN} prints the line where
6366 execution in that frame has stopped. You can print other portions of
6367 source files by explicit command.
6368
6369 If you use @value{GDBN} through its @sc{gnu} Emacs interface, you may
6370 prefer to use Emacs facilities to view source; see @ref{Emacs, ,Using
6371 @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs}.
6372
6373 @menu
6374 * List:: Printing source lines
6375 * Specify Location:: How to specify code locations
6376 * Edit:: Editing source files
6377 * Search:: Searching source files
6378 * Source Path:: Specifying source directories
6379 * Machine Code:: Source and machine code
6380 @end menu
6381
6382 @node List
6383 @section Printing Source Lines
6384
6385 @kindex list
6386 @kindex l @r{(@code{list})}
6387 To print lines from a source file, use the @code{list} command
6388 (abbreviated @code{l}). By default, ten lines are printed.
6389 There are several ways to specify what part of the file you want to
6390 print; see @ref{Specify Location}, for the full list.
6391
6392 Here are the forms of the @code{list} command most commonly used:
6393
6394 @table @code
6395 @item list @var{linenum}
6396 Print lines centered around line number @var{linenum} in the
6397 current source file.
6398
6399 @item list @var{function}
6400 Print lines centered around the beginning of function
6401 @var{function}.
6402
6403 @item list
6404 Print more lines. If the last lines printed were printed with a
6405 @code{list} command, this prints lines following the last lines
6406 printed; however, if the last line printed was a solitary line printed
6407 as part of displaying a stack frame (@pxref{Stack, ,Examining the
6408 Stack}), this prints lines centered around that line.
6409
6410 @item list -
6411 Print lines just before the lines last printed.
6412 @end table
6413
6414 @cindex @code{list}, how many lines to display
6415 By default, @value{GDBN} prints ten source lines with any of these forms of
6416 the @code{list} command. You can change this using @code{set listsize}:
6417
6418 @table @code
6419 @kindex set listsize
6420 @item set listsize @var{count}
6421 Make the @code{list} command display @var{count} source lines (unless
6422 the @code{list} argument explicitly specifies some other number).
6423
6424 @kindex show listsize
6425 @item show listsize
6426 Display the number of lines that @code{list} prints.
6427 @end table
6428
6429 Repeating a @code{list} command with @key{RET} discards the argument,
6430 so it is equivalent to typing just @code{list}. This is more useful
6431 than listing the same lines again. An exception is made for an
6432 argument of @samp{-}; that argument is preserved in repetition so that
6433 each repetition moves up in the source file.
6434
6435 In general, the @code{list} command expects you to supply zero, one or two
6436 @dfn{linespecs}. Linespecs specify source lines; there are several ways
6437 of writing them (@pxref{Specify Location}), but the effect is always
6438 to specify some source line.
6439
6440 Here is a complete description of the possible arguments for @code{list}:
6441
6442 @table @code
6443 @item list @var{linespec}
6444 Print lines centered around the line specified by @var{linespec}.
6445
6446 @item list @var{first},@var{last}
6447 Print lines from @var{first} to @var{last}. Both arguments are
6448 linespecs. When a @code{list} command has two linespecs, and the
6449 source file of the second linespec is omitted, this refers to
6450 the same source file as the first linespec.
6451
6452 @item list ,@var{last}
6453 Print lines ending with @var{last}.
6454
6455 @item list @var{first},
6456 Print lines starting with @var{first}.
6457
6458 @item list +
6459 Print lines just after the lines last printed.
6460
6461 @item list -
6462 Print lines just before the lines last printed.
6463
6464 @item list
6465 As described in the preceding table.
6466 @end table
6467
6468 @node Specify Location
6469 @section Specifying a Location
6470 @cindex specifying location
6471 @cindex linespec
6472
6473 Several @value{GDBN} commands accept arguments that specify a location
6474 of your program's code. Since @value{GDBN} is a source-level
6475 debugger, a location usually specifies some line in the source code;
6476 for that reason, locations are also known as @dfn{linespecs}.
6477
6478 Here are all the different ways of specifying a code location that
6479 @value{GDBN} understands:
6480
6481 @table @code
6482 @item @var{linenum}
6483 Specifies the line number @var{linenum} of the current source file.
6484
6485 @item -@var{offset}
6486 @itemx +@var{offset}
6487 Specifies the line @var{offset} lines before or after the @dfn{current
6488 line}. For the @code{list} command, the current line is the last one
6489 printed; for the breakpoint commands, this is the line at which
6490 execution stopped in the currently selected @dfn{stack frame}
6491 (@pxref{Frames, ,Frames}, for a description of stack frames.) When
6492 used as the second of the two linespecs in a @code{list} command,
6493 this specifies the line @var{offset} lines up or down from the first
6494 linespec.
6495
6496 @item @var{filename}:@var{linenum}
6497 Specifies the line @var{linenum} in the source file @var{filename}.
6498
6499 @item @var{function}
6500 Specifies the line that begins the body of the function @var{function}.
6501 For example, in C, this is the line with the open brace.
6502
6503 @item @var{function}:@var{label}
6504 Specifies the line where @var{label} appears in @var{function}.
6505
6506 @item @var{filename}:@var{function}
6507 Specifies the line that begins the body of the function @var{function}
6508 in the file @var{filename}. You only need the file name with a
6509 function name to avoid ambiguity when there are identically named
6510 functions in different source files.
6511
6512 @item @var{label}
6513 Specifies the line at which the label named @var{label} appears.
6514 @value{GDBN} searches for the label in the function corresponding to
6515 the currently selected stack frame. If there is no current selected
6516 stack frame (for instance, if the inferior is not running), then
6517 @value{GDBN} will not search for a label.
6518
6519 @item *@var{address}
6520 Specifies the program address @var{address}. For line-oriented
6521 commands, such as @code{list} and @code{edit}, this specifies a source
6522 line that contains @var{address}. For @code{break} and other
6523 breakpoint oriented commands, this can be used to set breakpoints in
6524 parts of your program which do not have debugging information or
6525 source files.
6526
6527 Here @var{address} may be any expression valid in the current working
6528 language (@pxref{Languages, working language}) that specifies a code
6529 address. In addition, as a convenience, @value{GDBN} extends the
6530 semantics of expressions used in locations to cover the situations
6531 that frequently happen during debugging. Here are the various forms
6532 of @var{address}:
6533
6534 @table @code
6535 @item @var{expression}
6536 Any expression valid in the current working language.
6537
6538 @item @var{funcaddr}
6539 An address of a function or procedure derived from its name. In C,
6540 C@t{++}, Java, Objective-C, Fortran, minimal, and assembly, this is
6541 simply the function's name @var{function} (and actually a special case
6542 of a valid expression). In Pascal and Modula-2, this is
6543 @code{&@var{function}}. In Ada, this is @code{@var{function}'Address}
6544 (although the Pascal form also works).
6545
6546 This form specifies the address of the function's first instruction,
6547 before the stack frame and arguments have been set up.
6548
6549 @item '@var{filename}'::@var{funcaddr}
6550 Like @var{funcaddr} above, but also specifies the name of the source
6551 file explicitly. This is useful if the name of the function does not
6552 specify the function unambiguously, e.g., if there are several
6553 functions with identical names in different source files.
6554 @end table
6555
6556 @end table
6557
6558
6559 @node Edit
6560 @section Editing Source Files
6561 @cindex editing source files
6562
6563 @kindex edit
6564 @kindex e @r{(@code{edit})}
6565 To edit the lines in a source file, use the @code{edit} command.
6566 The editing program of your choice
6567 is invoked with the current line set to
6568 the active line in the program.
6569 Alternatively, there are several ways to specify what part of the file you
6570 want to print if you want to see other parts of the program:
6571
6572 @table @code
6573 @item edit @var{location}
6574 Edit the source file specified by @code{location}. Editing starts at
6575 that @var{location}, e.g., at the specified source line of the
6576 specified file. @xref{Specify Location}, for all the possible forms
6577 of the @var{location} argument; here are the forms of the @code{edit}
6578 command most commonly used:
6579
6580 @table @code
6581 @item edit @var{number}
6582 Edit the current source file with @var{number} as the active line number.
6583
6584 @item edit @var{function}
6585 Edit the file containing @var{function} at the beginning of its definition.
6586 @end table
6587
6588 @end table
6589
6590 @subsection Choosing your Editor
6591 You can customize @value{GDBN} to use any editor you want
6592 @footnote{
6593 The only restriction is that your editor (say @code{ex}), recognizes the
6594 following command-line syntax:
6595 @smallexample
6596 ex +@var{number} file
6597 @end smallexample
6598 The optional numeric value +@var{number} specifies the number of the line in
6599 the file where to start editing.}.
6600 By default, it is @file{@value{EDITOR}}, but you can change this
6601 by setting the environment variable @code{EDITOR} before using
6602 @value{GDBN}. For example, to configure @value{GDBN} to use the
6603 @code{vi} editor, you could use these commands with the @code{sh} shell:
6604 @smallexample
6605 EDITOR=/usr/bin/vi
6606 export EDITOR
6607 gdb @dots{}
6608 @end smallexample
6609 or in the @code{csh} shell,
6610 @smallexample
6611 setenv EDITOR /usr/bin/vi
6612 gdb @dots{}
6613 @end smallexample
6614
6615 @node Search
6616 @section Searching Source Files
6617 @cindex searching source files
6618
6619 There are two commands for searching through the current source file for a
6620 regular expression.
6621
6622 @table @code
6623 @kindex search
6624 @kindex forward-search
6625 @item forward-search @var{regexp}
6626 @itemx search @var{regexp}
6627 The command @samp{forward-search @var{regexp}} checks each line,
6628 starting with the one following the last line listed, for a match for
6629 @var{regexp}. It lists the line that is found. You can use the
6630 synonym @samp{search @var{regexp}} or abbreviate the command name as
6631 @code{fo}.
6632
6633 @kindex reverse-search
6634 @item reverse-search @var{regexp}
6635 The command @samp{reverse-search @var{regexp}} checks each line, starting
6636 with the one before the last line listed and going backward, for a match
6637 for @var{regexp}. It lists the line that is found. You can abbreviate
6638 this command as @code{rev}.
6639 @end table
6640
6641 @node Source Path
6642 @section Specifying Source Directories
6643
6644 @cindex source path
6645 @cindex directories for source files
6646 Executable programs sometimes do not record the directories of the source
6647 files from which they were compiled, just the names. Even when they do,
6648 the directories could be moved between the compilation and your debugging
6649 session. @value{GDBN} has a list of directories to search for source files;
6650 this is called the @dfn{source path}. Each time @value{GDBN} wants a source file,
6651 it tries all the directories in the list, in the order they are present
6652 in the list, until it finds a file with the desired name.
6653
6654 For example, suppose an executable references the file
6655 @file{/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c}, and our source path is
6656 @file{/mnt/cross}. The file is first looked up literally; if this
6657 fails, @file{/mnt/cross/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c} is tried; if this
6658 fails, @file{/mnt/cross/foo.c} is opened; if this fails, an error
6659 message is printed. @value{GDBN} does not look up the parts of the
6660 source file name, such as @file{/mnt/cross/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c}.
6661 Likewise, the subdirectories of the source path are not searched: if
6662 the source path is @file{/mnt/cross}, and the binary refers to
6663 @file{foo.c}, @value{GDBN} would not find it under
6664 @file{/mnt/cross/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib}.
6665
6666 Plain file names, relative file names with leading directories, file
6667 names containing dots, etc.@: are all treated as described above; for
6668 instance, if the source path is @file{/mnt/cross}, and the source file
6669 is recorded as @file{../lib/foo.c}, @value{GDBN} would first try
6670 @file{../lib/foo.c}, then @file{/mnt/cross/../lib/foo.c}, and after
6671 that---@file{/mnt/cross/foo.c}.
6672
6673 Note that the executable search path is @emph{not} used to locate the
6674 source files.
6675
6676 Whenever you reset or rearrange the source path, @value{GDBN} clears out
6677 any information it has cached about where source files are found and where
6678 each line is in the file.
6679
6680 @kindex directory
6681 @kindex dir
6682 When you start @value{GDBN}, its source path includes only @samp{cdir}
6683 and @samp{cwd}, in that order.
6684 To add other directories, use the @code{directory} command.
6685
6686 The search path is used to find both program source files and @value{GDBN}
6687 script files (read using the @samp{-command} option and @samp{source} command).
6688
6689 In addition to the source path, @value{GDBN} provides a set of commands
6690 that manage a list of source path substitution rules. A @dfn{substitution
6691 rule} specifies how to rewrite source directories stored in the program's
6692 debug information in case the sources were moved to a different
6693 directory between compilation and debugging. A rule is made of
6694 two strings, the first specifying what needs to be rewritten in
6695 the path, and the second specifying how it should be rewritten.
6696 In @ref{set substitute-path}, we name these two parts @var{from} and
6697 @var{to} respectively. @value{GDBN} does a simple string replacement
6698 of @var{from} with @var{to} at the start of the directory part of the
6699 source file name, and uses that result instead of the original file
6700 name to look up the sources.
6701
6702 Using the previous example, suppose the @file{foo-1.0} tree has been
6703 moved from @file{/usr/src} to @file{/mnt/cross}, then you can tell
6704 @value{GDBN} to replace @file{/usr/src} in all source path names with
6705 @file{/mnt/cross}. The first lookup will then be
6706 @file{/mnt/cross/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c} in place of the original location
6707 of @file{/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c}. To define a source path
6708 substitution rule, use the @code{set substitute-path} command
6709 (@pxref{set substitute-path}).
6710
6711 To avoid unexpected substitution results, a rule is applied only if the
6712 @var{from} part of the directory name ends at a directory separator.
6713 For instance, a rule substituting @file{/usr/source} into
6714 @file{/mnt/cross} will be applied to @file{/usr/source/foo-1.0} but
6715 not to @file{/usr/sourceware/foo-2.0}. And because the substitution
6716 is applied only at the beginning of the directory name, this rule will
6717 not be applied to @file{/root/usr/source/baz.c} either.
6718
6719 In many cases, you can achieve the same result using the @code{directory}
6720 command. However, @code{set substitute-path} can be more efficient in
6721 the case where the sources are organized in a complex tree with multiple
6722 subdirectories. With the @code{directory} command, you need to add each
6723 subdirectory of your project. If you moved the entire tree while
6724 preserving its internal organization, then @code{set substitute-path}
6725 allows you to direct the debugger to all the sources with one single
6726 command.
6727
6728 @code{set substitute-path} is also more than just a shortcut command.
6729 The source path is only used if the file at the original location no
6730 longer exists. On the other hand, @code{set substitute-path} modifies
6731 the debugger behavior to look at the rewritten location instead. So, if
6732 for any reason a source file that is not relevant to your executable is
6733 located at the original location, a substitution rule is the only
6734 method available to point @value{GDBN} at the new location.
6735
6736 @cindex @samp{--with-relocated-sources}
6737 @cindex default source path substitution
6738 You can configure a default source path substitution rule by
6739 configuring @value{GDBN} with the
6740 @samp{--with-relocated-sources=@var{dir}} option. The @var{dir}
6741 should be the name of a directory under @value{GDBN}'s configured
6742 prefix (set with @samp{--prefix} or @samp{--exec-prefix}), and
6743 directory names in debug information under @var{dir} will be adjusted
6744 automatically if the installed @value{GDBN} is moved to a new
6745 location. This is useful if @value{GDBN}, libraries or executables
6746 with debug information and corresponding source code are being moved
6747 together.
6748
6749 @table @code
6750 @item directory @var{dirname} @dots{}
6751 @item dir @var{dirname} @dots{}
6752 Add directory @var{dirname} to the front of the source path. Several
6753 directory names may be given to this command, separated by @samp{:}
6754 (@samp{;} on MS-DOS and MS-Windows, where @samp{:} usually appears as
6755 part of absolute file names) or
6756 whitespace. You may specify a directory that is already in the source
6757 path; this moves it forward, so @value{GDBN} searches it sooner.
6758
6759 @kindex cdir
6760 @kindex cwd
6761 @vindex $cdir@r{, convenience variable}
6762 @vindex $cwd@r{, convenience variable}
6763 @cindex compilation directory
6764 @cindex current directory
6765 @cindex working directory
6766 @cindex directory, current
6767 @cindex directory, compilation
6768 You can use the string @samp{$cdir} to refer to the compilation
6769 directory (if one is recorded), and @samp{$cwd} to refer to the current
6770 working directory. @samp{$cwd} is not the same as @samp{.}---the former
6771 tracks the current working directory as it changes during your @value{GDBN}
6772 session, while the latter is immediately expanded to the current
6773 directory at the time you add an entry to the source path.
6774
6775 @item directory
6776 Reset the source path to its default value (@samp{$cdir:$cwd} on Unix systems). This requires confirmation.
6777
6778 @c RET-repeat for @code{directory} is explicitly disabled, but since
6779 @c repeating it would be a no-op we do not say that. (thanks to RMS)
6780
6781 @item set directories @var{path-list}
6782 @kindex set directories
6783 Set the source path to @var{path-list}.
6784 @samp{$cdir:$cwd} are added if missing.
6785
6786 @item show directories
6787 @kindex show directories
6788 Print the source path: show which directories it contains.
6789
6790 @anchor{set substitute-path}
6791 @item set substitute-path @var{from} @var{to}
6792 @kindex set substitute-path
6793 Define a source path substitution rule, and add it at the end of the
6794 current list of existing substitution rules. If a rule with the same
6795 @var{from} was already defined, then the old rule is also deleted.
6796
6797 For example, if the file @file{/foo/bar/baz.c} was moved to
6798 @file{/mnt/cross/baz.c}, then the command
6799
6800 @smallexample
6801 (@value{GDBP}) set substitute-path /usr/src /mnt/cross
6802 @end smallexample
6803
6804 @noindent
6805 will tell @value{GDBN} to replace @samp{/usr/src} with
6806 @samp{/mnt/cross}, which will allow @value{GDBN} to find the file
6807 @file{baz.c} even though it was moved.
6808
6809 In the case when more than one substitution rule have been defined,
6810 the rules are evaluated one by one in the order where they have been
6811 defined. The first one matching, if any, is selected to perform
6812 the substitution.
6813
6814 For instance, if we had entered the following commands:
6815
6816 @smallexample
6817 (@value{GDBP}) set substitute-path /usr/src/include /mnt/include
6818 (@value{GDBP}) set substitute-path /usr/src /mnt/src
6819 @end smallexample
6820
6821 @noindent
6822 @value{GDBN} would then rewrite @file{/usr/src/include/defs.h} into
6823 @file{/mnt/include/defs.h} by using the first rule. However, it would
6824 use the second rule to rewrite @file{/usr/src/lib/foo.c} into
6825 @file{/mnt/src/lib/foo.c}.
6826
6827
6828 @item unset substitute-path [path]
6829 @kindex unset substitute-path
6830 If a path is specified, search the current list of substitution rules
6831 for a rule that would rewrite that path. Delete that rule if found.
6832 A warning is emitted by the debugger if no rule could be found.
6833
6834 If no path is specified, then all substitution rules are deleted.
6835
6836 @item show substitute-path [path]
6837 @kindex show substitute-path
6838 If a path is specified, then print the source path substitution rule
6839 which would rewrite that path, if any.
6840
6841 If no path is specified, then print all existing source path substitution
6842 rules.
6843
6844 @end table
6845
6846 If your source path is cluttered with directories that are no longer of
6847 interest, @value{GDBN} may sometimes cause confusion by finding the wrong
6848 versions of source. You can correct the situation as follows:
6849
6850 @enumerate
6851 @item
6852 Use @code{directory} with no argument to reset the source path to its default value.
6853
6854 @item
6855 Use @code{directory} with suitable arguments to reinstall the
6856 directories you want in the source path. You can add all the
6857 directories in one command.
6858 @end enumerate
6859
6860 @node Machine Code
6861 @section Source and Machine Code
6862 @cindex source line and its code address
6863
6864 You can use the command @code{info line} to map source lines to program
6865 addresses (and vice versa), and the command @code{disassemble} to display
6866 a range of addresses as machine instructions. You can use the command
6867 @code{set disassemble-next-line} to set whether to disassemble next
6868 source line when execution stops. When run under @sc{gnu} Emacs
6869 mode, the @code{info line} command causes the arrow to point to the
6870 line specified. Also, @code{info line} prints addresses in symbolic form as
6871 well as hex.
6872
6873 @table @code
6874 @kindex info line
6875 @item info line @var{linespec}
6876 Print the starting and ending addresses of the compiled code for
6877 source line @var{linespec}. You can specify source lines in any of
6878 the ways documented in @ref{Specify Location}.
6879 @end table
6880
6881 For example, we can use @code{info line} to discover the location of
6882 the object code for the first line of function
6883 @code{m4_changequote}:
6884
6885 @c FIXME: I think this example should also show the addresses in
6886 @c symbolic form, as they usually would be displayed.
6887 @smallexample
6888 (@value{GDBP}) info line m4_changequote
6889 Line 895 of "builtin.c" starts at pc 0x634c and ends at 0x6350.
6890 @end smallexample
6891
6892 @noindent
6893 @cindex code address and its source line
6894 We can also inquire (using @code{*@var{addr}} as the form for
6895 @var{linespec}) what source line covers a particular address:
6896 @smallexample
6897 (@value{GDBP}) info line *0x63ff
6898 Line 926 of "builtin.c" starts at pc 0x63e4 and ends at 0x6404.
6899 @end smallexample
6900
6901 @cindex @code{$_} and @code{info line}
6902 @cindex @code{x} command, default address
6903 @kindex x@r{(examine), and} info line
6904 After @code{info line}, the default address for the @code{x} command
6905 is changed to the starting address of the line, so that @samp{x/i} is
6906 sufficient to begin examining the machine code (@pxref{Memory,
6907 ,Examining Memory}). Also, this address is saved as the value of the
6908 convenience variable @code{$_} (@pxref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
6909 Variables}).
6910
6911 @table @code
6912 @kindex disassemble
6913 @cindex assembly instructions
6914 @cindex instructions, assembly
6915 @cindex machine instructions
6916 @cindex listing machine instructions
6917 @item disassemble
6918 @itemx disassemble /m
6919 @itemx disassemble /r
6920 This specialized command dumps a range of memory as machine
6921 instructions. It can also print mixed source+disassembly by specifying
6922 the @code{/m} modifier and print the raw instructions in hex as well as
6923 in symbolic form by specifying the @code{/r}.
6924 The default memory range is the function surrounding the
6925 program counter of the selected frame. A single argument to this
6926 command is a program counter value; @value{GDBN} dumps the function
6927 surrounding this value. When two arguments are given, they should
6928 be separated by a comma, possibly surrounded by whitespace. The
6929 arguments specify a range of addresses to dump, in one of two forms:
6930
6931 @table @code
6932 @item @var{start},@var{end}
6933 the addresses from @var{start} (inclusive) to @var{end} (exclusive)
6934 @item @var{start},+@var{length}
6935 the addresses from @var{start} (inclusive) to
6936 @code{@var{start}+@var{length}} (exclusive).
6937 @end table
6938
6939 @noindent
6940 When 2 arguments are specified, the name of the function is also
6941 printed (since there could be several functions in the given range).
6942
6943 The argument(s) can be any expression yielding a numeric value, such as
6944 @samp{0x32c4}, @samp{&main+10} or @samp{$pc - 8}.
6945
6946 If the range of memory being disassembled contains current program counter,
6947 the instruction at that location is shown with a @code{=>} marker.
6948 @end table
6949
6950 The following example shows the disassembly of a range of addresses of
6951 HP PA-RISC 2.0 code:
6952
6953 @smallexample
6954 (@value{GDBP}) disas 0x32c4, 0x32e4
6955 Dump of assembler code from 0x32c4 to 0x32e4:
6956 0x32c4 <main+204>: addil 0,dp
6957 0x32c8 <main+208>: ldw 0x22c(sr0,r1),r26
6958 0x32cc <main+212>: ldil 0x3000,r31
6959 0x32d0 <main+216>: ble 0x3f8(sr4,r31)
6960 0x32d4 <main+220>: ldo 0(r31),rp
6961 0x32d8 <main+224>: addil -0x800,dp
6962 0x32dc <main+228>: ldo 0x588(r1),r26
6963 0x32e0 <main+232>: ldil 0x3000,r31
6964 End of assembler dump.
6965 @end smallexample
6966
6967 Here is an example showing mixed source+assembly for Intel x86, when the
6968 program is stopped just after function prologue:
6969
6970 @smallexample
6971 (@value{GDBP}) disas /m main
6972 Dump of assembler code for function main:
6973 5 @{
6974 0x08048330 <+0>: push %ebp
6975 0x08048331 <+1>: mov %esp,%ebp
6976 0x08048333 <+3>: sub $0x8,%esp
6977 0x08048336 <+6>: and $0xfffffff0,%esp
6978 0x08048339 <+9>: sub $0x10,%esp
6979
6980 6 printf ("Hello.\n");
6981 => 0x0804833c <+12>: movl $0x8048440,(%esp)
6982 0x08048343 <+19>: call 0x8048284 <puts@@plt>
6983
6984 7 return 0;
6985 8 @}
6986 0x08048348 <+24>: mov $0x0,%eax
6987 0x0804834d <+29>: leave
6988 0x0804834e <+30>: ret
6989
6990 End of assembler dump.
6991 @end smallexample
6992
6993 Here is another example showing raw instructions in hex for AMD x86-64,
6994
6995 @smallexample
6996 (gdb) disas /r 0x400281,+10
6997 Dump of assembler code from 0x400281 to 0x40028b:
6998 0x0000000000400281: 38 36 cmp %dh,(%rsi)
6999 0x0000000000400283: 2d 36 34 2e 73 sub $0x732e3436,%eax
7000 0x0000000000400288: 6f outsl %ds:(%rsi),(%dx)
7001 0x0000000000400289: 2e 32 00 xor %cs:(%rax),%al
7002 End of assembler dump.
7003 @end smallexample
7004
7005 Some architectures have more than one commonly-used set of instruction
7006 mnemonics or other syntax.
7007
7008 For programs that were dynamically linked and use shared libraries,
7009 instructions that call functions or branch to locations in the shared
7010 libraries might show a seemingly bogus location---it's actually a
7011 location of the relocation table. On some architectures, @value{GDBN}
7012 might be able to resolve these to actual function names.
7013
7014 @table @code
7015 @kindex set disassembly-flavor
7016 @cindex Intel disassembly flavor
7017 @cindex AT&T disassembly flavor
7018 @item set disassembly-flavor @var{instruction-set}
7019 Select the instruction set to use when disassembling the
7020 program via the @code{disassemble} or @code{x/i} commands.
7021
7022 Currently this command is only defined for the Intel x86 family. You
7023 can set @var{instruction-set} to either @code{intel} or @code{att}.
7024 The default is @code{att}, the AT&T flavor used by default by Unix
7025 assemblers for x86-based targets.
7026
7027 @kindex show disassembly-flavor
7028 @item show disassembly-flavor
7029 Show the current setting of the disassembly flavor.
7030 @end table
7031
7032 @table @code
7033 @kindex set disassemble-next-line
7034 @kindex show disassemble-next-line
7035 @item set disassemble-next-line
7036 @itemx show disassemble-next-line
7037 Control whether or not @value{GDBN} will disassemble the next source
7038 line or instruction when execution stops. If ON, @value{GDBN} will
7039 display disassembly of the next source line when execution of the
7040 program being debugged stops. This is @emph{in addition} to
7041 displaying the source line itself, which @value{GDBN} always does if
7042 possible. If the next source line cannot be displayed for some reason
7043 (e.g., if @value{GDBN} cannot find the source file, or there's no line
7044 info in the debug info), @value{GDBN} will display disassembly of the
7045 next @emph{instruction} instead of showing the next source line. If
7046 AUTO, @value{GDBN} will display disassembly of next instruction only
7047 if the source line cannot be displayed. This setting causes
7048 @value{GDBN} to display some feedback when you step through a function
7049 with no line info or whose source file is unavailable. The default is
7050 OFF, which means never display the disassembly of the next line or
7051 instruction.
7052 @end table
7053
7054
7055 @node Data
7056 @chapter Examining Data
7057
7058 @cindex printing data
7059 @cindex examining data
7060 @kindex print
7061 @kindex inspect
7062 @c "inspect" is not quite a synonym if you are using Epoch, which we do not
7063 @c document because it is nonstandard... Under Epoch it displays in a
7064 @c different window or something like that.
7065 The usual way to examine data in your program is with the @code{print}
7066 command (abbreviated @code{p}), or its synonym @code{inspect}. It
7067 evaluates and prints the value of an expression of the language your
7068 program is written in (@pxref{Languages, ,Using @value{GDBN} with
7069 Different Languages}). It may also print the expression using a
7070 Python-based pretty-printer (@pxref{Pretty Printing}).
7071
7072 @table @code
7073 @item print @var{expr}
7074 @itemx print /@var{f} @var{expr}
7075 @var{expr} is an expression (in the source language). By default the
7076 value of @var{expr} is printed in a format appropriate to its data type;
7077 you can choose a different format by specifying @samp{/@var{f}}, where
7078 @var{f} is a letter specifying the format; see @ref{Output Formats,,Output
7079 Formats}.
7080
7081 @item print
7082 @itemx print /@var{f}
7083 @cindex reprint the last value
7084 If you omit @var{expr}, @value{GDBN} displays the last value again (from the
7085 @dfn{value history}; @pxref{Value History, ,Value History}). This allows you to
7086 conveniently inspect the same value in an alternative format.
7087 @end table
7088
7089 A more low-level way of examining data is with the @code{x} command.
7090 It examines data in memory at a specified address and prints it in a
7091 specified format. @xref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}.
7092
7093 If you are interested in information about types, or about how the
7094 fields of a struct or a class are declared, use the @code{ptype @var{exp}}
7095 command rather than @code{print}. @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol
7096 Table}.
7097
7098 @menu
7099 * Expressions:: Expressions
7100 * Ambiguous Expressions:: Ambiguous Expressions
7101 * Variables:: Program variables
7102 * Arrays:: Artificial arrays
7103 * Output Formats:: Output formats
7104 * Memory:: Examining memory
7105 * Auto Display:: Automatic display
7106 * Print Settings:: Print settings
7107 * Pretty Printing:: Python pretty printing
7108 * Value History:: Value history
7109 * Convenience Vars:: Convenience variables
7110 * Registers:: Registers
7111 * Floating Point Hardware:: Floating point hardware
7112 * Vector Unit:: Vector Unit
7113 * OS Information:: Auxiliary data provided by operating system
7114 * Memory Region Attributes:: Memory region attributes
7115 * Dump/Restore Files:: Copy between memory and a file
7116 * Core File Generation:: Cause a program dump its core
7117 * Character Sets:: Debugging programs that use a different
7118 character set than GDB does
7119 * Caching Remote Data:: Data caching for remote targets
7120 * Searching Memory:: Searching memory for a sequence of bytes
7121 @end menu
7122
7123 @node Expressions
7124 @section Expressions
7125
7126 @cindex expressions
7127 @code{print} and many other @value{GDBN} commands accept an expression and
7128 compute its value. Any kind of constant, variable or operator defined
7129 by the programming language you are using is valid in an expression in
7130 @value{GDBN}. This includes conditional expressions, function calls,
7131 casts, and string constants. It also includes preprocessor macros, if
7132 you compiled your program to include this information; see
7133 @ref{Compilation}.
7134
7135 @cindex arrays in expressions
7136 @value{GDBN} supports array constants in expressions input by
7137 the user. The syntax is @{@var{element}, @var{element}@dots{}@}. For example,
7138 you can use the command @code{print @{1, 2, 3@}} to create an array
7139 of three integers. If you pass an array to a function or assign it
7140 to a program variable, @value{GDBN} copies the array to memory that
7141 is @code{malloc}ed in the target program.
7142
7143 Because C is so widespread, most of the expressions shown in examples in
7144 this manual are in C. @xref{Languages, , Using @value{GDBN} with Different
7145 Languages}, for information on how to use expressions in other
7146 languages.
7147
7148 In this section, we discuss operators that you can use in @value{GDBN}
7149 expressions regardless of your programming language.
7150
7151 @cindex casts, in expressions
7152 Casts are supported in all languages, not just in C, because it is so
7153 useful to cast a number into a pointer in order to examine a structure
7154 at that address in memory.
7155 @c FIXME: casts supported---Mod2 true?
7156
7157 @value{GDBN} supports these operators, in addition to those common
7158 to programming languages:
7159
7160 @table @code
7161 @item @@
7162 @samp{@@} is a binary operator for treating parts of memory as arrays.
7163 @xref{Arrays, ,Artificial Arrays}, for more information.
7164
7165 @item ::
7166 @samp{::} allows you to specify a variable in terms of the file or
7167 function where it is defined. @xref{Variables, ,Program Variables}.
7168
7169 @cindex @{@var{type}@}
7170 @cindex type casting memory
7171 @cindex memory, viewing as typed object
7172 @cindex casts, to view memory
7173 @item @{@var{type}@} @var{addr}
7174 Refers to an object of type @var{type} stored at address @var{addr} in
7175 memory. @var{addr} may be any expression whose value is an integer or
7176 pointer (but parentheses are required around binary operators, just as in
7177 a cast). This construct is allowed regardless of what kind of data is
7178 normally supposed to reside at @var{addr}.
7179 @end table
7180
7181 @node Ambiguous Expressions
7182 @section Ambiguous Expressions
7183 @cindex ambiguous expressions
7184
7185 Expressions can sometimes contain some ambiguous elements. For instance,
7186 some programming languages (notably Ada, C@t{++} and Objective-C) permit
7187 a single function name to be defined several times, for application in
7188 different contexts. This is called @dfn{overloading}. Another example
7189 involving Ada is generics. A @dfn{generic package} is similar to C@t{++}
7190 templates and is typically instantiated several times, resulting in
7191 the same function name being defined in different contexts.
7192
7193 In some cases and depending on the language, it is possible to adjust
7194 the expression to remove the ambiguity. For instance in C@t{++}, you
7195 can specify the signature of the function you want to break on, as in
7196 @kbd{break @var{function}(@var{types})}. In Ada, using the fully
7197 qualified name of your function often makes the expression unambiguous
7198 as well.
7199
7200 When an ambiguity that needs to be resolved is detected, the debugger
7201 has the capability to display a menu of numbered choices for each
7202 possibility, and then waits for the selection with the prompt @samp{>}.
7203 The first option is always @samp{[0] cancel}, and typing @kbd{0 @key{RET}}
7204 aborts the current command. If the command in which the expression was
7205 used allows more than one choice to be selected, the next option in the
7206 menu is @samp{[1] all}, and typing @kbd{1 @key{RET}} selects all possible
7207 choices.
7208
7209 For example, the following session excerpt shows an attempt to set a
7210 breakpoint at the overloaded symbol @code{String::after}.
7211 We choose three particular definitions of that function name:
7212
7213 @c FIXME! This is likely to change to show arg type lists, at least
7214 @smallexample
7215 @group
7216 (@value{GDBP}) b String::after
7217 [0] cancel
7218 [1] all
7219 [2] file:String.cc; line number:867
7220 [3] file:String.cc; line number:860
7221 [4] file:String.cc; line number:875
7222 [5] file:String.cc; line number:853
7223 [6] file:String.cc; line number:846
7224 [7] file:String.cc; line number:735
7225 > 2 4 6
7226 Breakpoint 1 at 0xb26c: file String.cc, line 867.
7227 Breakpoint 2 at 0xb344: file String.cc, line 875.
7228 Breakpoint 3 at 0xafcc: file String.cc, line 846.
7229 Multiple breakpoints were set.
7230 Use the "delete" command to delete unwanted
7231 breakpoints.
7232 (@value{GDBP})
7233 @end group
7234 @end smallexample
7235
7236 @table @code
7237 @kindex set multiple-symbols
7238 @item set multiple-symbols @var{mode}
7239 @cindex multiple-symbols menu
7240
7241 This option allows you to adjust the debugger behavior when an expression
7242 is ambiguous.
7243
7244 By default, @var{mode} is set to @code{all}. If the command with which
7245 the expression is used allows more than one choice, then @value{GDBN}
7246 automatically selects all possible choices. For instance, inserting
7247 a breakpoint on a function using an ambiguous name results in a breakpoint
7248 inserted on each possible match. However, if a unique choice must be made,
7249 then @value{GDBN} uses the menu to help you disambiguate the expression.
7250 For instance, printing the address of an overloaded function will result
7251 in the use of the menu.
7252
7253 When @var{mode} is set to @code{ask}, the debugger always uses the menu
7254 when an ambiguity is detected.
7255
7256 Finally, when @var{mode} is set to @code{cancel}, the debugger reports
7257 an error due to the ambiguity and the command is aborted.
7258
7259 @kindex show multiple-symbols
7260 @item show multiple-symbols
7261 Show the current value of the @code{multiple-symbols} setting.
7262 @end table
7263
7264 @node Variables
7265 @section Program Variables
7266
7267 The most common kind of expression to use is the name of a variable
7268 in your program.
7269
7270 Variables in expressions are understood in the selected stack frame
7271 (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}); they must be either:
7272
7273 @itemize @bullet
7274 @item
7275 global (or file-static)
7276 @end itemize
7277
7278 @noindent or
7279
7280 @itemize @bullet
7281 @item
7282 visible according to the scope rules of the
7283 programming language from the point of execution in that frame
7284 @end itemize
7285
7286 @noindent This means that in the function
7287
7288 @smallexample
7289 foo (a)
7290 int a;
7291 @{
7292 bar (a);
7293 @{
7294 int b = test ();
7295 bar (b);
7296 @}
7297 @}
7298 @end smallexample
7299
7300 @noindent
7301 you can examine and use the variable @code{a} whenever your program is
7302 executing within the function @code{foo}, but you can only use or
7303 examine the variable @code{b} while your program is executing inside
7304 the block where @code{b} is declared.
7305
7306 @cindex variable name conflict
7307 There is an exception: you can refer to a variable or function whose
7308 scope is a single source file even if the current execution point is not
7309 in this file. But it is possible to have more than one such variable or
7310 function with the same name (in different source files). If that
7311 happens, referring to that name has unpredictable effects. If you wish,
7312 you can specify a static variable in a particular function or file,
7313 using the colon-colon (@code{::}) notation:
7314
7315 @cindex colon-colon, context for variables/functions
7316 @ifnotinfo
7317 @c info cannot cope with a :: index entry, but why deprive hard copy readers?
7318 @cindex @code{::}, context for variables/functions
7319 @end ifnotinfo
7320 @smallexample
7321 @var{file}::@var{variable}
7322 @var{function}::@var{variable}
7323 @end smallexample
7324
7325 @noindent
7326 Here @var{file} or @var{function} is the name of the context for the
7327 static @var{variable}. In the case of file names, you can use quotes to
7328 make sure @value{GDBN} parses the file name as a single word---for example,
7329 to print a global value of @code{x} defined in @file{f2.c}:
7330
7331 @smallexample
7332 (@value{GDBP}) p 'f2.c'::x
7333 @end smallexample
7334
7335 @cindex C@t{++} scope resolution
7336 This use of @samp{::} is very rarely in conflict with the very similar
7337 use of the same notation in C@t{++}. @value{GDBN} also supports use of the C@t{++}
7338 scope resolution operator in @value{GDBN} expressions.
7339 @c FIXME: Um, so what happens in one of those rare cases where it's in
7340 @c conflict?? --mew
7341
7342 @cindex wrong values
7343 @cindex variable values, wrong
7344 @cindex function entry/exit, wrong values of variables
7345 @cindex optimized code, wrong values of variables
7346 @quotation
7347 @emph{Warning:} Occasionally, a local variable may appear to have the
7348 wrong value at certain points in a function---just after entry to a new
7349 scope, and just before exit.
7350 @end quotation
7351 You may see this problem when you are stepping by machine instructions.
7352 This is because, on most machines, it takes more than one instruction to
7353 set up a stack frame (including local variable definitions); if you are
7354 stepping by machine instructions, variables may appear to have the wrong
7355 values until the stack frame is completely built. On exit, it usually
7356 also takes more than one machine instruction to destroy a stack frame;
7357 after you begin stepping through that group of instructions, local
7358 variable definitions may be gone.
7359
7360 This may also happen when the compiler does significant optimizations.
7361 To be sure of always seeing accurate values, turn off all optimization
7362 when compiling.
7363
7364 @cindex ``No symbol "foo" in current context''
7365 Another possible effect of compiler optimizations is to optimize
7366 unused variables out of existence, or assign variables to registers (as
7367 opposed to memory addresses). Depending on the support for such cases
7368 offered by the debug info format used by the compiler, @value{GDBN}
7369 might not be able to display values for such local variables. If that
7370 happens, @value{GDBN} will print a message like this:
7371
7372 @smallexample
7373 No symbol "foo" in current context.
7374 @end smallexample
7375
7376 To solve such problems, either recompile without optimizations, or use a
7377 different debug info format, if the compiler supports several such
7378 formats. @xref{Compilation}, for more information on choosing compiler
7379 options. @xref{C, ,C and C@t{++}}, for more information about debug
7380 info formats that are best suited to C@t{++} programs.
7381
7382 If you ask to print an object whose contents are unknown to
7383 @value{GDBN}, e.g., because its data type is not completely specified
7384 by the debug information, @value{GDBN} will say @samp{<incomplete
7385 type>}. @xref{Symbols, incomplete type}, for more about this.
7386
7387 If you append @kbd{@@entry} string to a function parameter name you get its
7388 value at the time the function got called. If the value is not available an
7389 error message is printed. Entry values are available only with some compilers.
7390 Entry values are normally also printed at the function parameter list according
7391 to @ref{set print entry-values}.
7392
7393 @smallexample
7394 Breakpoint 1, d (i=30) at gdb.base/entry-value.c:29
7395 29 i++;
7396 (gdb) next
7397 30 e (i);
7398 (gdb) print i
7399 $1 = 31
7400 (gdb) print i@@entry
7401 $2 = 30
7402 @end smallexample
7403
7404 Strings are identified as arrays of @code{char} values without specified
7405 signedness. Arrays of either @code{signed char} or @code{unsigned char} get
7406 printed as arrays of 1 byte sized integers. @code{-fsigned-char} or
7407 @code{-funsigned-char} @value{NGCC} options have no effect as @value{GDBN}
7408 defines literal string type @code{"char"} as @code{char} without a sign.
7409 For program code
7410
7411 @smallexample
7412 char var0[] = "A";
7413 signed char var1[] = "A";
7414 @end smallexample
7415
7416 You get during debugging
7417 @smallexample
7418 (gdb) print var0
7419 $1 = "A"
7420 (gdb) print var1
7421 $2 = @{65 'A', 0 '\0'@}
7422 @end smallexample
7423
7424 @node Arrays
7425 @section Artificial Arrays
7426
7427 @cindex artificial array
7428 @cindex arrays
7429 @kindex @@@r{, referencing memory as an array}
7430 It is often useful to print out several successive objects of the
7431 same type in memory; a section of an array, or an array of
7432 dynamically determined size for which only a pointer exists in the
7433 program.
7434
7435 You can do this by referring to a contiguous span of memory as an
7436 @dfn{artificial array}, using the binary operator @samp{@@}. The left
7437 operand of @samp{@@} should be the first element of the desired array
7438 and be an individual object. The right operand should be the desired length
7439 of the array. The result is an array value whose elements are all of
7440 the type of the left argument. The first element is actually the left
7441 argument; the second element comes from bytes of memory immediately
7442 following those that hold the first element, and so on. Here is an
7443 example. If a program says
7444
7445 @smallexample
7446 int *array = (int *) malloc (len * sizeof (int));
7447 @end smallexample
7448
7449 @noindent
7450 you can print the contents of @code{array} with
7451
7452 @smallexample
7453 p *array@@len
7454 @end smallexample
7455
7456 The left operand of @samp{@@} must reside in memory. Array values made
7457 with @samp{@@} in this way behave just like other arrays in terms of
7458 subscripting, and are coerced to pointers when used in expressions.
7459 Artificial arrays most often appear in expressions via the value history
7460 (@pxref{Value History, ,Value History}), after printing one out.
7461
7462 Another way to create an artificial array is to use a cast.
7463 This re-interprets a value as if it were an array.
7464 The value need not be in memory:
7465 @smallexample
7466 (@value{GDBP}) p/x (short[2])0x12345678
7467 $1 = @{0x1234, 0x5678@}
7468 @end smallexample
7469
7470 As a convenience, if you leave the array length out (as in
7471 @samp{(@var{type}[])@var{value}}) @value{GDBN} calculates the size to fill
7472 the value (as @samp{sizeof(@var{value})/sizeof(@var{type})}:
7473 @smallexample
7474 (@value{GDBP}) p/x (short[])0x12345678
7475 $2 = @{0x1234, 0x5678@}
7476 @end smallexample
7477
7478 Sometimes the artificial array mechanism is not quite enough; in
7479 moderately complex data structures, the elements of interest may not
7480 actually be adjacent---for example, if you are interested in the values
7481 of pointers in an array. One useful work-around in this situation is
7482 to use a convenience variable (@pxref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
7483 Variables}) as a counter in an expression that prints the first
7484 interesting value, and then repeat that expression via @key{RET}. For
7485 instance, suppose you have an array @code{dtab} of pointers to
7486 structures, and you are interested in the values of a field @code{fv}
7487 in each structure. Here is an example of what you might type:
7488
7489 @smallexample
7490 set $i = 0
7491 p dtab[$i++]->fv
7492 @key{RET}
7493 @key{RET}
7494 @dots{}
7495 @end smallexample
7496
7497 @node Output Formats
7498 @section Output Formats
7499
7500 @cindex formatted output
7501 @cindex output formats
7502 By default, @value{GDBN} prints a value according to its data type. Sometimes
7503 this is not what you want. For example, you might want to print a number
7504 in hex, or a pointer in decimal. Or you might want to view data in memory
7505 at a certain address as a character string or as an instruction. To do
7506 these things, specify an @dfn{output format} when you print a value.
7507
7508 The simplest use of output formats is to say how to print a value
7509 already computed. This is done by starting the arguments of the
7510 @code{print} command with a slash and a format letter. The format
7511 letters supported are:
7512
7513 @table @code
7514 @item x
7515 Regard the bits of the value as an integer, and print the integer in
7516 hexadecimal.
7517
7518 @item d
7519 Print as integer in signed decimal.
7520
7521 @item u
7522 Print as integer in unsigned decimal.
7523
7524 @item o
7525 Print as integer in octal.
7526
7527 @item t
7528 Print as integer in binary. The letter @samp{t} stands for ``two''.
7529 @footnote{@samp{b} cannot be used because these format letters are also
7530 used with the @code{x} command, where @samp{b} stands for ``byte'';
7531 see @ref{Memory,,Examining Memory}.}
7532
7533 @item a
7534 @cindex unknown address, locating
7535 @cindex locate address
7536 Print as an address, both absolute in hexadecimal and as an offset from
7537 the nearest preceding symbol. You can use this format used to discover
7538 where (in what function) an unknown address is located:
7539
7540 @smallexample
7541 (@value{GDBP}) p/a 0x54320
7542 $3 = 0x54320 <_initialize_vx+396>
7543 @end smallexample
7544
7545 @noindent
7546 The command @code{info symbol 0x54320} yields similar results.
7547 @xref{Symbols, info symbol}.
7548
7549 @item c
7550 Regard as an integer and print it as a character constant. This
7551 prints both the numerical value and its character representation. The
7552 character representation is replaced with the octal escape @samp{\nnn}
7553 for characters outside the 7-bit @sc{ascii} range.
7554
7555 Without this format, @value{GDBN} displays @code{char},
7556 @w{@code{unsigned char}}, and @w{@code{signed char}} data as character
7557 constants. Single-byte members of vectors are displayed as integer
7558 data.
7559
7560 @item f
7561 Regard the bits of the value as a floating point number and print
7562 using typical floating point syntax.
7563
7564 @item s
7565 @cindex printing strings
7566 @cindex printing byte arrays
7567 Regard as a string, if possible. With this format, pointers to single-byte
7568 data are displayed as null-terminated strings and arrays of single-byte data
7569 are displayed as fixed-length strings. Other values are displayed in their
7570 natural types.
7571
7572 Without this format, @value{GDBN} displays pointers to and arrays of
7573 @code{char}, @w{@code{unsigned char}}, and @w{@code{signed char}} as
7574 strings. Single-byte members of a vector are displayed as an integer
7575 array.
7576
7577 @item r
7578 @cindex raw printing
7579 Print using the @samp{raw} formatting. By default, @value{GDBN} will
7580 use a Python-based pretty-printer, if one is available (@pxref{Pretty
7581 Printing}). This typically results in a higher-level display of the
7582 value's contents. The @samp{r} format bypasses any Python
7583 pretty-printer which might exist.
7584 @end table
7585
7586 For example, to print the program counter in hex (@pxref{Registers}), type
7587
7588 @smallexample
7589 p/x $pc
7590 @end smallexample
7591
7592 @noindent
7593 Note that no space is required before the slash; this is because command
7594 names in @value{GDBN} cannot contain a slash.
7595
7596 To reprint the last value in the value history with a different format,
7597 you can use the @code{print} command with just a format and no
7598 expression. For example, @samp{p/x} reprints the last value in hex.
7599
7600 @node Memory
7601 @section Examining Memory
7602
7603 You can use the command @code{x} (for ``examine'') to examine memory in
7604 any of several formats, independently of your program's data types.
7605
7606 @cindex examining memory
7607 @table @code
7608 @kindex x @r{(examine memory)}
7609 @item x/@var{nfu} @var{addr}
7610 @itemx x @var{addr}
7611 @itemx x
7612 Use the @code{x} command to examine memory.
7613 @end table
7614
7615 @var{n}, @var{f}, and @var{u} are all optional parameters that specify how
7616 much memory to display and how to format it; @var{addr} is an
7617 expression giving the address where you want to start displaying memory.
7618 If you use defaults for @var{nfu}, you need not type the slash @samp{/}.
7619 Several commands set convenient defaults for @var{addr}.
7620
7621 @table @r
7622 @item @var{n}, the repeat count
7623 The repeat count is a decimal integer; the default is 1. It specifies
7624 how much memory (counting by units @var{u}) to display.
7625 @c This really is **decimal**; unaffected by 'set radix' as of GDB
7626 @c 4.1.2.
7627
7628 @item @var{f}, the display format
7629 The display format is one of the formats used by @code{print}
7630 (@samp{x}, @samp{d}, @samp{u}, @samp{o}, @samp{t}, @samp{a}, @samp{c},
7631 @samp{f}, @samp{s}), and in addition @samp{i} (for machine instructions).
7632 The default is @samp{x} (hexadecimal) initially. The default changes
7633 each time you use either @code{x} or @code{print}.
7634
7635 @item @var{u}, the unit size
7636 The unit size is any of
7637
7638 @table @code
7639 @item b
7640 Bytes.
7641 @item h
7642 Halfwords (two bytes).
7643 @item w
7644 Words (four bytes). This is the initial default.
7645 @item g
7646 Giant words (eight bytes).
7647 @end table
7648
7649 Each time you specify a unit size with @code{x}, that size becomes the
7650 default unit the next time you use @code{x}. For the @samp{i} format,
7651 the unit size is ignored and is normally not written. For the @samp{s} format,
7652 the unit size defaults to @samp{b}, unless it is explicitly given.
7653 Use @kbd{x /hs} to display 16-bit char strings and @kbd{x /ws} to display
7654 32-bit strings. The next use of @kbd{x /s} will again display 8-bit strings.
7655 Note that the results depend on the programming language of the
7656 current compilation unit. If the language is C, the @samp{s}
7657 modifier will use the UTF-16 encoding while @samp{w} will use
7658 UTF-32. The encoding is set by the programming language and cannot
7659 be altered.
7660
7661 @item @var{addr}, starting display address
7662 @var{addr} is the address where you want @value{GDBN} to begin displaying
7663 memory. The expression need not have a pointer value (though it may);
7664 it is always interpreted as an integer address of a byte of memory.
7665 @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}, for more information on expressions. The default for
7666 @var{addr} is usually just after the last address examined---but several
7667 other commands also set the default address: @code{info breakpoints} (to
7668 the address of the last breakpoint listed), @code{info line} (to the
7669 starting address of a line), and @code{print} (if you use it to display
7670 a value from memory).
7671 @end table
7672
7673 For example, @samp{x/3uh 0x54320} is a request to display three halfwords
7674 (@code{h}) of memory, formatted as unsigned decimal integers (@samp{u}),
7675 starting at address @code{0x54320}. @samp{x/4xw $sp} prints the four
7676 words (@samp{w}) of memory above the stack pointer (here, @samp{$sp};
7677 @pxref{Registers, ,Registers}) in hexadecimal (@samp{x}).
7678
7679 Since the letters indicating unit sizes are all distinct from the
7680 letters specifying output formats, you do not have to remember whether
7681 unit size or format comes first; either order works. The output
7682 specifications @samp{4xw} and @samp{4wx} mean exactly the same thing.
7683 (However, the count @var{n} must come first; @samp{wx4} does not work.)
7684
7685 Even though the unit size @var{u} is ignored for the formats @samp{s}
7686 and @samp{i}, you might still want to use a count @var{n}; for example,
7687 @samp{3i} specifies that you want to see three machine instructions,
7688 including any operands. For convenience, especially when used with
7689 the @code{display} command, the @samp{i} format also prints branch delay
7690 slot instructions, if any, beyond the count specified, which immediately
7691 follow the last instruction that is within the count. The command
7692 @code{disassemble} gives an alternative way of inspecting machine
7693 instructions; see @ref{Machine Code,,Source and Machine Code}.
7694
7695 All the defaults for the arguments to @code{x} are designed to make it
7696 easy to continue scanning memory with minimal specifications each time
7697 you use @code{x}. For example, after you have inspected three machine
7698 instructions with @samp{x/3i @var{addr}}, you can inspect the next seven
7699 with just @samp{x/7}. If you use @key{RET} to repeat the @code{x} command,
7700 the repeat count @var{n} is used again; the other arguments default as
7701 for successive uses of @code{x}.
7702
7703 When examining machine instructions, the instruction at current program
7704 counter is shown with a @code{=>} marker. For example:
7705
7706 @smallexample
7707 (@value{GDBP}) x/5i $pc-6
7708 0x804837f <main+11>: mov %esp,%ebp
7709 0x8048381 <main+13>: push %ecx
7710 0x8048382 <main+14>: sub $0x4,%esp
7711 => 0x8048385 <main+17>: movl $0x8048460,(%esp)
7712 0x804838c <main+24>: call 0x80482d4 <puts@@plt>
7713 @end smallexample
7714
7715 @cindex @code{$_}, @code{$__}, and value history
7716 The addresses and contents printed by the @code{x} command are not saved
7717 in the value history because there is often too much of them and they
7718 would get in the way. Instead, @value{GDBN} makes these values available for
7719 subsequent use in expressions as values of the convenience variables
7720 @code{$_} and @code{$__}. After an @code{x} command, the last address
7721 examined is available for use in expressions in the convenience variable
7722 @code{$_}. The contents of that address, as examined, are available in
7723 the convenience variable @code{$__}.
7724
7725 If the @code{x} command has a repeat count, the address and contents saved
7726 are from the last memory unit printed; this is not the same as the last
7727 address printed if several units were printed on the last line of output.
7728
7729 @cindex remote memory comparison
7730 @cindex verify remote memory image
7731 When you are debugging a program running on a remote target machine
7732 (@pxref{Remote Debugging}), you may wish to verify the program's image in the
7733 remote machine's memory against the executable file you downloaded to
7734 the target. The @code{compare-sections} command is provided for such
7735 situations.
7736
7737 @table @code
7738 @kindex compare-sections
7739 @item compare-sections @r{[}@var{section-name}@r{]}
7740 Compare the data of a loadable section @var{section-name} in the
7741 executable file of the program being debugged with the same section in
7742 the remote machine's memory, and report any mismatches. With no
7743 arguments, compares all loadable sections. This command's
7744 availability depends on the target's support for the @code{"qCRC"}
7745 remote request.
7746 @end table
7747
7748 @node Auto Display
7749 @section Automatic Display
7750 @cindex automatic display
7751 @cindex display of expressions
7752
7753 If you find that you want to print the value of an expression frequently
7754 (to see how it changes), you might want to add it to the @dfn{automatic
7755 display list} so that @value{GDBN} prints its value each time your program stops.
7756 Each expression added to the list is given a number to identify it;
7757 to remove an expression from the list, you specify that number.
7758 The automatic display looks like this:
7759
7760 @smallexample
7761 2: foo = 38
7762 3: bar[5] = (struct hack *) 0x3804
7763 @end smallexample
7764
7765 @noindent
7766 This display shows item numbers, expressions and their current values. As with
7767 displays you request manually using @code{x} or @code{print}, you can
7768 specify the output format you prefer; in fact, @code{display} decides
7769 whether to use @code{print} or @code{x} depending your format
7770 specification---it uses @code{x} if you specify either the @samp{i}
7771 or @samp{s} format, or a unit size; otherwise it uses @code{print}.
7772
7773 @table @code
7774 @kindex display
7775 @item display @var{expr}
7776 Add the expression @var{expr} to the list of expressions to display
7777 each time your program stops. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
7778
7779 @code{display} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after using it.
7780
7781 @item display/@var{fmt} @var{expr}
7782 For @var{fmt} specifying only a display format and not a size or
7783 count, add the expression @var{expr} to the auto-display list but
7784 arrange to display it each time in the specified format @var{fmt}.
7785 @xref{Output Formats,,Output Formats}.
7786
7787 @item display/@var{fmt} @var{addr}
7788 For @var{fmt} @samp{i} or @samp{s}, or including a unit-size or a
7789 number of units, add the expression @var{addr} as a memory address to
7790 be examined each time your program stops. Examining means in effect
7791 doing @samp{x/@var{fmt} @var{addr}}. @xref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}.
7792 @end table
7793
7794 For example, @samp{display/i $pc} can be helpful, to see the machine
7795 instruction about to be executed each time execution stops (@samp{$pc}
7796 is a common name for the program counter; @pxref{Registers, ,Registers}).
7797
7798 @table @code
7799 @kindex delete display
7800 @kindex undisplay
7801 @item undisplay @var{dnums}@dots{}
7802 @itemx delete display @var{dnums}@dots{}
7803 Remove items from the list of expressions to display. Specify the
7804 numbers of the displays that you want affected with the command
7805 argument @var{dnums}. It can be a single display number, one of the
7806 numbers shown in the first field of the @samp{info display} display;
7807 or it could be a range of display numbers, as in @code{2-4}.
7808
7809 @code{undisplay} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} after using it.
7810 (Otherwise you would just get the error @samp{No display number @dots{}}.)
7811
7812 @kindex disable display
7813 @item disable display @var{dnums}@dots{}
7814 Disable the display of item numbers @var{dnums}. A disabled display
7815 item is not printed automatically, but is not forgotten. It may be
7816 enabled again later. Specify the numbers of the displays that you
7817 want affected with the command argument @var{dnums}. It can be a
7818 single display number, one of the numbers shown in the first field of
7819 the @samp{info display} display; or it could be a range of display
7820 numbers, as in @code{2-4}.
7821
7822 @kindex enable display
7823 @item enable display @var{dnums}@dots{}
7824 Enable display of item numbers @var{dnums}. It becomes effective once
7825 again in auto display of its expression, until you specify otherwise.
7826 Specify the numbers of the displays that you want affected with the
7827 command argument @var{dnums}. It can be a single display number, one
7828 of the numbers shown in the first field of the @samp{info display}
7829 display; or it could be a range of display numbers, as in @code{2-4}.
7830
7831 @item display
7832 Display the current values of the expressions on the list, just as is
7833 done when your program stops.
7834
7835 @kindex info display
7836 @item info display
7837 Print the list of expressions previously set up to display
7838 automatically, each one with its item number, but without showing the
7839 values. This includes disabled expressions, which are marked as such.
7840 It also includes expressions which would not be displayed right now
7841 because they refer to automatic variables not currently available.
7842 @end table
7843
7844 @cindex display disabled out of scope
7845 If a display expression refers to local variables, then it does not make
7846 sense outside the lexical context for which it was set up. Such an
7847 expression is disabled when execution enters a context where one of its
7848 variables is not defined. For example, if you give the command
7849 @code{display last_char} while inside a function with an argument
7850 @code{last_char}, @value{GDBN} displays this argument while your program
7851 continues to stop inside that function. When it stops elsewhere---where
7852 there is no variable @code{last_char}---the display is disabled
7853 automatically. The next time your program stops where @code{last_char}
7854 is meaningful, you can enable the display expression once again.
7855
7856 @node Print Settings
7857 @section Print Settings
7858
7859 @cindex format options
7860 @cindex print settings
7861 @value{GDBN} provides the following ways to control how arrays, structures,
7862 and symbols are printed.
7863
7864 @noindent
7865 These settings are useful for debugging programs in any language:
7866
7867 @table @code
7868 @kindex set print
7869 @item set print address
7870 @itemx set print address on
7871 @cindex print/don't print memory addresses
7872 @value{GDBN} prints memory addresses showing the location of stack
7873 traces, structure values, pointer values, breakpoints, and so forth,
7874 even when it also displays the contents of those addresses. The default
7875 is @code{on}. For example, this is what a stack frame display looks like with
7876 @code{set print address on}:
7877
7878 @smallexample
7879 @group
7880 (@value{GDBP}) f
7881 #0 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<<", rq=0x34c88 ">>")
7882 at input.c:530
7883 530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
7884 @end group
7885 @end smallexample
7886
7887 @item set print address off
7888 Do not print addresses when displaying their contents. For example,
7889 this is the same stack frame displayed with @code{set print address off}:
7890
7891 @smallexample
7892 @group
7893 (@value{GDBP}) set print addr off
7894 (@value{GDBP}) f
7895 #0 set_quotes (lq="<<", rq=">>") at input.c:530
7896 530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
7897 @end group
7898 @end smallexample
7899
7900 You can use @samp{set print address off} to eliminate all machine
7901 dependent displays from the @value{GDBN} interface. For example, with
7902 @code{print address off}, you should get the same text for backtraces on
7903 all machines---whether or not they involve pointer arguments.
7904
7905 @kindex show print
7906 @item show print address
7907 Show whether or not addresses are to be printed.
7908 @end table
7909
7910 When @value{GDBN} prints a symbolic address, it normally prints the
7911 closest earlier symbol plus an offset. If that symbol does not uniquely
7912 identify the address (for example, it is a name whose scope is a single
7913 source file), you may need to clarify. One way to do this is with
7914 @code{info line}, for example @samp{info line *0x4537}. Alternately,
7915 you can set @value{GDBN} to print the source file and line number when
7916 it prints a symbolic address:
7917
7918 @table @code
7919 @item set print symbol-filename on
7920 @cindex source file and line of a symbol
7921 @cindex symbol, source file and line
7922 Tell @value{GDBN} to print the source file name and line number of a
7923 symbol in the symbolic form of an address.
7924
7925 @item set print symbol-filename off
7926 Do not print source file name and line number of a symbol. This is the
7927 default.
7928
7929 @item show print symbol-filename
7930 Show whether or not @value{GDBN} will print the source file name and
7931 line number of a symbol in the symbolic form of an address.
7932 @end table
7933
7934 Another situation where it is helpful to show symbol filenames and line
7935 numbers is when disassembling code; @value{GDBN} shows you the line
7936 number and source file that corresponds to each instruction.
7937
7938 Also, you may wish to see the symbolic form only if the address being
7939 printed is reasonably close to the closest earlier symbol:
7940
7941 @table @code
7942 @item set print max-symbolic-offset @var{max-offset}
7943 @cindex maximum value for offset of closest symbol
7944 Tell @value{GDBN} to only display the symbolic form of an address if the
7945 offset between the closest earlier symbol and the address is less than
7946 @var{max-offset}. The default is 0, which tells @value{GDBN}
7947 to always print the symbolic form of an address if any symbol precedes it.
7948
7949 @item show print max-symbolic-offset
7950 Ask how large the maximum offset is that @value{GDBN} prints in a
7951 symbolic address.
7952 @end table
7953
7954 @cindex wild pointer, interpreting
7955 @cindex pointer, finding referent
7956 If you have a pointer and you are not sure where it points, try
7957 @samp{set print symbol-filename on}. Then you can determine the name
7958 and source file location of the variable where it points, using
7959 @samp{p/a @var{pointer}}. This interprets the address in symbolic form.
7960 For example, here @value{GDBN} shows that a variable @code{ptt} points
7961 at another variable @code{t}, defined in @file{hi2.c}:
7962
7963 @smallexample
7964 (@value{GDBP}) set print symbol-filename on
7965 (@value{GDBP}) p/a ptt
7966 $4 = 0xe008 <t in hi2.c>
7967 @end smallexample
7968
7969 @quotation
7970 @emph{Warning:} For pointers that point to a local variable, @samp{p/a}
7971 does not show the symbol name and filename of the referent, even with
7972 the appropriate @code{set print} options turned on.
7973 @end quotation
7974
7975 Other settings control how different kinds of objects are printed:
7976
7977 @table @code
7978 @item set print array
7979 @itemx set print array on
7980 @cindex pretty print arrays
7981 Pretty print arrays. This format is more convenient to read,
7982 but uses more space. The default is off.
7983
7984 @item set print array off
7985 Return to compressed format for arrays.
7986
7987 @item show print array
7988 Show whether compressed or pretty format is selected for displaying
7989 arrays.
7990
7991 @cindex print array indexes
7992 @item set print array-indexes
7993 @itemx set print array-indexes on
7994 Print the index of each element when displaying arrays. May be more
7995 convenient to locate a given element in the array or quickly find the
7996 index of a given element in that printed array. The default is off.
7997
7998 @item set print array-indexes off
7999 Stop printing element indexes when displaying arrays.
8000
8001 @item show print array-indexes
8002 Show whether the index of each element is printed when displaying
8003 arrays.
8004
8005 @item set print elements @var{number-of-elements}
8006 @cindex number of array elements to print
8007 @cindex limit on number of printed array elements
8008 Set a limit on how many elements of an array @value{GDBN} will print.
8009 If @value{GDBN} is printing a large array, it stops printing after it has
8010 printed the number of elements set by the @code{set print elements} command.
8011 This limit also applies to the display of strings.
8012 When @value{GDBN} starts, this limit is set to 200.
8013 Setting @var{number-of-elements} to zero means that the printing is unlimited.
8014
8015 @item show print elements
8016 Display the number of elements of a large array that @value{GDBN} will print.
8017 If the number is 0, then the printing is unlimited.
8018
8019 @item set print frame-arguments @var{value}
8020 @kindex set print frame-arguments
8021 @cindex printing frame argument values
8022 @cindex print all frame argument values
8023 @cindex print frame argument values for scalars only
8024 @cindex do not print frame argument values
8025 This command allows to control how the values of arguments are printed
8026 when the debugger prints a frame (@pxref{Frames}). The possible
8027 values are:
8028
8029 @table @code
8030 @item all
8031 The values of all arguments are printed.
8032
8033 @item scalars
8034 Print the value of an argument only if it is a scalar. The value of more
8035 complex arguments such as arrays, structures, unions, etc, is replaced
8036 by @code{@dots{}}. This is the default. Here is an example where
8037 only scalar arguments are shown:
8038
8039 @smallexample
8040 #1 0x08048361 in call_me (i=3, s=@dots{}, ss=0xbf8d508c, u=@dots{}, e=green)
8041 at frame-args.c:23
8042 @end smallexample
8043
8044 @item none
8045 None of the argument values are printed. Instead, the value of each argument
8046 is replaced by @code{@dots{}}. In this case, the example above now becomes:
8047
8048 @smallexample
8049 #1 0x08048361 in call_me (i=@dots{}, s=@dots{}, ss=@dots{}, u=@dots{}, e=@dots{})
8050 at frame-args.c:23
8051 @end smallexample
8052 @end table
8053
8054 By default, only scalar arguments are printed. This command can be used
8055 to configure the debugger to print the value of all arguments, regardless
8056 of their type. However, it is often advantageous to not print the value
8057 of more complex parameters. For instance, it reduces the amount of
8058 information printed in each frame, making the backtrace more readable.
8059 Also, it improves performance when displaying Ada frames, because
8060 the computation of large arguments can sometimes be CPU-intensive,
8061 especially in large applications. Setting @code{print frame-arguments}
8062 to @code{scalars} (the default) or @code{none} avoids this computation,
8063 thus speeding up the display of each Ada frame.
8064
8065 @item show print frame-arguments
8066 Show how the value of arguments should be displayed when printing a frame.
8067
8068 @anchor{set print entry-values}
8069 @item set print entry-values @var{value}
8070 @kindex set print entry-values
8071 Set printing of frame argument values at function entry. In some cases
8072 @value{GDBN} can determine the value of function argument which was passed by
8073 the function caller, even if the value was modified inside the called function
8074 and therefore is different. With optimized code, the current value could be
8075 unavailable, but the entry value may still be known.
8076
8077 The default value is @code{default} (see below for its description). Older
8078 @value{GDBN} behaved as with the setting @code{no}. Compilers not supporting
8079 this feature will behave in the @code{default} setting the same way as with the
8080 @code{no} setting.
8081
8082 This functionality is currently supported only by DWARF 2 debugging format and
8083 the compiler has to produce @samp{DW_TAG_GNU_call_site} tags. With
8084 @value{NGCC}, you need to specify @option{-O -g} during compilation, to get
8085 this information.
8086
8087 The @var{value} parameter can be one of the following:
8088
8089 @table @code
8090 @item no
8091 Print only actual parameter values, never print values from function entry
8092 point.
8093 @smallexample
8094 #0 equal (val=5)
8095 #0 different (val=6)
8096 #0 lost (val=<optimized out>)
8097 #0 born (val=10)
8098 #0 invalid (val=<optimized out>)
8099 @end smallexample
8100
8101 @item only
8102 Print only parameter values from function entry point. The actual parameter
8103 values are never printed.
8104 @smallexample
8105 #0 equal (val@@entry=5)
8106 #0 different (val@@entry=5)
8107 #0 lost (val@@entry=5)
8108 #0 born (val@@entry=<optimized out>)
8109 #0 invalid (val@@entry=<optimized out>)
8110 @end smallexample
8111
8112 @item preferred
8113 Print only parameter values from function entry point. If value from function
8114 entry point is not known while the actual value is known, print the actual
8115 value for such parameter.
8116 @smallexample
8117 #0 equal (val@@entry=5)
8118 #0 different (val@@entry=5)
8119 #0 lost (val@@entry=5)
8120 #0 born (val=10)
8121 #0 invalid (val@@entry=<optimized out>)
8122 @end smallexample
8123
8124 @item if-needed
8125 Print actual parameter values. If actual parameter value is not known while
8126 value from function entry point is known, print the entry point value for such
8127 parameter.
8128 @smallexample
8129 #0 equal (val=5)
8130 #0 different (val=6)
8131 #0 lost (val@@entry=5)
8132 #0 born (val=10)
8133 #0 invalid (val=<optimized out>)
8134 @end smallexample
8135
8136 @item both
8137 Always print both the actual parameter value and its value from function entry
8138 point, even if values of one or both are not available due to compiler
8139 optimizations.
8140 @smallexample
8141 #0 equal (val=5, val@@entry=5)
8142 #0 different (val=6, val@@entry=5)
8143 #0 lost (val=<optimized out>, val@@entry=5)
8144 #0 born (val=10, val@@entry=<optimized out>)
8145 #0 invalid (val=<optimized out>, val@@entry=<optimized out>)
8146 @end smallexample
8147
8148 @item compact
8149 Print the actual parameter value if it is known and also its value from
8150 function entry point if it is known. If neither is known, print for the actual
8151 value @code{<optimized out>}. If not in MI mode (@pxref{GDB/MI}) and if both
8152 values are known and identical, print the shortened
8153 @code{param=param@@entry=VALUE} notation.
8154 @smallexample
8155 #0 equal (val=val@@entry=5)
8156 #0 different (val=6, val@@entry=5)
8157 #0 lost (val@@entry=5)
8158 #0 born (val=10)
8159 #0 invalid (val=<optimized out>)
8160 @end smallexample
8161
8162 @item default
8163 Always print the actual parameter value. Print also its value from function
8164 entry point, but only if it is known. If not in MI mode (@pxref{GDB/MI}) and
8165 if both values are known and identical, print the shortened
8166 @code{param=param@@entry=VALUE} notation.
8167 @smallexample
8168 #0 equal (val=val@@entry=5)
8169 #0 different (val=6, val@@entry=5)
8170 #0 lost (val=<optimized out>, val@@entry=5)
8171 #0 born (val=10)
8172 #0 invalid (val=<optimized out>)
8173 @end smallexample
8174 @end table
8175
8176 For analysis messages on possible failures of frame argument values at function
8177 entry resolution see @ref{set debug entry-values}.
8178
8179 @item show print entry-values
8180 Show the method being used for printing of frame argument values at function
8181 entry.
8182
8183 @item set print repeats
8184 @cindex repeated array elements
8185 Set the threshold for suppressing display of repeated array
8186 elements. When the number of consecutive identical elements of an
8187 array exceeds the threshold, @value{GDBN} prints the string
8188 @code{"<repeats @var{n} times>"}, where @var{n} is the number of
8189 identical repetitions, instead of displaying the identical elements
8190 themselves. Setting the threshold to zero will cause all elements to
8191 be individually printed. The default threshold is 10.
8192
8193 @item show print repeats
8194 Display the current threshold for printing repeated identical
8195 elements.
8196
8197 @item set print null-stop
8198 @cindex @sc{null} elements in arrays
8199 Cause @value{GDBN} to stop printing the characters of an array when the first
8200 @sc{null} is encountered. This is useful when large arrays actually
8201 contain only short strings.
8202 The default is off.
8203
8204 @item show print null-stop
8205 Show whether @value{GDBN} stops printing an array on the first
8206 @sc{null} character.
8207
8208 @item set print pretty on
8209 @cindex print structures in indented form
8210 @cindex indentation in structure display
8211 Cause @value{GDBN} to print structures in an indented format with one member
8212 per line, like this:
8213
8214 @smallexample
8215 @group
8216 $1 = @{
8217 next = 0x0,
8218 flags = @{
8219 sweet = 1,
8220 sour = 1
8221 @},
8222 meat = 0x54 "Pork"
8223 @}
8224 @end group
8225 @end smallexample
8226
8227 @item set print pretty off
8228 Cause @value{GDBN} to print structures in a compact format, like this:
8229
8230 @smallexample
8231 @group
8232 $1 = @{next = 0x0, flags = @{sweet = 1, sour = 1@}, \
8233 meat = 0x54 "Pork"@}
8234 @end group
8235 @end smallexample
8236
8237 @noindent
8238 This is the default format.
8239
8240 @item show print pretty
8241 Show which format @value{GDBN} is using to print structures.
8242
8243 @item set print sevenbit-strings on
8244 @cindex eight-bit characters in strings
8245 @cindex octal escapes in strings
8246 Print using only seven-bit characters; if this option is set,
8247 @value{GDBN} displays any eight-bit characters (in strings or
8248 character values) using the notation @code{\}@var{nnn}. This setting is
8249 best if you are working in English (@sc{ascii}) and you use the
8250 high-order bit of characters as a marker or ``meta'' bit.
8251
8252 @item set print sevenbit-strings off
8253 Print full eight-bit characters. This allows the use of more
8254 international character sets, and is the default.
8255
8256 @item show print sevenbit-strings
8257 Show whether or not @value{GDBN} is printing only seven-bit characters.
8258
8259 @item set print union on
8260 @cindex unions in structures, printing
8261 Tell @value{GDBN} to print unions which are contained in structures
8262 and other unions. This is the default setting.
8263
8264 @item set print union off
8265 Tell @value{GDBN} not to print unions which are contained in
8266 structures and other unions. @value{GDBN} will print @code{"@{...@}"}
8267 instead.
8268
8269 @item show print union
8270 Ask @value{GDBN} whether or not it will print unions which are contained in
8271 structures and other unions.
8272
8273 For example, given the declarations
8274
8275 @smallexample
8276 typedef enum @{Tree, Bug@} Species;
8277 typedef enum @{Big_tree, Acorn, Seedling@} Tree_forms;
8278 typedef enum @{Caterpillar, Cocoon, Butterfly@}
8279 Bug_forms;
8280
8281 struct thing @{
8282 Species it;
8283 union @{
8284 Tree_forms tree;
8285 Bug_forms bug;
8286 @} form;
8287 @};
8288
8289 struct thing foo = @{Tree, @{Acorn@}@};
8290 @end smallexample
8291
8292 @noindent
8293 with @code{set print union on} in effect @samp{p foo} would print
8294
8295 @smallexample
8296 $1 = @{it = Tree, form = @{tree = Acorn, bug = Cocoon@}@}
8297 @end smallexample
8298
8299 @noindent
8300 and with @code{set print union off} in effect it would print
8301
8302 @smallexample
8303 $1 = @{it = Tree, form = @{...@}@}
8304 @end smallexample
8305
8306 @noindent
8307 @code{set print union} affects programs written in C-like languages
8308 and in Pascal.
8309 @end table
8310
8311 @need 1000
8312 @noindent
8313 These settings are of interest when debugging C@t{++} programs:
8314
8315 @table @code
8316 @cindex demangling C@t{++} names
8317 @item set print demangle
8318 @itemx set print demangle on
8319 Print C@t{++} names in their source form rather than in the encoded
8320 (``mangled'') form passed to the assembler and linker for type-safe
8321 linkage. The default is on.
8322
8323 @item show print demangle
8324 Show whether C@t{++} names are printed in mangled or demangled form.
8325
8326 @item set print asm-demangle
8327 @itemx set print asm-demangle on
8328 Print C@t{++} names in their source form rather than their mangled form, even
8329 in assembler code printouts such as instruction disassemblies.
8330 The default is off.
8331
8332 @item show print asm-demangle
8333 Show whether C@t{++} names in assembly listings are printed in mangled
8334 or demangled form.
8335
8336 @cindex C@t{++} symbol decoding style
8337 @cindex symbol decoding style, C@t{++}
8338 @kindex set demangle-style
8339 @item set demangle-style @var{style}
8340 Choose among several encoding schemes used by different compilers to
8341 represent C@t{++} names. The choices for @var{style} are currently:
8342
8343 @table @code
8344 @item auto
8345 Allow @value{GDBN} to choose a decoding style by inspecting your program.
8346
8347 @item gnu
8348 Decode based on the @sc{gnu} C@t{++} compiler (@code{g++}) encoding algorithm.
8349 This is the default.
8350
8351 @item hp
8352 Decode based on the HP ANSI C@t{++} (@code{aCC}) encoding algorithm.
8353
8354 @item lucid
8355 Decode based on the Lucid C@t{++} compiler (@code{lcc}) encoding algorithm.
8356
8357 @item arm
8358 Decode using the algorithm in the @cite{C@t{++} Annotated Reference Manual}.
8359 @strong{Warning:} this setting alone is not sufficient to allow
8360 debugging @code{cfront}-generated executables. @value{GDBN} would
8361 require further enhancement to permit that.
8362
8363 @end table
8364 If you omit @var{style}, you will see a list of possible formats.
8365
8366 @item show demangle-style
8367 Display the encoding style currently in use for decoding C@t{++} symbols.
8368
8369 @item set print object
8370 @itemx set print object on
8371 @cindex derived type of an object, printing
8372 @cindex display derived types
8373 When displaying a pointer to an object, identify the @emph{actual}
8374 (derived) type of the object rather than the @emph{declared} type, using
8375 the virtual function table. Note that the virtual function table is
8376 required---this feature can only work for objects that have run-time
8377 type identification; a single virtual method in the object's declared
8378 type is sufficient.
8379
8380 @item set print object off
8381 Display only the declared type of objects, without reference to the
8382 virtual function table. This is the default setting.
8383
8384 @item show print object
8385 Show whether actual, or declared, object types are displayed.
8386
8387 @item set print static-members
8388 @itemx set print static-members on
8389 @cindex static members of C@t{++} objects
8390 Print static members when displaying a C@t{++} object. The default is on.
8391
8392 @item set print static-members off
8393 Do not print static members when displaying a C@t{++} object.
8394
8395 @item show print static-members
8396 Show whether C@t{++} static members are printed or not.
8397
8398 @item set print pascal_static-members
8399 @itemx set print pascal_static-members on
8400 @cindex static members of Pascal objects
8401 @cindex Pascal objects, static members display
8402 Print static members when displaying a Pascal object. The default is on.
8403
8404 @item set print pascal_static-members off
8405 Do not print static members when displaying a Pascal object.
8406
8407 @item show print pascal_static-members
8408 Show whether Pascal static members are printed or not.
8409
8410 @c These don't work with HP ANSI C++ yet.
8411 @item set print vtbl
8412 @itemx set print vtbl on
8413 @cindex pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables
8414 @cindex virtual functions (C@t{++}) display
8415 @cindex VTBL display
8416 Pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables. The default is off.
8417 (The @code{vtbl} commands do not work on programs compiled with the HP
8418 ANSI C@t{++} compiler (@code{aCC}).)
8419
8420 @item set print vtbl off
8421 Do not pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables.
8422
8423 @item show print vtbl
8424 Show whether C@t{++} virtual function tables are pretty printed, or not.
8425 @end table
8426
8427 @node Pretty Printing
8428 @section Pretty Printing
8429
8430 @value{GDBN} provides a mechanism to allow pretty-printing of values using
8431 Python code. It greatly simplifies the display of complex objects. This
8432 mechanism works for both MI and the CLI.
8433
8434 @menu
8435 * Pretty-Printer Introduction:: Introduction to pretty-printers
8436 * Pretty-Printer Example:: An example pretty-printer
8437 * Pretty-Printer Commands:: Pretty-printer commands
8438 @end menu
8439
8440 @node Pretty-Printer Introduction
8441 @subsection Pretty-Printer Introduction
8442
8443 When @value{GDBN} prints a value, it first sees if there is a pretty-printer
8444 registered for the value. If there is then @value{GDBN} invokes the
8445 pretty-printer to print the value. Otherwise the value is printed normally.
8446
8447 Pretty-printers are normally named. This makes them easy to manage.
8448 The @samp{info pretty-printer} command will list all the installed
8449 pretty-printers with their names.
8450 If a pretty-printer can handle multiple data types, then its
8451 @dfn{subprinters} are the printers for the individual data types.
8452 Each such subprinter has its own name.
8453 The format of the name is @var{printer-name};@var{subprinter-name}.
8454
8455 Pretty-printers are installed by @dfn{registering} them with @value{GDBN}.
8456 Typically they are automatically loaded and registered when the corresponding
8457 debug information is loaded, thus making them available without having to
8458 do anything special.
8459
8460 There are three places where a pretty-printer can be registered.
8461
8462 @itemize @bullet
8463 @item
8464 Pretty-printers registered globally are available when debugging
8465 all inferiors.
8466
8467 @item
8468 Pretty-printers registered with a program space are available only
8469 when debugging that program.
8470 @xref{Progspaces In Python}, for more details on program spaces in Python.
8471
8472 @item
8473 Pretty-printers registered with an objfile are loaded and unloaded
8474 with the corresponding objfile (e.g., shared library).
8475 @xref{Objfiles In Python}, for more details on objfiles in Python.
8476 @end itemize
8477
8478 @xref{Selecting Pretty-Printers}, for further information on how
8479 pretty-printers are selected,
8480
8481 @xref{Writing a Pretty-Printer}, for implementing pretty printers
8482 for new types.
8483
8484 @node Pretty-Printer Example
8485 @subsection Pretty-Printer Example
8486
8487 Here is how a C@t{++} @code{std::string} looks without a pretty-printer:
8488
8489 @smallexample
8490 (@value{GDBP}) print s
8491 $1 = @{
8492 static npos = 4294967295,
8493 _M_dataplus = @{
8494 <std::allocator<char>> = @{
8495 <__gnu_cxx::new_allocator<char>> = @{
8496 <No data fields>@}, <No data fields>
8497 @},
8498 members of std::basic_string<char, std::char_traits<char>,
8499 std::allocator<char> >::_Alloc_hider:
8500 _M_p = 0x804a014 "abcd"
8501 @}
8502 @}
8503 @end smallexample
8504
8505 With a pretty-printer for @code{std::string} only the contents are printed:
8506
8507 @smallexample
8508 (@value{GDBP}) print s
8509 $2 = "abcd"
8510 @end smallexample
8511
8512 @node Pretty-Printer Commands
8513 @subsection Pretty-Printer Commands
8514 @cindex pretty-printer commands
8515
8516 @table @code
8517 @kindex info pretty-printer
8518 @item info pretty-printer [@var{object-regexp} [@var{name-regexp}]]
8519 Print the list of installed pretty-printers.
8520 This includes disabled pretty-printers, which are marked as such.
8521
8522 @var{object-regexp} is a regular expression matching the objects
8523 whose pretty-printers to list.
8524 Objects can be @code{global}, the program space's file
8525 (@pxref{Progspaces In Python}),
8526 and the object files within that program space (@pxref{Objfiles In Python}).
8527 @xref{Selecting Pretty-Printers}, for details on how @value{GDBN}
8528 looks up a printer from these three objects.
8529
8530 @var{name-regexp} is a regular expression matching the name of the printers
8531 to list.
8532
8533 @kindex disable pretty-printer
8534 @item disable pretty-printer [@var{object-regexp} [@var{name-regexp}]]
8535 Disable pretty-printers matching @var{object-regexp} and @var{name-regexp}.
8536 A disabled pretty-printer is not forgotten, it may be enabled again later.
8537
8538 @kindex enable pretty-printer
8539 @item enable pretty-printer [@var{object-regexp} [@var{name-regexp}]]
8540 Enable pretty-printers matching @var{object-regexp} and @var{name-regexp}.
8541 @end table
8542
8543 Example:
8544
8545 Suppose we have three pretty-printers installed: one from library1.so
8546 named @code{foo} that prints objects of type @code{foo}, and
8547 another from library2.so named @code{bar} that prints two types of objects,
8548 @code{bar1} and @code{bar2}.
8549
8550 @smallexample
8551 (gdb) info pretty-printer
8552 library1.so:
8553 foo
8554 library2.so:
8555 bar
8556 bar1
8557 bar2
8558 (gdb) info pretty-printer library2
8559 library2.so:
8560 bar
8561 bar1
8562 bar2
8563 (gdb) disable pretty-printer library1
8564 1 printer disabled
8565 2 of 3 printers enabled
8566 (gdb) info pretty-printer
8567 library1.so:
8568 foo [disabled]
8569 library2.so:
8570 bar
8571 bar1
8572 bar2
8573 (gdb) disable pretty-printer library2 bar:bar1
8574 1 printer disabled
8575 1 of 3 printers enabled
8576 (gdb) info pretty-printer library2
8577 library1.so:
8578 foo [disabled]
8579 library2.so:
8580 bar
8581 bar1 [disabled]
8582 bar2
8583 (gdb) disable pretty-printer library2 bar
8584 1 printer disabled
8585 0 of 3 printers enabled
8586 (gdb) info pretty-printer library2
8587 library1.so:
8588 foo [disabled]
8589 library2.so:
8590 bar [disabled]
8591 bar1 [disabled]
8592 bar2
8593 @end smallexample
8594
8595 Note that for @code{bar} the entire printer can be disabled,
8596 as can each individual subprinter.
8597
8598 @node Value History
8599 @section Value History
8600
8601 @cindex value history
8602 @cindex history of values printed by @value{GDBN}
8603 Values printed by the @code{print} command are saved in the @value{GDBN}
8604 @dfn{value history}. This allows you to refer to them in other expressions.
8605 Values are kept until the symbol table is re-read or discarded
8606 (for example with the @code{file} or @code{symbol-file} commands).
8607 When the symbol table changes, the value history is discarded,
8608 since the values may contain pointers back to the types defined in the
8609 symbol table.
8610
8611 @cindex @code{$}
8612 @cindex @code{$$}
8613 @cindex history number
8614 The values printed are given @dfn{history numbers} by which you can
8615 refer to them. These are successive integers starting with one.
8616 @code{print} shows you the history number assigned to a value by
8617 printing @samp{$@var{num} = } before the value; here @var{num} is the
8618 history number.
8619
8620 To refer to any previous value, use @samp{$} followed by the value's
8621 history number. The way @code{print} labels its output is designed to
8622 remind you of this. Just @code{$} refers to the most recent value in
8623 the history, and @code{$$} refers to the value before that.
8624 @code{$$@var{n}} refers to the @var{n}th value from the end; @code{$$2}
8625 is the value just prior to @code{$$}, @code{$$1} is equivalent to
8626 @code{$$}, and @code{$$0} is equivalent to @code{$}.
8627
8628 For example, suppose you have just printed a pointer to a structure and
8629 want to see the contents of the structure. It suffices to type
8630
8631 @smallexample
8632 p *$
8633 @end smallexample
8634
8635 If you have a chain of structures where the component @code{next} points
8636 to the next one, you can print the contents of the next one with this:
8637
8638 @smallexample
8639 p *$.next
8640 @end smallexample
8641
8642 @noindent
8643 You can print successive links in the chain by repeating this
8644 command---which you can do by just typing @key{RET}.
8645
8646 Note that the history records values, not expressions. If the value of
8647 @code{x} is 4 and you type these commands:
8648
8649 @smallexample
8650 print x
8651 set x=5
8652 @end smallexample
8653
8654 @noindent
8655 then the value recorded in the value history by the @code{print} command
8656 remains 4 even though the value of @code{x} has changed.
8657
8658 @table @code
8659 @kindex show values
8660 @item show values
8661 Print the last ten values in the value history, with their item numbers.
8662 This is like @samp{p@ $$9} repeated ten times, except that @code{show
8663 values} does not change the history.
8664
8665 @item show values @var{n}
8666 Print ten history values centered on history item number @var{n}.
8667
8668 @item show values +
8669 Print ten history values just after the values last printed. If no more
8670 values are available, @code{show values +} produces no display.
8671 @end table
8672
8673 Pressing @key{RET} to repeat @code{show values @var{n}} has exactly the
8674 same effect as @samp{show values +}.
8675
8676 @node Convenience Vars
8677 @section Convenience Variables
8678
8679 @cindex convenience variables
8680 @cindex user-defined variables
8681 @value{GDBN} provides @dfn{convenience variables} that you can use within
8682 @value{GDBN} to hold on to a value and refer to it later. These variables
8683 exist entirely within @value{GDBN}; they are not part of your program, and
8684 setting a convenience variable has no direct effect on further execution
8685 of your program. That is why you can use them freely.
8686
8687 Convenience variables are prefixed with @samp{$}. Any name preceded by
8688 @samp{$} can be used for a convenience variable, unless it is one of
8689 the predefined machine-specific register names (@pxref{Registers, ,Registers}).
8690 (Value history references, in contrast, are @emph{numbers} preceded
8691 by @samp{$}. @xref{Value History, ,Value History}.)
8692
8693 You can save a value in a convenience variable with an assignment
8694 expression, just as you would set a variable in your program.
8695 For example:
8696
8697 @smallexample
8698 set $foo = *object_ptr
8699 @end smallexample
8700
8701 @noindent
8702 would save in @code{$foo} the value contained in the object pointed to by
8703 @code{object_ptr}.
8704
8705 Using a convenience variable for the first time creates it, but its
8706 value is @code{void} until you assign a new value. You can alter the
8707 value with another assignment at any time.
8708
8709 Convenience variables have no fixed types. You can assign a convenience
8710 variable any type of value, including structures and arrays, even if
8711 that variable already has a value of a different type. The convenience
8712 variable, when used as an expression, has the type of its current value.
8713
8714 @table @code
8715 @kindex show convenience
8716 @cindex show all user variables
8717 @item show convenience
8718 Print a list of convenience variables used so far, and their values.
8719 Abbreviated @code{show conv}.
8720
8721 @kindex init-if-undefined
8722 @cindex convenience variables, initializing
8723 @item init-if-undefined $@var{variable} = @var{expression}
8724 Set a convenience variable if it has not already been set. This is useful
8725 for user-defined commands that keep some state. It is similar, in concept,
8726 to using local static variables with initializers in C (except that
8727 convenience variables are global). It can also be used to allow users to
8728 override default values used in a command script.
8729
8730 If the variable is already defined then the expression is not evaluated so
8731 any side-effects do not occur.
8732 @end table
8733
8734 One of the ways to use a convenience variable is as a counter to be
8735 incremented or a pointer to be advanced. For example, to print
8736 a field from successive elements of an array of structures:
8737
8738 @smallexample
8739 set $i = 0
8740 print bar[$i++]->contents
8741 @end smallexample
8742
8743 @noindent
8744 Repeat that command by typing @key{RET}.
8745
8746 Some convenience variables are created automatically by @value{GDBN} and given
8747 values likely to be useful.
8748
8749 @table @code
8750 @vindex $_@r{, convenience variable}
8751 @item $_
8752 The variable @code{$_} is automatically set by the @code{x} command to
8753 the last address examined (@pxref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}). Other
8754 commands which provide a default address for @code{x} to examine also
8755 set @code{$_} to that address; these commands include @code{info line}
8756 and @code{info breakpoint}. The type of @code{$_} is @code{void *}
8757 except when set by the @code{x} command, in which case it is a pointer
8758 to the type of @code{$__}.
8759
8760 @vindex $__@r{, convenience variable}
8761 @item $__
8762 The variable @code{$__} is automatically set by the @code{x} command
8763 to the value found in the last address examined. Its type is chosen
8764 to match the format in which the data was printed.
8765
8766 @item $_exitcode
8767 @vindex $_exitcode@r{, convenience variable}
8768 The variable @code{$_exitcode} is automatically set to the exit code when
8769 the program being debugged terminates.
8770
8771 @item $_sdata
8772 @vindex $_sdata@r{, inspect, convenience variable}
8773 The variable @code{$_sdata} contains extra collected static tracepoint
8774 data. @xref{Tracepoint Actions,,Tracepoint Action Lists}. Note that
8775 @code{$_sdata} could be empty, if not inspecting a trace buffer, or
8776 if extra static tracepoint data has not been collected.
8777
8778 @item $_siginfo
8779 @vindex $_siginfo@r{, convenience variable}
8780 The variable @code{$_siginfo} contains extra signal information
8781 (@pxref{extra signal information}). Note that @code{$_siginfo}
8782 could be empty, if the application has not yet received any signals.
8783 For example, it will be empty before you execute the @code{run} command.
8784
8785 @item $_tlb
8786 @vindex $_tlb@r{, convenience variable}
8787 The variable @code{$_tlb} is automatically set when debugging
8788 applications running on MS-Windows in native mode or connected to
8789 gdbserver that supports the @code{qGetTIBAddr} request.
8790 @xref{General Query Packets}.
8791 This variable contains the address of the thread information block.
8792
8793 @end table
8794
8795 On HP-UX systems, if you refer to a function or variable name that
8796 begins with a dollar sign, @value{GDBN} searches for a user or system
8797 name first, before it searches for a convenience variable.
8798
8799 @cindex convenience functions
8800 @value{GDBN} also supplies some @dfn{convenience functions}. These
8801 have a syntax similar to convenience variables. A convenience
8802 function can be used in an expression just like an ordinary function;
8803 however, a convenience function is implemented internally to
8804 @value{GDBN}.
8805
8806 @table @code
8807 @item help function
8808 @kindex help function
8809 @cindex show all convenience functions
8810 Print a list of all convenience functions.
8811 @end table
8812
8813 @node Registers
8814 @section Registers
8815
8816 @cindex registers
8817 You can refer to machine register contents, in expressions, as variables
8818 with names starting with @samp{$}. The names of registers are different
8819 for each machine; use @code{info registers} to see the names used on
8820 your machine.
8821
8822 @table @code
8823 @kindex info registers
8824 @item info registers
8825 Print the names and values of all registers except floating-point
8826 and vector registers (in the selected stack frame).
8827
8828 @kindex info all-registers
8829 @cindex floating point registers
8830 @item info all-registers
8831 Print the names and values of all registers, including floating-point
8832 and vector registers (in the selected stack frame).
8833
8834 @item info registers @var{regname} @dots{}
8835 Print the @dfn{relativized} value of each specified register @var{regname}.
8836 As discussed in detail below, register values are normally relative to
8837 the selected stack frame. @var{regname} may be any register name valid on
8838 the machine you are using, with or without the initial @samp{$}.
8839 @end table
8840
8841 @cindex stack pointer register
8842 @cindex program counter register
8843 @cindex process status register
8844 @cindex frame pointer register
8845 @cindex standard registers
8846 @value{GDBN} has four ``standard'' register names that are available (in
8847 expressions) on most machines---whenever they do not conflict with an
8848 architecture's canonical mnemonics for registers. The register names
8849 @code{$pc} and @code{$sp} are used for the program counter register and
8850 the stack pointer. @code{$fp} is used for a register that contains a
8851 pointer to the current stack frame, and @code{$ps} is used for a
8852 register that contains the processor status. For example,
8853 you could print the program counter in hex with
8854
8855 @smallexample
8856 p/x $pc
8857 @end smallexample
8858
8859 @noindent
8860 or print the instruction to be executed next with
8861
8862 @smallexample
8863 x/i $pc
8864 @end smallexample
8865
8866 @noindent
8867 or add four to the stack pointer@footnote{This is a way of removing
8868 one word from the stack, on machines where stacks grow downward in
8869 memory (most machines, nowadays). This assumes that the innermost
8870 stack frame is selected; setting @code{$sp} is not allowed when other
8871 stack frames are selected. To pop entire frames off the stack,
8872 regardless of machine architecture, use @code{return};
8873 see @ref{Returning, ,Returning from a Function}.} with
8874
8875 @smallexample
8876 set $sp += 4
8877 @end smallexample
8878
8879 Whenever possible, these four standard register names are available on
8880 your machine even though the machine has different canonical mnemonics,
8881 so long as there is no conflict. The @code{info registers} command
8882 shows the canonical names. For example, on the SPARC, @code{info
8883 registers} displays the processor status register as @code{$psr} but you
8884 can also refer to it as @code{$ps}; and on x86-based machines @code{$ps}
8885 is an alias for the @sc{eflags} register.
8886
8887 @value{GDBN} always considers the contents of an ordinary register as an
8888 integer when the register is examined in this way. Some machines have
8889 special registers which can hold nothing but floating point; these
8890 registers are considered to have floating point values. There is no way
8891 to refer to the contents of an ordinary register as floating point value
8892 (although you can @emph{print} it as a floating point value with
8893 @samp{print/f $@var{regname}}).
8894
8895 Some registers have distinct ``raw'' and ``virtual'' data formats. This
8896 means that the data format in which the register contents are saved by
8897 the operating system is not the same one that your program normally
8898 sees. For example, the registers of the 68881 floating point
8899 coprocessor are always saved in ``extended'' (raw) format, but all C
8900 programs expect to work with ``double'' (virtual) format. In such
8901 cases, @value{GDBN} normally works with the virtual format only (the format
8902 that makes sense for your program), but the @code{info registers} command
8903 prints the data in both formats.
8904
8905 @cindex SSE registers (x86)
8906 @cindex MMX registers (x86)
8907 Some machines have special registers whose contents can be interpreted
8908 in several different ways. For example, modern x86-based machines
8909 have SSE and MMX registers that can hold several values packed
8910 together in several different formats. @value{GDBN} refers to such
8911 registers in @code{struct} notation:
8912
8913 @smallexample
8914 (@value{GDBP}) print $xmm1
8915 $1 = @{
8916 v4_float = @{0, 3.43859137e-038, 1.54142831e-044, 1.821688e-044@},
8917 v2_double = @{9.92129282474342e-303, 2.7585945287983262e-313@},
8918 v16_int8 = "\000\000\000\000\3706;\001\v\000\000\000\r\000\000",
8919 v8_int16 = @{0, 0, 14072, 315, 11, 0, 13, 0@},
8920 v4_int32 = @{0, 20657912, 11, 13@},
8921 v2_int64 = @{88725056443645952, 55834574859@},
8922 uint128 = 0x0000000d0000000b013b36f800000000
8923 @}
8924 @end smallexample
8925
8926 @noindent
8927 To set values of such registers, you need to tell @value{GDBN} which
8928 view of the register you wish to change, as if you were assigning
8929 value to a @code{struct} member:
8930
8931 @smallexample
8932 (@value{GDBP}) set $xmm1.uint128 = 0x000000000000000000000000FFFFFFFF
8933 @end smallexample
8934
8935 Normally, register values are relative to the selected stack frame
8936 (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}). This means that you get the
8937 value that the register would contain if all stack frames farther in
8938 were exited and their saved registers restored. In order to see the
8939 true contents of hardware registers, you must select the innermost
8940 frame (with @samp{frame 0}).
8941
8942 However, @value{GDBN} must deduce where registers are saved, from the machine
8943 code generated by your compiler. If some registers are not saved, or if
8944 @value{GDBN} is unable to locate the saved registers, the selected stack
8945 frame makes no difference.
8946
8947 @node Floating Point Hardware
8948 @section Floating Point Hardware
8949 @cindex floating point
8950
8951 Depending on the configuration, @value{GDBN} may be able to give
8952 you more information about the status of the floating point hardware.
8953
8954 @table @code
8955 @kindex info float
8956 @item info float
8957 Display hardware-dependent information about the floating
8958 point unit. The exact contents and layout vary depending on the
8959 floating point chip. Currently, @samp{info float} is supported on
8960 the ARM and x86 machines.
8961 @end table
8962
8963 @node Vector Unit
8964 @section Vector Unit
8965 @cindex vector unit
8966
8967 Depending on the configuration, @value{GDBN} may be able to give you
8968 more information about the status of the vector unit.
8969
8970 @table @code
8971 @kindex info vector
8972 @item info vector
8973 Display information about the vector unit. The exact contents and
8974 layout vary depending on the hardware.
8975 @end table
8976
8977 @node OS Information
8978 @section Operating System Auxiliary Information
8979 @cindex OS information
8980
8981 @value{GDBN} provides interfaces to useful OS facilities that can help
8982 you debug your program.
8983
8984 @cindex @code{ptrace} system call
8985 @cindex @code{struct user} contents
8986 When @value{GDBN} runs on a @dfn{Posix system} (such as GNU or Unix
8987 machines), it interfaces with the inferior via the @code{ptrace}
8988 system call. The operating system creates a special sata structure,
8989 called @code{struct user}, for this interface. You can use the
8990 command @code{info udot} to display the contents of this data
8991 structure.
8992
8993 @table @code
8994 @item info udot
8995 @kindex info udot
8996 Display the contents of the @code{struct user} maintained by the OS
8997 kernel for the program being debugged. @value{GDBN} displays the
8998 contents of @code{struct user} as a list of hex numbers, similar to
8999 the @code{examine} command.
9000 @end table
9001
9002 @cindex auxiliary vector
9003 @cindex vector, auxiliary
9004 Some operating systems supply an @dfn{auxiliary vector} to programs at
9005 startup. This is akin to the arguments and environment that you
9006 specify for a program, but contains a system-dependent variety of
9007 binary values that tell system libraries important details about the
9008 hardware, operating system, and process. Each value's purpose is
9009 identified by an integer tag; the meanings are well-known but system-specific.
9010 Depending on the configuration and operating system facilities,
9011 @value{GDBN} may be able to show you this information. For remote
9012 targets, this functionality may further depend on the remote stub's
9013 support of the @samp{qXfer:auxv:read} packet, see
9014 @ref{qXfer auxiliary vector read}.
9015
9016 @table @code
9017 @kindex info auxv
9018 @item info auxv
9019 Display the auxiliary vector of the inferior, which can be either a
9020 live process or a core dump file. @value{GDBN} prints each tag value
9021 numerically, and also shows names and text descriptions for recognized
9022 tags. Some values in the vector are numbers, some bit masks, and some
9023 pointers to strings or other data. @value{GDBN} displays each value in the
9024 most appropriate form for a recognized tag, and in hexadecimal for
9025 an unrecognized tag.
9026 @end table
9027
9028 On some targets, @value{GDBN} can access operating-system-specific information
9029 and display it to user, without interpretation. For remote targets,
9030 this functionality depends on the remote stub's support of the
9031 @samp{qXfer:osdata:read} packet, see @ref{qXfer osdata read}.
9032
9033 @table @code
9034 @kindex info os
9035 @item info os
9036 List the types of OS information available for the target. If the
9037 target does not return a list of possible types, this command will
9038 report an error.
9039
9040 @kindex info os processes
9041 @item info os processes
9042 Display the list of processes on the target. For each process,
9043 @value{GDBN} prints the process identifier, the name of the user, and
9044 the command corresponding to the process.
9045 @end table
9046
9047 @node Memory Region Attributes
9048 @section Memory Region Attributes
9049 @cindex memory region attributes
9050
9051 @dfn{Memory region attributes} allow you to describe special handling
9052 required by regions of your target's memory. @value{GDBN} uses
9053 attributes to determine whether to allow certain types of memory
9054 accesses; whether to use specific width accesses; and whether to cache
9055 target memory. By default the description of memory regions is
9056 fetched from the target (if the current target supports this), but the
9057 user can override the fetched regions.
9058
9059 Defined memory regions can be individually enabled and disabled. When a
9060 memory region is disabled, @value{GDBN} uses the default attributes when
9061 accessing memory in that region. Similarly, if no memory regions have
9062 been defined, @value{GDBN} uses the default attributes when accessing
9063 all memory.
9064
9065 When a memory region is defined, it is given a number to identify it;
9066 to enable, disable, or remove a memory region, you specify that number.
9067
9068 @table @code
9069 @kindex mem
9070 @item mem @var{lower} @var{upper} @var{attributes}@dots{}
9071 Define a memory region bounded by @var{lower} and @var{upper} with
9072 attributes @var{attributes}@dots{}, and add it to the list of regions
9073 monitored by @value{GDBN}. Note that @var{upper} == 0 is a special
9074 case: it is treated as the target's maximum memory address.
9075 (0xffff on 16 bit targets, 0xffffffff on 32 bit targets, etc.)
9076
9077 @item mem auto
9078 Discard any user changes to the memory regions and use target-supplied
9079 regions, if available, or no regions if the target does not support.
9080
9081 @kindex delete mem
9082 @item delete mem @var{nums}@dots{}
9083 Remove memory regions @var{nums}@dots{} from the list of regions
9084 monitored by @value{GDBN}.
9085
9086 @kindex disable mem
9087 @item disable mem @var{nums}@dots{}
9088 Disable monitoring of memory regions @var{nums}@dots{}.
9089 A disabled memory region is not forgotten.
9090 It may be enabled again later.
9091
9092 @kindex enable mem
9093 @item enable mem @var{nums}@dots{}
9094 Enable monitoring of memory regions @var{nums}@dots{}.
9095
9096 @kindex info mem
9097 @item info mem
9098 Print a table of all defined memory regions, with the following columns
9099 for each region:
9100
9101 @table @emph
9102 @item Memory Region Number
9103 @item Enabled or Disabled.
9104 Enabled memory regions are marked with @samp{y}.
9105 Disabled memory regions are marked with @samp{n}.
9106
9107 @item Lo Address
9108 The address defining the inclusive lower bound of the memory region.
9109
9110 @item Hi Address
9111 The address defining the exclusive upper bound of the memory region.
9112
9113 @item Attributes
9114 The list of attributes set for this memory region.
9115 @end table
9116 @end table
9117
9118
9119 @subsection Attributes
9120
9121 @subsubsection Memory Access Mode
9122 The access mode attributes set whether @value{GDBN} may make read or
9123 write accesses to a memory region.
9124
9125 While these attributes prevent @value{GDBN} from performing invalid
9126 memory accesses, they do nothing to prevent the target system, I/O DMA,
9127 etc.@: from accessing memory.
9128
9129 @table @code
9130 @item ro
9131 Memory is read only.
9132 @item wo
9133 Memory is write only.
9134 @item rw
9135 Memory is read/write. This is the default.
9136 @end table
9137
9138 @subsubsection Memory Access Size
9139 The access size attribute tells @value{GDBN} to use specific sized
9140 accesses in the memory region. Often memory mapped device registers
9141 require specific sized accesses. If no access size attribute is
9142 specified, @value{GDBN} may use accesses of any size.
9143
9144 @table @code
9145 @item 8
9146 Use 8 bit memory accesses.
9147 @item 16
9148 Use 16 bit memory accesses.
9149 @item 32
9150 Use 32 bit memory accesses.
9151 @item 64
9152 Use 64 bit memory accesses.
9153 @end table
9154
9155 @c @subsubsection Hardware/Software Breakpoints
9156 @c The hardware/software breakpoint attributes set whether @value{GDBN}
9157 @c will use hardware or software breakpoints for the internal breakpoints
9158 @c used by the step, next, finish, until, etc. commands.
9159 @c
9160 @c @table @code
9161 @c @item hwbreak
9162 @c Always use hardware breakpoints
9163 @c @item swbreak (default)
9164 @c @end table
9165
9166 @subsubsection Data Cache
9167 The data cache attributes set whether @value{GDBN} will cache target
9168 memory. While this generally improves performance by reducing debug
9169 protocol overhead, it can lead to incorrect results because @value{GDBN}
9170 does not know about volatile variables or memory mapped device
9171 registers.
9172
9173 @table @code
9174 @item cache
9175 Enable @value{GDBN} to cache target memory.
9176 @item nocache
9177 Disable @value{GDBN} from caching target memory. This is the default.
9178 @end table
9179
9180 @subsection Memory Access Checking
9181 @value{GDBN} can be instructed to refuse accesses to memory that is
9182 not explicitly described. This can be useful if accessing such
9183 regions has undesired effects for a specific target, or to provide
9184 better error checking. The following commands control this behaviour.
9185
9186 @table @code
9187 @kindex set mem inaccessible-by-default
9188 @item set mem inaccessible-by-default [on|off]
9189 If @code{on} is specified, make @value{GDBN} treat memory not
9190 explicitly described by the memory ranges as non-existent and refuse accesses
9191 to such memory. The checks are only performed if there's at least one
9192 memory range defined. If @code{off} is specified, make @value{GDBN}
9193 treat the memory not explicitly described by the memory ranges as RAM.
9194 The default value is @code{on}.
9195 @kindex show mem inaccessible-by-default
9196 @item show mem inaccessible-by-default
9197 Show the current handling of accesses to unknown memory.
9198 @end table
9199
9200
9201 @c @subsubsection Memory Write Verification
9202 @c The memory write verification attributes set whether @value{GDBN}
9203 @c will re-reads data after each write to verify the write was successful.
9204 @c
9205 @c @table @code
9206 @c @item verify
9207 @c @item noverify (default)
9208 @c @end table
9209
9210 @node Dump/Restore Files
9211 @section Copy Between Memory and a File
9212 @cindex dump/restore files
9213 @cindex append data to a file
9214 @cindex dump data to a file
9215 @cindex restore data from a file
9216
9217 You can use the commands @code{dump}, @code{append}, and
9218 @code{restore} to copy data between target memory and a file. The
9219 @code{dump} and @code{append} commands write data to a file, and the
9220 @code{restore} command reads data from a file back into the inferior's
9221 memory. Files may be in binary, Motorola S-record, Intel hex, or
9222 Tektronix Hex format; however, @value{GDBN} can only append to binary
9223 files.
9224
9225 @table @code
9226
9227 @kindex dump
9228 @item dump @r{[}@var{format}@r{]} memory @var{filename} @var{start_addr} @var{end_addr}
9229 @itemx dump @r{[}@var{format}@r{]} value @var{filename} @var{expr}
9230 Dump the contents of memory from @var{start_addr} to @var{end_addr},
9231 or the value of @var{expr}, to @var{filename} in the given format.
9232
9233 The @var{format} parameter may be any one of:
9234 @table @code
9235 @item binary
9236 Raw binary form.
9237 @item ihex
9238 Intel hex format.
9239 @item srec
9240 Motorola S-record format.
9241 @item tekhex
9242 Tektronix Hex format.
9243 @end table
9244
9245 @value{GDBN} uses the same definitions of these formats as the
9246 @sc{gnu} binary utilities, like @samp{objdump} and @samp{objcopy}. If
9247 @var{format} is omitted, @value{GDBN} dumps the data in raw binary
9248 form.
9249
9250 @kindex append
9251 @item append @r{[}binary@r{]} memory @var{filename} @var{start_addr} @var{end_addr}
9252 @itemx append @r{[}binary@r{]} value @var{filename} @var{expr}
9253 Append the contents of memory from @var{start_addr} to @var{end_addr},
9254 or the value of @var{expr}, to the file @var{filename}, in raw binary form.
9255 (@value{GDBN} can only append data to files in raw binary form.)
9256
9257 @kindex restore
9258 @item restore @var{filename} @r{[}binary@r{]} @var{bias} @var{start} @var{end}
9259 Restore the contents of file @var{filename} into memory. The
9260 @code{restore} command can automatically recognize any known @sc{bfd}
9261 file format, except for raw binary. To restore a raw binary file you
9262 must specify the optional keyword @code{binary} after the filename.
9263
9264 If @var{bias} is non-zero, its value will be added to the addresses
9265 contained in the file. Binary files always start at address zero, so
9266 they will be restored at address @var{bias}. Other bfd files have
9267 a built-in location; they will be restored at offset @var{bias}
9268 from that location.
9269
9270 If @var{start} and/or @var{end} are non-zero, then only data between
9271 file offset @var{start} and file offset @var{end} will be restored.
9272 These offsets are relative to the addresses in the file, before
9273 the @var{bias} argument is applied.
9274
9275 @end table
9276
9277 @node Core File Generation
9278 @section How to Produce a Core File from Your Program
9279 @cindex dump core from inferior
9280
9281 A @dfn{core file} or @dfn{core dump} is a file that records the memory
9282 image of a running process and its process status (register values
9283 etc.). Its primary use is post-mortem debugging of a program that
9284 crashed while it ran outside a debugger. A program that crashes
9285 automatically produces a core file, unless this feature is disabled by
9286 the user. @xref{Files}, for information on invoking @value{GDBN} in
9287 the post-mortem debugging mode.
9288
9289 Occasionally, you may wish to produce a core file of the program you
9290 are debugging in order to preserve a snapshot of its state.
9291 @value{GDBN} has a special command for that.
9292
9293 @table @code
9294 @kindex gcore
9295 @kindex generate-core-file
9296 @item generate-core-file [@var{file}]
9297 @itemx gcore [@var{file}]
9298 Produce a core dump of the inferior process. The optional argument
9299 @var{file} specifies the file name where to put the core dump. If not
9300 specified, the file name defaults to @file{core.@var{pid}}, where
9301 @var{pid} is the inferior process ID.
9302
9303 Note that this command is implemented only for some systems (as of
9304 this writing, @sc{gnu}/Linux, FreeBSD, Solaris, Unixware, and S390).
9305 @end table
9306
9307 @node Character Sets
9308 @section Character Sets
9309 @cindex character sets
9310 @cindex charset
9311 @cindex translating between character sets
9312 @cindex host character set
9313 @cindex target character set
9314
9315 If the program you are debugging uses a different character set to
9316 represent characters and strings than the one @value{GDBN} uses itself,
9317 @value{GDBN} can automatically translate between the character sets for
9318 you. The character set @value{GDBN} uses we call the @dfn{host
9319 character set}; the one the inferior program uses we call the
9320 @dfn{target character set}.
9321
9322 For example, if you are running @value{GDBN} on a @sc{gnu}/Linux system, which
9323 uses the ISO Latin 1 character set, but you are using @value{GDBN}'s
9324 remote protocol (@pxref{Remote Debugging}) to debug a program
9325 running on an IBM mainframe, which uses the @sc{ebcdic} character set,
9326 then the host character set is Latin-1, and the target character set is
9327 @sc{ebcdic}. If you give @value{GDBN} the command @code{set
9328 target-charset EBCDIC-US}, then @value{GDBN} translates between
9329 @sc{ebcdic} and Latin 1 as you print character or string values, or use
9330 character and string literals in expressions.
9331
9332 @value{GDBN} has no way to automatically recognize which character set
9333 the inferior program uses; you must tell it, using the @code{set
9334 target-charset} command, described below.
9335
9336 Here are the commands for controlling @value{GDBN}'s character set
9337 support:
9338
9339 @table @code
9340 @item set target-charset @var{charset}
9341 @kindex set target-charset
9342 Set the current target character set to @var{charset}. To display the
9343 list of supported target character sets, type
9344 @kbd{@w{set target-charset @key{TAB}@key{TAB}}}.
9345
9346 @item set host-charset @var{charset}
9347 @kindex set host-charset
9348 Set the current host character set to @var{charset}.
9349
9350 By default, @value{GDBN} uses a host character set appropriate to the
9351 system it is running on; you can override that default using the
9352 @code{set host-charset} command. On some systems, @value{GDBN} cannot
9353 automatically determine the appropriate host character set. In this
9354 case, @value{GDBN} uses @samp{UTF-8}.
9355
9356 @value{GDBN} can only use certain character sets as its host character
9357 set. If you type @kbd{@w{set host-charset @key{TAB}@key{TAB}}},
9358 @value{GDBN} will list the host character sets it supports.
9359
9360 @item set charset @var{charset}
9361 @kindex set charset
9362 Set the current host and target character sets to @var{charset}. As
9363 above, if you type @kbd{@w{set charset @key{TAB}@key{TAB}}},
9364 @value{GDBN} will list the names of the character sets that can be used
9365 for both host and target.
9366
9367 @item show charset
9368 @kindex show charset
9369 Show the names of the current host and target character sets.
9370
9371 @item show host-charset
9372 @kindex show host-charset
9373 Show the name of the current host character set.
9374
9375 @item show target-charset
9376 @kindex show target-charset
9377 Show the name of the current target character set.
9378
9379 @item set target-wide-charset @var{charset}
9380 @kindex set target-wide-charset
9381 Set the current target's wide character set to @var{charset}. This is
9382 the character set used by the target's @code{wchar_t} type. To
9383 display the list of supported wide character sets, type
9384 @kbd{@w{set target-wide-charset @key{TAB}@key{TAB}}}.
9385
9386 @item show target-wide-charset
9387 @kindex show target-wide-charset
9388 Show the name of the current target's wide character set.
9389 @end table
9390
9391 Here is an example of @value{GDBN}'s character set support in action.
9392 Assume that the following source code has been placed in the file
9393 @file{charset-test.c}:
9394
9395 @smallexample
9396 #include <stdio.h>
9397
9398 char ascii_hello[]
9399 = @{72, 101, 108, 108, 111, 44, 32, 119,
9400 111, 114, 108, 100, 33, 10, 0@};
9401 char ibm1047_hello[]
9402 = @{200, 133, 147, 147, 150, 107, 64, 166,
9403 150, 153, 147, 132, 90, 37, 0@};
9404
9405 main ()
9406 @{
9407 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
9408 @}
9409 @end smallexample
9410
9411 In this program, @code{ascii_hello} and @code{ibm1047_hello} are arrays
9412 containing the string @samp{Hello, world!} followed by a newline,
9413 encoded in the @sc{ascii} and @sc{ibm1047} character sets.
9414
9415 We compile the program, and invoke the debugger on it:
9416
9417 @smallexample
9418 $ gcc -g charset-test.c -o charset-test
9419 $ gdb -nw charset-test
9420 GNU gdb 2001-12-19-cvs
9421 Copyright 2001 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
9422 @dots{}
9423 (@value{GDBP})
9424 @end smallexample
9425
9426 We can use the @code{show charset} command to see what character sets
9427 @value{GDBN} is currently using to interpret and display characters and
9428 strings:
9429
9430 @smallexample
9431 (@value{GDBP}) show charset
9432 The current host and target character set is `ISO-8859-1'.
9433 (@value{GDBP})
9434 @end smallexample
9435
9436 For the sake of printing this manual, let's use @sc{ascii} as our
9437 initial character set:
9438 @smallexample
9439 (@value{GDBP}) set charset ASCII
9440 (@value{GDBP}) show charset
9441 The current host and target character set is `ASCII'.
9442 (@value{GDBP})
9443 @end smallexample
9444
9445 Let's assume that @sc{ascii} is indeed the correct character set for our
9446 host system --- in other words, let's assume that if @value{GDBN} prints
9447 characters using the @sc{ascii} character set, our terminal will display
9448 them properly. Since our current target character set is also
9449 @sc{ascii}, the contents of @code{ascii_hello} print legibly:
9450
9451 @smallexample
9452 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello
9453 $1 = 0x401698 "Hello, world!\n"
9454 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello[0]
9455 $2 = 72 'H'
9456 (@value{GDBP})
9457 @end smallexample
9458
9459 @value{GDBN} uses the target character set for character and string
9460 literals you use in expressions:
9461
9462 @smallexample
9463 (@value{GDBP}) print '+'
9464 $3 = 43 '+'
9465 (@value{GDBP})
9466 @end smallexample
9467
9468 The @sc{ascii} character set uses the number 43 to encode the @samp{+}
9469 character.
9470
9471 @value{GDBN} relies on the user to tell it which character set the
9472 target program uses. If we print @code{ibm1047_hello} while our target
9473 character set is still @sc{ascii}, we get jibberish:
9474
9475 @smallexample
9476 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello
9477 $4 = 0x4016a8 "\310\205\223\223\226k@@\246\226\231\223\204Z%"
9478 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello[0]
9479 $5 = 200 '\310'
9480 (@value{GDBP})
9481 @end smallexample
9482
9483 If we invoke the @code{set target-charset} followed by @key{TAB}@key{TAB},
9484 @value{GDBN} tells us the character sets it supports:
9485
9486 @smallexample
9487 (@value{GDBP}) set target-charset
9488 ASCII EBCDIC-US IBM1047 ISO-8859-1
9489 (@value{GDBP}) set target-charset
9490 @end smallexample
9491
9492 We can select @sc{ibm1047} as our target character set, and examine the
9493 program's strings again. Now the @sc{ascii} string is wrong, but
9494 @value{GDBN} translates the contents of @code{ibm1047_hello} from the
9495 target character set, @sc{ibm1047}, to the host character set,
9496 @sc{ascii}, and they display correctly:
9497
9498 @smallexample
9499 (@value{GDBP}) set target-charset IBM1047
9500 (@value{GDBP}) show charset
9501 The current host character set is `ASCII'.
9502 The current target character set is `IBM1047'.
9503 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello
9504 $6 = 0x401698 "\110\145%%?\054\040\167?\162%\144\041\012"
9505 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello[0]
9506 $7 = 72 '\110'
9507 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello
9508 $8 = 0x4016a8 "Hello, world!\n"
9509 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello[0]
9510 $9 = 200 'H'
9511 (@value{GDBP})
9512 @end smallexample
9513
9514 As above, @value{GDBN} uses the target character set for character and
9515 string literals you use in expressions:
9516
9517 @smallexample
9518 (@value{GDBP}) print '+'
9519 $10 = 78 '+'
9520 (@value{GDBP})
9521 @end smallexample
9522
9523 The @sc{ibm1047} character set uses the number 78 to encode the @samp{+}
9524 character.
9525
9526 @node Caching Remote Data
9527 @section Caching Data of Remote Targets
9528 @cindex caching data of remote targets
9529
9530 @value{GDBN} caches data exchanged between the debugger and a
9531 remote target (@pxref{Remote Debugging}). Such caching generally improves
9532 performance, because it reduces the overhead of the remote protocol by
9533 bundling memory reads and writes into large chunks. Unfortunately, simply
9534 caching everything would lead to incorrect results, since @value{GDBN}
9535 does not necessarily know anything about volatile values, memory-mapped I/O
9536 addresses, etc. Furthermore, in non-stop mode (@pxref{Non-Stop Mode})
9537 memory can be changed @emph{while} a gdb command is executing.
9538 Therefore, by default, @value{GDBN} only caches data
9539 known to be on the stack@footnote{In non-stop mode, it is moderately
9540 rare for a running thread to modify the stack of a stopped thread
9541 in a way that would interfere with a backtrace, and caching of
9542 stack reads provides a significant speed up of remote backtraces.}.
9543 Other regions of memory can be explicitly marked as
9544 cacheable; see @pxref{Memory Region Attributes}.
9545
9546 @table @code
9547 @kindex set remotecache
9548 @item set remotecache on
9549 @itemx set remotecache off
9550 This option no longer does anything; it exists for compatibility
9551 with old scripts.
9552
9553 @kindex show remotecache
9554 @item show remotecache
9555 Show the current state of the obsolete remotecache flag.
9556
9557 @kindex set stack-cache
9558 @item set stack-cache on
9559 @itemx set stack-cache off
9560 Enable or disable caching of stack accesses. When @code{ON}, use
9561 caching. By default, this option is @code{ON}.
9562
9563 @kindex show stack-cache
9564 @item show stack-cache
9565 Show the current state of data caching for memory accesses.
9566
9567 @kindex info dcache
9568 @item info dcache @r{[}line@r{]}
9569 Print the information about the data cache performance. The
9570 information displayed includes the dcache width and depth, and for
9571 each cache line, its number, address, and how many times it was
9572 referenced. This command is useful for debugging the data cache
9573 operation.
9574
9575 If a line number is specified, the contents of that line will be
9576 printed in hex.
9577
9578 @item set dcache size @var{size}
9579 @cindex dcache size
9580 @kindex set dcache size
9581 Set maximum number of entries in dcache (dcache depth above).
9582
9583 @item set dcache line-size @var{line-size}
9584 @cindex dcache line-size
9585 @kindex set dcache line-size
9586 Set number of bytes each dcache entry caches (dcache width above).
9587 Must be a power of 2.
9588
9589 @item show dcache size
9590 @kindex show dcache size
9591 Show maximum number of dcache entries. See also @ref{Caching Remote Data, info dcache}.
9592
9593 @item show dcache line-size
9594 @kindex show dcache line-size
9595 Show default size of dcache lines. See also @ref{Caching Remote Data, info dcache}.
9596
9597 @end table
9598
9599 @node Searching Memory
9600 @section Search Memory
9601 @cindex searching memory
9602
9603 Memory can be searched for a particular sequence of bytes with the
9604 @code{find} command.
9605
9606 @table @code
9607 @kindex find
9608 @item find @r{[}/@var{sn}@r{]} @var{start_addr}, +@var{len}, @var{val1} @r{[}, @var{val2}, @dots{}@r{]}
9609 @itemx find @r{[}/@var{sn}@r{]} @var{start_addr}, @var{end_addr}, @var{val1} @r{[}, @var{val2}, @dots{}@r{]}
9610 Search memory for the sequence of bytes specified by @var{val1}, @var{val2},
9611 etc. The search begins at address @var{start_addr} and continues for either
9612 @var{len} bytes or through to @var{end_addr} inclusive.
9613 @end table
9614
9615 @var{s} and @var{n} are optional parameters.
9616 They may be specified in either order, apart or together.
9617
9618 @table @r
9619 @item @var{s}, search query size
9620 The size of each search query value.
9621
9622 @table @code
9623 @item b
9624 bytes
9625 @item h
9626 halfwords (two bytes)
9627 @item w
9628 words (four bytes)
9629 @item g
9630 giant words (eight bytes)
9631 @end table
9632
9633 All values are interpreted in the current language.
9634 This means, for example, that if the current source language is C/C@t{++}
9635 then searching for the string ``hello'' includes the trailing '\0'.
9636
9637 If the value size is not specified, it is taken from the
9638 value's type in the current language.
9639 This is useful when one wants to specify the search
9640 pattern as a mixture of types.
9641 Note that this means, for example, that in the case of C-like languages
9642 a search for an untyped 0x42 will search for @samp{(int) 0x42}
9643 which is typically four bytes.
9644
9645 @item @var{n}, maximum number of finds
9646 The maximum number of matches to print. The default is to print all finds.
9647 @end table
9648
9649 You can use strings as search values. Quote them with double-quotes
9650 (@code{"}).
9651 The string value is copied into the search pattern byte by byte,
9652 regardless of the endianness of the target and the size specification.
9653
9654 The address of each match found is printed as well as a count of the
9655 number of matches found.
9656
9657 The address of the last value found is stored in convenience variable
9658 @samp{$_}.
9659 A count of the number of matches is stored in @samp{$numfound}.
9660
9661 For example, if stopped at the @code{printf} in this function:
9662
9663 @smallexample
9664 void
9665 hello ()
9666 @{
9667 static char hello[] = "hello-hello";
9668 static struct @{ char c; short s; int i; @}
9669 __attribute__ ((packed)) mixed
9670 = @{ 'c', 0x1234, 0x87654321 @};
9671 printf ("%s\n", hello);
9672 @}
9673 @end smallexample
9674
9675 @noindent
9676 you get during debugging:
9677
9678 @smallexample
9679 (gdb) find &hello[0], +sizeof(hello), "hello"
9680 0x804956d <hello.1620+6>
9681 1 pattern found
9682 (gdb) find &hello[0], +sizeof(hello), 'h', 'e', 'l', 'l', 'o'
9683 0x8049567 <hello.1620>
9684 0x804956d <hello.1620+6>
9685 2 patterns found
9686 (gdb) find /b1 &hello[0], +sizeof(hello), 'h', 0x65, 'l'
9687 0x8049567 <hello.1620>
9688 1 pattern found
9689 (gdb) find &mixed, +sizeof(mixed), (char) 'c', (short) 0x1234, (int) 0x87654321
9690 0x8049560 <mixed.1625>
9691 1 pattern found
9692 (gdb) print $numfound
9693 $1 = 1
9694 (gdb) print $_
9695 $2 = (void *) 0x8049560
9696 @end smallexample
9697
9698 @node Optimized Code
9699 @chapter Debugging Optimized Code
9700 @cindex optimized code, debugging
9701 @cindex debugging optimized code
9702
9703 Almost all compilers support optimization. With optimization
9704 disabled, the compiler generates assembly code that corresponds
9705 directly to your source code, in a simplistic way. As the compiler
9706 applies more powerful optimizations, the generated assembly code
9707 diverges from your original source code. With help from debugging
9708 information generated by the compiler, @value{GDBN} can map from
9709 the running program back to constructs from your original source.
9710
9711 @value{GDBN} is more accurate with optimization disabled. If you
9712 can recompile without optimization, it is easier to follow the
9713 progress of your program during debugging. But, there are many cases
9714 where you may need to debug an optimized version.
9715
9716 When you debug a program compiled with @samp{-g -O}, remember that the
9717 optimizer has rearranged your code; the debugger shows you what is
9718 really there. Do not be too surprised when the execution path does not
9719 exactly match your source file! An extreme example: if you define a
9720 variable, but never use it, @value{GDBN} never sees that
9721 variable---because the compiler optimizes it out of existence.
9722
9723 Some things do not work as well with @samp{-g -O} as with just
9724 @samp{-g}, particularly on machines with instruction scheduling. If in
9725 doubt, recompile with @samp{-g} alone, and if this fixes the problem,
9726 please report it to us as a bug (including a test case!).
9727 @xref{Variables}, for more information about debugging optimized code.
9728
9729 @menu
9730 * Inline Functions:: How @value{GDBN} presents inlining
9731 * Tail Call Frames:: @value{GDBN} analysis of jumps to functions
9732 @end menu
9733
9734 @node Inline Functions
9735 @section Inline Functions
9736 @cindex inline functions, debugging
9737
9738 @dfn{Inlining} is an optimization that inserts a copy of the function
9739 body directly at each call site, instead of jumping to a shared
9740 routine. @value{GDBN} displays inlined functions just like
9741 non-inlined functions. They appear in backtraces. You can view their
9742 arguments and local variables, step into them with @code{step}, skip
9743 them with @code{next}, and escape from them with @code{finish}.
9744 You can check whether a function was inlined by using the
9745 @code{info frame} command.
9746
9747 For @value{GDBN} to support inlined functions, the compiler must
9748 record information about inlining in the debug information ---
9749 @value{NGCC} using the @sc{dwarf 2} format does this, and several
9750 other compilers do also. @value{GDBN} only supports inlined functions
9751 when using @sc{dwarf 2}. Versions of @value{NGCC} before 4.1
9752 do not emit two required attributes (@samp{DW_AT_call_file} and
9753 @samp{DW_AT_call_line}); @value{GDBN} does not display inlined
9754 function calls with earlier versions of @value{NGCC}. It instead
9755 displays the arguments and local variables of inlined functions as
9756 local variables in the caller.
9757
9758 The body of an inlined function is directly included at its call site;
9759 unlike a non-inlined function, there are no instructions devoted to
9760 the call. @value{GDBN} still pretends that the call site and the
9761 start of the inlined function are different instructions. Stepping to
9762 the call site shows the call site, and then stepping again shows
9763 the first line of the inlined function, even though no additional
9764 instructions are executed.
9765
9766 This makes source-level debugging much clearer; you can see both the
9767 context of the call and then the effect of the call. Only stepping by
9768 a single instruction using @code{stepi} or @code{nexti} does not do
9769 this; single instruction steps always show the inlined body.
9770
9771 There are some ways that @value{GDBN} does not pretend that inlined
9772 function calls are the same as normal calls:
9773
9774 @itemize @bullet
9775 @item
9776 You cannot set breakpoints on inlined functions. @value{GDBN}
9777 either reports that there is no symbol with that name, or else sets the
9778 breakpoint only on non-inlined copies of the function. This limitation
9779 will be removed in a future version of @value{GDBN}; until then,
9780 set a breakpoint by line number on the first line of the inlined
9781 function instead.
9782
9783 @item
9784 Setting breakpoints at the call site of an inlined function may not
9785 work, because the call site does not contain any code. @value{GDBN}
9786 may incorrectly move the breakpoint to the next line of the enclosing
9787 function, after the call. This limitation will be removed in a future
9788 version of @value{GDBN}; until then, set a breakpoint on an earlier line
9789 or inside the inlined function instead.
9790
9791 @item
9792 @value{GDBN} cannot locate the return value of inlined calls after
9793 using the @code{finish} command. This is a limitation of compiler-generated
9794 debugging information; after @code{finish}, you can step to the next line
9795 and print a variable where your program stored the return value.
9796
9797 @end itemize
9798
9799 @node Tail Call Frames
9800 @section Tail Call Frames
9801 @cindex tail call frames, debugging
9802
9803 Function @code{B} can call function @code{C} in its very last statement. In
9804 unoptimized compilation the call of @code{C} is immediately followed by return
9805 instruction at the end of @code{B} code. Optimizing compiler may replace the
9806 call and return in function @code{B} into one jump to function @code{C}
9807 instead. Such use of a jump instruction is called @dfn{tail call}.
9808
9809 During execution of function @code{C}, there will be no indication in the
9810 function call stack frames that it was tail-called from @code{B}. If function
9811 @code{A} regularly calls function @code{B} which tail-calls function @code{C},
9812 then @value{GDBN} will see @code{A} as the caller of @code{C}. However, in
9813 some cases @value{GDBN} can determine that @code{C} was tail-called from
9814 @code{B}, and it will then create fictitious call frame for that, with the
9815 return address set up as if @code{B} called @code{C} normally.
9816
9817 This functionality is currently supported only by DWARF 2 debugging format and
9818 the compiler has to produce @samp{DW_TAG_GNU_call_site} tags. With
9819 @value{NGCC}, you need to specify @option{-O -g} during compilation, to get
9820 this information.
9821
9822 @kbd{info frame} command (@pxref{Frame Info}) will indicate the tail call frame
9823 kind by text @code{tail call frame} such as in this sample @value{GDBN} output:
9824
9825 @smallexample
9826 (gdb) x/i $pc - 2
9827 0x40066b <b(int, double)+11>: jmp 0x400640 <c(int, double)>
9828 (gdb) info frame
9829 Stack level 1, frame at 0x7fffffffda30:
9830 rip = 0x40066d in b (amd64-entry-value.cc:59); saved rip 0x4004c5
9831 tail call frame, caller of frame at 0x7fffffffda30
9832 source language c++.
9833 Arglist at unknown address.
9834 Locals at unknown address, Previous frame's sp is 0x7fffffffda30
9835 @end smallexample
9836
9837 The detection of all the possible code path executions can find them ambiguous.
9838 There is no execution history stored (possible @ref{Reverse Execution} is never
9839 used for this purpose) and the last known caller could have reached the known
9840 callee by multiple different jump sequences. In such case @value{GDBN} still
9841 tries to show at least all the unambiguous top tail callers and all the
9842 unambiguous bottom tail calees, if any.
9843
9844 @table @code
9845 @anchor{set debug entry-values}
9846 @item set debug entry-values
9847 @kindex set debug entry-values
9848 When set to on, enables printing of analysis messages for both frame argument
9849 values at function entry and tail calls. It will show all the possible valid
9850 tail calls code paths it has considered. It will also print the intersection
9851 of them with the final unambiguous (possibly partial or even empty) code path
9852 result.
9853
9854 @item show debug entry-values
9855 @kindex show debug entry-values
9856 Show the current state of analysis messages printing for both frame argument
9857 values at function entry and tail calls.
9858 @end table
9859
9860 The analysis messages for tail calls can for example show why the virtual tail
9861 call frame for function @code{c} has not been recognized (due to the indirect
9862 reference by variable @code{x}):
9863
9864 @smallexample
9865 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) c (void);
9866 void (*x) (void) = c;
9867 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) a (void) @{ x++; @}
9868 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) c (void) @{ a (); @}
9869 int main (void) @{ x (); return 0; @}
9870
9871 Breakpoint 1, DW_OP_GNU_entry_value resolving cannot find
9872 DW_TAG_GNU_call_site 0x40039a in main
9873 a () at t.c:3
9874 3 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) a (void) @{ x++; @}
9875 (gdb) bt
9876 #0 a () at t.c:3
9877 #1 0x000000000040039a in main () at t.c:5
9878 @end smallexample
9879
9880 Another possibility is an ambiguous virtual tail call frames resolution:
9881
9882 @smallexample
9883 int i;
9884 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) f (void) @{ i++; @}
9885 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) e (void) @{ f (); @}
9886 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) d (void) @{ f (); @}
9887 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) c (void) @{ d (); @}
9888 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) b (void)
9889 @{ if (i) c (); else e (); @}
9890 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) a (void) @{ b (); @}
9891 int main (void) @{ a (); return 0; @}
9892
9893 tailcall: initial: 0x4004d2(a) 0x4004ce(b) 0x4004b2(c) 0x4004a2(d)
9894 tailcall: compare: 0x4004d2(a) 0x4004cc(b) 0x400492(e)
9895 tailcall: reduced: 0x4004d2(a) |
9896 (gdb) bt
9897 #0 f () at t.c:2
9898 #1 0x00000000004004d2 in a () at t.c:8
9899 #2 0x0000000000400395 in main () at t.c:9
9900 @end smallexample
9901
9902 @set CALLSEQ1A @code{main@value{ARROW}a@value{ARROW}b@value{ARROW}c@value{ARROW}d@value{ARROW}f}
9903 @set CALLSEQ2A @code{main@value{ARROW}a@value{ARROW}b@value{ARROW}e@value{ARROW}f}
9904
9905 @c Convert CALLSEQ#A to CALLSEQ#B depending on HAVE_MAKEINFO_CLICK.
9906 @ifset HAVE_MAKEINFO_CLICK
9907 @set ARROW @click{}
9908 @set CALLSEQ1B @clicksequence{@value{CALLSEQ1A}}
9909 @set CALLSEQ2B @clicksequence{@value{CALLSEQ2A}}
9910 @end ifset
9911 @ifclear HAVE_MAKEINFO_CLICK
9912 @set ARROW ->
9913 @set CALLSEQ1B @value{CALLSEQ1A}
9914 @set CALLSEQ2B @value{CALLSEQ2A}
9915 @end ifclear
9916
9917 Frames #0 and #2 are real, #1 is a virtual tail call frame.
9918 The code can have possible execution paths @value{CALLSEQ1B} or
9919 @value{CALLSEQ2B}, @value{GDBN} cannot find which one from the inferior state.
9920
9921 @code{initial:} state shows some random possible calling sequence @value{GDBN}
9922 has found. It then finds another possible calling sequcen - that one is
9923 prefixed by @code{compare:}. The non-ambiguous intersection of these two is
9924 printed as the @code{reduced:} calling sequence. That one could have many
9925 futher @code{compare:} and @code{reduced:} statements as long as there remain
9926 any non-ambiguous sequence entries.
9927
9928 For the frame of function @code{b} in both cases there are different possible
9929 @code{$pc} values (@code{0x4004cc} or @code{0x4004ce}), therefore this frame is
9930 also ambigous. The only non-ambiguous frame is the one for function @code{a},
9931 therefore this one is displayed to the user while the ambiguous frames are
9932 omitted.
9933
9934 There can be also reasons why printing of frame argument values at function
9935 entry may fail:
9936
9937 @smallexample
9938 int v;
9939 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) c (int i) @{ v++; @}
9940 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) a (int i);
9941 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) b (int i) @{ a (i); @}
9942 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) a (int i)
9943 @{ if (i) b (i - 1); else c (0); @}
9944 int main (void) @{ a (5); return 0; @}
9945
9946 (gdb) bt
9947 #0 c (i=i@@entry=0) at t.c:2
9948 #1 0x0000000000400428 in a (DW_OP_GNU_entry_value resolving has found
9949 function "a" at 0x400420 can call itself via tail calls
9950 i=<optimized out>) at t.c:6
9951 #2 0x000000000040036e in main () at t.c:7
9952 @end smallexample
9953
9954 @value{GDBN} cannot find out from the inferior state if and how many times did
9955 function @code{a} call itself (via function @code{b}) as these calls would be
9956 tail calls. Such tail calls would modify thue @code{i} variable, therefore
9957 @value{GDBN} cannot be sure the value it knows would be right - @value{GDBN}
9958 prints @code{<optimized out>} instead.
9959
9960 @node Macros
9961 @chapter C Preprocessor Macros
9962
9963 Some languages, such as C and C@t{++}, provide a way to define and invoke
9964 ``preprocessor macros'' which expand into strings of tokens.
9965 @value{GDBN} can evaluate expressions containing macro invocations, show
9966 the result of macro expansion, and show a macro's definition, including
9967 where it was defined.
9968
9969 You may need to compile your program specially to provide @value{GDBN}
9970 with information about preprocessor macros. Most compilers do not
9971 include macros in their debugging information, even when you compile
9972 with the @option{-g} flag. @xref{Compilation}.
9973
9974 A program may define a macro at one point, remove that definition later,
9975 and then provide a different definition after that. Thus, at different
9976 points in the program, a macro may have different definitions, or have
9977 no definition at all. If there is a current stack frame, @value{GDBN}
9978 uses the macros in scope at that frame's source code line. Otherwise,
9979 @value{GDBN} uses the macros in scope at the current listing location;
9980 see @ref{List}.
9981
9982 Whenever @value{GDBN} evaluates an expression, it always expands any
9983 macro invocations present in the expression. @value{GDBN} also provides
9984 the following commands for working with macros explicitly.
9985
9986 @table @code
9987
9988 @kindex macro expand
9989 @cindex macro expansion, showing the results of preprocessor
9990 @cindex preprocessor macro expansion, showing the results of
9991 @cindex expanding preprocessor macros
9992 @item macro expand @var{expression}
9993 @itemx macro exp @var{expression}
9994 Show the results of expanding all preprocessor macro invocations in
9995 @var{expression}. Since @value{GDBN} simply expands macros, but does
9996 not parse the result, @var{expression} need not be a valid expression;
9997 it can be any string of tokens.
9998
9999 @kindex macro exp1
10000 @item macro expand-once @var{expression}
10001 @itemx macro exp1 @var{expression}
10002 @cindex expand macro once
10003 @i{(This command is not yet implemented.)} Show the results of
10004 expanding those preprocessor macro invocations that appear explicitly in
10005 @var{expression}. Macro invocations appearing in that expansion are
10006 left unchanged. This command allows you to see the effect of a
10007 particular macro more clearly, without being confused by further
10008 expansions. Since @value{GDBN} simply expands macros, but does not
10009 parse the result, @var{expression} need not be a valid expression; it
10010 can be any string of tokens.
10011
10012 @kindex info macro
10013 @cindex macro definition, showing
10014 @cindex definition of a macro, showing
10015 @cindex macros, from debug info
10016 @item info macro [-a|-all] [--] @var{macro}
10017 Show the current definition or all definitions of the named @var{macro},
10018 and describe the source location or compiler command-line where that
10019 definition was established. The optional double dash is to signify the end of
10020 argument processing and the beginning of @var{macro} for non C-like macros where
10021 the macro may begin with a hyphen.
10022
10023 @kindex info macros
10024 @item info macros @var{linespec}
10025 Show all macro definitions that are in effect at the location specified
10026 by @var{linespec}, and describe the source location or compiler
10027 command-line where those definitions were established.
10028
10029 @kindex macro define
10030 @cindex user-defined macros
10031 @cindex defining macros interactively
10032 @cindex macros, user-defined
10033 @item macro define @var{macro} @var{replacement-list}
10034 @itemx macro define @var{macro}(@var{arglist}) @var{replacement-list}
10035 Introduce a definition for a preprocessor macro named @var{macro},
10036 invocations of which are replaced by the tokens given in
10037 @var{replacement-list}. The first form of this command defines an
10038 ``object-like'' macro, which takes no arguments; the second form
10039 defines a ``function-like'' macro, which takes the arguments given in
10040 @var{arglist}.
10041
10042 A definition introduced by this command is in scope in every
10043 expression evaluated in @value{GDBN}, until it is removed with the
10044 @code{macro undef} command, described below. The definition overrides
10045 all definitions for @var{macro} present in the program being debugged,
10046 as well as any previous user-supplied definition.
10047
10048 @kindex macro undef
10049 @item macro undef @var{macro}
10050 Remove any user-supplied definition for the macro named @var{macro}.
10051 This command only affects definitions provided with the @code{macro
10052 define} command, described above; it cannot remove definitions present
10053 in the program being debugged.
10054
10055 @kindex macro list
10056 @item macro list
10057 List all the macros defined using the @code{macro define} command.
10058 @end table
10059
10060 @cindex macros, example of debugging with
10061 Here is a transcript showing the above commands in action. First, we
10062 show our source files:
10063
10064 @smallexample
10065 $ cat sample.c
10066 #include <stdio.h>
10067 #include "sample.h"
10068
10069 #define M 42
10070 #define ADD(x) (M + x)
10071
10072 main ()
10073 @{
10074 #define N 28
10075 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
10076 #undef N
10077 printf ("We're so creative.\n");
10078 #define N 1729
10079 printf ("Goodbye, world!\n");
10080 @}
10081 $ cat sample.h
10082 #define Q <
10083 $
10084 @end smallexample
10085
10086 Now, we compile the program using the @sc{gnu} C compiler,
10087 @value{NGCC}. We pass the @option{-gdwarf-2}@footnote{This is the
10088 minimum. Recent versions of @value{NGCC} support @option{-gdwarf-3}
10089 and @option{-gdwarf-4}; we recommend always choosing the most recent
10090 version of DWARF.} @emph{and} @option{-g3} flags to ensure the compiler
10091 includes information about preprocessor macros in the debugging
10092 information.
10093
10094 @smallexample
10095 $ gcc -gdwarf-2 -g3 sample.c -o sample
10096 $
10097 @end smallexample
10098
10099 Now, we start @value{GDBN} on our sample program:
10100
10101 @smallexample
10102 $ gdb -nw sample
10103 GNU gdb 2002-05-06-cvs
10104 Copyright 2002 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
10105 GDB is free software, @dots{}
10106 (@value{GDBP})
10107 @end smallexample
10108
10109 We can expand macros and examine their definitions, even when the
10110 program is not running. @value{GDBN} uses the current listing position
10111 to decide which macro definitions are in scope:
10112
10113 @smallexample
10114 (@value{GDBP}) list main
10115 3
10116 4 #define M 42
10117 5 #define ADD(x) (M + x)
10118 6
10119 7 main ()
10120 8 @{
10121 9 #define N 28
10122 10 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
10123 11 #undef N
10124 12 printf ("We're so creative.\n");
10125 (@value{GDBP}) info macro ADD
10126 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:5
10127 #define ADD(x) (M + x)
10128 (@value{GDBP}) info macro Q
10129 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.h:1
10130 included at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:2
10131 #define Q <
10132 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand ADD(1)
10133 expands to: (42 + 1)
10134 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand-once ADD(1)
10135 expands to: once (M + 1)
10136 (@value{GDBP})
10137 @end smallexample
10138
10139 In the example above, note that @code{macro expand-once} expands only
10140 the macro invocation explicit in the original text --- the invocation of
10141 @code{ADD} --- but does not expand the invocation of the macro @code{M},
10142 which was introduced by @code{ADD}.
10143
10144 Once the program is running, @value{GDBN} uses the macro definitions in
10145 force at the source line of the current stack frame:
10146
10147 @smallexample
10148 (@value{GDBP}) break main
10149 Breakpoint 1 at 0x8048370: file sample.c, line 10.
10150 (@value{GDBP}) run
10151 Starting program: /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample
10152
10153 Breakpoint 1, main () at sample.c:10
10154 10 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
10155 (@value{GDBP})
10156 @end smallexample
10157
10158 At line 10, the definition of the macro @code{N} at line 9 is in force:
10159
10160 @smallexample
10161 (@value{GDBP}) info macro N
10162 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:9
10163 #define N 28
10164 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand N Q M
10165 expands to: 28 < 42
10166 (@value{GDBP}) print N Q M
10167 $1 = 1
10168 (@value{GDBP})
10169 @end smallexample
10170
10171 As we step over directives that remove @code{N}'s definition, and then
10172 give it a new definition, @value{GDBN} finds the definition (or lack
10173 thereof) in force at each point:
10174
10175 @smallexample
10176 (@value{GDBP}) next
10177 Hello, world!
10178 12 printf ("We're so creative.\n");
10179 (@value{GDBP}) info macro N
10180 The symbol `N' has no definition as a C/C++ preprocessor macro
10181 at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:12
10182 (@value{GDBP}) next
10183 We're so creative.
10184 14 printf ("Goodbye, world!\n");
10185 (@value{GDBP}) info macro N
10186 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:13
10187 #define N 1729
10188 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand N Q M
10189 expands to: 1729 < 42
10190 (@value{GDBP}) print N Q M
10191 $2 = 0
10192 (@value{GDBP})
10193 @end smallexample
10194
10195 In addition to source files, macros can be defined on the compilation command
10196 line using the @option{-D@var{name}=@var{value}} syntax. For macros defined in
10197 such a way, @value{GDBN} displays the location of their definition as line zero
10198 of the source file submitted to the compiler.
10199
10200 @smallexample
10201 (@value{GDBP}) info macro __STDC__
10202 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:0
10203 -D__STDC__=1
10204 (@value{GDBP})
10205 @end smallexample
10206
10207
10208 @node Tracepoints
10209 @chapter Tracepoints
10210 @c This chapter is based on the documentation written by Michael
10211 @c Snyder, David Taylor, Jim Blandy, and Elena Zannoni.
10212
10213 @cindex tracepoints
10214 In some applications, it is not feasible for the debugger to interrupt
10215 the program's execution long enough for the developer to learn
10216 anything helpful about its behavior. If the program's correctness
10217 depends on its real-time behavior, delays introduced by a debugger
10218 might cause the program to change its behavior drastically, or perhaps
10219 fail, even when the code itself is correct. It is useful to be able
10220 to observe the program's behavior without interrupting it.
10221
10222 Using @value{GDBN}'s @code{trace} and @code{collect} commands, you can
10223 specify locations in the program, called @dfn{tracepoints}, and
10224 arbitrary expressions to evaluate when those tracepoints are reached.
10225 Later, using the @code{tfind} command, you can examine the values
10226 those expressions had when the program hit the tracepoints. The
10227 expressions may also denote objects in memory---structures or arrays,
10228 for example---whose values @value{GDBN} should record; while visiting
10229 a particular tracepoint, you may inspect those objects as if they were
10230 in memory at that moment. However, because @value{GDBN} records these
10231 values without interacting with you, it can do so quickly and
10232 unobtrusively, hopefully not disturbing the program's behavior.
10233
10234 The tracepoint facility is currently available only for remote
10235 targets. @xref{Targets}. In addition, your remote target must know
10236 how to collect trace data. This functionality is implemented in the
10237 remote stub; however, none of the stubs distributed with @value{GDBN}
10238 support tracepoints as of this writing. The format of the remote
10239 packets used to implement tracepoints are described in @ref{Tracepoint
10240 Packets}.
10241
10242 It is also possible to get trace data from a file, in a manner reminiscent
10243 of corefiles; you specify the filename, and use @code{tfind} to search
10244 through the file. @xref{Trace Files}, for more details.
10245
10246 This chapter describes the tracepoint commands and features.
10247
10248 @menu
10249 * Set Tracepoints::
10250 * Analyze Collected Data::
10251 * Tracepoint Variables::
10252 * Trace Files::
10253 @end menu
10254
10255 @node Set Tracepoints
10256 @section Commands to Set Tracepoints
10257
10258 Before running such a @dfn{trace experiment}, an arbitrary number of
10259 tracepoints can be set. A tracepoint is actually a special type of
10260 breakpoint (@pxref{Set Breaks}), so you can manipulate it using
10261 standard breakpoint commands. For instance, as with breakpoints,
10262 tracepoint numbers are successive integers starting from one, and many
10263 of the commands associated with tracepoints take the tracepoint number
10264 as their argument, to identify which tracepoint to work on.
10265
10266 For each tracepoint, you can specify, in advance, some arbitrary set
10267 of data that you want the target to collect in the trace buffer when
10268 it hits that tracepoint. The collected data can include registers,
10269 local variables, or global data. Later, you can use @value{GDBN}
10270 commands to examine the values these data had at the time the
10271 tracepoint was hit.
10272
10273 Tracepoints do not support every breakpoint feature. Ignore counts on
10274 tracepoints have no effect, and tracepoints cannot run @value{GDBN}
10275 commands when they are hit. Tracepoints may not be thread-specific
10276 either.
10277
10278 @cindex fast tracepoints
10279 Some targets may support @dfn{fast tracepoints}, which are inserted in
10280 a different way (such as with a jump instead of a trap), that is
10281 faster but possibly restricted in where they may be installed.
10282
10283 @cindex static tracepoints
10284 @cindex markers, static tracepoints
10285 @cindex probing markers, static tracepoints
10286 Regular and fast tracepoints are dynamic tracing facilities, meaning
10287 that they can be used to insert tracepoints at (almost) any location
10288 in the target. Some targets may also support controlling @dfn{static
10289 tracepoints} from @value{GDBN}. With static tracing, a set of
10290 instrumentation points, also known as @dfn{markers}, are embedded in
10291 the target program, and can be activated or deactivated by name or
10292 address. These are usually placed at locations which facilitate
10293 investigating what the target is actually doing. @value{GDBN}'s
10294 support for static tracing includes being able to list instrumentation
10295 points, and attach them with @value{GDBN} defined high level
10296 tracepoints that expose the whole range of convenience of
10297 @value{GDBN}'s tracepoints support. Namely, support for collecting
10298 registers values and values of global or local (to the instrumentation
10299 point) variables; tracepoint conditions and trace state variables.
10300 The act of installing a @value{GDBN} static tracepoint on an
10301 instrumentation point, or marker, is referred to as @dfn{probing} a
10302 static tracepoint marker.
10303
10304 @code{gdbserver} supports tracepoints on some target systems.
10305 @xref{Server,,Tracepoints support in @code{gdbserver}}.
10306
10307 This section describes commands to set tracepoints and associated
10308 conditions and actions.
10309
10310 @menu
10311 * Create and Delete Tracepoints::
10312 * Enable and Disable Tracepoints::
10313 * Tracepoint Passcounts::
10314 * Tracepoint Conditions::
10315 * Trace State Variables::
10316 * Tracepoint Actions::
10317 * Listing Tracepoints::
10318 * Listing Static Tracepoint Markers::
10319 * Starting and Stopping Trace Experiments::
10320 * Tracepoint Restrictions::
10321 @end menu
10322
10323 @node Create and Delete Tracepoints
10324 @subsection Create and Delete Tracepoints
10325
10326 @table @code
10327 @cindex set tracepoint
10328 @kindex trace
10329 @item trace @var{location}
10330 The @code{trace} command is very similar to the @code{break} command.
10331 Its argument @var{location} can be a source line, a function name, or
10332 an address in the target program. @xref{Specify Location}. The
10333 @code{trace} command defines a tracepoint, which is a point in the
10334 target program where the debugger will briefly stop, collect some
10335 data, and then allow the program to continue. Setting a tracepoint or
10336 changing its actions takes effect immediately if the remote stub
10337 supports the @samp{InstallInTrace} feature (@pxref{install tracepoint
10338 in tracing}).
10339 If remote stub doesn't support the @samp{InstallInTrace} feature, all
10340 these changes don't take effect until the next @code{tstart}
10341 command, and once a trace experiment is running, further changes will
10342 not have any effect until the next trace experiment starts. In addition,
10343 @value{GDBN} supports @dfn{pending tracepoints}---tracepoints whose
10344 address is not yet resolved. (This is similar to pending breakpoints.)
10345 Pending tracepoints are not downloaded to the target and not installed
10346 until they are resolved. The resolution of pending tracepoints requires
10347 @value{GDBN} support---when debugging with the remote target, and
10348 @value{GDBN} disconnects from the remote stub (@pxref{disconnected
10349 tracing}), pending tracepoints can not be resolved (and downloaded to
10350 the remote stub) while @value{GDBN} is disconnected.
10351
10352 Here are some examples of using the @code{trace} command:
10353
10354 @smallexample
10355 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo.c:121} // a source file and line number
10356
10357 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace +2} // 2 lines forward
10358
10359 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace my_function} // first source line of function
10360
10361 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace *my_function} // EXACT start address of function
10362
10363 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace *0x2117c4} // an address
10364 @end smallexample
10365
10366 @noindent
10367 You can abbreviate @code{trace} as @code{tr}.
10368
10369 @item trace @var{location} if @var{cond}
10370 Set a tracepoint with condition @var{cond}; evaluate the expression
10371 @var{cond} each time the tracepoint is reached, and collect data only
10372 if the value is nonzero---that is, if @var{cond} evaluates as true.
10373 @xref{Tracepoint Conditions, ,Tracepoint Conditions}, for more
10374 information on tracepoint conditions.
10375
10376 @item ftrace @var{location} [ if @var{cond} ]
10377 @cindex set fast tracepoint
10378 @cindex fast tracepoints, setting
10379 @kindex ftrace
10380 The @code{ftrace} command sets a fast tracepoint. For targets that
10381 support them, fast tracepoints will use a more efficient but possibly
10382 less general technique to trigger data collection, such as a jump
10383 instruction instead of a trap, or some sort of hardware support. It
10384 may not be possible to create a fast tracepoint at the desired
10385 location, in which case the command will exit with an explanatory
10386 message.
10387
10388 @value{GDBN} handles arguments to @code{ftrace} exactly as for
10389 @code{trace}.
10390
10391 On 32-bit x86-architecture systems, fast tracepoints normally need to
10392 be placed at an instruction that is 5 bytes or longer, but can be
10393 placed at 4-byte instructions if the low 64K of memory of the target
10394 program is available to install trampolines. Some Unix-type systems,
10395 such as @sc{gnu}/Linux, exclude low addresses from the program's
10396 address space; but for instance with the Linux kernel it is possible
10397 to let @value{GDBN} use this area by doing a @command{sysctl} command
10398 to set the @code{mmap_min_addr} kernel parameter, as in
10399
10400 @example
10401 sudo sysctl -w vm.mmap_min_addr=32768
10402 @end example
10403
10404 @noindent
10405 which sets the low address to 32K, which leaves plenty of room for
10406 trampolines. The minimum address should be set to a page boundary.
10407
10408 @item strace @var{location} [ if @var{cond} ]
10409 @cindex set static tracepoint
10410 @cindex static tracepoints, setting
10411 @cindex probe static tracepoint marker
10412 @kindex strace
10413 The @code{strace} command sets a static tracepoint. For targets that
10414 support it, setting a static tracepoint probes a static
10415 instrumentation point, or marker, found at @var{location}. It may not
10416 be possible to set a static tracepoint at the desired location, in
10417 which case the command will exit with an explanatory message.
10418
10419 @value{GDBN} handles arguments to @code{strace} exactly as for
10420 @code{trace}, with the addition that the user can also specify
10421 @code{-m @var{marker}} as @var{location}. This probes the marker
10422 identified by the @var{marker} string identifier. This identifier
10423 depends on the static tracepoint backend library your program is
10424 using. You can find all the marker identifiers in the @samp{ID} field
10425 of the @code{info static-tracepoint-markers} command output.
10426 @xref{Listing Static Tracepoint Markers,,Listing Static Tracepoint
10427 Markers}. For example, in the following small program using the UST
10428 tracing engine:
10429
10430 @smallexample
10431 main ()
10432 @{
10433 trace_mark(ust, bar33, "str %s", "FOOBAZ");
10434 @}
10435 @end smallexample
10436
10437 @noindent
10438 the marker id is composed of joining the first two arguments to the
10439 @code{trace_mark} call with a slash, which translates to:
10440
10441 @smallexample
10442 (@value{GDBP}) info static-tracepoint-markers
10443 Cnt Enb ID Address What
10444 1 n ust/bar33 0x0000000000400ddc in main at stexample.c:22
10445 Data: "str %s"
10446 [etc...]
10447 @end smallexample
10448
10449 @noindent
10450 so you may probe the marker above with:
10451
10452 @smallexample
10453 (@value{GDBP}) strace -m ust/bar33
10454 @end smallexample
10455
10456 Static tracepoints accept an extra collect action --- @code{collect
10457 $_sdata}. This collects arbitrary user data passed in the probe point
10458 call to the tracing library. In the UST example above, you'll see
10459 that the third argument to @code{trace_mark} is a printf-like format
10460 string. The user data is then the result of running that formating
10461 string against the following arguments. Note that @code{info
10462 static-tracepoint-markers} command output lists that format string in
10463 the @samp{Data:} field.
10464
10465 You can inspect this data when analyzing the trace buffer, by printing
10466 the $_sdata variable like any other variable available to
10467 @value{GDBN}. @xref{Tracepoint Actions,,Tracepoint Action Lists}.
10468
10469 @vindex $tpnum
10470 @cindex last tracepoint number
10471 @cindex recent tracepoint number
10472 @cindex tracepoint number
10473 The convenience variable @code{$tpnum} records the tracepoint number
10474 of the most recently set tracepoint.
10475
10476 @kindex delete tracepoint
10477 @cindex tracepoint deletion
10478 @item delete tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
10479 Permanently delete one or more tracepoints. With no argument, the
10480 default is to delete all tracepoints. Note that the regular
10481 @code{delete} command can remove tracepoints also.
10482
10483 Examples:
10484
10485 @smallexample
10486 (@value{GDBP}) @b{delete trace 1 2 3} // remove three tracepoints
10487
10488 (@value{GDBP}) @b{delete trace} // remove all tracepoints
10489 @end smallexample
10490
10491 @noindent
10492 You can abbreviate this command as @code{del tr}.
10493 @end table
10494
10495 @node Enable and Disable Tracepoints
10496 @subsection Enable and Disable Tracepoints
10497
10498 These commands are deprecated; they are equivalent to plain @code{disable} and @code{enable}.
10499
10500 @table @code
10501 @kindex disable tracepoint
10502 @item disable tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
10503 Disable tracepoint @var{num}, or all tracepoints if no argument
10504 @var{num} is given. A disabled tracepoint will have no effect during
10505 a trace experiment, but it is not forgotten. You can re-enable
10506 a disabled tracepoint using the @code{enable tracepoint} command.
10507 If the command is issued during a trace experiment and the debug target
10508 has support for disabling tracepoints during a trace experiment, then the
10509 change will be effective immediately. Otherwise, it will be applied to the
10510 next trace experiment.
10511
10512 @kindex enable tracepoint
10513 @item enable tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
10514 Enable tracepoint @var{num}, or all tracepoints. If this command is
10515 issued during a trace experiment and the debug target supports enabling
10516 tracepoints during a trace experiment, then the enabled tracepoints will
10517 become effective immediately. Otherwise, they will become effective the
10518 next time a trace experiment is run.
10519 @end table
10520
10521 @node Tracepoint Passcounts
10522 @subsection Tracepoint Passcounts
10523
10524 @table @code
10525 @kindex passcount
10526 @cindex tracepoint pass count
10527 @item passcount @r{[}@var{n} @r{[}@var{num}@r{]]}
10528 Set the @dfn{passcount} of a tracepoint. The passcount is a way to
10529 automatically stop a trace experiment. If a tracepoint's passcount is
10530 @var{n}, then the trace experiment will be automatically stopped on
10531 the @var{n}'th time that tracepoint is hit. If the tracepoint number
10532 @var{num} is not specified, the @code{passcount} command sets the
10533 passcount of the most recently defined tracepoint. If no passcount is
10534 given, the trace experiment will run until stopped explicitly by the
10535 user.
10536
10537 Examples:
10538
10539 @smallexample
10540 (@value{GDBP}) @b{passcount 5 2} // Stop on the 5th execution of
10541 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// tracepoint 2}
10542
10543 (@value{GDBP}) @b{passcount 12} // Stop on the 12th execution of the
10544 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// most recently defined tracepoint.}
10545 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo}
10546 (@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 3}
10547 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace bar}
10548 (@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 2}
10549 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace baz}
10550 (@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 1} // Stop tracing when foo has been
10551 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// executed 3 times OR when bar has}
10552 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// been executed 2 times}
10553 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// OR when baz has been executed 1 time.}
10554 @end smallexample
10555 @end table
10556
10557 @node Tracepoint Conditions
10558 @subsection Tracepoint Conditions
10559 @cindex conditional tracepoints
10560 @cindex tracepoint conditions
10561
10562 The simplest sort of tracepoint collects data every time your program
10563 reaches a specified place. You can also specify a @dfn{condition} for
10564 a tracepoint. A condition is just a Boolean expression in your
10565 programming language (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). A
10566 tracepoint with a condition evaluates the expression each time your
10567 program reaches it, and data collection happens only if the condition
10568 is true.
10569
10570 Tracepoint conditions can be specified when a tracepoint is set, by
10571 using @samp{if} in the arguments to the @code{trace} command.
10572 @xref{Create and Delete Tracepoints, ,Setting Tracepoints}. They can
10573 also be set or changed at any time with the @code{condition} command,
10574 just as with breakpoints.
10575
10576 Unlike breakpoint conditions, @value{GDBN} does not actually evaluate
10577 the conditional expression itself. Instead, @value{GDBN} encodes the
10578 expression into an agent expression (@pxref{Agent Expressions})
10579 suitable for execution on the target, independently of @value{GDBN}.
10580 Global variables become raw memory locations, locals become stack
10581 accesses, and so forth.
10582
10583 For instance, suppose you have a function that is usually called
10584 frequently, but should not be called after an error has occurred. You
10585 could use the following tracepoint command to collect data about calls
10586 of that function that happen while the error code is propagating
10587 through the program; an unconditional tracepoint could end up
10588 collecting thousands of useless trace frames that you would have to
10589 search through.
10590
10591 @smallexample
10592 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{trace normal_operation if errcode > 0}
10593 @end smallexample
10594
10595 @node Trace State Variables
10596 @subsection Trace State Variables
10597 @cindex trace state variables
10598
10599 A @dfn{trace state variable} is a special type of variable that is
10600 created and managed by target-side code. The syntax is the same as
10601 that for GDB's convenience variables (a string prefixed with ``$''),
10602 but they are stored on the target. They must be created explicitly,
10603 using a @code{tvariable} command. They are always 64-bit signed
10604 integers.
10605
10606 Trace state variables are remembered by @value{GDBN}, and downloaded
10607 to the target along with tracepoint information when the trace
10608 experiment starts. There are no intrinsic limits on the number of
10609 trace state variables, beyond memory limitations of the target.
10610
10611 @cindex convenience variables, and trace state variables
10612 Although trace state variables are managed by the target, you can use
10613 them in print commands and expressions as if they were convenience
10614 variables; @value{GDBN} will get the current value from the target
10615 while the trace experiment is running. Trace state variables share
10616 the same namespace as other ``$'' variables, which means that you
10617 cannot have trace state variables with names like @code{$23} or
10618 @code{$pc}, nor can you have a trace state variable and a convenience
10619 variable with the same name.
10620
10621 @table @code
10622
10623 @item tvariable $@var{name} [ = @var{expression} ]
10624 @kindex tvariable
10625 The @code{tvariable} command creates a new trace state variable named
10626 @code{$@var{name}}, and optionally gives it an initial value of
10627 @var{expression}. @var{expression} is evaluated when this command is
10628 entered; the result will be converted to an integer if possible,
10629 otherwise @value{GDBN} will report an error. A subsequent
10630 @code{tvariable} command specifying the same name does not create a
10631 variable, but instead assigns the supplied initial value to the
10632 existing variable of that name, overwriting any previous initial
10633 value. The default initial value is 0.
10634
10635 @item info tvariables
10636 @kindex info tvariables
10637 List all the trace state variables along with their initial values.
10638 Their current values may also be displayed, if the trace experiment is
10639 currently running.
10640
10641 @item delete tvariable @r{[} $@var{name} @dots{} @r{]}
10642 @kindex delete tvariable
10643 Delete the given trace state variables, or all of them if no arguments
10644 are specified.
10645
10646 @end table
10647
10648 @node Tracepoint Actions
10649 @subsection Tracepoint Action Lists
10650
10651 @table @code
10652 @kindex actions
10653 @cindex tracepoint actions
10654 @item actions @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
10655 This command will prompt for a list of actions to be taken when the
10656 tracepoint is hit. If the tracepoint number @var{num} is not
10657 specified, this command sets the actions for the one that was most
10658 recently defined (so that you can define a tracepoint and then say
10659 @code{actions} without bothering about its number). You specify the
10660 actions themselves on the following lines, one action at a time, and
10661 terminate the actions list with a line containing just @code{end}. So
10662 far, the only defined actions are @code{collect}, @code{teval}, and
10663 @code{while-stepping}.
10664
10665 @code{actions} is actually equivalent to @code{commands} (@pxref{Break
10666 Commands, ,Breakpoint Command Lists}), except that only the defined
10667 actions are allowed; any other @value{GDBN} command is rejected.
10668
10669 @cindex remove actions from a tracepoint
10670 To remove all actions from a tracepoint, type @samp{actions @var{num}}
10671 and follow it immediately with @samp{end}.
10672
10673 @smallexample
10674 (@value{GDBP}) @b{collect @var{data}} // collect some data
10675
10676 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while-stepping 5} // single-step 5 times, collect data
10677
10678 (@value{GDBP}) @b{end} // signals the end of actions.
10679 @end smallexample
10680
10681 In the following example, the action list begins with @code{collect}
10682 commands indicating the things to be collected when the tracepoint is
10683 hit. Then, in order to single-step and collect additional data
10684 following the tracepoint, a @code{while-stepping} command is used,
10685 followed by the list of things to be collected after each step in a
10686 sequence of single steps. The @code{while-stepping} command is
10687 terminated by its own separate @code{end} command. Lastly, the action
10688 list is terminated by an @code{end} command.
10689
10690 @smallexample
10691 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo}
10692 (@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
10693 Enter actions for tracepoint 1, one per line:
10694 > collect bar,baz
10695 > collect $regs
10696 > while-stepping 12
10697 > collect $pc, arr[i]
10698 > end
10699 end
10700 @end smallexample
10701
10702 @kindex collect @r{(tracepoints)}
10703 @item collect@r{[}/@var{mods}@r{]} @var{expr1}, @var{expr2}, @dots{}
10704 Collect values of the given expressions when the tracepoint is hit.
10705 This command accepts a comma-separated list of any valid expressions.
10706 In addition to global, static, or local variables, the following
10707 special arguments are supported:
10708
10709 @table @code
10710 @item $regs
10711 Collect all registers.
10712
10713 @item $args
10714 Collect all function arguments.
10715
10716 @item $locals
10717 Collect all local variables.
10718
10719 @item $_ret
10720 Collect the return address. This is helpful if you want to see more
10721 of a backtrace.
10722
10723 @item $_sdata
10724 @vindex $_sdata@r{, collect}
10725 Collect static tracepoint marker specific data. Only available for
10726 static tracepoints. @xref{Tracepoint Actions,,Tracepoint Action
10727 Lists}. On the UST static tracepoints library backend, an
10728 instrumentation point resembles a @code{printf} function call. The
10729 tracing library is able to collect user specified data formatted to a
10730 character string using the format provided by the programmer that
10731 instrumented the program. Other backends have similar mechanisms.
10732 Here's an example of a UST marker call:
10733
10734 @smallexample
10735 const char master_name[] = "$your_name";
10736 trace_mark(channel1, marker1, "hello %s", master_name)
10737 @end smallexample
10738
10739 In this case, collecting @code{$_sdata} collects the string
10740 @samp{hello $yourname}. When analyzing the trace buffer, you can
10741 inspect @samp{$_sdata} like any other variable available to
10742 @value{GDBN}.
10743 @end table
10744
10745 You can give several consecutive @code{collect} commands, each one
10746 with a single argument, or one @code{collect} command with several
10747 arguments separated by commas; the effect is the same.
10748
10749 The optional @var{mods} changes the usual handling of the arguments.
10750 @code{s} requests that pointers to chars be handled as strings, in
10751 particular collecting the contents of the memory being pointed at, up
10752 to the first zero. The upper bound is by default the value of the
10753 @code{print elements} variable; if @code{s} is followed by a decimal
10754 number, that is the upper bound instead. So for instance
10755 @samp{collect/s25 mystr} collects as many as 25 characters at
10756 @samp{mystr}.
10757
10758 The command @code{info scope} (@pxref{Symbols, info scope}) is
10759 particularly useful for figuring out what data to collect.
10760
10761 @kindex teval @r{(tracepoints)}
10762 @item teval @var{expr1}, @var{expr2}, @dots{}
10763 Evaluate the given expressions when the tracepoint is hit. This
10764 command accepts a comma-separated list of expressions. The results
10765 are discarded, so this is mainly useful for assigning values to trace
10766 state variables (@pxref{Trace State Variables}) without adding those
10767 values to the trace buffer, as would be the case if the @code{collect}
10768 action were used.
10769
10770 @kindex while-stepping @r{(tracepoints)}
10771 @item while-stepping @var{n}
10772 Perform @var{n} single-step instruction traces after the tracepoint,
10773 collecting new data after each step. The @code{while-stepping}
10774 command is followed by the list of what to collect while stepping
10775 (followed by its own @code{end} command):
10776
10777 @smallexample
10778 > while-stepping 12
10779 > collect $regs, myglobal
10780 > end
10781 >
10782 @end smallexample
10783
10784 @noindent
10785 Note that @code{$pc} is not automatically collected by
10786 @code{while-stepping}; you need to explicitly collect that register if
10787 you need it. You may abbreviate @code{while-stepping} as @code{ws} or
10788 @code{stepping}.
10789
10790 @item set default-collect @var{expr1}, @var{expr2}, @dots{}
10791 @kindex set default-collect
10792 @cindex default collection action
10793 This variable is a list of expressions to collect at each tracepoint
10794 hit. It is effectively an additional @code{collect} action prepended
10795 to every tracepoint action list. The expressions are parsed
10796 individually for each tracepoint, so for instance a variable named
10797 @code{xyz} may be interpreted as a global for one tracepoint, and a
10798 local for another, as appropriate to the tracepoint's location.
10799
10800 @item show default-collect
10801 @kindex show default-collect
10802 Show the list of expressions that are collected by default at each
10803 tracepoint hit.
10804
10805 @end table
10806
10807 @node Listing Tracepoints
10808 @subsection Listing Tracepoints
10809
10810 @table @code
10811 @kindex info tracepoints @r{[}@var{n}@dots{}@r{]}
10812 @kindex info tp @r{[}@var{n}@dots{}@r{]}
10813 @cindex information about tracepoints
10814 @item info tracepoints @r{[}@var{num}@dots{}@r{]}
10815 Display information about the tracepoint @var{num}. If you don't
10816 specify a tracepoint number, displays information about all the
10817 tracepoints defined so far. The format is similar to that used for
10818 @code{info breakpoints}; in fact, @code{info tracepoints} is the same
10819 command, simply restricting itself to tracepoints.
10820
10821 A tracepoint's listing may include additional information specific to
10822 tracing:
10823
10824 @itemize @bullet
10825 @item
10826 its passcount as given by the @code{passcount @var{n}} command
10827 @end itemize
10828
10829 @smallexample
10830 (@value{GDBP}) @b{info trace}
10831 Num Type Disp Enb Address What
10832 1 tracepoint keep y 0x0804ab57 in foo() at main.cxx:7
10833 while-stepping 20
10834 collect globfoo, $regs
10835 end
10836 collect globfoo2
10837 end
10838 pass count 1200
10839 (@value{GDBP})
10840 @end smallexample
10841
10842 @noindent
10843 This command can be abbreviated @code{info tp}.
10844 @end table
10845
10846 @node Listing Static Tracepoint Markers
10847 @subsection Listing Static Tracepoint Markers
10848
10849 @table @code
10850 @kindex info static-tracepoint-markers
10851 @cindex information about static tracepoint markers
10852 @item info static-tracepoint-markers
10853 Display information about all static tracepoint markers defined in the
10854 program.
10855
10856 For each marker, the following columns are printed:
10857
10858 @table @emph
10859 @item Count
10860 An incrementing counter, output to help readability. This is not a
10861 stable identifier.
10862 @item ID
10863 The marker ID, as reported by the target.
10864 @item Enabled or Disabled
10865 Probed markers are tagged with @samp{y}. @samp{n} identifies marks
10866 that are not enabled.
10867 @item Address
10868 Where the marker is in your program, as a memory address.
10869 @item What
10870 Where the marker is in the source for your program, as a file and line
10871 number. If the debug information included in the program does not
10872 allow @value{GDBN} to locate the source of the marker, this column
10873 will be left blank.
10874 @end table
10875
10876 @noindent
10877 In addition, the following information may be printed for each marker:
10878
10879 @table @emph
10880 @item Data
10881 User data passed to the tracing library by the marker call. In the
10882 UST backend, this is the format string passed as argument to the
10883 marker call.
10884 @item Static tracepoints probing the marker
10885 The list of static tracepoints attached to the marker.
10886 @end table
10887
10888 @smallexample
10889 (@value{GDBP}) info static-tracepoint-markers
10890 Cnt ID Enb Address What
10891 1 ust/bar2 y 0x0000000000400e1a in main at stexample.c:25
10892 Data: number1 %d number2 %d
10893 Probed by static tracepoints: #2
10894 2 ust/bar33 n 0x0000000000400c87 in main at stexample.c:24
10895 Data: str %s
10896 (@value{GDBP})
10897 @end smallexample
10898 @end table
10899
10900 @node Starting and Stopping Trace Experiments
10901 @subsection Starting and Stopping Trace Experiments
10902
10903 @table @code
10904 @kindex tstart [ @var{notes} ]
10905 @cindex start a new trace experiment
10906 @cindex collected data discarded
10907 @item tstart
10908 This command starts the trace experiment, and begins collecting data.
10909 It has the side effect of discarding all the data collected in the
10910 trace buffer during the previous trace experiment. If any arguments
10911 are supplied, they are taken as a note and stored with the trace
10912 experiment's state. The notes may be arbitrary text, and are
10913 especially useful with disconnected tracing in a multi-user context;
10914 the notes can explain what the trace is doing, supply user contact
10915 information, and so forth.
10916
10917 @kindex tstop [ @var{notes} ]
10918 @cindex stop a running trace experiment
10919 @item tstop
10920 This command stops the trace experiment. If any arguments are
10921 supplied, they are recorded with the experiment as a note. This is
10922 useful if you are stopping a trace started by someone else, for
10923 instance if the trace is interfering with the system's behavior and
10924 needs to be stopped quickly.
10925
10926 @strong{Note}: a trace experiment and data collection may stop
10927 automatically if any tracepoint's passcount is reached
10928 (@pxref{Tracepoint Passcounts}), or if the trace buffer becomes full.
10929
10930 @kindex tstatus
10931 @cindex status of trace data collection
10932 @cindex trace experiment, status of
10933 @item tstatus
10934 This command displays the status of the current trace data
10935 collection.
10936 @end table
10937
10938 Here is an example of the commands we described so far:
10939
10940 @smallexample
10941 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace gdb_c_test}
10942 (@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
10943 Enter actions for tracepoint #1, one per line.
10944 > collect $regs,$locals,$args
10945 > while-stepping 11
10946 > collect $regs
10947 > end
10948 > end
10949 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tstart}
10950 [time passes @dots{}]
10951 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tstop}
10952 @end smallexample
10953
10954 @anchor{disconnected tracing}
10955 @cindex disconnected tracing
10956 You can choose to continue running the trace experiment even if
10957 @value{GDBN} disconnects from the target, voluntarily or
10958 involuntarily. For commands such as @code{detach}, the debugger will
10959 ask what you want to do with the trace. But for unexpected
10960 terminations (@value{GDBN} crash, network outage), it would be
10961 unfortunate to lose hard-won trace data, so the variable
10962 @code{disconnected-tracing} lets you decide whether the trace should
10963 continue running without @value{GDBN}.
10964
10965 @table @code
10966 @item set disconnected-tracing on
10967 @itemx set disconnected-tracing off
10968 @kindex set disconnected-tracing
10969 Choose whether a tracing run should continue to run if @value{GDBN}
10970 has disconnected from the target. Note that @code{detach} or
10971 @code{quit} will ask you directly what to do about a running trace no
10972 matter what this variable's setting, so the variable is mainly useful
10973 for handling unexpected situations, such as loss of the network.
10974
10975 @item show disconnected-tracing
10976 @kindex show disconnected-tracing
10977 Show the current choice for disconnected tracing.
10978
10979 @end table
10980
10981 When you reconnect to the target, the trace experiment may or may not
10982 still be running; it might have filled the trace buffer in the
10983 meantime, or stopped for one of the other reasons. If it is running,
10984 it will continue after reconnection.
10985
10986 Upon reconnection, the target will upload information about the
10987 tracepoints in effect. @value{GDBN} will then compare that
10988 information to the set of tracepoints currently defined, and attempt
10989 to match them up, allowing for the possibility that the numbers may
10990 have changed due to creation and deletion in the meantime. If one of
10991 the target's tracepoints does not match any in @value{GDBN}, the
10992 debugger will create a new tracepoint, so that you have a number with
10993 which to specify that tracepoint. This matching-up process is
10994 necessarily heuristic, and it may result in useless tracepoints being
10995 created; you may simply delete them if they are of no use.
10996
10997 @cindex circular trace buffer
10998 If your target agent supports a @dfn{circular trace buffer}, then you
10999 can run a trace experiment indefinitely without filling the trace
11000 buffer; when space runs out, the agent deletes already-collected trace
11001 frames, oldest first, until there is enough room to continue
11002 collecting. This is especially useful if your tracepoints are being
11003 hit too often, and your trace gets terminated prematurely because the
11004 buffer is full. To ask for a circular trace buffer, simply set
11005 @samp{circular-trace-buffer} to on. You can set this at any time,
11006 including during tracing; if the agent can do it, it will change
11007 buffer handling on the fly, otherwise it will not take effect until
11008 the next run.
11009
11010 @table @code
11011 @item set circular-trace-buffer on
11012 @itemx set circular-trace-buffer off
11013 @kindex set circular-trace-buffer
11014 Choose whether a tracing run should use a linear or circular buffer
11015 for trace data. A linear buffer will not lose any trace data, but may
11016 fill up prematurely, while a circular buffer will discard old trace
11017 data, but it will have always room for the latest tracepoint hits.
11018
11019 @item show circular-trace-buffer
11020 @kindex show circular-trace-buffer
11021 Show the current choice for the trace buffer. Note that this may not
11022 match the agent's current buffer handling, nor is it guaranteed to
11023 match the setting that might have been in effect during a past run,
11024 for instance if you are looking at frames from a trace file.
11025
11026 @end table
11027
11028 @table @code
11029 @item set trace-user @var{text}
11030 @kindex set trace-user
11031
11032 @item show trace-user
11033 @kindex show trace-user
11034
11035 @item set trace-notes @var{text}
11036 @kindex set trace-notes
11037 Set the trace run's notes.
11038
11039 @item show trace-notes
11040 @kindex show trace-notes
11041 Show the trace run's notes.
11042
11043 @item set trace-stop-notes @var{text}
11044 @kindex set trace-stop-notes
11045 Set the trace run's stop notes. The handling of the note is as for
11046 @code{tstop} arguments; the set command is convenient way to fix a
11047 stop note that is mistaken or incomplete.
11048
11049 @item show trace-stop-notes
11050 @kindex show trace-stop-notes
11051 Show the trace run's stop notes.
11052
11053 @end table
11054
11055 @node Tracepoint Restrictions
11056 @subsection Tracepoint Restrictions
11057
11058 @cindex tracepoint restrictions
11059 There are a number of restrictions on the use of tracepoints. As
11060 described above, tracepoint data gathering occurs on the target
11061 without interaction from @value{GDBN}. Thus the full capabilities of
11062 the debugger are not available during data gathering, and then at data
11063 examination time, you will be limited by only having what was
11064 collected. The following items describe some common problems, but it
11065 is not exhaustive, and you may run into additional difficulties not
11066 mentioned here.
11067
11068 @itemize @bullet
11069
11070 @item
11071 Tracepoint expressions are intended to gather objects (lvalues). Thus
11072 the full flexibility of GDB's expression evaluator is not available.
11073 You cannot call functions, cast objects to aggregate types, access
11074 convenience variables or modify values (except by assignment to trace
11075 state variables). Some language features may implicitly call
11076 functions (for instance Objective-C fields with accessors), and therefore
11077 cannot be collected either.
11078
11079 @item
11080 Collection of local variables, either individually or in bulk with
11081 @code{$locals} or @code{$args}, during @code{while-stepping} may
11082 behave erratically. The stepping action may enter a new scope (for
11083 instance by stepping into a function), or the location of the variable
11084 may change (for instance it is loaded into a register). The
11085 tracepoint data recorded uses the location information for the
11086 variables that is correct for the tracepoint location. When the
11087 tracepoint is created, it is not possible, in general, to determine
11088 where the steps of a @code{while-stepping} sequence will advance the
11089 program---particularly if a conditional branch is stepped.
11090
11091 @item
11092 Collection of an incompletely-initialized or partially-destroyed object
11093 may result in something that @value{GDBN} cannot display, or displays
11094 in a misleading way.
11095
11096 @item
11097 When @value{GDBN} displays a pointer to character it automatically
11098 dereferences the pointer to also display characters of the string
11099 being pointed to. However, collecting the pointer during tracing does
11100 not automatically collect the string. You need to explicitly
11101 dereference the pointer and provide size information if you want to
11102 collect not only the pointer, but the memory pointed to. For example,
11103 @code{*ptr@@50} can be used to collect the 50 element array pointed to
11104 by @code{ptr}.
11105
11106 @item
11107 It is not possible to collect a complete stack backtrace at a
11108 tracepoint. Instead, you may collect the registers and a few hundred
11109 bytes from the stack pointer with something like @code{*(unsigned char *)$esp@@300}
11110 (adjust to use the name of the actual stack pointer register on your
11111 target architecture, and the amount of stack you wish to capture).
11112 Then the @code{backtrace} command will show a partial backtrace when
11113 using a trace frame. The number of stack frames that can be examined
11114 depends on the sizes of the frames in the collected stack. Note that
11115 if you ask for a block so large that it goes past the bottom of the
11116 stack, the target agent may report an error trying to read from an
11117 invalid address.
11118
11119 @item
11120 If you do not collect registers at a tracepoint, @value{GDBN} can
11121 infer that the value of @code{$pc} must be the same as the address of
11122 the tracepoint and use that when you are looking at a trace frame
11123 for that tracepoint. However, this cannot work if the tracepoint has
11124 multiple locations (for instance if it was set in a function that was
11125 inlined), or if it has a @code{while-stepping} loop. In those cases
11126 @value{GDBN} will warn you that it can't infer @code{$pc}, and default
11127 it to zero.
11128
11129 @end itemize
11130
11131 @node Analyze Collected Data
11132 @section Using the Collected Data
11133
11134 After the tracepoint experiment ends, you use @value{GDBN} commands
11135 for examining the trace data. The basic idea is that each tracepoint
11136 collects a trace @dfn{snapshot} every time it is hit and another
11137 snapshot every time it single-steps. All these snapshots are
11138 consecutively numbered from zero and go into a buffer, and you can
11139 examine them later. The way you examine them is to @dfn{focus} on a
11140 specific trace snapshot. When the remote stub is focused on a trace
11141 snapshot, it will respond to all @value{GDBN} requests for memory and
11142 registers by reading from the buffer which belongs to that snapshot,
11143 rather than from @emph{real} memory or registers of the program being
11144 debugged. This means that @strong{all} @value{GDBN} commands
11145 (@code{print}, @code{info registers}, @code{backtrace}, etc.) will
11146 behave as if we were currently debugging the program state as it was
11147 when the tracepoint occurred. Any requests for data that are not in
11148 the buffer will fail.
11149
11150 @menu
11151 * tfind:: How to select a trace snapshot
11152 * tdump:: How to display all data for a snapshot
11153 * save tracepoints:: How to save tracepoints for a future run
11154 @end menu
11155
11156 @node tfind
11157 @subsection @code{tfind @var{n}}
11158
11159 @kindex tfind
11160 @cindex select trace snapshot
11161 @cindex find trace snapshot
11162 The basic command for selecting a trace snapshot from the buffer is
11163 @code{tfind @var{n}}, which finds trace snapshot number @var{n},
11164 counting from zero. If no argument @var{n} is given, the next
11165 snapshot is selected.
11166
11167 Here are the various forms of using the @code{tfind} command.
11168
11169 @table @code
11170 @item tfind start
11171 Find the first snapshot in the buffer. This is a synonym for
11172 @code{tfind 0} (since 0 is the number of the first snapshot).
11173
11174 @item tfind none
11175 Stop debugging trace snapshots, resume @emph{live} debugging.
11176
11177 @item tfind end
11178 Same as @samp{tfind none}.
11179
11180 @item tfind
11181 No argument means find the next trace snapshot.
11182
11183 @item tfind -
11184 Find the previous trace snapshot before the current one. This permits
11185 retracing earlier steps.
11186
11187 @item tfind tracepoint @var{num}
11188 Find the next snapshot associated with tracepoint @var{num}. Search
11189 proceeds forward from the last examined trace snapshot. If no
11190 argument @var{num} is given, it means find the next snapshot collected
11191 for the same tracepoint as the current snapshot.
11192
11193 @item tfind pc @var{addr}
11194 Find the next snapshot associated with the value @var{addr} of the
11195 program counter. Search proceeds forward from the last examined trace
11196 snapshot. If no argument @var{addr} is given, it means find the next
11197 snapshot with the same value of PC as the current snapshot.
11198
11199 @item tfind outside @var{addr1}, @var{addr2}
11200 Find the next snapshot whose PC is outside the given range of
11201 addresses (exclusive).
11202
11203 @item tfind range @var{addr1}, @var{addr2}
11204 Find the next snapshot whose PC is between @var{addr1} and
11205 @var{addr2} (inclusive).
11206
11207 @item tfind line @r{[}@var{file}:@r{]}@var{n}
11208 Find the next snapshot associated with the source line @var{n}. If
11209 the optional argument @var{file} is given, refer to line @var{n} in
11210 that source file. Search proceeds forward from the last examined
11211 trace snapshot. If no argument @var{n} is given, it means find the
11212 next line other than the one currently being examined; thus saying
11213 @code{tfind line} repeatedly can appear to have the same effect as
11214 stepping from line to line in a @emph{live} debugging session.
11215 @end table
11216
11217 The default arguments for the @code{tfind} commands are specifically
11218 designed to make it easy to scan through the trace buffer. For
11219 instance, @code{tfind} with no argument selects the next trace
11220 snapshot, and @code{tfind -} with no argument selects the previous
11221 trace snapshot. So, by giving one @code{tfind} command, and then
11222 simply hitting @key{RET} repeatedly you can examine all the trace
11223 snapshots in order. Or, by saying @code{tfind -} and then hitting
11224 @key{RET} repeatedly you can examine the snapshots in reverse order.
11225 The @code{tfind line} command with no argument selects the snapshot
11226 for the next source line executed. The @code{tfind pc} command with
11227 no argument selects the next snapshot with the same program counter
11228 (PC) as the current frame. The @code{tfind tracepoint} command with
11229 no argument selects the next trace snapshot collected by the same
11230 tracepoint as the current one.
11231
11232 In addition to letting you scan through the trace buffer manually,
11233 these commands make it easy to construct @value{GDBN} scripts that
11234 scan through the trace buffer and print out whatever collected data
11235 you are interested in. Thus, if we want to examine the PC, FP, and SP
11236 registers from each trace frame in the buffer, we can say this:
11237
11238 @smallexample
11239 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
11240 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while ($trace_frame != -1)}
11241 > printf "Frame %d, PC = %08X, SP = %08X, FP = %08X\n", \
11242 $trace_frame, $pc, $sp, $fp
11243 > tfind
11244 > end
11245
11246 Frame 0, PC = 0020DC64, SP = 0030BF3C, FP = 0030BF44
11247 Frame 1, PC = 0020DC6C, SP = 0030BF38, FP = 0030BF44
11248 Frame 2, PC = 0020DC70, SP = 0030BF34, FP = 0030BF44
11249 Frame 3, PC = 0020DC74, SP = 0030BF30, FP = 0030BF44
11250 Frame 4, PC = 0020DC78, SP = 0030BF2C, FP = 0030BF44
11251 Frame 5, PC = 0020DC7C, SP = 0030BF28, FP = 0030BF44
11252 Frame 6, PC = 0020DC80, SP = 0030BF24, FP = 0030BF44
11253 Frame 7, PC = 0020DC84, SP = 0030BF20, FP = 0030BF44
11254 Frame 8, PC = 0020DC88, SP = 0030BF1C, FP = 0030BF44
11255 Frame 9, PC = 0020DC8E, SP = 0030BF18, FP = 0030BF44
11256 Frame 10, PC = 00203F6C, SP = 0030BE3C, FP = 0030BF14
11257 @end smallexample
11258
11259 Or, if we want to examine the variable @code{X} at each source line in
11260 the buffer:
11261
11262 @smallexample
11263 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
11264 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while ($trace_frame != -1)}
11265 > printf "Frame %d, X == %d\n", $trace_frame, X
11266 > tfind line
11267 > end
11268
11269 Frame 0, X = 1
11270 Frame 7, X = 2
11271 Frame 13, X = 255
11272 @end smallexample
11273
11274 @node tdump
11275 @subsection @code{tdump}
11276 @kindex tdump
11277 @cindex dump all data collected at tracepoint
11278 @cindex tracepoint data, display
11279
11280 This command takes no arguments. It prints all the data collected at
11281 the current trace snapshot.
11282
11283 @smallexample
11284 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace 444}
11285 (@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
11286 Enter actions for tracepoint #2, one per line:
11287 > collect $regs, $locals, $args, gdb_long_test
11288 > end
11289
11290 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tstart}
11291
11292 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind line 444}
11293 #0 gdb_test (p1=0x11, p2=0x22, p3=0x33, p4=0x44, p5=0x55, p6=0x66)
11294 at gdb_test.c:444
11295 444 printp( "%s: arguments = 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X\n", )
11296
11297 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tdump}
11298 Data collected at tracepoint 2, trace frame 1:
11299 d0 0xc4aa0085 -995491707
11300 d1 0x18 24
11301 d2 0x80 128
11302 d3 0x33 51
11303 d4 0x71aea3d 119204413
11304 d5 0x22 34
11305 d6 0xe0 224
11306 d7 0x380035 3670069
11307 a0 0x19e24a 1696330
11308 a1 0x3000668 50333288
11309 a2 0x100 256
11310 a3 0x322000 3284992
11311 a4 0x3000698 50333336
11312 a5 0x1ad3cc 1758156
11313 fp 0x30bf3c 0x30bf3c
11314 sp 0x30bf34 0x30bf34
11315 ps 0x0 0
11316 pc 0x20b2c8 0x20b2c8
11317 fpcontrol 0x0 0
11318 fpstatus 0x0 0
11319 fpiaddr 0x0 0
11320 p = 0x20e5b4 "gdb-test"
11321 p1 = (void *) 0x11
11322 p2 = (void *) 0x22
11323 p3 = (void *) 0x33
11324 p4 = (void *) 0x44
11325 p5 = (void *) 0x55
11326 p6 = (void *) 0x66
11327 gdb_long_test = 17 '\021'
11328
11329 (@value{GDBP})
11330 @end smallexample
11331
11332 @code{tdump} works by scanning the tracepoint's current collection
11333 actions and printing the value of each expression listed. So
11334 @code{tdump} can fail, if after a run, you change the tracepoint's
11335 actions to mention variables that were not collected during the run.
11336
11337 Also, for tracepoints with @code{while-stepping} loops, @code{tdump}
11338 uses the collected value of @code{$pc} to distinguish between trace
11339 frames that were collected at the tracepoint hit, and frames that were
11340 collected while stepping. This allows it to correctly choose whether
11341 to display the basic list of collections, or the collections from the
11342 body of the while-stepping loop. However, if @code{$pc} was not collected,
11343 then @code{tdump} will always attempt to dump using the basic collection
11344 list, and may fail if a while-stepping frame does not include all the
11345 same data that is collected at the tracepoint hit.
11346 @c This is getting pretty arcane, example would be good.
11347
11348 @node save tracepoints
11349 @subsection @code{save tracepoints @var{filename}}
11350 @kindex save tracepoints
11351 @kindex save-tracepoints
11352 @cindex save tracepoints for future sessions
11353
11354 This command saves all current tracepoint definitions together with
11355 their actions and passcounts, into a file @file{@var{filename}}
11356 suitable for use in a later debugging session. To read the saved
11357 tracepoint definitions, use the @code{source} command (@pxref{Command
11358 Files}). The @w{@code{save-tracepoints}} command is a deprecated
11359 alias for @w{@code{save tracepoints}}
11360
11361 @node Tracepoint Variables
11362 @section Convenience Variables for Tracepoints
11363 @cindex tracepoint variables
11364 @cindex convenience variables for tracepoints
11365
11366 @table @code
11367 @vindex $trace_frame
11368 @item (int) $trace_frame
11369 The current trace snapshot (a.k.a.@: @dfn{frame}) number, or -1 if no
11370 snapshot is selected.
11371
11372 @vindex $tracepoint
11373 @item (int) $tracepoint
11374 The tracepoint for the current trace snapshot.
11375
11376 @vindex $trace_line
11377 @item (int) $trace_line
11378 The line number for the current trace snapshot.
11379
11380 @vindex $trace_file
11381 @item (char []) $trace_file
11382 The source file for the current trace snapshot.
11383
11384 @vindex $trace_func
11385 @item (char []) $trace_func
11386 The name of the function containing @code{$tracepoint}.
11387 @end table
11388
11389 Note: @code{$trace_file} is not suitable for use in @code{printf},
11390 use @code{output} instead.
11391
11392 Here's a simple example of using these convenience variables for
11393 stepping through all the trace snapshots and printing some of their
11394 data. Note that these are not the same as trace state variables,
11395 which are managed by the target.
11396
11397 @smallexample
11398 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
11399
11400 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while $trace_frame != -1}
11401 > output $trace_file
11402 > printf ", line %d (tracepoint #%d)\n", $trace_line, $tracepoint
11403 > tfind
11404 > end
11405 @end smallexample
11406
11407 @node Trace Files
11408 @section Using Trace Files
11409 @cindex trace files
11410
11411 In some situations, the target running a trace experiment may no
11412 longer be available; perhaps it crashed, or the hardware was needed
11413 for a different activity. To handle these cases, you can arrange to
11414 dump the trace data into a file, and later use that file as a source
11415 of trace data, via the @code{target tfile} command.
11416
11417 @table @code
11418
11419 @kindex tsave
11420 @item tsave [ -r ] @var{filename}
11421 Save the trace data to @var{filename}. By default, this command
11422 assumes that @var{filename} refers to the host filesystem, so if
11423 necessary @value{GDBN} will copy raw trace data up from the target and
11424 then save it. If the target supports it, you can also supply the
11425 optional argument @code{-r} (``remote'') to direct the target to save
11426 the data directly into @var{filename} in its own filesystem, which may be
11427 more efficient if the trace buffer is very large. (Note, however, that
11428 @code{target tfile} can only read from files accessible to the host.)
11429
11430 @kindex target tfile
11431 @kindex tfile
11432 @item target tfile @var{filename}
11433 Use the file named @var{filename} as a source of trace data. Commands
11434 that examine data work as they do with a live target, but it is not
11435 possible to run any new trace experiments. @code{tstatus} will report
11436 the state of the trace run at the moment the data was saved, as well
11437 as the current trace frame you are examining. @var{filename} must be
11438 on a filesystem accessible to the host.
11439
11440 @end table
11441
11442 @node Overlays
11443 @chapter Debugging Programs That Use Overlays
11444 @cindex overlays
11445
11446 If your program is too large to fit completely in your target system's
11447 memory, you can sometimes use @dfn{overlays} to work around this
11448 problem. @value{GDBN} provides some support for debugging programs that
11449 use overlays.
11450
11451 @menu
11452 * How Overlays Work:: A general explanation of overlays.
11453 * Overlay Commands:: Managing overlays in @value{GDBN}.
11454 * Automatic Overlay Debugging:: @value{GDBN} can find out which overlays are
11455 mapped by asking the inferior.
11456 * Overlay Sample Program:: A sample program using overlays.
11457 @end menu
11458
11459 @node How Overlays Work
11460 @section How Overlays Work
11461 @cindex mapped overlays
11462 @cindex unmapped overlays
11463 @cindex load address, overlay's
11464 @cindex mapped address
11465 @cindex overlay area
11466
11467 Suppose you have a computer whose instruction address space is only 64
11468 kilobytes long, but which has much more memory which can be accessed by
11469 other means: special instructions, segment registers, or memory
11470 management hardware, for example. Suppose further that you want to
11471 adapt a program which is larger than 64 kilobytes to run on this system.
11472
11473 One solution is to identify modules of your program which are relatively
11474 independent, and need not call each other directly; call these modules
11475 @dfn{overlays}. Separate the overlays from the main program, and place
11476 their machine code in the larger memory. Place your main program in
11477 instruction memory, but leave at least enough space there to hold the
11478 largest overlay as well.
11479
11480 Now, to call a function located in an overlay, you must first copy that
11481 overlay's machine code from the large memory into the space set aside
11482 for it in the instruction memory, and then jump to its entry point
11483 there.
11484
11485 @c NB: In the below the mapped area's size is greater or equal to the
11486 @c size of all overlays. This is intentional to remind the developer
11487 @c that overlays don't necessarily need to be the same size.
11488
11489 @smallexample
11490 @group
11491 Data Instruction Larger
11492 Address Space Address Space Address Space
11493 +-----------+ +-----------+ +-----------+
11494 | | | | | |
11495 +-----------+ +-----------+ +-----------+<-- overlay 1
11496 | program | | main | .----| overlay 1 | load address
11497 | variables | | program | | +-----------+
11498 | and heap | | | | | |
11499 +-----------+ | | | +-----------+<-- overlay 2
11500 | | +-----------+ | | | load address
11501 +-----------+ | | | .-| overlay 2 |
11502 | | | | | |
11503 mapped --->+-----------+ | | +-----------+
11504 address | | | | | |
11505 | overlay | <-' | | |
11506 | area | <---' +-----------+<-- overlay 3
11507 | | <---. | | load address
11508 +-----------+ `--| overlay 3 |
11509 | | | |
11510 +-----------+ | |
11511 +-----------+
11512 | |
11513 +-----------+
11514
11515 @anchor{A code overlay}A code overlay
11516 @end group
11517 @end smallexample
11518
11519 The diagram (@pxref{A code overlay}) shows a system with separate data
11520 and instruction address spaces. To map an overlay, the program copies
11521 its code from the larger address space to the instruction address space.
11522 Since the overlays shown here all use the same mapped address, only one
11523 may be mapped at a time. For a system with a single address space for
11524 data and instructions, the diagram would be similar, except that the
11525 program variables and heap would share an address space with the main
11526 program and the overlay area.
11527
11528 An overlay loaded into instruction memory and ready for use is called a
11529 @dfn{mapped} overlay; its @dfn{mapped address} is its address in the
11530 instruction memory. An overlay not present (or only partially present)
11531 in instruction memory is called @dfn{unmapped}; its @dfn{load address}
11532 is its address in the larger memory. The mapped address is also called
11533 the @dfn{virtual memory address}, or @dfn{VMA}; the load address is also
11534 called the @dfn{load memory address}, or @dfn{LMA}.
11535
11536 Unfortunately, overlays are not a completely transparent way to adapt a
11537 program to limited instruction memory. They introduce a new set of
11538 global constraints you must keep in mind as you design your program:
11539
11540 @itemize @bullet
11541
11542 @item
11543 Before calling or returning to a function in an overlay, your program
11544 must make sure that overlay is actually mapped. Otherwise, the call or
11545 return will transfer control to the right address, but in the wrong
11546 overlay, and your program will probably crash.
11547
11548 @item
11549 If the process of mapping an overlay is expensive on your system, you
11550 will need to choose your overlays carefully to minimize their effect on
11551 your program's performance.
11552
11553 @item
11554 The executable file you load onto your system must contain each
11555 overlay's instructions, appearing at the overlay's load address, not its
11556 mapped address. However, each overlay's instructions must be relocated
11557 and its symbols defined as if the overlay were at its mapped address.
11558 You can use GNU linker scripts to specify different load and relocation
11559 addresses for pieces of your program; see @ref{Overlay Description,,,
11560 ld.info, Using ld: the GNU linker}.
11561
11562 @item
11563 The procedure for loading executable files onto your system must be able
11564 to load their contents into the larger address space as well as the
11565 instruction and data spaces.
11566
11567 @end itemize
11568
11569 The overlay system described above is rather simple, and could be
11570 improved in many ways:
11571
11572 @itemize @bullet
11573
11574 @item
11575 If your system has suitable bank switch registers or memory management
11576 hardware, you could use those facilities to make an overlay's load area
11577 contents simply appear at their mapped address in instruction space.
11578 This would probably be faster than copying the overlay to its mapped
11579 area in the usual way.
11580
11581 @item
11582 If your overlays are small enough, you could set aside more than one
11583 overlay area, and have more than one overlay mapped at a time.
11584
11585 @item
11586 You can use overlays to manage data, as well as instructions. In
11587 general, data overlays are even less transparent to your design than
11588 code overlays: whereas code overlays only require care when you call or
11589 return to functions, data overlays require care every time you access
11590 the data. Also, if you change the contents of a data overlay, you
11591 must copy its contents back out to its load address before you can copy a
11592 different data overlay into the same mapped area.
11593
11594 @end itemize
11595
11596
11597 @node Overlay Commands
11598 @section Overlay Commands
11599
11600 To use @value{GDBN}'s overlay support, each overlay in your program must
11601 correspond to a separate section of the executable file. The section's
11602 virtual memory address and load memory address must be the overlay's
11603 mapped and load addresses. Identifying overlays with sections allows
11604 @value{GDBN} to determine the appropriate address of a function or
11605 variable, depending on whether the overlay is mapped or not.
11606
11607 @value{GDBN}'s overlay commands all start with the word @code{overlay};
11608 you can abbreviate this as @code{ov} or @code{ovly}. The commands are:
11609
11610 @table @code
11611 @item overlay off
11612 @kindex overlay
11613 Disable @value{GDBN}'s overlay support. When overlay support is
11614 disabled, @value{GDBN} assumes that all functions and variables are
11615 always present at their mapped addresses. By default, @value{GDBN}'s
11616 overlay support is disabled.
11617
11618 @item overlay manual
11619 @cindex manual overlay debugging
11620 Enable @dfn{manual} overlay debugging. In this mode, @value{GDBN}
11621 relies on you to tell it which overlays are mapped, and which are not,
11622 using the @code{overlay map-overlay} and @code{overlay unmap-overlay}
11623 commands described below.
11624
11625 @item overlay map-overlay @var{overlay}
11626 @itemx overlay map @var{overlay}
11627 @cindex map an overlay
11628 Tell @value{GDBN} that @var{overlay} is now mapped; @var{overlay} must
11629 be the name of the object file section containing the overlay. When an
11630 overlay is mapped, @value{GDBN} assumes it can find the overlay's
11631 functions and variables at their mapped addresses. @value{GDBN} assumes
11632 that any other overlays whose mapped ranges overlap that of
11633 @var{overlay} are now unmapped.
11634
11635 @item overlay unmap-overlay @var{overlay}
11636 @itemx overlay unmap @var{overlay}
11637 @cindex unmap an overlay
11638 Tell @value{GDBN} that @var{overlay} is no longer mapped; @var{overlay}
11639 must be the name of the object file section containing the overlay.
11640 When an overlay is unmapped, @value{GDBN} assumes it can find the
11641 overlay's functions and variables at their load addresses.
11642
11643 @item overlay auto
11644 Enable @dfn{automatic} overlay debugging. In this mode, @value{GDBN}
11645 consults a data structure the overlay manager maintains in the inferior
11646 to see which overlays are mapped. For details, see @ref{Automatic
11647 Overlay Debugging}.
11648
11649 @item overlay load-target
11650 @itemx overlay load
11651 @cindex reloading the overlay table
11652 Re-read the overlay table from the inferior. Normally, @value{GDBN}
11653 re-reads the table @value{GDBN} automatically each time the inferior
11654 stops, so this command should only be necessary if you have changed the
11655 overlay mapping yourself using @value{GDBN}. This command is only
11656 useful when using automatic overlay debugging.
11657
11658 @item overlay list-overlays
11659 @itemx overlay list
11660 @cindex listing mapped overlays
11661 Display a list of the overlays currently mapped, along with their mapped
11662 addresses, load addresses, and sizes.
11663
11664 @end table
11665
11666 Normally, when @value{GDBN} prints a code address, it includes the name
11667 of the function the address falls in:
11668
11669 @smallexample
11670 (@value{GDBP}) print main
11671 $3 = @{int ()@} 0x11a0 <main>
11672 @end smallexample
11673 @noindent
11674 When overlay debugging is enabled, @value{GDBN} recognizes code in
11675 unmapped overlays, and prints the names of unmapped functions with
11676 asterisks around them. For example, if @code{foo} is a function in an
11677 unmapped overlay, @value{GDBN} prints it this way:
11678
11679 @smallexample
11680 (@value{GDBP}) overlay list
11681 No sections are mapped.
11682 (@value{GDBP}) print foo
11683 $5 = @{int (int)@} 0x100000 <*foo*>
11684 @end smallexample
11685 @noindent
11686 When @code{foo}'s overlay is mapped, @value{GDBN} prints the function's
11687 name normally:
11688
11689 @smallexample
11690 (@value{GDBP}) overlay list
11691 Section .ov.foo.text, loaded at 0x100000 - 0x100034,
11692 mapped at 0x1016 - 0x104a
11693 (@value{GDBP}) print foo
11694 $6 = @{int (int)@} 0x1016 <foo>
11695 @end smallexample
11696
11697 When overlay debugging is enabled, @value{GDBN} can find the correct
11698 address for functions and variables in an overlay, whether or not the
11699 overlay is mapped. This allows most @value{GDBN} commands, like
11700 @code{break} and @code{disassemble}, to work normally, even on unmapped
11701 code. However, @value{GDBN}'s breakpoint support has some limitations:
11702
11703 @itemize @bullet
11704 @item
11705 @cindex breakpoints in overlays
11706 @cindex overlays, setting breakpoints in
11707 You can set breakpoints in functions in unmapped overlays, as long as
11708 @value{GDBN} can write to the overlay at its load address.
11709 @item
11710 @value{GDBN} can not set hardware or simulator-based breakpoints in
11711 unmapped overlays. However, if you set a breakpoint at the end of your
11712 overlay manager (and tell @value{GDBN} which overlays are now mapped, if
11713 you are using manual overlay management), @value{GDBN} will re-set its
11714 breakpoints properly.
11715 @end itemize
11716
11717
11718 @node Automatic Overlay Debugging
11719 @section Automatic Overlay Debugging
11720 @cindex automatic overlay debugging
11721
11722 @value{GDBN} can automatically track which overlays are mapped and which
11723 are not, given some simple co-operation from the overlay manager in the
11724 inferior. If you enable automatic overlay debugging with the
11725 @code{overlay auto} command (@pxref{Overlay Commands}), @value{GDBN}
11726 looks in the inferior's memory for certain variables describing the
11727 current state of the overlays.
11728
11729 Here are the variables your overlay manager must define to support
11730 @value{GDBN}'s automatic overlay debugging:
11731
11732 @table @asis
11733
11734 @item @code{_ovly_table}:
11735 This variable must be an array of the following structures:
11736
11737 @smallexample
11738 struct
11739 @{
11740 /* The overlay's mapped address. */
11741 unsigned long vma;
11742
11743 /* The size of the overlay, in bytes. */
11744 unsigned long size;
11745
11746 /* The overlay's load address. */
11747 unsigned long lma;
11748
11749 /* Non-zero if the overlay is currently mapped;
11750 zero otherwise. */
11751 unsigned long mapped;
11752 @}
11753 @end smallexample
11754
11755 @item @code{_novlys}:
11756 This variable must be a four-byte signed integer, holding the total
11757 number of elements in @code{_ovly_table}.
11758
11759 @end table
11760
11761 To decide whether a particular overlay is mapped or not, @value{GDBN}
11762 looks for an entry in @w{@code{_ovly_table}} whose @code{vma} and
11763 @code{lma} members equal the VMA and LMA of the overlay's section in the
11764 executable file. When @value{GDBN} finds a matching entry, it consults
11765 the entry's @code{mapped} member to determine whether the overlay is
11766 currently mapped.
11767
11768 In addition, your overlay manager may define a function called
11769 @code{_ovly_debug_event}. If this function is defined, @value{GDBN}
11770 will silently set a breakpoint there. If the overlay manager then
11771 calls this function whenever it has changed the overlay table, this
11772 will enable @value{GDBN} to accurately keep track of which overlays
11773 are in program memory, and update any breakpoints that may be set
11774 in overlays. This will allow breakpoints to work even if the
11775 overlays are kept in ROM or other non-writable memory while they
11776 are not being executed.
11777
11778 @node Overlay Sample Program
11779 @section Overlay Sample Program
11780 @cindex overlay example program
11781
11782 When linking a program which uses overlays, you must place the overlays
11783 at their load addresses, while relocating them to run at their mapped
11784 addresses. To do this, you must write a linker script (@pxref{Overlay
11785 Description,,, ld.info, Using ld: the GNU linker}). Unfortunately,
11786 since linker scripts are specific to a particular host system, target
11787 architecture, and target memory layout, this manual cannot provide
11788 portable sample code demonstrating @value{GDBN}'s overlay support.
11789
11790 However, the @value{GDBN} source distribution does contain an overlaid
11791 program, with linker scripts for a few systems, as part of its test
11792 suite. The program consists of the following files from
11793 @file{gdb/testsuite/gdb.base}:
11794
11795 @table @file
11796 @item overlays.c
11797 The main program file.
11798 @item ovlymgr.c
11799 A simple overlay manager, used by @file{overlays.c}.
11800 @item foo.c
11801 @itemx bar.c
11802 @itemx baz.c
11803 @itemx grbx.c
11804 Overlay modules, loaded and used by @file{overlays.c}.
11805 @item d10v.ld
11806 @itemx m32r.ld
11807 Linker scripts for linking the test program on the @code{d10v-elf}
11808 and @code{m32r-elf} targets.
11809 @end table
11810
11811 You can build the test program using the @code{d10v-elf} GCC
11812 cross-compiler like this:
11813
11814 @smallexample
11815 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c overlays.c
11816 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c ovlymgr.c
11817 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c foo.c
11818 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c bar.c
11819 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c baz.c
11820 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c grbx.c
11821 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g overlays.o ovlymgr.o foo.o bar.o \
11822 baz.o grbx.o -Wl,-Td10v.ld -o overlays
11823 @end smallexample
11824
11825 The build process is identical for any other architecture, except that
11826 you must substitute the appropriate compiler and linker script for the
11827 target system for @code{d10v-elf-gcc} and @code{d10v.ld}.
11828
11829
11830 @node Languages
11831 @chapter Using @value{GDBN} with Different Languages
11832 @cindex languages
11833
11834 Although programming languages generally have common aspects, they are
11835 rarely expressed in the same manner. For instance, in ANSI C,
11836 dereferencing a pointer @code{p} is accomplished by @code{*p}, but in
11837 Modula-2, it is accomplished by @code{p^}. Values can also be
11838 represented (and displayed) differently. Hex numbers in C appear as
11839 @samp{0x1ae}, while in Modula-2 they appear as @samp{1AEH}.
11840
11841 @cindex working language
11842 Language-specific information is built into @value{GDBN} for some languages,
11843 allowing you to express operations like the above in your program's
11844 native language, and allowing @value{GDBN} to output values in a manner
11845 consistent with the syntax of your program's native language. The
11846 language you use to build expressions is called the @dfn{working
11847 language}.
11848
11849 @menu
11850 * Setting:: Switching between source languages
11851 * Show:: Displaying the language
11852 * Checks:: Type and range checks
11853 * Supported Languages:: Supported languages
11854 * Unsupported Languages:: Unsupported languages
11855 @end menu
11856
11857 @node Setting
11858 @section Switching Between Source Languages
11859
11860 There are two ways to control the working language---either have @value{GDBN}
11861 set it automatically, or select it manually yourself. You can use the
11862 @code{set language} command for either purpose. On startup, @value{GDBN}
11863 defaults to setting the language automatically. The working language is
11864 used to determine how expressions you type are interpreted, how values
11865 are printed, etc.
11866
11867 In addition to the working language, every source file that
11868 @value{GDBN} knows about has its own working language. For some object
11869 file formats, the compiler might indicate which language a particular
11870 source file is in. However, most of the time @value{GDBN} infers the
11871 language from the name of the file. The language of a source file
11872 controls whether C@t{++} names are demangled---this way @code{backtrace} can
11873 show each frame appropriately for its own language. There is no way to
11874 set the language of a source file from within @value{GDBN}, but you can
11875 set the language associated with a filename extension. @xref{Show, ,
11876 Displaying the Language}.
11877
11878 This is most commonly a problem when you use a program, such
11879 as @code{cfront} or @code{f2c}, that generates C but is written in
11880 another language. In that case, make the
11881 program use @code{#line} directives in its C output; that way
11882 @value{GDBN} will know the correct language of the source code of the original
11883 program, and will display that source code, not the generated C code.
11884
11885 @menu
11886 * Filenames:: Filename extensions and languages.
11887 * Manually:: Setting the working language manually
11888 * Automatically:: Having @value{GDBN} infer the source language
11889 @end menu
11890
11891 @node Filenames
11892 @subsection List of Filename Extensions and Languages
11893
11894 If a source file name ends in one of the following extensions, then
11895 @value{GDBN} infers that its language is the one indicated.
11896
11897 @table @file
11898 @item .ada
11899 @itemx .ads
11900 @itemx .adb
11901 @itemx .a
11902 Ada source file.
11903
11904 @item .c
11905 C source file
11906
11907 @item .C
11908 @itemx .cc
11909 @itemx .cp
11910 @itemx .cpp
11911 @itemx .cxx
11912 @itemx .c++
11913 C@t{++} source file
11914
11915 @item .d
11916 D source file
11917
11918 @item .m
11919 Objective-C source file
11920
11921 @item .f
11922 @itemx .F
11923 Fortran source file
11924
11925 @item .mod
11926 Modula-2 source file
11927
11928 @item .s
11929 @itemx .S
11930 Assembler source file. This actually behaves almost like C, but
11931 @value{GDBN} does not skip over function prologues when stepping.
11932 @end table
11933
11934 In addition, you may set the language associated with a filename
11935 extension. @xref{Show, , Displaying the Language}.
11936
11937 @node Manually
11938 @subsection Setting the Working Language
11939
11940 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically,
11941 expressions are interpreted the same way in your debugging session and
11942 your program.
11943
11944 @kindex set language
11945 If you wish, you may set the language manually. To do this, issue the
11946 command @samp{set language @var{lang}}, where @var{lang} is the name of
11947 a language, such as
11948 @code{c} or @code{modula-2}.
11949 For a list of the supported languages, type @samp{set language}.
11950
11951 Setting the language manually prevents @value{GDBN} from updating the working
11952 language automatically. This can lead to confusion if you try
11953 to debug a program when the working language is not the same as the
11954 source language, when an expression is acceptable to both
11955 languages---but means different things. For instance, if the current
11956 source file were written in C, and @value{GDBN} was parsing Modula-2, a
11957 command such as:
11958
11959 @smallexample
11960 print a = b + c
11961 @end smallexample
11962
11963 @noindent
11964 might not have the effect you intended. In C, this means to add
11965 @code{b} and @code{c} and place the result in @code{a}. The result
11966 printed would be the value of @code{a}. In Modula-2, this means to compare
11967 @code{a} to the result of @code{b+c}, yielding a @code{BOOLEAN} value.
11968
11969 @node Automatically
11970 @subsection Having @value{GDBN} Infer the Source Language
11971
11972 To have @value{GDBN} set the working language automatically, use
11973 @samp{set language local} or @samp{set language auto}. @value{GDBN}
11974 then infers the working language. That is, when your program stops in a
11975 frame (usually by encountering a breakpoint), @value{GDBN} sets the
11976 working language to the language recorded for the function in that
11977 frame. If the language for a frame is unknown (that is, if the function
11978 or block corresponding to the frame was defined in a source file that
11979 does not have a recognized extension), the current working language is
11980 not changed, and @value{GDBN} issues a warning.
11981
11982 This may not seem necessary for most programs, which are written
11983 entirely in one source language. However, program modules and libraries
11984 written in one source language can be used by a main program written in
11985 a different source language. Using @samp{set language auto} in this
11986 case frees you from having to set the working language manually.
11987
11988 @node Show
11989 @section Displaying the Language
11990
11991 The following commands help you find out which language is the
11992 working language, and also what language source files were written in.
11993
11994 @table @code
11995 @item show language
11996 @kindex show language
11997 Display the current working language. This is the
11998 language you can use with commands such as @code{print} to
11999 build and compute expressions that may involve variables in your program.
12000
12001 @item info frame
12002 @kindex info frame@r{, show the source language}
12003 Display the source language for this frame. This language becomes the
12004 working language if you use an identifier from this frame.
12005 @xref{Frame Info, ,Information about a Frame}, to identify the other
12006 information listed here.
12007
12008 @item info source
12009 @kindex info source@r{, show the source language}
12010 Display the source language of this source file.
12011 @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol Table}, to identify the other
12012 information listed here.
12013 @end table
12014
12015 In unusual circumstances, you may have source files with extensions
12016 not in the standard list. You can then set the extension associated
12017 with a language explicitly:
12018
12019 @table @code
12020 @item set extension-language @var{ext} @var{language}
12021 @kindex set extension-language
12022 Tell @value{GDBN} that source files with extension @var{ext} are to be
12023 assumed as written in the source language @var{language}.
12024
12025 @item info extensions
12026 @kindex info extensions
12027 List all the filename extensions and the associated languages.
12028 @end table
12029
12030 @node Checks
12031 @section Type and Range Checking
12032
12033 @quotation
12034 @emph{Warning:} In this release, the @value{GDBN} commands for type and range
12035 checking are included, but they do not yet have any effect. This
12036 section documents the intended facilities.
12037 @end quotation
12038 @c FIXME remove warning when type/range code added
12039
12040 Some languages are designed to guard you against making seemingly common
12041 errors through a series of compile- and run-time checks. These include
12042 checking the type of arguments to functions and operators, and making
12043 sure mathematical overflows are caught at run time. Checks such as
12044 these help to ensure a program's correctness once it has been compiled
12045 by eliminating type mismatches, and providing active checks for range
12046 errors when your program is running.
12047
12048 @value{GDBN} can check for conditions like the above if you wish.
12049 Although @value{GDBN} does not check the statements in your program,
12050 it can check expressions entered directly into @value{GDBN} for
12051 evaluation via the @code{print} command, for example. As with the
12052 working language, @value{GDBN} can also decide whether or not to check
12053 automatically based on your program's source language.
12054 @xref{Supported Languages, ,Supported Languages}, for the default
12055 settings of supported languages.
12056
12057 @menu
12058 * Type Checking:: An overview of type checking
12059 * Range Checking:: An overview of range checking
12060 @end menu
12061
12062 @cindex type checking
12063 @cindex checks, type
12064 @node Type Checking
12065 @subsection An Overview of Type Checking
12066
12067 Some languages, such as Modula-2, are strongly typed, meaning that the
12068 arguments to operators and functions have to be of the correct type,
12069 otherwise an error occurs. These checks prevent type mismatch
12070 errors from ever causing any run-time problems. For example,
12071
12072 @smallexample
12073 1 + 2 @result{} 3
12074 @exdent but
12075 @error{} 1 + 2.3
12076 @end smallexample
12077
12078 The second example fails because the @code{CARDINAL} 1 is not
12079 type-compatible with the @code{REAL} 2.3.
12080
12081 For the expressions you use in @value{GDBN} commands, you can tell the
12082 @value{GDBN} type checker to skip checking;
12083 to treat any mismatches as errors and abandon the expression;
12084 or to only issue warnings when type mismatches occur,
12085 but evaluate the expression anyway. When you choose the last of
12086 these, @value{GDBN} evaluates expressions like the second example above, but
12087 also issues a warning.
12088
12089 Even if you turn type checking off, there may be other reasons
12090 related to type that prevent @value{GDBN} from evaluating an expression.
12091 For instance, @value{GDBN} does not know how to add an @code{int} and
12092 a @code{struct foo}. These particular type errors have nothing to do
12093 with the language in use, and usually arise from expressions, such as
12094 the one described above, which make little sense to evaluate anyway.
12095
12096 Each language defines to what degree it is strict about type. For
12097 instance, both Modula-2 and C require the arguments to arithmetical
12098 operators to be numbers. In C, enumerated types and pointers can be
12099 represented as numbers, so that they are valid arguments to mathematical
12100 operators. @xref{Supported Languages, ,Supported Languages}, for further
12101 details on specific languages.
12102
12103 @value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling the type checker:
12104
12105 @kindex set check type
12106 @kindex show check type
12107 @table @code
12108 @item set check type auto
12109 Set type checking on or off based on the current working language.
12110 @xref{Supported Languages, ,Supported Languages}, for the default settings for
12111 each language.
12112
12113 @item set check type on
12114 @itemx set check type off
12115 Set type checking on or off, overriding the default setting for the
12116 current working language. Issue a warning if the setting does not
12117 match the language default. If any type mismatches occur in
12118 evaluating an expression while type checking is on, @value{GDBN} prints a
12119 message and aborts evaluation of the expression.
12120
12121 @item set check type warn
12122 Cause the type checker to issue warnings, but to always attempt to
12123 evaluate the expression. Evaluating the expression may still
12124 be impossible for other reasons. For example, @value{GDBN} cannot add
12125 numbers and structures.
12126
12127 @item show type
12128 Show the current setting of the type checker, and whether or not @value{GDBN}
12129 is setting it automatically.
12130 @end table
12131
12132 @cindex range checking
12133 @cindex checks, range
12134 @node Range Checking
12135 @subsection An Overview of Range Checking
12136
12137 In some languages (such as Modula-2), it is an error to exceed the
12138 bounds of a type; this is enforced with run-time checks. Such range
12139 checking is meant to ensure program correctness by making sure
12140 computations do not overflow, or indices on an array element access do
12141 not exceed the bounds of the array.
12142
12143 For expressions you use in @value{GDBN} commands, you can tell
12144 @value{GDBN} to treat range errors in one of three ways: ignore them,
12145 always treat them as errors and abandon the expression, or issue
12146 warnings but evaluate the expression anyway.
12147
12148 A range error can result from numerical overflow, from exceeding an
12149 array index bound, or when you type a constant that is not a member
12150 of any type. Some languages, however, do not treat overflows as an
12151 error. In many implementations of C, mathematical overflow causes the
12152 result to ``wrap around'' to lower values---for example, if @var{m} is
12153 the largest integer value, and @var{s} is the smallest, then
12154
12155 @smallexample
12156 @var{m} + 1 @result{} @var{s}
12157 @end smallexample
12158
12159 This, too, is specific to individual languages, and in some cases
12160 specific to individual compilers or machines. @xref{Supported Languages, ,
12161 Supported Languages}, for further details on specific languages.
12162
12163 @value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling the range checker:
12164
12165 @kindex set check range
12166 @kindex show check range
12167 @table @code
12168 @item set check range auto
12169 Set range checking on or off based on the current working language.
12170 @xref{Supported Languages, ,Supported Languages}, for the default settings for
12171 each language.
12172
12173 @item set check range on
12174 @itemx set check range off
12175 Set range checking on or off, overriding the default setting for the
12176 current working language. A warning is issued if the setting does not
12177 match the language default. If a range error occurs and range checking is on,
12178 then a message is printed and evaluation of the expression is aborted.
12179
12180 @item set check range warn
12181 Output messages when the @value{GDBN} range checker detects a range error,
12182 but attempt to evaluate the expression anyway. Evaluating the
12183 expression may still be impossible for other reasons, such as accessing
12184 memory that the process does not own (a typical example from many Unix
12185 systems).
12186
12187 @item show range
12188 Show the current setting of the range checker, and whether or not it is
12189 being set automatically by @value{GDBN}.
12190 @end table
12191
12192 @node Supported Languages
12193 @section Supported Languages
12194
12195 @value{GDBN} supports C, C@t{++}, D, Objective-C, Fortran, Java, OpenCL C, Pascal,
12196 assembly, Modula-2, and Ada.
12197 @c This is false ...
12198 Some @value{GDBN} features may be used in expressions regardless of the
12199 language you use: the @value{GDBN} @code{@@} and @code{::} operators,
12200 and the @samp{@{type@}addr} construct (@pxref{Expressions,
12201 ,Expressions}) can be used with the constructs of any supported
12202 language.
12203
12204 The following sections detail to what degree each source language is
12205 supported by @value{GDBN}. These sections are not meant to be language
12206 tutorials or references, but serve only as a reference guide to what the
12207 @value{GDBN} expression parser accepts, and what input and output
12208 formats should look like for different languages. There are many good
12209 books written on each of these languages; please look to these for a
12210 language reference or tutorial.
12211
12212 @menu
12213 * C:: C and C@t{++}
12214 * D:: D
12215 * Objective-C:: Objective-C
12216 * OpenCL C:: OpenCL C
12217 * Fortran:: Fortran
12218 * Pascal:: Pascal
12219 * Modula-2:: Modula-2
12220 * Ada:: Ada
12221 @end menu
12222
12223 @node C
12224 @subsection C and C@t{++}
12225
12226 @cindex C and C@t{++}
12227 @cindex expressions in C or C@t{++}
12228
12229 Since C and C@t{++} are so closely related, many features of @value{GDBN} apply
12230 to both languages. Whenever this is the case, we discuss those languages
12231 together.
12232
12233 @cindex C@t{++}
12234 @cindex @code{g++}, @sc{gnu} C@t{++} compiler
12235 @cindex @sc{gnu} C@t{++}
12236 The C@t{++} debugging facilities are jointly implemented by the C@t{++}
12237 compiler and @value{GDBN}. Therefore, to debug your C@t{++} code
12238 effectively, you must compile your C@t{++} programs with a supported
12239 C@t{++} compiler, such as @sc{gnu} @code{g++}, or the HP ANSI C@t{++}
12240 compiler (@code{aCC}).
12241
12242 @menu
12243 * C Operators:: C and C@t{++} operators
12244 * C Constants:: C and C@t{++} constants
12245 * C Plus Plus Expressions:: C@t{++} expressions
12246 * C Defaults:: Default settings for C and C@t{++}
12247 * C Checks:: C and C@t{++} type and range checks
12248 * Debugging C:: @value{GDBN} and C
12249 * Debugging C Plus Plus:: @value{GDBN} features for C@t{++}
12250 * Decimal Floating Point:: Numbers in Decimal Floating Point format
12251 @end menu
12252
12253 @node C Operators
12254 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} Operators
12255
12256 @cindex C and C@t{++} operators
12257
12258 Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
12259 @code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on structures. Operators are
12260 often defined on groups of types.
12261
12262 For the purposes of C and C@t{++}, the following definitions hold:
12263
12264 @itemize @bullet
12265
12266 @item
12267 @emph{Integral types} include @code{int} with any of its storage-class
12268 specifiers; @code{char}; @code{enum}; and, for C@t{++}, @code{bool}.
12269
12270 @item
12271 @emph{Floating-point types} include @code{float}, @code{double}, and
12272 @code{long double} (if supported by the target platform).
12273
12274 @item
12275 @emph{Pointer types} include all types defined as @code{(@var{type} *)}.
12276
12277 @item
12278 @emph{Scalar types} include all of the above.
12279
12280 @end itemize
12281
12282 @noindent
12283 The following operators are supported. They are listed here
12284 in order of increasing precedence:
12285
12286 @table @code
12287 @item ,
12288 The comma or sequencing operator. Expressions in a comma-separated list
12289 are evaluated from left to right, with the result of the entire
12290 expression being the last expression evaluated.
12291
12292 @item =
12293 Assignment. The value of an assignment expression is the value
12294 assigned. Defined on scalar types.
12295
12296 @item @var{op}=
12297 Used in an expression of the form @w{@code{@var{a} @var{op}= @var{b}}},
12298 and translated to @w{@code{@var{a} = @var{a op b}}}.
12299 @w{@code{@var{op}=}} and @code{=} have the same precedence.
12300 @var{op} is any one of the operators @code{|}, @code{^}, @code{&},
12301 @code{<<}, @code{>>}, @code{+}, @code{-}, @code{*}, @code{/}, @code{%}.
12302
12303 @item ?:
12304 The ternary operator. @code{@var{a} ? @var{b} : @var{c}} can be thought
12305 of as: if @var{a} then @var{b} else @var{c}. @var{a} should be of an
12306 integral type.
12307
12308 @item ||
12309 Logical @sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
12310
12311 @item &&
12312 Logical @sc{and}. Defined on integral types.
12313
12314 @item |
12315 Bitwise @sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
12316
12317 @item ^
12318 Bitwise exclusive-@sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
12319
12320 @item &
12321 Bitwise @sc{and}. Defined on integral types.
12322
12323 @item ==@r{, }!=
12324 Equality and inequality. Defined on scalar types. The value of these
12325 expressions is 0 for false and non-zero for true.
12326
12327 @item <@r{, }>@r{, }<=@r{, }>=
12328 Less than, greater than, less than or equal, greater than or equal.
12329 Defined on scalar types. The value of these expressions is 0 for false
12330 and non-zero for true.
12331
12332 @item <<@r{, }>>
12333 left shift, and right shift. Defined on integral types.
12334
12335 @item @@
12336 The @value{GDBN} ``artificial array'' operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}).
12337
12338 @item +@r{, }-
12339 Addition and subtraction. Defined on integral types, floating-point types and
12340 pointer types.
12341
12342 @item *@r{, }/@r{, }%
12343 Multiplication, division, and modulus. Multiplication and division are
12344 defined on integral and floating-point types. Modulus is defined on
12345 integral types.
12346
12347 @item ++@r{, }--
12348 Increment and decrement. When appearing before a variable, the
12349 operation is performed before the variable is used in an expression;
12350 when appearing after it, the variable's value is used before the
12351 operation takes place.
12352
12353 @item *
12354 Pointer dereferencing. Defined on pointer types. Same precedence as
12355 @code{++}.
12356
12357 @item &
12358 Address operator. Defined on variables. Same precedence as @code{++}.
12359
12360 For debugging C@t{++}, @value{GDBN} implements a use of @samp{&} beyond what is
12361 allowed in the C@t{++} language itself: you can use @samp{&(&@var{ref})}
12362 to examine the address
12363 where a C@t{++} reference variable (declared with @samp{&@var{ref}}) is
12364 stored.
12365
12366 @item -
12367 Negative. Defined on integral and floating-point types. Same
12368 precedence as @code{++}.
12369
12370 @item !
12371 Logical negation. Defined on integral types. Same precedence as
12372 @code{++}.
12373
12374 @item ~
12375 Bitwise complement operator. Defined on integral types. Same precedence as
12376 @code{++}.
12377
12378
12379 @item .@r{, }->
12380 Structure member, and pointer-to-structure member. For convenience,
12381 @value{GDBN} regards the two as equivalent, choosing whether to dereference a
12382 pointer based on the stored type information.
12383 Defined on @code{struct} and @code{union} data.
12384
12385 @item .*@r{, }->*
12386 Dereferences of pointers to members.
12387
12388 @item []
12389 Array indexing. @code{@var{a}[@var{i}]} is defined as
12390 @code{*(@var{a}+@var{i})}. Same precedence as @code{->}.
12391
12392 @item ()
12393 Function parameter list. Same precedence as @code{->}.
12394
12395 @item ::
12396 C@t{++} scope resolution operator. Defined on @code{struct}, @code{union},
12397 and @code{class} types.
12398
12399 @item ::
12400 Doubled colons also represent the @value{GDBN} scope operator
12401 (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). Same precedence as @code{::},
12402 above.
12403 @end table
12404
12405 If an operator is redefined in the user code, @value{GDBN} usually
12406 attempts to invoke the redefined version instead of using the operator's
12407 predefined meaning.
12408
12409 @node C Constants
12410 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} Constants
12411
12412 @cindex C and C@t{++} constants
12413
12414 @value{GDBN} allows you to express the constants of C and C@t{++} in the
12415 following ways:
12416
12417 @itemize @bullet
12418 @item
12419 Integer constants are a sequence of digits. Octal constants are
12420 specified by a leading @samp{0} (i.e.@: zero), and hexadecimal constants
12421 by a leading @samp{0x} or @samp{0X}. Constants may also end with a letter
12422 @samp{l}, specifying that the constant should be treated as a
12423 @code{long} value.
12424
12425 @item
12426 Floating point constants are a sequence of digits, followed by a decimal
12427 point, followed by a sequence of digits, and optionally followed by an
12428 exponent. An exponent is of the form:
12429 @samp{@w{e@r{[[}+@r{]|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}}}, where @var{nnn} is another
12430 sequence of digits. The @samp{+} is optional for positive exponents.
12431 A floating-point constant may also end with a letter @samp{f} or
12432 @samp{F}, specifying that the constant should be treated as being of
12433 the @code{float} (as opposed to the default @code{double}) type; or with
12434 a letter @samp{l} or @samp{L}, which specifies a @code{long double}
12435 constant.
12436
12437 @item
12438 Enumerated constants consist of enumerated identifiers, or their
12439 integral equivalents.
12440
12441 @item
12442 Character constants are a single character surrounded by single quotes
12443 (@code{'}), or a number---the ordinal value of the corresponding character
12444 (usually its @sc{ascii} value). Within quotes, the single character may
12445 be represented by a letter or by @dfn{escape sequences}, which are of
12446 the form @samp{\@var{nnn}}, where @var{nnn} is the octal representation
12447 of the character's ordinal value; or of the form @samp{\@var{x}}, where
12448 @samp{@var{x}} is a predefined special character---for example,
12449 @samp{\n} for newline.
12450
12451 Wide character constants can be written by prefixing a character
12452 constant with @samp{L}, as in C. For example, @samp{L'x'} is the wide
12453 form of @samp{x}. The target wide character set is used when
12454 computing the value of this constant (@pxref{Character Sets}).
12455
12456 @item
12457 String constants are a sequence of character constants surrounded by
12458 double quotes (@code{"}). Any valid character constant (as described
12459 above) may appear. Double quotes within the string must be preceded by
12460 a backslash, so for instance @samp{"a\"b'c"} is a string of five
12461 characters.
12462
12463 Wide string constants can be written by prefixing a string constant
12464 with @samp{L}, as in C. The target wide character set is used when
12465 computing the value of this constant (@pxref{Character Sets}).
12466
12467 @item
12468 Pointer constants are an integral value. You can also write pointers
12469 to constants using the C operator @samp{&}.
12470
12471 @item
12472 Array constants are comma-separated lists surrounded by braces @samp{@{}
12473 and @samp{@}}; for example, @samp{@{1,2,3@}} is a three-element array of
12474 integers, @samp{@{@{1,2@}, @{3,4@}, @{5,6@}@}} is a three-by-two array,
12475 and @samp{@{&"hi", &"there", &"fred"@}} is a three-element array of pointers.
12476 @end itemize
12477
12478 @node C Plus Plus Expressions
12479 @subsubsection C@t{++} Expressions
12480
12481 @cindex expressions in C@t{++}
12482 @value{GDBN} expression handling can interpret most C@t{++} expressions.
12483
12484 @cindex debugging C@t{++} programs
12485 @cindex C@t{++} compilers
12486 @cindex debug formats and C@t{++}
12487 @cindex @value{NGCC} and C@t{++}
12488 @quotation
12489 @emph{Warning:} @value{GDBN} can only debug C@t{++} code if you use
12490 the proper compiler and the proper debug format. Currently,
12491 @value{GDBN} works best when debugging C@t{++} code that is compiled
12492 with the most recent version of @value{NGCC} possible. The DWARF
12493 debugging format is preferred; @value{NGCC} defaults to this on most
12494 popular platforms. Other compilers and/or debug formats are likely to
12495 work badly or not at all when using @value{GDBN} to debug C@t{++}
12496 code. @xref{Compilation}.
12497 @end quotation
12498
12499 @enumerate
12500
12501 @cindex member functions
12502 @item
12503 Member function calls are allowed; you can use expressions like
12504
12505 @smallexample
12506 count = aml->GetOriginal(x, y)
12507 @end smallexample
12508
12509 @vindex this@r{, inside C@t{++} member functions}
12510 @cindex namespace in C@t{++}
12511 @item
12512 While a member function is active (in the selected stack frame), your
12513 expressions have the same namespace available as the member function;
12514 that is, @value{GDBN} allows implicit references to the class instance
12515 pointer @code{this} following the same rules as C@t{++}. @code{using}
12516 declarations in the current scope are also respected by @value{GDBN}.
12517
12518 @cindex call overloaded functions
12519 @cindex overloaded functions, calling
12520 @cindex type conversions in C@t{++}
12521 @item
12522 You can call overloaded functions; @value{GDBN} resolves the function
12523 call to the right definition, with some restrictions. @value{GDBN} does not
12524 perform overload resolution involving user-defined type conversions,
12525 calls to constructors, or instantiations of templates that do not exist
12526 in the program. It also cannot handle ellipsis argument lists or
12527 default arguments.
12528
12529 It does perform integral conversions and promotions, floating-point
12530 promotions, arithmetic conversions, pointer conversions, conversions of
12531 class objects to base classes, and standard conversions such as those of
12532 functions or arrays to pointers; it requires an exact match on the
12533 number of function arguments.
12534
12535 Overload resolution is always performed, unless you have specified
12536 @code{set overload-resolution off}. @xref{Debugging C Plus Plus,
12537 ,@value{GDBN} Features for C@t{++}}.
12538
12539 You must specify @code{set overload-resolution off} in order to use an
12540 explicit function signature to call an overloaded function, as in
12541 @smallexample
12542 p 'foo(char,int)'('x', 13)
12543 @end smallexample
12544
12545 The @value{GDBN} command-completion facility can simplify this;
12546 see @ref{Completion, ,Command Completion}.
12547
12548 @cindex reference declarations
12549 @item
12550 @value{GDBN} understands variables declared as C@t{++} references; you can use
12551 them in expressions just as you do in C@t{++} source---they are automatically
12552 dereferenced.
12553
12554 In the parameter list shown when @value{GDBN} displays a frame, the values of
12555 reference variables are not displayed (unlike other variables); this
12556 avoids clutter, since references are often used for large structures.
12557 The @emph{address} of a reference variable is always shown, unless
12558 you have specified @samp{set print address off}.
12559
12560 @item
12561 @value{GDBN} supports the C@t{++} name resolution operator @code{::}---your
12562 expressions can use it just as expressions in your program do. Since
12563 one scope may be defined in another, you can use @code{::} repeatedly if
12564 necessary, for example in an expression like
12565 @samp{@var{scope1}::@var{scope2}::@var{name}}. @value{GDBN} also allows
12566 resolving name scope by reference to source files, in both C and C@t{++}
12567 debugging (@pxref{Variables, ,Program Variables}).
12568
12569 @item
12570 @value{GDBN} performs argument-dependent lookup, following the C@t{++}
12571 specification.
12572 @end enumerate
12573
12574 @node C Defaults
12575 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} Defaults
12576
12577 @cindex C and C@t{++} defaults
12578
12579 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set type and range checking automatically, they
12580 both default to @code{off} whenever the working language changes to
12581 C or C@t{++}. This happens regardless of whether you or @value{GDBN}
12582 selects the working language.
12583
12584 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically, it
12585 recognizes source files whose names end with @file{.c}, @file{.C}, or
12586 @file{.cc}, etc, and when @value{GDBN} enters code compiled from one of
12587 these files, it sets the working language to C or C@t{++}.
12588 @xref{Automatically, ,Having @value{GDBN} Infer the Source Language},
12589 for further details.
12590
12591 @c Type checking is (a) primarily motivated by Modula-2, and (b)
12592 @c unimplemented. If (b) changes, it might make sense to let this node
12593 @c appear even if Mod-2 does not, but meanwhile ignore it. roland 16jul93.
12594
12595 @node C Checks
12596 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} Type and Range Checks
12597
12598 @cindex C and C@t{++} checks
12599
12600 By default, when @value{GDBN} parses C or C@t{++} expressions, type checking
12601 is not used. However, if you turn type checking on, @value{GDBN}
12602 considers two variables type equivalent if:
12603
12604 @itemize @bullet
12605 @item
12606 The two variables are structured and have the same structure, union, or
12607 enumerated tag.
12608
12609 @item
12610 The two variables have the same type name, or types that have been
12611 declared equivalent through @code{typedef}.
12612
12613 @ignore
12614 @c leaving this out because neither J Gilmore nor R Pesch understand it.
12615 @c FIXME--beers?
12616 @item
12617 The two @code{struct}, @code{union}, or @code{enum} variables are
12618 declared in the same declaration. (Note: this may not be true for all C
12619 compilers.)
12620 @end ignore
12621 @end itemize
12622
12623 Range checking, if turned on, is done on mathematical operations. Array
12624 indices are not checked, since they are often used to index a pointer
12625 that is not itself an array.
12626
12627 @node Debugging C
12628 @subsubsection @value{GDBN} and C
12629
12630 The @code{set print union} and @code{show print union} commands apply to
12631 the @code{union} type. When set to @samp{on}, any @code{union} that is
12632 inside a @code{struct} or @code{class} is also printed. Otherwise, it
12633 appears as @samp{@{...@}}.
12634
12635 The @code{@@} operator aids in the debugging of dynamic arrays, formed
12636 with pointers and a memory allocation function. @xref{Expressions,
12637 ,Expressions}.
12638
12639 @node Debugging C Plus Plus
12640 @subsubsection @value{GDBN} Features for C@t{++}
12641
12642 @cindex commands for C@t{++}
12643
12644 Some @value{GDBN} commands are particularly useful with C@t{++}, and some are
12645 designed specifically for use with C@t{++}. Here is a summary:
12646
12647 @table @code
12648 @cindex break in overloaded functions
12649 @item @r{breakpoint menus}
12650 When you want a breakpoint in a function whose name is overloaded,
12651 @value{GDBN} has the capability to display a menu of possible breakpoint
12652 locations to help you specify which function definition you want.
12653 @xref{Ambiguous Expressions,,Ambiguous Expressions}.
12654
12655 @cindex overloading in C@t{++}
12656 @item rbreak @var{regex}
12657 Setting breakpoints using regular expressions is helpful for setting
12658 breakpoints on overloaded functions that are not members of any special
12659 classes.
12660 @xref{Set Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}.
12661
12662 @cindex C@t{++} exception handling
12663 @item catch throw
12664 @itemx catch catch
12665 Debug C@t{++} exception handling using these commands. @xref{Set
12666 Catchpoints, , Setting Catchpoints}.
12667
12668 @cindex inheritance
12669 @item ptype @var{typename}
12670 Print inheritance relationships as well as other information for type
12671 @var{typename}.
12672 @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol Table}.
12673
12674 @cindex C@t{++} symbol display
12675 @item set print demangle
12676 @itemx show print demangle
12677 @itemx set print asm-demangle
12678 @itemx show print asm-demangle
12679 Control whether C@t{++} symbols display in their source form, both when
12680 displaying code as C@t{++} source and when displaying disassemblies.
12681 @xref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}.
12682
12683 @item set print object
12684 @itemx show print object
12685 Choose whether to print derived (actual) or declared types of objects.
12686 @xref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}.
12687
12688 @item set print vtbl
12689 @itemx show print vtbl
12690 Control the format for printing virtual function tables.
12691 @xref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}.
12692 (The @code{vtbl} commands do not work on programs compiled with the HP
12693 ANSI C@t{++} compiler (@code{aCC}).)
12694
12695 @kindex set overload-resolution
12696 @cindex overloaded functions, overload resolution
12697 @item set overload-resolution on
12698 Enable overload resolution for C@t{++} expression evaluation. The default
12699 is on. For overloaded functions, @value{GDBN} evaluates the arguments
12700 and searches for a function whose signature matches the argument types,
12701 using the standard C@t{++} conversion rules (see @ref{C Plus Plus
12702 Expressions, ,C@t{++} Expressions}, for details).
12703 If it cannot find a match, it emits a message.
12704
12705 @item set overload-resolution off
12706 Disable overload resolution for C@t{++} expression evaluation. For
12707 overloaded functions that are not class member functions, @value{GDBN}
12708 chooses the first function of the specified name that it finds in the
12709 symbol table, whether or not its arguments are of the correct type. For
12710 overloaded functions that are class member functions, @value{GDBN}
12711 searches for a function whose signature @emph{exactly} matches the
12712 argument types.
12713
12714 @kindex show overload-resolution
12715 @item show overload-resolution
12716 Show the current setting of overload resolution.
12717
12718 @item @r{Overloaded symbol names}
12719 You can specify a particular definition of an overloaded symbol, using
12720 the same notation that is used to declare such symbols in C@t{++}: type
12721 @code{@var{symbol}(@var{types})} rather than just @var{symbol}. You can
12722 also use the @value{GDBN} command-line word completion facilities to list the
12723 available choices, or to finish the type list for you.
12724 @xref{Completion,, Command Completion}, for details on how to do this.
12725 @end table
12726
12727 @node Decimal Floating Point
12728 @subsubsection Decimal Floating Point format
12729 @cindex decimal floating point format
12730
12731 @value{GDBN} can examine, set and perform computations with numbers in
12732 decimal floating point format, which in the C language correspond to the
12733 @code{_Decimal32}, @code{_Decimal64} and @code{_Decimal128} types as
12734 specified by the extension to support decimal floating-point arithmetic.
12735
12736 There are two encodings in use, depending on the architecture: BID (Binary
12737 Integer Decimal) for x86 and x86-64, and DPD (Densely Packed Decimal) for
12738 PowerPC. @value{GDBN} will use the appropriate encoding for the configured
12739 target.
12740
12741 Because of a limitation in @file{libdecnumber}, the library used by @value{GDBN}
12742 to manipulate decimal floating point numbers, it is not possible to convert
12743 (using a cast, for example) integers wider than 32-bit to decimal float.
12744
12745 In addition, in order to imitate @value{GDBN}'s behaviour with binary floating
12746 point computations, error checking in decimal float operations ignores
12747 underflow, overflow and divide by zero exceptions.
12748
12749 In the PowerPC architecture, @value{GDBN} provides a set of pseudo-registers
12750 to inspect @code{_Decimal128} values stored in floating point registers.
12751 See @ref{PowerPC,,PowerPC} for more details.
12752
12753 @node D
12754 @subsection D
12755
12756 @cindex D
12757 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in D and compiled with
12758 GDC, LDC or DMD compilers. Currently @value{GDBN} supports only one D
12759 specific feature --- dynamic arrays.
12760
12761 @node Objective-C
12762 @subsection Objective-C
12763
12764 @cindex Objective-C
12765 This section provides information about some commands and command
12766 options that are useful for debugging Objective-C code. See also
12767 @ref{Symbols, info classes}, and @ref{Symbols, info selectors}, for a
12768 few more commands specific to Objective-C support.
12769
12770 @menu
12771 * Method Names in Commands::
12772 * The Print Command with Objective-C::
12773 @end menu
12774
12775 @node Method Names in Commands
12776 @subsubsection Method Names in Commands
12777
12778 The following commands have been extended to accept Objective-C method
12779 names as line specifications:
12780
12781 @kindex clear@r{, and Objective-C}
12782 @kindex break@r{, and Objective-C}
12783 @kindex info line@r{, and Objective-C}
12784 @kindex jump@r{, and Objective-C}
12785 @kindex list@r{, and Objective-C}
12786 @itemize
12787 @item @code{clear}
12788 @item @code{break}
12789 @item @code{info line}
12790 @item @code{jump}
12791 @item @code{list}
12792 @end itemize
12793
12794 A fully qualified Objective-C method name is specified as
12795
12796 @smallexample
12797 -[@var{Class} @var{methodName}]
12798 @end smallexample
12799
12800 where the minus sign is used to indicate an instance method and a
12801 plus sign (not shown) is used to indicate a class method. The class
12802 name @var{Class} and method name @var{methodName} are enclosed in
12803 brackets, similar to the way messages are specified in Objective-C
12804 source code. For example, to set a breakpoint at the @code{create}
12805 instance method of class @code{Fruit} in the program currently being
12806 debugged, enter:
12807
12808 @smallexample
12809 break -[Fruit create]
12810 @end smallexample
12811
12812 To list ten program lines around the @code{initialize} class method,
12813 enter:
12814
12815 @smallexample
12816 list +[NSText initialize]
12817 @end smallexample
12818
12819 In the current version of @value{GDBN}, the plus or minus sign is
12820 required. In future versions of @value{GDBN}, the plus or minus
12821 sign will be optional, but you can use it to narrow the search. It
12822 is also possible to specify just a method name:
12823
12824 @smallexample
12825 break create
12826 @end smallexample
12827
12828 You must specify the complete method name, including any colons. If
12829 your program's source files contain more than one @code{create} method,
12830 you'll be presented with a numbered list of classes that implement that
12831 method. Indicate your choice by number, or type @samp{0} to exit if
12832 none apply.
12833
12834 As another example, to clear a breakpoint established at the
12835 @code{makeKeyAndOrderFront:} method of the @code{NSWindow} class, enter:
12836
12837 @smallexample
12838 clear -[NSWindow makeKeyAndOrderFront:]
12839 @end smallexample
12840
12841 @node The Print Command with Objective-C
12842 @subsubsection The Print Command With Objective-C
12843 @cindex Objective-C, print objects
12844 @kindex print-object
12845 @kindex po @r{(@code{print-object})}
12846
12847 The print command has also been extended to accept methods. For example:
12848
12849 @smallexample
12850 print -[@var{object} hash]
12851 @end smallexample
12852
12853 @cindex print an Objective-C object description
12854 @cindex @code{_NSPrintForDebugger}, and printing Objective-C objects
12855 @noindent
12856 will tell @value{GDBN} to send the @code{hash} message to @var{object}
12857 and print the result. Also, an additional command has been added,
12858 @code{print-object} or @code{po} for short, which is meant to print
12859 the description of an object. However, this command may only work
12860 with certain Objective-C libraries that have a particular hook
12861 function, @code{_NSPrintForDebugger}, defined.
12862
12863 @node OpenCL C
12864 @subsection OpenCL C
12865
12866 @cindex OpenCL C
12867 This section provides information about @value{GDBN}s OpenCL C support.
12868
12869 @menu
12870 * OpenCL C Datatypes::
12871 * OpenCL C Expressions::
12872 * OpenCL C Operators::
12873 @end menu
12874
12875 @node OpenCL C Datatypes
12876 @subsubsection OpenCL C Datatypes
12877
12878 @cindex OpenCL C Datatypes
12879 @value{GDBN} supports the builtin scalar and vector datatypes specified
12880 by OpenCL 1.1. In addition the half- and double-precision floating point
12881 data types of the @code{cl_khr_fp16} and @code{cl_khr_fp64} OpenCL
12882 extensions are also known to @value{GDBN}.
12883
12884 @node OpenCL C Expressions
12885 @subsubsection OpenCL C Expressions
12886
12887 @cindex OpenCL C Expressions
12888 @value{GDBN} supports accesses to vector components including the access as
12889 lvalue where possible. Since OpenCL C is based on C99 most C expressions
12890 supported by @value{GDBN} can be used as well.
12891
12892 @node OpenCL C Operators
12893 @subsubsection OpenCL C Operators
12894
12895 @cindex OpenCL C Operators
12896 @value{GDBN} supports the operators specified by OpenCL 1.1 for scalar and
12897 vector data types.
12898
12899 @node Fortran
12900 @subsection Fortran
12901 @cindex Fortran-specific support in @value{GDBN}
12902
12903 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Fortran, but it
12904 currently supports only the features of Fortran 77 language.
12905
12906 @cindex trailing underscore, in Fortran symbols
12907 Some Fortran compilers (@sc{gnu} Fortran 77 and Fortran 95 compilers
12908 among them) append an underscore to the names of variables and
12909 functions. When you debug programs compiled by those compilers, you
12910 will need to refer to variables and functions with a trailing
12911 underscore.
12912
12913 @menu
12914 * Fortran Operators:: Fortran operators and expressions
12915 * Fortran Defaults:: Default settings for Fortran
12916 * Special Fortran Commands:: Special @value{GDBN} commands for Fortran
12917 @end menu
12918
12919 @node Fortran Operators
12920 @subsubsection Fortran Operators and Expressions
12921
12922 @cindex Fortran operators and expressions
12923
12924 Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
12925 @code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on characters or other non-
12926 arithmetic types. Operators are often defined on groups of types.
12927
12928 @table @code
12929 @item **
12930 The exponentiation operator. It raises the first operand to the power
12931 of the second one.
12932
12933 @item :
12934 The range operator. Normally used in the form of array(low:high) to
12935 represent a section of array.
12936
12937 @item %
12938 The access component operator. Normally used to access elements in derived
12939 types. Also suitable for unions. As unions aren't part of regular Fortran,
12940 this can only happen when accessing a register that uses a gdbarch-defined
12941 union type.
12942 @end table
12943
12944 @node Fortran Defaults
12945 @subsubsection Fortran Defaults
12946
12947 @cindex Fortran Defaults
12948
12949 Fortran symbols are usually case-insensitive, so @value{GDBN} by
12950 default uses case-insensitive matches for Fortran symbols. You can
12951 change that with the @samp{set case-insensitive} command, see
12952 @ref{Symbols}, for the details.
12953
12954 @node Special Fortran Commands
12955 @subsubsection Special Fortran Commands
12956
12957 @cindex Special Fortran commands
12958
12959 @value{GDBN} has some commands to support Fortran-specific features,
12960 such as displaying common blocks.
12961
12962 @table @code
12963 @cindex @code{COMMON} blocks, Fortran
12964 @kindex info common
12965 @item info common @r{[}@var{common-name}@r{]}
12966 This command prints the values contained in the Fortran @code{COMMON}
12967 block whose name is @var{common-name}. With no argument, the names of
12968 all @code{COMMON} blocks visible at the current program location are
12969 printed.
12970 @end table
12971
12972 @node Pascal
12973 @subsection Pascal
12974
12975 @cindex Pascal support in @value{GDBN}, limitations
12976 Debugging Pascal programs which use sets, subranges, file variables, or
12977 nested functions does not currently work. @value{GDBN} does not support
12978 entering expressions, printing values, or similar features using Pascal
12979 syntax.
12980
12981 The Pascal-specific command @code{set print pascal_static-members}
12982 controls whether static members of Pascal objects are displayed.
12983 @xref{Print Settings, pascal_static-members}.
12984
12985 @node Modula-2
12986 @subsection Modula-2
12987
12988 @cindex Modula-2, @value{GDBN} support
12989
12990 The extensions made to @value{GDBN} to support Modula-2 only support
12991 output from the @sc{gnu} Modula-2 compiler (which is currently being
12992 developed). Other Modula-2 compilers are not currently supported, and
12993 attempting to debug executables produced by them is most likely
12994 to give an error as @value{GDBN} reads in the executable's symbol
12995 table.
12996
12997 @cindex expressions in Modula-2
12998 @menu
12999 * M2 Operators:: Built-in operators
13000 * Built-In Func/Proc:: Built-in functions and procedures
13001 * M2 Constants:: Modula-2 constants
13002 * M2 Types:: Modula-2 types
13003 * M2 Defaults:: Default settings for Modula-2
13004 * Deviations:: Deviations from standard Modula-2
13005 * M2 Checks:: Modula-2 type and range checks
13006 * M2 Scope:: The scope operators @code{::} and @code{.}
13007 * GDB/M2:: @value{GDBN} and Modula-2
13008 @end menu
13009
13010 @node M2 Operators
13011 @subsubsection Operators
13012 @cindex Modula-2 operators
13013
13014 Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
13015 @code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on structures. Operators are
13016 often defined on groups of types. For the purposes of Modula-2, the
13017 following definitions hold:
13018
13019 @itemize @bullet
13020
13021 @item
13022 @emph{Integral types} consist of @code{INTEGER}, @code{CARDINAL}, and
13023 their subranges.
13024
13025 @item
13026 @emph{Character types} consist of @code{CHAR} and its subranges.
13027
13028 @item
13029 @emph{Floating-point types} consist of @code{REAL}.
13030
13031 @item
13032 @emph{Pointer types} consist of anything declared as @code{POINTER TO
13033 @var{type}}.
13034
13035 @item
13036 @emph{Scalar types} consist of all of the above.
13037
13038 @item
13039 @emph{Set types} consist of @code{SET} and @code{BITSET} types.
13040
13041 @item
13042 @emph{Boolean types} consist of @code{BOOLEAN}.
13043 @end itemize
13044
13045 @noindent
13046 The following operators are supported, and appear in order of
13047 increasing precedence:
13048
13049 @table @code
13050 @item ,
13051 Function argument or array index separator.
13052
13053 @item :=
13054 Assignment. The value of @var{var} @code{:=} @var{value} is
13055 @var{value}.
13056
13057 @item <@r{, }>
13058 Less than, greater than on integral, floating-point, or enumerated
13059 types.
13060
13061 @item <=@r{, }>=
13062 Less than or equal to, greater than or equal to
13063 on integral, floating-point and enumerated types, or set inclusion on
13064 set types. Same precedence as @code{<}.
13065
13066 @item =@r{, }<>@r{, }#
13067 Equality and two ways of expressing inequality, valid on scalar types.
13068 Same precedence as @code{<}. In @value{GDBN} scripts, only @code{<>} is
13069 available for inequality, since @code{#} conflicts with the script
13070 comment character.
13071
13072 @item IN
13073 Set membership. Defined on set types and the types of their members.
13074 Same precedence as @code{<}.
13075
13076 @item OR
13077 Boolean disjunction. Defined on boolean types.
13078
13079 @item AND@r{, }&
13080 Boolean conjunction. Defined on boolean types.
13081
13082 @item @@
13083 The @value{GDBN} ``artificial array'' operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}).
13084
13085 @item +@r{, }-
13086 Addition and subtraction on integral and floating-point types, or union
13087 and difference on set types.
13088
13089 @item *
13090 Multiplication on integral and floating-point types, or set intersection
13091 on set types.
13092
13093 @item /
13094 Division on floating-point types, or symmetric set difference on set
13095 types. Same precedence as @code{*}.
13096
13097 @item DIV@r{, }MOD
13098 Integer division and remainder. Defined on integral types. Same
13099 precedence as @code{*}.
13100
13101 @item -
13102 Negative. Defined on @code{INTEGER} and @code{REAL} data.
13103
13104 @item ^
13105 Pointer dereferencing. Defined on pointer types.
13106
13107 @item NOT
13108 Boolean negation. Defined on boolean types. Same precedence as
13109 @code{^}.
13110
13111 @item .
13112 @code{RECORD} field selector. Defined on @code{RECORD} data. Same
13113 precedence as @code{^}.
13114
13115 @item []
13116 Array indexing. Defined on @code{ARRAY} data. Same precedence as @code{^}.
13117
13118 @item ()
13119 Procedure argument list. Defined on @code{PROCEDURE} objects. Same precedence
13120 as @code{^}.
13121
13122 @item ::@r{, }.
13123 @value{GDBN} and Modula-2 scope operators.
13124 @end table
13125
13126 @quotation
13127 @emph{Warning:} Set expressions and their operations are not yet supported, so @value{GDBN}
13128 treats the use of the operator @code{IN}, or the use of operators
13129 @code{+}, @code{-}, @code{*}, @code{/}, @code{=}, , @code{<>}, @code{#},
13130 @code{<=}, and @code{>=} on sets as an error.
13131 @end quotation
13132
13133
13134 @node Built-In Func/Proc
13135 @subsubsection Built-in Functions and Procedures
13136 @cindex Modula-2 built-ins
13137
13138 Modula-2 also makes available several built-in procedures and functions.
13139 In describing these, the following metavariables are used:
13140
13141 @table @var
13142
13143 @item a
13144 represents an @code{ARRAY} variable.
13145
13146 @item c
13147 represents a @code{CHAR} constant or variable.
13148
13149 @item i
13150 represents a variable or constant of integral type.
13151
13152 @item m
13153 represents an identifier that belongs to a set. Generally used in the
13154 same function with the metavariable @var{s}. The type of @var{s} should
13155 be @code{SET OF @var{mtype}} (where @var{mtype} is the type of @var{m}).
13156
13157 @item n
13158 represents a variable or constant of integral or floating-point type.
13159
13160 @item r
13161 represents a variable or constant of floating-point type.
13162
13163 @item t
13164 represents a type.
13165
13166 @item v
13167 represents a variable.
13168
13169 @item x
13170 represents a variable or constant of one of many types. See the
13171 explanation of the function for details.
13172 @end table
13173
13174 All Modula-2 built-in procedures also return a result, described below.
13175
13176 @table @code
13177 @item ABS(@var{n})
13178 Returns the absolute value of @var{n}.
13179
13180 @item CAP(@var{c})
13181 If @var{c} is a lower case letter, it returns its upper case
13182 equivalent, otherwise it returns its argument.
13183
13184 @item CHR(@var{i})
13185 Returns the character whose ordinal value is @var{i}.
13186
13187 @item DEC(@var{v})
13188 Decrements the value in the variable @var{v} by one. Returns the new value.
13189
13190 @item DEC(@var{v},@var{i})
13191 Decrements the value in the variable @var{v} by @var{i}. Returns the
13192 new value.
13193
13194 @item EXCL(@var{m},@var{s})
13195 Removes the element @var{m} from the set @var{s}. Returns the new
13196 set.
13197
13198 @item FLOAT(@var{i})
13199 Returns the floating point equivalent of the integer @var{i}.
13200
13201 @item HIGH(@var{a})
13202 Returns the index of the last member of @var{a}.
13203
13204 @item INC(@var{v})
13205 Increments the value in the variable @var{v} by one. Returns the new value.
13206
13207 @item INC(@var{v},@var{i})
13208 Increments the value in the variable @var{v} by @var{i}. Returns the
13209 new value.
13210
13211 @item INCL(@var{m},@var{s})
13212 Adds the element @var{m} to the set @var{s} if it is not already
13213 there. Returns the new set.
13214
13215 @item MAX(@var{t})
13216 Returns the maximum value of the type @var{t}.
13217
13218 @item MIN(@var{t})
13219 Returns the minimum value of the type @var{t}.
13220
13221 @item ODD(@var{i})
13222 Returns boolean TRUE if @var{i} is an odd number.
13223
13224 @item ORD(@var{x})
13225 Returns the ordinal value of its argument. For example, the ordinal
13226 value of a character is its @sc{ascii} value (on machines supporting the
13227 @sc{ascii} character set). @var{x} must be of an ordered type, which include
13228 integral, character and enumerated types.
13229
13230 @item SIZE(@var{x})
13231 Returns the size of its argument. @var{x} can be a variable or a type.
13232
13233 @item TRUNC(@var{r})
13234 Returns the integral part of @var{r}.
13235
13236 @item TSIZE(@var{x})
13237 Returns the size of its argument. @var{x} can be a variable or a type.
13238
13239 @item VAL(@var{t},@var{i})
13240 Returns the member of the type @var{t} whose ordinal value is @var{i}.
13241 @end table
13242
13243 @quotation
13244 @emph{Warning:} Sets and their operations are not yet supported, so
13245 @value{GDBN} treats the use of procedures @code{INCL} and @code{EXCL} as
13246 an error.
13247 @end quotation
13248
13249 @cindex Modula-2 constants
13250 @node M2 Constants
13251 @subsubsection Constants
13252
13253 @value{GDBN} allows you to express the constants of Modula-2 in the following
13254 ways:
13255
13256 @itemize @bullet
13257
13258 @item
13259 Integer constants are simply a sequence of digits. When used in an
13260 expression, a constant is interpreted to be type-compatible with the
13261 rest of the expression. Hexadecimal integers are specified by a
13262 trailing @samp{H}, and octal integers by a trailing @samp{B}.
13263
13264 @item
13265 Floating point constants appear as a sequence of digits, followed by a
13266 decimal point and another sequence of digits. An optional exponent can
13267 then be specified, in the form @samp{E@r{[}+@r{|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}}, where
13268 @samp{@r{[}+@r{|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}} is the desired exponent. All of the
13269 digits of the floating point constant must be valid decimal (base 10)
13270 digits.
13271
13272 @item
13273 Character constants consist of a single character enclosed by a pair of
13274 like quotes, either single (@code{'}) or double (@code{"}). They may
13275 also be expressed by their ordinal value (their @sc{ascii} value, usually)
13276 followed by a @samp{C}.
13277
13278 @item
13279 String constants consist of a sequence of characters enclosed by a
13280 pair of like quotes, either single (@code{'}) or double (@code{"}).
13281 Escape sequences in the style of C are also allowed. @xref{C
13282 Constants, ,C and C@t{++} Constants}, for a brief explanation of escape
13283 sequences.
13284
13285 @item
13286 Enumerated constants consist of an enumerated identifier.
13287
13288 @item
13289 Boolean constants consist of the identifiers @code{TRUE} and
13290 @code{FALSE}.
13291
13292 @item
13293 Pointer constants consist of integral values only.
13294
13295 @item
13296 Set constants are not yet supported.
13297 @end itemize
13298
13299 @node M2 Types
13300 @subsubsection Modula-2 Types
13301 @cindex Modula-2 types
13302
13303 Currently @value{GDBN} can print the following data types in Modula-2
13304 syntax: array types, record types, set types, pointer types, procedure
13305 types, enumerated types, subrange types and base types. You can also
13306 print the contents of variables declared using these type.
13307 This section gives a number of simple source code examples together with
13308 sample @value{GDBN} sessions.
13309
13310 The first example contains the following section of code:
13311
13312 @smallexample
13313 VAR
13314 s: SET OF CHAR ;
13315 r: [20..40] ;
13316 @end smallexample
13317
13318 @noindent
13319 and you can request @value{GDBN} to interrogate the type and value of
13320 @code{r} and @code{s}.
13321
13322 @smallexample
13323 (@value{GDBP}) print s
13324 @{'A'..'C', 'Z'@}
13325 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
13326 SET OF CHAR
13327 (@value{GDBP}) print r
13328 21
13329 (@value{GDBP}) ptype r
13330 [20..40]
13331 @end smallexample
13332
13333 @noindent
13334 Likewise if your source code declares @code{s} as:
13335
13336 @smallexample
13337 VAR
13338 s: SET ['A'..'Z'] ;
13339 @end smallexample
13340
13341 @noindent
13342 then you may query the type of @code{s} by:
13343
13344 @smallexample
13345 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
13346 type = SET ['A'..'Z']
13347 @end smallexample
13348
13349 @noindent
13350 Note that at present you cannot interactively manipulate set
13351 expressions using the debugger.
13352
13353 The following example shows how you might declare an array in Modula-2
13354 and how you can interact with @value{GDBN} to print its type and contents:
13355
13356 @smallexample
13357 VAR
13358 s: ARRAY [-10..10] OF CHAR ;
13359 @end smallexample
13360
13361 @smallexample
13362 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
13363 ARRAY [-10..10] OF CHAR
13364 @end smallexample
13365
13366 Note that the array handling is not yet complete and although the type
13367 is printed correctly, expression handling still assumes that all
13368 arrays have a lower bound of zero and not @code{-10} as in the example
13369 above.
13370
13371 Here are some more type related Modula-2 examples:
13372
13373 @smallexample
13374 TYPE
13375 colour = (blue, red, yellow, green) ;
13376 t = [blue..yellow] ;
13377 VAR
13378 s: t ;
13379 BEGIN
13380 s := blue ;
13381 @end smallexample
13382
13383 @noindent
13384 The @value{GDBN} interaction shows how you can query the data type
13385 and value of a variable.
13386
13387 @smallexample
13388 (@value{GDBP}) print s
13389 $1 = blue
13390 (@value{GDBP}) ptype t
13391 type = [blue..yellow]
13392 @end smallexample
13393
13394 @noindent
13395 In this example a Modula-2 array is declared and its contents
13396 displayed. Observe that the contents are written in the same way as
13397 their @code{C} counterparts.
13398
13399 @smallexample
13400 VAR
13401 s: ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL ;
13402 BEGIN
13403 s[1] := 1 ;
13404 @end smallexample
13405
13406 @smallexample
13407 (@value{GDBP}) print s
13408 $1 = @{1, 0, 0, 0, 0@}
13409 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
13410 type = ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL
13411 @end smallexample
13412
13413 The Modula-2 language interface to @value{GDBN} also understands
13414 pointer types as shown in this example:
13415
13416 @smallexample
13417 VAR
13418 s: POINTER TO ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL ;
13419 BEGIN
13420 NEW(s) ;
13421 s^[1] := 1 ;
13422 @end smallexample
13423
13424 @noindent
13425 and you can request that @value{GDBN} describes the type of @code{s}.
13426
13427 @smallexample
13428 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
13429 type = POINTER TO ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL
13430 @end smallexample
13431
13432 @value{GDBN} handles compound types as we can see in this example.
13433 Here we combine array types, record types, pointer types and subrange
13434 types:
13435
13436 @smallexample
13437 TYPE
13438 foo = RECORD
13439 f1: CARDINAL ;
13440 f2: CHAR ;
13441 f3: myarray ;
13442 END ;
13443
13444 myarray = ARRAY myrange OF CARDINAL ;
13445 myrange = [-2..2] ;
13446 VAR
13447 s: POINTER TO ARRAY myrange OF foo ;
13448 @end smallexample
13449
13450 @noindent
13451 and you can ask @value{GDBN} to describe the type of @code{s} as shown
13452 below.
13453
13454 @smallexample
13455 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
13456 type = POINTER TO ARRAY [-2..2] OF foo = RECORD
13457 f1 : CARDINAL;
13458 f2 : CHAR;
13459 f3 : ARRAY [-2..2] OF CARDINAL;
13460 END
13461 @end smallexample
13462
13463 @node M2 Defaults
13464 @subsubsection Modula-2 Defaults
13465 @cindex Modula-2 defaults
13466
13467 If type and range checking are set automatically by @value{GDBN}, they
13468 both default to @code{on} whenever the working language changes to
13469 Modula-2. This happens regardless of whether you or @value{GDBN}
13470 selected the working language.
13471
13472 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically, then entering
13473 code compiled from a file whose name ends with @file{.mod} sets the
13474 working language to Modula-2. @xref{Automatically, ,Having @value{GDBN}
13475 Infer the Source Language}, for further details.
13476
13477 @node Deviations
13478 @subsubsection Deviations from Standard Modula-2
13479 @cindex Modula-2, deviations from
13480
13481 A few changes have been made to make Modula-2 programs easier to debug.
13482 This is done primarily via loosening its type strictness:
13483
13484 @itemize @bullet
13485 @item
13486 Unlike in standard Modula-2, pointer constants can be formed by
13487 integers. This allows you to modify pointer variables during
13488 debugging. (In standard Modula-2, the actual address contained in a
13489 pointer variable is hidden from you; it can only be modified
13490 through direct assignment to another pointer variable or expression that
13491 returned a pointer.)
13492
13493 @item
13494 C escape sequences can be used in strings and characters to represent
13495 non-printable characters. @value{GDBN} prints out strings with these
13496 escape sequences embedded. Single non-printable characters are
13497 printed using the @samp{CHR(@var{nnn})} format.
13498
13499 @item
13500 The assignment operator (@code{:=}) returns the value of its right-hand
13501 argument.
13502
13503 @item
13504 All built-in procedures both modify @emph{and} return their argument.
13505 @end itemize
13506
13507 @node M2 Checks
13508 @subsubsection Modula-2 Type and Range Checks
13509 @cindex Modula-2 checks
13510
13511 @quotation
13512 @emph{Warning:} in this release, @value{GDBN} does not yet perform type or
13513 range checking.
13514 @end quotation
13515 @c FIXME remove warning when type/range checks added
13516
13517 @value{GDBN} considers two Modula-2 variables type equivalent if:
13518
13519 @itemize @bullet
13520 @item
13521 They are of types that have been declared equivalent via a @code{TYPE
13522 @var{t1} = @var{t2}} statement
13523
13524 @item
13525 They have been declared on the same line. (Note: This is true of the
13526 @sc{gnu} Modula-2 compiler, but it may not be true of other compilers.)
13527 @end itemize
13528
13529 As long as type checking is enabled, any attempt to combine variables
13530 whose types are not equivalent is an error.
13531
13532 Range checking is done on all mathematical operations, assignment, array
13533 index bounds, and all built-in functions and procedures.
13534
13535 @node M2 Scope
13536 @subsubsection The Scope Operators @code{::} and @code{.}
13537 @cindex scope
13538 @cindex @code{.}, Modula-2 scope operator
13539 @cindex colon, doubled as scope operator
13540 @ifinfo
13541 @vindex colon-colon@r{, in Modula-2}
13542 @c Info cannot handle :: but TeX can.
13543 @end ifinfo
13544 @ifnotinfo
13545 @vindex ::@r{, in Modula-2}
13546 @end ifnotinfo
13547
13548 There are a few subtle differences between the Modula-2 scope operator
13549 (@code{.}) and the @value{GDBN} scope operator (@code{::}). The two have
13550 similar syntax:
13551
13552 @smallexample
13553
13554 @var{module} . @var{id}
13555 @var{scope} :: @var{id}
13556 @end smallexample
13557
13558 @noindent
13559 where @var{scope} is the name of a module or a procedure,
13560 @var{module} the name of a module, and @var{id} is any declared
13561 identifier within your program, except another module.
13562
13563 Using the @code{::} operator makes @value{GDBN} search the scope
13564 specified by @var{scope} for the identifier @var{id}. If it is not
13565 found in the specified scope, then @value{GDBN} searches all scopes
13566 enclosing the one specified by @var{scope}.
13567
13568 Using the @code{.} operator makes @value{GDBN} search the current scope for
13569 the identifier specified by @var{id} that was imported from the
13570 definition module specified by @var{module}. With this operator, it is
13571 an error if the identifier @var{id} was not imported from definition
13572 module @var{module}, or if @var{id} is not an identifier in
13573 @var{module}.
13574
13575 @node GDB/M2
13576 @subsubsection @value{GDBN} and Modula-2
13577
13578 Some @value{GDBN} commands have little use when debugging Modula-2 programs.
13579 Five subcommands of @code{set print} and @code{show print} apply
13580 specifically to C and C@t{++}: @samp{vtbl}, @samp{demangle},
13581 @samp{asm-demangle}, @samp{object}, and @samp{union}. The first four
13582 apply to C@t{++}, and the last to the C @code{union} type, which has no direct
13583 analogue in Modula-2.
13584
13585 The @code{@@} operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}), while available
13586 with any language, is not useful with Modula-2. Its
13587 intent is to aid the debugging of @dfn{dynamic arrays}, which cannot be
13588 created in Modula-2 as they can in C or C@t{++}. However, because an
13589 address can be specified by an integral constant, the construct
13590 @samp{@{@var{type}@}@var{adrexp}} is still useful.
13591
13592 @cindex @code{#} in Modula-2
13593 In @value{GDBN} scripts, the Modula-2 inequality operator @code{#} is
13594 interpreted as the beginning of a comment. Use @code{<>} instead.
13595
13596 @node Ada
13597 @subsection Ada
13598 @cindex Ada
13599
13600 The extensions made to @value{GDBN} for Ada only support
13601 output from the @sc{gnu} Ada (GNAT) compiler.
13602 Other Ada compilers are not currently supported, and
13603 attempting to debug executables produced by them is most likely
13604 to be difficult.
13605
13606
13607 @cindex expressions in Ada
13608 @menu
13609 * Ada Mode Intro:: General remarks on the Ada syntax
13610 and semantics supported by Ada mode
13611 in @value{GDBN}.
13612 * Omissions from Ada:: Restrictions on the Ada expression syntax.
13613 * Additions to Ada:: Extensions of the Ada expression syntax.
13614 * Stopping Before Main Program:: Debugging the program during elaboration.
13615 * Ada Tasks:: Listing and setting breakpoints in tasks.
13616 * Ada Tasks and Core Files:: Tasking Support when Debugging Core Files
13617 * Ravenscar Profile:: Tasking Support when using the Ravenscar
13618 Profile
13619 * Ada Glitches:: Known peculiarities of Ada mode.
13620 @end menu
13621
13622 @node Ada Mode Intro
13623 @subsubsection Introduction
13624 @cindex Ada mode, general
13625
13626 The Ada mode of @value{GDBN} supports a fairly large subset of Ada expression
13627 syntax, with some extensions.
13628 The philosophy behind the design of this subset is
13629
13630 @itemize @bullet
13631 @item
13632 That @value{GDBN} should provide basic literals and access to operations for
13633 arithmetic, dereferencing, field selection, indexing, and subprogram calls,
13634 leaving more sophisticated computations to subprograms written into the
13635 program (which therefore may be called from @value{GDBN}).
13636
13637 @item
13638 That type safety and strict adherence to Ada language restrictions
13639 are not particularly important to the @value{GDBN} user.
13640
13641 @item
13642 That brevity is important to the @value{GDBN} user.
13643 @end itemize
13644
13645 Thus, for brevity, the debugger acts as if all names declared in
13646 user-written packages are directly visible, even if they are not visible
13647 according to Ada rules, thus making it unnecessary to fully qualify most
13648 names with their packages, regardless of context. Where this causes
13649 ambiguity, @value{GDBN} asks the user's intent.
13650
13651 The debugger will start in Ada mode if it detects an Ada main program.
13652 As for other languages, it will enter Ada mode when stopped in a program that
13653 was translated from an Ada source file.
13654
13655 While in Ada mode, you may use `@t{--}' for comments. This is useful
13656 mostly for documenting command files. The standard @value{GDBN} comment
13657 (@samp{#}) still works at the beginning of a line in Ada mode, but not in the
13658 middle (to allow based literals).
13659
13660 The debugger supports limited overloading. Given a subprogram call in which
13661 the function symbol has multiple definitions, it will use the number of
13662 actual parameters and some information about their types to attempt to narrow
13663 the set of definitions. It also makes very limited use of context, preferring
13664 procedures to functions in the context of the @code{call} command, and
13665 functions to procedures elsewhere.
13666
13667 @node Omissions from Ada
13668 @subsubsection Omissions from Ada
13669 @cindex Ada, omissions from
13670
13671 Here are the notable omissions from the subset:
13672
13673 @itemize @bullet
13674 @item
13675 Only a subset of the attributes are supported:
13676
13677 @itemize @minus
13678 @item
13679 @t{'First}, @t{'Last}, and @t{'Length}
13680 on array objects (not on types and subtypes).
13681
13682 @item
13683 @t{'Min} and @t{'Max}.
13684
13685 @item
13686 @t{'Pos} and @t{'Val}.
13687
13688 @item
13689 @t{'Tag}.
13690
13691 @item
13692 @t{'Range} on array objects (not subtypes), but only as the right
13693 operand of the membership (@code{in}) operator.
13694
13695 @item
13696 @t{'Access}, @t{'Unchecked_Access}, and
13697 @t{'Unrestricted_Access} (a GNAT extension).
13698
13699 @item
13700 @t{'Address}.
13701 @end itemize
13702
13703 @item
13704 The names in
13705 @code{Characters.Latin_1} are not available and
13706 concatenation is not implemented. Thus, escape characters in strings are
13707 not currently available.
13708
13709 @item
13710 Equality tests (@samp{=} and @samp{/=}) on arrays test for bitwise
13711 equality of representations. They will generally work correctly
13712 for strings and arrays whose elements have integer or enumeration types.
13713 They may not work correctly for arrays whose element
13714 types have user-defined equality, for arrays of real values
13715 (in particular, IEEE-conformant floating point, because of negative
13716 zeroes and NaNs), and for arrays whose elements contain unused bits with
13717 indeterminate values.
13718
13719 @item
13720 The other component-by-component array operations (@code{and}, @code{or},
13721 @code{xor}, @code{not}, and relational tests other than equality)
13722 are not implemented.
13723
13724 @item
13725 @cindex array aggregates (Ada)
13726 @cindex record aggregates (Ada)
13727 @cindex aggregates (Ada)
13728 There is limited support for array and record aggregates. They are
13729 permitted only on the right sides of assignments, as in these examples:
13730
13731 @smallexample
13732 (@value{GDBP}) set An_Array := (1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6)
13733 (@value{GDBP}) set An_Array := (1, others => 0)
13734 (@value{GDBP}) set An_Array := (0|4 => 1, 1..3 => 2, 5 => 6)
13735 (@value{GDBP}) set A_2D_Array := ((1, 2, 3), (4, 5, 6), (7, 8, 9))
13736 (@value{GDBP}) set A_Record := (1, "Peter", True);
13737 (@value{GDBP}) set A_Record := (Name => "Peter", Id => 1, Alive => True)
13738 @end smallexample
13739
13740 Changing a
13741 discriminant's value by assigning an aggregate has an
13742 undefined effect if that discriminant is used within the record.
13743 However, you can first modify discriminants by directly assigning to
13744 them (which normally would not be allowed in Ada), and then performing an
13745 aggregate assignment. For example, given a variable @code{A_Rec}
13746 declared to have a type such as:
13747
13748 @smallexample
13749 type Rec (Len : Small_Integer := 0) is record
13750 Id : Integer;
13751 Vals : IntArray (1 .. Len);
13752 end record;
13753 @end smallexample
13754
13755 you can assign a value with a different size of @code{Vals} with two
13756 assignments:
13757
13758 @smallexample
13759 (@value{GDBP}) set A_Rec.Len := 4
13760 (@value{GDBP}) set A_Rec := (Id => 42, Vals => (1, 2, 3, 4))
13761 @end smallexample
13762
13763 As this example also illustrates, @value{GDBN} is very loose about the usual
13764 rules concerning aggregates. You may leave out some of the
13765 components of an array or record aggregate (such as the @code{Len}
13766 component in the assignment to @code{A_Rec} above); they will retain their
13767 original values upon assignment. You may freely use dynamic values as
13768 indices in component associations. You may even use overlapping or
13769 redundant component associations, although which component values are
13770 assigned in such cases is not defined.
13771
13772 @item
13773 Calls to dispatching subprograms are not implemented.
13774
13775 @item
13776 The overloading algorithm is much more limited (i.e., less selective)
13777 than that of real Ada. It makes only limited use of the context in
13778 which a subexpression appears to resolve its meaning, and it is much
13779 looser in its rules for allowing type matches. As a result, some
13780 function calls will be ambiguous, and the user will be asked to choose
13781 the proper resolution.
13782
13783 @item
13784 The @code{new} operator is not implemented.
13785
13786 @item
13787 Entry calls are not implemented.
13788
13789 @item
13790 Aside from printing, arithmetic operations on the native VAX floating-point
13791 formats are not supported.
13792
13793 @item
13794 It is not possible to slice a packed array.
13795
13796 @item
13797 The names @code{True} and @code{False}, when not part of a qualified name,
13798 are interpreted as if implicitly prefixed by @code{Standard}, regardless of
13799 context.
13800 Should your program
13801 redefine these names in a package or procedure (at best a dubious practice),
13802 you will have to use fully qualified names to access their new definitions.
13803 @end itemize
13804
13805 @node Additions to Ada
13806 @subsubsection Additions to Ada
13807 @cindex Ada, deviations from
13808
13809 As it does for other languages, @value{GDBN} makes certain generic
13810 extensions to Ada (@pxref{Expressions}):
13811
13812 @itemize @bullet
13813 @item
13814 If the expression @var{E} is a variable residing in memory (typically
13815 a local variable or array element) and @var{N} is a positive integer,
13816 then @code{@var{E}@@@var{N}} displays the values of @var{E} and the
13817 @var{N}-1 adjacent variables following it in memory as an array. In
13818 Ada, this operator is generally not necessary, since its prime use is
13819 in displaying parts of an array, and slicing will usually do this in
13820 Ada. However, there are occasional uses when debugging programs in
13821 which certain debugging information has been optimized away.
13822
13823 @item
13824 @code{@var{B}::@var{var}} means ``the variable named @var{var} that
13825 appears in function or file @var{B}.'' When @var{B} is a file name,
13826 you must typically surround it in single quotes.
13827
13828 @item
13829 The expression @code{@{@var{type}@} @var{addr}} means ``the variable of type
13830 @var{type} that appears at address @var{addr}.''
13831
13832 @item
13833 A name starting with @samp{$} is a convenience variable
13834 (@pxref{Convenience Vars}) or a machine register (@pxref{Registers}).
13835 @end itemize
13836
13837 In addition, @value{GDBN} provides a few other shortcuts and outright
13838 additions specific to Ada:
13839
13840 @itemize @bullet
13841 @item
13842 The assignment statement is allowed as an expression, returning
13843 its right-hand operand as its value. Thus, you may enter
13844
13845 @smallexample
13846 (@value{GDBP}) set x := y + 3
13847 (@value{GDBP}) print A(tmp := y + 1)
13848 @end smallexample
13849
13850 @item
13851 The semicolon is allowed as an ``operator,'' returning as its value
13852 the value of its right-hand operand.
13853 This allows, for example,
13854 complex conditional breaks:
13855
13856 @smallexample
13857 (@value{GDBP}) break f
13858 (@value{GDBP}) condition 1 (report(i); k += 1; A(k) > 100)
13859 @end smallexample
13860
13861 @item
13862 Rather than use catenation and symbolic character names to introduce special
13863 characters into strings, one may instead use a special bracket notation,
13864 which is also used to print strings. A sequence of characters of the form
13865 @samp{["@var{XX}"]} within a string or character literal denotes the
13866 (single) character whose numeric encoding is @var{XX} in hexadecimal. The
13867 sequence of characters @samp{["""]} also denotes a single quotation mark
13868 in strings. For example,
13869 @smallexample
13870 "One line.["0a"]Next line.["0a"]"
13871 @end smallexample
13872 @noindent
13873 contains an ASCII newline character (@code{Ada.Characters.Latin_1.LF})
13874 after each period.
13875
13876 @item
13877 The subtype used as a prefix for the attributes @t{'Pos}, @t{'Min}, and
13878 @t{'Max} is optional (and is ignored in any case). For example, it is valid
13879 to write
13880
13881 @smallexample
13882 (@value{GDBP}) print 'max(x, y)
13883 @end smallexample
13884
13885 @item
13886 When printing arrays, @value{GDBN} uses positional notation when the
13887 array has a lower bound of 1, and uses a modified named notation otherwise.
13888 For example, a one-dimensional array of three integers with a lower bound
13889 of 3 might print as
13890
13891 @smallexample
13892 (3 => 10, 17, 1)
13893 @end smallexample
13894
13895 @noindent
13896 That is, in contrast to valid Ada, only the first component has a @code{=>}
13897 clause.
13898
13899 @item
13900 You may abbreviate attributes in expressions with any unique,
13901 multi-character subsequence of
13902 their names (an exact match gets preference).
13903 For example, you may use @t{a'len}, @t{a'gth}, or @t{a'lh}
13904 in place of @t{a'length}.
13905
13906 @item
13907 @cindex quoting Ada internal identifiers
13908 Since Ada is case-insensitive, the debugger normally maps identifiers you type
13909 to lower case. The GNAT compiler uses upper-case characters for
13910 some of its internal identifiers, which are normally of no interest to users.
13911 For the rare occasions when you actually have to look at them,
13912 enclose them in angle brackets to avoid the lower-case mapping.
13913 For example,
13914 @smallexample
13915 (@value{GDBP}) print <JMPBUF_SAVE>[0]
13916 @end smallexample
13917
13918 @item
13919 Printing an object of class-wide type or dereferencing an
13920 access-to-class-wide value will display all the components of the object's
13921 specific type (as indicated by its run-time tag). Likewise, component
13922 selection on such a value will operate on the specific type of the
13923 object.
13924
13925 @end itemize
13926
13927 @node Stopping Before Main Program
13928 @subsubsection Stopping at the Very Beginning
13929
13930 @cindex breakpointing Ada elaboration code
13931 It is sometimes necessary to debug the program during elaboration, and
13932 before reaching the main procedure.
13933 As defined in the Ada Reference
13934 Manual, the elaboration code is invoked from a procedure called
13935 @code{adainit}. To run your program up to the beginning of
13936 elaboration, simply use the following two commands:
13937 @code{tbreak adainit} and @code{run}.
13938
13939 @node Ada Tasks
13940 @subsubsection Extensions for Ada Tasks
13941 @cindex Ada, tasking
13942
13943 Support for Ada tasks is analogous to that for threads (@pxref{Threads}).
13944 @value{GDBN} provides the following task-related commands:
13945
13946 @table @code
13947 @kindex info tasks
13948 @item info tasks
13949 This command shows a list of current Ada tasks, as in the following example:
13950
13951
13952 @smallexample
13953 @iftex
13954 @leftskip=0.5cm
13955 @end iftex
13956 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
13957 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
13958 1 8088000 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
13959 2 80a4000 1 15 Accept Statement b
13960 3 809a800 1 15 Child Activation Wait a
13961 * 4 80ae800 3 15 Runnable c
13962
13963 @end smallexample
13964
13965 @noindent
13966 In this listing, the asterisk before the last task indicates it to be the
13967 task currently being inspected.
13968
13969 @table @asis
13970 @item ID
13971 Represents @value{GDBN}'s internal task number.
13972
13973 @item TID
13974 The Ada task ID.
13975
13976 @item P-ID
13977 The parent's task ID (@value{GDBN}'s internal task number).
13978
13979 @item Pri
13980 The base priority of the task.
13981
13982 @item State
13983 Current state of the task.
13984
13985 @table @code
13986 @item Unactivated
13987 The task has been created but has not been activated. It cannot be
13988 executing.
13989
13990 @item Runnable
13991 The task is not blocked for any reason known to Ada. (It may be waiting
13992 for a mutex, though.) It is conceptually "executing" in normal mode.
13993
13994 @item Terminated
13995 The task is terminated, in the sense of ARM 9.3 (5). Any dependents
13996 that were waiting on terminate alternatives have been awakened and have
13997 terminated themselves.
13998
13999 @item Child Activation Wait
14000 The task is waiting for created tasks to complete activation.
14001
14002 @item Accept Statement
14003 The task is waiting on an accept or selective wait statement.
14004
14005 @item Waiting on entry call
14006 The task is waiting on an entry call.
14007
14008 @item Async Select Wait
14009 The task is waiting to start the abortable part of an asynchronous
14010 select statement.
14011
14012 @item Delay Sleep
14013 The task is waiting on a select statement with only a delay
14014 alternative open.
14015
14016 @item Child Termination Wait
14017 The task is sleeping having completed a master within itself, and is
14018 waiting for the tasks dependent on that master to become terminated or
14019 waiting on a terminate Phase.
14020
14021 @item Wait Child in Term Alt
14022 The task is sleeping waiting for tasks on terminate alternatives to
14023 finish terminating.
14024
14025 @item Accepting RV with @var{taskno}
14026 The task is accepting a rendez-vous with the task @var{taskno}.
14027 @end table
14028
14029 @item Name
14030 Name of the task in the program.
14031
14032 @end table
14033
14034 @kindex info task @var{taskno}
14035 @item info task @var{taskno}
14036 This command shows detailled informations on the specified task, as in
14037 the following example:
14038 @smallexample
14039 @iftex
14040 @leftskip=0.5cm
14041 @end iftex
14042 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
14043 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
14044 1 8077880 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
14045 * 2 807c468 1 15 Runnable task_1
14046 (@value{GDBP}) info task 2
14047 Ada Task: 0x807c468
14048 Name: task_1
14049 Thread: 0x807f378
14050 Parent: 1 (main_task)
14051 Base Priority: 15
14052 State: Runnable
14053 @end smallexample
14054
14055 @item task
14056 @kindex task@r{ (Ada)}
14057 @cindex current Ada task ID
14058 This command prints the ID of the current task.
14059
14060 @smallexample
14061 @iftex
14062 @leftskip=0.5cm
14063 @end iftex
14064 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
14065 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
14066 1 8077870 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
14067 * 2 807c458 1 15 Runnable t
14068 (@value{GDBP}) task
14069 [Current task is 2]
14070 @end smallexample
14071
14072 @item task @var{taskno}
14073 @cindex Ada task switching
14074 This command is like the @code{thread @var{threadno}}
14075 command (@pxref{Threads}). It switches the context of debugging
14076 from the current task to the given task.
14077
14078 @smallexample
14079 @iftex
14080 @leftskip=0.5cm
14081 @end iftex
14082 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
14083 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
14084 1 8077870 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
14085 * 2 807c458 1 15 Runnable t
14086 (@value{GDBP}) task 1
14087 [Switching to task 1]
14088 #0 0x8067726 in pthread_cond_wait ()
14089 (@value{GDBP}) bt
14090 #0 0x8067726 in pthread_cond_wait ()
14091 #1 0x8056714 in system.os_interface.pthread_cond_wait ()
14092 #2 0x805cb63 in system.task_primitives.operations.sleep ()
14093 #3 0x806153e in system.tasking.stages.activate_tasks ()
14094 #4 0x804aacc in un () at un.adb:5
14095 @end smallexample
14096
14097 @item break @var{linespec} task @var{taskno}
14098 @itemx break @var{linespec} task @var{taskno} if @dots{}
14099 @cindex breakpoints and tasks, in Ada
14100 @cindex task breakpoints, in Ada
14101 @kindex break @dots{} task @var{taskno}@r{ (Ada)}
14102 These commands are like the @code{break @dots{} thread @dots{}}
14103 command (@pxref{Thread Stops}).
14104 @var{linespec} specifies source lines, as described
14105 in @ref{Specify Location}.
14106
14107 Use the qualifier @samp{task @var{taskno}} with a breakpoint command
14108 to specify that you only want @value{GDBN} to stop the program when a
14109 particular Ada task reaches this breakpoint. @var{taskno} is one of the
14110 numeric task identifiers assigned by @value{GDBN}, shown in the first
14111 column of the @samp{info tasks} display.
14112
14113 If you do not specify @samp{task @var{taskno}} when you set a
14114 breakpoint, the breakpoint applies to @emph{all} tasks of your
14115 program.
14116
14117 You can use the @code{task} qualifier on conditional breakpoints as
14118 well; in this case, place @samp{task @var{taskno}} before the
14119 breakpoint condition (before the @code{if}).
14120
14121 For example,
14122
14123 @smallexample
14124 @iftex
14125 @leftskip=0.5cm
14126 @end iftex
14127 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
14128 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
14129 1 140022020 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
14130 2 140045060 1 15 Accept/Select Wait t2
14131 3 140044840 1 15 Runnable t1
14132 * 4 140056040 1 15 Runnable t3
14133 (@value{GDBP}) b 15 task 2
14134 Breakpoint 5 at 0x120044cb0: file test_task_debug.adb, line 15.
14135 (@value{GDBP}) cont
14136 Continuing.
14137 task # 1 running
14138 task # 2 running
14139
14140 Breakpoint 5, test_task_debug () at test_task_debug.adb:15
14141 15 flush;
14142 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
14143 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
14144 1 140022020 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
14145 * 2 140045060 1 15 Runnable t2
14146 3 140044840 1 15 Runnable t1
14147 4 140056040 1 15 Delay Sleep t3
14148 @end smallexample
14149 @end table
14150
14151 @node Ada Tasks and Core Files
14152 @subsubsection Tasking Support when Debugging Core Files
14153 @cindex Ada tasking and core file debugging
14154
14155 When inspecting a core file, as opposed to debugging a live program,
14156 tasking support may be limited or even unavailable, depending on
14157 the platform being used.
14158 For instance, on x86-linux, the list of tasks is available, but task
14159 switching is not supported. On Tru64, however, task switching will work
14160 as usual.
14161
14162 On certain platforms, including Tru64, the debugger needs to perform some
14163 memory writes in order to provide Ada tasking support. When inspecting
14164 a core file, this means that the core file must be opened with read-write
14165 privileges, using the command @samp{"set write on"} (@pxref{Patching}).
14166 Under these circumstances, you should make a backup copy of the core
14167 file before inspecting it with @value{GDBN}.
14168
14169 @node Ravenscar Profile
14170 @subsubsection Tasking Support when using the Ravenscar Profile
14171 @cindex Ravenscar Profile
14172
14173 The @dfn{Ravenscar Profile} is a subset of the Ada tasking features,
14174 specifically designed for systems with safety-critical real-time
14175 requirements.
14176
14177 @table @code
14178 @kindex set ravenscar task-switching on
14179 @cindex task switching with program using Ravenscar Profile
14180 @item set ravenscar task-switching on
14181 Allows task switching when debugging a program that uses the Ravenscar
14182 Profile. This is the default.
14183
14184 @kindex set ravenscar task-switching off
14185 @item set ravenscar task-switching off
14186 Turn off task switching when debugging a program that uses the Ravenscar
14187 Profile. This is mostly intended to disable the code that adds support
14188 for the Ravenscar Profile, in case a bug in either @value{GDBN} or in
14189 the Ravenscar runtime is preventing @value{GDBN} from working properly.
14190 To be effective, this command should be run before the program is started.
14191
14192 @kindex show ravenscar task-switching
14193 @item show ravenscar task-switching
14194 Show whether it is possible to switch from task to task in a program
14195 using the Ravenscar Profile.
14196
14197 @end table
14198
14199 @node Ada Glitches
14200 @subsubsection Known Peculiarities of Ada Mode
14201 @cindex Ada, problems
14202
14203 Besides the omissions listed previously (@pxref{Omissions from Ada}),
14204 we know of several problems with and limitations of Ada mode in
14205 @value{GDBN},
14206 some of which will be fixed with planned future releases of the debugger
14207 and the GNU Ada compiler.
14208
14209 @itemize @bullet
14210 @item
14211 Static constants that the compiler chooses not to materialize as objects in
14212 storage are invisible to the debugger.
14213
14214 @item
14215 Named parameter associations in function argument lists are ignored (the
14216 argument lists are treated as positional).
14217
14218 @item
14219 Many useful library packages are currently invisible to the debugger.
14220
14221 @item
14222 Fixed-point arithmetic, conversions, input, and output is carried out using
14223 floating-point arithmetic, and may give results that only approximate those on
14224 the host machine.
14225
14226 @item
14227 The GNAT compiler never generates the prefix @code{Standard} for any of
14228 the standard symbols defined by the Ada language. @value{GDBN} knows about
14229 this: it will strip the prefix from names when you use it, and will never
14230 look for a name you have so qualified among local symbols, nor match against
14231 symbols in other packages or subprograms. If you have
14232 defined entities anywhere in your program other than parameters and
14233 local variables whose simple names match names in @code{Standard},
14234 GNAT's lack of qualification here can cause confusion. When this happens,
14235 you can usually resolve the confusion
14236 by qualifying the problematic names with package
14237 @code{Standard} explicitly.
14238 @end itemize
14239
14240 Older versions of the compiler sometimes generate erroneous debugging
14241 information, resulting in the debugger incorrectly printing the value
14242 of affected entities. In some cases, the debugger is able to work
14243 around an issue automatically. In other cases, the debugger is able
14244 to work around the issue, but the work-around has to be specifically
14245 enabled.
14246
14247 @kindex set ada trust-PAD-over-XVS
14248 @kindex show ada trust-PAD-over-XVS
14249 @table @code
14250
14251 @item set ada trust-PAD-over-XVS on
14252 Configure GDB to strictly follow the GNAT encoding when computing the
14253 value of Ada entities, particularly when @code{PAD} and @code{PAD___XVS}
14254 types are involved (see @code{ada/exp_dbug.ads} in the GCC sources for
14255 a complete description of the encoding used by the GNAT compiler).
14256 This is the default.
14257
14258 @item set ada trust-PAD-over-XVS off
14259 This is related to the encoding using by the GNAT compiler. If @value{GDBN}
14260 sometimes prints the wrong value for certain entities, changing @code{ada
14261 trust-PAD-over-XVS} to @code{off} activates a work-around which may fix
14262 the issue. It is always safe to set @code{ada trust-PAD-over-XVS} to
14263 @code{off}, but this incurs a slight performance penalty, so it is
14264 recommended to leave this setting to @code{on} unless necessary.
14265
14266 @end table
14267
14268 @node Unsupported Languages
14269 @section Unsupported Languages
14270
14271 @cindex unsupported languages
14272 @cindex minimal language
14273 In addition to the other fully-supported programming languages,
14274 @value{GDBN} also provides a pseudo-language, called @code{minimal}.
14275 It does not represent a real programming language, but provides a set
14276 of capabilities close to what the C or assembly languages provide.
14277 This should allow most simple operations to be performed while debugging
14278 an application that uses a language currently not supported by @value{GDBN}.
14279
14280 If the language is set to @code{auto}, @value{GDBN} will automatically
14281 select this language if the current frame corresponds to an unsupported
14282 language.
14283
14284 @node Symbols
14285 @chapter Examining the Symbol Table
14286
14287 The commands described in this chapter allow you to inquire about the
14288 symbols (names of variables, functions and types) defined in your
14289 program. This information is inherent in the text of your program and
14290 does not change as your program executes. @value{GDBN} finds it in your
14291 program's symbol table, in the file indicated when you started @value{GDBN}
14292 (@pxref{File Options, ,Choosing Files}), or by one of the
14293 file-management commands (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}).
14294
14295 @cindex symbol names
14296 @cindex names of symbols
14297 @cindex quoting names
14298 Occasionally, you may need to refer to symbols that contain unusual
14299 characters, which @value{GDBN} ordinarily treats as word delimiters. The
14300 most frequent case is in referring to static variables in other
14301 source files (@pxref{Variables,,Program Variables}). File names
14302 are recorded in object files as debugging symbols, but @value{GDBN} would
14303 ordinarily parse a typical file name, like @file{foo.c}, as the three words
14304 @samp{foo} @samp{.} @samp{c}. To allow @value{GDBN} to recognize
14305 @samp{foo.c} as a single symbol, enclose it in single quotes; for example,
14306
14307 @smallexample
14308 p 'foo.c'::x
14309 @end smallexample
14310
14311 @noindent
14312 looks up the value of @code{x} in the scope of the file @file{foo.c}.
14313
14314 @table @code
14315 @cindex case-insensitive symbol names
14316 @cindex case sensitivity in symbol names
14317 @kindex set case-sensitive
14318 @item set case-sensitive on
14319 @itemx set case-sensitive off
14320 @itemx set case-sensitive auto
14321 Normally, when @value{GDBN} looks up symbols, it matches their names
14322 with case sensitivity determined by the current source language.
14323 Occasionally, you may wish to control that. The command @code{set
14324 case-sensitive} lets you do that by specifying @code{on} for
14325 case-sensitive matches or @code{off} for case-insensitive ones. If
14326 you specify @code{auto}, case sensitivity is reset to the default
14327 suitable for the source language. The default is case-sensitive
14328 matches for all languages except for Fortran, for which the default is
14329 case-insensitive matches.
14330
14331 @kindex show case-sensitive
14332 @item show case-sensitive
14333 This command shows the current setting of case sensitivity for symbols
14334 lookups.
14335
14336 @kindex info address
14337 @cindex address of a symbol
14338 @item info address @var{symbol}
14339 Describe where the data for @var{symbol} is stored. For a register
14340 variable, this says which register it is kept in. For a non-register
14341 local variable, this prints the stack-frame offset at which the variable
14342 is always stored.
14343
14344 Note the contrast with @samp{print &@var{symbol}}, which does not work
14345 at all for a register variable, and for a stack local variable prints
14346 the exact address of the current instantiation of the variable.
14347
14348 @kindex info symbol
14349 @cindex symbol from address
14350 @cindex closest symbol and offset for an address
14351 @item info symbol @var{addr}
14352 Print the name of a symbol which is stored at the address @var{addr}.
14353 If no symbol is stored exactly at @var{addr}, @value{GDBN} prints the
14354 nearest symbol and an offset from it:
14355
14356 @smallexample
14357 (@value{GDBP}) info symbol 0x54320
14358 _initialize_vx + 396 in section .text
14359 @end smallexample
14360
14361 @noindent
14362 This is the opposite of the @code{info address} command. You can use
14363 it to find out the name of a variable or a function given its address.
14364
14365 For dynamically linked executables, the name of executable or shared
14366 library containing the symbol is also printed:
14367
14368 @smallexample
14369 (@value{GDBP}) info symbol 0x400225
14370 _start + 5 in section .text of /tmp/a.out
14371 (@value{GDBP}) info symbol 0x2aaaac2811cf
14372 __read_nocancel + 6 in section .text of /usr/lib64/libc.so.6
14373 @end smallexample
14374
14375 @kindex whatis
14376 @item whatis [@var{arg}]
14377 Print the data type of @var{arg}, which can be either an expression
14378 or a name of a data type. With no argument, print the data type of
14379 @code{$}, the last value in the value history.
14380
14381 If @var{arg} is an expression (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}), it
14382 is not actually evaluated, and any side-effecting operations (such as
14383 assignments or function calls) inside it do not take place.
14384
14385 If @var{arg} is a variable or an expression, @code{whatis} prints its
14386 literal type as it is used in the source code. If the type was
14387 defined using a @code{typedef}, @code{whatis} will @emph{not} print
14388 the data type underlying the @code{typedef}. If the type of the
14389 variable or the expression is a compound data type, such as
14390 @code{struct} or @code{class}, @code{whatis} never prints their
14391 fields or methods. It just prints the @code{struct}/@code{class}
14392 name (a.k.a.@: its @dfn{tag}). If you want to see the members of
14393 such a compound data type, use @code{ptype}.
14394
14395 If @var{arg} is a type name that was defined using @code{typedef},
14396 @code{whatis} @dfn{unrolls} only one level of that @code{typedef}.
14397 Unrolling means that @code{whatis} will show the underlying type used
14398 in the @code{typedef} declaration of @var{arg}. However, if that
14399 underlying type is also a @code{typedef}, @code{whatis} will not
14400 unroll it.
14401
14402 For C code, the type names may also have the form @samp{class
14403 @var{class-name}}, @samp{struct @var{struct-tag}}, @samp{union
14404 @var{union-tag}} or @samp{enum @var{enum-tag}}.
14405
14406 @kindex ptype
14407 @item ptype [@var{arg}]
14408 @code{ptype} accepts the same arguments as @code{whatis}, but prints a
14409 detailed description of the type, instead of just the name of the type.
14410 @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
14411
14412 Contrary to @code{whatis}, @code{ptype} always unrolls any
14413 @code{typedef}s in its argument declaration, whether the argument is
14414 a variable, expression, or a data type. This means that @code{ptype}
14415 of a variable or an expression will not print literally its type as
14416 present in the source code---use @code{whatis} for that. @code{typedef}s at
14417 the pointer or reference targets are also unrolled. Only @code{typedef}s of
14418 fields, methods and inner @code{class typedef}s of @code{struct}s,
14419 @code{class}es and @code{union}s are not unrolled even with @code{ptype}.
14420
14421 For example, for this variable declaration:
14422
14423 @smallexample
14424 typedef double real_t;
14425 struct complex @{ real_t real; double imag; @};
14426 typedef struct complex complex_t;
14427 complex_t var;
14428 real_t *real_pointer_var;
14429 @end smallexample
14430
14431 @noindent
14432 the two commands give this output:
14433
14434 @smallexample
14435 @group
14436 (@value{GDBP}) whatis var
14437 type = complex_t
14438 (@value{GDBP}) ptype var
14439 type = struct complex @{
14440 real_t real;
14441 double imag;
14442 @}
14443 (@value{GDBP}) whatis complex_t
14444 type = struct complex
14445 (@value{GDBP}) whatis struct complex
14446 type = struct complex
14447 (@value{GDBP}) ptype struct complex
14448 type = struct complex @{
14449 real_t real;
14450 double imag;
14451 @}
14452 (@value{GDBP}) whatis real_pointer_var
14453 type = real_t *
14454 (@value{GDBP}) ptype real_pointer_var
14455 type = double *
14456 @end group
14457 @end smallexample
14458
14459 @noindent
14460 As with @code{whatis}, using @code{ptype} without an argument refers to
14461 the type of @code{$}, the last value in the value history.
14462
14463 @cindex incomplete type
14464 Sometimes, programs use opaque data types or incomplete specifications
14465 of complex data structure. If the debug information included in the
14466 program does not allow @value{GDBN} to display a full declaration of
14467 the data type, it will say @samp{<incomplete type>}. For example,
14468 given these declarations:
14469
14470 @smallexample
14471 struct foo;
14472 struct foo *fooptr;
14473 @end smallexample
14474
14475 @noindent
14476 but no definition for @code{struct foo} itself, @value{GDBN} will say:
14477
14478 @smallexample
14479 (@value{GDBP}) ptype foo
14480 $1 = <incomplete type>
14481 @end smallexample
14482
14483 @noindent
14484 ``Incomplete type'' is C terminology for data types that are not
14485 completely specified.
14486
14487 @kindex info types
14488 @item info types @var{regexp}
14489 @itemx info types
14490 Print a brief description of all types whose names match the regular
14491 expression @var{regexp} (or all types in your program, if you supply
14492 no argument). Each complete typename is matched as though it were a
14493 complete line; thus, @samp{i type value} gives information on all
14494 types in your program whose names include the string @code{value}, but
14495 @samp{i type ^value$} gives information only on types whose complete
14496 name is @code{value}.
14497
14498 This command differs from @code{ptype} in two ways: first, like
14499 @code{whatis}, it does not print a detailed description; second, it
14500 lists all source files where a type is defined.
14501
14502 @kindex info scope
14503 @cindex local variables
14504 @item info scope @var{location}
14505 List all the variables local to a particular scope. This command
14506 accepts a @var{location} argument---a function name, a source line, or
14507 an address preceded by a @samp{*}, and prints all the variables local
14508 to the scope defined by that location. (@xref{Specify Location}, for
14509 details about supported forms of @var{location}.) For example:
14510
14511 @smallexample
14512 (@value{GDBP}) @b{info scope command_line_handler}
14513 Scope for command_line_handler:
14514 Symbol rl is an argument at stack/frame offset 8, length 4.
14515 Symbol linebuffer is in static storage at address 0x150a18, length 4.
14516 Symbol linelength is in static storage at address 0x150a1c, length 4.
14517 Symbol p is a local variable in register $esi, length 4.
14518 Symbol p1 is a local variable in register $ebx, length 4.
14519 Symbol nline is a local variable in register $edx, length 4.
14520 Symbol repeat is a local variable at frame offset -8, length 4.
14521 @end smallexample
14522
14523 @noindent
14524 This command is especially useful for determining what data to collect
14525 during a @dfn{trace experiment}, see @ref{Tracepoint Actions,
14526 collect}.
14527
14528 @kindex info source
14529 @item info source
14530 Show information about the current source file---that is, the source file for
14531 the function containing the current point of execution:
14532 @itemize @bullet
14533 @item
14534 the name of the source file, and the directory containing it,
14535 @item
14536 the directory it was compiled in,
14537 @item
14538 its length, in lines,
14539 @item
14540 which programming language it is written in,
14541 @item
14542 whether the executable includes debugging information for that file, and
14543 if so, what format the information is in (e.g., STABS, Dwarf 2, etc.), and
14544 @item
14545 whether the debugging information includes information about
14546 preprocessor macros.
14547 @end itemize
14548
14549
14550 @kindex info sources
14551 @item info sources
14552 Print the names of all source files in your program for which there is
14553 debugging information, organized into two lists: files whose symbols
14554 have already been read, and files whose symbols will be read when needed.
14555
14556 @kindex info functions
14557 @item info functions
14558 Print the names and data types of all defined functions.
14559
14560 @item info functions @var{regexp}
14561 Print the names and data types of all defined functions
14562 whose names contain a match for regular expression @var{regexp}.
14563 Thus, @samp{info fun step} finds all functions whose names
14564 include @code{step}; @samp{info fun ^step} finds those whose names
14565 start with @code{step}. If a function name contains characters
14566 that conflict with the regular expression language (e.g.@:
14567 @samp{operator*()}), they may be quoted with a backslash.
14568
14569 @kindex info variables
14570 @item info variables
14571 Print the names and data types of all variables that are defined
14572 outside of functions (i.e.@: excluding local variables).
14573
14574 @item info variables @var{regexp}
14575 Print the names and data types of all variables (except for local
14576 variables) whose names contain a match for regular expression
14577 @var{regexp}.
14578
14579 @kindex info classes
14580 @cindex Objective-C, classes and selectors
14581 @item info classes
14582 @itemx info classes @var{regexp}
14583 Display all Objective-C classes in your program, or
14584 (with the @var{regexp} argument) all those matching a particular regular
14585 expression.
14586
14587 @kindex info selectors
14588 @item info selectors
14589 @itemx info selectors @var{regexp}
14590 Display all Objective-C selectors in your program, or
14591 (with the @var{regexp} argument) all those matching a particular regular
14592 expression.
14593
14594 @ignore
14595 This was never implemented.
14596 @kindex info methods
14597 @item info methods
14598 @itemx info methods @var{regexp}
14599 The @code{info methods} command permits the user to examine all defined
14600 methods within C@t{++} program, or (with the @var{regexp} argument) a
14601 specific set of methods found in the various C@t{++} classes. Many
14602 C@t{++} classes provide a large number of methods. Thus, the output
14603 from the @code{ptype} command can be overwhelming and hard to use. The
14604 @code{info-methods} command filters the methods, printing only those
14605 which match the regular-expression @var{regexp}.
14606 @end ignore
14607
14608 @cindex reloading symbols
14609 Some systems allow individual object files that make up your program to
14610 be replaced without stopping and restarting your program. For example,
14611 in VxWorks you can simply recompile a defective object file and keep on
14612 running. If you are running on one of these systems, you can allow
14613 @value{GDBN} to reload the symbols for automatically relinked modules:
14614
14615 @table @code
14616 @kindex set symbol-reloading
14617 @item set symbol-reloading on
14618 Replace symbol definitions for the corresponding source file when an
14619 object file with a particular name is seen again.
14620
14621 @item set symbol-reloading off
14622 Do not replace symbol definitions when encountering object files of the
14623 same name more than once. This is the default state; if you are not
14624 running on a system that permits automatic relinking of modules, you
14625 should leave @code{symbol-reloading} off, since otherwise @value{GDBN}
14626 may discard symbols when linking large programs, that may contain
14627 several modules (from different directories or libraries) with the same
14628 name.
14629
14630 @kindex show symbol-reloading
14631 @item show symbol-reloading
14632 Show the current @code{on} or @code{off} setting.
14633 @end table
14634
14635 @cindex opaque data types
14636 @kindex set opaque-type-resolution
14637 @item set opaque-type-resolution on
14638 Tell @value{GDBN} to resolve opaque types. An opaque type is a type
14639 declared as a pointer to a @code{struct}, @code{class}, or
14640 @code{union}---for example, @code{struct MyType *}---that is used in one
14641 source file although the full declaration of @code{struct MyType} is in
14642 another source file. The default is on.
14643
14644 A change in the setting of this subcommand will not take effect until
14645 the next time symbols for a file are loaded.
14646
14647 @item set opaque-type-resolution off
14648 Tell @value{GDBN} not to resolve opaque types. In this case, the type
14649 is printed as follows:
14650 @smallexample
14651 @{<no data fields>@}
14652 @end smallexample
14653
14654 @kindex show opaque-type-resolution
14655 @item show opaque-type-resolution
14656 Show whether opaque types are resolved or not.
14657
14658 @kindex maint print symbols
14659 @cindex symbol dump
14660 @kindex maint print psymbols
14661 @cindex partial symbol dump
14662 @item maint print symbols @var{filename}
14663 @itemx maint print psymbols @var{filename}
14664 @itemx maint print msymbols @var{filename}
14665 Write a dump of debugging symbol data into the file @var{filename}.
14666 These commands are used to debug the @value{GDBN} symbol-reading code. Only
14667 symbols with debugging data are included. If you use @samp{maint print
14668 symbols}, @value{GDBN} includes all the symbols for which it has already
14669 collected full details: that is, @var{filename} reflects symbols for
14670 only those files whose symbols @value{GDBN} has read. You can use the
14671 command @code{info sources} to find out which files these are. If you
14672 use @samp{maint print psymbols} instead, the dump shows information about
14673 symbols that @value{GDBN} only knows partially---that is, symbols defined in
14674 files that @value{GDBN} has skimmed, but not yet read completely. Finally,
14675 @samp{maint print msymbols} dumps just the minimal symbol information
14676 required for each object file from which @value{GDBN} has read some symbols.
14677 @xref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}, for a discussion of how
14678 @value{GDBN} reads symbols (in the description of @code{symbol-file}).
14679
14680 @kindex maint info symtabs
14681 @kindex maint info psymtabs
14682 @cindex listing @value{GDBN}'s internal symbol tables
14683 @cindex symbol tables, listing @value{GDBN}'s internal
14684 @cindex full symbol tables, listing @value{GDBN}'s internal
14685 @cindex partial symbol tables, listing @value{GDBN}'s internal
14686 @item maint info symtabs @r{[} @var{regexp} @r{]}
14687 @itemx maint info psymtabs @r{[} @var{regexp} @r{]}
14688
14689 List the @code{struct symtab} or @code{struct partial_symtab}
14690 structures whose names match @var{regexp}. If @var{regexp} is not
14691 given, list them all. The output includes expressions which you can
14692 copy into a @value{GDBN} debugging this one to examine a particular
14693 structure in more detail. For example:
14694
14695 @smallexample
14696 (@value{GDBP}) maint info psymtabs dwarf2read
14697 @{ objfile /home/gnu/build/gdb/gdb
14698 ((struct objfile *) 0x82e69d0)
14699 @{ psymtab /home/gnu/src/gdb/dwarf2read.c
14700 ((struct partial_symtab *) 0x8474b10)
14701 readin no
14702 fullname (null)
14703 text addresses 0x814d3c8 -- 0x8158074
14704 globals (* (struct partial_symbol **) 0x8507a08 @@ 9)
14705 statics (* (struct partial_symbol **) 0x40e95b78 @@ 2882)
14706 dependencies (none)
14707 @}
14708 @}
14709 (@value{GDBP}) maint info symtabs
14710 (@value{GDBP})
14711 @end smallexample
14712 @noindent
14713 We see that there is one partial symbol table whose filename contains
14714 the string @samp{dwarf2read}, belonging to the @samp{gdb} executable;
14715 and we see that @value{GDBN} has not read in any symtabs yet at all.
14716 If we set a breakpoint on a function, that will cause @value{GDBN} to
14717 read the symtab for the compilation unit containing that function:
14718
14719 @smallexample
14720 (@value{GDBP}) break dwarf2_psymtab_to_symtab
14721 Breakpoint 1 at 0x814e5da: file /home/gnu/src/gdb/dwarf2read.c,
14722 line 1574.
14723 (@value{GDBP}) maint info symtabs
14724 @{ objfile /home/gnu/build/gdb/gdb
14725 ((struct objfile *) 0x82e69d0)
14726 @{ symtab /home/gnu/src/gdb/dwarf2read.c
14727 ((struct symtab *) 0x86c1f38)
14728 dirname (null)
14729 fullname (null)
14730 blockvector ((struct blockvector *) 0x86c1bd0) (primary)
14731 linetable ((struct linetable *) 0x8370fa0)
14732 debugformat DWARF 2
14733 @}
14734 @}
14735 (@value{GDBP})
14736 @end smallexample
14737 @end table
14738
14739
14740 @node Altering
14741 @chapter Altering Execution
14742
14743 Once you think you have found an error in your program, you might want to
14744 find out for certain whether correcting the apparent error would lead to
14745 correct results in the rest of the run. You can find the answer by
14746 experiment, using the @value{GDBN} features for altering execution of the
14747 program.
14748
14749 For example, you can store new values into variables or memory
14750 locations, give your program a signal, restart it at a different
14751 address, or even return prematurely from a function.
14752
14753 @menu
14754 * Assignment:: Assignment to variables
14755 * Jumping:: Continuing at a different address
14756 * Signaling:: Giving your program a signal
14757 * Returning:: Returning from a function
14758 * Calling:: Calling your program's functions
14759 * Patching:: Patching your program
14760 @end menu
14761
14762 @node Assignment
14763 @section Assignment to Variables
14764
14765 @cindex assignment
14766 @cindex setting variables
14767 To alter the value of a variable, evaluate an assignment expression.
14768 @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}. For example,
14769
14770 @smallexample
14771 print x=4
14772 @end smallexample
14773
14774 @noindent
14775 stores the value 4 into the variable @code{x}, and then prints the
14776 value of the assignment expression (which is 4).
14777 @xref{Languages, ,Using @value{GDBN} with Different Languages}, for more
14778 information on operators in supported languages.
14779
14780 @kindex set variable
14781 @cindex variables, setting
14782 If you are not interested in seeing the value of the assignment, use the
14783 @code{set} command instead of the @code{print} command. @code{set} is
14784 really the same as @code{print} except that the expression's value is
14785 not printed and is not put in the value history (@pxref{Value History,
14786 ,Value History}). The expression is evaluated only for its effects.
14787
14788 If the beginning of the argument string of the @code{set} command
14789 appears identical to a @code{set} subcommand, use the @code{set
14790 variable} command instead of just @code{set}. This command is identical
14791 to @code{set} except for its lack of subcommands. For example, if your
14792 program has a variable @code{width}, you get an error if you try to set
14793 a new value with just @samp{set width=13}, because @value{GDBN} has the
14794 command @code{set width}:
14795
14796 @smallexample
14797 (@value{GDBP}) whatis width
14798 type = double
14799 (@value{GDBP}) p width
14800 $4 = 13
14801 (@value{GDBP}) set width=47
14802 Invalid syntax in expression.
14803 @end smallexample
14804
14805 @noindent
14806 The invalid expression, of course, is @samp{=47}. In
14807 order to actually set the program's variable @code{width}, use
14808
14809 @smallexample
14810 (@value{GDBP}) set var width=47
14811 @end smallexample
14812
14813 Because the @code{set} command has many subcommands that can conflict
14814 with the names of program variables, it is a good idea to use the
14815 @code{set variable} command instead of just @code{set}. For example, if
14816 your program has a variable @code{g}, you run into problems if you try
14817 to set a new value with just @samp{set g=4}, because @value{GDBN} has
14818 the command @code{set gnutarget}, abbreviated @code{set g}:
14819
14820 @smallexample
14821 @group
14822 (@value{GDBP}) whatis g
14823 type = double
14824 (@value{GDBP}) p g
14825 $1 = 1
14826 (@value{GDBP}) set g=4
14827 (@value{GDBP}) p g
14828 $2 = 1
14829 (@value{GDBP}) r
14830 The program being debugged has been started already.
14831 Start it from the beginning? (y or n) y
14832 Starting program: /home/smith/cc_progs/a.out
14833 "/home/smith/cc_progs/a.out": can't open to read symbols:
14834 Invalid bfd target.
14835 (@value{GDBP}) show g
14836 The current BFD target is "=4".
14837 @end group
14838 @end smallexample
14839
14840 @noindent
14841 The program variable @code{g} did not change, and you silently set the
14842 @code{gnutarget} to an invalid value. In order to set the variable
14843 @code{g}, use
14844
14845 @smallexample
14846 (@value{GDBP}) set var g=4
14847 @end smallexample
14848
14849 @value{GDBN} allows more implicit conversions in assignments than C; you can
14850 freely store an integer value into a pointer variable or vice versa,
14851 and you can convert any structure to any other structure that is the
14852 same length or shorter.
14853 @comment FIXME: how do structs align/pad in these conversions?
14854 @comment /doc@cygnus.com 18dec1990
14855
14856 To store values into arbitrary places in memory, use the @samp{@{@dots{}@}}
14857 construct to generate a value of specified type at a specified address
14858 (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). For example, @code{@{int@}0x83040} refers
14859 to memory location @code{0x83040} as an integer (which implies a certain size
14860 and representation in memory), and
14861
14862 @smallexample
14863 set @{int@}0x83040 = 4
14864 @end smallexample
14865
14866 @noindent
14867 stores the value 4 into that memory location.
14868
14869 @node Jumping
14870 @section Continuing at a Different Address
14871
14872 Ordinarily, when you continue your program, you do so at the place where
14873 it stopped, with the @code{continue} command. You can instead continue at
14874 an address of your own choosing, with the following commands:
14875
14876 @table @code
14877 @kindex jump
14878 @item jump @var{linespec}
14879 @itemx jump @var{location}
14880 Resume execution at line @var{linespec} or at address given by
14881 @var{location}. Execution stops again immediately if there is a
14882 breakpoint there. @xref{Specify Location}, for a description of the
14883 different forms of @var{linespec} and @var{location}. It is common
14884 practice to use the @code{tbreak} command in conjunction with
14885 @code{jump}. @xref{Set Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}.
14886
14887 The @code{jump} command does not change the current stack frame, or
14888 the stack pointer, or the contents of any memory location or any
14889 register other than the program counter. If line @var{linespec} is in
14890 a different function from the one currently executing, the results may
14891 be bizarre if the two functions expect different patterns of arguments or
14892 of local variables. For this reason, the @code{jump} command requests
14893 confirmation if the specified line is not in the function currently
14894 executing. However, even bizarre results are predictable if you are
14895 well acquainted with the machine-language code of your program.
14896 @end table
14897
14898 @c Doesn't work on HP-UX; have to set $pcoqh and $pcoqt.
14899 On many systems, you can get much the same effect as the @code{jump}
14900 command by storing a new value into the register @code{$pc}. The
14901 difference is that this does not start your program running; it only
14902 changes the address of where it @emph{will} run when you continue. For
14903 example,
14904
14905 @smallexample
14906 set $pc = 0x485
14907 @end smallexample
14908
14909 @noindent
14910 makes the next @code{continue} command or stepping command execute at
14911 address @code{0x485}, rather than at the address where your program stopped.
14912 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, ,Continuing and Stepping}.
14913
14914 The most common occasion to use the @code{jump} command is to back
14915 up---perhaps with more breakpoints set---over a portion of a program
14916 that has already executed, in order to examine its execution in more
14917 detail.
14918
14919 @c @group
14920 @node Signaling
14921 @section Giving your Program a Signal
14922 @cindex deliver a signal to a program
14923
14924 @table @code
14925 @kindex signal
14926 @item signal @var{signal}
14927 Resume execution where your program stopped, but immediately give it the
14928 signal @var{signal}. @var{signal} can be the name or the number of a
14929 signal. For example, on many systems @code{signal 2} and @code{signal
14930 SIGINT} are both ways of sending an interrupt signal.
14931
14932 Alternatively, if @var{signal} is zero, continue execution without
14933 giving a signal. This is useful when your program stopped on account of
14934 a signal and would ordinary see the signal when resumed with the
14935 @code{continue} command; @samp{signal 0} causes it to resume without a
14936 signal.
14937
14938 @code{signal} does not repeat when you press @key{RET} a second time
14939 after executing the command.
14940 @end table
14941 @c @end group
14942
14943 Invoking the @code{signal} command is not the same as invoking the
14944 @code{kill} utility from the shell. Sending a signal with @code{kill}
14945 causes @value{GDBN} to decide what to do with the signal depending on
14946 the signal handling tables (@pxref{Signals}). The @code{signal} command
14947 passes the signal directly to your program.
14948
14949
14950 @node Returning
14951 @section Returning from a Function
14952
14953 @table @code
14954 @cindex returning from a function
14955 @kindex return
14956 @item return
14957 @itemx return @var{expression}
14958 You can cancel execution of a function call with the @code{return}
14959 command. If you give an
14960 @var{expression} argument, its value is used as the function's return
14961 value.
14962 @end table
14963
14964 When you use @code{return}, @value{GDBN} discards the selected stack frame
14965 (and all frames within it). You can think of this as making the
14966 discarded frame return prematurely. If you wish to specify a value to
14967 be returned, give that value as the argument to @code{return}.
14968
14969 This pops the selected stack frame (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a
14970 Frame}), and any other frames inside of it, leaving its caller as the
14971 innermost remaining frame. That frame becomes selected. The
14972 specified value is stored in the registers used for returning values
14973 of functions.
14974
14975 The @code{return} command does not resume execution; it leaves the
14976 program stopped in the state that would exist if the function had just
14977 returned. In contrast, the @code{finish} command (@pxref{Continuing
14978 and Stepping, ,Continuing and Stepping}) resumes execution until the
14979 selected stack frame returns naturally.
14980
14981 @value{GDBN} needs to know how the @var{expression} argument should be set for
14982 the inferior. The concrete registers assignment depends on the OS ABI and the
14983 type being returned by the selected stack frame. For example it is common for
14984 OS ABI to return floating point values in FPU registers while integer values in
14985 CPU registers. Still some ABIs return even floating point values in CPU
14986 registers. Larger integer widths (such as @code{long long int}) also have
14987 specific placement rules. @value{GDBN} already knows the OS ABI from its
14988 current target so it needs to find out also the type being returned to make the
14989 assignment into the right register(s).
14990
14991 Normally, the selected stack frame has debug info. @value{GDBN} will always
14992 use the debug info instead of the implicit type of @var{expression} when the
14993 debug info is available. For example, if you type @kbd{return -1}, and the
14994 function in the current stack frame is declared to return a @code{long long
14995 int}, @value{GDBN} transparently converts the implicit @code{int} value of -1
14996 into a @code{long long int}:
14997
14998 @smallexample
14999 Breakpoint 1, func () at gdb.base/return-nodebug.c:29
15000 29 return 31;
15001 (@value{GDBP}) return -1
15002 Make func return now? (y or n) y
15003 #0 0x004004f6 in main () at gdb.base/return-nodebug.c:43
15004 43 printf ("result=%lld\n", func ());
15005 (@value{GDBP})
15006 @end smallexample
15007
15008 However, if the selected stack frame does not have a debug info, e.g., if the
15009 function was compiled without debug info, @value{GDBN} has to find out the type
15010 to return from user. Specifying a different type by mistake may set the value
15011 in different inferior registers than the caller code expects. For example,
15012 typing @kbd{return -1} with its implicit type @code{int} would set only a part
15013 of a @code{long long int} result for a debug info less function (on 32-bit
15014 architectures). Therefore the user is required to specify the return type by
15015 an appropriate cast explicitly:
15016
15017 @smallexample
15018 Breakpoint 2, 0x0040050b in func ()
15019 (@value{GDBP}) return -1
15020 Return value type not available for selected stack frame.
15021 Please use an explicit cast of the value to return.
15022 (@value{GDBP}) return (long long int) -1
15023 Make selected stack frame return now? (y or n) y
15024 #0 0x00400526 in main ()
15025 (@value{GDBP})
15026 @end smallexample
15027
15028 @node Calling
15029 @section Calling Program Functions
15030
15031 @table @code
15032 @cindex calling functions
15033 @cindex inferior functions, calling
15034 @item print @var{expr}
15035 Evaluate the expression @var{expr} and display the resulting value.
15036 @var{expr} may include calls to functions in the program being
15037 debugged.
15038
15039 @kindex call
15040 @item call @var{expr}
15041 Evaluate the expression @var{expr} without displaying @code{void}
15042 returned values.
15043
15044 You can use this variant of the @code{print} command if you want to
15045 execute a function from your program that does not return anything
15046 (a.k.a.@: @dfn{a void function}), but without cluttering the output
15047 with @code{void} returned values that @value{GDBN} will otherwise
15048 print. If the result is not void, it is printed and saved in the
15049 value history.
15050 @end table
15051
15052 It is possible for the function you call via the @code{print} or
15053 @code{call} command to generate a signal (e.g., if there's a bug in
15054 the function, or if you passed it incorrect arguments). What happens
15055 in that case is controlled by the @code{set unwindonsignal} command.
15056
15057 Similarly, with a C@t{++} program it is possible for the function you
15058 call via the @code{print} or @code{call} command to generate an
15059 exception that is not handled due to the constraints of the dummy
15060 frame. In this case, any exception that is raised in the frame, but has
15061 an out-of-frame exception handler will not be found. GDB builds a
15062 dummy-frame for the inferior function call, and the unwinder cannot
15063 seek for exception handlers outside of this dummy-frame. What happens
15064 in that case is controlled by the
15065 @code{set unwind-on-terminating-exception} command.
15066
15067 @table @code
15068 @item set unwindonsignal
15069 @kindex set unwindonsignal
15070 @cindex unwind stack in called functions
15071 @cindex call dummy stack unwinding
15072 Set unwinding of the stack if a signal is received while in a function
15073 that @value{GDBN} called in the program being debugged. If set to on,
15074 @value{GDBN} unwinds the stack it created for the call and restores
15075 the context to what it was before the call. If set to off (the
15076 default), @value{GDBN} stops in the frame where the signal was
15077 received.
15078
15079 @item show unwindonsignal
15080 @kindex show unwindonsignal
15081 Show the current setting of stack unwinding in the functions called by
15082 @value{GDBN}.
15083
15084 @item set unwind-on-terminating-exception
15085 @kindex set unwind-on-terminating-exception
15086 @cindex unwind stack in called functions with unhandled exceptions
15087 @cindex call dummy stack unwinding on unhandled exception.
15088 Set unwinding of the stack if a C@t{++} exception is raised, but left
15089 unhandled while in a function that @value{GDBN} called in the program being
15090 debugged. If set to on (the default), @value{GDBN} unwinds the stack
15091 it created for the call and restores the context to what it was before
15092 the call. If set to off, @value{GDBN} the exception is delivered to
15093 the default C@t{++} exception handler and the inferior terminated.
15094
15095 @item show unwind-on-terminating-exception
15096 @kindex show unwind-on-terminating-exception
15097 Show the current setting of stack unwinding in the functions called by
15098 @value{GDBN}.
15099
15100 @end table
15101
15102 @cindex weak alias functions
15103 Sometimes, a function you wish to call is actually a @dfn{weak alias}
15104 for another function. In such case, @value{GDBN} might not pick up
15105 the type information, including the types of the function arguments,
15106 which causes @value{GDBN} to call the inferior function incorrectly.
15107 As a result, the called function will function erroneously and may
15108 even crash. A solution to that is to use the name of the aliased
15109 function instead.
15110
15111 @node Patching
15112 @section Patching Programs
15113
15114 @cindex patching binaries
15115 @cindex writing into executables
15116 @cindex writing into corefiles
15117
15118 By default, @value{GDBN} opens the file containing your program's
15119 executable code (or the corefile) read-only. This prevents accidental
15120 alterations to machine code; but it also prevents you from intentionally
15121 patching your program's binary.
15122
15123 If you'd like to be able to patch the binary, you can specify that
15124 explicitly with the @code{set write} command. For example, you might
15125 want to turn on internal debugging flags, or even to make emergency
15126 repairs.
15127
15128 @table @code
15129 @kindex set write
15130 @item set write on
15131 @itemx set write off
15132 If you specify @samp{set write on}, @value{GDBN} opens executable and
15133 core files for both reading and writing; if you specify @kbd{set write
15134 off} (the default), @value{GDBN} opens them read-only.
15135
15136 If you have already loaded a file, you must load it again (using the
15137 @code{exec-file} or @code{core-file} command) after changing @code{set
15138 write}, for your new setting to take effect.
15139
15140 @item show write
15141 @kindex show write
15142 Display whether executable files and core files are opened for writing
15143 as well as reading.
15144 @end table
15145
15146 @node GDB Files
15147 @chapter @value{GDBN} Files
15148
15149 @value{GDBN} needs to know the file name of the program to be debugged,
15150 both in order to read its symbol table and in order to start your
15151 program. To debug a core dump of a previous run, you must also tell
15152 @value{GDBN} the name of the core dump file.
15153
15154 @menu
15155 * Files:: Commands to specify files
15156 * Separate Debug Files:: Debugging information in separate files
15157 * Index Files:: Index files speed up GDB
15158 * Symbol Errors:: Errors reading symbol files
15159 * Data Files:: GDB data files
15160 @end menu
15161
15162 @node Files
15163 @section Commands to Specify Files
15164
15165 @cindex symbol table
15166 @cindex core dump file
15167
15168 You may want to specify executable and core dump file names. The usual
15169 way to do this is at start-up time, using the arguments to
15170 @value{GDBN}'s start-up commands (@pxref{Invocation, , Getting In and
15171 Out of @value{GDBN}}).
15172
15173 Occasionally it is necessary to change to a different file during a
15174 @value{GDBN} session. Or you may run @value{GDBN} and forget to
15175 specify a file you want to use. Or you are debugging a remote target
15176 via @code{gdbserver} (@pxref{Server, file, Using the @code{gdbserver}
15177 Program}). In these situations the @value{GDBN} commands to specify
15178 new files are useful.
15179
15180 @table @code
15181 @cindex executable file
15182 @kindex file
15183 @item file @var{filename}
15184 Use @var{filename} as the program to be debugged. It is read for its
15185 symbols and for the contents of pure memory. It is also the program
15186 executed when you use the @code{run} command. If you do not specify a
15187 directory and the file is not found in the @value{GDBN} working directory,
15188 @value{GDBN} uses the environment variable @code{PATH} as a list of
15189 directories to search, just as the shell does when looking for a program
15190 to run. You can change the value of this variable, for both @value{GDBN}
15191 and your program, using the @code{path} command.
15192
15193 @cindex unlinked object files
15194 @cindex patching object files
15195 You can load unlinked object @file{.o} files into @value{GDBN} using
15196 the @code{file} command. You will not be able to ``run'' an object
15197 file, but you can disassemble functions and inspect variables. Also,
15198 if the underlying BFD functionality supports it, you could use
15199 @kbd{gdb -write} to patch object files using this technique. Note
15200 that @value{GDBN} can neither interpret nor modify relocations in this
15201 case, so branches and some initialized variables will appear to go to
15202 the wrong place. But this feature is still handy from time to time.
15203
15204 @item file
15205 @code{file} with no argument makes @value{GDBN} discard any information it
15206 has on both executable file and the symbol table.
15207
15208 @kindex exec-file
15209 @item exec-file @r{[} @var{filename} @r{]}
15210 Specify that the program to be run (but not the symbol table) is found
15211 in @var{filename}. @value{GDBN} searches the environment variable @code{PATH}
15212 if necessary to locate your program. Omitting @var{filename} means to
15213 discard information on the executable file.
15214
15215 @kindex symbol-file
15216 @item symbol-file @r{[} @var{filename} @r{]}
15217 Read symbol table information from file @var{filename}. @code{PATH} is
15218 searched when necessary. Use the @code{file} command to get both symbol
15219 table and program to run from the same file.
15220
15221 @code{symbol-file} with no argument clears out @value{GDBN} information on your
15222 program's symbol table.
15223
15224 The @code{symbol-file} command causes @value{GDBN} to forget the contents of
15225 some breakpoints and auto-display expressions. This is because they may
15226 contain pointers to the internal data recording symbols and data types,
15227 which are part of the old symbol table data being discarded inside
15228 @value{GDBN}.
15229
15230 @code{symbol-file} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after
15231 executing it once.
15232
15233 When @value{GDBN} is configured for a particular environment, it
15234 understands debugging information in whatever format is the standard
15235 generated for that environment; you may use either a @sc{gnu} compiler, or
15236 other compilers that adhere to the local conventions.
15237 Best results are usually obtained from @sc{gnu} compilers; for example,
15238 using @code{@value{NGCC}} you can generate debugging information for
15239 optimized code.
15240
15241 For most kinds of object files, with the exception of old SVR3 systems
15242 using COFF, the @code{symbol-file} command does not normally read the
15243 symbol table in full right away. Instead, it scans the symbol table
15244 quickly to find which source files and which symbols are present. The
15245 details are read later, one source file at a time, as they are needed.
15246
15247 The purpose of this two-stage reading strategy is to make @value{GDBN}
15248 start up faster. For the most part, it is invisible except for
15249 occasional pauses while the symbol table details for a particular source
15250 file are being read. (The @code{set verbose} command can turn these
15251 pauses into messages if desired. @xref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional
15252 Warnings and Messages}.)
15253
15254 We have not implemented the two-stage strategy for COFF yet. When the
15255 symbol table is stored in COFF format, @code{symbol-file} reads the
15256 symbol table data in full right away. Note that ``stabs-in-COFF''
15257 still does the two-stage strategy, since the debug info is actually
15258 in stabs format.
15259
15260 @kindex readnow
15261 @cindex reading symbols immediately
15262 @cindex symbols, reading immediately
15263 @item symbol-file @r{[} -readnow @r{]} @var{filename}
15264 @itemx file @r{[} -readnow @r{]} @var{filename}
15265 You can override the @value{GDBN} two-stage strategy for reading symbol
15266 tables by using the @samp{-readnow} option with any of the commands that
15267 load symbol table information, if you want to be sure @value{GDBN} has the
15268 entire symbol table available.
15269
15270 @c FIXME: for now no mention of directories, since this seems to be in
15271 @c flux. 13mar1992 status is that in theory GDB would look either in
15272 @c current dir or in same dir as myprog; but issues like competing
15273 @c GDB's, or clutter in system dirs, mean that in practice right now
15274 @c only current dir is used. FFish says maybe a special GDB hierarchy
15275 @c (eg rooted in val of env var GDBSYMS) could exist for mappable symbol
15276 @c files.
15277
15278 @kindex core-file
15279 @item core-file @r{[}@var{filename}@r{]}
15280 @itemx core
15281 Specify the whereabouts of a core dump file to be used as the ``contents
15282 of memory''. Traditionally, core files contain only some parts of the
15283 address space of the process that generated them; @value{GDBN} can access the
15284 executable file itself for other parts.
15285
15286 @code{core-file} with no argument specifies that no core file is
15287 to be used.
15288
15289 Note that the core file is ignored when your program is actually running
15290 under @value{GDBN}. So, if you have been running your program and you
15291 wish to debug a core file instead, you must kill the subprocess in which
15292 the program is running. To do this, use the @code{kill} command
15293 (@pxref{Kill Process, ,Killing the Child Process}).
15294
15295 @kindex add-symbol-file
15296 @cindex dynamic linking
15297 @item add-symbol-file @var{filename} @var{address}
15298 @itemx add-symbol-file @var{filename} @var{address} @r{[} -readnow @r{]}
15299 @itemx add-symbol-file @var{filename} @var{address} -s @var{section} @var{address} @dots{}
15300 The @code{add-symbol-file} command reads additional symbol table
15301 information from the file @var{filename}. You would use this command
15302 when @var{filename} has been dynamically loaded (by some other means)
15303 into the program that is running. @var{address} should be the memory
15304 address at which the file has been loaded; @value{GDBN} cannot figure
15305 this out for itself. You can additionally specify an arbitrary number
15306 of @samp{-s @var{section} @var{address}} pairs, to give an explicit
15307 section name and base address for that section. You can specify any
15308 @var{address} as an expression.
15309
15310 The symbol table of the file @var{filename} is added to the symbol table
15311 originally read with the @code{symbol-file} command. You can use the
15312 @code{add-symbol-file} command any number of times; the new symbol data
15313 thus read keeps adding to the old. To discard all old symbol data
15314 instead, use the @code{symbol-file} command without any arguments.
15315
15316 @cindex relocatable object files, reading symbols from
15317 @cindex object files, relocatable, reading symbols from
15318 @cindex reading symbols from relocatable object files
15319 @cindex symbols, reading from relocatable object files
15320 @cindex @file{.o} files, reading symbols from
15321 Although @var{filename} is typically a shared library file, an
15322 executable file, or some other object file which has been fully
15323 relocated for loading into a process, you can also load symbolic
15324 information from relocatable @file{.o} files, as long as:
15325
15326 @itemize @bullet
15327 @item
15328 the file's symbolic information refers only to linker symbols defined in
15329 that file, not to symbols defined by other object files,
15330 @item
15331 every section the file's symbolic information refers to has actually
15332 been loaded into the inferior, as it appears in the file, and
15333 @item
15334 you can determine the address at which every section was loaded, and
15335 provide these to the @code{add-symbol-file} command.
15336 @end itemize
15337
15338 @noindent
15339 Some embedded operating systems, like Sun Chorus and VxWorks, can load
15340 relocatable files into an already running program; such systems
15341 typically make the requirements above easy to meet. However, it's
15342 important to recognize that many native systems use complex link
15343 procedures (@code{.linkonce} section factoring and C@t{++} constructor table
15344 assembly, for example) that make the requirements difficult to meet. In
15345 general, one cannot assume that using @code{add-symbol-file} to read a
15346 relocatable object file's symbolic information will have the same effect
15347 as linking the relocatable object file into the program in the normal
15348 way.
15349
15350 @code{add-symbol-file} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} after using it.
15351
15352 @kindex add-symbol-file-from-memory
15353 @cindex @code{syscall DSO}
15354 @cindex load symbols from memory
15355 @item add-symbol-file-from-memory @var{address}
15356 Load symbols from the given @var{address} in a dynamically loaded
15357 object file whose image is mapped directly into the inferior's memory.
15358 For example, the Linux kernel maps a @code{syscall DSO} into each
15359 process's address space; this DSO provides kernel-specific code for
15360 some system calls. The argument can be any expression whose
15361 evaluation yields the address of the file's shared object file header.
15362 For this command to work, you must have used @code{symbol-file} or
15363 @code{exec-file} commands in advance.
15364
15365 @kindex add-shared-symbol-files
15366 @kindex assf
15367 @item add-shared-symbol-files @var{library-file}
15368 @itemx assf @var{library-file}
15369 The @code{add-shared-symbol-files} command can currently be used only
15370 in the Cygwin build of @value{GDBN} on MS-Windows OS, where it is an
15371 alias for the @code{dll-symbols} command (@pxref{Cygwin Native}).
15372 @value{GDBN} automatically looks for shared libraries, however if
15373 @value{GDBN} does not find yours, you can invoke
15374 @code{add-shared-symbol-files}. It takes one argument: the shared
15375 library's file name. @code{assf} is a shorthand alias for
15376 @code{add-shared-symbol-files}.
15377
15378 @kindex section
15379 @item section @var{section} @var{addr}
15380 The @code{section} command changes the base address of the named
15381 @var{section} of the exec file to @var{addr}. This can be used if the
15382 exec file does not contain section addresses, (such as in the
15383 @code{a.out} format), or when the addresses specified in the file
15384 itself are wrong. Each section must be changed separately. The
15385 @code{info files} command, described below, lists all the sections and
15386 their addresses.
15387
15388 @kindex info files
15389 @kindex info target
15390 @item info files
15391 @itemx info target
15392 @code{info files} and @code{info target} are synonymous; both print the
15393 current target (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}),
15394 including the names of the executable and core dump files currently in
15395 use by @value{GDBN}, and the files from which symbols were loaded. The
15396 command @code{help target} lists all possible targets rather than
15397 current ones.
15398
15399 @kindex maint info sections
15400 @item maint info sections
15401 Another command that can give you extra information about program sections
15402 is @code{maint info sections}. In addition to the section information
15403 displayed by @code{info files}, this command displays the flags and file
15404 offset of each section in the executable and core dump files. In addition,
15405 @code{maint info sections} provides the following command options (which
15406 may be arbitrarily combined):
15407
15408 @table @code
15409 @item ALLOBJ
15410 Display sections for all loaded object files, including shared libraries.
15411 @item @var{sections}
15412 Display info only for named @var{sections}.
15413 @item @var{section-flags}
15414 Display info only for sections for which @var{section-flags} are true.
15415 The section flags that @value{GDBN} currently knows about are:
15416 @table @code
15417 @item ALLOC
15418 Section will have space allocated in the process when loaded.
15419 Set for all sections except those containing debug information.
15420 @item LOAD
15421 Section will be loaded from the file into the child process memory.
15422 Set for pre-initialized code and data, clear for @code{.bss} sections.
15423 @item RELOC
15424 Section needs to be relocated before loading.
15425 @item READONLY
15426 Section cannot be modified by the child process.
15427 @item CODE
15428 Section contains executable code only.
15429 @item DATA
15430 Section contains data only (no executable code).
15431 @item ROM
15432 Section will reside in ROM.
15433 @item CONSTRUCTOR
15434 Section contains data for constructor/destructor lists.
15435 @item HAS_CONTENTS
15436 Section is not empty.
15437 @item NEVER_LOAD
15438 An instruction to the linker to not output the section.
15439 @item COFF_SHARED_LIBRARY
15440 A notification to the linker that the section contains
15441 COFF shared library information.
15442 @item IS_COMMON
15443 Section contains common symbols.
15444 @end table
15445 @end table
15446 @kindex set trust-readonly-sections
15447 @cindex read-only sections
15448 @item set trust-readonly-sections on
15449 Tell @value{GDBN} that readonly sections in your object file
15450 really are read-only (i.e.@: that their contents will not change).
15451 In that case, @value{GDBN} can fetch values from these sections
15452 out of the object file, rather than from the target program.
15453 For some targets (notably embedded ones), this can be a significant
15454 enhancement to debugging performance.
15455
15456 The default is off.
15457
15458 @item set trust-readonly-sections off
15459 Tell @value{GDBN} not to trust readonly sections. This means that
15460 the contents of the section might change while the program is running,
15461 and must therefore be fetched from the target when needed.
15462
15463 @item show trust-readonly-sections
15464 Show the current setting of trusting readonly sections.
15465 @end table
15466
15467 All file-specifying commands allow both absolute and relative file names
15468 as arguments. @value{GDBN} always converts the file name to an absolute file
15469 name and remembers it that way.
15470
15471 @cindex shared libraries
15472 @anchor{Shared Libraries}
15473 @value{GDBN} supports @sc{gnu}/Linux, MS-Windows, HP-UX, SunOS, SVr4, Irix,
15474 and IBM RS/6000 AIX shared libraries.
15475
15476 On MS-Windows @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support
15477 shared libraries. @xref{Expat}.
15478
15479 @value{GDBN} automatically loads symbol definitions from shared libraries
15480 when you use the @code{run} command, or when you examine a core file.
15481 (Before you issue the @code{run} command, @value{GDBN} does not understand
15482 references to a function in a shared library, however---unless you are
15483 debugging a core file).
15484
15485 On HP-UX, if the program loads a library explicitly, @value{GDBN}
15486 automatically loads the symbols at the time of the @code{shl_load} call.
15487
15488 @c FIXME: some @value{GDBN} release may permit some refs to undef
15489 @c FIXME...symbols---eg in a break cmd---assuming they are from a shared
15490 @c FIXME...lib; check this from time to time when updating manual
15491
15492 There are times, however, when you may wish to not automatically load
15493 symbol definitions from shared libraries, such as when they are
15494 particularly large or there are many of them.
15495
15496 To control the automatic loading of shared library symbols, use the
15497 commands:
15498
15499 @table @code
15500 @kindex set auto-solib-add
15501 @item set auto-solib-add @var{mode}
15502 If @var{mode} is @code{on}, symbols from all shared object libraries
15503 will be loaded automatically when the inferior begins execution, you
15504 attach to an independently started inferior, or when the dynamic linker
15505 informs @value{GDBN} that a new library has been loaded. If @var{mode}
15506 is @code{off}, symbols must be loaded manually, using the
15507 @code{sharedlibrary} command. The default value is @code{on}.
15508
15509 @cindex memory used for symbol tables
15510 If your program uses lots of shared libraries with debug info that
15511 takes large amounts of memory, you can decrease the @value{GDBN}
15512 memory footprint by preventing it from automatically loading the
15513 symbols from shared libraries. To that end, type @kbd{set
15514 auto-solib-add off} before running the inferior, then load each
15515 library whose debug symbols you do need with @kbd{sharedlibrary
15516 @var{regexp}}, where @var{regexp} is a regular expression that matches
15517 the libraries whose symbols you want to be loaded.
15518
15519 @kindex show auto-solib-add
15520 @item show auto-solib-add
15521 Display the current autoloading mode.
15522 @end table
15523
15524 @cindex load shared library
15525 To explicitly load shared library symbols, use the @code{sharedlibrary}
15526 command:
15527
15528 @table @code
15529 @kindex info sharedlibrary
15530 @kindex info share
15531 @item info share @var{regex}
15532 @itemx info sharedlibrary @var{regex}
15533 Print the names of the shared libraries which are currently loaded
15534 that match @var{regex}. If @var{regex} is omitted then print
15535 all shared libraries that are loaded.
15536
15537 @kindex sharedlibrary
15538 @kindex share
15539 @item sharedlibrary @var{regex}
15540 @itemx share @var{regex}
15541 Load shared object library symbols for files matching a
15542 Unix regular expression.
15543 As with files loaded automatically, it only loads shared libraries
15544 required by your program for a core file or after typing @code{run}. If
15545 @var{regex} is omitted all shared libraries required by your program are
15546 loaded.
15547
15548 @item nosharedlibrary
15549 @kindex nosharedlibrary
15550 @cindex unload symbols from shared libraries
15551 Unload all shared object library symbols. This discards all symbols
15552 that have been loaded from all shared libraries. Symbols from shared
15553 libraries that were loaded by explicit user requests are not
15554 discarded.
15555 @end table
15556
15557 Sometimes you may wish that @value{GDBN} stops and gives you control
15558 when any of shared library events happen. Use the @code{set
15559 stop-on-solib-events} command for this:
15560
15561 @table @code
15562 @item set stop-on-solib-events
15563 @kindex set stop-on-solib-events
15564 This command controls whether @value{GDBN} should give you control
15565 when the dynamic linker notifies it about some shared library event.
15566 The most common event of interest is loading or unloading of a new
15567 shared library.
15568
15569 @item show stop-on-solib-events
15570 @kindex show stop-on-solib-events
15571 Show whether @value{GDBN} stops and gives you control when shared
15572 library events happen.
15573 @end table
15574
15575 Shared libraries are also supported in many cross or remote debugging
15576 configurations. @value{GDBN} needs to have access to the target's libraries;
15577 this can be accomplished either by providing copies of the libraries
15578 on the host system, or by asking @value{GDBN} to automatically retrieve the
15579 libraries from the target. If copies of the target libraries are
15580 provided, they need to be the same as the target libraries, although the
15581 copies on the target can be stripped as long as the copies on the host are
15582 not.
15583
15584 @cindex where to look for shared libraries
15585 For remote debugging, you need to tell @value{GDBN} where the target
15586 libraries are, so that it can load the correct copies---otherwise, it
15587 may try to load the host's libraries. @value{GDBN} has two variables
15588 to specify the search directories for target libraries.
15589
15590 @table @code
15591 @cindex prefix for shared library file names
15592 @cindex system root, alternate
15593 @kindex set solib-absolute-prefix
15594 @kindex set sysroot
15595 @item set sysroot @var{path}
15596 Use @var{path} as the system root for the program being debugged. Any
15597 absolute shared library paths will be prefixed with @var{path}; many
15598 runtime loaders store the absolute paths to the shared library in the
15599 target program's memory. If you use @code{set sysroot} to find shared
15600 libraries, they need to be laid out in the same way that they are on
15601 the target, with e.g.@: a @file{/lib} and @file{/usr/lib} hierarchy
15602 under @var{path}.
15603
15604 If @var{path} starts with the sequence @file{remote:}, @value{GDBN} will
15605 retrieve the target libraries from the remote system. This is only
15606 supported when using a remote target that supports the @code{remote get}
15607 command (@pxref{File Transfer,,Sending files to a remote system}).
15608 The part of @var{path} following the initial @file{remote:}
15609 (if present) is used as system root prefix on the remote file system.
15610 @footnote{If you want to specify a local system root using a directory
15611 that happens to be named @file{remote:}, you need to use some equivalent
15612 variant of the name like @file{./remote:}.}
15613
15614 For targets with an MS-DOS based filesystem, such as MS-Windows and
15615 SymbianOS, @value{GDBN} tries prefixing a few variants of the target
15616 absolute file name with @var{path}. But first, on Unix hosts,
15617 @value{GDBN} converts all backslash directory separators into forward
15618 slashes, because the backslash is not a directory separator on Unix:
15619
15620 @smallexample
15621 c:\foo\bar.dll @result{} c:/foo/bar.dll
15622 @end smallexample
15623
15624 Then, @value{GDBN} attempts prefixing the target file name with
15625 @var{path}, and looks for the resulting file name in the host file
15626 system:
15627
15628 @smallexample
15629 c:/foo/bar.dll @result{} /path/to/sysroot/c:/foo/bar.dll
15630 @end smallexample
15631
15632 If that does not find the shared library, @value{GDBN} tries removing
15633 the @samp{:} character from the drive spec, both for convenience, and,
15634 for the case of the host file system not supporting file names with
15635 colons:
15636
15637 @smallexample
15638 c:/foo/bar.dll @result{} /path/to/sysroot/c/foo/bar.dll
15639 @end smallexample
15640
15641 This makes it possible to have a system root that mirrors a target
15642 with more than one drive. E.g., you may want to setup your local
15643 copies of the target system shared libraries like so (note @samp{c} vs
15644 @samp{z}):
15645
15646 @smallexample
15647 @file{/path/to/sysroot/c/sys/bin/foo.dll}
15648 @file{/path/to/sysroot/c/sys/bin/bar.dll}
15649 @file{/path/to/sysroot/z/sys/bin/bar.dll}
15650 @end smallexample
15651
15652 @noindent
15653 and point the system root at @file{/path/to/sysroot}, so that
15654 @value{GDBN} can find the correct copies of both
15655 @file{c:\sys\bin\foo.dll}, and @file{z:\sys\bin\bar.dll}.
15656
15657 If that still does not find the shared library, @value{GDBN} tries
15658 removing the whole drive spec from the target file name:
15659
15660 @smallexample
15661 c:/foo/bar.dll @result{} /path/to/sysroot/foo/bar.dll
15662 @end smallexample
15663
15664 This last lookup makes it possible to not care about the drive name,
15665 if you don't want or need to.
15666
15667 The @code{set solib-absolute-prefix} command is an alias for @code{set
15668 sysroot}.
15669
15670 @cindex default system root
15671 @cindex @samp{--with-sysroot}
15672 You can set the default system root by using the configure-time
15673 @samp{--with-sysroot} option. If the system root is inside
15674 @value{GDBN}'s configured binary prefix (set with @samp{--prefix} or
15675 @samp{--exec-prefix}), then the default system root will be updated
15676 automatically if the installed @value{GDBN} is moved to a new
15677 location.
15678
15679 @kindex show sysroot
15680 @item show sysroot
15681 Display the current shared library prefix.
15682
15683 @kindex set solib-search-path
15684 @item set solib-search-path @var{path}
15685 If this variable is set, @var{path} is a colon-separated list of
15686 directories to search for shared libraries. @samp{solib-search-path}
15687 is used after @samp{sysroot} fails to locate the library, or if the
15688 path to the library is relative instead of absolute. If you want to
15689 use @samp{solib-search-path} instead of @samp{sysroot}, be sure to set
15690 @samp{sysroot} to a nonexistent directory to prevent @value{GDBN} from
15691 finding your host's libraries. @samp{sysroot} is preferred; setting
15692 it to a nonexistent directory may interfere with automatic loading
15693 of shared library symbols.
15694
15695 @kindex show solib-search-path
15696 @item show solib-search-path
15697 Display the current shared library search path.
15698
15699 @cindex DOS file-name semantics of file names.
15700 @kindex set target-file-system-kind (unix|dos-based|auto)
15701 @kindex show target-file-system-kind
15702 @item set target-file-system-kind @var{kind}
15703 Set assumed file system kind for target reported file names.
15704
15705 Shared library file names as reported by the target system may not
15706 make sense as is on the system @value{GDBN} is running on. For
15707 example, when remote debugging a target that has MS-DOS based file
15708 system semantics, from a Unix host, the target may be reporting to
15709 @value{GDBN} a list of loaded shared libraries with file names such as
15710 @file{c:\Windows\kernel32.dll}. On Unix hosts, there's no concept of
15711 drive letters, so the @samp{c:\} prefix is not normally understood as
15712 indicating an absolute file name, and neither is the backslash
15713 normally considered a directory separator character. In that case,
15714 the native file system would interpret this whole absolute file name
15715 as a relative file name with no directory components. This would make
15716 it impossible to point @value{GDBN} at a copy of the remote target's
15717 shared libraries on the host using @code{set sysroot}, and impractical
15718 with @code{set solib-search-path}. Setting
15719 @code{target-file-system-kind} to @code{dos-based} tells @value{GDBN}
15720 to interpret such file names similarly to how the target would, and to
15721 map them to file names valid on @value{GDBN}'s native file system
15722 semantics. The value of @var{kind} can be @code{"auto"}, in addition
15723 to one of the supported file system kinds. In that case, @value{GDBN}
15724 tries to determine the appropriate file system variant based on the
15725 current target's operating system (@pxref{ABI, ,Configuring the
15726 Current ABI}). The supported file system settings are:
15727
15728 @table @code
15729 @item unix
15730 Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target file system is of Unix
15731 kind. Only file names starting the forward slash (@samp{/}) character
15732 are considered absolute, and the directory separator character is also
15733 the forward slash.
15734
15735 @item dos-based
15736 Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target file system is DOS based.
15737 File names starting with either a forward slash, or a drive letter
15738 followed by a colon (e.g., @samp{c:}), are considered absolute, and
15739 both the slash (@samp{/}) and the backslash (@samp{\\}) characters are
15740 considered directory separators.
15741
15742 @item auto
15743 Instruct @value{GDBN} to use the file system kind associated with the
15744 target operating system (@pxref{ABI, ,Configuring the Current ABI}).
15745 This is the default.
15746 @end table
15747 @end table
15748
15749 @cindex file name canonicalization
15750 @cindex base name differences
15751 When processing file names provided by the user, @value{GDBN}
15752 frequently needs to compare them to the file names recorded in the
15753 program's debug info. Normally, @value{GDBN} compares just the
15754 @dfn{base names} of the files as strings, which is reasonably fast
15755 even for very large programs. (The base name of a file is the last
15756 portion of its name, after stripping all the leading directories.)
15757 This shortcut in comparison is based upon the assumption that files
15758 cannot have more than one base name. This is usually true, but
15759 references to files that use symlinks or similar filesystem
15760 facilities violate that assumption. If your program records files
15761 using such facilities, or if you provide file names to @value{GDBN}
15762 using symlinks etc., you can set @code{basenames-may-differ} to
15763 @code{true} to instruct @value{GDBN} to completely canonicalize each
15764 pair of file names it needs to compare. This will make file-name
15765 comparisons accurate, but at a price of a significant slowdown.
15766
15767 @table @code
15768 @item set basenames-may-differ
15769 @kindex set basenames-may-differ
15770 Set whether a source file may have multiple base names.
15771
15772 @item show basenames-may-differ
15773 @kindex show basenames-may-differ
15774 Show whether a source file may have multiple base names.
15775 @end table
15776
15777 @node Separate Debug Files
15778 @section Debugging Information in Separate Files
15779 @cindex separate debugging information files
15780 @cindex debugging information in separate files
15781 @cindex @file{.debug} subdirectories
15782 @cindex debugging information directory, global
15783 @cindex global debugging information directory
15784 @cindex build ID, and separate debugging files
15785 @cindex @file{.build-id} directory
15786
15787 @value{GDBN} allows you to put a program's debugging information in a
15788 file separate from the executable itself, in a way that allows
15789 @value{GDBN} to find and load the debugging information automatically.
15790 Since debugging information can be very large---sometimes larger
15791 than the executable code itself---some systems distribute debugging
15792 information for their executables in separate files, which users can
15793 install only when they need to debug a problem.
15794
15795 @value{GDBN} supports two ways of specifying the separate debug info
15796 file:
15797
15798 @itemize @bullet
15799 @item
15800 The executable contains a @dfn{debug link} that specifies the name of
15801 the separate debug info file. The separate debug file's name is
15802 usually @file{@var{executable}.debug}, where @var{executable} is the
15803 name of the corresponding executable file without leading directories
15804 (e.g., @file{ls.debug} for @file{/usr/bin/ls}). In addition, the
15805 debug link specifies a 32-bit @dfn{Cyclic Redundancy Check} (CRC)
15806 checksum for the debug file, which @value{GDBN} uses to validate that
15807 the executable and the debug file came from the same build.
15808
15809 @item
15810 The executable contains a @dfn{build ID}, a unique bit string that is
15811 also present in the corresponding debug info file. (This is supported
15812 only on some operating systems, notably those which use the ELF format
15813 for binary files and the @sc{gnu} Binutils.) For more details about
15814 this feature, see the description of the @option{--build-id}
15815 command-line option in @ref{Options, , Command Line Options, ld.info,
15816 The GNU Linker}. The debug info file's name is not specified
15817 explicitly by the build ID, but can be computed from the build ID, see
15818 below.
15819 @end itemize
15820
15821 Depending on the way the debug info file is specified, @value{GDBN}
15822 uses two different methods of looking for the debug file:
15823
15824 @itemize @bullet
15825 @item
15826 For the ``debug link'' method, @value{GDBN} looks up the named file in
15827 the directory of the executable file, then in a subdirectory of that
15828 directory named @file{.debug}, and finally under the global debug
15829 directory, in a subdirectory whose name is identical to the leading
15830 directories of the executable's absolute file name.
15831
15832 @item
15833 For the ``build ID'' method, @value{GDBN} looks in the
15834 @file{.build-id} subdirectory of the global debug directory for a file
15835 named @file{@var{nn}/@var{nnnnnnnn}.debug}, where @var{nn} are the
15836 first 2 hex characters of the build ID bit string, and @var{nnnnnnnn}
15837 are the rest of the bit string. (Real build ID strings are 32 or more
15838 hex characters, not 10.)
15839 @end itemize
15840
15841 So, for example, suppose you ask @value{GDBN} to debug
15842 @file{/usr/bin/ls}, which has a debug link that specifies the
15843 file @file{ls.debug}, and a build ID whose value in hex is
15844 @code{abcdef1234}. If the global debug directory is
15845 @file{/usr/lib/debug}, then @value{GDBN} will look for the following
15846 debug information files, in the indicated order:
15847
15848 @itemize @minus
15849 @item
15850 @file{/usr/lib/debug/.build-id/ab/cdef1234.debug}
15851 @item
15852 @file{/usr/bin/ls.debug}
15853 @item
15854 @file{/usr/bin/.debug/ls.debug}
15855 @item
15856 @file{/usr/lib/debug/usr/bin/ls.debug}.
15857 @end itemize
15858
15859 You can set the global debugging info directory's name, and view the
15860 name @value{GDBN} is currently using.
15861
15862 @table @code
15863
15864 @kindex set debug-file-directory
15865 @item set debug-file-directory @var{directories}
15866 Set the directories which @value{GDBN} searches for separate debugging
15867 information files to @var{directory}. Multiple directory components can be set
15868 concatenating them by a directory separator.
15869
15870 @kindex show debug-file-directory
15871 @item show debug-file-directory
15872 Show the directories @value{GDBN} searches for separate debugging
15873 information files.
15874
15875 @end table
15876
15877 @cindex @code{.gnu_debuglink} sections
15878 @cindex debug link sections
15879 A debug link is a special section of the executable file named
15880 @code{.gnu_debuglink}. The section must contain:
15881
15882 @itemize
15883 @item
15884 A filename, with any leading directory components removed, followed by
15885 a zero byte,
15886 @item
15887 zero to three bytes of padding, as needed to reach the next four-byte
15888 boundary within the section, and
15889 @item
15890 a four-byte CRC checksum, stored in the same endianness used for the
15891 executable file itself. The checksum is computed on the debugging
15892 information file's full contents by the function given below, passing
15893 zero as the @var{crc} argument.
15894 @end itemize
15895
15896 Any executable file format can carry a debug link, as long as it can
15897 contain a section named @code{.gnu_debuglink} with the contents
15898 described above.
15899
15900 @cindex @code{.note.gnu.build-id} sections
15901 @cindex build ID sections
15902 The build ID is a special section in the executable file (and in other
15903 ELF binary files that @value{GDBN} may consider). This section is
15904 often named @code{.note.gnu.build-id}, but that name is not mandatory.
15905 It contains unique identification for the built files---the ID remains
15906 the same across multiple builds of the same build tree. The default
15907 algorithm SHA1 produces 160 bits (40 hexadecimal characters) of the
15908 content for the build ID string. The same section with an identical
15909 value is present in the original built binary with symbols, in its
15910 stripped variant, and in the separate debugging information file.
15911
15912 The debugging information file itself should be an ordinary
15913 executable, containing a full set of linker symbols, sections, and
15914 debugging information. The sections of the debugging information file
15915 should have the same names, addresses, and sizes as the original file,
15916 but they need not contain any data---much like a @code{.bss} section
15917 in an ordinary executable.
15918
15919 The @sc{gnu} binary utilities (Binutils) package includes the
15920 @samp{objcopy} utility that can produce
15921 the separated executable / debugging information file pairs using the
15922 following commands:
15923
15924 @smallexample
15925 @kbd{objcopy --only-keep-debug foo foo.debug}
15926 @kbd{strip -g foo}
15927 @end smallexample
15928
15929 @noindent
15930 These commands remove the debugging
15931 information from the executable file @file{foo} and place it in the file
15932 @file{foo.debug}. You can use the first, second or both methods to link the
15933 two files:
15934
15935 @itemize @bullet
15936 @item
15937 The debug link method needs the following additional command to also leave
15938 behind a debug link in @file{foo}:
15939
15940 @smallexample
15941 @kbd{objcopy --add-gnu-debuglink=foo.debug foo}
15942 @end smallexample
15943
15944 Ulrich Drepper's @file{elfutils} package, starting with version 0.53, contains
15945 a version of the @code{strip} command such that the command @kbd{strip foo -f
15946 foo.debug} has the same functionality as the two @code{objcopy} commands and
15947 the @code{ln -s} command above, together.
15948
15949 @item
15950 Build ID gets embedded into the main executable using @code{ld --build-id} or
15951 the @value{NGCC} counterpart @code{gcc -Wl,--build-id}. Build ID support plus
15952 compatibility fixes for debug files separation are present in @sc{gnu} binary
15953 utilities (Binutils) package since version 2.18.
15954 @end itemize
15955
15956 @noindent
15957
15958 @cindex CRC algorithm definition
15959 The CRC used in @code{.gnu_debuglink} is the CRC-32 defined in
15960 IEEE 802.3 using the polynomial:
15961
15962 @c TexInfo requires naked braces for multi-digit exponents for Tex
15963 @c output, but this causes HTML output to barf. HTML has to be set using
15964 @c raw commands. So we end up having to specify this equation in 2
15965 @c different ways!
15966 @ifhtml
15967 @display
15968 @html
15969 <em>x</em><sup>32</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>26</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>23</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>22</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>16</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>12</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>11</sup>
15970 + <em>x</em><sup>10</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>8</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>7</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>5</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>4</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>2</sup> + <em>x</em> + 1
15971 @end html
15972 @end display
15973 @end ifhtml
15974 @ifnothtml
15975 @display
15976 @math{x^{32} + x^{26} + x^{23} + x^{22} + x^{16} + x^{12} + x^{11}}
15977 @math{+ x^{10} + x^8 + x^7 + x^5 + x^4 + x^2 + x + 1}
15978 @end display
15979 @end ifnothtml
15980
15981 The function is computed byte at a time, taking the least
15982 significant bit of each byte first. The initial pattern
15983 @code{0xffffffff} is used, to ensure leading zeros affect the CRC and
15984 the final result is inverted to ensure trailing zeros also affect the
15985 CRC.
15986
15987 @emph{Note:} This is the same CRC polynomial as used in handling the
15988 @dfn{Remote Serial Protocol} @code{qCRC} packet (@pxref{Remote Protocol,
15989 , @value{GDBN} Remote Serial Protocol}). However in the
15990 case of the Remote Serial Protocol, the CRC is computed @emph{most}
15991 significant bit first, and the result is not inverted, so trailing
15992 zeros have no effect on the CRC value.
15993
15994 To complete the description, we show below the code of the function
15995 which produces the CRC used in @code{.gnu_debuglink}. Inverting the
15996 initially supplied @code{crc} argument means that an initial call to
15997 this function passing in zero will start computing the CRC using
15998 @code{0xffffffff}.
15999
16000 @kindex gnu_debuglink_crc32
16001 @smallexample
16002 unsigned long
16003 gnu_debuglink_crc32 (unsigned long crc,
16004 unsigned char *buf, size_t len)
16005 @{
16006 static const unsigned long crc32_table[256] =
16007 @{
16008 0x00000000, 0x77073096, 0xee0e612c, 0x990951ba, 0x076dc419,
16009 0x706af48f, 0xe963a535, 0x9e6495a3, 0x0edb8832, 0x79dcb8a4,
16010 0xe0d5e91e, 0x97d2d988, 0x09b64c2b, 0x7eb17cbd, 0xe7b82d07,
16011 0x90bf1d91, 0x1db71064, 0x6ab020f2, 0xf3b97148, 0x84be41de,
16012 0x1adad47d, 0x6ddde4eb, 0xf4d4b551, 0x83d385c7, 0x136c9856,
16013 0x646ba8c0, 0xfd62f97a, 0x8a65c9ec, 0x14015c4f, 0x63066cd9,
16014 0xfa0f3d63, 0x8d080df5, 0x3b6e20c8, 0x4c69105e, 0xd56041e4,
16015 0xa2677172, 0x3c03e4d1, 0x4b04d447, 0xd20d85fd, 0xa50ab56b,
16016 0x35b5a8fa, 0x42b2986c, 0xdbbbc9d6, 0xacbcf940, 0x32d86ce3,
16017 0x45df5c75, 0xdcd60dcf, 0xabd13d59, 0x26d930ac, 0x51de003a,
16018 0xc8d75180, 0xbfd06116, 0x21b4f4b5, 0x56b3c423, 0xcfba9599,
16019 0xb8bda50f, 0x2802b89e, 0x5f058808, 0xc60cd9b2, 0xb10be924,
16020 0x2f6f7c87, 0x58684c11, 0xc1611dab, 0xb6662d3d, 0x76dc4190,
16021 0x01db7106, 0x98d220bc, 0xefd5102a, 0x71b18589, 0x06b6b51f,
16022 0x9fbfe4a5, 0xe8b8d433, 0x7807c9a2, 0x0f00f934, 0x9609a88e,
16023 0xe10e9818, 0x7f6a0dbb, 0x086d3d2d, 0x91646c97, 0xe6635c01,
16024 0x6b6b51f4, 0x1c6c6162, 0x856530d8, 0xf262004e, 0x6c0695ed,
16025 0x1b01a57b, 0x8208f4c1, 0xf50fc457, 0x65b0d9c6, 0x12b7e950,
16026 0x8bbeb8ea, 0xfcb9887c, 0x62dd1ddf, 0x15da2d49, 0x8cd37cf3,
16027 0xfbd44c65, 0x4db26158, 0x3ab551ce, 0xa3bc0074, 0xd4bb30e2,
16028 0x4adfa541, 0x3dd895d7, 0xa4d1c46d, 0xd3d6f4fb, 0x4369e96a,
16029 0x346ed9fc, 0xad678846, 0xda60b8d0, 0x44042d73, 0x33031de5,
16030 0xaa0a4c5f, 0xdd0d7cc9, 0x5005713c, 0x270241aa, 0xbe0b1010,
16031 0xc90c2086, 0x5768b525, 0x206f85b3, 0xb966d409, 0xce61e49f,
16032 0x5edef90e, 0x29d9c998, 0xb0d09822, 0xc7d7a8b4, 0x59b33d17,
16033 0x2eb40d81, 0xb7bd5c3b, 0xc0ba6cad, 0xedb88320, 0x9abfb3b6,
16034 0x03b6e20c, 0x74b1d29a, 0xead54739, 0x9dd277af, 0x04db2615,
16035 0x73dc1683, 0xe3630b12, 0x94643b84, 0x0d6d6a3e, 0x7a6a5aa8,
16036 0xe40ecf0b, 0x9309ff9d, 0x0a00ae27, 0x7d079eb1, 0xf00f9344,
16037 0x8708a3d2, 0x1e01f268, 0x6906c2fe, 0xf762575d, 0x806567cb,
16038 0x196c3671, 0x6e6b06e7, 0xfed41b76, 0x89d32be0, 0x10da7a5a,
16039 0x67dd4acc, 0xf9b9df6f, 0x8ebeeff9, 0x17b7be43, 0x60b08ed5,
16040 0xd6d6a3e8, 0xa1d1937e, 0x38d8c2c4, 0x4fdff252, 0xd1bb67f1,
16041 0xa6bc5767, 0x3fb506dd, 0x48b2364b, 0xd80d2bda, 0xaf0a1b4c,
16042 0x36034af6, 0x41047a60, 0xdf60efc3, 0xa867df55, 0x316e8eef,
16043 0x4669be79, 0xcb61b38c, 0xbc66831a, 0x256fd2a0, 0x5268e236,
16044 0xcc0c7795, 0xbb0b4703, 0x220216b9, 0x5505262f, 0xc5ba3bbe,
16045 0xb2bd0b28, 0x2bb45a92, 0x5cb36a04, 0xc2d7ffa7, 0xb5d0cf31,
16046 0x2cd99e8b, 0x5bdeae1d, 0x9b64c2b0, 0xec63f226, 0x756aa39c,
16047 0x026d930a, 0x9c0906a9, 0xeb0e363f, 0x72076785, 0x05005713,
16048 0x95bf4a82, 0xe2b87a14, 0x7bb12bae, 0x0cb61b38, 0x92d28e9b,
16049 0xe5d5be0d, 0x7cdcefb7, 0x0bdbdf21, 0x86d3d2d4, 0xf1d4e242,
16050 0x68ddb3f8, 0x1fda836e, 0x81be16cd, 0xf6b9265b, 0x6fb077e1,
16051 0x18b74777, 0x88085ae6, 0xff0f6a70, 0x66063bca, 0x11010b5c,
16052 0x8f659eff, 0xf862ae69, 0x616bffd3, 0x166ccf45, 0xa00ae278,
16053 0xd70dd2ee, 0x4e048354, 0x3903b3c2, 0xa7672661, 0xd06016f7,
16054 0x4969474d, 0x3e6e77db, 0xaed16a4a, 0xd9d65adc, 0x40df0b66,
16055 0x37d83bf0, 0xa9bcae53, 0xdebb9ec5, 0x47b2cf7f, 0x30b5ffe9,
16056 0xbdbdf21c, 0xcabac28a, 0x53b39330, 0x24b4a3a6, 0xbad03605,
16057 0xcdd70693, 0x54de5729, 0x23d967bf, 0xb3667a2e, 0xc4614ab8,
16058 0x5d681b02, 0x2a6f2b94, 0xb40bbe37, 0xc30c8ea1, 0x5a05df1b,
16059 0x2d02ef8d
16060 @};
16061 unsigned char *end;
16062
16063 crc = ~crc & 0xffffffff;
16064 for (end = buf + len; buf < end; ++buf)
16065 crc = crc32_table[(crc ^ *buf) & 0xff] ^ (crc >> 8);
16066 return ~crc & 0xffffffff;
16067 @}
16068 @end smallexample
16069
16070 @noindent
16071 This computation does not apply to the ``build ID'' method.
16072
16073
16074 @node Index Files
16075 @section Index Files Speed Up @value{GDBN}
16076 @cindex index files
16077 @cindex @samp{.gdb_index} section
16078
16079 When @value{GDBN} finds a symbol file, it scans the symbols in the
16080 file in order to construct an internal symbol table. This lets most
16081 @value{GDBN} operations work quickly---at the cost of a delay early
16082 on. For large programs, this delay can be quite lengthy, so
16083 @value{GDBN} provides a way to build an index, which speeds up
16084 startup.
16085
16086 The index is stored as a section in the symbol file. @value{GDBN} can
16087 write the index to a file, then you can put it into the symbol file
16088 using @command{objcopy}.
16089
16090 To create an index file, use the @code{save gdb-index} command:
16091
16092 @table @code
16093 @item save gdb-index @var{directory}
16094 @kindex save gdb-index
16095 Create an index file for each symbol file currently known by
16096 @value{GDBN}. Each file is named after its corresponding symbol file,
16097 with @samp{.gdb-index} appended, and is written into the given
16098 @var{directory}.
16099 @end table
16100
16101 Once you have created an index file you can merge it into your symbol
16102 file, here named @file{symfile}, using @command{objcopy}:
16103
16104 @smallexample
16105 $ objcopy --add-section .gdb_index=symfile.gdb-index \
16106 --set-section-flags .gdb_index=readonly symfile symfile
16107 @end smallexample
16108
16109 There are currently some limitation on indices. They only work when
16110 for DWARF debugging information, not stabs. And, they do not
16111 currently work for programs using Ada.
16112
16113 @node Symbol Errors
16114 @section Errors Reading Symbol Files
16115
16116 While reading a symbol file, @value{GDBN} occasionally encounters problems,
16117 such as symbol types it does not recognize, or known bugs in compiler
16118 output. By default, @value{GDBN} does not notify you of such problems, since
16119 they are relatively common and primarily of interest to people
16120 debugging compilers. If you are interested in seeing information
16121 about ill-constructed symbol tables, you can either ask @value{GDBN} to print
16122 only one message about each such type of problem, no matter how many
16123 times the problem occurs; or you can ask @value{GDBN} to print more messages,
16124 to see how many times the problems occur, with the @code{set
16125 complaints} command (@pxref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional Warnings and
16126 Messages}).
16127
16128 The messages currently printed, and their meanings, include:
16129
16130 @table @code
16131 @item inner block not inside outer block in @var{symbol}
16132
16133 The symbol information shows where symbol scopes begin and end
16134 (such as at the start of a function or a block of statements). This
16135 error indicates that an inner scope block is not fully contained
16136 in its outer scope blocks.
16137
16138 @value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by treating the inner block as if it had
16139 the same scope as the outer block. In the error message, @var{symbol}
16140 may be shown as ``@code{(don't know)}'' if the outer block is not a
16141 function.
16142
16143 @item block at @var{address} out of order
16144
16145 The symbol information for symbol scope blocks should occur in
16146 order of increasing addresses. This error indicates that it does not
16147 do so.
16148
16149 @value{GDBN} does not circumvent this problem, and has trouble
16150 locating symbols in the source file whose symbols it is reading. (You
16151 can often determine what source file is affected by specifying
16152 @code{set verbose on}. @xref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional Warnings and
16153 Messages}.)
16154
16155 @item bad block start address patched
16156
16157 The symbol information for a symbol scope block has a start address
16158 smaller than the address of the preceding source line. This is known
16159 to occur in the SunOS 4.1.1 (and earlier) C compiler.
16160
16161 @value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by treating the symbol scope block as
16162 starting on the previous source line.
16163
16164 @item bad string table offset in symbol @var{n}
16165
16166 @cindex foo
16167 Symbol number @var{n} contains a pointer into the string table which is
16168 larger than the size of the string table.
16169
16170 @value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by considering the symbol to have the
16171 name @code{foo}, which may cause other problems if many symbols end up
16172 with this name.
16173
16174 @item unknown symbol type @code{0x@var{nn}}
16175
16176 The symbol information contains new data types that @value{GDBN} does
16177 not yet know how to read. @code{0x@var{nn}} is the symbol type of the
16178 uncomprehended information, in hexadecimal.
16179
16180 @value{GDBN} circumvents the error by ignoring this symbol information.
16181 This usually allows you to debug your program, though certain symbols
16182 are not accessible. If you encounter such a problem and feel like
16183 debugging it, you can debug @code{@value{GDBP}} with itself, breakpoint
16184 on @code{complain}, then go up to the function @code{read_dbx_symtab}
16185 and examine @code{*bufp} to see the symbol.
16186
16187 @item stub type has NULL name
16188
16189 @value{GDBN} could not find the full definition for a struct or class.
16190
16191 @item const/volatile indicator missing (ok if using g++ v1.x), got@dots{}
16192 The symbol information for a C@t{++} member function is missing some
16193 information that recent versions of the compiler should have output for
16194 it.
16195
16196 @item info mismatch between compiler and debugger
16197
16198 @value{GDBN} could not parse a type specification output by the compiler.
16199
16200 @end table
16201
16202 @node Data Files
16203 @section GDB Data Files
16204
16205 @cindex prefix for data files
16206 @value{GDBN} will sometimes read an auxiliary data file. These files
16207 are kept in a directory known as the @dfn{data directory}.
16208
16209 You can set the data directory's name, and view the name @value{GDBN}
16210 is currently using.
16211
16212 @table @code
16213 @kindex set data-directory
16214 @item set data-directory @var{directory}
16215 Set the directory which @value{GDBN} searches for auxiliary data files
16216 to @var{directory}.
16217
16218 @kindex show data-directory
16219 @item show data-directory
16220 Show the directory @value{GDBN} searches for auxiliary data files.
16221 @end table
16222
16223 @cindex default data directory
16224 @cindex @samp{--with-gdb-datadir}
16225 You can set the default data directory by using the configure-time
16226 @samp{--with-gdb-datadir} option. If the data directory is inside
16227 @value{GDBN}'s configured binary prefix (set with @samp{--prefix} or
16228 @samp{--exec-prefix}), then the default data directory will be updated
16229 automatically if the installed @value{GDBN} is moved to a new
16230 location.
16231
16232 The data directory may also be specified with the
16233 @code{--data-directory} command line option.
16234 @xref{Mode Options}.
16235
16236 @node Targets
16237 @chapter Specifying a Debugging Target
16238
16239 @cindex debugging target
16240 A @dfn{target} is the execution environment occupied by your program.
16241
16242 Often, @value{GDBN} runs in the same host environment as your program;
16243 in that case, the debugging target is specified as a side effect when
16244 you use the @code{file} or @code{core} commands. When you need more
16245 flexibility---for example, running @value{GDBN} on a physically separate
16246 host, or controlling a standalone system over a serial port or a
16247 realtime system over a TCP/IP connection---you can use the @code{target}
16248 command to specify one of the target types configured for @value{GDBN}
16249 (@pxref{Target Commands, ,Commands for Managing Targets}).
16250
16251 @cindex target architecture
16252 It is possible to build @value{GDBN} for several different @dfn{target
16253 architectures}. When @value{GDBN} is built like that, you can choose
16254 one of the available architectures with the @kbd{set architecture}
16255 command.
16256
16257 @table @code
16258 @kindex set architecture
16259 @kindex show architecture
16260 @item set architecture @var{arch}
16261 This command sets the current target architecture to @var{arch}. The
16262 value of @var{arch} can be @code{"auto"}, in addition to one of the
16263 supported architectures.
16264
16265 @item show architecture
16266 Show the current target architecture.
16267
16268 @item set processor
16269 @itemx processor
16270 @kindex set processor
16271 @kindex show processor
16272 These are alias commands for, respectively, @code{set architecture}
16273 and @code{show architecture}.
16274 @end table
16275
16276 @menu
16277 * Active Targets:: Active targets
16278 * Target Commands:: Commands for managing targets
16279 * Byte Order:: Choosing target byte order
16280 @end menu
16281
16282 @node Active Targets
16283 @section Active Targets
16284
16285 @cindex stacking targets
16286 @cindex active targets
16287 @cindex multiple targets
16288
16289 There are multiple classes of targets such as: processes, executable files or
16290 recording sessions. Core files belong to the process class, making core file
16291 and process mutually exclusive. Otherwise, @value{GDBN} can work concurrently
16292 on multiple active targets, one in each class. This allows you to (for
16293 example) start a process and inspect its activity, while still having access to
16294 the executable file after the process finishes. Or if you start process
16295 recording (@pxref{Reverse Execution}) and @code{reverse-step} there, you are
16296 presented a virtual layer of the recording target, while the process target
16297 remains stopped at the chronologically last point of the process execution.
16298
16299 Use the @code{core-file} and @code{exec-file} commands to select a new core
16300 file or executable target (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}). To
16301 specify as a target a process that is already running, use the @code{attach}
16302 command (@pxref{Attach, ,Debugging an Already-running Process}).
16303
16304 @node Target Commands
16305 @section Commands for Managing Targets
16306
16307 @table @code
16308 @item target @var{type} @var{parameters}
16309 Connects the @value{GDBN} host environment to a target machine or
16310 process. A target is typically a protocol for talking to debugging
16311 facilities. You use the argument @var{type} to specify the type or
16312 protocol of the target machine.
16313
16314 Further @var{parameters} are interpreted by the target protocol, but
16315 typically include things like device names or host names to connect
16316 with, process numbers, and baud rates.
16317
16318 The @code{target} command does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again
16319 after executing the command.
16320
16321 @kindex help target
16322 @item help target
16323 Displays the names of all targets available. To display targets
16324 currently selected, use either @code{info target} or @code{info files}
16325 (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}).
16326
16327 @item help target @var{name}
16328 Describe a particular target, including any parameters necessary to
16329 select it.
16330
16331 @kindex set gnutarget
16332 @item set gnutarget @var{args}
16333 @value{GDBN} uses its own library BFD to read your files. @value{GDBN}
16334 knows whether it is reading an @dfn{executable},
16335 a @dfn{core}, or a @dfn{.o} file; however, you can specify the file format
16336 with the @code{set gnutarget} command. Unlike most @code{target} commands,
16337 with @code{gnutarget} the @code{target} refers to a program, not a machine.
16338
16339 @quotation
16340 @emph{Warning:} To specify a file format with @code{set gnutarget},
16341 you must know the actual BFD name.
16342 @end quotation
16343
16344 @noindent
16345 @xref{Files, , Commands to Specify Files}.
16346
16347 @kindex show gnutarget
16348 @item show gnutarget
16349 Use the @code{show gnutarget} command to display what file format
16350 @code{gnutarget} is set to read. If you have not set @code{gnutarget},
16351 @value{GDBN} will determine the file format for each file automatically,
16352 and @code{show gnutarget} displays @samp{The current BDF target is "auto"}.
16353 @end table
16354
16355 @cindex common targets
16356 Here are some common targets (available, or not, depending on the GDB
16357 configuration):
16358
16359 @table @code
16360 @kindex target
16361 @item target exec @var{program}
16362 @cindex executable file target
16363 An executable file. @samp{target exec @var{program}} is the same as
16364 @samp{exec-file @var{program}}.
16365
16366 @item target core @var{filename}
16367 @cindex core dump file target
16368 A core dump file. @samp{target core @var{filename}} is the same as
16369 @samp{core-file @var{filename}}.
16370
16371 @item target remote @var{medium}
16372 @cindex remote target
16373 A remote system connected to @value{GDBN} via a serial line or network
16374 connection. This command tells @value{GDBN} to use its own remote
16375 protocol over @var{medium} for debugging. @xref{Remote Debugging}.
16376
16377 For example, if you have a board connected to @file{/dev/ttya} on the
16378 machine running @value{GDBN}, you could say:
16379
16380 @smallexample
16381 target remote /dev/ttya
16382 @end smallexample
16383
16384 @code{target remote} supports the @code{load} command. This is only
16385 useful if you have some other way of getting the stub to the target
16386 system, and you can put it somewhere in memory where it won't get
16387 clobbered by the download.
16388
16389 @item target sim @r{[}@var{simargs}@r{]} @dots{}
16390 @cindex built-in simulator target
16391 Builtin CPU simulator. @value{GDBN} includes simulators for most architectures.
16392 In general,
16393 @smallexample
16394 target sim
16395 load
16396 run
16397 @end smallexample
16398 @noindent
16399 works; however, you cannot assume that a specific memory map, device
16400 drivers, or even basic I/O is available, although some simulators do
16401 provide these. For info about any processor-specific simulator details,
16402 see the appropriate section in @ref{Embedded Processors, ,Embedded
16403 Processors}.
16404
16405 @end table
16406
16407 Some configurations may include these targets as well:
16408
16409 @table @code
16410
16411 @item target nrom @var{dev}
16412 @cindex NetROM ROM emulator target
16413 NetROM ROM emulator. This target only supports downloading.
16414
16415 @end table
16416
16417 Different targets are available on different configurations of @value{GDBN};
16418 your configuration may have more or fewer targets.
16419
16420 Many remote targets require you to download the executable's code once
16421 you've successfully established a connection. You may wish to control
16422 various aspects of this process.
16423
16424 @table @code
16425
16426 @item set hash
16427 @kindex set hash@r{, for remote monitors}
16428 @cindex hash mark while downloading
16429 This command controls whether a hash mark @samp{#} is displayed while
16430 downloading a file to the remote monitor. If on, a hash mark is
16431 displayed after each S-record is successfully downloaded to the
16432 monitor.
16433
16434 @item show hash
16435 @kindex show hash@r{, for remote monitors}
16436 Show the current status of displaying the hash mark.
16437
16438 @item set debug monitor
16439 @kindex set debug monitor
16440 @cindex display remote monitor communications
16441 Enable or disable display of communications messages between
16442 @value{GDBN} and the remote monitor.
16443
16444 @item show debug monitor
16445 @kindex show debug monitor
16446 Show the current status of displaying communications between
16447 @value{GDBN} and the remote monitor.
16448 @end table
16449
16450 @table @code
16451
16452 @kindex load @var{filename}
16453 @item load @var{filename}
16454 @anchor{load}
16455 Depending on what remote debugging facilities are configured into
16456 @value{GDBN}, the @code{load} command may be available. Where it exists, it
16457 is meant to make @var{filename} (an executable) available for debugging
16458 on the remote system---by downloading, or dynamic linking, for example.
16459 @code{load} also records the @var{filename} symbol table in @value{GDBN}, like
16460 the @code{add-symbol-file} command.
16461
16462 If your @value{GDBN} does not have a @code{load} command, attempting to
16463 execute it gets the error message ``@code{You can't do that when your
16464 target is @dots{}}''
16465
16466 The file is loaded at whatever address is specified in the executable.
16467 For some object file formats, you can specify the load address when you
16468 link the program; for other formats, like a.out, the object file format
16469 specifies a fixed address.
16470 @c FIXME! This would be a good place for an xref to the GNU linker doc.
16471
16472 Depending on the remote side capabilities, @value{GDBN} may be able to
16473 load programs into flash memory.
16474
16475 @code{load} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after using it.
16476 @end table
16477
16478 @node Byte Order
16479 @section Choosing Target Byte Order
16480
16481 @cindex choosing target byte order
16482 @cindex target byte order
16483
16484 Some types of processors, such as the MIPS, PowerPC, and Renesas SH,
16485 offer the ability to run either big-endian or little-endian byte
16486 orders. Usually the executable or symbol will include a bit to
16487 designate the endian-ness, and you will not need to worry about
16488 which to use. However, you may still find it useful to adjust
16489 @value{GDBN}'s idea of processor endian-ness manually.
16490
16491 @table @code
16492 @kindex set endian
16493 @item set endian big
16494 Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target is big-endian.
16495
16496 @item set endian little
16497 Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target is little-endian.
16498
16499 @item set endian auto
16500 Instruct @value{GDBN} to use the byte order associated with the
16501 executable.
16502
16503 @item show endian
16504 Display @value{GDBN}'s current idea of the target byte order.
16505
16506 @end table
16507
16508 Note that these commands merely adjust interpretation of symbolic
16509 data on the host, and that they have absolutely no effect on the
16510 target system.
16511
16512
16513 @node Remote Debugging
16514 @chapter Debugging Remote Programs
16515 @cindex remote debugging
16516
16517 If you are trying to debug a program running on a machine that cannot run
16518 @value{GDBN} in the usual way, it is often useful to use remote debugging.
16519 For example, you might use remote debugging on an operating system kernel,
16520 or on a small system which does not have a general purpose operating system
16521 powerful enough to run a full-featured debugger.
16522
16523 Some configurations of @value{GDBN} have special serial or TCP/IP interfaces
16524 to make this work with particular debugging targets. In addition,
16525 @value{GDBN} comes with a generic serial protocol (specific to @value{GDBN},
16526 but not specific to any particular target system) which you can use if you
16527 write the remote stubs---the code that runs on the remote system to
16528 communicate with @value{GDBN}.
16529
16530 Other remote targets may be available in your
16531 configuration of @value{GDBN}; use @code{help target} to list them.
16532
16533 @menu
16534 * Connecting:: Connecting to a remote target
16535 * File Transfer:: Sending files to a remote system
16536 * Server:: Using the gdbserver program
16537 * Remote Configuration:: Remote configuration
16538 * Remote Stub:: Implementing a remote stub
16539 @end menu
16540
16541 @node Connecting
16542 @section Connecting to a Remote Target
16543
16544 On the @value{GDBN} host machine, you will need an unstripped copy of
16545 your program, since @value{GDBN} needs symbol and debugging information.
16546 Start up @value{GDBN} as usual, using the name of the local copy of your
16547 program as the first argument.
16548
16549 @cindex @code{target remote}
16550 @value{GDBN} can communicate with the target over a serial line, or
16551 over an @acronym{IP} network using @acronym{TCP} or @acronym{UDP}. In
16552 each case, @value{GDBN} uses the same protocol for debugging your
16553 program; only the medium carrying the debugging packets varies. The
16554 @code{target remote} command establishes a connection to the target.
16555 Its arguments indicate which medium to use:
16556
16557 @table @code
16558
16559 @item target remote @var{serial-device}
16560 @cindex serial line, @code{target remote}
16561 Use @var{serial-device} to communicate with the target. For example,
16562 to use a serial line connected to the device named @file{/dev/ttyb}:
16563
16564 @smallexample
16565 target remote /dev/ttyb
16566 @end smallexample
16567
16568 If you're using a serial line, you may want to give @value{GDBN} the
16569 @w{@samp{--baud}} option, or use the @code{set remotebaud} command
16570 (@pxref{Remote Configuration, set remotebaud}) before the
16571 @code{target} command.
16572
16573 @item target remote @code{@var{host}:@var{port}}
16574 @itemx target remote @code{tcp:@var{host}:@var{port}}
16575 @cindex @acronym{TCP} port, @code{target remote}
16576 Debug using a @acronym{TCP} connection to @var{port} on @var{host}.
16577 The @var{host} may be either a host name or a numeric @acronym{IP}
16578 address; @var{port} must be a decimal number. The @var{host} could be
16579 the target machine itself, if it is directly connected to the net, or
16580 it might be a terminal server which in turn has a serial line to the
16581 target.
16582
16583 For example, to connect to port 2828 on a terminal server named
16584 @code{manyfarms}:
16585
16586 @smallexample
16587 target remote manyfarms:2828
16588 @end smallexample
16589
16590 If your remote target is actually running on the same machine as your
16591 debugger session (e.g.@: a simulator for your target running on the
16592 same host), you can omit the hostname. For example, to connect to
16593 port 1234 on your local machine:
16594
16595 @smallexample
16596 target remote :1234
16597 @end smallexample
16598 @noindent
16599
16600 Note that the colon is still required here.
16601
16602 @item target remote @code{udp:@var{host}:@var{port}}
16603 @cindex @acronym{UDP} port, @code{target remote}
16604 Debug using @acronym{UDP} packets to @var{port} on @var{host}. For example, to
16605 connect to @acronym{UDP} port 2828 on a terminal server named @code{manyfarms}:
16606
16607 @smallexample
16608 target remote udp:manyfarms:2828
16609 @end smallexample
16610
16611 When using a @acronym{UDP} connection for remote debugging, you should
16612 keep in mind that the `U' stands for ``Unreliable''. @acronym{UDP}
16613 can silently drop packets on busy or unreliable networks, which will
16614 cause havoc with your debugging session.
16615
16616 @item target remote | @var{command}
16617 @cindex pipe, @code{target remote} to
16618 Run @var{command} in the background and communicate with it using a
16619 pipe. The @var{command} is a shell command, to be parsed and expanded
16620 by the system's command shell, @code{/bin/sh}; it should expect remote
16621 protocol packets on its standard input, and send replies on its
16622 standard output. You could use this to run a stand-alone simulator
16623 that speaks the remote debugging protocol, to make net connections
16624 using programs like @code{ssh}, or for other similar tricks.
16625
16626 If @var{command} closes its standard output (perhaps by exiting),
16627 @value{GDBN} will try to send it a @code{SIGTERM} signal. (If the
16628 program has already exited, this will have no effect.)
16629
16630 @end table
16631
16632 Once the connection has been established, you can use all the usual
16633 commands to examine and change data. The remote program is already
16634 running; you can use @kbd{step} and @kbd{continue}, and you do not
16635 need to use @kbd{run}.
16636
16637 @cindex interrupting remote programs
16638 @cindex remote programs, interrupting
16639 Whenever @value{GDBN} is waiting for the remote program, if you type the
16640 interrupt character (often @kbd{Ctrl-c}), @value{GDBN} attempts to stop the
16641 program. This may or may not succeed, depending in part on the hardware
16642 and the serial drivers the remote system uses. If you type the
16643 interrupt character once again, @value{GDBN} displays this prompt:
16644
16645 @smallexample
16646 Interrupted while waiting for the program.
16647 Give up (and stop debugging it)? (y or n)
16648 @end smallexample
16649
16650 If you type @kbd{y}, @value{GDBN} abandons the remote debugging session.
16651 (If you decide you want to try again later, you can use @samp{target
16652 remote} again to connect once more.) If you type @kbd{n}, @value{GDBN}
16653 goes back to waiting.
16654
16655 @table @code
16656 @kindex detach (remote)
16657 @item detach
16658 When you have finished debugging the remote program, you can use the
16659 @code{detach} command to release it from @value{GDBN} control.
16660 Detaching from the target normally resumes its execution, but the results
16661 will depend on your particular remote stub. After the @code{detach}
16662 command, @value{GDBN} is free to connect to another target.
16663
16664 @kindex disconnect
16665 @item disconnect
16666 The @code{disconnect} command behaves like @code{detach}, except that
16667 the target is generally not resumed. It will wait for @value{GDBN}
16668 (this instance or another one) to connect and continue debugging. After
16669 the @code{disconnect} command, @value{GDBN} is again free to connect to
16670 another target.
16671
16672 @cindex send command to remote monitor
16673 @cindex extend @value{GDBN} for remote targets
16674 @cindex add new commands for external monitor
16675 @kindex monitor
16676 @item monitor @var{cmd}
16677 This command allows you to send arbitrary commands directly to the
16678 remote monitor. Since @value{GDBN} doesn't care about the commands it
16679 sends like this, this command is the way to extend @value{GDBN}---you
16680 can add new commands that only the external monitor will understand
16681 and implement.
16682 @end table
16683
16684 @node File Transfer
16685 @section Sending files to a remote system
16686 @cindex remote target, file transfer
16687 @cindex file transfer
16688 @cindex sending files to remote systems
16689
16690 Some remote targets offer the ability to transfer files over the same
16691 connection used to communicate with @value{GDBN}. This is convenient
16692 for targets accessible through other means, e.g.@: @sc{gnu}/Linux systems
16693 running @code{gdbserver} over a network interface. For other targets,
16694 e.g.@: embedded devices with only a single serial port, this may be
16695 the only way to upload or download files.
16696
16697 Not all remote targets support these commands.
16698
16699 @table @code
16700 @kindex remote put
16701 @item remote put @var{hostfile} @var{targetfile}
16702 Copy file @var{hostfile} from the host system (the machine running
16703 @value{GDBN}) to @var{targetfile} on the target system.
16704
16705 @kindex remote get
16706 @item remote get @var{targetfile} @var{hostfile}
16707 Copy file @var{targetfile} from the target system to @var{hostfile}
16708 on the host system.
16709
16710 @kindex remote delete
16711 @item remote delete @var{targetfile}
16712 Delete @var{targetfile} from the target system.
16713
16714 @end table
16715
16716 @node Server
16717 @section Using the @code{gdbserver} Program
16718
16719 @kindex gdbserver
16720 @cindex remote connection without stubs
16721 @code{gdbserver} is a control program for Unix-like systems, which
16722 allows you to connect your program with a remote @value{GDBN} via
16723 @code{target remote}---but without linking in the usual debugging stub.
16724
16725 @code{gdbserver} is not a complete replacement for the debugging stubs,
16726 because it requires essentially the same operating-system facilities
16727 that @value{GDBN} itself does. In fact, a system that can run
16728 @code{gdbserver} to connect to a remote @value{GDBN} could also run
16729 @value{GDBN} locally! @code{gdbserver} is sometimes useful nevertheless,
16730 because it is a much smaller program than @value{GDBN} itself. It is
16731 also easier to port than all of @value{GDBN}, so you may be able to get
16732 started more quickly on a new system by using @code{gdbserver}.
16733 Finally, if you develop code for real-time systems, you may find that
16734 the tradeoffs involved in real-time operation make it more convenient to
16735 do as much development work as possible on another system, for example
16736 by cross-compiling. You can use @code{gdbserver} to make a similar
16737 choice for debugging.
16738
16739 @value{GDBN} and @code{gdbserver} communicate via either a serial line
16740 or a TCP connection, using the standard @value{GDBN} remote serial
16741 protocol.
16742
16743 @quotation
16744 @emph{Warning:} @code{gdbserver} does not have any built-in security.
16745 Do not run @code{gdbserver} connected to any public network; a
16746 @value{GDBN} connection to @code{gdbserver} provides access to the
16747 target system with the same privileges as the user running
16748 @code{gdbserver}.
16749 @end quotation
16750
16751 @subsection Running @code{gdbserver}
16752 @cindex arguments, to @code{gdbserver}
16753 @cindex @code{gdbserver}, command-line arguments
16754
16755 Run @code{gdbserver} on the target system. You need a copy of the
16756 program you want to debug, including any libraries it requires.
16757 @code{gdbserver} does not need your program's symbol table, so you can
16758 strip the program if necessary to save space. @value{GDBN} on the host
16759 system does all the symbol handling.
16760
16761 To use the server, you must tell it how to communicate with @value{GDBN};
16762 the name of your program; and the arguments for your program. The usual
16763 syntax is:
16764
16765 @smallexample
16766 target> gdbserver @var{comm} @var{program} [ @var{args} @dots{} ]
16767 @end smallexample
16768
16769 @var{comm} is either a device name (to use a serial line) or a TCP
16770 hostname and portnumber. For example, to debug Emacs with the argument
16771 @samp{foo.txt} and communicate with @value{GDBN} over the serial port
16772 @file{/dev/com1}:
16773
16774 @smallexample
16775 target> gdbserver /dev/com1 emacs foo.txt
16776 @end smallexample
16777
16778 @code{gdbserver} waits passively for the host @value{GDBN} to communicate
16779 with it.
16780
16781 To use a TCP connection instead of a serial line:
16782
16783 @smallexample
16784 target> gdbserver host:2345 emacs foo.txt
16785 @end smallexample
16786
16787 The only difference from the previous example is the first argument,
16788 specifying that you are communicating with the host @value{GDBN} via
16789 TCP. The @samp{host:2345} argument means that @code{gdbserver} is to
16790 expect a TCP connection from machine @samp{host} to local TCP port 2345.
16791 (Currently, the @samp{host} part is ignored.) You can choose any number
16792 you want for the port number as long as it does not conflict with any
16793 TCP ports already in use on the target system (for example, @code{23} is
16794 reserved for @code{telnet}).@footnote{If you choose a port number that
16795 conflicts with another service, @code{gdbserver} prints an error message
16796 and exits.} You must use the same port number with the host @value{GDBN}
16797 @code{target remote} command.
16798
16799 @subsubsection Attaching to a Running Program
16800 @cindex attach to a program, @code{gdbserver}
16801 @cindex @option{--attach}, @code{gdbserver} option
16802
16803 On some targets, @code{gdbserver} can also attach to running programs.
16804 This is accomplished via the @code{--attach} argument. The syntax is:
16805
16806 @smallexample
16807 target> gdbserver --attach @var{comm} @var{pid}
16808 @end smallexample
16809
16810 @var{pid} is the process ID of a currently running process. It isn't necessary
16811 to point @code{gdbserver} at a binary for the running process.
16812
16813 @pindex pidof
16814 You can debug processes by name instead of process ID if your target has the
16815 @code{pidof} utility:
16816
16817 @smallexample
16818 target> gdbserver --attach @var{comm} `pidof @var{program}`
16819 @end smallexample
16820
16821 In case more than one copy of @var{program} is running, or @var{program}
16822 has multiple threads, most versions of @code{pidof} support the
16823 @code{-s} option to only return the first process ID.
16824
16825 @subsubsection Multi-Process Mode for @code{gdbserver}
16826 @cindex @code{gdbserver}, multiple processes
16827 @cindex multiple processes with @code{gdbserver}
16828
16829 When you connect to @code{gdbserver} using @code{target remote},
16830 @code{gdbserver} debugs the specified program only once. When the
16831 program exits, or you detach from it, @value{GDBN} closes the connection
16832 and @code{gdbserver} exits.
16833
16834 If you connect using @kbd{target extended-remote}, @code{gdbserver}
16835 enters multi-process mode. When the debugged program exits, or you
16836 detach from it, @value{GDBN} stays connected to @code{gdbserver} even
16837 though no program is running. The @code{run} and @code{attach}
16838 commands instruct @code{gdbserver} to run or attach to a new program.
16839 The @code{run} command uses @code{set remote exec-file} (@pxref{set
16840 remote exec-file}) to select the program to run. Command line
16841 arguments are supported, except for wildcard expansion and I/O
16842 redirection (@pxref{Arguments}).
16843
16844 @cindex @option{--multi}, @code{gdbserver} option
16845 To start @code{gdbserver} without supplying an initial command to run
16846 or process ID to attach, use the @option{--multi} command line option.
16847 Then you can connect using @kbd{target extended-remote} and start
16848 the program you want to debug.
16849
16850 In multi-process mode @code{gdbserver} does not automatically exit unless you
16851 use the option @option{--once}. You can terminate it by using
16852 @code{monitor exit} (@pxref{Monitor Commands for gdbserver}). Note that the
16853 conditions under which @code{gdbserver} terminates depend on how @value{GDBN}
16854 connects to it (@kbd{target remote} or @kbd{target extended-remote}). The
16855 @option{--multi} option to @code{gdbserver} has no influence on that.
16856
16857 @subsubsection TCP port allocation lifecycle of @code{gdbserver}
16858
16859 This section applies only when @code{gdbserver} is run to listen on a TCP port.
16860
16861 @code{gdbserver} normally terminates after all of its debugged processes have
16862 terminated in @kbd{target remote} mode. On the other hand, for @kbd{target
16863 extended-remote}, @code{gdbserver} stays running even with no processes left.
16864 @value{GDBN} normally terminates the spawned debugged process on its exit,
16865 which normally also terminates @code{gdbserver} in the @kbd{target remote}
16866 mode. Therefore, when the connection drops unexpectedly, and @value{GDBN}
16867 cannot ask @code{gdbserver} to kill its debugged processes, @code{gdbserver}
16868 stays running even in the @kbd{target remote} mode.
16869
16870 When @code{gdbserver} stays running, @value{GDBN} can connect to it again later.
16871 Such reconnecting is useful for features like @ref{disconnected tracing}. For
16872 completeness, at most one @value{GDBN} can be connected at a time.
16873
16874 @cindex @option{--once}, @code{gdbserver} option
16875 By default, @code{gdbserver} keeps the listening TCP port open, so that
16876 additional connections are possible. However, if you start @code{gdbserver}
16877 with the @option{--once} option, it will stop listening for any further
16878 connection attempts after connecting to the first @value{GDBN} session. This
16879 means no further connections to @code{gdbserver} will be possible after the
16880 first one. It also means @code{gdbserver} will terminate after the first
16881 connection with remote @value{GDBN} has closed, even for unexpectedly closed
16882 connections and even in the @kbd{target extended-remote} mode. The
16883 @option{--once} option allows reusing the same port number for connecting to
16884 multiple instances of @code{gdbserver} running on the same host, since each
16885 instance closes its port after the first connection.
16886
16887 @subsubsection Other Command-Line Arguments for @code{gdbserver}
16888
16889 @cindex @option{--debug}, @code{gdbserver} option
16890 The @option{--debug} option tells @code{gdbserver} to display extra
16891 status information about the debugging process.
16892 @cindex @option{--remote-debug}, @code{gdbserver} option
16893 The @option{--remote-debug} option tells @code{gdbserver} to display
16894 remote protocol debug output. These options are intended for
16895 @code{gdbserver} development and for bug reports to the developers.
16896
16897 @cindex @option{--wrapper}, @code{gdbserver} option
16898 The @option{--wrapper} option specifies a wrapper to launch programs
16899 for debugging. The option should be followed by the name of the
16900 wrapper, then any command-line arguments to pass to the wrapper, then
16901 @kbd{--} indicating the end of the wrapper arguments.
16902
16903 @code{gdbserver} runs the specified wrapper program with a combined
16904 command line including the wrapper arguments, then the name of the
16905 program to debug, then any arguments to the program. The wrapper
16906 runs until it executes your program, and then @value{GDBN} gains control.
16907
16908 You can use any program that eventually calls @code{execve} with
16909 its arguments as a wrapper. Several standard Unix utilities do
16910 this, e.g.@: @code{env} and @code{nohup}. Any Unix shell script ending
16911 with @code{exec "$@@"} will also work.
16912
16913 For example, you can use @code{env} to pass an environment variable to
16914 the debugged program, without setting the variable in @code{gdbserver}'s
16915 environment:
16916
16917 @smallexample
16918 $ gdbserver --wrapper env LD_PRELOAD=libtest.so -- :2222 ./testprog
16919 @end smallexample
16920
16921 @subsection Connecting to @code{gdbserver}
16922
16923 Run @value{GDBN} on the host system.
16924
16925 First make sure you have the necessary symbol files. Load symbols for
16926 your application using the @code{file} command before you connect. Use
16927 @code{set sysroot} to locate target libraries (unless your @value{GDBN}
16928 was compiled with the correct sysroot using @code{--with-sysroot}).
16929
16930 The symbol file and target libraries must exactly match the executable
16931 and libraries on the target, with one exception: the files on the host
16932 system should not be stripped, even if the files on the target system
16933 are. Mismatched or missing files will lead to confusing results
16934 during debugging. On @sc{gnu}/Linux targets, mismatched or missing
16935 files may also prevent @code{gdbserver} from debugging multi-threaded
16936 programs.
16937
16938 Connect to your target (@pxref{Connecting,,Connecting to a Remote Target}).
16939 For TCP connections, you must start up @code{gdbserver} prior to using
16940 the @code{target remote} command. Otherwise you may get an error whose
16941 text depends on the host system, but which usually looks something like
16942 @samp{Connection refused}. Don't use the @code{load}
16943 command in @value{GDBN} when using @code{gdbserver}, since the program is
16944 already on the target.
16945
16946 @subsection Monitor Commands for @code{gdbserver}
16947 @cindex monitor commands, for @code{gdbserver}
16948 @anchor{Monitor Commands for gdbserver}
16949
16950 During a @value{GDBN} session using @code{gdbserver}, you can use the
16951 @code{monitor} command to send special requests to @code{gdbserver}.
16952 Here are the available commands.
16953
16954 @table @code
16955 @item monitor help
16956 List the available monitor commands.
16957
16958 @item monitor set debug 0
16959 @itemx monitor set debug 1
16960 Disable or enable general debugging messages.
16961
16962 @item monitor set remote-debug 0
16963 @itemx monitor set remote-debug 1
16964 Disable or enable specific debugging messages associated with the remote
16965 protocol (@pxref{Remote Protocol}).
16966
16967 @item monitor set libthread-db-search-path [PATH]
16968 @cindex gdbserver, search path for @code{libthread_db}
16969 When this command is issued, @var{path} is a colon-separated list of
16970 directories to search for @code{libthread_db} (@pxref{Threads,,set
16971 libthread-db-search-path}). If you omit @var{path},
16972 @samp{libthread-db-search-path} will be reset to its default value.
16973
16974 The special entry @samp{$pdir} for @samp{libthread-db-search-path} is
16975 not supported in @code{gdbserver}.
16976
16977 @item monitor exit
16978 Tell gdbserver to exit immediately. This command should be followed by
16979 @code{disconnect} to close the debugging session. @code{gdbserver} will
16980 detach from any attached processes and kill any processes it created.
16981 Use @code{monitor exit} to terminate @code{gdbserver} at the end
16982 of a multi-process mode debug session.
16983
16984 @end table
16985
16986 @subsection Tracepoints support in @code{gdbserver}
16987 @cindex tracepoints support in @code{gdbserver}
16988
16989 On some targets, @code{gdbserver} supports tracepoints, fast
16990 tracepoints and static tracepoints.
16991
16992 For fast or static tracepoints to work, a special library called the
16993 @dfn{in-process agent} (IPA), must be loaded in the inferior process.
16994 This library is built and distributed as an integral part of
16995 @code{gdbserver}. In addition, support for static tracepoints
16996 requires building the in-process agent library with static tracepoints
16997 support. At present, the UST (LTTng Userspace Tracer,
16998 @url{http://lttng.org/ust}) tracing engine is supported. This support
16999 is automatically available if UST development headers are found in the
17000 standard include path when @code{gdbserver} is built, or if
17001 @code{gdbserver} was explicitly configured using @option{--with-ust}
17002 to point at such headers. You can explicitly disable the support
17003 using @option{--with-ust=no}.
17004
17005 There are several ways to load the in-process agent in your program:
17006
17007 @table @code
17008 @item Specifying it as dependency at link time
17009
17010 You can link your program dynamically with the in-process agent
17011 library. On most systems, this is accomplished by adding
17012 @code{-linproctrace} to the link command.
17013
17014 @item Using the system's preloading mechanisms
17015
17016 You can force loading the in-process agent at startup time by using
17017 your system's support for preloading shared libraries. Many Unixes
17018 support the concept of preloading user defined libraries. In most
17019 cases, you do that by specifying @code{LD_PRELOAD=libinproctrace.so}
17020 in the environment. See also the description of @code{gdbserver}'s
17021 @option{--wrapper} command line option.
17022
17023 @item Using @value{GDBN} to force loading the agent at run time
17024
17025 On some systems, you can force the inferior to load a shared library,
17026 by calling a dynamic loader function in the inferior that takes care
17027 of dynamically looking up and loading a shared library. On most Unix
17028 systems, the function is @code{dlopen}. You'll use the @code{call}
17029 command for that. For example:
17030
17031 @smallexample
17032 (@value{GDBP}) call dlopen ("libinproctrace.so", ...)
17033 @end smallexample
17034
17035 Note that on most Unix systems, for the @code{dlopen} function to be
17036 available, the program needs to be linked with @code{-ldl}.
17037 @end table
17038
17039 On systems that have a userspace dynamic loader, like most Unix
17040 systems, when you connect to @code{gdbserver} using @code{target
17041 remote}, you'll find that the program is stopped at the dynamic
17042 loader's entry point, and no shared library has been loaded in the
17043 program's address space yet, including the in-process agent. In that
17044 case, before being able to use any of the fast or static tracepoints
17045 features, you need to let the loader run and load the shared
17046 libraries. The simplest way to do that is to run the program to the
17047 main procedure. E.g., if debugging a C or C@t{++} program, start
17048 @code{gdbserver} like so:
17049
17050 @smallexample
17051 $ gdbserver :9999 myprogram
17052 @end smallexample
17053
17054 Start GDB and connect to @code{gdbserver} like so, and run to main:
17055
17056 @smallexample
17057 $ gdb myprogram
17058 (@value{GDBP}) target remote myhost:9999
17059 0x00007f215893ba60 in ?? () from /lib64/ld-linux-x86-64.so.2
17060 (@value{GDBP}) b main
17061 (@value{GDBP}) continue
17062 @end smallexample
17063
17064 The in-process tracing agent library should now be loaded into the
17065 process; you can confirm it with the @code{info sharedlibrary}
17066 command, which will list @file{libinproctrace.so} as loaded in the
17067 process. You are now ready to install fast tracepoints, list static
17068 tracepoint markers, probe static tracepoints markers, and start
17069 tracing.
17070
17071 @node Remote Configuration
17072 @section Remote Configuration
17073
17074 @kindex set remote
17075 @kindex show remote
17076 This section documents the configuration options available when
17077 debugging remote programs. For the options related to the File I/O
17078 extensions of the remote protocol, see @ref{system,
17079 system-call-allowed}.
17080
17081 @table @code
17082 @item set remoteaddresssize @var{bits}
17083 @cindex address size for remote targets
17084 @cindex bits in remote address
17085 Set the maximum size of address in a memory packet to the specified
17086 number of bits. @value{GDBN} will mask off the address bits above
17087 that number, when it passes addresses to the remote target. The
17088 default value is the number of bits in the target's address.
17089
17090 @item show remoteaddresssize
17091 Show the current value of remote address size in bits.
17092
17093 @item set remotebaud @var{n}
17094 @cindex baud rate for remote targets
17095 Set the baud rate for the remote serial I/O to @var{n} baud. The
17096 value is used to set the speed of the serial port used for debugging
17097 remote targets.
17098
17099 @item show remotebaud
17100 Show the current speed of the remote connection.
17101
17102 @item set remotebreak
17103 @cindex interrupt remote programs
17104 @cindex BREAK signal instead of Ctrl-C
17105 @anchor{set remotebreak}
17106 If set to on, @value{GDBN} sends a @code{BREAK} signal to the remote
17107 when you type @kbd{Ctrl-c} to interrupt the program running
17108 on the remote. If set to off, @value{GDBN} sends the @samp{Ctrl-C}
17109 character instead. The default is off, since most remote systems
17110 expect to see @samp{Ctrl-C} as the interrupt signal.
17111
17112 @item show remotebreak
17113 Show whether @value{GDBN} sends @code{BREAK} or @samp{Ctrl-C} to
17114 interrupt the remote program.
17115
17116 @item set remoteflow on
17117 @itemx set remoteflow off
17118 @kindex set remoteflow
17119 Enable or disable hardware flow control (@code{RTS}/@code{CTS})
17120 on the serial port used to communicate to the remote target.
17121
17122 @item show remoteflow
17123 @kindex show remoteflow
17124 Show the current setting of hardware flow control.
17125
17126 @item set remotelogbase @var{base}
17127 Set the base (a.k.a.@: radix) of logging serial protocol
17128 communications to @var{base}. Supported values of @var{base} are:
17129 @code{ascii}, @code{octal}, and @code{hex}. The default is
17130 @code{ascii}.
17131
17132 @item show remotelogbase
17133 Show the current setting of the radix for logging remote serial
17134 protocol.
17135
17136 @item set remotelogfile @var{file}
17137 @cindex record serial communications on file
17138 Record remote serial communications on the named @var{file}. The
17139 default is not to record at all.
17140
17141 @item show remotelogfile.
17142 Show the current setting of the file name on which to record the
17143 serial communications.
17144
17145 @item set remotetimeout @var{num}
17146 @cindex timeout for serial communications
17147 @cindex remote timeout
17148 Set the timeout limit to wait for the remote target to respond to
17149 @var{num} seconds. The default is 2 seconds.
17150
17151 @item show remotetimeout
17152 Show the current number of seconds to wait for the remote target
17153 responses.
17154
17155 @cindex limit hardware breakpoints and watchpoints
17156 @cindex remote target, limit break- and watchpoints
17157 @anchor{set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit}
17158 @anchor{set remote hardware-breakpoint-limit}
17159 @item set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit @var{limit}
17160 @itemx set remote hardware-breakpoint-limit @var{limit}
17161 Restrict @value{GDBN} to using @var{limit} remote hardware breakpoint or
17162 watchpoints. A limit of -1, the default, is treated as unlimited.
17163
17164 @cindex limit hardware watchpoints length
17165 @cindex remote target, limit watchpoints length
17166 @anchor{set remote hardware-watchpoint-length-limit}
17167 @item set remote hardware-watchpoint-length-limit @var{limit}
17168 Restrict @value{GDBN} to using @var{limit} bytes for the maximum length of
17169 a remote hardware watchpoint. A limit of -1, the default, is treated
17170 as unlimited.
17171
17172 @item show remote hardware-watchpoint-length-limit
17173 Show the current limit (in bytes) of the maximum length of
17174 a remote hardware watchpoint.
17175
17176 @item set remote exec-file @var{filename}
17177 @itemx show remote exec-file
17178 @anchor{set remote exec-file}
17179 @cindex executable file, for remote target
17180 Select the file used for @code{run} with @code{target
17181 extended-remote}. This should be set to a filename valid on the
17182 target system. If it is not set, the target will use a default
17183 filename (e.g.@: the last program run).
17184
17185 @item set remote interrupt-sequence
17186 @cindex interrupt remote programs
17187 @cindex select Ctrl-C, BREAK or BREAK-g
17188 Allow the user to select one of @samp{Ctrl-C}, a @code{BREAK} or
17189 @samp{BREAK-g} as the
17190 sequence to the remote target in order to interrupt the execution.
17191 @samp{Ctrl-C} is a default. Some system prefers @code{BREAK} which
17192 is high level of serial line for some certain time.
17193 Linux kernel prefers @samp{BREAK-g}, a.k.a Magic SysRq g.
17194 It is @code{BREAK} signal followed by character @code{g}.
17195
17196 @item show interrupt-sequence
17197 Show which of @samp{Ctrl-C}, @code{BREAK} or @code{BREAK-g}
17198 is sent by @value{GDBN} to interrupt the remote program.
17199 @code{BREAK-g} is BREAK signal followed by @code{g} and
17200 also known as Magic SysRq g.
17201
17202 @item set remote interrupt-on-connect
17203 @cindex send interrupt-sequence on start
17204 Specify whether interrupt-sequence is sent to remote target when
17205 @value{GDBN} connects to it. This is mostly needed when you debug
17206 Linux kernel. Linux kernel expects @code{BREAK} followed by @code{g}
17207 which is known as Magic SysRq g in order to connect @value{GDBN}.
17208
17209 @item show interrupt-on-connect
17210 Show whether interrupt-sequence is sent
17211 to remote target when @value{GDBN} connects to it.
17212
17213 @kindex set tcp
17214 @kindex show tcp
17215 @item set tcp auto-retry on
17216 @cindex auto-retry, for remote TCP target
17217 Enable auto-retry for remote TCP connections. This is useful if the remote
17218 debugging agent is launched in parallel with @value{GDBN}; there is a race
17219 condition because the agent may not become ready to accept the connection
17220 before @value{GDBN} attempts to connect. When auto-retry is
17221 enabled, if the initial attempt to connect fails, @value{GDBN} reattempts
17222 to establish the connection using the timeout specified by
17223 @code{set tcp connect-timeout}.
17224
17225 @item set tcp auto-retry off
17226 Do not auto-retry failed TCP connections.
17227
17228 @item show tcp auto-retry
17229 Show the current auto-retry setting.
17230
17231 @item set tcp connect-timeout @var{seconds}
17232 @cindex connection timeout, for remote TCP target
17233 @cindex timeout, for remote target connection
17234 Set the timeout for establishing a TCP connection to the remote target to
17235 @var{seconds}. The timeout affects both polling to retry failed connections
17236 (enabled by @code{set tcp auto-retry on}) and waiting for connections
17237 that are merely slow to complete, and represents an approximate cumulative
17238 value.
17239
17240 @item show tcp connect-timeout
17241 Show the current connection timeout setting.
17242 @end table
17243
17244 @cindex remote packets, enabling and disabling
17245 The @value{GDBN} remote protocol autodetects the packets supported by
17246 your debugging stub. If you need to override the autodetection, you
17247 can use these commands to enable or disable individual packets. Each
17248 packet can be set to @samp{on} (the remote target supports this
17249 packet), @samp{off} (the remote target does not support this packet),
17250 or @samp{auto} (detect remote target support for this packet). They
17251 all default to @samp{auto}. For more information about each packet,
17252 see @ref{Remote Protocol}.
17253
17254 During normal use, you should not have to use any of these commands.
17255 If you do, that may be a bug in your remote debugging stub, or a bug
17256 in @value{GDBN}. You may want to report the problem to the
17257 @value{GDBN} developers.
17258
17259 For each packet @var{name}, the command to enable or disable the
17260 packet is @code{set remote @var{name}-packet}. The available settings
17261 are:
17262
17263 @multitable @columnfractions 0.28 0.32 0.25
17264 @item Command Name
17265 @tab Remote Packet
17266 @tab Related Features
17267
17268 @item @code{fetch-register}
17269 @tab @code{p}
17270 @tab @code{info registers}
17271
17272 @item @code{set-register}
17273 @tab @code{P}
17274 @tab @code{set}
17275
17276 @item @code{binary-download}
17277 @tab @code{X}
17278 @tab @code{load}, @code{set}
17279
17280 @item @code{read-aux-vector}
17281 @tab @code{qXfer:auxv:read}
17282 @tab @code{info auxv}
17283
17284 @item @code{symbol-lookup}
17285 @tab @code{qSymbol}
17286 @tab Detecting multiple threads
17287
17288 @item @code{attach}
17289 @tab @code{vAttach}
17290 @tab @code{attach}
17291
17292 @item @code{verbose-resume}
17293 @tab @code{vCont}
17294 @tab Stepping or resuming multiple threads
17295
17296 @item @code{run}
17297 @tab @code{vRun}
17298 @tab @code{run}
17299
17300 @item @code{software-breakpoint}
17301 @tab @code{Z0}
17302 @tab @code{break}
17303
17304 @item @code{hardware-breakpoint}
17305 @tab @code{Z1}
17306 @tab @code{hbreak}
17307
17308 @item @code{write-watchpoint}
17309 @tab @code{Z2}
17310 @tab @code{watch}
17311
17312 @item @code{read-watchpoint}
17313 @tab @code{Z3}
17314 @tab @code{rwatch}
17315
17316 @item @code{access-watchpoint}
17317 @tab @code{Z4}
17318 @tab @code{awatch}
17319
17320 @item @code{target-features}
17321 @tab @code{qXfer:features:read}
17322 @tab @code{set architecture}
17323
17324 @item @code{library-info}
17325 @tab @code{qXfer:libraries:read}
17326 @tab @code{info sharedlibrary}
17327
17328 @item @code{memory-map}
17329 @tab @code{qXfer:memory-map:read}
17330 @tab @code{info mem}
17331
17332 @item @code{read-sdata-object}
17333 @tab @code{qXfer:sdata:read}
17334 @tab @code{print $_sdata}
17335
17336 @item @code{read-spu-object}
17337 @tab @code{qXfer:spu:read}
17338 @tab @code{info spu}
17339
17340 @item @code{write-spu-object}
17341 @tab @code{qXfer:spu:write}
17342 @tab @code{info spu}
17343
17344 @item @code{read-siginfo-object}
17345 @tab @code{qXfer:siginfo:read}
17346 @tab @code{print $_siginfo}
17347
17348 @item @code{write-siginfo-object}
17349 @tab @code{qXfer:siginfo:write}
17350 @tab @code{set $_siginfo}
17351
17352 @item @code{threads}
17353 @tab @code{qXfer:threads:read}
17354 @tab @code{info threads}
17355
17356 @item @code{get-thread-local-@*storage-address}
17357 @tab @code{qGetTLSAddr}
17358 @tab Displaying @code{__thread} variables
17359
17360 @item @code{get-thread-information-block-address}
17361 @tab @code{qGetTIBAddr}
17362 @tab Display MS-Windows Thread Information Block.
17363
17364 @item @code{search-memory}
17365 @tab @code{qSearch:memory}
17366 @tab @code{find}
17367
17368 @item @code{supported-packets}
17369 @tab @code{qSupported}
17370 @tab Remote communications parameters
17371
17372 @item @code{pass-signals}
17373 @tab @code{QPassSignals}
17374 @tab @code{handle @var{signal}}
17375
17376 @item @code{hostio-close-packet}
17377 @tab @code{vFile:close}
17378 @tab @code{remote get}, @code{remote put}
17379
17380 @item @code{hostio-open-packet}
17381 @tab @code{vFile:open}
17382 @tab @code{remote get}, @code{remote put}
17383
17384 @item @code{hostio-pread-packet}
17385 @tab @code{vFile:pread}
17386 @tab @code{remote get}, @code{remote put}
17387
17388 @item @code{hostio-pwrite-packet}
17389 @tab @code{vFile:pwrite}
17390 @tab @code{remote get}, @code{remote put}
17391
17392 @item @code{hostio-unlink-packet}
17393 @tab @code{vFile:unlink}
17394 @tab @code{remote delete}
17395
17396 @item @code{noack-packet}
17397 @tab @code{QStartNoAckMode}
17398 @tab Packet acknowledgment
17399
17400 @item @code{osdata}
17401 @tab @code{qXfer:osdata:read}
17402 @tab @code{info os}
17403
17404 @item @code{query-attached}
17405 @tab @code{qAttached}
17406 @tab Querying remote process attach state.
17407
17408 @item @code{traceframe-info}
17409 @tab @code{qXfer:traceframe-info:read}
17410 @tab Traceframe info
17411
17412 @item @code{install-in-trace}
17413 @tab @code{InstallInTrace}
17414 @tab Install tracepoint in tracing
17415
17416 @item @code{disable-randomization}
17417 @tab @code{QDisableRandomization}
17418 @tab @code{set disable-randomization}
17419 @end multitable
17420
17421 @node Remote Stub
17422 @section Implementing a Remote Stub
17423
17424 @cindex debugging stub, example
17425 @cindex remote stub, example
17426 @cindex stub example, remote debugging
17427 The stub files provided with @value{GDBN} implement the target side of the
17428 communication protocol, and the @value{GDBN} side is implemented in the
17429 @value{GDBN} source file @file{remote.c}. Normally, you can simply allow
17430 these subroutines to communicate, and ignore the details. (If you're
17431 implementing your own stub file, you can still ignore the details: start
17432 with one of the existing stub files. @file{sparc-stub.c} is the best
17433 organized, and therefore the easiest to read.)
17434
17435 @cindex remote serial debugging, overview
17436 To debug a program running on another machine (the debugging
17437 @dfn{target} machine), you must first arrange for all the usual
17438 prerequisites for the program to run by itself. For example, for a C
17439 program, you need:
17440
17441 @enumerate
17442 @item
17443 A startup routine to set up the C runtime environment; these usually
17444 have a name like @file{crt0}. The startup routine may be supplied by
17445 your hardware supplier, or you may have to write your own.
17446
17447 @item
17448 A C subroutine library to support your program's
17449 subroutine calls, notably managing input and output.
17450
17451 @item
17452 A way of getting your program to the other machine---for example, a
17453 download program. These are often supplied by the hardware
17454 manufacturer, but you may have to write your own from hardware
17455 documentation.
17456 @end enumerate
17457
17458 The next step is to arrange for your program to use a serial port to
17459 communicate with the machine where @value{GDBN} is running (the @dfn{host}
17460 machine). In general terms, the scheme looks like this:
17461
17462 @table @emph
17463 @item On the host,
17464 @value{GDBN} already understands how to use this protocol; when everything
17465 else is set up, you can simply use the @samp{target remote} command
17466 (@pxref{Targets,,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
17467
17468 @item On the target,
17469 you must link with your program a few special-purpose subroutines that
17470 implement the @value{GDBN} remote serial protocol. The file containing these
17471 subroutines is called a @dfn{debugging stub}.
17472
17473 On certain remote targets, you can use an auxiliary program
17474 @code{gdbserver} instead of linking a stub into your program.
17475 @xref{Server,,Using the @code{gdbserver} Program}, for details.
17476 @end table
17477
17478 The debugging stub is specific to the architecture of the remote
17479 machine; for example, use @file{sparc-stub.c} to debug programs on
17480 @sc{sparc} boards.
17481
17482 @cindex remote serial stub list
17483 These working remote stubs are distributed with @value{GDBN}:
17484
17485 @table @code
17486
17487 @item i386-stub.c
17488 @cindex @file{i386-stub.c}
17489 @cindex Intel
17490 @cindex i386
17491 For Intel 386 and compatible architectures.
17492
17493 @item m68k-stub.c
17494 @cindex @file{m68k-stub.c}
17495 @cindex Motorola 680x0
17496 @cindex m680x0
17497 For Motorola 680x0 architectures.
17498
17499 @item sh-stub.c
17500 @cindex @file{sh-stub.c}
17501 @cindex Renesas
17502 @cindex SH
17503 For Renesas SH architectures.
17504
17505 @item sparc-stub.c
17506 @cindex @file{sparc-stub.c}
17507 @cindex Sparc
17508 For @sc{sparc} architectures.
17509
17510 @item sparcl-stub.c
17511 @cindex @file{sparcl-stub.c}
17512 @cindex Fujitsu
17513 @cindex SparcLite
17514 For Fujitsu @sc{sparclite} architectures.
17515
17516 @end table
17517
17518 The @file{README} file in the @value{GDBN} distribution may list other
17519 recently added stubs.
17520
17521 @menu
17522 * Stub Contents:: What the stub can do for you
17523 * Bootstrapping:: What you must do for the stub
17524 * Debug Session:: Putting it all together
17525 @end menu
17526
17527 @node Stub Contents
17528 @subsection What the Stub Can Do for You
17529
17530 @cindex remote serial stub
17531 The debugging stub for your architecture supplies these three
17532 subroutines:
17533
17534 @table @code
17535 @item set_debug_traps
17536 @findex set_debug_traps
17537 @cindex remote serial stub, initialization
17538 This routine arranges for @code{handle_exception} to run when your
17539 program stops. You must call this subroutine explicitly in your
17540 program's startup code.
17541
17542 @item handle_exception
17543 @findex handle_exception
17544 @cindex remote serial stub, main routine
17545 This is the central workhorse, but your program never calls it
17546 explicitly---the setup code arranges for @code{handle_exception} to
17547 run when a trap is triggered.
17548
17549 @code{handle_exception} takes control when your program stops during
17550 execution (for example, on a breakpoint), and mediates communications
17551 with @value{GDBN} on the host machine. This is where the communications
17552 protocol is implemented; @code{handle_exception} acts as the @value{GDBN}
17553 representative on the target machine. It begins by sending summary
17554 information on the state of your program, then continues to execute,
17555 retrieving and transmitting any information @value{GDBN} needs, until you
17556 execute a @value{GDBN} command that makes your program resume; at that point,
17557 @code{handle_exception} returns control to your own code on the target
17558 machine.
17559
17560 @item breakpoint
17561 @cindex @code{breakpoint} subroutine, remote
17562 Use this auxiliary subroutine to make your program contain a
17563 breakpoint. Depending on the particular situation, this may be the only
17564 way for @value{GDBN} to get control. For instance, if your target
17565 machine has some sort of interrupt button, you won't need to call this;
17566 pressing the interrupt button transfers control to
17567 @code{handle_exception}---in effect, to @value{GDBN}. On some machines,
17568 simply receiving characters on the serial port may also trigger a trap;
17569 again, in that situation, you don't need to call @code{breakpoint} from
17570 your own program---simply running @samp{target remote} from the host
17571 @value{GDBN} session gets control.
17572
17573 Call @code{breakpoint} if none of these is true, or if you simply want
17574 to make certain your program stops at a predetermined point for the
17575 start of your debugging session.
17576 @end table
17577
17578 @node Bootstrapping
17579 @subsection What You Must Do for the Stub
17580
17581 @cindex remote stub, support routines
17582 The debugging stubs that come with @value{GDBN} are set up for a particular
17583 chip architecture, but they have no information about the rest of your
17584 debugging target machine.
17585
17586 First of all you need to tell the stub how to communicate with the
17587 serial port.
17588
17589 @table @code
17590 @item int getDebugChar()
17591 @findex getDebugChar
17592 Write this subroutine to read a single character from the serial port.
17593 It may be identical to @code{getchar} for your target system; a
17594 different name is used to allow you to distinguish the two if you wish.
17595
17596 @item void putDebugChar(int)
17597 @findex putDebugChar
17598 Write this subroutine to write a single character to the serial port.
17599 It may be identical to @code{putchar} for your target system; a
17600 different name is used to allow you to distinguish the two if you wish.
17601 @end table
17602
17603 @cindex control C, and remote debugging
17604 @cindex interrupting remote targets
17605 If you want @value{GDBN} to be able to stop your program while it is
17606 running, you need to use an interrupt-driven serial driver, and arrange
17607 for it to stop when it receives a @code{^C} (@samp{\003}, the control-C
17608 character). That is the character which @value{GDBN} uses to tell the
17609 remote system to stop.
17610
17611 Getting the debugging target to return the proper status to @value{GDBN}
17612 probably requires changes to the standard stub; one quick and dirty way
17613 is to just execute a breakpoint instruction (the ``dirty'' part is that
17614 @value{GDBN} reports a @code{SIGTRAP} instead of a @code{SIGINT}).
17615
17616 Other routines you need to supply are:
17617
17618 @table @code
17619 @item void exceptionHandler (int @var{exception_number}, void *@var{exception_address})
17620 @findex exceptionHandler
17621 Write this function to install @var{exception_address} in the exception
17622 handling tables. You need to do this because the stub does not have any
17623 way of knowing what the exception handling tables on your target system
17624 are like (for example, the processor's table might be in @sc{rom},
17625 containing entries which point to a table in @sc{ram}).
17626 @var{exception_number} is the exception number which should be changed;
17627 its meaning is architecture-dependent (for example, different numbers
17628 might represent divide by zero, misaligned access, etc). When this
17629 exception occurs, control should be transferred directly to
17630 @var{exception_address}, and the processor state (stack, registers,
17631 and so on) should be just as it is when a processor exception occurs. So if
17632 you want to use a jump instruction to reach @var{exception_address}, it
17633 should be a simple jump, not a jump to subroutine.
17634
17635 For the 386, @var{exception_address} should be installed as an interrupt
17636 gate so that interrupts are masked while the handler runs. The gate
17637 should be at privilege level 0 (the most privileged level). The
17638 @sc{sparc} and 68k stubs are able to mask interrupts themselves without
17639 help from @code{exceptionHandler}.
17640
17641 @item void flush_i_cache()
17642 @findex flush_i_cache
17643 On @sc{sparc} and @sc{sparclite} only, write this subroutine to flush the
17644 instruction cache, if any, on your target machine. If there is no
17645 instruction cache, this subroutine may be a no-op.
17646
17647 On target machines that have instruction caches, @value{GDBN} requires this
17648 function to make certain that the state of your program is stable.
17649 @end table
17650
17651 @noindent
17652 You must also make sure this library routine is available:
17653
17654 @table @code
17655 @item void *memset(void *, int, int)
17656 @findex memset
17657 This is the standard library function @code{memset} that sets an area of
17658 memory to a known value. If you have one of the free versions of
17659 @code{libc.a}, @code{memset} can be found there; otherwise, you must
17660 either obtain it from your hardware manufacturer, or write your own.
17661 @end table
17662
17663 If you do not use the GNU C compiler, you may need other standard
17664 library subroutines as well; this varies from one stub to another,
17665 but in general the stubs are likely to use any of the common library
17666 subroutines which @code{@value{NGCC}} generates as inline code.
17667
17668
17669 @node Debug Session
17670 @subsection Putting it All Together
17671
17672 @cindex remote serial debugging summary
17673 In summary, when your program is ready to debug, you must follow these
17674 steps.
17675
17676 @enumerate
17677 @item
17678 Make sure you have defined the supporting low-level routines
17679 (@pxref{Bootstrapping,,What You Must Do for the Stub}):
17680 @display
17681 @code{getDebugChar}, @code{putDebugChar},
17682 @code{flush_i_cache}, @code{memset}, @code{exceptionHandler}.
17683 @end display
17684
17685 @item
17686 Insert these lines in your program's startup code, before the main
17687 procedure is called:
17688
17689 @smallexample
17690 set_debug_traps();
17691 breakpoint();
17692 @end smallexample
17693
17694 On some machines, when a breakpoint trap is raised, the hardware
17695 automatically makes the PC point to the instruction after the
17696 breakpoint. If your machine doesn't do that, you may need to adjust
17697 @code{handle_exception} to arrange for it to return to the instruction
17698 after the breakpoint on this first invocation, so that your program
17699 doesn't keep hitting the initial breakpoint instead of making
17700 progress.
17701
17702 @item
17703 For the 680x0 stub only, you need to provide a variable called
17704 @code{exceptionHook}. Normally you just use:
17705
17706 @smallexample
17707 void (*exceptionHook)() = 0;
17708 @end smallexample
17709
17710 @noindent
17711 but if before calling @code{set_debug_traps}, you set it to point to a
17712 function in your program, that function is called when
17713 @code{@value{GDBN}} continues after stopping on a trap (for example, bus
17714 error). The function indicated by @code{exceptionHook} is called with
17715 one parameter: an @code{int} which is the exception number.
17716
17717 @item
17718 Compile and link together: your program, the @value{GDBN} debugging stub for
17719 your target architecture, and the supporting subroutines.
17720
17721 @item
17722 Make sure you have a serial connection between your target machine and
17723 the @value{GDBN} host, and identify the serial port on the host.
17724
17725 @item
17726 @c The "remote" target now provides a `load' command, so we should
17727 @c document that. FIXME.
17728 Download your program to your target machine (or get it there by
17729 whatever means the manufacturer provides), and start it.
17730
17731 @item
17732 Start @value{GDBN} on the host, and connect to the target
17733 (@pxref{Connecting,,Connecting to a Remote Target}).
17734
17735 @end enumerate
17736
17737 @node Configurations
17738 @chapter Configuration-Specific Information
17739
17740 While nearly all @value{GDBN} commands are available for all native and
17741 cross versions of the debugger, there are some exceptions. This chapter
17742 describes things that are only available in certain configurations.
17743
17744 There are three major categories of configurations: native
17745 configurations, where the host and target are the same, embedded
17746 operating system configurations, which are usually the same for several
17747 different processor architectures, and bare embedded processors, which
17748 are quite different from each other.
17749
17750 @menu
17751 * Native::
17752 * Embedded OS::
17753 * Embedded Processors::
17754 * Architectures::
17755 @end menu
17756
17757 @node Native
17758 @section Native
17759
17760 This section describes details specific to particular native
17761 configurations.
17762
17763 @menu
17764 * HP-UX:: HP-UX
17765 * BSD libkvm Interface:: Debugging BSD kernel memory images
17766 * SVR4 Process Information:: SVR4 process information
17767 * DJGPP Native:: Features specific to the DJGPP port
17768 * Cygwin Native:: Features specific to the Cygwin port
17769 * Hurd Native:: Features specific to @sc{gnu} Hurd
17770 * Neutrino:: Features specific to QNX Neutrino
17771 * Darwin:: Features specific to Darwin
17772 @end menu
17773
17774 @node HP-UX
17775 @subsection HP-UX
17776
17777 On HP-UX systems, if you refer to a function or variable name that
17778 begins with a dollar sign, @value{GDBN} searches for a user or system
17779 name first, before it searches for a convenience variable.
17780
17781
17782 @node BSD libkvm Interface
17783 @subsection BSD libkvm Interface
17784
17785 @cindex libkvm
17786 @cindex kernel memory image
17787 @cindex kernel crash dump
17788
17789 BSD-derived systems (FreeBSD/NetBSD/OpenBSD) have a kernel memory
17790 interface that provides a uniform interface for accessing kernel virtual
17791 memory images, including live systems and crash dumps. @value{GDBN}
17792 uses this interface to allow you to debug live kernels and kernel crash
17793 dumps on many native BSD configurations. This is implemented as a
17794 special @code{kvm} debugging target. For debugging a live system, load
17795 the currently running kernel into @value{GDBN} and connect to the
17796 @code{kvm} target:
17797
17798 @smallexample
17799 (@value{GDBP}) @b{target kvm}
17800 @end smallexample
17801
17802 For debugging crash dumps, provide the file name of the crash dump as an
17803 argument:
17804
17805 @smallexample
17806 (@value{GDBP}) @b{target kvm /var/crash/bsd.0}
17807 @end smallexample
17808
17809 Once connected to the @code{kvm} target, the following commands are
17810 available:
17811
17812 @table @code
17813 @kindex kvm
17814 @item kvm pcb
17815 Set current context from the @dfn{Process Control Block} (PCB) address.
17816
17817 @item kvm proc
17818 Set current context from proc address. This command isn't available on
17819 modern FreeBSD systems.
17820 @end table
17821
17822 @node SVR4 Process Information
17823 @subsection SVR4 Process Information
17824 @cindex /proc
17825 @cindex examine process image
17826 @cindex process info via @file{/proc}
17827
17828 Many versions of SVR4 and compatible systems provide a facility called
17829 @samp{/proc} that can be used to examine the image of a running
17830 process using file-system subroutines. If @value{GDBN} is configured
17831 for an operating system with this facility, the command @code{info
17832 proc} is available to report information about the process running
17833 your program, or about any process running on your system. @code{info
17834 proc} works only on SVR4 systems that include the @code{procfs} code.
17835 This includes, as of this writing, @sc{gnu}/Linux, OSF/1 (Digital
17836 Unix), Solaris, Irix, and Unixware, but not HP-UX, for example.
17837
17838 @table @code
17839 @kindex info proc
17840 @cindex process ID
17841 @item info proc
17842 @itemx info proc @var{process-id}
17843 Summarize available information about any running process. If a
17844 process ID is specified by @var{process-id}, display information about
17845 that process; otherwise display information about the program being
17846 debugged. The summary includes the debugged process ID, the command
17847 line used to invoke it, its current working directory, and its
17848 executable file's absolute file name.
17849
17850 On some systems, @var{process-id} can be of the form
17851 @samp{[@var{pid}]/@var{tid}} which specifies a certain thread ID
17852 within a process. If the optional @var{pid} part is missing, it means
17853 a thread from the process being debugged (the leading @samp{/} still
17854 needs to be present, or else @value{GDBN} will interpret the number as
17855 a process ID rather than a thread ID).
17856
17857 @item info proc mappings
17858 @cindex memory address space mappings
17859 Report the memory address space ranges accessible in the program, with
17860 information on whether the process has read, write, or execute access
17861 rights to each range. On @sc{gnu}/Linux systems, each memory range
17862 includes the object file which is mapped to that range, instead of the
17863 memory access rights to that range.
17864
17865 @item info proc stat
17866 @itemx info proc status
17867 @cindex process detailed status information
17868 These subcommands are specific to @sc{gnu}/Linux systems. They show
17869 the process-related information, including the user ID and group ID;
17870 how many threads are there in the process; its virtual memory usage;
17871 the signals that are pending, blocked, and ignored; its TTY; its
17872 consumption of system and user time; its stack size; its @samp{nice}
17873 value; etc. For more information, see the @samp{proc} man page
17874 (type @kbd{man 5 proc} from your shell prompt).
17875
17876 @item info proc all
17877 Show all the information about the process described under all of the
17878 above @code{info proc} subcommands.
17879
17880 @ignore
17881 @comment These sub-options of 'info proc' were not included when
17882 @comment procfs.c was re-written. Keep their descriptions around
17883 @comment against the day when someone finds the time to put them back in.
17884 @kindex info proc times
17885 @item info proc times
17886 Starting time, user CPU time, and system CPU time for your program and
17887 its children.
17888
17889 @kindex info proc id
17890 @item info proc id
17891 Report on the process IDs related to your program: its own process ID,
17892 the ID of its parent, the process group ID, and the session ID.
17893 @end ignore
17894
17895 @item set procfs-trace
17896 @kindex set procfs-trace
17897 @cindex @code{procfs} API calls
17898 This command enables and disables tracing of @code{procfs} API calls.
17899
17900 @item show procfs-trace
17901 @kindex show procfs-trace
17902 Show the current state of @code{procfs} API call tracing.
17903
17904 @item set procfs-file @var{file}
17905 @kindex set procfs-file
17906 Tell @value{GDBN} to write @code{procfs} API trace to the named
17907 @var{file}. @value{GDBN} appends the trace info to the previous
17908 contents of the file. The default is to display the trace on the
17909 standard output.
17910
17911 @item show procfs-file
17912 @kindex show procfs-file
17913 Show the file to which @code{procfs} API trace is written.
17914
17915 @item proc-trace-entry
17916 @itemx proc-trace-exit
17917 @itemx proc-untrace-entry
17918 @itemx proc-untrace-exit
17919 @kindex proc-trace-entry
17920 @kindex proc-trace-exit
17921 @kindex proc-untrace-entry
17922 @kindex proc-untrace-exit
17923 These commands enable and disable tracing of entries into and exits
17924 from the @code{syscall} interface.
17925
17926 @item info pidlist
17927 @kindex info pidlist
17928 @cindex process list, QNX Neutrino
17929 For QNX Neutrino only, this command displays the list of all the
17930 processes and all the threads within each process.
17931
17932 @item info meminfo
17933 @kindex info meminfo
17934 @cindex mapinfo list, QNX Neutrino
17935 For QNX Neutrino only, this command displays the list of all mapinfos.
17936 @end table
17937
17938 @node DJGPP Native
17939 @subsection Features for Debugging @sc{djgpp} Programs
17940 @cindex @sc{djgpp} debugging
17941 @cindex native @sc{djgpp} debugging
17942 @cindex MS-DOS-specific commands
17943
17944 @cindex DPMI
17945 @sc{djgpp} is a port of the @sc{gnu} development tools to MS-DOS and
17946 MS-Windows. @sc{djgpp} programs are 32-bit protected-mode programs
17947 that use the @dfn{DPMI} (DOS Protected-Mode Interface) API to run on
17948 top of real-mode DOS systems and their emulations.
17949
17950 @value{GDBN} supports native debugging of @sc{djgpp} programs, and
17951 defines a few commands specific to the @sc{djgpp} port. This
17952 subsection describes those commands.
17953
17954 @table @code
17955 @kindex info dos
17956 @item info dos
17957 This is a prefix of @sc{djgpp}-specific commands which print
17958 information about the target system and important OS structures.
17959
17960 @kindex sysinfo
17961 @cindex MS-DOS system info
17962 @cindex free memory information (MS-DOS)
17963 @item info dos sysinfo
17964 This command displays assorted information about the underlying
17965 platform: the CPU type and features, the OS version and flavor, the
17966 DPMI version, and the available conventional and DPMI memory.
17967
17968 @cindex GDT
17969 @cindex LDT
17970 @cindex IDT
17971 @cindex segment descriptor tables
17972 @cindex descriptor tables display
17973 @item info dos gdt
17974 @itemx info dos ldt
17975 @itemx info dos idt
17976 These 3 commands display entries from, respectively, Global, Local,
17977 and Interrupt Descriptor Tables (GDT, LDT, and IDT). The descriptor
17978 tables are data structures which store a descriptor for each segment
17979 that is currently in use. The segment's selector is an index into a
17980 descriptor table; the table entry for that index holds the
17981 descriptor's base address and limit, and its attributes and access
17982 rights.
17983
17984 A typical @sc{djgpp} program uses 3 segments: a code segment, a data
17985 segment (used for both data and the stack), and a DOS segment (which
17986 allows access to DOS/BIOS data structures and absolute addresses in
17987 conventional memory). However, the DPMI host will usually define
17988 additional segments in order to support the DPMI environment.
17989
17990 @cindex garbled pointers
17991 These commands allow to display entries from the descriptor tables.
17992 Without an argument, all entries from the specified table are
17993 displayed. An argument, which should be an integer expression, means
17994 display a single entry whose index is given by the argument. For
17995 example, here's a convenient way to display information about the
17996 debugged program's data segment:
17997
17998 @smallexample
17999 @exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos ldt $ds}
18000 @exdent @code{0x13f: base=0x11970000 limit=0x0009ffff 32-Bit Data (Read/Write, Exp-up)}
18001 @end smallexample
18002
18003 @noindent
18004 This comes in handy when you want to see whether a pointer is outside
18005 the data segment's limit (i.e.@: @dfn{garbled}).
18006
18007 @cindex page tables display (MS-DOS)
18008 @item info dos pde
18009 @itemx info dos pte
18010 These two commands display entries from, respectively, the Page
18011 Directory and the Page Tables. Page Directories and Page Tables are
18012 data structures which control how virtual memory addresses are mapped
18013 into physical addresses. A Page Table includes an entry for every
18014 page of memory that is mapped into the program's address space; there
18015 may be several Page Tables, each one holding up to 4096 entries. A
18016 Page Directory has up to 4096 entries, one each for every Page Table
18017 that is currently in use.
18018
18019 Without an argument, @kbd{info dos pde} displays the entire Page
18020 Directory, and @kbd{info dos pte} displays all the entries in all of
18021 the Page Tables. An argument, an integer expression, given to the
18022 @kbd{info dos pde} command means display only that entry from the Page
18023 Directory table. An argument given to the @kbd{info dos pte} command
18024 means display entries from a single Page Table, the one pointed to by
18025 the specified entry in the Page Directory.
18026
18027 @cindex direct memory access (DMA) on MS-DOS
18028 These commands are useful when your program uses @dfn{DMA} (Direct
18029 Memory Access), which needs physical addresses to program the DMA
18030 controller.
18031
18032 These commands are supported only with some DPMI servers.
18033
18034 @cindex physical address from linear address
18035 @item info dos address-pte @var{addr}
18036 This command displays the Page Table entry for a specified linear
18037 address. The argument @var{addr} is a linear address which should
18038 already have the appropriate segment's base address added to it,
18039 because this command accepts addresses which may belong to @emph{any}
18040 segment. For example, here's how to display the Page Table entry for
18041 the page where a variable @code{i} is stored:
18042
18043 @smallexample
18044 @exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos address-pte __djgpp_base_address + (char *)&i}
18045 @exdent @code{Page Table entry for address 0x11a00d30:}
18046 @exdent @code{Base=0x02698000 Dirty Acc. Not-Cached Write-Back Usr Read-Write +0xd30}
18047 @end smallexample
18048
18049 @noindent
18050 This says that @code{i} is stored at offset @code{0xd30} from the page
18051 whose physical base address is @code{0x02698000}, and shows all the
18052 attributes of that page.
18053
18054 Note that you must cast the addresses of variables to a @code{char *},
18055 since otherwise the value of @code{__djgpp_base_address}, the base
18056 address of all variables and functions in a @sc{djgpp} program, will
18057 be added using the rules of C pointer arithmetics: if @code{i} is
18058 declared an @code{int}, @value{GDBN} will add 4 times the value of
18059 @code{__djgpp_base_address} to the address of @code{i}.
18060
18061 Here's another example, it displays the Page Table entry for the
18062 transfer buffer:
18063
18064 @smallexample
18065 @exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos address-pte *((unsigned *)&_go32_info_block + 3)}
18066 @exdent @code{Page Table entry for address 0x29110:}
18067 @exdent @code{Base=0x00029000 Dirty Acc. Not-Cached Write-Back Usr Read-Write +0x110}
18068 @end smallexample
18069
18070 @noindent
18071 (The @code{+ 3} offset is because the transfer buffer's address is the
18072 3rd member of the @code{_go32_info_block} structure.) The output
18073 clearly shows that this DPMI server maps the addresses in conventional
18074 memory 1:1, i.e.@: the physical (@code{0x00029000} + @code{0x110}) and
18075 linear (@code{0x29110}) addresses are identical.
18076
18077 This command is supported only with some DPMI servers.
18078 @end table
18079
18080 @cindex DOS serial data link, remote debugging
18081 In addition to native debugging, the DJGPP port supports remote
18082 debugging via a serial data link. The following commands are specific
18083 to remote serial debugging in the DJGPP port of @value{GDBN}.
18084
18085 @table @code
18086 @kindex set com1base
18087 @kindex set com1irq
18088 @kindex set com2base
18089 @kindex set com2irq
18090 @kindex set com3base
18091 @kindex set com3irq
18092 @kindex set com4base
18093 @kindex set com4irq
18094 @item set com1base @var{addr}
18095 This command sets the base I/O port address of the @file{COM1} serial
18096 port.
18097
18098 @item set com1irq @var{irq}
18099 This command sets the @dfn{Interrupt Request} (@code{IRQ}) line to use
18100 for the @file{COM1} serial port.
18101
18102 There are similar commands @samp{set com2base}, @samp{set com3irq},
18103 etc.@: for setting the port address and the @code{IRQ} lines for the
18104 other 3 COM ports.
18105
18106 @kindex show com1base
18107 @kindex show com1irq
18108 @kindex show com2base
18109 @kindex show com2irq
18110 @kindex show com3base
18111 @kindex show com3irq
18112 @kindex show com4base
18113 @kindex show com4irq
18114 The related commands @samp{show com1base}, @samp{show com1irq} etc.@:
18115 display the current settings of the base address and the @code{IRQ}
18116 lines used by the COM ports.
18117
18118 @item info serial
18119 @kindex info serial
18120 @cindex DOS serial port status
18121 This command prints the status of the 4 DOS serial ports. For each
18122 port, it prints whether it's active or not, its I/O base address and
18123 IRQ number, whether it uses a 16550-style FIFO, its baudrate, and the
18124 counts of various errors encountered so far.
18125 @end table
18126
18127
18128 @node Cygwin Native
18129 @subsection Features for Debugging MS Windows PE Executables
18130 @cindex MS Windows debugging
18131 @cindex native Cygwin debugging
18132 @cindex Cygwin-specific commands
18133
18134 @value{GDBN} supports native debugging of MS Windows programs, including
18135 DLLs with and without symbolic debugging information.
18136
18137 @cindex Ctrl-BREAK, MS-Windows
18138 @cindex interrupt debuggee on MS-Windows
18139 MS-Windows programs that call @code{SetConsoleMode} to switch off the
18140 special meaning of the @samp{Ctrl-C} keystroke cannot be interrupted
18141 by typing @kbd{C-c}. For this reason, @value{GDBN} on MS-Windows
18142 supports @kbd{C-@key{BREAK}} as an alternative interrupt key
18143 sequence, which can be used to interrupt the debuggee even if it
18144 ignores @kbd{C-c}.
18145
18146 There are various additional Cygwin-specific commands, described in
18147 this section. Working with DLLs that have no debugging symbols is
18148 described in @ref{Non-debug DLL Symbols}.
18149
18150 @table @code
18151 @kindex info w32
18152 @item info w32
18153 This is a prefix of MS Windows-specific commands which print
18154 information about the target system and important OS structures.
18155
18156 @item info w32 selector
18157 This command displays information returned by
18158 the Win32 API @code{GetThreadSelectorEntry} function.
18159 It takes an optional argument that is evaluated to
18160 a long value to give the information about this given selector.
18161 Without argument, this command displays information
18162 about the six segment registers.
18163
18164 @item info w32 thread-information-block
18165 This command displays thread specific information stored in the
18166 Thread Information Block (readable on the X86 CPU family using @code{$fs}
18167 selector for 32-bit programs and @code{$gs} for 64-bit programs).
18168
18169 @kindex info dll
18170 @item info dll
18171 This is a Cygwin-specific alias of @code{info shared}.
18172
18173 @kindex dll-symbols
18174 @item dll-symbols
18175 This command loads symbols from a dll similarly to
18176 add-sym command but without the need to specify a base address.
18177
18178 @kindex set cygwin-exceptions
18179 @cindex debugging the Cygwin DLL
18180 @cindex Cygwin DLL, debugging
18181 @item set cygwin-exceptions @var{mode}
18182 If @var{mode} is @code{on}, @value{GDBN} will break on exceptions that
18183 happen inside the Cygwin DLL. If @var{mode} is @code{off},
18184 @value{GDBN} will delay recognition of exceptions, and may ignore some
18185 exceptions which seem to be caused by internal Cygwin DLL
18186 ``bookkeeping''. This option is meant primarily for debugging the
18187 Cygwin DLL itself; the default value is @code{off} to avoid annoying
18188 @value{GDBN} users with false @code{SIGSEGV} signals.
18189
18190 @kindex show cygwin-exceptions
18191 @item show cygwin-exceptions
18192 Displays whether @value{GDBN} will break on exceptions that happen
18193 inside the Cygwin DLL itself.
18194
18195 @kindex set new-console
18196 @item set new-console @var{mode}
18197 If @var{mode} is @code{on} the debuggee will
18198 be started in a new console on next start.
18199 If @var{mode} is @code{off}, the debuggee will
18200 be started in the same console as the debugger.
18201
18202 @kindex show new-console
18203 @item show new-console
18204 Displays whether a new console is used
18205 when the debuggee is started.
18206
18207 @kindex set new-group
18208 @item set new-group @var{mode}
18209 This boolean value controls whether the debuggee should
18210 start a new group or stay in the same group as the debugger.
18211 This affects the way the Windows OS handles
18212 @samp{Ctrl-C}.
18213
18214 @kindex show new-group
18215 @item show new-group
18216 Displays current value of new-group boolean.
18217
18218 @kindex set debugevents
18219 @item set debugevents
18220 This boolean value adds debug output concerning kernel events related
18221 to the debuggee seen by the debugger. This includes events that
18222 signal thread and process creation and exit, DLL loading and
18223 unloading, console interrupts, and debugging messages produced by the
18224 Windows @code{OutputDebugString} API call.
18225
18226 @kindex set debugexec
18227 @item set debugexec
18228 This boolean value adds debug output concerning execute events
18229 (such as resume thread) seen by the debugger.
18230
18231 @kindex set debugexceptions
18232 @item set debugexceptions
18233 This boolean value adds debug output concerning exceptions in the
18234 debuggee seen by the debugger.
18235
18236 @kindex set debugmemory
18237 @item set debugmemory
18238 This boolean value adds debug output concerning debuggee memory reads
18239 and writes by the debugger.
18240
18241 @kindex set shell
18242 @item set shell
18243 This boolean values specifies whether the debuggee is called
18244 via a shell or directly (default value is on).
18245
18246 @kindex show shell
18247 @item show shell
18248 Displays if the debuggee will be started with a shell.
18249
18250 @end table
18251
18252 @menu
18253 * Non-debug DLL Symbols:: Support for DLLs without debugging symbols
18254 @end menu
18255
18256 @node Non-debug DLL Symbols
18257 @subsubsection Support for DLLs without Debugging Symbols
18258 @cindex DLLs with no debugging symbols
18259 @cindex Minimal symbols and DLLs
18260
18261 Very often on windows, some of the DLLs that your program relies on do
18262 not include symbolic debugging information (for example,
18263 @file{kernel32.dll}). When @value{GDBN} doesn't recognize any debugging
18264 symbols in a DLL, it relies on the minimal amount of symbolic
18265 information contained in the DLL's export table. This section
18266 describes working with such symbols, known internally to @value{GDBN} as
18267 ``minimal symbols''.
18268
18269 Note that before the debugged program has started execution, no DLLs
18270 will have been loaded. The easiest way around this problem is simply to
18271 start the program --- either by setting a breakpoint or letting the
18272 program run once to completion. It is also possible to force
18273 @value{GDBN} to load a particular DLL before starting the executable ---
18274 see the shared library information in @ref{Files}, or the
18275 @code{dll-symbols} command in @ref{Cygwin Native}. Currently,
18276 explicitly loading symbols from a DLL with no debugging information will
18277 cause the symbol names to be duplicated in @value{GDBN}'s lookup table,
18278 which may adversely affect symbol lookup performance.
18279
18280 @subsubsection DLL Name Prefixes
18281
18282 In keeping with the naming conventions used by the Microsoft debugging
18283 tools, DLL export symbols are made available with a prefix based on the
18284 DLL name, for instance @code{KERNEL32!CreateFileA}. The plain name is
18285 also entered into the symbol table, so @code{CreateFileA} is often
18286 sufficient. In some cases there will be name clashes within a program
18287 (particularly if the executable itself includes full debugging symbols)
18288 necessitating the use of the fully qualified name when referring to the
18289 contents of the DLL. Use single-quotes around the name to avoid the
18290 exclamation mark (``!'') being interpreted as a language operator.
18291
18292 Note that the internal name of the DLL may be all upper-case, even
18293 though the file name of the DLL is lower-case, or vice-versa. Since
18294 symbols within @value{GDBN} are @emph{case-sensitive} this may cause
18295 some confusion. If in doubt, try the @code{info functions} and
18296 @code{info variables} commands or even @code{maint print msymbols}
18297 (@pxref{Symbols}). Here's an example:
18298
18299 @smallexample
18300 (@value{GDBP}) info function CreateFileA
18301 All functions matching regular expression "CreateFileA":
18302
18303 Non-debugging symbols:
18304 0x77e885f4 CreateFileA
18305 0x77e885f4 KERNEL32!CreateFileA
18306 @end smallexample
18307
18308 @smallexample
18309 (@value{GDBP}) info function !
18310 All functions matching regular expression "!":
18311
18312 Non-debugging symbols:
18313 0x6100114c cygwin1!__assert
18314 0x61004034 cygwin1!_dll_crt0@@0
18315 0x61004240 cygwin1!dll_crt0(per_process *)
18316 [etc...]
18317 @end smallexample
18318
18319 @subsubsection Working with Minimal Symbols
18320
18321 Symbols extracted from a DLL's export table do not contain very much
18322 type information. All that @value{GDBN} can do is guess whether a symbol
18323 refers to a function or variable depending on the linker section that
18324 contains the symbol. Also note that the actual contents of the memory
18325 contained in a DLL are not available unless the program is running. This
18326 means that you cannot examine the contents of a variable or disassemble
18327 a function within a DLL without a running program.
18328
18329 Variables are generally treated as pointers and dereferenced
18330 automatically. For this reason, it is often necessary to prefix a
18331 variable name with the address-of operator (``&'') and provide explicit
18332 type information in the command. Here's an example of the type of
18333 problem:
18334
18335 @smallexample
18336 (@value{GDBP}) print 'cygwin1!__argv'
18337 $1 = 268572168
18338 @end smallexample
18339
18340 @smallexample
18341 (@value{GDBP}) x 'cygwin1!__argv'
18342 0x10021610: "\230y\""
18343 @end smallexample
18344
18345 And two possible solutions:
18346
18347 @smallexample
18348 (@value{GDBP}) print ((char **)'cygwin1!__argv')[0]
18349 $2 = 0x22fd98 "/cygdrive/c/mydirectory/myprogram"
18350 @end smallexample
18351
18352 @smallexample
18353 (@value{GDBP}) x/2x &'cygwin1!__argv'
18354 0x610c0aa8 <cygwin1!__argv>: 0x10021608 0x00000000
18355 (@value{GDBP}) x/x 0x10021608
18356 0x10021608: 0x0022fd98
18357 (@value{GDBP}) x/s 0x0022fd98
18358 0x22fd98: "/cygdrive/c/mydirectory/myprogram"
18359 @end smallexample
18360
18361 Setting a break point within a DLL is possible even before the program
18362 starts execution. However, under these circumstances, @value{GDBN} can't
18363 examine the initial instructions of the function in order to skip the
18364 function's frame set-up code. You can work around this by using ``*&''
18365 to set the breakpoint at a raw memory address:
18366
18367 @smallexample
18368 (@value{GDBP}) break *&'python22!PyOS_Readline'
18369 Breakpoint 1 at 0x1e04eff0
18370 @end smallexample
18371
18372 The author of these extensions is not entirely convinced that setting a
18373 break point within a shared DLL like @file{kernel32.dll} is completely
18374 safe.
18375
18376 @node Hurd Native
18377 @subsection Commands Specific to @sc{gnu} Hurd Systems
18378 @cindex @sc{gnu} Hurd debugging
18379
18380 This subsection describes @value{GDBN} commands specific to the
18381 @sc{gnu} Hurd native debugging.
18382
18383 @table @code
18384 @item set signals
18385 @itemx set sigs
18386 @kindex set signals@r{, Hurd command}
18387 @kindex set sigs@r{, Hurd command}
18388 This command toggles the state of inferior signal interception by
18389 @value{GDBN}. Mach exceptions, such as breakpoint traps, are not
18390 affected by this command. @code{sigs} is a shorthand alias for
18391 @code{signals}.
18392
18393 @item show signals
18394 @itemx show sigs
18395 @kindex show signals@r{, Hurd command}
18396 @kindex show sigs@r{, Hurd command}
18397 Show the current state of intercepting inferior's signals.
18398
18399 @item set signal-thread
18400 @itemx set sigthread
18401 @kindex set signal-thread
18402 @kindex set sigthread
18403 This command tells @value{GDBN} which thread is the @code{libc} signal
18404 thread. That thread is run when a signal is delivered to a running
18405 process. @code{set sigthread} is the shorthand alias of @code{set
18406 signal-thread}.
18407
18408 @item show signal-thread
18409 @itemx show sigthread
18410 @kindex show signal-thread
18411 @kindex show sigthread
18412 These two commands show which thread will run when the inferior is
18413 delivered a signal.
18414
18415 @item set stopped
18416 @kindex set stopped@r{, Hurd command}
18417 This commands tells @value{GDBN} that the inferior process is stopped,
18418 as with the @code{SIGSTOP} signal. The stopped process can be
18419 continued by delivering a signal to it.
18420
18421 @item show stopped
18422 @kindex show stopped@r{, Hurd command}
18423 This command shows whether @value{GDBN} thinks the debuggee is
18424 stopped.
18425
18426 @item set exceptions
18427 @kindex set exceptions@r{, Hurd command}
18428 Use this command to turn off trapping of exceptions in the inferior.
18429 When exception trapping is off, neither breakpoints nor
18430 single-stepping will work. To restore the default, set exception
18431 trapping on.
18432
18433 @item show exceptions
18434 @kindex show exceptions@r{, Hurd command}
18435 Show the current state of trapping exceptions in the inferior.
18436
18437 @item set task pause
18438 @kindex set task@r{, Hurd commands}
18439 @cindex task attributes (@sc{gnu} Hurd)
18440 @cindex pause current task (@sc{gnu} Hurd)
18441 This command toggles task suspension when @value{GDBN} has control.
18442 Setting it to on takes effect immediately, and the task is suspended
18443 whenever @value{GDBN} gets control. Setting it to off will take
18444 effect the next time the inferior is continued. If this option is set
18445 to off, you can use @code{set thread default pause on} or @code{set
18446 thread pause on} (see below) to pause individual threads.
18447
18448 @item show task pause
18449 @kindex show task@r{, Hurd commands}
18450 Show the current state of task suspension.
18451
18452 @item set task detach-suspend-count
18453 @cindex task suspend count
18454 @cindex detach from task, @sc{gnu} Hurd
18455 This command sets the suspend count the task will be left with when
18456 @value{GDBN} detaches from it.
18457
18458 @item show task detach-suspend-count
18459 Show the suspend count the task will be left with when detaching.
18460
18461 @item set task exception-port
18462 @itemx set task excp
18463 @cindex task exception port, @sc{gnu} Hurd
18464 This command sets the task exception port to which @value{GDBN} will
18465 forward exceptions. The argument should be the value of the @dfn{send
18466 rights} of the task. @code{set task excp} is a shorthand alias.
18467
18468 @item set noninvasive
18469 @cindex noninvasive task options
18470 This command switches @value{GDBN} to a mode that is the least
18471 invasive as far as interfering with the inferior is concerned. This
18472 is the same as using @code{set task pause}, @code{set exceptions}, and
18473 @code{set signals} to values opposite to the defaults.
18474
18475 @item info send-rights
18476 @itemx info receive-rights
18477 @itemx info port-rights
18478 @itemx info port-sets
18479 @itemx info dead-names
18480 @itemx info ports
18481 @itemx info psets
18482 @cindex send rights, @sc{gnu} Hurd
18483 @cindex receive rights, @sc{gnu} Hurd
18484 @cindex port rights, @sc{gnu} Hurd
18485 @cindex port sets, @sc{gnu} Hurd
18486 @cindex dead names, @sc{gnu} Hurd
18487 These commands display information about, respectively, send rights,
18488 receive rights, port rights, port sets, and dead names of a task.
18489 There are also shorthand aliases: @code{info ports} for @code{info
18490 port-rights} and @code{info psets} for @code{info port-sets}.
18491
18492 @item set thread pause
18493 @kindex set thread@r{, Hurd command}
18494 @cindex thread properties, @sc{gnu} Hurd
18495 @cindex pause current thread (@sc{gnu} Hurd)
18496 This command toggles current thread suspension when @value{GDBN} has
18497 control. Setting it to on takes effect immediately, and the current
18498 thread is suspended whenever @value{GDBN} gets control. Setting it to
18499 off will take effect the next time the inferior is continued.
18500 Normally, this command has no effect, since when @value{GDBN} has
18501 control, the whole task is suspended. However, if you used @code{set
18502 task pause off} (see above), this command comes in handy to suspend
18503 only the current thread.
18504
18505 @item show thread pause
18506 @kindex show thread@r{, Hurd command}
18507 This command shows the state of current thread suspension.
18508
18509 @item set thread run
18510 This command sets whether the current thread is allowed to run.
18511
18512 @item show thread run
18513 Show whether the current thread is allowed to run.
18514
18515 @item set thread detach-suspend-count
18516 @cindex thread suspend count, @sc{gnu} Hurd
18517 @cindex detach from thread, @sc{gnu} Hurd
18518 This command sets the suspend count @value{GDBN} will leave on a
18519 thread when detaching. This number is relative to the suspend count
18520 found by @value{GDBN} when it notices the thread; use @code{set thread
18521 takeover-suspend-count} to force it to an absolute value.
18522
18523 @item show thread detach-suspend-count
18524 Show the suspend count @value{GDBN} will leave on the thread when
18525 detaching.
18526
18527 @item set thread exception-port
18528 @itemx set thread excp
18529 Set the thread exception port to which to forward exceptions. This
18530 overrides the port set by @code{set task exception-port} (see above).
18531 @code{set thread excp} is the shorthand alias.
18532
18533 @item set thread takeover-suspend-count
18534 Normally, @value{GDBN}'s thread suspend counts are relative to the
18535 value @value{GDBN} finds when it notices each thread. This command
18536 changes the suspend counts to be absolute instead.
18537
18538 @item set thread default
18539 @itemx show thread default
18540 @cindex thread default settings, @sc{gnu} Hurd
18541 Each of the above @code{set thread} commands has a @code{set thread
18542 default} counterpart (e.g., @code{set thread default pause}, @code{set
18543 thread default exception-port}, etc.). The @code{thread default}
18544 variety of commands sets the default thread properties for all
18545 threads; you can then change the properties of individual threads with
18546 the non-default commands.
18547 @end table
18548
18549
18550 @node Neutrino
18551 @subsection QNX Neutrino
18552 @cindex QNX Neutrino
18553
18554 @value{GDBN} provides the following commands specific to the QNX
18555 Neutrino target:
18556
18557 @table @code
18558 @item set debug nto-debug
18559 @kindex set debug nto-debug
18560 When set to on, enables debugging messages specific to the QNX
18561 Neutrino support.
18562
18563 @item show debug nto-debug
18564 @kindex show debug nto-debug
18565 Show the current state of QNX Neutrino messages.
18566 @end table
18567
18568 @node Darwin
18569 @subsection Darwin
18570 @cindex Darwin
18571
18572 @value{GDBN} provides the following commands specific to the Darwin target:
18573
18574 @table @code
18575 @item set debug darwin @var{num}
18576 @kindex set debug darwin
18577 When set to a non zero value, enables debugging messages specific to
18578 the Darwin support. Higher values produce more verbose output.
18579
18580 @item show debug darwin
18581 @kindex show debug darwin
18582 Show the current state of Darwin messages.
18583
18584 @item set debug mach-o @var{num}
18585 @kindex set debug mach-o
18586 When set to a non zero value, enables debugging messages while
18587 @value{GDBN} is reading Darwin object files. (@dfn{Mach-O} is the
18588 file format used on Darwin for object and executable files.) Higher
18589 values produce more verbose output. This is a command to diagnose
18590 problems internal to @value{GDBN} and should not be needed in normal
18591 usage.
18592
18593 @item show debug mach-o
18594 @kindex show debug mach-o
18595 Show the current state of Mach-O file messages.
18596
18597 @item set mach-exceptions on
18598 @itemx set mach-exceptions off
18599 @kindex set mach-exceptions
18600 On Darwin, faults are first reported as a Mach exception and are then
18601 mapped to a Posix signal. Use this command to turn on trapping of
18602 Mach exceptions in the inferior. This might be sometimes useful to
18603 better understand the cause of a fault. The default is off.
18604
18605 @item show mach-exceptions
18606 @kindex show mach-exceptions
18607 Show the current state of exceptions trapping.
18608 @end table
18609
18610
18611 @node Embedded OS
18612 @section Embedded Operating Systems
18613
18614 This section describes configurations involving the debugging of
18615 embedded operating systems that are available for several different
18616 architectures.
18617
18618 @menu
18619 * VxWorks:: Using @value{GDBN} with VxWorks
18620 @end menu
18621
18622 @value{GDBN} includes the ability to debug programs running on
18623 various real-time operating systems.
18624
18625 @node VxWorks
18626 @subsection Using @value{GDBN} with VxWorks
18627
18628 @cindex VxWorks
18629
18630 @table @code
18631
18632 @kindex target vxworks
18633 @item target vxworks @var{machinename}
18634 A VxWorks system, attached via TCP/IP. The argument @var{machinename}
18635 is the target system's machine name or IP address.
18636
18637 @end table
18638
18639 On VxWorks, @code{load} links @var{filename} dynamically on the
18640 current target system as well as adding its symbols in @value{GDBN}.
18641
18642 @value{GDBN} enables developers to spawn and debug tasks running on networked
18643 VxWorks targets from a Unix host. Already-running tasks spawned from
18644 the VxWorks shell can also be debugged. @value{GDBN} uses code that runs on
18645 both the Unix host and on the VxWorks target. The program
18646 @code{@value{GDBP}} is installed and executed on the Unix host. (It may be
18647 installed with the name @code{vxgdb}, to distinguish it from a
18648 @value{GDBN} for debugging programs on the host itself.)
18649
18650 @table @code
18651 @item VxWorks-timeout @var{args}
18652 @kindex vxworks-timeout
18653 All VxWorks-based targets now support the option @code{vxworks-timeout}.
18654 This option is set by the user, and @var{args} represents the number of
18655 seconds @value{GDBN} waits for responses to rpc's. You might use this if
18656 your VxWorks target is a slow software simulator or is on the far side
18657 of a thin network line.
18658 @end table
18659
18660 The following information on connecting to VxWorks was current when
18661 this manual was produced; newer releases of VxWorks may use revised
18662 procedures.
18663
18664 @findex INCLUDE_RDB
18665 To use @value{GDBN} with VxWorks, you must rebuild your VxWorks kernel
18666 to include the remote debugging interface routines in the VxWorks
18667 library @file{rdb.a}. To do this, define @code{INCLUDE_RDB} in the
18668 VxWorks configuration file @file{configAll.h} and rebuild your VxWorks
18669 kernel. The resulting kernel contains @file{rdb.a}, and spawns the
18670 source debugging task @code{tRdbTask} when VxWorks is booted. For more
18671 information on configuring and remaking VxWorks, see the manufacturer's
18672 manual.
18673 @c VxWorks, see the @cite{VxWorks Programmer's Guide}.
18674
18675 Once you have included @file{rdb.a} in your VxWorks system image and set
18676 your Unix execution search path to find @value{GDBN}, you are ready to
18677 run @value{GDBN}. From your Unix host, run @code{@value{GDBP}} (or
18678 @code{vxgdb}, depending on your installation).
18679
18680 @value{GDBN} comes up showing the prompt:
18681
18682 @smallexample
18683 (vxgdb)
18684 @end smallexample
18685
18686 @menu
18687 * VxWorks Connection:: Connecting to VxWorks
18688 * VxWorks Download:: VxWorks download
18689 * VxWorks Attach:: Running tasks
18690 @end menu
18691
18692 @node VxWorks Connection
18693 @subsubsection Connecting to VxWorks
18694
18695 The @value{GDBN} command @code{target} lets you connect to a VxWorks target on the
18696 network. To connect to a target whose host name is ``@code{tt}'', type:
18697
18698 @smallexample
18699 (vxgdb) target vxworks tt
18700 @end smallexample
18701
18702 @need 750
18703 @value{GDBN} displays messages like these:
18704
18705 @smallexample
18706 Attaching remote machine across net...
18707 Connected to tt.
18708 @end smallexample
18709
18710 @need 1000
18711 @value{GDBN} then attempts to read the symbol tables of any object modules
18712 loaded into the VxWorks target since it was last booted. @value{GDBN} locates
18713 these files by searching the directories listed in the command search
18714 path (@pxref{Environment, ,Your Program's Environment}); if it fails
18715 to find an object file, it displays a message such as:
18716
18717 @smallexample
18718 prog.o: No such file or directory.
18719 @end smallexample
18720
18721 When this happens, add the appropriate directory to the search path with
18722 the @value{GDBN} command @code{path}, and execute the @code{target}
18723 command again.
18724
18725 @node VxWorks Download
18726 @subsubsection VxWorks Download
18727
18728 @cindex download to VxWorks
18729 If you have connected to the VxWorks target and you want to debug an
18730 object that has not yet been loaded, you can use the @value{GDBN}
18731 @code{load} command to download a file from Unix to VxWorks
18732 incrementally. The object file given as an argument to the @code{load}
18733 command is actually opened twice: first by the VxWorks target in order
18734 to download the code, then by @value{GDBN} in order to read the symbol
18735 table. This can lead to problems if the current working directories on
18736 the two systems differ. If both systems have NFS mounted the same
18737 filesystems, you can avoid these problems by using absolute paths.
18738 Otherwise, it is simplest to set the working directory on both systems
18739 to the directory in which the object file resides, and then to reference
18740 the file by its name, without any path. For instance, a program
18741 @file{prog.o} may reside in @file{@var{vxpath}/vw/demo/rdb} in VxWorks
18742 and in @file{@var{hostpath}/vw/demo/rdb} on the host. To load this
18743 program, type this on VxWorks:
18744
18745 @smallexample
18746 -> cd "@var{vxpath}/vw/demo/rdb"
18747 @end smallexample
18748
18749 @noindent
18750 Then, in @value{GDBN}, type:
18751
18752 @smallexample
18753 (vxgdb) cd @var{hostpath}/vw/demo/rdb
18754 (vxgdb) load prog.o
18755 @end smallexample
18756
18757 @value{GDBN} displays a response similar to this:
18758
18759 @smallexample
18760 Reading symbol data from wherever/vw/demo/rdb/prog.o... done.
18761 @end smallexample
18762
18763 You can also use the @code{load} command to reload an object module
18764 after editing and recompiling the corresponding source file. Note that
18765 this makes @value{GDBN} delete all currently-defined breakpoints,
18766 auto-displays, and convenience variables, and to clear the value
18767 history. (This is necessary in order to preserve the integrity of
18768 debugger's data structures that reference the target system's symbol
18769 table.)
18770
18771 @node VxWorks Attach
18772 @subsubsection Running Tasks
18773
18774 @cindex running VxWorks tasks
18775 You can also attach to an existing task using the @code{attach} command as
18776 follows:
18777
18778 @smallexample
18779 (vxgdb) attach @var{task}
18780 @end smallexample
18781
18782 @noindent
18783 where @var{task} is the VxWorks hexadecimal task ID. The task can be running
18784 or suspended when you attach to it. Running tasks are suspended at
18785 the time of attachment.
18786
18787 @node Embedded Processors
18788 @section Embedded Processors
18789
18790 This section goes into details specific to particular embedded
18791 configurations.
18792
18793 @cindex send command to simulator
18794 Whenever a specific embedded processor has a simulator, @value{GDBN}
18795 allows to send an arbitrary command to the simulator.
18796
18797 @table @code
18798 @item sim @var{command}
18799 @kindex sim@r{, a command}
18800 Send an arbitrary @var{command} string to the simulator. Consult the
18801 documentation for the specific simulator in use for information about
18802 acceptable commands.
18803 @end table
18804
18805
18806 @menu
18807 * ARM:: ARM RDI
18808 * M32R/D:: Renesas M32R/D
18809 * M68K:: Motorola M68K
18810 * MicroBlaze:: Xilinx MicroBlaze
18811 * MIPS Embedded:: MIPS Embedded
18812 * OpenRISC 1000:: OpenRisc 1000
18813 * PA:: HP PA Embedded
18814 * PowerPC Embedded:: PowerPC Embedded
18815 * Sparclet:: Tsqware Sparclet
18816 * Sparclite:: Fujitsu Sparclite
18817 * Z8000:: Zilog Z8000
18818 * AVR:: Atmel AVR
18819 * CRIS:: CRIS
18820 * Super-H:: Renesas Super-H
18821 @end menu
18822
18823 @node ARM
18824 @subsection ARM
18825 @cindex ARM RDI
18826
18827 @table @code
18828 @kindex target rdi
18829 @item target rdi @var{dev}
18830 ARM Angel monitor, via RDI library interface to ADP protocol. You may
18831 use this target to communicate with both boards running the Angel
18832 monitor, or with the EmbeddedICE JTAG debug device.
18833
18834 @kindex target rdp
18835 @item target rdp @var{dev}
18836 ARM Demon monitor.
18837
18838 @end table
18839
18840 @value{GDBN} provides the following ARM-specific commands:
18841
18842 @table @code
18843 @item set arm disassembler
18844 @kindex set arm
18845 This commands selects from a list of disassembly styles. The
18846 @code{"std"} style is the standard style.
18847
18848 @item show arm disassembler
18849 @kindex show arm
18850 Show the current disassembly style.
18851
18852 @item set arm apcs32
18853 @cindex ARM 32-bit mode
18854 This command toggles ARM operation mode between 32-bit and 26-bit.
18855
18856 @item show arm apcs32
18857 Display the current usage of the ARM 32-bit mode.
18858
18859 @item set arm fpu @var{fputype}
18860 This command sets the ARM floating-point unit (FPU) type. The
18861 argument @var{fputype} can be one of these:
18862
18863 @table @code
18864 @item auto
18865 Determine the FPU type by querying the OS ABI.
18866 @item softfpa
18867 Software FPU, with mixed-endian doubles on little-endian ARM
18868 processors.
18869 @item fpa
18870 GCC-compiled FPA co-processor.
18871 @item softvfp
18872 Software FPU with pure-endian doubles.
18873 @item vfp
18874 VFP co-processor.
18875 @end table
18876
18877 @item show arm fpu
18878 Show the current type of the FPU.
18879
18880 @item set arm abi
18881 This command forces @value{GDBN} to use the specified ABI.
18882
18883 @item show arm abi
18884 Show the currently used ABI.
18885
18886 @item set arm fallback-mode (arm|thumb|auto)
18887 @value{GDBN} uses the symbol table, when available, to determine
18888 whether instructions are ARM or Thumb. This command controls
18889 @value{GDBN}'s default behavior when the symbol table is not
18890 available. The default is @samp{auto}, which causes @value{GDBN} to
18891 use the current execution mode (from the @code{T} bit in the @code{CPSR}
18892 register).
18893
18894 @item show arm fallback-mode
18895 Show the current fallback instruction mode.
18896
18897 @item set arm force-mode (arm|thumb|auto)
18898 This command overrides use of the symbol table to determine whether
18899 instructions are ARM or Thumb. The default is @samp{auto}, which
18900 causes @value{GDBN} to use the symbol table and then the setting
18901 of @samp{set arm fallback-mode}.
18902
18903 @item show arm force-mode
18904 Show the current forced instruction mode.
18905
18906 @item set debug arm
18907 Toggle whether to display ARM-specific debugging messages from the ARM
18908 target support subsystem.
18909
18910 @item show debug arm
18911 Show whether ARM-specific debugging messages are enabled.
18912 @end table
18913
18914 The following commands are available when an ARM target is debugged
18915 using the RDI interface:
18916
18917 @table @code
18918 @item rdilogfile @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
18919 @kindex rdilogfile
18920 @cindex ADP (Angel Debugger Protocol) logging
18921 Set the filename for the ADP (Angel Debugger Protocol) packet log.
18922 With an argument, sets the log file to the specified @var{file}. With
18923 no argument, show the current log file name. The default log file is
18924 @file{rdi.log}.
18925
18926 @item rdilogenable @r{[}@var{arg}@r{]}
18927 @kindex rdilogenable
18928 Control logging of ADP packets. With an argument of 1 or @code{"yes"}
18929 enables logging, with an argument 0 or @code{"no"} disables it. With
18930 no arguments displays the current setting. When logging is enabled,
18931 ADP packets exchanged between @value{GDBN} and the RDI target device
18932 are logged to a file.
18933
18934 @item set rdiromatzero
18935 @kindex set rdiromatzero
18936 @cindex ROM at zero address, RDI
18937 Tell @value{GDBN} whether the target has ROM at address 0. If on,
18938 vector catching is disabled, so that zero address can be used. If off
18939 (the default), vector catching is enabled. For this command to take
18940 effect, it needs to be invoked prior to the @code{target rdi} command.
18941
18942 @item show rdiromatzero
18943 @kindex show rdiromatzero
18944 Show the current setting of ROM at zero address.
18945
18946 @item set rdiheartbeat
18947 @kindex set rdiheartbeat
18948 @cindex RDI heartbeat
18949 Enable or disable RDI heartbeat packets. It is not recommended to
18950 turn on this option, since it confuses ARM and EPI JTAG interface, as
18951 well as the Angel monitor.
18952
18953 @item show rdiheartbeat
18954 @kindex show rdiheartbeat
18955 Show the setting of RDI heartbeat packets.
18956 @end table
18957
18958 @table @code
18959 @item target sim @r{[}@var{simargs}@r{]} @dots{}
18960 The @value{GDBN} ARM simulator accepts the following optional arguments.
18961
18962 @table @code
18963 @item --swi-support=@var{type}
18964 Tell the simulator which SWI interfaces to support.
18965 @var{type} may be a comma separated list of the following values.
18966 The default value is @code{all}.
18967
18968 @table @code
18969 @item none
18970 @item demon
18971 @item angel
18972 @item redboot
18973 @item all
18974 @end table
18975 @end table
18976 @end table
18977
18978 @node M32R/D
18979 @subsection Renesas M32R/D and M32R/SDI
18980
18981 @table @code
18982 @kindex target m32r
18983 @item target m32r @var{dev}
18984 Renesas M32R/D ROM monitor.
18985
18986 @kindex target m32rsdi
18987 @item target m32rsdi @var{dev}
18988 Renesas M32R SDI server, connected via parallel port to the board.
18989 @end table
18990
18991 The following @value{GDBN} commands are specific to the M32R monitor:
18992
18993 @table @code
18994 @item set download-path @var{path}
18995 @kindex set download-path
18996 @cindex find downloadable @sc{srec} files (M32R)
18997 Set the default path for finding downloadable @sc{srec} files.
18998
18999 @item show download-path
19000 @kindex show download-path
19001 Show the default path for downloadable @sc{srec} files.
19002
19003 @item set board-address @var{addr}
19004 @kindex set board-address
19005 @cindex M32-EVA target board address
19006 Set the IP address for the M32R-EVA target board.
19007
19008 @item show board-address
19009 @kindex show board-address
19010 Show the current IP address of the target board.
19011
19012 @item set server-address @var{addr}
19013 @kindex set server-address
19014 @cindex download server address (M32R)
19015 Set the IP address for the download server, which is the @value{GDBN}'s
19016 host machine.
19017
19018 @item show server-address
19019 @kindex show server-address
19020 Display the IP address of the download server.
19021
19022 @item upload @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
19023 @kindex upload@r{, M32R}
19024 Upload the specified @sc{srec} @var{file} via the monitor's Ethernet
19025 upload capability. If no @var{file} argument is given, the current
19026 executable file is uploaded.
19027
19028 @item tload @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
19029 @kindex tload@r{, M32R}
19030 Test the @code{upload} command.
19031 @end table
19032
19033 The following commands are available for M32R/SDI:
19034
19035 @table @code
19036 @item sdireset
19037 @kindex sdireset
19038 @cindex reset SDI connection, M32R
19039 This command resets the SDI connection.
19040
19041 @item sdistatus
19042 @kindex sdistatus
19043 This command shows the SDI connection status.
19044
19045 @item debug_chaos
19046 @kindex debug_chaos
19047 @cindex M32R/Chaos debugging
19048 Instructs the remote that M32R/Chaos debugging is to be used.
19049
19050 @item use_debug_dma
19051 @kindex use_debug_dma
19052 Instructs the remote to use the DEBUG_DMA method of accessing memory.
19053
19054 @item use_mon_code
19055 @kindex use_mon_code
19056 Instructs the remote to use the MON_CODE method of accessing memory.
19057
19058 @item use_ib_break
19059 @kindex use_ib_break
19060 Instructs the remote to set breakpoints by IB break.
19061
19062 @item use_dbt_break
19063 @kindex use_dbt_break
19064 Instructs the remote to set breakpoints by DBT.
19065 @end table
19066
19067 @node M68K
19068 @subsection M68k
19069
19070 The Motorola m68k configuration includes ColdFire support, and a
19071 target command for the following ROM monitor.
19072
19073 @table @code
19074
19075 @kindex target dbug
19076 @item target dbug @var{dev}
19077 dBUG ROM monitor for Motorola ColdFire.
19078
19079 @end table
19080
19081 @node MicroBlaze
19082 @subsection MicroBlaze
19083 @cindex Xilinx MicroBlaze
19084 @cindex XMD, Xilinx Microprocessor Debugger
19085
19086 The MicroBlaze is a soft-core processor supported on various Xilinx
19087 FPGAs, such as Spartan or Virtex series. Boards with these processors
19088 usually have JTAG ports which connect to a host system running the Xilinx
19089 Embedded Development Kit (EDK) or Software Development Kit (SDK).
19090 This host system is used to download the configuration bitstream to
19091 the target FPGA. The Xilinx Microprocessor Debugger (XMD) program
19092 communicates with the target board using the JTAG interface and
19093 presents a @code{gdbserver} interface to the board. By default
19094 @code{xmd} uses port @code{1234}. (While it is possible to change
19095 this default port, it requires the use of undocumented @code{xmd}
19096 commands. Contact Xilinx support if you need to do this.)
19097
19098 Use these GDB commands to connect to the MicroBlaze target processor.
19099
19100 @table @code
19101 @item target remote :1234
19102 Use this command to connect to the target if you are running @value{GDBN}
19103 on the same system as @code{xmd}.
19104
19105 @item target remote @var{xmd-host}:1234
19106 Use this command to connect to the target if it is connected to @code{xmd}
19107 running on a different system named @var{xmd-host}.
19108
19109 @item load
19110 Use this command to download a program to the MicroBlaze target.
19111
19112 @item set debug microblaze @var{n}
19113 Enable MicroBlaze-specific debugging messages if non-zero.
19114
19115 @item show debug microblaze @var{n}
19116 Show MicroBlaze-specific debugging level.
19117 @end table
19118
19119 @node MIPS Embedded
19120 @subsection MIPS Embedded
19121
19122 @cindex MIPS boards
19123 @value{GDBN} can use the MIPS remote debugging protocol to talk to a
19124 MIPS board attached to a serial line. This is available when
19125 you configure @value{GDBN} with @samp{--target=mips-idt-ecoff}.
19126
19127 @need 1000
19128 Use these @value{GDBN} commands to specify the connection to your target board:
19129
19130 @table @code
19131 @item target mips @var{port}
19132 @kindex target mips @var{port}
19133 To run a program on the board, start up @code{@value{GDBP}} with the
19134 name of your program as the argument. To connect to the board, use the
19135 command @samp{target mips @var{port}}, where @var{port} is the name of
19136 the serial port connected to the board. If the program has not already
19137 been downloaded to the board, you may use the @code{load} command to
19138 download it. You can then use all the usual @value{GDBN} commands.
19139
19140 For example, this sequence connects to the target board through a serial
19141 port, and loads and runs a program called @var{prog} through the
19142 debugger:
19143
19144 @smallexample
19145 host$ @value{GDBP} @var{prog}
19146 @value{GDBN} is free software and @dots{}
19147 (@value{GDBP}) target mips /dev/ttyb
19148 (@value{GDBP}) load @var{prog}
19149 (@value{GDBP}) run
19150 @end smallexample
19151
19152 @item target mips @var{hostname}:@var{portnumber}
19153 On some @value{GDBN} host configurations, you can specify a TCP
19154 connection (for instance, to a serial line managed by a terminal
19155 concentrator) instead of a serial port, using the syntax
19156 @samp{@var{hostname}:@var{portnumber}}.
19157
19158 @item target pmon @var{port}
19159 @kindex target pmon @var{port}
19160 PMON ROM monitor.
19161
19162 @item target ddb @var{port}
19163 @kindex target ddb @var{port}
19164 NEC's DDB variant of PMON for Vr4300.
19165
19166 @item target lsi @var{port}
19167 @kindex target lsi @var{port}
19168 LSI variant of PMON.
19169
19170 @kindex target r3900
19171 @item target r3900 @var{dev}
19172 Densan DVE-R3900 ROM monitor for Toshiba R3900 Mips.
19173
19174 @kindex target array
19175 @item target array @var{dev}
19176 Array Tech LSI33K RAID controller board.
19177
19178 @end table
19179
19180
19181 @noindent
19182 @value{GDBN} also supports these special commands for MIPS targets:
19183
19184 @table @code
19185 @item set mipsfpu double
19186 @itemx set mipsfpu single
19187 @itemx set mipsfpu none
19188 @itemx set mipsfpu auto
19189 @itemx show mipsfpu
19190 @kindex set mipsfpu
19191 @kindex show mipsfpu
19192 @cindex MIPS remote floating point
19193 @cindex floating point, MIPS remote
19194 If your target board does not support the MIPS floating point
19195 coprocessor, you should use the command @samp{set mipsfpu none} (if you
19196 need this, you may wish to put the command in your @value{GDBN} init
19197 file). This tells @value{GDBN} how to find the return value of
19198 functions which return floating point values. It also allows
19199 @value{GDBN} to avoid saving the floating point registers when calling
19200 functions on the board. If you are using a floating point coprocessor
19201 with only single precision floating point support, as on the @sc{r4650}
19202 processor, use the command @samp{set mipsfpu single}. The default
19203 double precision floating point coprocessor may be selected using
19204 @samp{set mipsfpu double}.
19205
19206 In previous versions the only choices were double precision or no
19207 floating point, so @samp{set mipsfpu on} will select double precision
19208 and @samp{set mipsfpu off} will select no floating point.
19209
19210 As usual, you can inquire about the @code{mipsfpu} variable with
19211 @samp{show mipsfpu}.
19212
19213 @item set timeout @var{seconds}
19214 @itemx set retransmit-timeout @var{seconds}
19215 @itemx show timeout
19216 @itemx show retransmit-timeout
19217 @cindex @code{timeout}, MIPS protocol
19218 @cindex @code{retransmit-timeout}, MIPS protocol
19219 @kindex set timeout
19220 @kindex show timeout
19221 @kindex set retransmit-timeout
19222 @kindex show retransmit-timeout
19223 You can control the timeout used while waiting for a packet, in the MIPS
19224 remote protocol, with the @code{set timeout @var{seconds}} command. The
19225 default is 5 seconds. Similarly, you can control the timeout used while
19226 waiting for an acknowledgment of a packet with the @code{set
19227 retransmit-timeout @var{seconds}} command. The default is 3 seconds.
19228 You can inspect both values with @code{show timeout} and @code{show
19229 retransmit-timeout}. (These commands are @emph{only} available when
19230 @value{GDBN} is configured for @samp{--target=mips-idt-ecoff}.)
19231
19232 The timeout set by @code{set timeout} does not apply when @value{GDBN}
19233 is waiting for your program to stop. In that case, @value{GDBN} waits
19234 forever because it has no way of knowing how long the program is going
19235 to run before stopping.
19236
19237 @item set syn-garbage-limit @var{num}
19238 @kindex set syn-garbage-limit@r{, MIPS remote}
19239 @cindex synchronize with remote MIPS target
19240 Limit the maximum number of characters @value{GDBN} should ignore when
19241 it tries to synchronize with the remote target. The default is 10
19242 characters. Setting the limit to -1 means there's no limit.
19243
19244 @item show syn-garbage-limit
19245 @kindex show syn-garbage-limit@r{, MIPS remote}
19246 Show the current limit on the number of characters to ignore when
19247 trying to synchronize with the remote system.
19248
19249 @item set monitor-prompt @var{prompt}
19250 @kindex set monitor-prompt@r{, MIPS remote}
19251 @cindex remote monitor prompt
19252 Tell @value{GDBN} to expect the specified @var{prompt} string from the
19253 remote monitor. The default depends on the target:
19254 @table @asis
19255 @item pmon target
19256 @samp{PMON}
19257 @item ddb target
19258 @samp{NEC010}
19259 @item lsi target
19260 @samp{PMON>}
19261 @end table
19262
19263 @item show monitor-prompt
19264 @kindex show monitor-prompt@r{, MIPS remote}
19265 Show the current strings @value{GDBN} expects as the prompt from the
19266 remote monitor.
19267
19268 @item set monitor-warnings
19269 @kindex set monitor-warnings@r{, MIPS remote}
19270 Enable or disable monitor warnings about hardware breakpoints. This
19271 has effect only for the @code{lsi} target. When on, @value{GDBN} will
19272 display warning messages whose codes are returned by the @code{lsi}
19273 PMON monitor for breakpoint commands.
19274
19275 @item show monitor-warnings
19276 @kindex show monitor-warnings@r{, MIPS remote}
19277 Show the current setting of printing monitor warnings.
19278
19279 @item pmon @var{command}
19280 @kindex pmon@r{, MIPS remote}
19281 @cindex send PMON command
19282 This command allows sending an arbitrary @var{command} string to the
19283 monitor. The monitor must be in debug mode for this to work.
19284 @end table
19285
19286 @node OpenRISC 1000
19287 @subsection OpenRISC 1000
19288 @cindex OpenRISC 1000
19289
19290 @cindex or1k boards
19291 See OR1k Architecture document (@uref{www.opencores.org}) for more information
19292 about platform and commands.
19293
19294 @table @code
19295
19296 @kindex target jtag
19297 @item target jtag jtag://@var{host}:@var{port}
19298
19299 Connects to remote JTAG server.
19300 JTAG remote server can be either an or1ksim or JTAG server,
19301 connected via parallel port to the board.
19302
19303 Example: @code{target jtag jtag://localhost:9999}
19304
19305 @kindex or1ksim
19306 @item or1ksim @var{command}
19307 If connected to @code{or1ksim} OpenRISC 1000 Architectural
19308 Simulator, proprietary commands can be executed.
19309
19310 @kindex info or1k spr
19311 @item info or1k spr
19312 Displays spr groups.
19313
19314 @item info or1k spr @var{group}
19315 @itemx info or1k spr @var{groupno}
19316 Displays register names in selected group.
19317
19318 @item info or1k spr @var{group} @var{register}
19319 @itemx info or1k spr @var{register}
19320 @itemx info or1k spr @var{groupno} @var{registerno}
19321 @itemx info or1k spr @var{registerno}
19322 Shows information about specified spr register.
19323
19324 @kindex spr
19325 @item spr @var{group} @var{register} @var{value}
19326 @itemx spr @var{register @var{value}}
19327 @itemx spr @var{groupno} @var{registerno @var{value}}
19328 @itemx spr @var{registerno @var{value}}
19329 Writes @var{value} to specified spr register.
19330 @end table
19331
19332 Some implementations of OpenRISC 1000 Architecture also have hardware trace.
19333 It is very similar to @value{GDBN} trace, except it does not interfere with normal
19334 program execution and is thus much faster. Hardware breakpoints/watchpoint
19335 triggers can be set using:
19336 @table @code
19337 @item $LEA/$LDATA
19338 Load effective address/data
19339 @item $SEA/$SDATA
19340 Store effective address/data
19341 @item $AEA/$ADATA
19342 Access effective address ($SEA or $LEA) or data ($SDATA/$LDATA)
19343 @item $FETCH
19344 Fetch data
19345 @end table
19346
19347 When triggered, it can capture low level data, like: @code{PC}, @code{LSEA},
19348 @code{LDATA}, @code{SDATA}, @code{READSPR}, @code{WRITESPR}, @code{INSTR}.
19349
19350 @code{htrace} commands:
19351 @cindex OpenRISC 1000 htrace
19352 @table @code
19353 @kindex hwatch
19354 @item hwatch @var{conditional}
19355 Set hardware watchpoint on combination of Load/Store Effective Address(es)
19356 or Data. For example:
19357
19358 @code{hwatch ($LEA == my_var) && ($LDATA < 50) || ($SEA == my_var) && ($SDATA >= 50)}
19359
19360 @code{hwatch ($LEA == my_var) && ($LDATA < 50) || ($SEA == my_var) && ($SDATA >= 50)}
19361
19362 @kindex htrace
19363 @item htrace info
19364 Display information about current HW trace configuration.
19365
19366 @item htrace trigger @var{conditional}
19367 Set starting criteria for HW trace.
19368
19369 @item htrace qualifier @var{conditional}
19370 Set acquisition qualifier for HW trace.
19371
19372 @item htrace stop @var{conditional}
19373 Set HW trace stopping criteria.
19374
19375 @item htrace record [@var{data}]*
19376 Selects the data to be recorded, when qualifier is met and HW trace was
19377 triggered.
19378
19379 @item htrace enable
19380 @itemx htrace disable
19381 Enables/disables the HW trace.
19382
19383 @item htrace rewind [@var{filename}]
19384 Clears currently recorded trace data.
19385
19386 If filename is specified, new trace file is made and any newly collected data
19387 will be written there.
19388
19389 @item htrace print [@var{start} [@var{len}]]
19390 Prints trace buffer, using current record configuration.
19391
19392 @item htrace mode continuous
19393 Set continuous trace mode.
19394
19395 @item htrace mode suspend
19396 Set suspend trace mode.
19397
19398 @end table
19399
19400 @node PowerPC Embedded
19401 @subsection PowerPC Embedded
19402
19403 @cindex DVC register
19404 @value{GDBN} supports using the DVC (Data Value Compare) register to
19405 implement in hardware simple hardware watchpoint conditions of the form:
19406
19407 @smallexample
19408 (@value{GDBP}) watch @var{ADDRESS|VARIABLE} \
19409 if @var{ADDRESS|VARIABLE} == @var{CONSTANT EXPRESSION}
19410 @end smallexample
19411
19412 The DVC register will be automatically used when @value{GDBN} detects
19413 such pattern in a condition expression, and the created watchpoint uses one
19414 debug register (either the @code{exact-watchpoints} option is on and the
19415 variable is scalar, or the variable has a length of one byte). This feature
19416 is available in native @value{GDBN} running on a Linux kernel version 2.6.34
19417 or newer.
19418
19419 When running on PowerPC embedded processors, @value{GDBN} automatically uses
19420 ranged hardware watchpoints, unless the @code{exact-watchpoints} option is on,
19421 in which case watchpoints using only one debug register are created when
19422 watching variables of scalar types.
19423
19424 You can create an artificial array to watch an arbitrary memory
19425 region using one of the following commands (@pxref{Expressions}):
19426
19427 @smallexample
19428 (@value{GDBP}) watch *((char *) @var{address})@@@var{length}
19429 (@value{GDBP}) watch @{char[@var{length}]@} @var{address}
19430 @end smallexample
19431
19432 PowerPC embedded processors support masked watchpoints. See the discussion
19433 about the @code{mask} argument in @ref{Set Watchpoints}.
19434
19435 @cindex ranged breakpoint
19436 PowerPC embedded processors support hardware accelerated
19437 @dfn{ranged breakpoints}. A ranged breakpoint stops execution of
19438 the inferior whenever it executes an instruction at any address within
19439 the range it specifies. To set a ranged breakpoint in @value{GDBN},
19440 use the @code{break-range} command.
19441
19442 @value{GDBN} provides the following PowerPC-specific commands:
19443
19444 @table @code
19445 @kindex break-range
19446 @item break-range @var{start-location}, @var{end-location}
19447 Set a breakpoint for an address range.
19448 @var{start-location} and @var{end-location} can specify a function name,
19449 a line number, an offset of lines from the current line or from the start
19450 location, or an address of an instruction (see @ref{Specify Location},
19451 for a list of all the possible ways to specify a @var{location}.)
19452 The breakpoint will stop execution of the inferior whenever it
19453 executes an instruction at any address within the specified range,
19454 (including @var{start-location} and @var{end-location}.)
19455
19456 @kindex set powerpc
19457 @item set powerpc soft-float
19458 @itemx show powerpc soft-float
19459 Force @value{GDBN} to use (or not use) a software floating point calling
19460 convention. By default, @value{GDBN} selects the calling convention based
19461 on the selected architecture and the provided executable file.
19462
19463 @item set powerpc vector-abi
19464 @itemx show powerpc vector-abi
19465 Force @value{GDBN} to use the specified calling convention for vector
19466 arguments and return values. The valid options are @samp{auto};
19467 @samp{generic}, to avoid vector registers even if they are present;
19468 @samp{altivec}, to use AltiVec registers; and @samp{spe} to use SPE
19469 registers. By default, @value{GDBN} selects the calling convention
19470 based on the selected architecture and the provided executable file.
19471
19472 @item set powerpc exact-watchpoints
19473 @itemx show powerpc exact-watchpoints
19474 Allow @value{GDBN} to use only one debug register when watching a variable
19475 of scalar type, thus assuming that the variable is accessed through the
19476 address of its first byte.
19477
19478 @kindex target dink32
19479 @item target dink32 @var{dev}
19480 DINK32 ROM monitor.
19481
19482 @kindex target ppcbug
19483 @item target ppcbug @var{dev}
19484 @kindex target ppcbug1
19485 @item target ppcbug1 @var{dev}
19486 PPCBUG ROM monitor for PowerPC.
19487
19488 @kindex target sds
19489 @item target sds @var{dev}
19490 SDS monitor, running on a PowerPC board (such as Motorola's ADS).
19491 @end table
19492
19493 @cindex SDS protocol
19494 The following commands specific to the SDS protocol are supported
19495 by @value{GDBN}:
19496
19497 @table @code
19498 @item set sdstimeout @var{nsec}
19499 @kindex set sdstimeout
19500 Set the timeout for SDS protocol reads to be @var{nsec} seconds. The
19501 default is 2 seconds.
19502
19503 @item show sdstimeout
19504 @kindex show sdstimeout
19505 Show the current value of the SDS timeout.
19506
19507 @item sds @var{command}
19508 @kindex sds@r{, a command}
19509 Send the specified @var{command} string to the SDS monitor.
19510 @end table
19511
19512
19513 @node PA
19514 @subsection HP PA Embedded
19515
19516 @table @code
19517
19518 @kindex target op50n
19519 @item target op50n @var{dev}
19520 OP50N monitor, running on an OKI HPPA board.
19521
19522 @kindex target w89k
19523 @item target w89k @var{dev}
19524 W89K monitor, running on a Winbond HPPA board.
19525
19526 @end table
19527
19528 @node Sparclet
19529 @subsection Tsqware Sparclet
19530
19531 @cindex Sparclet
19532
19533 @value{GDBN} enables developers to debug tasks running on
19534 Sparclet targets from a Unix host.
19535 @value{GDBN} uses code that runs on
19536 both the Unix host and on the Sparclet target. The program
19537 @code{@value{GDBP}} is installed and executed on the Unix host.
19538
19539 @table @code
19540 @item remotetimeout @var{args}
19541 @kindex remotetimeout
19542 @value{GDBN} supports the option @code{remotetimeout}.
19543 This option is set by the user, and @var{args} represents the number of
19544 seconds @value{GDBN} waits for responses.
19545 @end table
19546
19547 @cindex compiling, on Sparclet
19548 When compiling for debugging, include the options @samp{-g} to get debug
19549 information and @samp{-Ttext} to relocate the program to where you wish to
19550 load it on the target. You may also want to add the options @samp{-n} or
19551 @samp{-N} in order to reduce the size of the sections. Example:
19552
19553 @smallexample
19554 sparclet-aout-gcc prog.c -Ttext 0x12010000 -g -o prog -N
19555 @end smallexample
19556
19557 You can use @code{objdump} to verify that the addresses are what you intended:
19558
19559 @smallexample
19560 sparclet-aout-objdump --headers --syms prog
19561 @end smallexample
19562
19563 @cindex running, on Sparclet
19564 Once you have set
19565 your Unix execution search path to find @value{GDBN}, you are ready to
19566 run @value{GDBN}. From your Unix host, run @code{@value{GDBP}}
19567 (or @code{sparclet-aout-gdb}, depending on your installation).
19568
19569 @value{GDBN} comes up showing the prompt:
19570
19571 @smallexample
19572 (gdbslet)
19573 @end smallexample
19574
19575 @menu
19576 * Sparclet File:: Setting the file to debug
19577 * Sparclet Connection:: Connecting to Sparclet
19578 * Sparclet Download:: Sparclet download
19579 * Sparclet Execution:: Running and debugging
19580 @end menu
19581
19582 @node Sparclet File
19583 @subsubsection Setting File to Debug
19584
19585 The @value{GDBN} command @code{file} lets you choose with program to debug.
19586
19587 @smallexample
19588 (gdbslet) file prog
19589 @end smallexample
19590
19591 @need 1000
19592 @value{GDBN} then attempts to read the symbol table of @file{prog}.
19593 @value{GDBN} locates
19594 the file by searching the directories listed in the command search
19595 path.
19596 If the file was compiled with debug information (option @samp{-g}), source
19597 files will be searched as well.
19598 @value{GDBN} locates
19599 the source files by searching the directories listed in the directory search
19600 path (@pxref{Environment, ,Your Program's Environment}).
19601 If it fails
19602 to find a file, it displays a message such as:
19603
19604 @smallexample
19605 prog: No such file or directory.
19606 @end smallexample
19607
19608 When this happens, add the appropriate directories to the search paths with
19609 the @value{GDBN} commands @code{path} and @code{dir}, and execute the
19610 @code{target} command again.
19611
19612 @node Sparclet Connection
19613 @subsubsection Connecting to Sparclet
19614
19615 The @value{GDBN} command @code{target} lets you connect to a Sparclet target.
19616 To connect to a target on serial port ``@code{ttya}'', type:
19617
19618 @smallexample
19619 (gdbslet) target sparclet /dev/ttya
19620 Remote target sparclet connected to /dev/ttya
19621 main () at ../prog.c:3
19622 @end smallexample
19623
19624 @need 750
19625 @value{GDBN} displays messages like these:
19626
19627 @smallexample
19628 Connected to ttya.
19629 @end smallexample
19630
19631 @node Sparclet Download
19632 @subsubsection Sparclet Download
19633
19634 @cindex download to Sparclet
19635 Once connected to the Sparclet target,
19636 you can use the @value{GDBN}
19637 @code{load} command to download the file from the host to the target.
19638 The file name and load offset should be given as arguments to the @code{load}
19639 command.
19640 Since the file format is aout, the program must be loaded to the starting
19641 address. You can use @code{objdump} to find out what this value is. The load
19642 offset is an offset which is added to the VMA (virtual memory address)
19643 of each of the file's sections.
19644 For instance, if the program
19645 @file{prog} was linked to text address 0x1201000, with data at 0x12010160
19646 and bss at 0x12010170, in @value{GDBN}, type:
19647
19648 @smallexample
19649 (gdbslet) load prog 0x12010000
19650 Loading section .text, size 0xdb0 vma 0x12010000
19651 @end smallexample
19652
19653 If the code is loaded at a different address then what the program was linked
19654 to, you may need to use the @code{section} and @code{add-symbol-file} commands
19655 to tell @value{GDBN} where to map the symbol table.
19656
19657 @node Sparclet Execution
19658 @subsubsection Running and Debugging
19659
19660 @cindex running and debugging Sparclet programs
19661 You can now begin debugging the task using @value{GDBN}'s execution control
19662 commands, @code{b}, @code{step}, @code{run}, etc. See the @value{GDBN}
19663 manual for the list of commands.
19664
19665 @smallexample
19666 (gdbslet) b main
19667 Breakpoint 1 at 0x12010000: file prog.c, line 3.
19668 (gdbslet) run
19669 Starting program: prog
19670 Breakpoint 1, main (argc=1, argv=0xeffff21c) at prog.c:3
19671 3 char *symarg = 0;
19672 (gdbslet) step
19673 4 char *execarg = "hello!";
19674 (gdbslet)
19675 @end smallexample
19676
19677 @node Sparclite
19678 @subsection Fujitsu Sparclite
19679
19680 @table @code
19681
19682 @kindex target sparclite
19683 @item target sparclite @var{dev}
19684 Fujitsu sparclite boards, used only for the purpose of loading.
19685 You must use an additional command to debug the program.
19686 For example: target remote @var{dev} using @value{GDBN} standard
19687 remote protocol.
19688
19689 @end table
19690
19691 @node Z8000
19692 @subsection Zilog Z8000
19693
19694 @cindex Z8000
19695 @cindex simulator, Z8000
19696 @cindex Zilog Z8000 simulator
19697
19698 When configured for debugging Zilog Z8000 targets, @value{GDBN} includes
19699 a Z8000 simulator.
19700
19701 For the Z8000 family, @samp{target sim} simulates either the Z8002 (the
19702 unsegmented variant of the Z8000 architecture) or the Z8001 (the
19703 segmented variant). The simulator recognizes which architecture is
19704 appropriate by inspecting the object code.
19705
19706 @table @code
19707 @item target sim @var{args}
19708 @kindex sim
19709 @kindex target sim@r{, with Z8000}
19710 Debug programs on a simulated CPU. If the simulator supports setup
19711 options, specify them via @var{args}.
19712 @end table
19713
19714 @noindent
19715 After specifying this target, you can debug programs for the simulated
19716 CPU in the same style as programs for your host computer; use the
19717 @code{file} command to load a new program image, the @code{run} command
19718 to run your program, and so on.
19719
19720 As well as making available all the usual machine registers
19721 (@pxref{Registers, ,Registers}), the Z8000 simulator provides three
19722 additional items of information as specially named registers:
19723
19724 @table @code
19725
19726 @item cycles
19727 Counts clock-ticks in the simulator.
19728
19729 @item insts
19730 Counts instructions run in the simulator.
19731
19732 @item time
19733 Execution time in 60ths of a second.
19734
19735 @end table
19736
19737 You can refer to these values in @value{GDBN} expressions with the usual
19738 conventions; for example, @w{@samp{b fputc if $cycles>5000}} sets a
19739 conditional breakpoint that suspends only after at least 5000
19740 simulated clock ticks.
19741
19742 @node AVR
19743 @subsection Atmel AVR
19744 @cindex AVR
19745
19746 When configured for debugging the Atmel AVR, @value{GDBN} supports the
19747 following AVR-specific commands:
19748
19749 @table @code
19750 @item info io_registers
19751 @kindex info io_registers@r{, AVR}
19752 @cindex I/O registers (Atmel AVR)
19753 This command displays information about the AVR I/O registers. For
19754 each register, @value{GDBN} prints its number and value.
19755 @end table
19756
19757 @node CRIS
19758 @subsection CRIS
19759 @cindex CRIS
19760
19761 When configured for debugging CRIS, @value{GDBN} provides the
19762 following CRIS-specific commands:
19763
19764 @table @code
19765 @item set cris-version @var{ver}
19766 @cindex CRIS version
19767 Set the current CRIS version to @var{ver}, either @samp{10} or @samp{32}.
19768 The CRIS version affects register names and sizes. This command is useful in
19769 case autodetection of the CRIS version fails.
19770
19771 @item show cris-version
19772 Show the current CRIS version.
19773
19774 @item set cris-dwarf2-cfi
19775 @cindex DWARF-2 CFI and CRIS
19776 Set the usage of DWARF-2 CFI for CRIS debugging. The default is @samp{on}.
19777 Change to @samp{off} when using @code{gcc-cris} whose version is below
19778 @code{R59}.
19779
19780 @item show cris-dwarf2-cfi
19781 Show the current state of using DWARF-2 CFI.
19782
19783 @item set cris-mode @var{mode}
19784 @cindex CRIS mode
19785 Set the current CRIS mode to @var{mode}. It should only be changed when
19786 debugging in guru mode, in which case it should be set to
19787 @samp{guru} (the default is @samp{normal}).
19788
19789 @item show cris-mode
19790 Show the current CRIS mode.
19791 @end table
19792
19793 @node Super-H
19794 @subsection Renesas Super-H
19795 @cindex Super-H
19796
19797 For the Renesas Super-H processor, @value{GDBN} provides these
19798 commands:
19799
19800 @table @code
19801 @item regs
19802 @kindex regs@r{, Super-H}
19803 Show the values of all Super-H registers.
19804
19805 @item set sh calling-convention @var{convention}
19806 @kindex set sh calling-convention
19807 Set the calling-convention used when calling functions from @value{GDBN}.
19808 Allowed values are @samp{gcc}, which is the default setting, and @samp{renesas}.
19809 With the @samp{gcc} setting, functions are called using the @value{NGCC} calling
19810 convention. If the DWARF-2 information of the called function specifies
19811 that the function follows the Renesas calling convention, the function
19812 is called using the Renesas calling convention. If the calling convention
19813 is set to @samp{renesas}, the Renesas calling convention is always used,
19814 regardless of the DWARF-2 information. This can be used to override the
19815 default of @samp{gcc} if debug information is missing, or the compiler
19816 does not emit the DWARF-2 calling convention entry for a function.
19817
19818 @item show sh calling-convention
19819 @kindex show sh calling-convention
19820 Show the current calling convention setting.
19821
19822 @end table
19823
19824
19825 @node Architectures
19826 @section Architectures
19827
19828 This section describes characteristics of architectures that affect
19829 all uses of @value{GDBN} with the architecture, both native and cross.
19830
19831 @menu
19832 * i386::
19833 * A29K::
19834 * Alpha::
19835 * MIPS::
19836 * HPPA:: HP PA architecture
19837 * SPU:: Cell Broadband Engine SPU architecture
19838 * PowerPC::
19839 @end menu
19840
19841 @node i386
19842 @subsection x86 Architecture-specific Issues
19843
19844 @table @code
19845 @item set struct-convention @var{mode}
19846 @kindex set struct-convention
19847 @cindex struct return convention
19848 @cindex struct/union returned in registers
19849 Set the convention used by the inferior to return @code{struct}s and
19850 @code{union}s from functions to @var{mode}. Possible values of
19851 @var{mode} are @code{"pcc"}, @code{"reg"}, and @code{"default"} (the
19852 default). @code{"default"} or @code{"pcc"} means that @code{struct}s
19853 are returned on the stack, while @code{"reg"} means that a
19854 @code{struct} or a @code{union} whose size is 1, 2, 4, or 8 bytes will
19855 be returned in a register.
19856
19857 @item show struct-convention
19858 @kindex show struct-convention
19859 Show the current setting of the convention to return @code{struct}s
19860 from functions.
19861 @end table
19862
19863 @node A29K
19864 @subsection A29K
19865
19866 @table @code
19867
19868 @kindex set rstack_high_address
19869 @cindex AMD 29K register stack
19870 @cindex register stack, AMD29K
19871 @item set rstack_high_address @var{address}
19872 On AMD 29000 family processors, registers are saved in a separate
19873 @dfn{register stack}. There is no way for @value{GDBN} to determine the
19874 extent of this stack. Normally, @value{GDBN} just assumes that the
19875 stack is ``large enough''. This may result in @value{GDBN} referencing
19876 memory locations that do not exist. If necessary, you can get around
19877 this problem by specifying the ending address of the register stack with
19878 the @code{set rstack_high_address} command. The argument should be an
19879 address, which you probably want to precede with @samp{0x} to specify in
19880 hexadecimal.
19881
19882 @kindex show rstack_high_address
19883 @item show rstack_high_address
19884 Display the current limit of the register stack, on AMD 29000 family
19885 processors.
19886
19887 @end table
19888
19889 @node Alpha
19890 @subsection Alpha
19891
19892 See the following section.
19893
19894 @node MIPS
19895 @subsection MIPS
19896
19897 @cindex stack on Alpha
19898 @cindex stack on MIPS
19899 @cindex Alpha stack
19900 @cindex MIPS stack
19901 Alpha- and MIPS-based computers use an unusual stack frame, which
19902 sometimes requires @value{GDBN} to search backward in the object code to
19903 find the beginning of a function.
19904
19905 @cindex response time, MIPS debugging
19906 To improve response time (especially for embedded applications, where
19907 @value{GDBN} may be restricted to a slow serial line for this search)
19908 you may want to limit the size of this search, using one of these
19909 commands:
19910
19911 @table @code
19912 @cindex @code{heuristic-fence-post} (Alpha, MIPS)
19913 @item set heuristic-fence-post @var{limit}
19914 Restrict @value{GDBN} to examining at most @var{limit} bytes in its
19915 search for the beginning of a function. A value of @var{0} (the
19916 default) means there is no limit. However, except for @var{0}, the
19917 larger the limit the more bytes @code{heuristic-fence-post} must search
19918 and therefore the longer it takes to run. You should only need to use
19919 this command when debugging a stripped executable.
19920
19921 @item show heuristic-fence-post
19922 Display the current limit.
19923 @end table
19924
19925 @noindent
19926 These commands are available @emph{only} when @value{GDBN} is configured
19927 for debugging programs on Alpha or MIPS processors.
19928
19929 Several MIPS-specific commands are available when debugging MIPS
19930 programs:
19931
19932 @table @code
19933 @item set mips abi @var{arg}
19934 @kindex set mips abi
19935 @cindex set ABI for MIPS
19936 Tell @value{GDBN} which MIPS ABI is used by the inferior. Possible
19937 values of @var{arg} are:
19938
19939 @table @samp
19940 @item auto
19941 The default ABI associated with the current binary (this is the
19942 default).
19943 @item o32
19944 @item o64
19945 @item n32
19946 @item n64
19947 @item eabi32
19948 @item eabi64
19949 @end table
19950
19951 @item show mips abi
19952 @kindex show mips abi
19953 Show the MIPS ABI used by @value{GDBN} to debug the inferior.
19954
19955 @item set mipsfpu
19956 @itemx show mipsfpu
19957 @xref{MIPS Embedded, set mipsfpu}.
19958
19959 @item set mips mask-address @var{arg}
19960 @kindex set mips mask-address
19961 @cindex MIPS addresses, masking
19962 This command determines whether the most-significant 32 bits of 64-bit
19963 MIPS addresses are masked off. The argument @var{arg} can be
19964 @samp{on}, @samp{off}, or @samp{auto}. The latter is the default
19965 setting, which lets @value{GDBN} determine the correct value.
19966
19967 @item show mips mask-address
19968 @kindex show mips mask-address
19969 Show whether the upper 32 bits of MIPS addresses are masked off or
19970 not.
19971
19972 @item set remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
19973 @kindex set remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
19974 This command controls compatibility with 64-bit MIPS targets that
19975 transfer data in 32-bit quantities. If you have an old MIPS 64 target
19976 that transfers 32 bits for some registers, like @sc{sr} and @sc{fsr},
19977 and 64 bits for other registers, set this option to @samp{on}.
19978
19979 @item show remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
19980 @kindex show remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
19981 Show the current setting of compatibility with older MIPS 64 targets.
19982
19983 @item set debug mips
19984 @kindex set debug mips
19985 This command turns on and off debugging messages for the MIPS-specific
19986 target code in @value{GDBN}.
19987
19988 @item show debug mips
19989 @kindex show debug mips
19990 Show the current setting of MIPS debugging messages.
19991 @end table
19992
19993
19994 @node HPPA
19995 @subsection HPPA
19996 @cindex HPPA support
19997
19998 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the HP PA architecture, it provides the
19999 following special commands:
20000
20001 @table @code
20002 @item set debug hppa
20003 @kindex set debug hppa
20004 This command determines whether HPPA architecture-specific debugging
20005 messages are to be displayed.
20006
20007 @item show debug hppa
20008 Show whether HPPA debugging messages are displayed.
20009
20010 @item maint print unwind @var{address}
20011 @kindex maint print unwind@r{, HPPA}
20012 This command displays the contents of the unwind table entry at the
20013 given @var{address}.
20014
20015 @end table
20016
20017
20018 @node SPU
20019 @subsection Cell Broadband Engine SPU architecture
20020 @cindex Cell Broadband Engine
20021 @cindex SPU
20022
20023 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the Cell Broadband Engine SPU architecture,
20024 it provides the following special commands:
20025
20026 @table @code
20027 @item info spu event
20028 @kindex info spu
20029 Display SPU event facility status. Shows current event mask
20030 and pending event status.
20031
20032 @item info spu signal
20033 Display SPU signal notification facility status. Shows pending
20034 signal-control word and signal notification mode of both signal
20035 notification channels.
20036
20037 @item info spu mailbox
20038 Display SPU mailbox facility status. Shows all pending entries,
20039 in order of processing, in each of the SPU Write Outbound,
20040 SPU Write Outbound Interrupt, and SPU Read Inbound mailboxes.
20041
20042 @item info spu dma
20043 Display MFC DMA status. Shows all pending commands in the MFC
20044 DMA queue. For each entry, opcode, tag, class IDs, effective
20045 and local store addresses and transfer size are shown.
20046
20047 @item info spu proxydma
20048 Display MFC Proxy-DMA status. Shows all pending commands in the MFC
20049 Proxy-DMA queue. For each entry, opcode, tag, class IDs, effective
20050 and local store addresses and transfer size are shown.
20051
20052 @end table
20053
20054 When @value{GDBN} is debugging a combined PowerPC/SPU application
20055 on the Cell Broadband Engine, it provides in addition the following
20056 special commands:
20057
20058 @table @code
20059 @item set spu stop-on-load @var{arg}
20060 @kindex set spu
20061 Set whether to stop for new SPE threads. When set to @code{on}, @value{GDBN}
20062 will give control to the user when a new SPE thread enters its @code{main}
20063 function. The default is @code{off}.
20064
20065 @item show spu stop-on-load
20066 @kindex show spu
20067 Show whether to stop for new SPE threads.
20068
20069 @item set spu auto-flush-cache @var{arg}
20070 Set whether to automatically flush the software-managed cache. When set to
20071 @code{on}, @value{GDBN} will automatically cause the SPE software-managed
20072 cache to be flushed whenever SPE execution stops. This provides a consistent
20073 view of PowerPC memory that is accessed via the cache. If an application
20074 does not use the software-managed cache, this option has no effect.
20075
20076 @item show spu auto-flush-cache
20077 Show whether to automatically flush the software-managed cache.
20078
20079 @end table
20080
20081 @node PowerPC
20082 @subsection PowerPC
20083 @cindex PowerPC architecture
20084
20085 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the PowerPC architecture, it provides a set of
20086 pseudo-registers to enable inspection of 128-bit wide Decimal Floating Point
20087 numbers stored in the floating point registers. These values must be stored
20088 in two consecutive registers, always starting at an even register like
20089 @code{f0} or @code{f2}.
20090
20091 The pseudo-registers go from @code{$dl0} through @code{$dl15}, and are formed
20092 by joining the even/odd register pairs @code{f0} and @code{f1} for @code{$dl0},
20093 @code{f2} and @code{f3} for @code{$dl1} and so on.
20094
20095 For POWER7 processors, @value{GDBN} provides a set of pseudo-registers, the 64-bit
20096 wide Extended Floating Point Registers (@samp{f32} through @samp{f63}).
20097
20098
20099 @node Controlling GDB
20100 @chapter Controlling @value{GDBN}
20101
20102 You can alter the way @value{GDBN} interacts with you by using the
20103 @code{set} command. For commands controlling how @value{GDBN} displays
20104 data, see @ref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}. Other settings are
20105 described here.
20106
20107 @menu
20108 * Prompt:: Prompt
20109 * Editing:: Command editing
20110 * Command History:: Command history
20111 * Screen Size:: Screen size
20112 * Numbers:: Numbers
20113 * ABI:: Configuring the current ABI
20114 * Messages/Warnings:: Optional warnings and messages
20115 * Debugging Output:: Optional messages about internal happenings
20116 * Other Misc Settings:: Other Miscellaneous Settings
20117 @end menu
20118
20119 @node Prompt
20120 @section Prompt
20121
20122 @cindex prompt
20123
20124 @value{GDBN} indicates its readiness to read a command by printing a string
20125 called the @dfn{prompt}. This string is normally @samp{(@value{GDBP})}. You
20126 can change the prompt string with the @code{set prompt} command. For
20127 instance, when debugging @value{GDBN} with @value{GDBN}, it is useful to change
20128 the prompt in one of the @value{GDBN} sessions so that you can always tell
20129 which one you are talking to.
20130
20131 @emph{Note:} @code{set prompt} does not add a space for you after the
20132 prompt you set. This allows you to set a prompt which ends in a space
20133 or a prompt that does not.
20134
20135 @table @code
20136 @kindex set prompt
20137 @item set prompt @var{newprompt}
20138 Directs @value{GDBN} to use @var{newprompt} as its prompt string henceforth.
20139
20140 @kindex show prompt
20141 @item show prompt
20142 Prints a line of the form: @samp{Gdb's prompt is: @var{your-prompt}}
20143 @end table
20144
20145 Versions of @value{GDBN} that ship with Python scripting enabled have
20146 prompt extensions. The commands for interacting with these extensions
20147 are:
20148
20149 @table @code
20150 @kindex set extended-prompt
20151 @item set extended-prompt @var{prompt}
20152 Set an extended prompt that allows for substitutions.
20153 @xref{gdb.prompt}, for a list of escape sequences that can be used for
20154 substitution. Any escape sequences specified as part of the prompt
20155 string are replaced with the corresponding strings each time the prompt
20156 is displayed.
20157
20158 For example:
20159
20160 @smallexample
20161 set extended-prompt Current working directory: \w (gdb)
20162 @end smallexample
20163
20164 Note that when an extended-prompt is set, it takes control of the
20165 @var{prompt_hook} hook. @xref{prompt_hook}, for further information.
20166
20167 @kindex show extended-prompt
20168 @item show extended-prompt
20169 Prints the extended prompt. Any escape sequences specified as part of
20170 the prompt string with @code{set extended-prompt}, are replaced with the
20171 corresponding strings each time the prompt is displayed.
20172 @end table
20173
20174 @node Editing
20175 @section Command Editing
20176 @cindex readline
20177 @cindex command line editing
20178
20179 @value{GDBN} reads its input commands via the @dfn{Readline} interface. This
20180 @sc{gnu} library provides consistent behavior for programs which provide a
20181 command line interface to the user. Advantages are @sc{gnu} Emacs-style
20182 or @dfn{vi}-style inline editing of commands, @code{csh}-like history
20183 substitution, and a storage and recall of command history across
20184 debugging sessions.
20185
20186 You may control the behavior of command line editing in @value{GDBN} with the
20187 command @code{set}.
20188
20189 @table @code
20190 @kindex set editing
20191 @cindex editing
20192 @item set editing
20193 @itemx set editing on
20194 Enable command line editing (enabled by default).
20195
20196 @item set editing off
20197 Disable command line editing.
20198
20199 @kindex show editing
20200 @item show editing
20201 Show whether command line editing is enabled.
20202 @end table
20203
20204 @ifset SYSTEM_READLINE
20205 @xref{Command Line Editing, , , rluserman, GNU Readline Library},
20206 @end ifset
20207 @ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
20208 @xref{Command Line Editing},
20209 @end ifclear
20210 for more details about the Readline
20211 interface. Users unfamiliar with @sc{gnu} Emacs or @code{vi} are
20212 encouraged to read that chapter.
20213
20214 @node Command History
20215 @section Command History
20216 @cindex command history
20217
20218 @value{GDBN} can keep track of the commands you type during your
20219 debugging sessions, so that you can be certain of precisely what
20220 happened. Use these commands to manage the @value{GDBN} command
20221 history facility.
20222
20223 @value{GDBN} uses the @sc{gnu} History library, a part of the Readline
20224 package, to provide the history facility.
20225 @ifset SYSTEM_READLINE
20226 @xref{Using History Interactively, , , history, GNU History Library},
20227 @end ifset
20228 @ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
20229 @xref{Using History Interactively},
20230 @end ifclear
20231 for the detailed description of the History library.
20232
20233 To issue a command to @value{GDBN} without affecting certain aspects of
20234 the state which is seen by users, prefix it with @samp{server }
20235 (@pxref{Server Prefix}). This
20236 means that this command will not affect the command history, nor will it
20237 affect @value{GDBN}'s notion of which command to repeat if @key{RET} is
20238 pressed on a line by itself.
20239
20240 @cindex @code{server}, command prefix
20241 The server prefix does not affect the recording of values into the value
20242 history; to print a value without recording it into the value history,
20243 use the @code{output} command instead of the @code{print} command.
20244
20245 Here is the description of @value{GDBN} commands related to command
20246 history.
20247
20248 @table @code
20249 @cindex history substitution
20250 @cindex history file
20251 @kindex set history filename
20252 @cindex @env{GDBHISTFILE}, environment variable
20253 @item set history filename @var{fname}
20254 Set the name of the @value{GDBN} command history file to @var{fname}.
20255 This is the file where @value{GDBN} reads an initial command history
20256 list, and where it writes the command history from this session when it
20257 exits. You can access this list through history expansion or through
20258 the history command editing characters listed below. This file defaults
20259 to the value of the environment variable @code{GDBHISTFILE}, or to
20260 @file{./.gdb_history} (@file{./_gdb_history} on MS-DOS) if this variable
20261 is not set.
20262
20263 @cindex save command history
20264 @kindex set history save
20265 @item set history save
20266 @itemx set history save on
20267 Record command history in a file, whose name may be specified with the
20268 @code{set history filename} command. By default, this option is disabled.
20269
20270 @item set history save off
20271 Stop recording command history in a file.
20272
20273 @cindex history size
20274 @kindex set history size
20275 @cindex @env{HISTSIZE}, environment variable
20276 @item set history size @var{size}
20277 Set the number of commands which @value{GDBN} keeps in its history list.
20278 This defaults to the value of the environment variable
20279 @code{HISTSIZE}, or to 256 if this variable is not set.
20280 @end table
20281
20282 History expansion assigns special meaning to the character @kbd{!}.
20283 @ifset SYSTEM_READLINE
20284 @xref{Event Designators, , , history, GNU History Library},
20285 @end ifset
20286 @ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
20287 @xref{Event Designators},
20288 @end ifclear
20289 for more details.
20290
20291 @cindex history expansion, turn on/off
20292 Since @kbd{!} is also the logical not operator in C, history expansion
20293 is off by default. If you decide to enable history expansion with the
20294 @code{set history expansion on} command, you may sometimes need to
20295 follow @kbd{!} (when it is used as logical not, in an expression) with
20296 a space or a tab to prevent it from being expanded. The readline
20297 history facilities do not attempt substitution on the strings
20298 @kbd{!=} and @kbd{!(}, even when history expansion is enabled.
20299
20300 The commands to control history expansion are:
20301
20302 @table @code
20303 @item set history expansion on
20304 @itemx set history expansion
20305 @kindex set history expansion
20306 Enable history expansion. History expansion is off by default.
20307
20308 @item set history expansion off
20309 Disable history expansion.
20310
20311 @c @group
20312 @kindex show history
20313 @item show history
20314 @itemx show history filename
20315 @itemx show history save
20316 @itemx show history size
20317 @itemx show history expansion
20318 These commands display the state of the @value{GDBN} history parameters.
20319 @code{show history} by itself displays all four states.
20320 @c @end group
20321 @end table
20322
20323 @table @code
20324 @kindex show commands
20325 @cindex show last commands
20326 @cindex display command history
20327 @item show commands
20328 Display the last ten commands in the command history.
20329
20330 @item show commands @var{n}
20331 Print ten commands centered on command number @var{n}.
20332
20333 @item show commands +
20334 Print ten commands just after the commands last printed.
20335 @end table
20336
20337 @node Screen Size
20338 @section Screen Size
20339 @cindex size of screen
20340 @cindex pauses in output
20341
20342 Certain commands to @value{GDBN} may produce large amounts of
20343 information output to the screen. To help you read all of it,
20344 @value{GDBN} pauses and asks you for input at the end of each page of
20345 output. Type @key{RET} when you want to continue the output, or @kbd{q}
20346 to discard the remaining output. Also, the screen width setting
20347 determines when to wrap lines of output. Depending on what is being
20348 printed, @value{GDBN} tries to break the line at a readable place,
20349 rather than simply letting it overflow onto the following line.
20350
20351 Normally @value{GDBN} knows the size of the screen from the terminal
20352 driver software. For example, on Unix @value{GDBN} uses the termcap data base
20353 together with the value of the @code{TERM} environment variable and the
20354 @code{stty rows} and @code{stty cols} settings. If this is not correct,
20355 you can override it with the @code{set height} and @code{set
20356 width} commands:
20357
20358 @table @code
20359 @kindex set height
20360 @kindex set width
20361 @kindex show width
20362 @kindex show height
20363 @item set height @var{lpp}
20364 @itemx show height
20365 @itemx set width @var{cpl}
20366 @itemx show width
20367 These @code{set} commands specify a screen height of @var{lpp} lines and
20368 a screen width of @var{cpl} characters. The associated @code{show}
20369 commands display the current settings.
20370
20371 If you specify a height of zero lines, @value{GDBN} does not pause during
20372 output no matter how long the output is. This is useful if output is to a
20373 file or to an editor buffer.
20374
20375 Likewise, you can specify @samp{set width 0} to prevent @value{GDBN}
20376 from wrapping its output.
20377
20378 @item set pagination on
20379 @itemx set pagination off
20380 @kindex set pagination
20381 Turn the output pagination on or off; the default is on. Turning
20382 pagination off is the alternative to @code{set height 0}. Note that
20383 running @value{GDBN} with the @option{--batch} option (@pxref{Mode
20384 Options, -batch}) also automatically disables pagination.
20385
20386 @item show pagination
20387 @kindex show pagination
20388 Show the current pagination mode.
20389 @end table
20390
20391 @node Numbers
20392 @section Numbers
20393 @cindex number representation
20394 @cindex entering numbers
20395
20396 You can always enter numbers in octal, decimal, or hexadecimal in
20397 @value{GDBN} by the usual conventions: octal numbers begin with
20398 @samp{0}, decimal numbers end with @samp{.}, and hexadecimal numbers
20399 begin with @samp{0x}. Numbers that neither begin with @samp{0} or
20400 @samp{0x}, nor end with a @samp{.} are, by default, entered in base
20401 10; likewise, the default display for numbers---when no particular
20402 format is specified---is base 10. You can change the default base for
20403 both input and output with the commands described below.
20404
20405 @table @code
20406 @kindex set input-radix
20407 @item set input-radix @var{base}
20408 Set the default base for numeric input. Supported choices
20409 for @var{base} are decimal 8, 10, or 16. @var{base} must itself be
20410 specified either unambiguously or using the current input radix; for
20411 example, any of
20412
20413 @smallexample
20414 set input-radix 012
20415 set input-radix 10.
20416 set input-radix 0xa
20417 @end smallexample
20418
20419 @noindent
20420 sets the input base to decimal. On the other hand, @samp{set input-radix 10}
20421 leaves the input radix unchanged, no matter what it was, since
20422 @samp{10}, being without any leading or trailing signs of its base, is
20423 interpreted in the current radix. Thus, if the current radix is 16,
20424 @samp{10} is interpreted in hex, i.e.@: as 16 decimal, which doesn't
20425 change the radix.
20426
20427 @kindex set output-radix
20428 @item set output-radix @var{base}
20429 Set the default base for numeric display. Supported choices
20430 for @var{base} are decimal 8, 10, or 16. @var{base} must itself be
20431 specified either unambiguously or using the current input radix.
20432
20433 @kindex show input-radix
20434 @item show input-radix
20435 Display the current default base for numeric input.
20436
20437 @kindex show output-radix
20438 @item show output-radix
20439 Display the current default base for numeric display.
20440
20441 @item set radix @r{[}@var{base}@r{]}
20442 @itemx show radix
20443 @kindex set radix
20444 @kindex show radix
20445 These commands set and show the default base for both input and output
20446 of numbers. @code{set radix} sets the radix of input and output to
20447 the same base; without an argument, it resets the radix back to its
20448 default value of 10.
20449
20450 @end table
20451
20452 @node ABI
20453 @section Configuring the Current ABI
20454
20455 @value{GDBN} can determine the @dfn{ABI} (Application Binary Interface) of your
20456 application automatically. However, sometimes you need to override its
20457 conclusions. Use these commands to manage @value{GDBN}'s view of the
20458 current ABI.
20459
20460 @cindex OS ABI
20461 @kindex set osabi
20462 @kindex show osabi
20463
20464 One @value{GDBN} configuration can debug binaries for multiple operating
20465 system targets, either via remote debugging or native emulation.
20466 @value{GDBN} will autodetect the @dfn{OS ABI} (Operating System ABI) in use,
20467 but you can override its conclusion using the @code{set osabi} command.
20468 One example where this is useful is in debugging of binaries which use
20469 an alternate C library (e.g.@: @sc{uClibc} for @sc{gnu}/Linux) which does
20470 not have the same identifying marks that the standard C library for your
20471 platform provides.
20472
20473 @table @code
20474 @item show osabi
20475 Show the OS ABI currently in use.
20476
20477 @item set osabi
20478 With no argument, show the list of registered available OS ABI's.
20479
20480 @item set osabi @var{abi}
20481 Set the current OS ABI to @var{abi}.
20482 @end table
20483
20484 @cindex float promotion
20485
20486 Generally, the way that an argument of type @code{float} is passed to a
20487 function depends on whether the function is prototyped. For a prototyped
20488 (i.e.@: ANSI/ISO style) function, @code{float} arguments are passed unchanged,
20489 according to the architecture's convention for @code{float}. For unprototyped
20490 (i.e.@: K&R style) functions, @code{float} arguments are first promoted to type
20491 @code{double} and then passed.
20492
20493 Unfortunately, some forms of debug information do not reliably indicate whether
20494 a function is prototyped. If @value{GDBN} calls a function that is not marked
20495 as prototyped, it consults @kbd{set coerce-float-to-double}.
20496
20497 @table @code
20498 @kindex set coerce-float-to-double
20499 @item set coerce-float-to-double
20500 @itemx set coerce-float-to-double on
20501 Arguments of type @code{float} will be promoted to @code{double} when passed
20502 to an unprototyped function. This is the default setting.
20503
20504 @item set coerce-float-to-double off
20505 Arguments of type @code{float} will be passed directly to unprototyped
20506 functions.
20507
20508 @kindex show coerce-float-to-double
20509 @item show coerce-float-to-double
20510 Show the current setting of promoting @code{float} to @code{double}.
20511 @end table
20512
20513 @kindex set cp-abi
20514 @kindex show cp-abi
20515 @value{GDBN} needs to know the ABI used for your program's C@t{++}
20516 objects. The correct C@t{++} ABI depends on which C@t{++} compiler was
20517 used to build your application. @value{GDBN} only fully supports
20518 programs with a single C@t{++} ABI; if your program contains code using
20519 multiple C@t{++} ABI's or if @value{GDBN} can not identify your
20520 program's ABI correctly, you can tell @value{GDBN} which ABI to use.
20521 Currently supported ABI's include ``gnu-v2'', for @code{g++} versions
20522 before 3.0, ``gnu-v3'', for @code{g++} versions 3.0 and later, and
20523 ``hpaCC'' for the HP ANSI C@t{++} compiler. Other C@t{++} compilers may
20524 use the ``gnu-v2'' or ``gnu-v3'' ABI's as well. The default setting is
20525 ``auto''.
20526
20527 @table @code
20528 @item show cp-abi
20529 Show the C@t{++} ABI currently in use.
20530
20531 @item set cp-abi
20532 With no argument, show the list of supported C@t{++} ABI's.
20533
20534 @item set cp-abi @var{abi}
20535 @itemx set cp-abi auto
20536 Set the current C@t{++} ABI to @var{abi}, or return to automatic detection.
20537 @end table
20538
20539 @node Messages/Warnings
20540 @section Optional Warnings and Messages
20541
20542 @cindex verbose operation
20543 @cindex optional warnings
20544 By default, @value{GDBN} is silent about its inner workings. If you are
20545 running on a slow machine, you may want to use the @code{set verbose}
20546 command. This makes @value{GDBN} tell you when it does a lengthy
20547 internal operation, so you will not think it has crashed.
20548
20549 Currently, the messages controlled by @code{set verbose} are those
20550 which announce that the symbol table for a source file is being read;
20551 see @code{symbol-file} in @ref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}.
20552
20553 @table @code
20554 @kindex set verbose
20555 @item set verbose on
20556 Enables @value{GDBN} output of certain informational messages.
20557
20558 @item set verbose off
20559 Disables @value{GDBN} output of certain informational messages.
20560
20561 @kindex show verbose
20562 @item show verbose
20563 Displays whether @code{set verbose} is on or off.
20564 @end table
20565
20566 By default, if @value{GDBN} encounters bugs in the symbol table of an
20567 object file, it is silent; but if you are debugging a compiler, you may
20568 find this information useful (@pxref{Symbol Errors, ,Errors Reading
20569 Symbol Files}).
20570
20571 @table @code
20572
20573 @kindex set complaints
20574 @item set complaints @var{limit}
20575 Permits @value{GDBN} to output @var{limit} complaints about each type of
20576 unusual symbols before becoming silent about the problem. Set
20577 @var{limit} to zero to suppress all complaints; set it to a large number
20578 to prevent complaints from being suppressed.
20579
20580 @kindex show complaints
20581 @item show complaints
20582 Displays how many symbol complaints @value{GDBN} is permitted to produce.
20583
20584 @end table
20585
20586 @anchor{confirmation requests}
20587 By default, @value{GDBN} is cautious, and asks what sometimes seems to be a
20588 lot of stupid questions to confirm certain commands. For example, if
20589 you try to run a program which is already running:
20590
20591 @smallexample
20592 (@value{GDBP}) run
20593 The program being debugged has been started already.
20594 Start it from the beginning? (y or n)
20595 @end smallexample
20596
20597 If you are willing to unflinchingly face the consequences of your own
20598 commands, you can disable this ``feature'':
20599
20600 @table @code
20601
20602 @kindex set confirm
20603 @cindex flinching
20604 @cindex confirmation
20605 @cindex stupid questions
20606 @item set confirm off
20607 Disables confirmation requests. Note that running @value{GDBN} with
20608 the @option{--batch} option (@pxref{Mode Options, -batch}) also
20609 automatically disables confirmation requests.
20610
20611 @item set confirm on
20612 Enables confirmation requests (the default).
20613
20614 @kindex show confirm
20615 @item show confirm
20616 Displays state of confirmation requests.
20617
20618 @end table
20619
20620 @cindex command tracing
20621 If you need to debug user-defined commands or sourced files you may find it
20622 useful to enable @dfn{command tracing}. In this mode each command will be
20623 printed as it is executed, prefixed with one or more @samp{+} symbols, the
20624 quantity denoting the call depth of each command.
20625
20626 @table @code
20627 @kindex set trace-commands
20628 @cindex command scripts, debugging
20629 @item set trace-commands on
20630 Enable command tracing.
20631 @item set trace-commands off
20632 Disable command tracing.
20633 @item show trace-commands
20634 Display the current state of command tracing.
20635 @end table
20636
20637 @node Debugging Output
20638 @section Optional Messages about Internal Happenings
20639 @cindex optional debugging messages
20640
20641 @value{GDBN} has commands that enable optional debugging messages from
20642 various @value{GDBN} subsystems; normally these commands are of
20643 interest to @value{GDBN} maintainers, or when reporting a bug. This
20644 section documents those commands.
20645
20646 @table @code
20647 @kindex set exec-done-display
20648 @item set exec-done-display
20649 Turns on or off the notification of asynchronous commands'
20650 completion. When on, @value{GDBN} will print a message when an
20651 asynchronous command finishes its execution. The default is off.
20652 @kindex show exec-done-display
20653 @item show exec-done-display
20654 Displays the current setting of asynchronous command completion
20655 notification.
20656 @kindex set debug
20657 @cindex gdbarch debugging info
20658 @cindex architecture debugging info
20659 @item set debug arch
20660 Turns on or off display of gdbarch debugging info. The default is off
20661 @kindex show debug
20662 @item show debug arch
20663 Displays the current state of displaying gdbarch debugging info.
20664 @item set debug aix-thread
20665 @cindex AIX threads
20666 Display debugging messages about inner workings of the AIX thread
20667 module.
20668 @item show debug aix-thread
20669 Show the current state of AIX thread debugging info display.
20670 @item set debug check-physname
20671 @cindex physname
20672 Check the results of the ``physname'' computation. When reading DWARF
20673 debugging information for C@t{++}, @value{GDBN} attempts to compute
20674 each entity's name. @value{GDBN} can do this computation in two
20675 different ways, depending on exactly what information is present.
20676 When enabled, this setting causes @value{GDBN} to compute the names
20677 both ways and display any discrepancies.
20678 @item show debug check-physname
20679 Show the current state of ``physname'' checking.
20680 @item set debug dwarf2-die
20681 @cindex DWARF2 DIEs
20682 Dump DWARF2 DIEs after they are read in.
20683 The value is the number of nesting levels to print.
20684 A value of zero turns off the display.
20685 @item show debug dwarf2-die
20686 Show the current state of DWARF2 DIE debugging.
20687 @item set debug displaced
20688 @cindex displaced stepping debugging info
20689 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} debugging info for the
20690 displaced stepping support. The default is off.
20691 @item show debug displaced
20692 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} debugging info
20693 related to displaced stepping.
20694 @item set debug event
20695 @cindex event debugging info
20696 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} event debugging info. The
20697 default is off.
20698 @item show debug event
20699 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} event debugging
20700 info.
20701 @item set debug expression
20702 @cindex expression debugging info
20703 Turns on or off display of debugging info about @value{GDBN}
20704 expression parsing. The default is off.
20705 @item show debug expression
20706 Displays the current state of displaying debugging info about
20707 @value{GDBN} expression parsing.
20708 @item set debug frame
20709 @cindex frame debugging info
20710 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} frame debugging info. The
20711 default is off.
20712 @item show debug frame
20713 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} frame debugging
20714 info.
20715 @item set debug gnu-nat
20716 @cindex @sc{gnu}/Hurd debug messages
20717 Turns on or off debugging messages from the @sc{gnu}/Hurd debug support.
20718 @item show debug gnu-nat
20719 Show the current state of @sc{gnu}/Hurd debugging messages.
20720 @item set debug infrun
20721 @cindex inferior debugging info
20722 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} debugging info for running the inferior.
20723 The default is off. @file{infrun.c} contains GDB's runtime state machine used
20724 for implementing operations such as single-stepping the inferior.
20725 @item show debug infrun
20726 Displays the current state of @value{GDBN} inferior debugging.
20727 @item set debug jit
20728 @cindex just-in-time compilation, debugging messages
20729 Turns on or off debugging messages from JIT debug support.
20730 @item show debug jit
20731 Displays the current state of @value{GDBN} JIT debugging.
20732 @item set debug lin-lwp
20733 @cindex @sc{gnu}/Linux LWP debug messages
20734 @cindex Linux lightweight processes
20735 Turns on or off debugging messages from the Linux LWP debug support.
20736 @item show debug lin-lwp
20737 Show the current state of Linux LWP debugging messages.
20738 @item set debug observer
20739 @cindex observer debugging info
20740 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} observer debugging. This
20741 includes info such as the notification of observable events.
20742 @item show debug observer
20743 Displays the current state of observer debugging.
20744 @item set debug overload
20745 @cindex C@t{++} overload debugging info
20746 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} C@t{++} overload debugging
20747 info. This includes info such as ranking of functions, etc. The default
20748 is off.
20749 @item show debug overload
20750 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} C@t{++} overload
20751 debugging info.
20752 @cindex expression parser, debugging info
20753 @cindex debug expression parser
20754 @item set debug parser
20755 Turns on or off the display of expression parser debugging output.
20756 Internally, this sets the @code{yydebug} variable in the expression
20757 parser. @xref{Tracing, , Tracing Your Parser, bison, Bison}, for
20758 details. The default is off.
20759 @item show debug parser
20760 Show the current state of expression parser debugging.
20761 @cindex packets, reporting on stdout
20762 @cindex serial connections, debugging
20763 @cindex debug remote protocol
20764 @cindex remote protocol debugging
20765 @cindex display remote packets
20766 @item set debug remote
20767 Turns on or off display of reports on all packets sent back and forth across
20768 the serial line to the remote machine. The info is printed on the
20769 @value{GDBN} standard output stream. The default is off.
20770 @item show debug remote
20771 Displays the state of display of remote packets.
20772 @item set debug serial
20773 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} serial debugging info. The
20774 default is off.
20775 @item show debug serial
20776 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} serial debugging
20777 info.
20778 @item set debug solib-frv
20779 @cindex FR-V shared-library debugging
20780 Turns on or off debugging messages for FR-V shared-library code.
20781 @item show debug solib-frv
20782 Display the current state of FR-V shared-library code debugging
20783 messages.
20784 @item set debug target
20785 @cindex target debugging info
20786 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} target debugging info. This info
20787 includes what is going on at the target level of GDB, as it happens. The
20788 default is 0. Set it to 1 to track events, and to 2 to also track the
20789 value of large memory transfers. Changes to this flag do not take effect
20790 until the next time you connect to a target or use the @code{run} command.
20791 @item show debug target
20792 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} target debugging
20793 info.
20794 @item set debug timestamp
20795 @cindex timestampping debugging info
20796 Turns on or off display of timestamps with @value{GDBN} debugging info.
20797 When enabled, seconds and microseconds are displayed before each debugging
20798 message.
20799 @item show debug timestamp
20800 Displays the current state of displaying timestamps with @value{GDBN}
20801 debugging info.
20802 @item set debugvarobj
20803 @cindex variable object debugging info
20804 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} variable object debugging
20805 info. The default is off.
20806 @item show debugvarobj
20807 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} variable object
20808 debugging info.
20809 @item set debug xml
20810 @cindex XML parser debugging
20811 Turns on or off debugging messages for built-in XML parsers.
20812 @item show debug xml
20813 Displays the current state of XML debugging messages.
20814 @end table
20815
20816 @node Other Misc Settings
20817 @section Other Miscellaneous Settings
20818 @cindex miscellaneous settings
20819
20820 @table @code
20821 @kindex set interactive-mode
20822 @item set interactive-mode
20823 If @code{on}, forces @value{GDBN} to assume that GDB was started
20824 in a terminal. In practice, this means that @value{GDBN} should wait
20825 for the user to answer queries generated by commands entered at
20826 the command prompt. If @code{off}, forces @value{GDBN} to operate
20827 in the opposite mode, and it uses the default answers to all queries.
20828 If @code{auto} (the default), @value{GDBN} tries to determine whether
20829 its standard input is a terminal, and works in interactive-mode if it
20830 is, non-interactively otherwise.
20831
20832 In the vast majority of cases, the debugger should be able to guess
20833 correctly which mode should be used. But this setting can be useful
20834 in certain specific cases, such as running a MinGW @value{GDBN}
20835 inside a cygwin window.
20836
20837 @kindex show interactive-mode
20838 @item show interactive-mode
20839 Displays whether the debugger is operating in interactive mode or not.
20840 @end table
20841
20842 @node Extending GDB
20843 @chapter Extending @value{GDBN}
20844 @cindex extending GDB
20845
20846 @value{GDBN} provides three mechanisms for extension. The first is based
20847 on composition of @value{GDBN} commands, the second is based on the
20848 Python scripting language, and the third is for defining new aliases of
20849 existing commands.
20850
20851 To facilitate the use of the first two extensions, @value{GDBN} is capable
20852 of evaluating the contents of a file. When doing so, @value{GDBN}
20853 can recognize which scripting language is being used by looking at
20854 the filename extension. Files with an unrecognized filename extension
20855 are always treated as a @value{GDBN} Command Files.
20856 @xref{Command Files,, Command files}.
20857
20858 You can control how @value{GDBN} evaluates these files with the following
20859 setting:
20860
20861 @table @code
20862 @kindex set script-extension
20863 @kindex show script-extension
20864 @item set script-extension off
20865 All scripts are always evaluated as @value{GDBN} Command Files.
20866
20867 @item set script-extension soft
20868 The debugger determines the scripting language based on filename
20869 extension. If this scripting language is supported, @value{GDBN}
20870 evaluates the script using that language. Otherwise, it evaluates
20871 the file as a @value{GDBN} Command File.
20872
20873 @item set script-extension strict
20874 The debugger determines the scripting language based on filename
20875 extension, and evaluates the script using that language. If the
20876 language is not supported, then the evaluation fails.
20877
20878 @item show script-extension
20879 Display the current value of the @code{script-extension} option.
20880
20881 @end table
20882
20883 @menu
20884 * Sequences:: Canned Sequences of Commands
20885 * Python:: Scripting @value{GDBN} using Python
20886 * Aliases:: Creating new spellings of existing commands
20887 @end menu
20888
20889 @node Sequences
20890 @section Canned Sequences of Commands
20891
20892 Aside from breakpoint commands (@pxref{Break Commands, ,Breakpoint
20893 Command Lists}), @value{GDBN} provides two ways to store sequences of
20894 commands for execution as a unit: user-defined commands and command
20895 files.
20896
20897 @menu
20898 * Define:: How to define your own commands
20899 * Hooks:: Hooks for user-defined commands
20900 * Command Files:: How to write scripts of commands to be stored in a file
20901 * Output:: Commands for controlled output
20902 @end menu
20903
20904 @node Define
20905 @subsection User-defined Commands
20906
20907 @cindex user-defined command
20908 @cindex arguments, to user-defined commands
20909 A @dfn{user-defined command} is a sequence of @value{GDBN} commands to
20910 which you assign a new name as a command. This is done with the
20911 @code{define} command. User commands may accept up to 10 arguments
20912 separated by whitespace. Arguments are accessed within the user command
20913 via @code{$arg0@dots{}$arg9}. A trivial example:
20914
20915 @smallexample
20916 define adder
20917 print $arg0 + $arg1 + $arg2
20918 end
20919 @end smallexample
20920
20921 @noindent
20922 To execute the command use:
20923
20924 @smallexample
20925 adder 1 2 3
20926 @end smallexample
20927
20928 @noindent
20929 This defines the command @code{adder}, which prints the sum of
20930 its three arguments. Note the arguments are text substitutions, so they may
20931 reference variables, use complex expressions, or even perform inferior
20932 functions calls.
20933
20934 @cindex argument count in user-defined commands
20935 @cindex how many arguments (user-defined commands)
20936 In addition, @code{$argc} may be used to find out how many arguments have
20937 been passed. This expands to a number in the range 0@dots{}10.
20938
20939 @smallexample
20940 define adder
20941 if $argc == 2
20942 print $arg0 + $arg1
20943 end
20944 if $argc == 3
20945 print $arg0 + $arg1 + $arg2
20946 end
20947 end
20948 @end smallexample
20949
20950 @table @code
20951
20952 @kindex define
20953 @item define @var{commandname}
20954 Define a command named @var{commandname}. If there is already a command
20955 by that name, you are asked to confirm that you want to redefine it.
20956 @var{commandname} may be a bare command name consisting of letters,
20957 numbers, dashes, and underscores. It may also start with any predefined
20958 prefix command. For example, @samp{define target my-target} creates
20959 a user-defined @samp{target my-target} command.
20960
20961 The definition of the command is made up of other @value{GDBN} command lines,
20962 which are given following the @code{define} command. The end of these
20963 commands is marked by a line containing @code{end}.
20964
20965 @kindex document
20966 @kindex end@r{ (user-defined commands)}
20967 @item document @var{commandname}
20968 Document the user-defined command @var{commandname}, so that it can be
20969 accessed by @code{help}. The command @var{commandname} must already be
20970 defined. This command reads lines of documentation just as @code{define}
20971 reads the lines of the command definition, ending with @code{end}.
20972 After the @code{document} command is finished, @code{help} on command
20973 @var{commandname} displays the documentation you have written.
20974
20975 You may use the @code{document} command again to change the
20976 documentation of a command. Redefining the command with @code{define}
20977 does not change the documentation.
20978
20979 @kindex dont-repeat
20980 @cindex don't repeat command
20981 @item dont-repeat
20982 Used inside a user-defined command, this tells @value{GDBN} that this
20983 command should not be repeated when the user hits @key{RET}
20984 (@pxref{Command Syntax, repeat last command}).
20985
20986 @kindex help user-defined
20987 @item help user-defined
20988 List all user-defined commands, with the first line of the documentation
20989 (if any) for each.
20990
20991 @kindex show user
20992 @item show user
20993 @itemx show user @var{commandname}
20994 Display the @value{GDBN} commands used to define @var{commandname} (but
20995 not its documentation). If no @var{commandname} is given, display the
20996 definitions for all user-defined commands.
20997
20998 @cindex infinite recursion in user-defined commands
20999 @kindex show max-user-call-depth
21000 @kindex set max-user-call-depth
21001 @item show max-user-call-depth
21002 @itemx set max-user-call-depth
21003 The value of @code{max-user-call-depth} controls how many recursion
21004 levels are allowed in user-defined commands before @value{GDBN} suspects an
21005 infinite recursion and aborts the command.
21006 @end table
21007
21008 In addition to the above commands, user-defined commands frequently
21009 use control flow commands, described in @ref{Command Files}.
21010
21011 When user-defined commands are executed, the
21012 commands of the definition are not printed. An error in any command
21013 stops execution of the user-defined command.
21014
21015 If used interactively, commands that would ask for confirmation proceed
21016 without asking when used inside a user-defined command. Many @value{GDBN}
21017 commands that normally print messages to say what they are doing omit the
21018 messages when used in a user-defined command.
21019
21020 @node Hooks
21021 @subsection User-defined Command Hooks
21022 @cindex command hooks
21023 @cindex hooks, for commands
21024 @cindex hooks, pre-command
21025
21026 @kindex hook
21027 You may define @dfn{hooks}, which are a special kind of user-defined
21028 command. Whenever you run the command @samp{foo}, if the user-defined
21029 command @samp{hook-foo} exists, it is executed (with no arguments)
21030 before that command.
21031
21032 @cindex hooks, post-command
21033 @kindex hookpost
21034 A hook may also be defined which is run after the command you executed.
21035 Whenever you run the command @samp{foo}, if the user-defined command
21036 @samp{hookpost-foo} exists, it is executed (with no arguments) after
21037 that command. Post-execution hooks may exist simultaneously with
21038 pre-execution hooks, for the same command.
21039
21040 It is valid for a hook to call the command which it hooks. If this
21041 occurs, the hook is not re-executed, thereby avoiding infinite recursion.
21042
21043 @c It would be nice if hookpost could be passed a parameter indicating
21044 @c if the command it hooks executed properly or not. FIXME!
21045
21046 @kindex stop@r{, a pseudo-command}
21047 In addition, a pseudo-command, @samp{stop} exists. Defining
21048 (@samp{hook-stop}) makes the associated commands execute every time
21049 execution stops in your program: before breakpoint commands are run,
21050 displays are printed, or the stack frame is printed.
21051
21052 For example, to ignore @code{SIGALRM} signals while
21053 single-stepping, but treat them normally during normal execution,
21054 you could define:
21055
21056 @smallexample
21057 define hook-stop
21058 handle SIGALRM nopass
21059 end
21060
21061 define hook-run
21062 handle SIGALRM pass
21063 end
21064
21065 define hook-continue
21066 handle SIGALRM pass
21067 end
21068 @end smallexample
21069
21070 As a further example, to hook at the beginning and end of the @code{echo}
21071 command, and to add extra text to the beginning and end of the message,
21072 you could define:
21073
21074 @smallexample
21075 define hook-echo
21076 echo <<<---
21077 end
21078
21079 define hookpost-echo
21080 echo --->>>\n
21081 end
21082
21083 (@value{GDBP}) echo Hello World
21084 <<<---Hello World--->>>
21085 (@value{GDBP})
21086
21087 @end smallexample
21088
21089 You can define a hook for any single-word command in @value{GDBN}, but
21090 not for command aliases; you should define a hook for the basic command
21091 name, e.g.@: @code{backtrace} rather than @code{bt}.
21092 @c FIXME! So how does Joe User discover whether a command is an alias
21093 @c or not?
21094 You can hook a multi-word command by adding @code{hook-} or
21095 @code{hookpost-} to the last word of the command, e.g.@:
21096 @samp{define target hook-remote} to add a hook to @samp{target remote}.
21097
21098 If an error occurs during the execution of your hook, execution of
21099 @value{GDBN} commands stops and @value{GDBN} issues a prompt
21100 (before the command that you actually typed had a chance to run).
21101
21102 If you try to define a hook which does not match any known command, you
21103 get a warning from the @code{define} command.
21104
21105 @node Command Files
21106 @subsection Command Files
21107
21108 @cindex command files
21109 @cindex scripting commands
21110 A command file for @value{GDBN} is a text file made of lines that are
21111 @value{GDBN} commands. Comments (lines starting with @kbd{#}) may
21112 also be included. An empty line in a command file does nothing; it
21113 does not mean to repeat the last command, as it would from the
21114 terminal.
21115
21116 You can request the execution of a command file with the @code{source}
21117 command. Note that the @code{source} command is also used to evaluate
21118 scripts that are not Command Files. The exact behavior can be configured
21119 using the @code{script-extension} setting.
21120 @xref{Extending GDB,, Extending GDB}.
21121
21122 @table @code
21123 @kindex source
21124 @cindex execute commands from a file
21125 @item source [-s] [-v] @var{filename}
21126 Execute the command file @var{filename}.
21127 @end table
21128
21129 The lines in a command file are generally executed sequentially,
21130 unless the order of execution is changed by one of the
21131 @emph{flow-control commands} described below. The commands are not
21132 printed as they are executed. An error in any command terminates
21133 execution of the command file and control is returned to the console.
21134
21135 @value{GDBN} first searches for @var{filename} in the current directory.
21136 If the file is not found there, and @var{filename} does not specify a
21137 directory, then @value{GDBN} also looks for the file on the source search path
21138 (specified with the @samp{directory} command);
21139 except that @file{$cdir} is not searched because the compilation directory
21140 is not relevant to scripts.
21141
21142 If @code{-s} is specified, then @value{GDBN} searches for @var{filename}
21143 on the search path even if @var{filename} specifies a directory.
21144 The search is done by appending @var{filename} to each element of the
21145 search path. So, for example, if @var{filename} is @file{mylib/myscript}
21146 and the search path contains @file{/home/user} then @value{GDBN} will
21147 look for the script @file{/home/user/mylib/myscript}.
21148 The search is also done if @var{filename} is an absolute path.
21149 For example, if @var{filename} is @file{/tmp/myscript} and
21150 the search path contains @file{/home/user} then @value{GDBN} will
21151 look for the script @file{/home/user/tmp/myscript}.
21152 For DOS-like systems, if @var{filename} contains a drive specification,
21153 it is stripped before concatenation. For example, if @var{filename} is
21154 @file{d:myscript} and the search path contains @file{c:/tmp} then @value{GDBN}
21155 will look for the script @file{c:/tmp/myscript}.
21156
21157 If @code{-v}, for verbose mode, is given then @value{GDBN} displays
21158 each command as it is executed. The option must be given before
21159 @var{filename}, and is interpreted as part of the filename anywhere else.
21160
21161 Commands that would ask for confirmation if used interactively proceed
21162 without asking when used in a command file. Many @value{GDBN} commands that
21163 normally print messages to say what they are doing omit the messages
21164 when called from command files.
21165
21166 @value{GDBN} also accepts command input from standard input. In this
21167 mode, normal output goes to standard output and error output goes to
21168 standard error. Errors in a command file supplied on standard input do
21169 not terminate execution of the command file---execution continues with
21170 the next command.
21171
21172 @smallexample
21173 gdb < cmds > log 2>&1
21174 @end smallexample
21175
21176 (The syntax above will vary depending on the shell used.) This example
21177 will execute commands from the file @file{cmds}. All output and errors
21178 would be directed to @file{log}.
21179
21180 Since commands stored on command files tend to be more general than
21181 commands typed interactively, they frequently need to deal with
21182 complicated situations, such as different or unexpected values of
21183 variables and symbols, changes in how the program being debugged is
21184 built, etc. @value{GDBN} provides a set of flow-control commands to
21185 deal with these complexities. Using these commands, you can write
21186 complex scripts that loop over data structures, execute commands
21187 conditionally, etc.
21188
21189 @table @code
21190 @kindex if
21191 @kindex else
21192 @item if
21193 @itemx else
21194 This command allows to include in your script conditionally executed
21195 commands. The @code{if} command takes a single argument, which is an
21196 expression to evaluate. It is followed by a series of commands that
21197 are executed only if the expression is true (its value is nonzero).
21198 There can then optionally be an @code{else} line, followed by a series
21199 of commands that are only executed if the expression was false. The
21200 end of the list is marked by a line containing @code{end}.
21201
21202 @kindex while
21203 @item while
21204 This command allows to write loops. Its syntax is similar to
21205 @code{if}: the command takes a single argument, which is an expression
21206 to evaluate, and must be followed by the commands to execute, one per
21207 line, terminated by an @code{end}. These commands are called the
21208 @dfn{body} of the loop. The commands in the body of @code{while} are
21209 executed repeatedly as long as the expression evaluates to true.
21210
21211 @kindex loop_break
21212 @item loop_break
21213 This command exits the @code{while} loop in whose body it is included.
21214 Execution of the script continues after that @code{while}s @code{end}
21215 line.
21216
21217 @kindex loop_continue
21218 @item loop_continue
21219 This command skips the execution of the rest of the body of commands
21220 in the @code{while} loop in whose body it is included. Execution
21221 branches to the beginning of the @code{while} loop, where it evaluates
21222 the controlling expression.
21223
21224 @kindex end@r{ (if/else/while commands)}
21225 @item end
21226 Terminate the block of commands that are the body of @code{if},
21227 @code{else}, or @code{while} flow-control commands.
21228 @end table
21229
21230
21231 @node Output
21232 @subsection Commands for Controlled Output
21233
21234 During the execution of a command file or a user-defined command, normal
21235 @value{GDBN} output is suppressed; the only output that appears is what is
21236 explicitly printed by the commands in the definition. This section
21237 describes three commands useful for generating exactly the output you
21238 want.
21239
21240 @table @code
21241 @kindex echo
21242 @item echo @var{text}
21243 @c I do not consider backslash-space a standard C escape sequence
21244 @c because it is not in ANSI.
21245 Print @var{text}. Nonprinting characters can be included in
21246 @var{text} using C escape sequences, such as @samp{\n} to print a
21247 newline. @strong{No newline is printed unless you specify one.}
21248 In addition to the standard C escape sequences, a backslash followed
21249 by a space stands for a space. This is useful for displaying a
21250 string with spaces at the beginning or the end, since leading and
21251 trailing spaces are otherwise trimmed from all arguments.
21252 To print @samp{@w{ }and foo =@w{ }}, use the command
21253 @samp{echo \@w{ }and foo = \@w{ }}.
21254
21255 A backslash at the end of @var{text} can be used, as in C, to continue
21256 the command onto subsequent lines. For example,
21257
21258 @smallexample
21259 echo This is some text\n\
21260 which is continued\n\
21261 onto several lines.\n
21262 @end smallexample
21263
21264 produces the same output as
21265
21266 @smallexample
21267 echo This is some text\n
21268 echo which is continued\n
21269 echo onto several lines.\n
21270 @end smallexample
21271
21272 @kindex output
21273 @item output @var{expression}
21274 Print the value of @var{expression} and nothing but that value: no
21275 newlines, no @samp{$@var{nn} = }. The value is not entered in the
21276 value history either. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}, for more information
21277 on expressions.
21278
21279 @item output/@var{fmt} @var{expression}
21280 Print the value of @var{expression} in format @var{fmt}. You can use
21281 the same formats as for @code{print}. @xref{Output Formats,,Output
21282 Formats}, for more information.
21283
21284 @kindex printf
21285 @item printf @var{template}, @var{expressions}@dots{}
21286 Print the values of one or more @var{expressions} under the control of
21287 the string @var{template}. To print several values, make
21288 @var{expressions} be a comma-separated list of individual expressions,
21289 which may be either numbers or pointers. Their values are printed as
21290 specified by @var{template}, exactly as a C program would do by
21291 executing the code below:
21292
21293 @smallexample
21294 printf (@var{template}, @var{expressions}@dots{});
21295 @end smallexample
21296
21297 As in @code{C} @code{printf}, ordinary characters in @var{template}
21298 are printed verbatim, while @dfn{conversion specification} introduced
21299 by the @samp{%} character cause subsequent @var{expressions} to be
21300 evaluated, their values converted and formatted according to type and
21301 style information encoded in the conversion specifications, and then
21302 printed.
21303
21304 For example, you can print two values in hex like this:
21305
21306 @smallexample
21307 printf "foo, bar-foo = 0x%x, 0x%x\n", foo, bar-foo
21308 @end smallexample
21309
21310 @code{printf} supports all the standard @code{C} conversion
21311 specifications, including the flags and modifiers between the @samp{%}
21312 character and the conversion letter, with the following exceptions:
21313
21314 @itemize @bullet
21315 @item
21316 The argument-ordering modifiers, such as @samp{2$}, are not supported.
21317
21318 @item
21319 The modifier @samp{*} is not supported for specifying precision or
21320 width.
21321
21322 @item
21323 The @samp{'} flag (for separation of digits into groups according to
21324 @code{LC_NUMERIC'}) is not supported.
21325
21326 @item
21327 The type modifiers @samp{hh}, @samp{j}, @samp{t}, and @samp{z} are not
21328 supported.
21329
21330 @item
21331 The conversion letter @samp{n} (as in @samp{%n}) is not supported.
21332
21333 @item
21334 The conversion letters @samp{a} and @samp{A} are not supported.
21335 @end itemize
21336
21337 @noindent
21338 Note that the @samp{ll} type modifier is supported only if the
21339 underlying @code{C} implementation used to build @value{GDBN} supports
21340 the @code{long long int} type, and the @samp{L} type modifier is
21341 supported only if @code{long double} type is available.
21342
21343 As in @code{C}, @code{printf} supports simple backslash-escape
21344 sequences, such as @code{\n}, @samp{\t}, @samp{\\}, @samp{\"},
21345 @samp{\a}, and @samp{\f}, that consist of backslash followed by a
21346 single character. Octal and hexadecimal escape sequences are not
21347 supported.
21348
21349 Additionally, @code{printf} supports conversion specifications for DFP
21350 (@dfn{Decimal Floating Point}) types using the following length modifiers
21351 together with a floating point specifier.
21352 letters:
21353
21354 @itemize @bullet
21355 @item
21356 @samp{H} for printing @code{Decimal32} types.
21357
21358 @item
21359 @samp{D} for printing @code{Decimal64} types.
21360
21361 @item
21362 @samp{DD} for printing @code{Decimal128} types.
21363 @end itemize
21364
21365 If the underlying @code{C} implementation used to build @value{GDBN} has
21366 support for the three length modifiers for DFP types, other modifiers
21367 such as width and precision will also be available for @value{GDBN} to use.
21368
21369 In case there is no such @code{C} support, no additional modifiers will be
21370 available and the value will be printed in the standard way.
21371
21372 Here's an example of printing DFP types using the above conversion letters:
21373 @smallexample
21374 printf "D32: %Hf - D64: %Df - D128: %DDf\n",1.2345df,1.2E10dd,1.2E1dl
21375 @end smallexample
21376
21377 @kindex eval
21378 @item eval @var{template}, @var{expressions}@dots{}
21379 Convert the values of one or more @var{expressions} under the control of
21380 the string @var{template} to a command line, and call it.
21381
21382 @end table
21383
21384 @node Python
21385 @section Scripting @value{GDBN} using Python
21386 @cindex python scripting
21387 @cindex scripting with python
21388
21389 You can script @value{GDBN} using the @uref{http://www.python.org/,
21390 Python programming language}. This feature is available only if
21391 @value{GDBN} was configured using @option{--with-python}.
21392
21393 @cindex python directory
21394 Python scripts used by @value{GDBN} should be installed in
21395 @file{@var{data-directory}/python}, where @var{data-directory} is
21396 the data directory as determined at @value{GDBN} startup (@pxref{Data Files}).
21397 This directory, known as the @dfn{python directory},
21398 is automatically added to the Python Search Path in order to allow
21399 the Python interpreter to locate all scripts installed at this location.
21400
21401 Additionally, @value{GDBN} commands and convenience functions which
21402 are written in Python and are located in the
21403 @file{@var{data-directory}/python/gdb/command} or
21404 @file{@var{data-directory}/python/gdb/function} directories are
21405 automatically imported when @value{GDBN} starts.
21406
21407 @menu
21408 * Python Commands:: Accessing Python from @value{GDBN}.
21409 * Python API:: Accessing @value{GDBN} from Python.
21410 * Auto-loading:: Automatically loading Python code.
21411 * Python modules:: Python modules provided by @value{GDBN}.
21412 @end menu
21413
21414 @node Python Commands
21415 @subsection Python Commands
21416 @cindex python commands
21417 @cindex commands to access python
21418
21419 @value{GDBN} provides one command for accessing the Python interpreter,
21420 and one related setting:
21421
21422 @table @code
21423 @kindex python
21424 @item python @r{[}@var{code}@r{]}
21425 The @code{python} command can be used to evaluate Python code.
21426
21427 If given an argument, the @code{python} command will evaluate the
21428 argument as a Python command. For example:
21429
21430 @smallexample
21431 (@value{GDBP}) python print 23
21432 23
21433 @end smallexample
21434
21435 If you do not provide an argument to @code{python}, it will act as a
21436 multi-line command, like @code{define}. In this case, the Python
21437 script is made up of subsequent command lines, given after the
21438 @code{python} command. This command list is terminated using a line
21439 containing @code{end}. For example:
21440
21441 @smallexample
21442 (@value{GDBP}) python
21443 Type python script
21444 End with a line saying just "end".
21445 >print 23
21446 >end
21447 23
21448 @end smallexample
21449
21450 @kindex set python print-stack
21451 @item set python print-stack
21452 By default, @value{GDBN} will print only the message component of a
21453 Python exception when an error occurs in a Python script. This can be
21454 controlled using @code{set python print-stack}: if @code{full}, then
21455 full Python stack printing is enabled; if @code{none}, then Python stack
21456 and message printing is disabled; if @code{message}, the default, only
21457 the message component of the error is printed.
21458 @end table
21459
21460 It is also possible to execute a Python script from the @value{GDBN}
21461 interpreter:
21462
21463 @table @code
21464 @item source @file{script-name}
21465 The script name must end with @samp{.py} and @value{GDBN} must be configured
21466 to recognize the script language based on filename extension using
21467 the @code{script-extension} setting. @xref{Extending GDB, ,Extending GDB}.
21468
21469 @item python execfile ("script-name")
21470 This method is based on the @code{execfile} Python built-in function,
21471 and thus is always available.
21472 @end table
21473
21474 @node Python API
21475 @subsection Python API
21476 @cindex python api
21477 @cindex programming in python
21478
21479 @cindex python stdout
21480 @cindex python pagination
21481 At startup, @value{GDBN} overrides Python's @code{sys.stdout} and
21482 @code{sys.stderr} to print using @value{GDBN}'s output-paging streams.
21483 A Python program which outputs to one of these streams may have its
21484 output interrupted by the user (@pxref{Screen Size}). In this
21485 situation, a Python @code{KeyboardInterrupt} exception is thrown.
21486
21487 @menu
21488 * Basic Python:: Basic Python Functions.
21489 * Exception Handling:: How Python exceptions are translated.
21490 * Values From Inferior:: Python representation of values.
21491 * Types In Python:: Python representation of types.
21492 * Pretty Printing API:: Pretty-printing values.
21493 * Selecting Pretty-Printers:: How GDB chooses a pretty-printer.
21494 * Writing a Pretty-Printer:: Writing a Pretty-Printer.
21495 * Inferiors In Python:: Python representation of inferiors (processes)
21496 * Events In Python:: Listening for events from @value{GDBN}.
21497 * Threads In Python:: Accessing inferior threads from Python.
21498 * Commands In Python:: Implementing new commands in Python.
21499 * Parameters In Python:: Adding new @value{GDBN} parameters.
21500 * Functions In Python:: Writing new convenience functions.
21501 * Progspaces In Python:: Program spaces.
21502 * Objfiles In Python:: Object files.
21503 * Frames In Python:: Accessing inferior stack frames from Python.
21504 * Blocks In Python:: Accessing frame blocks from Python.
21505 * Symbols In Python:: Python representation of symbols.
21506 * Symbol Tables In Python:: Python representation of symbol tables.
21507 * Lazy Strings In Python:: Python representation of lazy strings.
21508 * Breakpoints In Python:: Manipulating breakpoints using Python.
21509 @end menu
21510
21511 @node Basic Python
21512 @subsubsection Basic Python
21513
21514 @cindex python functions
21515 @cindex python module
21516 @cindex gdb module
21517 @value{GDBN} introduces a new Python module, named @code{gdb}. All
21518 methods and classes added by @value{GDBN} are placed in this module.
21519 @value{GDBN} automatically @code{import}s the @code{gdb} module for
21520 use in all scripts evaluated by the @code{python} command.
21521
21522 @findex gdb.PYTHONDIR
21523 @defvar gdb.PYTHONDIR
21524 A string containing the python directory (@pxref{Python}).
21525 @end defvar
21526
21527 @findex gdb.execute
21528 @defun gdb.execute (command @r{[}, from_tty @r{[}, to_string@r{]]})
21529 Evaluate @var{command}, a string, as a @value{GDBN} CLI command.
21530 If a GDB exception happens while @var{command} runs, it is
21531 translated as described in @ref{Exception Handling,,Exception Handling}.
21532
21533 @var{from_tty} specifies whether @value{GDBN} ought to consider this
21534 command as having originated from the user invoking it interactively.
21535 It must be a boolean value. If omitted, it defaults to @code{False}.
21536
21537 By default, any output produced by @var{command} is sent to
21538 @value{GDBN}'s standard output. If the @var{to_string} parameter is
21539 @code{True}, then output will be collected by @code{gdb.execute} and
21540 returned as a string. The default is @code{False}, in which case the
21541 return value is @code{None}. If @var{to_string} is @code{True}, the
21542 @value{GDBN} virtual terminal will be temporarily set to unlimited width
21543 and height, and its pagination will be disabled; @pxref{Screen Size}.
21544 @end defun
21545
21546 @findex gdb.breakpoints
21547 @defun gdb.breakpoints ()
21548 Return a sequence holding all of @value{GDBN}'s breakpoints.
21549 @xref{Breakpoints In Python}, for more information.
21550 @end defun
21551
21552 @findex gdb.parameter
21553 @defun gdb.parameter (parameter)
21554 Return the value of a @value{GDBN} parameter. @var{parameter} is a
21555 string naming the parameter to look up; @var{parameter} may contain
21556 spaces if the parameter has a multi-part name. For example,
21557 @samp{print object} is a valid parameter name.
21558
21559 If the named parameter does not exist, this function throws a
21560 @code{gdb.error} (@pxref{Exception Handling}). Otherwise, the
21561 parameter's value is converted to a Python value of the appropriate
21562 type, and returned.
21563 @end defun
21564
21565 @findex gdb.history
21566 @defun gdb.history (number)
21567 Return a value from @value{GDBN}'s value history (@pxref{Value
21568 History}). @var{number} indicates which history element to return.
21569 If @var{number} is negative, then @value{GDBN} will take its absolute value
21570 and count backward from the last element (i.e., the most recent element) to
21571 find the value to return. If @var{number} is zero, then @value{GDBN} will
21572 return the most recent element. If the element specified by @var{number}
21573 doesn't exist in the value history, a @code{gdb.error} exception will be
21574 raised.
21575
21576 If no exception is raised, the return value is always an instance of
21577 @code{gdb.Value} (@pxref{Values From Inferior}).
21578 @end defun
21579
21580 @findex gdb.parse_and_eval
21581 @defun gdb.parse_and_eval (expression)
21582 Parse @var{expression} as an expression in the current language,
21583 evaluate it, and return the result as a @code{gdb.Value}.
21584 @var{expression} must be a string.
21585
21586 This function can be useful when implementing a new command
21587 (@pxref{Commands In Python}), as it provides a way to parse the
21588 command's argument as an expression. It is also useful simply to
21589 compute values, for example, it is the only way to get the value of a
21590 convenience variable (@pxref{Convenience Vars}) as a @code{gdb.Value}.
21591 @end defun
21592
21593 @findex gdb.post_event
21594 @defun gdb.post_event (event)
21595 Put @var{event}, a callable object taking no arguments, into
21596 @value{GDBN}'s internal event queue. This callable will be invoked at
21597 some later point, during @value{GDBN}'s event processing. Events
21598 posted using @code{post_event} will be run in the order in which they
21599 were posted; however, there is no way to know when they will be
21600 processed relative to other events inside @value{GDBN}.
21601
21602 @value{GDBN} is not thread-safe. If your Python program uses multiple
21603 threads, you must be careful to only call @value{GDBN}-specific
21604 functions in the main @value{GDBN} thread. @code{post_event} ensures
21605 this. For example:
21606
21607 @smallexample
21608 (@value{GDBP}) python
21609 >import threading
21610 >
21611 >class Writer():
21612 > def __init__(self, message):
21613 > self.message = message;
21614 > def __call__(self):
21615 > gdb.write(self.message)
21616 >
21617 >class MyThread1 (threading.Thread):
21618 > def run (self):
21619 > gdb.post_event(Writer("Hello "))
21620 >
21621 >class MyThread2 (threading.Thread):
21622 > def run (self):
21623 > gdb.post_event(Writer("World\n"))
21624 >
21625 >MyThread1().start()
21626 >MyThread2().start()
21627 >end
21628 (@value{GDBP}) Hello World
21629 @end smallexample
21630 @end defun
21631
21632 @findex gdb.write
21633 @defun gdb.write (string @r{[}, stream{]})
21634 Print a string to @value{GDBN}'s paginated output stream. The
21635 optional @var{stream} determines the stream to print to. The default
21636 stream is @value{GDBN}'s standard output stream. Possible stream
21637 values are:
21638
21639 @table @code
21640 @findex STDOUT
21641 @findex gdb.STDOUT
21642 @item gdb.STDOUT
21643 @value{GDBN}'s standard output stream.
21644
21645 @findex STDERR
21646 @findex gdb.STDERR
21647 @item gdb.STDERR
21648 @value{GDBN}'s standard error stream.
21649
21650 @findex STDLOG
21651 @findex gdb.STDLOG
21652 @item gdb.STDLOG
21653 @value{GDBN}'s log stream (@pxref{Logging Output}).
21654 @end table
21655
21656 Writing to @code{sys.stdout} or @code{sys.stderr} will automatically
21657 call this function and will automatically direct the output to the
21658 relevant stream.
21659 @end defun
21660
21661 @findex gdb.flush
21662 @defun gdb.flush ()
21663 Flush the buffer of a @value{GDBN} paginated stream so that the
21664 contents are displayed immediately. @value{GDBN} will flush the
21665 contents of a stream automatically when it encounters a newline in the
21666 buffer. The optional @var{stream} determines the stream to flush. The
21667 default stream is @value{GDBN}'s standard output stream. Possible
21668 stream values are:
21669
21670 @table @code
21671 @findex STDOUT
21672 @findex gdb.STDOUT
21673 @item gdb.STDOUT
21674 @value{GDBN}'s standard output stream.
21675
21676 @findex STDERR
21677 @findex gdb.STDERR
21678 @item gdb.STDERR
21679 @value{GDBN}'s standard error stream.
21680
21681 @findex STDLOG
21682 @findex gdb.STDLOG
21683 @item gdb.STDLOG
21684 @value{GDBN}'s log stream (@pxref{Logging Output}).
21685
21686 @end table
21687
21688 Flushing @code{sys.stdout} or @code{sys.stderr} will automatically
21689 call this function for the relevant stream.
21690 @end defun
21691
21692 @findex gdb.target_charset
21693 @defun gdb.target_charset ()
21694 Return the name of the current target character set (@pxref{Character
21695 Sets}). This differs from @code{gdb.parameter('target-charset')} in
21696 that @samp{auto} is never returned.
21697 @end defun
21698
21699 @findex gdb.target_wide_charset
21700 @defun gdb.target_wide_charset ()
21701 Return the name of the current target wide character set
21702 (@pxref{Character Sets}). This differs from
21703 @code{gdb.parameter('target-wide-charset')} in that @samp{auto} is
21704 never returned.
21705 @end defun
21706
21707 @findex gdb.solib_name
21708 @defun gdb.solib_name (address)
21709 Return the name of the shared library holding the given @var{address}
21710 as a string, or @code{None}.
21711 @end defun
21712
21713 @findex gdb.decode_line
21714 @defun gdb.decode_line @r{[}expression@r{]}
21715 Return locations of the line specified by @var{expression}, or of the
21716 current line if no argument was given. This function returns a Python
21717 tuple containing two elements. The first element contains a string
21718 holding any unparsed section of @var{expression} (or @code{None} if
21719 the expression has been fully parsed). The second element contains
21720 either @code{None} or another tuple that contains all the locations
21721 that match the expression represented as @code{gdb.Symtab_and_line}
21722 objects (@pxref{Symbol Tables In Python}). If @var{expression} is
21723 provided, it is decoded the way that @value{GDBN}'s inbuilt
21724 @code{break} or @code{edit} commands do (@pxref{Specify Location}).
21725 @end defun
21726
21727 @defun gdb.prompt_hook (current_prompt)
21728 @anchor{prompt_hook}
21729
21730 If @var{prompt_hook} is callable, @value{GDBN} will call the method
21731 assigned to this operation before a prompt is displayed by
21732 @value{GDBN}.
21733
21734 The parameter @code{current_prompt} contains the current @value{GDBN}
21735 prompt. This method must return a Python string, or @code{None}. If
21736 a string is returned, the @value{GDBN} prompt will be set to that
21737 string. If @code{None} is returned, @value{GDBN} will continue to use
21738 the current prompt.
21739
21740 Some prompts cannot be substituted in @value{GDBN}. Secondary prompts
21741 such as those used by readline for command input, and annotation
21742 related prompts are prohibited from being changed.
21743 @end defun
21744
21745 @node Exception Handling
21746 @subsubsection Exception Handling
21747 @cindex python exceptions
21748 @cindex exceptions, python
21749
21750 When executing the @code{python} command, Python exceptions
21751 uncaught within the Python code are translated to calls to
21752 @value{GDBN} error-reporting mechanism. If the command that called
21753 @code{python} does not handle the error, @value{GDBN} will
21754 terminate it and print an error message containing the Python
21755 exception name, the associated value, and the Python call stack
21756 backtrace at the point where the exception was raised. Example:
21757
21758 @smallexample
21759 (@value{GDBP}) python print foo
21760 Traceback (most recent call last):
21761 File "<string>", line 1, in <module>
21762 NameError: name 'foo' is not defined
21763 @end smallexample
21764
21765 @value{GDBN} errors that happen in @value{GDBN} commands invoked by
21766 Python code are converted to Python exceptions. The type of the
21767 Python exception depends on the error.
21768
21769 @ftable @code
21770 @item gdb.error
21771 This is the base class for most exceptions generated by @value{GDBN}.
21772 It is derived from @code{RuntimeError}, for compatibility with earlier
21773 versions of @value{GDBN}.
21774
21775 If an error occurring in @value{GDBN} does not fit into some more
21776 specific category, then the generated exception will have this type.
21777
21778 @item gdb.MemoryError
21779 This is a subclass of @code{gdb.error} which is thrown when an
21780 operation tried to access invalid memory in the inferior.
21781
21782 @item KeyboardInterrupt
21783 User interrupt (via @kbd{C-c} or by typing @kbd{q} at a pagination
21784 prompt) is translated to a Python @code{KeyboardInterrupt} exception.
21785 @end ftable
21786
21787 In all cases, your exception handler will see the @value{GDBN} error
21788 message as its value and the Python call stack backtrace at the Python
21789 statement closest to where the @value{GDBN} error occured as the
21790 traceback.
21791
21792 @findex gdb.GdbError
21793 When implementing @value{GDBN} commands in Python via @code{gdb.Command},
21794 it is useful to be able to throw an exception that doesn't cause a
21795 traceback to be printed. For example, the user may have invoked the
21796 command incorrectly. Use the @code{gdb.GdbError} exception
21797 to handle this case. Example:
21798
21799 @smallexample
21800 (gdb) python
21801 >class HelloWorld (gdb.Command):
21802 > """Greet the whole world."""
21803 > def __init__ (self):
21804 > super (HelloWorld, self).__init__ ("hello-world", gdb.COMMAND_OBSCURE)
21805 > def invoke (self, args, from_tty):
21806 > argv = gdb.string_to_argv (args)
21807 > if len (argv) != 0:
21808 > raise gdb.GdbError ("hello-world takes no arguments")
21809 > print "Hello, World!"
21810 >HelloWorld ()
21811 >end
21812 (gdb) hello-world 42
21813 hello-world takes no arguments
21814 @end smallexample
21815
21816 @node Values From Inferior
21817 @subsubsection Values From Inferior
21818 @cindex values from inferior, with Python
21819 @cindex python, working with values from inferior
21820
21821 @cindex @code{gdb.Value}
21822 @value{GDBN} provides values it obtains from the inferior program in
21823 an object of type @code{gdb.Value}. @value{GDBN} uses this object
21824 for its internal bookkeeping of the inferior's values, and for
21825 fetching values when necessary.
21826
21827 Inferior values that are simple scalars can be used directly in
21828 Python expressions that are valid for the value's data type. Here's
21829 an example for an integer or floating-point value @code{some_val}:
21830
21831 @smallexample
21832 bar = some_val + 2
21833 @end smallexample
21834
21835 @noindent
21836 As result of this, @code{bar} will also be a @code{gdb.Value} object
21837 whose values are of the same type as those of @code{some_val}.
21838
21839 Inferior values that are structures or instances of some class can
21840 be accessed using the Python @dfn{dictionary syntax}. For example, if
21841 @code{some_val} is a @code{gdb.Value} instance holding a structure, you
21842 can access its @code{foo} element with:
21843
21844 @smallexample
21845 bar = some_val['foo']
21846 @end smallexample
21847
21848 Again, @code{bar} will also be a @code{gdb.Value} object.
21849
21850 A @code{gdb.Value} that represents a function can be executed via
21851 inferior function call. Any arguments provided to the call must match
21852 the function's prototype, and must be provided in the order specified
21853 by that prototype.
21854
21855 For example, @code{some_val} is a @code{gdb.Value} instance
21856 representing a function that takes two integers as arguments. To
21857 execute this function, call it like so:
21858
21859 @smallexample
21860 result = some_val (10,20)
21861 @end smallexample
21862
21863 Any values returned from a function call will be stored as a
21864 @code{gdb.Value}.
21865
21866 The following attributes are provided:
21867
21868 @table @code
21869 @defvar Value.address
21870 If this object is addressable, this read-only attribute holds a
21871 @code{gdb.Value} object representing the address. Otherwise,
21872 this attribute holds @code{None}.
21873 @end defvar
21874
21875 @cindex optimized out value in Python
21876 @defvar Value.is_optimized_out
21877 This read-only boolean attribute is true if the compiler optimized out
21878 this value, thus it is not available for fetching from the inferior.
21879 @end defvar
21880
21881 @defvar Value.type
21882 The type of this @code{gdb.Value}. The value of this attribute is a
21883 @code{gdb.Type} object (@pxref{Types In Python}).
21884 @end defvar
21885
21886 @defvar Value.dynamic_type
21887 The dynamic type of this @code{gdb.Value}. This uses C@t{++} run-time
21888 type information (@acronym{RTTI}) to determine the dynamic type of the
21889 value. If this value is of class type, it will return the class in
21890 which the value is embedded, if any. If this value is of pointer or
21891 reference to a class type, it will compute the dynamic type of the
21892 referenced object, and return a pointer or reference to that type,
21893 respectively. In all other cases, it will return the value's static
21894 type.
21895
21896 Note that this feature will only work when debugging a C@t{++} program
21897 that includes @acronym{RTTI} for the object in question. Otherwise,
21898 it will just return the static type of the value as in @kbd{ptype foo}
21899 (@pxref{Symbols, ptype}).
21900 @end defvar
21901
21902 @defvar Value.is_lazy
21903 The value of this read-only boolean attribute is @code{True} if this
21904 @code{gdb.Value} has not yet been fetched from the inferior.
21905 @value{GDBN} does not fetch values until necessary, for efficiency.
21906 For example:
21907
21908 @smallexample
21909 myval = gdb.parse_and_eval ('somevar')
21910 @end smallexample
21911
21912 The value of @code{somevar} is not fetched at this time. It will be
21913 fetched when the value is needed, or when the @code{fetch_lazy}
21914 method is invoked.
21915 @end defvar
21916 @end table
21917
21918 The following methods are provided:
21919
21920 @table @code
21921 @defun Value.__init__ (@var{val})
21922 Many Python values can be converted directly to a @code{gdb.Value} via
21923 this object initializer. Specifically:
21924
21925 @table @asis
21926 @item Python boolean
21927 A Python boolean is converted to the boolean type from the current
21928 language.
21929
21930 @item Python integer
21931 A Python integer is converted to the C @code{long} type for the
21932 current architecture.
21933
21934 @item Python long
21935 A Python long is converted to the C @code{long long} type for the
21936 current architecture.
21937
21938 @item Python float
21939 A Python float is converted to the C @code{double} type for the
21940 current architecture.
21941
21942 @item Python string
21943 A Python string is converted to a target string, using the current
21944 target encoding.
21945
21946 @item @code{gdb.Value}
21947 If @code{val} is a @code{gdb.Value}, then a copy of the value is made.
21948
21949 @item @code{gdb.LazyString}
21950 If @code{val} is a @code{gdb.LazyString} (@pxref{Lazy Strings In
21951 Python}), then the lazy string's @code{value} method is called, and
21952 its result is used.
21953 @end table
21954 @end defun
21955
21956 @defun Value.cast (type)
21957 Return a new instance of @code{gdb.Value} that is the result of
21958 casting this instance to the type described by @var{type}, which must
21959 be a @code{gdb.Type} object. If the cast cannot be performed for some
21960 reason, this method throws an exception.
21961 @end defun
21962
21963 @defun Value.dereference ()
21964 For pointer data types, this method returns a new @code{gdb.Value} object
21965 whose contents is the object pointed to by the pointer. For example, if
21966 @code{foo} is a C pointer to an @code{int}, declared in your C program as
21967
21968 @smallexample
21969 int *foo;
21970 @end smallexample
21971
21972 @noindent
21973 then you can use the corresponding @code{gdb.Value} to access what
21974 @code{foo} points to like this:
21975
21976 @smallexample
21977 bar = foo.dereference ()
21978 @end smallexample
21979
21980 The result @code{bar} will be a @code{gdb.Value} object holding the
21981 value pointed to by @code{foo}.
21982 @end defun
21983
21984 @defun Value.dynamic_cast (type)
21985 Like @code{Value.cast}, but works as if the C@t{++} @code{dynamic_cast}
21986 operator were used. Consult a C@t{++} reference for details.
21987 @end defun
21988
21989 @defun Value.reinterpret_cast (type)
21990 Like @code{Value.cast}, but works as if the C@t{++} @code{reinterpret_cast}
21991 operator were used. Consult a C@t{++} reference for details.
21992 @end defun
21993
21994 @defun Value.string (@r{[}encoding@r{[}, errors@r{[}, length@r{]]]})
21995 If this @code{gdb.Value} represents a string, then this method
21996 converts the contents to a Python string. Otherwise, this method will
21997 throw an exception.
21998
21999 Strings are recognized in a language-specific way; whether a given
22000 @code{gdb.Value} represents a string is determined by the current
22001 language.
22002
22003 For C-like languages, a value is a string if it is a pointer to or an
22004 array of characters or ints. The string is assumed to be terminated
22005 by a zero of the appropriate width. However if the optional length
22006 argument is given, the string will be converted to that given length,
22007 ignoring any embedded zeros that the string may contain.
22008
22009 If the optional @var{encoding} argument is given, it must be a string
22010 naming the encoding of the string in the @code{gdb.Value}, such as
22011 @code{"ascii"}, @code{"iso-8859-6"} or @code{"utf-8"}. It accepts
22012 the same encodings as the corresponding argument to Python's
22013 @code{string.decode} method, and the Python codec machinery will be used
22014 to convert the string. If @var{encoding} is not given, or if
22015 @var{encoding} is the empty string, then either the @code{target-charset}
22016 (@pxref{Character Sets}) will be used, or a language-specific encoding
22017 will be used, if the current language is able to supply one.
22018
22019 The optional @var{errors} argument is the same as the corresponding
22020 argument to Python's @code{string.decode} method.
22021
22022 If the optional @var{length} argument is given, the string will be
22023 fetched and converted to the given length.
22024 @end defun
22025
22026 @defun Value.lazy_string (@r{[}encoding @r{[}, length@r{]]})
22027 If this @code{gdb.Value} represents a string, then this method
22028 converts the contents to a @code{gdb.LazyString} (@pxref{Lazy Strings
22029 In Python}). Otherwise, this method will throw an exception.
22030
22031 If the optional @var{encoding} argument is given, it must be a string
22032 naming the encoding of the @code{gdb.LazyString}. Some examples are:
22033 @samp{ascii}, @samp{iso-8859-6} or @samp{utf-8}. If the
22034 @var{encoding} argument is an encoding that @value{GDBN} does
22035 recognize, @value{GDBN} will raise an error.
22036
22037 When a lazy string is printed, the @value{GDBN} encoding machinery is
22038 used to convert the string during printing. If the optional
22039 @var{encoding} argument is not provided, or is an empty string,
22040 @value{GDBN} will automatically select the encoding most suitable for
22041 the string type. For further information on encoding in @value{GDBN}
22042 please see @ref{Character Sets}.
22043
22044 If the optional @var{length} argument is given, the string will be
22045 fetched and encoded to the length of characters specified. If
22046 the @var{length} argument is not provided, the string will be fetched
22047 and encoded until a null of appropriate width is found.
22048 @end defun
22049
22050 @defun Value.fetch_lazy ()
22051 If the @code{gdb.Value} object is currently a lazy value
22052 (@code{gdb.Value.is_lazy} is @code{True}), then the value is
22053 fetched from the inferior. Any errors that occur in the process
22054 will produce a Python exception.
22055
22056 If the @code{gdb.Value} object is not a lazy value, this method
22057 has no effect.
22058
22059 This method does not return a value.
22060 @end defun
22061
22062 @end table
22063
22064 @node Types In Python
22065 @subsubsection Types In Python
22066 @cindex types in Python
22067 @cindex Python, working with types
22068
22069 @tindex gdb.Type
22070 @value{GDBN} represents types from the inferior using the class
22071 @code{gdb.Type}.
22072
22073 The following type-related functions are available in the @code{gdb}
22074 module:
22075
22076 @findex gdb.lookup_type
22077 @defun gdb.lookup_type (name @r{[}, block@r{]})
22078 This function looks up a type by name. @var{name} is the name of the
22079 type to look up. It must be a string.
22080
22081 If @var{block} is given, then @var{name} is looked up in that scope.
22082 Otherwise, it is searched for globally.
22083
22084 Ordinarily, this function will return an instance of @code{gdb.Type}.
22085 If the named type cannot be found, it will throw an exception.
22086 @end defun
22087
22088 If the type is a structure or class type, or an enum type, the fields
22089 of that type can be accessed using the Python @dfn{dictionary syntax}.
22090 For example, if @code{some_type} is a @code{gdb.Type} instance holding
22091 a structure type, you can access its @code{foo} field with:
22092
22093 @smallexample
22094 bar = some_type['foo']
22095 @end smallexample
22096
22097 @code{bar} will be a @code{gdb.Field} object; see below under the
22098 description of the @code{Type.fields} method for a description of the
22099 @code{gdb.Field} class.
22100
22101 An instance of @code{Type} has the following attributes:
22102
22103 @table @code
22104 @defvar Type.code
22105 The type code for this type. The type code will be one of the
22106 @code{TYPE_CODE_} constants defined below.
22107 @end defvar
22108
22109 @defvar Type.sizeof
22110 The size of this type, in target @code{char} units. Usually, a
22111 target's @code{char} type will be an 8-bit byte. However, on some
22112 unusual platforms, this type may have a different size.
22113 @end defvar
22114
22115 @defvar Type.tag
22116 The tag name for this type. The tag name is the name after
22117 @code{struct}, @code{union}, or @code{enum} in C and C@t{++}; not all
22118 languages have this concept. If this type has no tag name, then
22119 @code{None} is returned.
22120 @end defvar
22121 @end table
22122
22123 The following methods are provided:
22124
22125 @table @code
22126 @defun Type.fields ()
22127 For structure and union types, this method returns the fields. Range
22128 types have two fields, the minimum and maximum values. Enum types
22129 have one field per enum constant. Function and method types have one
22130 field per parameter. The base types of C@t{++} classes are also
22131 represented as fields. If the type has no fields, or does not fit
22132 into one of these categories, an empty sequence will be returned.
22133
22134 Each field is a @code{gdb.Field} object, with some pre-defined attributes:
22135 @table @code
22136 @item bitpos
22137 This attribute is not available for @code{static} fields (as in
22138 C@t{++} or Java). For non-@code{static} fields, the value is the bit
22139 position of the field. For @code{enum} fields, the value is the
22140 enumeration member's integer representation.
22141
22142 @item name
22143 The name of the field, or @code{None} for anonymous fields.
22144
22145 @item artificial
22146 This is @code{True} if the field is artificial, usually meaning that
22147 it was provided by the compiler and not the user. This attribute is
22148 always provided, and is @code{False} if the field is not artificial.
22149
22150 @item is_base_class
22151 This is @code{True} if the field represents a base class of a C@t{++}
22152 structure. This attribute is always provided, and is @code{False}
22153 if the field is not a base class of the type that is the argument of
22154 @code{fields}, or if that type was not a C@t{++} class.
22155
22156 @item bitsize
22157 If the field is packed, or is a bitfield, then this will have a
22158 non-zero value, which is the size of the field in bits. Otherwise,
22159 this will be zero; in this case the field's size is given by its type.
22160
22161 @item type
22162 The type of the field. This is usually an instance of @code{Type},
22163 but it can be @code{None} in some situations.
22164 @end table
22165 @end defun
22166
22167 @defun Type.array (@var{n1} @r{[}, @var{n2}@r{]})
22168 Return a new @code{gdb.Type} object which represents an array of this
22169 type. If one argument is given, it is the inclusive upper bound of
22170 the array; in this case the lower bound is zero. If two arguments are
22171 given, the first argument is the lower bound of the array, and the
22172 second argument is the upper bound of the array. An array's length
22173 must not be negative, but the bounds can be.
22174 @end defun
22175
22176 @defun Type.const ()
22177 Return a new @code{gdb.Type} object which represents a
22178 @code{const}-qualified variant of this type.
22179 @end defun
22180
22181 @defun Type.volatile ()
22182 Return a new @code{gdb.Type} object which represents a
22183 @code{volatile}-qualified variant of this type.
22184 @end defun
22185
22186 @defun Type.unqualified ()
22187 Return a new @code{gdb.Type} object which represents an unqualified
22188 variant of this type. That is, the result is neither @code{const} nor
22189 @code{volatile}.
22190 @end defun
22191
22192 @defun Type.range ()
22193 Return a Python @code{Tuple} object that contains two elements: the
22194 low bound of the argument type and the high bound of that type. If
22195 the type does not have a range, @value{GDBN} will raise a
22196 @code{gdb.error} exception (@pxref{Exception Handling}).
22197 @end defun
22198
22199 @defun Type.reference ()
22200 Return a new @code{gdb.Type} object which represents a reference to this
22201 type.
22202 @end defun
22203
22204 @defun Type.pointer ()
22205 Return a new @code{gdb.Type} object which represents a pointer to this
22206 type.
22207 @end defun
22208
22209 @defun Type.strip_typedefs ()
22210 Return a new @code{gdb.Type} that represents the real type,
22211 after removing all layers of typedefs.
22212 @end defun
22213
22214 @defun Type.target ()
22215 Return a new @code{gdb.Type} object which represents the target type
22216 of this type.
22217
22218 For a pointer type, the target type is the type of the pointed-to
22219 object. For an array type (meaning C-like arrays), the target type is
22220 the type of the elements of the array. For a function or method type,
22221 the target type is the type of the return value. For a complex type,
22222 the target type is the type of the elements. For a typedef, the
22223 target type is the aliased type.
22224
22225 If the type does not have a target, this method will throw an
22226 exception.
22227 @end defun
22228
22229 @defun Type.template_argument (n @r{[}, block@r{]})
22230 If this @code{gdb.Type} is an instantiation of a template, this will
22231 return a new @code{gdb.Type} which represents the type of the
22232 @var{n}th template argument.
22233
22234 If this @code{gdb.Type} is not a template type, this will throw an
22235 exception. Ordinarily, only C@t{++} code will have template types.
22236
22237 If @var{block} is given, then @var{name} is looked up in that scope.
22238 Otherwise, it is searched for globally.
22239 @end defun
22240 @end table
22241
22242
22243 Each type has a code, which indicates what category this type falls
22244 into. The available type categories are represented by constants
22245 defined in the @code{gdb} module:
22246
22247 @table @code
22248 @findex TYPE_CODE_PTR
22249 @findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_PTR
22250 @item gdb.TYPE_CODE_PTR
22251 The type is a pointer.
22252
22253 @findex TYPE_CODE_ARRAY
22254 @findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_ARRAY
22255 @item gdb.TYPE_CODE_ARRAY
22256 The type is an array.
22257
22258 @findex TYPE_CODE_STRUCT
22259 @findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_STRUCT
22260 @item gdb.TYPE_CODE_STRUCT
22261 The type is a structure.
22262
22263 @findex TYPE_CODE_UNION
22264 @findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_UNION
22265 @item gdb.TYPE_CODE_UNION
22266 The type is a union.
22267
22268 @findex TYPE_CODE_ENUM
22269 @findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_ENUM
22270 @item gdb.TYPE_CODE_ENUM
22271 The type is an enum.
22272
22273 @findex TYPE_CODE_FLAGS
22274 @findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_FLAGS
22275 @item gdb.TYPE_CODE_FLAGS
22276 A bit flags type, used for things such as status registers.
22277
22278 @findex TYPE_CODE_FUNC
22279 @findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_FUNC
22280 @item gdb.TYPE_CODE_FUNC
22281 The type is a function.
22282
22283 @findex TYPE_CODE_INT
22284 @findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_INT
22285 @item gdb.TYPE_CODE_INT
22286 The type is an integer type.
22287
22288 @findex TYPE_CODE_FLT
22289 @findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_FLT
22290 @item gdb.TYPE_CODE_FLT
22291 A floating point type.
22292
22293 @findex TYPE_CODE_VOID
22294 @findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_VOID
22295 @item gdb.TYPE_CODE_VOID
22296 The special type @code{void}.
22297
22298 @findex TYPE_CODE_SET
22299 @findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_SET
22300 @item gdb.TYPE_CODE_SET
22301 A Pascal set type.
22302
22303 @findex TYPE_CODE_RANGE
22304 @findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_RANGE
22305 @item gdb.TYPE_CODE_RANGE
22306 A range type, that is, an integer type with bounds.
22307
22308 @findex TYPE_CODE_STRING
22309 @findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_STRING
22310 @item gdb.TYPE_CODE_STRING
22311 A string type. Note that this is only used for certain languages with
22312 language-defined string types; C strings are not represented this way.
22313
22314 @findex TYPE_CODE_BITSTRING
22315 @findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_BITSTRING
22316 @item gdb.TYPE_CODE_BITSTRING
22317 A string of bits.
22318
22319 @findex TYPE_CODE_ERROR
22320 @findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_ERROR
22321 @item gdb.TYPE_CODE_ERROR
22322 An unknown or erroneous type.
22323
22324 @findex TYPE_CODE_METHOD
22325 @findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_METHOD
22326 @item gdb.TYPE_CODE_METHOD
22327 A method type, as found in C@t{++} or Java.
22328
22329 @findex TYPE_CODE_METHODPTR
22330 @findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_METHODPTR
22331 @item gdb.TYPE_CODE_METHODPTR
22332 A pointer-to-member-function.
22333
22334 @findex TYPE_CODE_MEMBERPTR
22335 @findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_MEMBERPTR
22336 @item gdb.TYPE_CODE_MEMBERPTR
22337 A pointer-to-member.
22338
22339 @findex TYPE_CODE_REF
22340 @findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_REF
22341 @item gdb.TYPE_CODE_REF
22342 A reference type.
22343
22344 @findex TYPE_CODE_CHAR
22345 @findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_CHAR
22346 @item gdb.TYPE_CODE_CHAR
22347 A character type.
22348
22349 @findex TYPE_CODE_BOOL
22350 @findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_BOOL
22351 @item gdb.TYPE_CODE_BOOL
22352 A boolean type.
22353
22354 @findex TYPE_CODE_COMPLEX
22355 @findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_COMPLEX
22356 @item gdb.TYPE_CODE_COMPLEX
22357 A complex float type.
22358
22359 @findex TYPE_CODE_TYPEDEF
22360 @findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_TYPEDEF
22361 @item gdb.TYPE_CODE_TYPEDEF
22362 A typedef to some other type.
22363
22364 @findex TYPE_CODE_NAMESPACE
22365 @findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_NAMESPACE
22366 @item gdb.TYPE_CODE_NAMESPACE
22367 A C@t{++} namespace.
22368
22369 @findex TYPE_CODE_DECFLOAT
22370 @findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_DECFLOAT
22371 @item gdb.TYPE_CODE_DECFLOAT
22372 A decimal floating point type.
22373
22374 @findex TYPE_CODE_INTERNAL_FUNCTION
22375 @findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_INTERNAL_FUNCTION
22376 @item gdb.TYPE_CODE_INTERNAL_FUNCTION
22377 A function internal to @value{GDBN}. This is the type used to represent
22378 convenience functions.
22379 @end table
22380
22381 Further support for types is provided in the @code{gdb.types}
22382 Python module (@pxref{gdb.types}).
22383
22384 @node Pretty Printing API
22385 @subsubsection Pretty Printing API
22386
22387 An example output is provided (@pxref{Pretty Printing}).
22388
22389 A pretty-printer is just an object that holds a value and implements a
22390 specific interface, defined here.
22391
22392 @defun pretty_printer.children (self)
22393 @value{GDBN} will call this method on a pretty-printer to compute the
22394 children of the pretty-printer's value.
22395
22396 This method must return an object conforming to the Python iterator
22397 protocol. Each item returned by the iterator must be a tuple holding
22398 two elements. The first element is the ``name'' of the child; the
22399 second element is the child's value. The value can be any Python
22400 object which is convertible to a @value{GDBN} value.
22401
22402 This method is optional. If it does not exist, @value{GDBN} will act
22403 as though the value has no children.
22404 @end defun
22405
22406 @defun pretty_printer.display_hint (self)
22407 The CLI may call this method and use its result to change the
22408 formatting of a value. The result will also be supplied to an MI
22409 consumer as a @samp{displayhint} attribute of the variable being
22410 printed.
22411
22412 This method is optional. If it does exist, this method must return a
22413 string.
22414
22415 Some display hints are predefined by @value{GDBN}:
22416
22417 @table @samp
22418 @item array
22419 Indicate that the object being printed is ``array-like''. The CLI
22420 uses this to respect parameters such as @code{set print elements} and
22421 @code{set print array}.
22422
22423 @item map
22424 Indicate that the object being printed is ``map-like'', and that the
22425 children of this value can be assumed to alternate between keys and
22426 values.
22427
22428 @item string
22429 Indicate that the object being printed is ``string-like''. If the
22430 printer's @code{to_string} method returns a Python string of some
22431 kind, then @value{GDBN} will call its internal language-specific
22432 string-printing function to format the string. For the CLI this means
22433 adding quotation marks, possibly escaping some characters, respecting
22434 @code{set print elements}, and the like.
22435 @end table
22436 @end defun
22437
22438 @defun pretty_printer.to_string (self)
22439 @value{GDBN} will call this method to display the string
22440 representation of the value passed to the object's constructor.
22441
22442 When printing from the CLI, if the @code{to_string} method exists,
22443 then @value{GDBN} will prepend its result to the values returned by
22444 @code{children}. Exactly how this formatting is done is dependent on
22445 the display hint, and may change as more hints are added. Also,
22446 depending on the print settings (@pxref{Print Settings}), the CLI may
22447 print just the result of @code{to_string} in a stack trace, omitting
22448 the result of @code{children}.
22449
22450 If this method returns a string, it is printed verbatim.
22451
22452 Otherwise, if this method returns an instance of @code{gdb.Value},
22453 then @value{GDBN} prints this value. This may result in a call to
22454 another pretty-printer.
22455
22456 If instead the method returns a Python value which is convertible to a
22457 @code{gdb.Value}, then @value{GDBN} performs the conversion and prints
22458 the resulting value. Again, this may result in a call to another
22459 pretty-printer. Python scalars (integers, floats, and booleans) and
22460 strings are convertible to @code{gdb.Value}; other types are not.
22461
22462 Finally, if this method returns @code{None} then no further operations
22463 are peformed in this method and nothing is printed.
22464
22465 If the result is not one of these types, an exception is raised.
22466 @end defun
22467
22468 @value{GDBN} provides a function which can be used to look up the
22469 default pretty-printer for a @code{gdb.Value}:
22470
22471 @findex gdb.default_visualizer
22472 @defun gdb.default_visualizer (value)
22473 This function takes a @code{gdb.Value} object as an argument. If a
22474 pretty-printer for this value exists, then it is returned. If no such
22475 printer exists, then this returns @code{None}.
22476 @end defun
22477
22478 @node Selecting Pretty-Printers
22479 @subsubsection Selecting Pretty-Printers
22480
22481 The Python list @code{gdb.pretty_printers} contains an array of
22482 functions or callable objects that have been registered via addition
22483 as a pretty-printer. Printers in this list are called @code{global}
22484 printers, they're available when debugging all inferiors.
22485 Each @code{gdb.Progspace} contains a @code{pretty_printers} attribute.
22486 Each @code{gdb.Objfile} also contains a @code{pretty_printers}
22487 attribute.
22488
22489 Each function on these lists is passed a single @code{gdb.Value}
22490 argument and should return a pretty-printer object conforming to the
22491 interface definition above (@pxref{Pretty Printing API}). If a function
22492 cannot create a pretty-printer for the value, it should return
22493 @code{None}.
22494
22495 @value{GDBN} first checks the @code{pretty_printers} attribute of each
22496 @code{gdb.Objfile} in the current program space and iteratively calls
22497 each enabled lookup routine in the list for that @code{gdb.Objfile}
22498 until it receives a pretty-printer object.
22499 If no pretty-printer is found in the objfile lists, @value{GDBN} then
22500 searches the pretty-printer list of the current program space,
22501 calling each enabled function until an object is returned.
22502 After these lists have been exhausted, it tries the global
22503 @code{gdb.pretty_printers} list, again calling each enabled function until an
22504 object is returned.
22505
22506 The order in which the objfiles are searched is not specified. For a
22507 given list, functions are always invoked from the head of the list,
22508 and iterated over sequentially until the end of the list, or a printer
22509 object is returned.
22510
22511 For various reasons a pretty-printer may not work.
22512 For example, the underlying data structure may have changed and
22513 the pretty-printer is out of date.
22514
22515 The consequences of a broken pretty-printer are severe enough that
22516 @value{GDBN} provides support for enabling and disabling individual
22517 printers. For example, if @code{print frame-arguments} is on,
22518 a backtrace can become highly illegible if any argument is printed
22519 with a broken printer.
22520
22521 Pretty-printers are enabled and disabled by attaching an @code{enabled}
22522 attribute to the registered function or callable object. If this attribute
22523 is present and its value is @code{False}, the printer is disabled, otherwise
22524 the printer is enabled.
22525
22526 @node Writing a Pretty-Printer
22527 @subsubsection Writing a Pretty-Printer
22528 @cindex writing a pretty-printer
22529
22530 A pretty-printer consists of two parts: a lookup function to detect
22531 if the type is supported, and the printer itself.
22532
22533 Here is an example showing how a @code{std::string} printer might be
22534 written. @xref{Pretty Printing API}, for details on the API this class
22535 must provide.
22536
22537 @smallexample
22538 class StdStringPrinter(object):
22539 "Print a std::string"
22540
22541 def __init__(self, val):
22542 self.val = val
22543
22544 def to_string(self):
22545 return self.val['_M_dataplus']['_M_p']
22546
22547 def display_hint(self):
22548 return 'string'
22549 @end smallexample
22550
22551 And here is an example showing how a lookup function for the printer
22552 example above might be written.
22553
22554 @smallexample
22555 def str_lookup_function(val):
22556 lookup_tag = val.type.tag
22557 if lookup_tag == None:
22558 return None
22559 regex = re.compile("^std::basic_string<char,.*>$")
22560 if regex.match(lookup_tag):
22561 return StdStringPrinter(val)
22562 return None
22563 @end smallexample
22564
22565 The example lookup function extracts the value's type, and attempts to
22566 match it to a type that it can pretty-print. If it is a type the
22567 printer can pretty-print, it will return a printer object. If not, it
22568 returns @code{None}.
22569
22570 We recommend that you put your core pretty-printers into a Python
22571 package. If your pretty-printers are for use with a library, we
22572 further recommend embedding a version number into the package name.
22573 This practice will enable @value{GDBN} to load multiple versions of
22574 your pretty-printers at the same time, because they will have
22575 different names.
22576
22577 You should write auto-loaded code (@pxref{Auto-loading}) such that it
22578 can be evaluated multiple times without changing its meaning. An
22579 ideal auto-load file will consist solely of @code{import}s of your
22580 printer modules, followed by a call to a register pretty-printers with
22581 the current objfile.
22582
22583 Taken as a whole, this approach will scale nicely to multiple
22584 inferiors, each potentially using a different library version.
22585 Embedding a version number in the Python package name will ensure that
22586 @value{GDBN} is able to load both sets of printers simultaneously.
22587 Then, because the search for pretty-printers is done by objfile, and
22588 because your auto-loaded code took care to register your library's
22589 printers with a specific objfile, @value{GDBN} will find the correct
22590 printers for the specific version of the library used by each
22591 inferior.
22592
22593 To continue the @code{std::string} example (@pxref{Pretty Printing API}),
22594 this code might appear in @code{gdb.libstdcxx.v6}:
22595
22596 @smallexample
22597 def register_printers(objfile):
22598 objfile.pretty_printers.append(str_lookup_function)
22599 @end smallexample
22600
22601 @noindent
22602 And then the corresponding contents of the auto-load file would be:
22603
22604 @smallexample
22605 import gdb.libstdcxx.v6
22606 gdb.libstdcxx.v6.register_printers(gdb.current_objfile())
22607 @end smallexample
22608
22609 The previous example illustrates a basic pretty-printer.
22610 There are a few things that can be improved on.
22611 The printer doesn't have a name, making it hard to identify in a
22612 list of installed printers. The lookup function has a name, but
22613 lookup functions can have arbitrary, even identical, names.
22614
22615 Second, the printer only handles one type, whereas a library typically has
22616 several types. One could install a lookup function for each desired type
22617 in the library, but one could also have a single lookup function recognize
22618 several types. The latter is the conventional way this is handled.
22619 If a pretty-printer can handle multiple data types, then its
22620 @dfn{subprinters} are the printers for the individual data types.
22621
22622 The @code{gdb.printing} module provides a formal way of solving these
22623 problems (@pxref{gdb.printing}).
22624 Here is another example that handles multiple types.
22625
22626 These are the types we are going to pretty-print:
22627
22628 @smallexample
22629 struct foo @{ int a, b; @};
22630 struct bar @{ struct foo x, y; @};
22631 @end smallexample
22632
22633 Here are the printers:
22634
22635 @smallexample
22636 class fooPrinter:
22637 """Print a foo object."""
22638
22639 def __init__(self, val):
22640 self.val = val
22641
22642 def to_string(self):
22643 return ("a=<" + str(self.val["a"]) +
22644 "> b=<" + str(self.val["b"]) + ">")
22645
22646 class barPrinter:
22647 """Print a bar object."""
22648
22649 def __init__(self, val):
22650 self.val = val
22651
22652 def to_string(self):
22653 return ("x=<" + str(self.val["x"]) +
22654 "> y=<" + str(self.val["y"]) + ">")
22655 @end smallexample
22656
22657 This example doesn't need a lookup function, that is handled by the
22658 @code{gdb.printing} module. Instead a function is provided to build up
22659 the object that handles the lookup.
22660
22661 @smallexample
22662 import gdb.printing
22663
22664 def build_pretty_printer():
22665 pp = gdb.printing.RegexpCollectionPrettyPrinter(
22666 "my_library")
22667 pp.add_printer('foo', '^foo$', fooPrinter)
22668 pp.add_printer('bar', '^bar$', barPrinter)
22669 return pp
22670 @end smallexample
22671
22672 And here is the autoload support:
22673
22674 @smallexample
22675 import gdb.printing
22676 import my_library
22677 gdb.printing.register_pretty_printer(
22678 gdb.current_objfile(),
22679 my_library.build_pretty_printer())
22680 @end smallexample
22681
22682 Finally, when this printer is loaded into @value{GDBN}, here is the
22683 corresponding output of @samp{info pretty-printer}:
22684
22685 @smallexample
22686 (gdb) info pretty-printer
22687 my_library.so:
22688 my_library
22689 foo
22690 bar
22691 @end smallexample
22692
22693 @node Inferiors In Python
22694 @subsubsection Inferiors In Python
22695 @cindex inferiors in Python
22696
22697 @findex gdb.Inferior
22698 Programs which are being run under @value{GDBN} are called inferiors
22699 (@pxref{Inferiors and Programs}). Python scripts can access
22700 information about and manipulate inferiors controlled by @value{GDBN}
22701 via objects of the @code{gdb.Inferior} class.
22702
22703 The following inferior-related functions are available in the @code{gdb}
22704 module:
22705
22706 @defun gdb.inferiors ()
22707 Return a tuple containing all inferior objects.
22708 @end defun
22709
22710 @defun gdb.selected_inferior ()
22711 Return an object representing the current inferior.
22712 @end defun
22713
22714 A @code{gdb.Inferior} object has the following attributes:
22715
22716 @table @code
22717 @defvar Inferior.num
22718 ID of inferior, as assigned by GDB.
22719 @end defvar
22720
22721 @defvar Inferior.pid
22722 Process ID of the inferior, as assigned by the underlying operating
22723 system.
22724 @end defvar
22725
22726 @defvar Inferior.was_attached
22727 Boolean signaling whether the inferior was created using `attach', or
22728 started by @value{GDBN} itself.
22729 @end defvar
22730 @end table
22731
22732 A @code{gdb.Inferior} object has the following methods:
22733
22734 @table @code
22735 @defun Inferior.is_valid ()
22736 Returns @code{True} if the @code{gdb.Inferior} object is valid,
22737 @code{False} if not. A @code{gdb.Inferior} object will become invalid
22738 if the inferior no longer exists within @value{GDBN}. All other
22739 @code{gdb.Inferior} methods will throw an exception if it is invalid
22740 at the time the method is called.
22741 @end defun
22742
22743 @defun Inferior.threads ()
22744 This method returns a tuple holding all the threads which are valid
22745 when it is called. If there are no valid threads, the method will
22746 return an empty tuple.
22747 @end defun
22748
22749 @findex gdb.read_memory
22750 @defun Inferior.read_memory (address, length)
22751 Read @var{length} bytes of memory from the inferior, starting at
22752 @var{address}. Returns a buffer object, which behaves much like an array
22753 or a string. It can be modified and given to the @code{gdb.write_memory}
22754 function.
22755 @end defun
22756
22757 @findex gdb.write_memory
22758 @defun Inferior.write_memory (address, buffer @r{[}, length@r{]})
22759 Write the contents of @var{buffer} to the inferior, starting at
22760 @var{address}. The @var{buffer} parameter must be a Python object
22761 which supports the buffer protocol, i.e., a string, an array or the
22762 object returned from @code{gdb.read_memory}. If given, @var{length}
22763 determines the number of bytes from @var{buffer} to be written.
22764 @end defun
22765
22766 @findex gdb.search_memory
22767 @defun Inferior.search_memory (address, length, pattern)
22768 Search a region of the inferior memory starting at @var{address} with
22769 the given @var{length} using the search pattern supplied in
22770 @var{pattern}. The @var{pattern} parameter must be a Python object
22771 which supports the buffer protocol, i.e., a string, an array or the
22772 object returned from @code{gdb.read_memory}. Returns a Python @code{Long}
22773 containing the address where the pattern was found, or @code{None} if
22774 the pattern could not be found.
22775 @end defun
22776 @end table
22777
22778 @node Events In Python
22779 @subsubsection Events In Python
22780 @cindex inferior events in Python
22781
22782 @value{GDBN} provides a general event facility so that Python code can be
22783 notified of various state changes, particularly changes that occur in
22784 the inferior.
22785
22786 An @dfn{event} is just an object that describes some state change. The
22787 type of the object and its attributes will vary depending on the details
22788 of the change. All the existing events are described below.
22789
22790 In order to be notified of an event, you must register an event handler
22791 with an @dfn{event registry}. An event registry is an object in the
22792 @code{gdb.events} module which dispatches particular events. A registry
22793 provides methods to register and unregister event handlers:
22794
22795 @table @code
22796 @defun EventRegistry.connect (object)
22797 Add the given callable @var{object} to the registry. This object will be
22798 called when an event corresponding to this registry occurs.
22799 @end defun
22800
22801 @defun EventRegistry.disconnect (object)
22802 Remove the given @var{object} from the registry. Once removed, the object
22803 will no longer receive notifications of events.
22804 @end defun
22805 @end table
22806
22807 Here is an example:
22808
22809 @smallexample
22810 def exit_handler (event):
22811 print "event type: exit"
22812 print "exit code: %d" % (event.exit_code)
22813
22814 gdb.events.exited.connect (exit_handler)
22815 @end smallexample
22816
22817 In the above example we connect our handler @code{exit_handler} to the
22818 registry @code{events.exited}. Once connected, @code{exit_handler} gets
22819 called when the inferior exits. The argument @dfn{event} in this example is
22820 of type @code{gdb.ExitedEvent}. As you can see in the example the
22821 @code{ExitedEvent} object has an attribute which indicates the exit code of
22822 the inferior.
22823
22824 The following is a listing of the event registries that are available and
22825 details of the events they emit:
22826
22827 @table @code
22828
22829 @item events.cont
22830 Emits @code{gdb.ThreadEvent}.
22831
22832 Some events can be thread specific when @value{GDBN} is running in non-stop
22833 mode. When represented in Python, these events all extend
22834 @code{gdb.ThreadEvent}. Note, this event is not emitted directly; instead,
22835 events which are emitted by this or other modules might extend this event.
22836 Examples of these events are @code{gdb.BreakpointEvent} and
22837 @code{gdb.ContinueEvent}.
22838
22839 @table @code
22840 @defvar ThreadEvent.inferior_thread
22841 In non-stop mode this attribute will be set to the specific thread which was
22842 involved in the emitted event. Otherwise, it will be set to @code{None}.
22843 @end defvar
22844 @end table
22845
22846 Emits @code{gdb.ContinueEvent} which extends @code{gdb.ThreadEvent}.
22847
22848 This event indicates that the inferior has been continued after a stop. For
22849 inherited attribute refer to @code{gdb.ThreadEvent} above.
22850
22851 @item events.exited
22852 Emits @code{events.ExitedEvent} which indicates that the inferior has exited.
22853 @code{events.ExitedEvent} has two attributes:
22854 @table @code
22855 @defvar ExitedEvent.exit_code
22856 An integer representing the exit code, if available, which the inferior
22857 has returned. (The exit code could be unavailable if, for example,
22858 @value{GDBN} detaches from the inferior.) If the exit code is unavailable,
22859 the attribute does not exist.
22860 @end defvar
22861 @defvar ExitedEvent inferior
22862 A reference to the inferior which triggered the @code{exited} event.
22863 @end defvar
22864 @end table
22865
22866 @item events.stop
22867 Emits @code{gdb.StopEvent} which extends @code{gdb.ThreadEvent}.
22868
22869 Indicates that the inferior has stopped. All events emitted by this registry
22870 extend StopEvent. As a child of @code{gdb.ThreadEvent}, @code{gdb.StopEvent}
22871 will indicate the stopped thread when @value{GDBN} is running in non-stop
22872 mode. Refer to @code{gdb.ThreadEvent} above for more details.
22873
22874 Emits @code{gdb.SignalEvent} which extends @code{gdb.StopEvent}.
22875
22876 This event indicates that the inferior or one of its threads has received as
22877 signal. @code{gdb.SignalEvent} has the following attributes:
22878
22879 @table @code
22880 @defvar SignalEvent.stop_signal
22881 A string representing the signal received by the inferior. A list of possible
22882 signal values can be obtained by running the command @code{info signals} in
22883 the @value{GDBN} command prompt.
22884 @end defvar
22885 @end table
22886
22887 Also emits @code{gdb.BreakpointEvent} which extends @code{gdb.StopEvent}.
22888
22889 @code{gdb.BreakpointEvent} event indicates that one or more breakpoints have
22890 been hit, and has the following attributes:
22891
22892 @table @code
22893 @defvar BreakpointEvent.breakpoints
22894 A sequence containing references to all the breakpoints (type
22895 @code{gdb.Breakpoint}) that were hit.
22896 @xref{Breakpoints In Python}, for details of the @code{gdb.Breakpoint} object.
22897 @end defvar
22898 @defvar BreakpointEvent.breakpoint
22899 A reference to the first breakpoint that was hit.
22900 This function is maintained for backward compatibility and is now deprecated
22901 in favor of the @code{gdb.BreakpointEvent.breakpoints} attribute.
22902 @end defvar
22903 @end table
22904
22905 @item events.new_objfile
22906 Emits @code{gdb.NewObjFileEvent} which indicates that a new object file has
22907 been loaded by @value{GDBN}. @code{gdb.NewObjFileEvent} has one attribute:
22908
22909 @table @code
22910 @defvar NewObjFileEvent.new_objfile
22911 A reference to the object file (@code{gdb.Objfile}) which has been loaded.
22912 @xref{Objfiles In Python}, for details of the @code{gdb.Objfile} object.
22913 @end defvar
22914 @end table
22915
22916 @end table
22917
22918 @node Threads In Python
22919 @subsubsection Threads In Python
22920 @cindex threads in python
22921
22922 @findex gdb.InferiorThread
22923 Python scripts can access information about, and manipulate inferior threads
22924 controlled by @value{GDBN}, via objects of the @code{gdb.InferiorThread} class.
22925
22926 The following thread-related functions are available in the @code{gdb}
22927 module:
22928
22929 @findex gdb.selected_thread
22930 @defun gdb.selected_thread ()
22931 This function returns the thread object for the selected thread. If there
22932 is no selected thread, this will return @code{None}.
22933 @end defun
22934
22935 A @code{gdb.InferiorThread} object has the following attributes:
22936
22937 @table @code
22938 @defvar InferiorThread.name
22939 The name of the thread. If the user specified a name using
22940 @code{thread name}, then this returns that name. Otherwise, if an
22941 OS-supplied name is available, then it is returned. Otherwise, this
22942 returns @code{None}.
22943
22944 This attribute can be assigned to. The new value must be a string
22945 object, which sets the new name, or @code{None}, which removes any
22946 user-specified thread name.
22947 @end defvar
22948
22949 @defvar InferiorThread.num
22950 ID of the thread, as assigned by GDB.
22951 @end defvar
22952
22953 @defvar InferiorThread.ptid
22954 ID of the thread, as assigned by the operating system. This attribute is a
22955 tuple containing three integers. The first is the Process ID (PID); the second
22956 is the Lightweight Process ID (LWPID), and the third is the Thread ID (TID).
22957 Either the LWPID or TID may be 0, which indicates that the operating system
22958 does not use that identifier.
22959 @end defvar
22960 @end table
22961
22962 A @code{gdb.InferiorThread} object has the following methods:
22963
22964 @table @code
22965 @defun InferiorThread.is_valid ()
22966 Returns @code{True} if the @code{gdb.InferiorThread} object is valid,
22967 @code{False} if not. A @code{gdb.InferiorThread} object will become
22968 invalid if the thread exits, or the inferior that the thread belongs
22969 is deleted. All other @code{gdb.InferiorThread} methods will throw an
22970 exception if it is invalid at the time the method is called.
22971 @end defun
22972
22973 @defun InferiorThread.switch ()
22974 This changes @value{GDBN}'s currently selected thread to the one represented
22975 by this object.
22976 @end defun
22977
22978 @defun InferiorThread.is_stopped ()
22979 Return a Boolean indicating whether the thread is stopped.
22980 @end defun
22981
22982 @defun InferiorThread.is_running ()
22983 Return a Boolean indicating whether the thread is running.
22984 @end defun
22985
22986 @defun InferiorThread.is_exited ()
22987 Return a Boolean indicating whether the thread is exited.
22988 @end defun
22989 @end table
22990
22991 @node Commands In Python
22992 @subsubsection Commands In Python
22993
22994 @cindex commands in python
22995 @cindex python commands
22996 You can implement new @value{GDBN} CLI commands in Python. A CLI
22997 command is implemented using an instance of the @code{gdb.Command}
22998 class, most commonly using a subclass.
22999
23000 @defun Command.__init__ (name, @var{command_class} @r{[}, @var{completer_class} @r{[}, @var{prefix}@r{]]})
23001 The object initializer for @code{Command} registers the new command
23002 with @value{GDBN}. This initializer is normally invoked from the
23003 subclass' own @code{__init__} method.
23004
23005 @var{name} is the name of the command. If @var{name} consists of
23006 multiple words, then the initial words are looked for as prefix
23007 commands. In this case, if one of the prefix commands does not exist,
23008 an exception is raised.
23009
23010 There is no support for multi-line commands.
23011
23012 @var{command_class} should be one of the @samp{COMMAND_} constants
23013 defined below. This argument tells @value{GDBN} how to categorize the
23014 new command in the help system.
23015
23016 @var{completer_class} is an optional argument. If given, it should be
23017 one of the @samp{COMPLETE_} constants defined below. This argument
23018 tells @value{GDBN} how to perform completion for this command. If not
23019 given, @value{GDBN} will attempt to complete using the object's
23020 @code{complete} method (see below); if no such method is found, an
23021 error will occur when completion is attempted.
23022
23023 @var{prefix} is an optional argument. If @code{True}, then the new
23024 command is a prefix command; sub-commands of this command may be
23025 registered.
23026
23027 The help text for the new command is taken from the Python
23028 documentation string for the command's class, if there is one. If no
23029 documentation string is provided, the default value ``This command is
23030 not documented.'' is used.
23031 @end defun
23032
23033 @cindex don't repeat Python command
23034 @defun Command.dont_repeat ()
23035 By default, a @value{GDBN} command is repeated when the user enters a
23036 blank line at the command prompt. A command can suppress this
23037 behavior by invoking the @code{dont_repeat} method. This is similar
23038 to the user command @code{dont-repeat}, see @ref{Define, dont-repeat}.
23039 @end defun
23040
23041 @defun Command.invoke (argument, from_tty)
23042 This method is called by @value{GDBN} when this command is invoked.
23043
23044 @var{argument} is a string. It is the argument to the command, after
23045 leading and trailing whitespace has been stripped.
23046
23047 @var{from_tty} is a boolean argument. When true, this means that the
23048 command was entered by the user at the terminal; when false it means
23049 that the command came from elsewhere.
23050
23051 If this method throws an exception, it is turned into a @value{GDBN}
23052 @code{error} call. Otherwise, the return value is ignored.
23053
23054 @findex gdb.string_to_argv
23055 To break @var{argument} up into an argv-like string use
23056 @code{gdb.string_to_argv}. This function behaves identically to
23057 @value{GDBN}'s internal argument lexer @code{buildargv}.
23058 It is recommended to use this for consistency.
23059 Arguments are separated by spaces and may be quoted.
23060 Example:
23061
23062 @smallexample
23063 print gdb.string_to_argv ("1 2\ \\\"3 '4 \"5' \"6 '7\"")
23064 ['1', '2 "3', '4 "5', "6 '7"]
23065 @end smallexample
23066
23067 @end defun
23068
23069 @cindex completion of Python commands
23070 @defun Command.complete (text, word)
23071 This method is called by @value{GDBN} when the user attempts
23072 completion on this command. All forms of completion are handled by
23073 this method, that is, the @key{TAB} and @key{M-?} key bindings
23074 (@pxref{Completion}), and the @code{complete} command (@pxref{Help,
23075 complete}).
23076
23077 The arguments @var{text} and @var{word} are both strings. @var{text}
23078 holds the complete command line up to the cursor's location.
23079 @var{word} holds the last word of the command line; this is computed
23080 using a word-breaking heuristic.
23081
23082 The @code{complete} method can return several values:
23083 @itemize @bullet
23084 @item
23085 If the return value is a sequence, the contents of the sequence are
23086 used as the completions. It is up to @code{complete} to ensure that the
23087 contents actually do complete the word. A zero-length sequence is
23088 allowed, it means that there were no completions available. Only
23089 string elements of the sequence are used; other elements in the
23090 sequence are ignored.
23091
23092 @item
23093 If the return value is one of the @samp{COMPLETE_} constants defined
23094 below, then the corresponding @value{GDBN}-internal completion
23095 function is invoked, and its result is used.
23096
23097 @item
23098 All other results are treated as though there were no available
23099 completions.
23100 @end itemize
23101 @end defun
23102
23103 When a new command is registered, it must be declared as a member of
23104 some general class of commands. This is used to classify top-level
23105 commands in the on-line help system; note that prefix commands are not
23106 listed under their own category but rather that of their top-level
23107 command. The available classifications are represented by constants
23108 defined in the @code{gdb} module:
23109
23110 @table @code
23111 @findex COMMAND_NONE
23112 @findex gdb.COMMAND_NONE
23113 @item gdb.COMMAND_NONE
23114 The command does not belong to any particular class. A command in
23115 this category will not be displayed in any of the help categories.
23116
23117 @findex COMMAND_RUNNING
23118 @findex gdb.COMMAND_RUNNING
23119 @item gdb.COMMAND_RUNNING
23120 The command is related to running the inferior. For example,
23121 @code{start}, @code{step}, and @code{continue} are in this category.
23122 Type @kbd{help running} at the @value{GDBN} prompt to see a list of
23123 commands in this category.
23124
23125 @findex COMMAND_DATA
23126 @findex gdb.COMMAND_DATA
23127 @item gdb.COMMAND_DATA
23128 The command is related to data or variables. For example,
23129 @code{call}, @code{find}, and @code{print} are in this category. Type
23130 @kbd{help data} at the @value{GDBN} prompt to see a list of commands
23131 in this category.
23132
23133 @findex COMMAND_STACK
23134 @findex gdb.COMMAND_STACK
23135 @item gdb.COMMAND_STACK
23136 The command has to do with manipulation of the stack. For example,
23137 @code{backtrace}, @code{frame}, and @code{return} are in this
23138 category. Type @kbd{help stack} at the @value{GDBN} prompt to see a
23139 list of commands in this category.
23140
23141 @findex COMMAND_FILES
23142 @findex gdb.COMMAND_FILES
23143 @item gdb.COMMAND_FILES
23144 This class is used for file-related commands. For example,
23145 @code{file}, @code{list} and @code{section} are in this category.
23146 Type @kbd{help files} at the @value{GDBN} prompt to see a list of
23147 commands in this category.
23148
23149 @findex COMMAND_SUPPORT
23150 @findex gdb.COMMAND_SUPPORT
23151 @item gdb.COMMAND_SUPPORT
23152 This should be used for ``support facilities'', generally meaning
23153 things that are useful to the user when interacting with @value{GDBN},
23154 but not related to the state of the inferior. For example,
23155 @code{help}, @code{make}, and @code{shell} are in this category. Type
23156 @kbd{help support} at the @value{GDBN} prompt to see a list of
23157 commands in this category.
23158
23159 @findex COMMAND_STATUS
23160 @findex gdb.COMMAND_STATUS
23161 @item gdb.COMMAND_STATUS
23162 The command is an @samp{info}-related command, that is, related to the
23163 state of @value{GDBN} itself. For example, @code{info}, @code{macro},
23164 and @code{show} are in this category. Type @kbd{help status} at the
23165 @value{GDBN} prompt to see a list of commands in this category.
23166
23167 @findex COMMAND_BREAKPOINTS
23168 @findex gdb.COMMAND_BREAKPOINTS
23169 @item gdb.COMMAND_BREAKPOINTS
23170 The command has to do with breakpoints. For example, @code{break},
23171 @code{clear}, and @code{delete} are in this category. Type @kbd{help
23172 breakpoints} at the @value{GDBN} prompt to see a list of commands in
23173 this category.
23174
23175 @findex COMMAND_TRACEPOINTS
23176 @findex gdb.COMMAND_TRACEPOINTS
23177 @item gdb.COMMAND_TRACEPOINTS
23178 The command has to do with tracepoints. For example, @code{trace},
23179 @code{actions}, and @code{tfind} are in this category. Type
23180 @kbd{help tracepoints} at the @value{GDBN} prompt to see a list of
23181 commands in this category.
23182
23183 @findex COMMAND_OBSCURE
23184 @findex gdb.COMMAND_OBSCURE
23185 @item gdb.COMMAND_OBSCURE
23186 The command is only used in unusual circumstances, or is not of
23187 general interest to users. For example, @code{checkpoint},
23188 @code{fork}, and @code{stop} are in this category. Type @kbd{help
23189 obscure} at the @value{GDBN} prompt to see a list of commands in this
23190 category.
23191
23192 @findex COMMAND_MAINTENANCE
23193 @findex gdb.COMMAND_MAINTENANCE
23194 @item gdb.COMMAND_MAINTENANCE
23195 The command is only useful to @value{GDBN} maintainers. The
23196 @code{maintenance} and @code{flushregs} commands are in this category.
23197 Type @kbd{help internals} at the @value{GDBN} prompt to see a list of
23198 commands in this category.
23199 @end table
23200
23201 A new command can use a predefined completion function, either by
23202 specifying it via an argument at initialization, or by returning it
23203 from the @code{complete} method. These predefined completion
23204 constants are all defined in the @code{gdb} module:
23205
23206 @table @code
23207 @findex COMPLETE_NONE
23208 @findex gdb.COMPLETE_NONE
23209 @item gdb.COMPLETE_NONE
23210 This constant means that no completion should be done.
23211
23212 @findex COMPLETE_FILENAME
23213 @findex gdb.COMPLETE_FILENAME
23214 @item gdb.COMPLETE_FILENAME
23215 This constant means that filename completion should be performed.
23216
23217 @findex COMPLETE_LOCATION
23218 @findex gdb.COMPLETE_LOCATION
23219 @item gdb.COMPLETE_LOCATION
23220 This constant means that location completion should be done.
23221 @xref{Specify Location}.
23222
23223 @findex COMPLETE_COMMAND
23224 @findex gdb.COMPLETE_COMMAND
23225 @item gdb.COMPLETE_COMMAND
23226 This constant means that completion should examine @value{GDBN}
23227 command names.
23228
23229 @findex COMPLETE_SYMBOL
23230 @findex gdb.COMPLETE_SYMBOL
23231 @item gdb.COMPLETE_SYMBOL
23232 This constant means that completion should be done using symbol names
23233 as the source.
23234 @end table
23235
23236 The following code snippet shows how a trivial CLI command can be
23237 implemented in Python:
23238
23239 @smallexample
23240 class HelloWorld (gdb.Command):
23241 """Greet the whole world."""
23242
23243 def __init__ (self):
23244 super (HelloWorld, self).__init__ ("hello-world", gdb.COMMAND_OBSCURE)
23245
23246 def invoke (self, arg, from_tty):
23247 print "Hello, World!"
23248
23249 HelloWorld ()
23250 @end smallexample
23251
23252 The last line instantiates the class, and is necessary to trigger the
23253 registration of the command with @value{GDBN}. Depending on how the
23254 Python code is read into @value{GDBN}, you may need to import the
23255 @code{gdb} module explicitly.
23256
23257 @node Parameters In Python
23258 @subsubsection Parameters In Python
23259
23260 @cindex parameters in python
23261 @cindex python parameters
23262 @tindex gdb.Parameter
23263 @tindex Parameter
23264 You can implement new @value{GDBN} parameters using Python. A new
23265 parameter is implemented as an instance of the @code{gdb.Parameter}
23266 class.
23267
23268 Parameters are exposed to the user via the @code{set} and
23269 @code{show} commands. @xref{Help}.
23270
23271 There are many parameters that already exist and can be set in
23272 @value{GDBN}. Two examples are: @code{set follow fork} and
23273 @code{set charset}. Setting these parameters influences certain
23274 behavior in @value{GDBN}. Similarly, you can define parameters that
23275 can be used to influence behavior in custom Python scripts and commands.
23276
23277 @defun Parameter.__init__ (name, @var{command-class}, @var{parameter-class} @r{[}, @var{enum-sequence}@r{]})
23278 The object initializer for @code{Parameter} registers the new
23279 parameter with @value{GDBN}. This initializer is normally invoked
23280 from the subclass' own @code{__init__} method.
23281
23282 @var{name} is the name of the new parameter. If @var{name} consists
23283 of multiple words, then the initial words are looked for as prefix
23284 parameters. An example of this can be illustrated with the
23285 @code{set print} set of parameters. If @var{name} is
23286 @code{print foo}, then @code{print} will be searched as the prefix
23287 parameter. In this case the parameter can subsequently be accessed in
23288 @value{GDBN} as @code{set print foo}.
23289
23290 If @var{name} consists of multiple words, and no prefix parameter group
23291 can be found, an exception is raised.
23292
23293 @var{command-class} should be one of the @samp{COMMAND_} constants
23294 (@pxref{Commands In Python}). This argument tells @value{GDBN} how to
23295 categorize the new parameter in the help system.
23296
23297 @var{parameter-class} should be one of the @samp{PARAM_} constants
23298 defined below. This argument tells @value{GDBN} the type of the new
23299 parameter; this information is used for input validation and
23300 completion.
23301
23302 If @var{parameter-class} is @code{PARAM_ENUM}, then
23303 @var{enum-sequence} must be a sequence of strings. These strings
23304 represent the possible values for the parameter.
23305
23306 If @var{parameter-class} is not @code{PARAM_ENUM}, then the presence
23307 of a fourth argument will cause an exception to be thrown.
23308
23309 The help text for the new parameter is taken from the Python
23310 documentation string for the parameter's class, if there is one. If
23311 there is no documentation string, a default value is used.
23312 @end defun
23313
23314 @defvar Parameter.set_doc
23315 If this attribute exists, and is a string, then its value is used as
23316 the help text for this parameter's @code{set} command. The value is
23317 examined when @code{Parameter.__init__} is invoked; subsequent changes
23318 have no effect.
23319 @end defvar
23320
23321 @defvar Parameter.show_doc
23322 If this attribute exists, and is a string, then its value is used as
23323 the help text for this parameter's @code{show} command. The value is
23324 examined when @code{Parameter.__init__} is invoked; subsequent changes
23325 have no effect.
23326 @end defvar
23327
23328 @defvar Parameter.value
23329 The @code{value} attribute holds the underlying value of the
23330 parameter. It can be read and assigned to just as any other
23331 attribute. @value{GDBN} does validation when assignments are made.
23332 @end defvar
23333
23334 There are two methods that should be implemented in any
23335 @code{Parameter} class. These are:
23336
23337 @defun Parameter.get_set_string (self)
23338 @value{GDBN} will call this method when a @var{parameter}'s value has
23339 been changed via the @code{set} API (for example, @kbd{set foo off}).
23340 The @code{value} attribute has already been populated with the new
23341 value and may be used in output. This method must return a string.
23342 @end defun
23343
23344 @defun Parameter.get_show_string (self, svalue)
23345 @value{GDBN} will call this method when a @var{parameter}'s
23346 @code{show} API has been invoked (for example, @kbd{show foo}). The
23347 argument @code{svalue} receives the string representation of the
23348 current value. This method must return a string.
23349 @end defun
23350
23351 When a new parameter is defined, its type must be specified. The
23352 available types are represented by constants defined in the @code{gdb}
23353 module:
23354
23355 @table @code
23356 @findex PARAM_BOOLEAN
23357 @findex gdb.PARAM_BOOLEAN
23358 @item gdb.PARAM_BOOLEAN
23359 The value is a plain boolean. The Python boolean values, @code{True}
23360 and @code{False} are the only valid values.
23361
23362 @findex PARAM_AUTO_BOOLEAN
23363 @findex gdb.PARAM_AUTO_BOOLEAN
23364 @item gdb.PARAM_AUTO_BOOLEAN
23365 The value has three possible states: true, false, and @samp{auto}. In
23366 Python, true and false are represented using boolean constants, and
23367 @samp{auto} is represented using @code{None}.
23368
23369 @findex PARAM_UINTEGER
23370 @findex gdb.PARAM_UINTEGER
23371 @item gdb.PARAM_UINTEGER
23372 The value is an unsigned integer. The value of 0 should be
23373 interpreted to mean ``unlimited''.
23374
23375 @findex PARAM_INTEGER
23376 @findex gdb.PARAM_INTEGER
23377 @item gdb.PARAM_INTEGER
23378 The value is a signed integer. The value of 0 should be interpreted
23379 to mean ``unlimited''.
23380
23381 @findex PARAM_STRING
23382 @findex gdb.PARAM_STRING
23383 @item gdb.PARAM_STRING
23384 The value is a string. When the user modifies the string, any escape
23385 sequences, such as @samp{\t}, @samp{\f}, and octal escapes, are
23386 translated into corresponding characters and encoded into the current
23387 host charset.
23388
23389 @findex PARAM_STRING_NOESCAPE
23390 @findex gdb.PARAM_STRING_NOESCAPE
23391 @item gdb.PARAM_STRING_NOESCAPE
23392 The value is a string. When the user modifies the string, escapes are
23393 passed through untranslated.
23394
23395 @findex PARAM_OPTIONAL_FILENAME
23396 @findex gdb.PARAM_OPTIONAL_FILENAME
23397 @item gdb.PARAM_OPTIONAL_FILENAME
23398 The value is a either a filename (a string), or @code{None}.
23399
23400 @findex PARAM_FILENAME
23401 @findex gdb.PARAM_FILENAME
23402 @item gdb.PARAM_FILENAME
23403 The value is a filename. This is just like
23404 @code{PARAM_STRING_NOESCAPE}, but uses file names for completion.
23405
23406 @findex PARAM_ZINTEGER
23407 @findex gdb.PARAM_ZINTEGER
23408 @item gdb.PARAM_ZINTEGER
23409 The value is an integer. This is like @code{PARAM_INTEGER}, except 0
23410 is interpreted as itself.
23411
23412 @findex PARAM_ENUM
23413 @findex gdb.PARAM_ENUM
23414 @item gdb.PARAM_ENUM
23415 The value is a string, which must be one of a collection string
23416 constants provided when the parameter is created.
23417 @end table
23418
23419 @node Functions In Python
23420 @subsubsection Writing new convenience functions
23421
23422 @cindex writing convenience functions
23423 @cindex convenience functions in python
23424 @cindex python convenience functions
23425 @tindex gdb.Function
23426 @tindex Function
23427 You can implement new convenience functions (@pxref{Convenience Vars})
23428 in Python. A convenience function is an instance of a subclass of the
23429 class @code{gdb.Function}.
23430
23431 @defun Function.__init__ (name)
23432 The initializer for @code{Function} registers the new function with
23433 @value{GDBN}. The argument @var{name} is the name of the function,
23434 a string. The function will be visible to the user as a convenience
23435 variable of type @code{internal function}, whose name is the same as
23436 the given @var{name}.
23437
23438 The documentation for the new function is taken from the documentation
23439 string for the new class.
23440 @end defun
23441
23442 @defun Function.invoke (@var{*args})
23443 When a convenience function is evaluated, its arguments are converted
23444 to instances of @code{gdb.Value}, and then the function's
23445 @code{invoke} method is called. Note that @value{GDBN} does not
23446 predetermine the arity of convenience functions. Instead, all
23447 available arguments are passed to @code{invoke}, following the
23448 standard Python calling convention. In particular, a convenience
23449 function can have default values for parameters without ill effect.
23450
23451 The return value of this method is used as its value in the enclosing
23452 expression. If an ordinary Python value is returned, it is converted
23453 to a @code{gdb.Value} following the usual rules.
23454 @end defun
23455
23456 The following code snippet shows how a trivial convenience function can
23457 be implemented in Python:
23458
23459 @smallexample
23460 class Greet (gdb.Function):
23461 """Return string to greet someone.
23462 Takes a name as argument."""
23463
23464 def __init__ (self):
23465 super (Greet, self).__init__ ("greet")
23466
23467 def invoke (self, name):
23468 return "Hello, %s!" % name.string ()
23469
23470 Greet ()
23471 @end smallexample
23472
23473 The last line instantiates the class, and is necessary to trigger the
23474 registration of the function with @value{GDBN}. Depending on how the
23475 Python code is read into @value{GDBN}, you may need to import the
23476 @code{gdb} module explicitly.
23477
23478 @node Progspaces In Python
23479 @subsubsection Program Spaces In Python
23480
23481 @cindex progspaces in python
23482 @tindex gdb.Progspace
23483 @tindex Progspace
23484 A program space, or @dfn{progspace}, represents a symbolic view
23485 of an address space.
23486 It consists of all of the objfiles of the program.
23487 @xref{Objfiles In Python}.
23488 @xref{Inferiors and Programs, program spaces}, for more details
23489 about program spaces.
23490
23491 The following progspace-related functions are available in the
23492 @code{gdb} module:
23493
23494 @findex gdb.current_progspace
23495 @defun gdb.current_progspace ()
23496 This function returns the program space of the currently selected inferior.
23497 @xref{Inferiors and Programs}.
23498 @end defun
23499
23500 @findex gdb.progspaces
23501 @defun gdb.progspaces ()
23502 Return a sequence of all the progspaces currently known to @value{GDBN}.
23503 @end defun
23504
23505 Each progspace is represented by an instance of the @code{gdb.Progspace}
23506 class.
23507
23508 @defvar Progspace.filename
23509 The file name of the progspace as a string.
23510 @end defvar
23511
23512 @defvar Progspace.pretty_printers
23513 The @code{pretty_printers} attribute is a list of functions. It is
23514 used to look up pretty-printers. A @code{Value} is passed to each
23515 function in order; if the function returns @code{None}, then the
23516 search continues. Otherwise, the return value should be an object
23517 which is used to format the value. @xref{Pretty Printing API}, for more
23518 information.
23519 @end defvar
23520
23521 @node Objfiles In Python
23522 @subsubsection Objfiles In Python
23523
23524 @cindex objfiles in python
23525 @tindex gdb.Objfile
23526 @tindex Objfile
23527 @value{GDBN} loads symbols for an inferior from various
23528 symbol-containing files (@pxref{Files}). These include the primary
23529 executable file, any shared libraries used by the inferior, and any
23530 separate debug info files (@pxref{Separate Debug Files}).
23531 @value{GDBN} calls these symbol-containing files @dfn{objfiles}.
23532
23533 The following objfile-related functions are available in the
23534 @code{gdb} module:
23535
23536 @findex gdb.current_objfile
23537 @defun gdb.current_objfile ()
23538 When auto-loading a Python script (@pxref{Auto-loading}), @value{GDBN}
23539 sets the ``current objfile'' to the corresponding objfile. This
23540 function returns the current objfile. If there is no current objfile,
23541 this function returns @code{None}.
23542 @end defun
23543
23544 @findex gdb.objfiles
23545 @defun gdb.objfiles ()
23546 Return a sequence of all the objfiles current known to @value{GDBN}.
23547 @xref{Objfiles In Python}.
23548 @end defun
23549
23550 Each objfile is represented by an instance of the @code{gdb.Objfile}
23551 class.
23552
23553 @defvar Objfile.filename
23554 The file name of the objfile as a string.
23555 @end defvar
23556
23557 @defvar Objfile.pretty_printers
23558 The @code{pretty_printers} attribute is a list of functions. It is
23559 used to look up pretty-printers. A @code{Value} is passed to each
23560 function in order; if the function returns @code{None}, then the
23561 search continues. Otherwise, the return value should be an object
23562 which is used to format the value. @xref{Pretty Printing API}, for more
23563 information.
23564 @end defvar
23565
23566 A @code{gdb.Objfile} object has the following methods:
23567
23568 @defun Objfile.is_valid ()
23569 Returns @code{True} if the @code{gdb.Objfile} object is valid,
23570 @code{False} if not. A @code{gdb.Objfile} object can become invalid
23571 if the object file it refers to is not loaded in @value{GDBN} any
23572 longer. All other @code{gdb.Objfile} methods will throw an exception
23573 if it is invalid at the time the method is called.
23574 @end defun
23575
23576 @node Frames In Python
23577 @subsubsection Accessing inferior stack frames from Python.
23578
23579 @cindex frames in python
23580 When the debugged program stops, @value{GDBN} is able to analyze its call
23581 stack (@pxref{Frames,,Stack frames}). The @code{gdb.Frame} class
23582 represents a frame in the stack. A @code{gdb.Frame} object is only valid
23583 while its corresponding frame exists in the inferior's stack. If you try
23584 to use an invalid frame object, @value{GDBN} will throw a @code{gdb.error}
23585 exception (@pxref{Exception Handling}).
23586
23587 Two @code{gdb.Frame} objects can be compared for equality with the @code{==}
23588 operator, like:
23589
23590 @smallexample
23591 (@value{GDBP}) python print gdb.newest_frame() == gdb.selected_frame ()
23592 True
23593 @end smallexample
23594
23595 The following frame-related functions are available in the @code{gdb} module:
23596
23597 @findex gdb.selected_frame
23598 @defun gdb.selected_frame ()
23599 Return the selected frame object. (@pxref{Selection,,Selecting a Frame}).
23600 @end defun
23601
23602 @findex gdb.newest_frame
23603 @defun gdb.newest_frame ()
23604 Return the newest frame object for the selected thread.
23605 @end defun
23606
23607 @defun gdb.frame_stop_reason_string (reason)
23608 Return a string explaining the reason why @value{GDBN} stopped unwinding
23609 frames, as expressed by the given @var{reason} code (an integer, see the
23610 @code{unwind_stop_reason} method further down in this section).
23611 @end defun
23612
23613 A @code{gdb.Frame} object has the following methods:
23614
23615 @table @code
23616 @defun Frame.is_valid ()
23617 Returns true if the @code{gdb.Frame} object is valid, false if not.
23618 A frame object can become invalid if the frame it refers to doesn't
23619 exist anymore in the inferior. All @code{gdb.Frame} methods will throw
23620 an exception if it is invalid at the time the method is called.
23621 @end defun
23622
23623 @defun Frame.name ()
23624 Returns the function name of the frame, or @code{None} if it can't be
23625 obtained.
23626 @end defun
23627
23628 @defun Frame.type ()
23629 Returns the type of the frame. The value can be one of:
23630 @table @code
23631 @item gdb.NORMAL_FRAME
23632 An ordinary stack frame.
23633
23634 @item gdb.DUMMY_FRAME
23635 A fake stack frame that was created by @value{GDBN} when performing an
23636 inferior function call.
23637
23638 @item gdb.INLINE_FRAME
23639 A frame representing an inlined function. The function was inlined
23640 into a @code{gdb.NORMAL_FRAME} that is older than this one.
23641
23642 @item gdb.TAILCALL_FRAME
23643 A frame representing a tail call. @xref{Tail Call Frames}.
23644
23645 @item gdb.SIGTRAMP_FRAME
23646 A signal trampoline frame. This is the frame created by the OS when
23647 it calls into a signal handler.
23648
23649 @item gdb.ARCH_FRAME
23650 A fake stack frame representing a cross-architecture call.
23651
23652 @item gdb.SENTINEL_FRAME
23653 This is like @code{gdb.NORMAL_FRAME}, but it is only used for the
23654 newest frame.
23655 @end table
23656 @end defun
23657
23658 @defun Frame.unwind_stop_reason ()
23659 Return an integer representing the reason why it's not possible to find
23660 more frames toward the outermost frame. Use
23661 @code{gdb.frame_stop_reason_string} to convert the value returned by this
23662 function to a string. The value can be one of:
23663
23664 @table @code
23665 @item gdb.FRAME_UNWIND_NO_REASON
23666 No particular reason (older frames should be available).
23667
23668 @item gdb.FRAME_UNWIND_NULL_ID
23669 The previous frame's analyzer returns an invalid result.
23670
23671 @item gdb.FRAME_UNWIND_OUTERMOST
23672 This frame is the outermost.
23673
23674 @item gdb.FRAME_UNWIND_UNAVAILABLE
23675 Cannot unwind further, because that would require knowing the
23676 values of registers or memory that have not been collected.
23677
23678 @item gdb.FRAME_UNWIND_INNER_ID
23679 This frame ID looks like it ought to belong to a NEXT frame,
23680 but we got it for a PREV frame. Normally, this is a sign of
23681 unwinder failure. It could also indicate stack corruption.
23682
23683 @item gdb.FRAME_UNWIND_SAME_ID
23684 This frame has the same ID as the previous one. That means
23685 that unwinding further would almost certainly give us another
23686 frame with exactly the same ID, so break the chain. Normally,
23687 this is a sign of unwinder failure. It could also indicate
23688 stack corruption.
23689
23690 @item gdb.FRAME_UNWIND_NO_SAVED_PC
23691 The frame unwinder did not find any saved PC, but we needed
23692 one to unwind further.
23693
23694 @item gdb.FRAME_UNWIND_FIRST_ERROR
23695 Any stop reason greater or equal to this value indicates some kind
23696 of error. This special value facilitates writing code that tests
23697 for errors in unwinding in a way that will work correctly even if
23698 the list of the other values is modified in future @value{GDBN}
23699 versions. Using it, you could write:
23700 @smallexample
23701 reason = gdb.selected_frame().unwind_stop_reason ()
23702 reason_str = gdb.frame_stop_reason_string (reason)
23703 if reason >= gdb.FRAME_UNWIND_FIRST_ERROR:
23704 print "An error occured: %s" % reason_str
23705 @end smallexample
23706 @end table
23707
23708 @end defun
23709
23710 @defun Frame.pc ()
23711 Returns the frame's resume address.
23712 @end defun
23713
23714 @defun Frame.block ()
23715 Return the frame's code block. @xref{Blocks In Python}.
23716 @end defun
23717
23718 @defun Frame.function ()
23719 Return the symbol for the function corresponding to this frame.
23720 @xref{Symbols In Python}.
23721 @end defun
23722
23723 @defun Frame.older ()
23724 Return the frame that called this frame.
23725 @end defun
23726
23727 @defun Frame.newer ()
23728 Return the frame called by this frame.
23729 @end defun
23730
23731 @defun Frame.find_sal ()
23732 Return the frame's symtab and line object.
23733 @xref{Symbol Tables In Python}.
23734 @end defun
23735
23736 @defun Frame.read_var (variable @r{[}, block@r{]})
23737 Return the value of @var{variable} in this frame. If the optional
23738 argument @var{block} is provided, search for the variable from that
23739 block; otherwise start at the frame's current block (which is
23740 determined by the frame's current program counter). @var{variable}
23741 must be a string or a @code{gdb.Symbol} object. @var{block} must be a
23742 @code{gdb.Block} object.
23743 @end defun
23744
23745 @defun Frame.select ()
23746 Set this frame to be the selected frame. @xref{Stack, ,Examining the
23747 Stack}.
23748 @end defun
23749 @end table
23750
23751 @node Blocks In Python
23752 @subsubsection Accessing frame blocks from Python.
23753
23754 @cindex blocks in python
23755 @tindex gdb.Block
23756
23757 Within each frame, @value{GDBN} maintains information on each block
23758 stored in that frame. These blocks are organized hierarchically, and
23759 are represented individually in Python as a @code{gdb.Block}.
23760 Please see @ref{Frames In Python}, for a more in-depth discussion on
23761 frames. Furthermore, see @ref{Stack, ,Examining the Stack}, for more
23762 detailed technical information on @value{GDBN}'s book-keeping of the
23763 stack.
23764
23765 The following block-related functions are available in the @code{gdb}
23766 module:
23767
23768 @findex gdb.block_for_pc
23769 @defun gdb.block_for_pc (pc)
23770 Return the @code{gdb.Block} containing the given @var{pc} value. If the
23771 block cannot be found for the @var{pc} value specified, the function
23772 will return @code{None}.
23773 @end defun
23774
23775 A @code{gdb.Block} object has the following methods:
23776
23777 @table @code
23778 @defun Block.is_valid ()
23779 Returns @code{True} if the @code{gdb.Block} object is valid,
23780 @code{False} if not. A block object can become invalid if the block it
23781 refers to doesn't exist anymore in the inferior. All other
23782 @code{gdb.Block} methods will throw an exception if it is invalid at
23783 the time the method is called. This method is also made available to
23784 the Python iterator object that @code{gdb.Block} provides in an iteration
23785 context and via the Python @code{iter} built-in function.
23786 @end defun
23787 @end table
23788
23789 A @code{gdb.Block} object has the following attributes:
23790
23791 @table @code
23792 @defvar Block.start
23793 The start address of the block. This attribute is not writable.
23794 @end defvar
23795
23796 @defvar Block.end
23797 The end address of the block. This attribute is not writable.
23798 @end defvar
23799
23800 @defvar Block.function
23801 The name of the block represented as a @code{gdb.Symbol}. If the
23802 block is not named, then this attribute holds @code{None}. This
23803 attribute is not writable.
23804 @end defvar
23805
23806 @defvar Block.superblock
23807 The block containing this block. If this parent block does not exist,
23808 this attribute holds @code{None}. This attribute is not writable.
23809 @end defvar
23810
23811 @defvar Block.global_block
23812 The global block associated with this block. This attribute is not
23813 writable.
23814 @end defvar
23815
23816 @defvar Block.static_block
23817 The static block associated with this block. This attribute is not
23818 writable.
23819 @end defvar
23820
23821 @defvar Block.is_global
23822 @code{True} if the @code{gdb.Block} object is a global block,
23823 @code{False} if not. This attribute is not
23824 writable.
23825 @end defvar
23826
23827 @defvar Block.is_static
23828 @code{True} if the @code{gdb.Block} object is a static block,
23829 @code{False} if not. This attribute is not writable.
23830 @end defvar
23831 @end table
23832
23833 @node Symbols In Python
23834 @subsubsection Python representation of Symbols.
23835
23836 @cindex symbols in python
23837 @tindex gdb.Symbol
23838
23839 @value{GDBN} represents every variable, function and type as an
23840 entry in a symbol table. @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol Table}.
23841 Similarly, Python represents these symbols in @value{GDBN} with the
23842 @code{gdb.Symbol} object.
23843
23844 The following symbol-related functions are available in the @code{gdb}
23845 module:
23846
23847 @findex gdb.lookup_symbol
23848 @defun gdb.lookup_symbol (name @r{[}, block @r{[}, domain@r{]]})
23849 This function searches for a symbol by name. The search scope can be
23850 restricted to the parameters defined in the optional domain and block
23851 arguments.
23852
23853 @var{name} is the name of the symbol. It must be a string. The
23854 optional @var{block} argument restricts the search to symbols visible
23855 in that @var{block}. The @var{block} argument must be a
23856 @code{gdb.Block} object. If omitted, the block for the current frame
23857 is used. The optional @var{domain} argument restricts
23858 the search to the domain type. The @var{domain} argument must be a
23859 domain constant defined in the @code{gdb} module and described later
23860 in this chapter.
23861
23862 The result is a tuple of two elements.
23863 The first element is a @code{gdb.Symbol} object or @code{None} if the symbol
23864 is not found.
23865 If the symbol is found, the second element is @code{True} if the symbol
23866 is a field of a method's object (e.g., @code{this} in C@t{++}),
23867 otherwise it is @code{False}.
23868 If the symbol is not found, the second element is @code{False}.
23869 @end defun
23870
23871 @findex gdb.lookup_global_symbol
23872 @defun gdb.lookup_global_symbol (name @r{[}, domain@r{]})
23873 This function searches for a global symbol by name.
23874 The search scope can be restricted to by the domain argument.
23875
23876 @var{name} is the name of the symbol. It must be a string.
23877 The optional @var{domain} argument restricts the search to the domain type.
23878 The @var{domain} argument must be a domain constant defined in the @code{gdb}
23879 module and described later in this chapter.
23880
23881 The result is a @code{gdb.Symbol} object or @code{None} if the symbol
23882 is not found.
23883 @end defun
23884
23885 A @code{gdb.Symbol} object has the following attributes:
23886
23887 @table @code
23888 @defvar Symbol.type
23889 The type of the symbol or @code{None} if no type is recorded.
23890 This attribute is represented as a @code{gdb.Type} object.
23891 @xref{Types In Python}. This attribute is not writable.
23892 @end defvar
23893
23894 @defvar Symbol.symtab
23895 The symbol table in which the symbol appears. This attribute is
23896 represented as a @code{gdb.Symtab} object. @xref{Symbol Tables In
23897 Python}. This attribute is not writable.
23898 @end defvar
23899
23900 @defvar Symbol.name
23901 The name of the symbol as a string. This attribute is not writable.
23902 @end defvar
23903
23904 @defvar Symbol.linkage_name
23905 The name of the symbol, as used by the linker (i.e., may be mangled).
23906 This attribute is not writable.
23907 @end defvar
23908
23909 @defvar Symbol.print_name
23910 The name of the symbol in a form suitable for output. This is either
23911 @code{name} or @code{linkage_name}, depending on whether the user
23912 asked @value{GDBN} to display demangled or mangled names.
23913 @end defvar
23914
23915 @defvar Symbol.addr_class
23916 The address class of the symbol. This classifies how to find the value
23917 of a symbol. Each address class is a constant defined in the
23918 @code{gdb} module and described later in this chapter.
23919 @end defvar
23920
23921 @defvar Symbol.is_argument
23922 @code{True} if the symbol is an argument of a function.
23923 @end defvar
23924
23925 @defvar Symbol.is_constant
23926 @code{True} if the symbol is a constant.
23927 @end defvar
23928
23929 @defvar Symbol.is_function
23930 @code{True} if the symbol is a function or a method.
23931 @end defvar
23932
23933 @defvar Symbol.is_variable
23934 @code{True} if the symbol is a variable.
23935 @end defvar
23936 @end table
23937
23938 A @code{gdb.Symbol} object has the following methods:
23939
23940 @table @code
23941 @defun Symbol.is_valid ()
23942 Returns @code{True} if the @code{gdb.Symbol} object is valid,
23943 @code{False} if not. A @code{gdb.Symbol} object can become invalid if
23944 the symbol it refers to does not exist in @value{GDBN} any longer.
23945 All other @code{gdb.Symbol} methods will throw an exception if it is
23946 invalid at the time the method is called.
23947 @end defun
23948 @end table
23949
23950 The available domain categories in @code{gdb.Symbol} are represented
23951 as constants in the @code{gdb} module:
23952
23953 @table @code
23954 @findex SYMBOL_UNDEF_DOMAIN
23955 @findex gdb.SYMBOL_UNDEF_DOMAIN
23956 @item gdb.SYMBOL_UNDEF_DOMAIN
23957 This is used when a domain has not been discovered or none of the
23958 following domains apply. This usually indicates an error either
23959 in the symbol information or in @value{GDBN}'s handling of symbols.
23960 @findex SYMBOL_VAR_DOMAIN
23961 @findex gdb.SYMBOL_VAR_DOMAIN
23962 @item gdb.SYMBOL_VAR_DOMAIN
23963 This domain contains variables, function names, typedef names and enum
23964 type values.
23965 @findex SYMBOL_STRUCT_DOMAIN
23966 @findex gdb.SYMBOL_STRUCT_DOMAIN
23967 @item gdb.SYMBOL_STRUCT_DOMAIN
23968 This domain holds struct, union and enum type names.
23969 @findex SYMBOL_LABEL_DOMAIN
23970 @findex gdb.SYMBOL_LABEL_DOMAIN
23971 @item gdb.SYMBOL_LABEL_DOMAIN
23972 This domain contains names of labels (for gotos).
23973 @findex SYMBOL_VARIABLES_DOMAIN
23974 @findex gdb.SYMBOL_VARIABLES_DOMAIN
23975 @item gdb.SYMBOL_VARIABLES_DOMAIN
23976 This domain holds a subset of the @code{SYMBOLS_VAR_DOMAIN}; it
23977 contains everything minus functions and types.
23978 @findex SYMBOL_FUNCTIONS_DOMAIN
23979 @findex gdb.SYMBOL_FUNCTIONS_DOMAIN
23980 @item gdb.SYMBOL_FUNCTION_DOMAIN
23981 This domain contains all functions.
23982 @findex SYMBOL_TYPES_DOMAIN
23983 @findex gdb.SYMBOL_TYPES_DOMAIN
23984 @item gdb.SYMBOL_TYPES_DOMAIN
23985 This domain contains all types.
23986 @end table
23987
23988 The available address class categories in @code{gdb.Symbol} are represented
23989 as constants in the @code{gdb} module:
23990
23991 @table @code
23992 @findex SYMBOL_LOC_UNDEF
23993 @findex gdb.SYMBOL_LOC_UNDEF
23994 @item gdb.SYMBOL_LOC_UNDEF
23995 If this is returned by address class, it indicates an error either in
23996 the symbol information or in @value{GDBN}'s handling of symbols.
23997 @findex SYMBOL_LOC_CONST
23998 @findex gdb.SYMBOL_LOC_CONST
23999 @item gdb.SYMBOL_LOC_CONST
24000 Value is constant int.
24001 @findex SYMBOL_LOC_STATIC
24002 @findex gdb.SYMBOL_LOC_STATIC
24003 @item gdb.SYMBOL_LOC_STATIC
24004 Value is at a fixed address.
24005 @findex SYMBOL_LOC_REGISTER
24006 @findex gdb.SYMBOL_LOC_REGISTER
24007 @item gdb.SYMBOL_LOC_REGISTER
24008 Value is in a register.
24009 @findex SYMBOL_LOC_ARG
24010 @findex gdb.SYMBOL_LOC_ARG
24011 @item gdb.SYMBOL_LOC_ARG
24012 Value is an argument. This value is at the offset stored within the
24013 symbol inside the frame's argument list.
24014 @findex SYMBOL_LOC_REF_ARG
24015 @findex gdb.SYMBOL_LOC_REF_ARG
24016 @item gdb.SYMBOL_LOC_REF_ARG
24017 Value address is stored in the frame's argument list. Just like
24018 @code{LOC_ARG} except that the value's address is stored at the
24019 offset, not the value itself.
24020 @findex SYMBOL_LOC_REGPARM_ADDR
24021 @findex gdb.SYMBOL_LOC_REGPARM_ADDR
24022 @item gdb.SYMBOL_LOC_REGPARM_ADDR
24023 Value is a specified register. Just like @code{LOC_REGISTER} except
24024 the register holds the address of the argument instead of the argument
24025 itself.
24026 @findex SYMBOL_LOC_LOCAL
24027 @findex gdb.SYMBOL_LOC_LOCAL
24028 @item gdb.SYMBOL_LOC_LOCAL
24029 Value is a local variable.
24030 @findex SYMBOL_LOC_TYPEDEF
24031 @findex gdb.SYMBOL_LOC_TYPEDEF
24032 @item gdb.SYMBOL_LOC_TYPEDEF
24033 Value not used. Symbols in the domain @code{SYMBOL_STRUCT_DOMAIN} all
24034 have this class.
24035 @findex SYMBOL_LOC_BLOCK
24036 @findex gdb.SYMBOL_LOC_BLOCK
24037 @item gdb.SYMBOL_LOC_BLOCK
24038 Value is a block.
24039 @findex SYMBOL_LOC_CONST_BYTES
24040 @findex gdb.SYMBOL_LOC_CONST_BYTES
24041 @item gdb.SYMBOL_LOC_CONST_BYTES
24042 Value is a byte-sequence.
24043 @findex SYMBOL_LOC_UNRESOLVED
24044 @findex gdb.SYMBOL_LOC_UNRESOLVED
24045 @item gdb.SYMBOL_LOC_UNRESOLVED
24046 Value is at a fixed address, but the address of the variable has to be
24047 determined from the minimal symbol table whenever the variable is
24048 referenced.
24049 @findex SYMBOL_LOC_OPTIMIZED_OUT
24050 @findex gdb.SYMBOL_LOC_OPTIMIZED_OUT
24051 @item gdb.SYMBOL_LOC_OPTIMIZED_OUT
24052 The value does not actually exist in the program.
24053 @findex SYMBOL_LOC_COMPUTED
24054 @findex gdb.SYMBOL_LOC_COMPUTED
24055 @item gdb.SYMBOL_LOC_COMPUTED
24056 The value's address is a computed location.
24057 @end table
24058
24059 @node Symbol Tables In Python
24060 @subsubsection Symbol table representation in Python.
24061
24062 @cindex symbol tables in python
24063 @tindex gdb.Symtab
24064 @tindex gdb.Symtab_and_line
24065
24066 Access to symbol table data maintained by @value{GDBN} on the inferior
24067 is exposed to Python via two objects: @code{gdb.Symtab_and_line} and
24068 @code{gdb.Symtab}. Symbol table and line data for a frame is returned
24069 from the @code{find_sal} method in @code{gdb.Frame} object.
24070 @xref{Frames In Python}.
24071
24072 For more information on @value{GDBN}'s symbol table management, see
24073 @ref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol Table}, for more information.
24074
24075 A @code{gdb.Symtab_and_line} object has the following attributes:
24076
24077 @table @code
24078 @defvar Symtab_and_line.symtab
24079 The symbol table object (@code{gdb.Symtab}) for this frame.
24080 This attribute is not writable.
24081 @end defvar
24082
24083 @defvar Symtab_and_line.pc
24084 Indicates the current program counter address. This attribute is not
24085 writable.
24086 @end defvar
24087
24088 @defvar Symtab_and_line.line
24089 Indicates the current line number for this object. This
24090 attribute is not writable.
24091 @end defvar
24092 @end table
24093
24094 A @code{gdb.Symtab_and_line} object has the following methods:
24095
24096 @table @code
24097 @defun Symtab_and_line.is_valid ()
24098 Returns @code{True} if the @code{gdb.Symtab_and_line} object is valid,
24099 @code{False} if not. A @code{gdb.Symtab_and_line} object can become
24100 invalid if the Symbol table and line object it refers to does not
24101 exist in @value{GDBN} any longer. All other
24102 @code{gdb.Symtab_and_line} methods will throw an exception if it is
24103 invalid at the time the method is called.
24104 @end defun
24105 @end table
24106
24107 A @code{gdb.Symtab} object has the following attributes:
24108
24109 @table @code
24110 @defvar Symtab.filename
24111 The symbol table's source filename. This attribute is not writable.
24112 @end defvar
24113
24114 @defvar Symtab.objfile
24115 The symbol table's backing object file. @xref{Objfiles In Python}.
24116 This attribute is not writable.
24117 @end defvar
24118 @end table
24119
24120 A @code{gdb.Symtab} object has the following methods:
24121
24122 @table @code
24123 @defun Symtab.is_valid ()
24124 Returns @code{True} if the @code{gdb.Symtab} object is valid,
24125 @code{False} if not. A @code{gdb.Symtab} object can become invalid if
24126 the symbol table it refers to does not exist in @value{GDBN} any
24127 longer. All other @code{gdb.Symtab} methods will throw an exception
24128 if it is invalid at the time the method is called.
24129 @end defun
24130
24131 @defun Symtab.fullname ()
24132 Return the symbol table's source absolute file name.
24133 @end defun
24134 @end table
24135
24136 @node Breakpoints In Python
24137 @subsubsection Manipulating breakpoints using Python
24138
24139 @cindex breakpoints in python
24140 @tindex gdb.Breakpoint
24141
24142 Python code can manipulate breakpoints via the @code{gdb.Breakpoint}
24143 class.
24144
24145 @defun Breakpoint.__init__ (spec @r{[}, type @r{[}, wp_class @r{[},internal@r{]]]})
24146 Create a new breakpoint. @var{spec} is a string naming the
24147 location of the breakpoint, or an expression that defines a
24148 watchpoint. The contents can be any location recognized by the
24149 @code{break} command, or in the case of a watchpoint, by the @code{watch}
24150 command. The optional @var{type} denotes the breakpoint to create
24151 from the types defined later in this chapter. This argument can be
24152 either: @code{gdb.BP_BREAKPOINT} or @code{gdb.BP_WATCHPOINT}. @var{type}
24153 defaults to @code{gdb.BP_BREAKPOINT}. The optional @var{internal} argument
24154 allows the breakpoint to become invisible to the user. The breakpoint
24155 will neither be reported when created, nor will it be listed in the
24156 output from @code{info breakpoints} (but will be listed with the
24157 @code{maint info breakpoints} command). The optional @var{wp_class}
24158 argument defines the class of watchpoint to create, if @var{type} is
24159 @code{gdb.BP_WATCHPOINT}. If a watchpoint class is not provided, it is
24160 assumed to be a @code{gdb.WP_WRITE} class.
24161 @end defun
24162
24163 @defun Breakpoint.stop (self)
24164 The @code{gdb.Breakpoint} class can be sub-classed and, in
24165 particular, you may choose to implement the @code{stop} method.
24166 If this method is defined as a sub-class of @code{gdb.Breakpoint},
24167 it will be called when the inferior reaches any location of a
24168 breakpoint which instantiates that sub-class. If the method returns
24169 @code{True}, the inferior will be stopped at the location of the
24170 breakpoint, otherwise the inferior will continue.
24171
24172 If there are multiple breakpoints at the same location with a
24173 @code{stop} method, each one will be called regardless of the
24174 return status of the previous. This ensures that all @code{stop}
24175 methods have a chance to execute at that location. In this scenario
24176 if one of the methods returns @code{True} but the others return
24177 @code{False}, the inferior will still be stopped.
24178
24179 You should not alter the execution state of the inferior (i.e.@:, step,
24180 next, etc.), alter the current frame context (i.e.@:, change the current
24181 active frame), or alter, add or delete any breakpoint. As a general
24182 rule, you should not alter any data within @value{GDBN} or the inferior
24183 at this time.
24184
24185 Example @code{stop} implementation:
24186
24187 @smallexample
24188 class MyBreakpoint (gdb.Breakpoint):
24189 def stop (self):
24190 inf_val = gdb.parse_and_eval("foo")
24191 if inf_val == 3:
24192 return True
24193 return False
24194 @end smallexample
24195 @end defun
24196
24197 The available watchpoint types represented by constants are defined in the
24198 @code{gdb} module:
24199
24200 @table @code
24201 @findex WP_READ
24202 @findex gdb.WP_READ
24203 @item gdb.WP_READ
24204 Read only watchpoint.
24205
24206 @findex WP_WRITE
24207 @findex gdb.WP_WRITE
24208 @item gdb.WP_WRITE
24209 Write only watchpoint.
24210
24211 @findex WP_ACCESS
24212 @findex gdb.WP_ACCESS
24213 @item gdb.WP_ACCESS
24214 Read/Write watchpoint.
24215 @end table
24216
24217 @defun Breakpoint.is_valid ()
24218 Return @code{True} if this @code{Breakpoint} object is valid,
24219 @code{False} otherwise. A @code{Breakpoint} object can become invalid
24220 if the user deletes the breakpoint. In this case, the object still
24221 exists, but the underlying breakpoint does not. In the cases of
24222 watchpoint scope, the watchpoint remains valid even if execution of the
24223 inferior leaves the scope of that watchpoint.
24224 @end defun
24225
24226 @defun Breakpoint.delete
24227 Permanently deletes the @value{GDBN} breakpoint. This also
24228 invalidates the Python @code{Breakpoint} object. Any further access
24229 to this object's attributes or methods will raise an error.
24230 @end defun
24231
24232 @defvar Breakpoint.enabled
24233 This attribute is @code{True} if the breakpoint is enabled, and
24234 @code{False} otherwise. This attribute is writable.
24235 @end defvar
24236
24237 @defvar Breakpoint.silent
24238 This attribute is @code{True} if the breakpoint is silent, and
24239 @code{False} otherwise. This attribute is writable.
24240
24241 Note that a breakpoint can also be silent if it has commands and the
24242 first command is @code{silent}. This is not reported by the
24243 @code{silent} attribute.
24244 @end defvar
24245
24246 @defvar Breakpoint.thread
24247 If the breakpoint is thread-specific, this attribute holds the thread
24248 id. If the breakpoint is not thread-specific, this attribute is
24249 @code{None}. This attribute is writable.
24250 @end defvar
24251
24252 @defvar Breakpoint.task
24253 If the breakpoint is Ada task-specific, this attribute holds the Ada task
24254 id. If the breakpoint is not task-specific (or the underlying
24255 language is not Ada), this attribute is @code{None}. This attribute
24256 is writable.
24257 @end defvar
24258
24259 @defvar Breakpoint.ignore_count
24260 This attribute holds the ignore count for the breakpoint, an integer.
24261 This attribute is writable.
24262 @end defvar
24263
24264 @defvar Breakpoint.number
24265 This attribute holds the breakpoint's number --- the identifier used by
24266 the user to manipulate the breakpoint. This attribute is not writable.
24267 @end defvar
24268
24269 @defvar Breakpoint.type
24270 This attribute holds the breakpoint's type --- the identifier used to
24271 determine the actual breakpoint type or use-case. This attribute is not
24272 writable.
24273 @end defvar
24274
24275 @defvar Breakpoint.visible
24276 This attribute tells whether the breakpoint is visible to the user
24277 when set, or when the @samp{info breakpoints} command is run. This
24278 attribute is not writable.
24279 @end defvar
24280
24281 The available types are represented by constants defined in the @code{gdb}
24282 module:
24283
24284 @table @code
24285 @findex BP_BREAKPOINT
24286 @findex gdb.BP_BREAKPOINT
24287 @item gdb.BP_BREAKPOINT
24288 Normal code breakpoint.
24289
24290 @findex BP_WATCHPOINT
24291 @findex gdb.BP_WATCHPOINT
24292 @item gdb.BP_WATCHPOINT
24293 Watchpoint breakpoint.
24294
24295 @findex BP_HARDWARE_WATCHPOINT
24296 @findex gdb.BP_HARDWARE_WATCHPOINT
24297 @item gdb.BP_HARDWARE_WATCHPOINT
24298 Hardware assisted watchpoint.
24299
24300 @findex BP_READ_WATCHPOINT
24301 @findex gdb.BP_READ_WATCHPOINT
24302 @item gdb.BP_READ_WATCHPOINT
24303 Hardware assisted read watchpoint.
24304
24305 @findex BP_ACCESS_WATCHPOINT
24306 @findex gdb.BP_ACCESS_WATCHPOINT
24307 @item gdb.BP_ACCESS_WATCHPOINT
24308 Hardware assisted access watchpoint.
24309 @end table
24310
24311 @defvar Breakpoint.hit_count
24312 This attribute holds the hit count for the breakpoint, an integer.
24313 This attribute is writable, but currently it can only be set to zero.
24314 @end defvar
24315
24316 @defvar Breakpoint.location
24317 This attribute holds the location of the breakpoint, as specified by
24318 the user. It is a string. If the breakpoint does not have a location
24319 (that is, it is a watchpoint) the attribute's value is @code{None}. This
24320 attribute is not writable.
24321 @end defvar
24322
24323 @defvar Breakpoint.expression
24324 This attribute holds a breakpoint expression, as specified by
24325 the user. It is a string. If the breakpoint does not have an
24326 expression (the breakpoint is not a watchpoint) the attribute's value
24327 is @code{None}. This attribute is not writable.
24328 @end defvar
24329
24330 @defvar Breakpoint.condition
24331 This attribute holds the condition of the breakpoint, as specified by
24332 the user. It is a string. If there is no condition, this attribute's
24333 value is @code{None}. This attribute is writable.
24334 @end defvar
24335
24336 @defvar Breakpoint.commands
24337 This attribute holds the commands attached to the breakpoint. If
24338 there are commands, this attribute's value is a string holding all the
24339 commands, separated by newlines. If there are no commands, this
24340 attribute is @code{None}. This attribute is not writable.
24341 @end defvar
24342
24343 @node Lazy Strings In Python
24344 @subsubsection Python representation of lazy strings.
24345
24346 @cindex lazy strings in python
24347 @tindex gdb.LazyString
24348
24349 A @dfn{lazy string} is a string whose contents is not retrieved or
24350 encoded until it is needed.
24351
24352 A @code{gdb.LazyString} is represented in @value{GDBN} as an
24353 @code{address} that points to a region of memory, an @code{encoding}
24354 that will be used to encode that region of memory, and a @code{length}
24355 to delimit the region of memory that represents the string. The
24356 difference between a @code{gdb.LazyString} and a string wrapped within
24357 a @code{gdb.Value} is that a @code{gdb.LazyString} will be treated
24358 differently by @value{GDBN} when printing. A @code{gdb.LazyString} is
24359 retrieved and encoded during printing, while a @code{gdb.Value}
24360 wrapping a string is immediately retrieved and encoded on creation.
24361
24362 A @code{gdb.LazyString} object has the following functions:
24363
24364 @defun LazyString.value ()
24365 Convert the @code{gdb.LazyString} to a @code{gdb.Value}. This value
24366 will point to the string in memory, but will lose all the delayed
24367 retrieval, encoding and handling that @value{GDBN} applies to a
24368 @code{gdb.LazyString}.
24369 @end defun
24370
24371 @defvar LazyString.address
24372 This attribute holds the address of the string. This attribute is not
24373 writable.
24374 @end defvar
24375
24376 @defvar LazyString.length
24377 This attribute holds the length of the string in characters. If the
24378 length is -1, then the string will be fetched and encoded up to the
24379 first null of appropriate width. This attribute is not writable.
24380 @end defvar
24381
24382 @defvar LazyString.encoding
24383 This attribute holds the encoding that will be applied to the string
24384 when the string is printed by @value{GDBN}. If the encoding is not
24385 set, or contains an empty string, then @value{GDBN} will select the
24386 most appropriate encoding when the string is printed. This attribute
24387 is not writable.
24388 @end defvar
24389
24390 @defvar LazyString.type
24391 This attribute holds the type that is represented by the lazy string's
24392 type. For a lazy string this will always be a pointer type. To
24393 resolve this to the lazy string's character type, use the type's
24394 @code{target} method. @xref{Types In Python}. This attribute is not
24395 writable.
24396 @end defvar
24397
24398 @node Auto-loading
24399 @subsection Auto-loading
24400 @cindex auto-loading, Python
24401
24402 When a new object file is read (for example, due to the @code{file}
24403 command, or because the inferior has loaded a shared library),
24404 @value{GDBN} will look for Python support scripts in several ways:
24405 @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.py} and @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section.
24406
24407 @menu
24408 * objfile-gdb.py file:: The @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.py} file
24409 * .debug_gdb_scripts section:: The @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section
24410 * Which flavor to choose?::
24411 @end menu
24412
24413 The auto-loading feature is useful for supplying application-specific
24414 debugging commands and scripts.
24415
24416 Auto-loading can be enabled or disabled,
24417 and the list of auto-loaded scripts can be printed.
24418
24419 @table @code
24420 @kindex set auto-load-scripts
24421 @item set auto-load-scripts [yes|no]
24422 Enable or disable the auto-loading of Python scripts.
24423
24424 @kindex show auto-load-scripts
24425 @item show auto-load-scripts
24426 Show whether auto-loading of Python scripts is enabled or disabled.
24427
24428 @kindex info auto-load-scripts
24429 @cindex print list of auto-loaded scripts
24430 @item info auto-load-scripts [@var{regexp}]
24431 Print the list of all scripts that @value{GDBN} auto-loaded.
24432
24433 Also printed is the list of scripts that were mentioned in
24434 the @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section and were not found
24435 (@pxref{.debug_gdb_scripts section}).
24436 This is useful because their names are not printed when @value{GDBN}
24437 tries to load them and fails. There may be many of them, and printing
24438 an error message for each one is problematic.
24439
24440 If @var{regexp} is supplied only scripts with matching names are printed.
24441
24442 Example:
24443
24444 @smallexample
24445 (gdb) info auto-load-scripts
24446 Loaded Script
24447 Yes py-section-script.py
24448 full name: /tmp/py-section-script.py
24449 Missing my-foo-pretty-printers.py
24450 @end smallexample
24451 @end table
24452
24453 When reading an auto-loaded file, @value{GDBN} sets the
24454 @dfn{current objfile}. This is available via the @code{gdb.current_objfile}
24455 function (@pxref{Objfiles In Python}). This can be useful for
24456 registering objfile-specific pretty-printers.
24457
24458 @node objfile-gdb.py file
24459 @subsubsection The @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.py} file
24460 @cindex @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.py}
24461
24462 When a new object file is read, @value{GDBN} looks for
24463 a file named @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.py},
24464 where @var{objfile} is the object file's real name, formed by ensuring
24465 that the file name is absolute, following all symlinks, and resolving
24466 @code{.} and @code{..} components. If this file exists and is
24467 readable, @value{GDBN} will evaluate it as a Python script.
24468
24469 If this file does not exist, and if the parameter
24470 @code{debug-file-directory} is set (@pxref{Separate Debug Files}),
24471 then @value{GDBN} will look for @var{real-name} in all of the
24472 directories mentioned in the value of @code{debug-file-directory}.
24473
24474 Finally, if this file does not exist, then @value{GDBN} will look for
24475 a file named @file{@var{data-directory}/python/auto-load/@var{real-name}}, where
24476 @var{data-directory} is @value{GDBN}'s data directory (available via
24477 @code{show data-directory}, @pxref{Data Files}), and @var{real-name}
24478 is the object file's real name, as described above.
24479
24480 @value{GDBN} does not track which files it has already auto-loaded this way.
24481 @value{GDBN} will load the associated script every time the corresponding
24482 @var{objfile} is opened.
24483 So your @file{-gdb.py} file should be careful to avoid errors if it
24484 is evaluated more than once.
24485
24486 @node .debug_gdb_scripts section
24487 @subsubsection The @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section
24488 @cindex @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section
24489
24490 For systems using file formats like ELF and COFF,
24491 when @value{GDBN} loads a new object file
24492 it will look for a special section named @samp{.debug_gdb_scripts}.
24493 If this section exists, its contents is a list of names of scripts to load.
24494
24495 @value{GDBN} will look for each specified script file first in the
24496 current directory and then along the source search path
24497 (@pxref{Source Path, ,Specifying Source Directories}),
24498 except that @file{$cdir} is not searched, since the compilation
24499 directory is not relevant to scripts.
24500
24501 Entries can be placed in section @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} with,
24502 for example, this GCC macro:
24503
24504 @example
24505 /* Note: The "MS" section flags are to remove duplicates. */
24506 #define DEFINE_GDB_SCRIPT(script_name) \
24507 asm("\
24508 .pushsection \".debug_gdb_scripts\", \"MS\",@@progbits,1\n\
24509 .byte 1\n\
24510 .asciz \"" script_name "\"\n\
24511 .popsection \n\
24512 ");
24513 @end example
24514
24515 @noindent
24516 Then one can reference the macro in a header or source file like this:
24517
24518 @example
24519 DEFINE_GDB_SCRIPT ("my-app-scripts.py")
24520 @end example
24521
24522 The script name may include directories if desired.
24523
24524 If the macro is put in a header, any application or library
24525 using this header will get a reference to the specified script.
24526
24527 @node Which flavor to choose?
24528 @subsubsection Which flavor to choose?
24529
24530 Given the multiple ways of auto-loading Python scripts, it might not always
24531 be clear which one to choose. This section provides some guidance.
24532
24533 Benefits of the @file{-gdb.py} way:
24534
24535 @itemize @bullet
24536 @item
24537 Can be used with file formats that don't support multiple sections.
24538
24539 @item
24540 Ease of finding scripts for public libraries.
24541
24542 Scripts specified in the @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section are searched for
24543 in the source search path.
24544 For publicly installed libraries, e.g., @file{libstdc++}, there typically
24545 isn't a source directory in which to find the script.
24546
24547 @item
24548 Doesn't require source code additions.
24549 @end itemize
24550
24551 Benefits of the @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} way:
24552
24553 @itemize @bullet
24554 @item
24555 Works with static linking.
24556
24557 Scripts for libraries done the @file{-gdb.py} way require an objfile to
24558 trigger their loading. When an application is statically linked the only
24559 objfile available is the executable, and it is cumbersome to attach all the
24560 scripts from all the input libraries to the executable's @file{-gdb.py} script.
24561
24562 @item
24563 Works with classes that are entirely inlined.
24564
24565 Some classes can be entirely inlined, and thus there may not be an associated
24566 shared library to attach a @file{-gdb.py} script to.
24567
24568 @item
24569 Scripts needn't be copied out of the source tree.
24570
24571 In some circumstances, apps can be built out of large collections of internal
24572 libraries, and the build infrastructure necessary to install the
24573 @file{-gdb.py} scripts in a place where @value{GDBN} can find them is
24574 cumbersome. It may be easier to specify the scripts in the
24575 @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section as relative paths, and add a path to the
24576 top of the source tree to the source search path.
24577 @end itemize
24578
24579 @node Python modules
24580 @subsection Python modules
24581 @cindex python modules
24582
24583 @value{GDBN} comes with several modules to assist writing Python code.
24584
24585 @menu
24586 * gdb.printing:: Building and registering pretty-printers.
24587 * gdb.types:: Utilities for working with types.
24588 * gdb.prompt:: Utilities for prompt value substitution.
24589 @end menu
24590
24591 @node gdb.printing
24592 @subsubsection gdb.printing
24593 @cindex gdb.printing
24594
24595 This module provides a collection of utilities for working with
24596 pretty-printers.
24597
24598 @table @code
24599 @item PrettyPrinter (@var{name}, @var{subprinters}=None)
24600 This class specifies the API that makes @samp{info pretty-printer},
24601 @samp{enable pretty-printer} and @samp{disable pretty-printer} work.
24602 Pretty-printers should generally inherit from this class.
24603
24604 @item SubPrettyPrinter (@var{name})
24605 For printers that handle multiple types, this class specifies the
24606 corresponding API for the subprinters.
24607
24608 @item RegexpCollectionPrettyPrinter (@var{name})
24609 Utility class for handling multiple printers, all recognized via
24610 regular expressions.
24611 @xref{Writing a Pretty-Printer}, for an example.
24612
24613 @item register_pretty_printer (@var{obj}, @var{printer}, @var{replace}=False)
24614 Register @var{printer} with the pretty-printer list of @var{obj}.
24615 If @var{replace} is @code{True} then any existing copy of the printer
24616 is replaced. Otherwise a @code{RuntimeError} exception is raised
24617 if a printer with the same name already exists.
24618 @end table
24619
24620 @node gdb.types
24621 @subsubsection gdb.types
24622 @cindex gdb.types
24623
24624 This module provides a collection of utilities for working with
24625 @code{gdb.Types} objects.
24626
24627 @table @code
24628 @item get_basic_type (@var{type})
24629 Return @var{type} with const and volatile qualifiers stripped,
24630 and with typedefs and C@t{++} references converted to the underlying type.
24631
24632 C@t{++} example:
24633
24634 @smallexample
24635 typedef const int const_int;
24636 const_int foo (3);
24637 const_int& foo_ref (foo);
24638 int main () @{ return 0; @}
24639 @end smallexample
24640
24641 Then in gdb:
24642
24643 @smallexample
24644 (gdb) start
24645 (gdb) python import gdb.types
24646 (gdb) python foo_ref = gdb.parse_and_eval("foo_ref")
24647 (gdb) python print gdb.types.get_basic_type(foo_ref.type)
24648 int
24649 @end smallexample
24650
24651 @item has_field (@var{type}, @var{field})
24652 Return @code{True} if @var{type}, assumed to be a type with fields
24653 (e.g., a structure or union), has field @var{field}.
24654
24655 @item make_enum_dict (@var{enum_type})
24656 Return a Python @code{dictionary} type produced from @var{enum_type}.
24657
24658 @item deep_items (@var{type})
24659 Returns a Python iterator similar to the standard
24660 @code{gdb.Type.iteritems} method, except that the iterator returned
24661 by @code{deep_items} will recursively traverse anonymous struct or
24662 union fields. For example:
24663
24664 @smallexample
24665 struct A
24666 @{
24667 int a;
24668 union @{
24669 int b0;
24670 int b1;
24671 @};
24672 @};
24673 @end smallexample
24674
24675 @noindent
24676 Then in @value{GDBN}:
24677 @smallexample
24678 (@value{GDBP}) python import gdb.types
24679 (@value{GDBP}) python struct_a = gdb.lookup_type("struct A")
24680 (@value{GDBP}) python print struct_a.keys ()
24681 @{['a', '']@}
24682 (@value{GDBP}) python print [k for k,v in gdb.types.deep_items(struct_a)]
24683 @{['a', 'b0', 'b1']@}
24684 @end smallexample
24685
24686 @end table
24687
24688 @node gdb.prompt
24689 @subsubsection gdb.prompt
24690 @cindex gdb.prompt
24691
24692 This module provides a method for prompt value-substitution.
24693
24694 @table @code
24695 @item substitute_prompt (@var{string})
24696 Return @var{string} with escape sequences substituted by values. Some
24697 escape sequences take arguments. You can specify arguments inside
24698 ``@{@}'' immediately following the escape sequence.
24699
24700 The escape sequences you can pass to this function are:
24701
24702 @table @code
24703 @item \\
24704 Substitute a backslash.
24705 @item \e
24706 Substitute an ESC character.
24707 @item \f
24708 Substitute the selected frame; an argument names a frame parameter.
24709 @item \n
24710 Substitute a newline.
24711 @item \p
24712 Substitute a parameter's value; the argument names the parameter.
24713 @item \r
24714 Substitute a carriage return.
24715 @item \t
24716 Substitute the selected thread; an argument names a thread parameter.
24717 @item \v
24718 Substitute the version of GDB.
24719 @item \w
24720 Substitute the current working directory.
24721 @item \[
24722 Begin a sequence of non-printing characters. These sequences are
24723 typically used with the ESC character, and are not counted in the string
24724 length. Example: ``\[\e[0;34m\](gdb)\[\e[0m\]'' will return a
24725 blue-colored ``(gdb)'' prompt where the length is five.
24726 @item \]
24727 End a sequence of non-printing characters.
24728 @end table
24729
24730 For example:
24731
24732 @smallexample
24733 substitute_prompt (``frame: \f,
24734 print arguments: \p@{print frame-arguments@}'')
24735 @end smallexample
24736
24737 @exdent will return the string:
24738
24739 @smallexample
24740 "frame: main, print arguments: scalars"
24741 @end smallexample
24742 @end table
24743
24744 @node Aliases
24745 @section Creating new spellings of existing commands
24746 @cindex aliases for commands
24747
24748 It is often useful to define alternate spellings of existing commands.
24749 For example, if a new @value{GDBN} command defined in Python has
24750 a long name to type, it is handy to have an abbreviated version of it
24751 that involves less typing.
24752
24753 @value{GDBN} itself uses aliases. For example @samp{s} is an alias
24754 of the @samp{step} command even though it is otherwise an ambiguous
24755 abbreviation of other commands like @samp{set} and @samp{show}.
24756
24757 Aliases are also used to provide shortened or more common versions
24758 of multi-word commands. For example, @value{GDBN} provides the
24759 @samp{tty} alias of the @samp{set inferior-tty} command.
24760
24761 You can define a new alias with the @samp{alias} command.
24762
24763 @table @code
24764
24765 @kindex alias
24766 @item alias [-a] [--] @var{ALIAS} = @var{COMMAND}
24767
24768 @end table
24769
24770 @var{ALIAS} specifies the name of the new alias.
24771 Each word of @var{ALIAS} must consist of letters, numbers, dashes and
24772 underscores.
24773
24774 @var{COMMAND} specifies the name of an existing command
24775 that is being aliased.
24776
24777 The @samp{-a} option specifies that the new alias is an abbreviation
24778 of the command. Abbreviations are not shown in command
24779 lists displayed by the @samp{help} command.
24780
24781 The @samp{--} option specifies the end of options,
24782 and is useful when @var{ALIAS} begins with a dash.
24783
24784 Here is a simple example showing how to make an abbreviation
24785 of a command so that there is less to type.
24786 Suppose you were tired of typing @samp{disas}, the current
24787 shortest unambiguous abbreviation of the @samp{disassemble} command
24788 and you wanted an even shorter version named @samp{di}.
24789 The following will accomplish this.
24790
24791 @smallexample
24792 (gdb) alias -a di = disas
24793 @end smallexample
24794
24795 Note that aliases are different from user-defined commands.
24796 With a user-defined command, you also need to write documentation
24797 for it with the @samp{document} command.
24798 An alias automatically picks up the documentation of the existing command.
24799
24800 Here is an example where we make @samp{elms} an abbreviation of
24801 @samp{elements} in the @samp{set print elements} command.
24802 This is to show that you can make an abbreviation of any part
24803 of a command.
24804
24805 @smallexample
24806 (gdb) alias -a set print elms = set print elements
24807 (gdb) alias -a show print elms = show print elements
24808 (gdb) set p elms 20
24809 (gdb) show p elms
24810 Limit on string chars or array elements to print is 200.
24811 @end smallexample
24812
24813 Note that if you are defining an alias of a @samp{set} command,
24814 and you want to have an alias for the corresponding @samp{show}
24815 command, then you need to define the latter separately.
24816
24817 Unambiguously abbreviated commands are allowed in @var{COMMAND} and
24818 @var{ALIAS}, just as they are normally.
24819
24820 @smallexample
24821 (gdb) alias -a set pr elms = set p ele
24822 @end smallexample
24823
24824 Finally, here is an example showing the creation of a one word
24825 alias for a more complex command.
24826 This creates alias @samp{spe} of the command @samp{set print elements}.
24827
24828 @smallexample
24829 (gdb) alias spe = set print elements
24830 (gdb) spe 20
24831 @end smallexample
24832
24833 @node Interpreters
24834 @chapter Command Interpreters
24835 @cindex command interpreters
24836
24837 @value{GDBN} supports multiple command interpreters, and some command
24838 infrastructure to allow users or user interface writers to switch
24839 between interpreters or run commands in other interpreters.
24840
24841 @value{GDBN} currently supports two command interpreters, the console
24842 interpreter (sometimes called the command-line interpreter or @sc{cli})
24843 and the machine interface interpreter (or @sc{gdb/mi}). This manual
24844 describes both of these interfaces in great detail.
24845
24846 By default, @value{GDBN} will start with the console interpreter.
24847 However, the user may choose to start @value{GDBN} with another
24848 interpreter by specifying the @option{-i} or @option{--interpreter}
24849 startup options. Defined interpreters include:
24850
24851 @table @code
24852 @item console
24853 @cindex console interpreter
24854 The traditional console or command-line interpreter. This is the most often
24855 used interpreter with @value{GDBN}. With no interpreter specified at runtime,
24856 @value{GDBN} will use this interpreter.
24857
24858 @item mi
24859 @cindex mi interpreter
24860 The newest @sc{gdb/mi} interface (currently @code{mi2}). Used primarily
24861 by programs wishing to use @value{GDBN} as a backend for a debugger GUI
24862 or an IDE. For more information, see @ref{GDB/MI, ,The @sc{gdb/mi}
24863 Interface}.
24864
24865 @item mi2
24866 @cindex mi2 interpreter
24867 The current @sc{gdb/mi} interface.
24868
24869 @item mi1
24870 @cindex mi1 interpreter
24871 The @sc{gdb/mi} interface included in @value{GDBN} 5.1, 5.2, and 5.3.
24872
24873 @end table
24874
24875 @cindex invoke another interpreter
24876 The interpreter being used by @value{GDBN} may not be dynamically
24877 switched at runtime. Although possible, this could lead to a very
24878 precarious situation. Consider an IDE using @sc{gdb/mi}. If a user
24879 enters the command "interpreter-set console" in a console view,
24880 @value{GDBN} would switch to using the console interpreter, rendering
24881 the IDE inoperable!
24882
24883 @kindex interpreter-exec
24884 Although you may only choose a single interpreter at startup, you may execute
24885 commands in any interpreter from the current interpreter using the appropriate
24886 command. If you are running the console interpreter, simply use the
24887 @code{interpreter-exec} command:
24888
24889 @smallexample
24890 interpreter-exec mi "-data-list-register-names"
24891 @end smallexample
24892
24893 @sc{gdb/mi} has a similar command, although it is only available in versions of
24894 @value{GDBN} which support @sc{gdb/mi} version 2 (or greater).
24895
24896 @node TUI
24897 @chapter @value{GDBN} Text User Interface
24898 @cindex TUI
24899 @cindex Text User Interface
24900
24901 @menu
24902 * TUI Overview:: TUI overview
24903 * TUI Keys:: TUI key bindings
24904 * TUI Single Key Mode:: TUI single key mode
24905 * TUI Commands:: TUI-specific commands
24906 * TUI Configuration:: TUI configuration variables
24907 @end menu
24908
24909 The @value{GDBN} Text User Interface (TUI) is a terminal
24910 interface which uses the @code{curses} library to show the source
24911 file, the assembly output, the program registers and @value{GDBN}
24912 commands in separate text windows. The TUI mode is supported only
24913 on platforms where a suitable version of the @code{curses} library
24914 is available.
24915
24916 @pindex @value{GDBTUI}
24917 The TUI mode is enabled by default when you invoke @value{GDBN} as
24918 either @samp{@value{GDBTUI}} or @samp{@value{GDBP} -tui}.
24919 You can also switch in and out of TUI mode while @value{GDBN} runs by
24920 using various TUI commands and key bindings, such as @kbd{C-x C-a}.
24921 @xref{TUI Keys, ,TUI Key Bindings}.
24922
24923 @node TUI Overview
24924 @section TUI Overview
24925
24926 In TUI mode, @value{GDBN} can display several text windows:
24927
24928 @table @emph
24929 @item command
24930 This window is the @value{GDBN} command window with the @value{GDBN}
24931 prompt and the @value{GDBN} output. The @value{GDBN} input is still
24932 managed using readline.
24933
24934 @item source
24935 The source window shows the source file of the program. The current
24936 line and active breakpoints are displayed in this window.
24937
24938 @item assembly
24939 The assembly window shows the disassembly output of the program.
24940
24941 @item register
24942 This window shows the processor registers. Registers are highlighted
24943 when their values change.
24944 @end table
24945
24946 The source and assembly windows show the current program position
24947 by highlighting the current line and marking it with a @samp{>} marker.
24948 Breakpoints are indicated with two markers. The first marker
24949 indicates the breakpoint type:
24950
24951 @table @code
24952 @item B
24953 Breakpoint which was hit at least once.
24954
24955 @item b
24956 Breakpoint which was never hit.
24957
24958 @item H
24959 Hardware breakpoint which was hit at least once.
24960
24961 @item h
24962 Hardware breakpoint which was never hit.
24963 @end table
24964
24965 The second marker indicates whether the breakpoint is enabled or not:
24966
24967 @table @code
24968 @item +
24969 Breakpoint is enabled.
24970
24971 @item -
24972 Breakpoint is disabled.
24973 @end table
24974
24975 The source, assembly and register windows are updated when the current
24976 thread changes, when the frame changes, or when the program counter
24977 changes.
24978
24979 These windows are not all visible at the same time. The command
24980 window is always visible. The others can be arranged in several
24981 layouts:
24982
24983 @itemize @bullet
24984 @item
24985 source only,
24986
24987 @item
24988 assembly only,
24989
24990 @item
24991 source and assembly,
24992
24993 @item
24994 source and registers, or
24995
24996 @item
24997 assembly and registers.
24998 @end itemize
24999
25000 A status line above the command window shows the following information:
25001
25002 @table @emph
25003 @item target
25004 Indicates the current @value{GDBN} target.
25005 (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
25006
25007 @item process
25008 Gives the current process or thread number.
25009 When no process is being debugged, this field is set to @code{No process}.
25010
25011 @item function
25012 Gives the current function name for the selected frame.
25013 The name is demangled if demangling is turned on (@pxref{Print Settings}).
25014 When there is no symbol corresponding to the current program counter,
25015 the string @code{??} is displayed.
25016
25017 @item line
25018 Indicates the current line number for the selected frame.
25019 When the current line number is not known, the string @code{??} is displayed.
25020
25021 @item pc
25022 Indicates the current program counter address.
25023 @end table
25024
25025 @node TUI Keys
25026 @section TUI Key Bindings
25027 @cindex TUI key bindings
25028
25029 The TUI installs several key bindings in the readline keymaps
25030 @ifset SYSTEM_READLINE
25031 (@pxref{Command Line Editing, , , rluserman, GNU Readline Library}).
25032 @end ifset
25033 @ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
25034 (@pxref{Command Line Editing}).
25035 @end ifclear
25036 The following key bindings are installed for both TUI mode and the
25037 @value{GDBN} standard mode.
25038
25039 @table @kbd
25040 @kindex C-x C-a
25041 @item C-x C-a
25042 @kindex C-x a
25043 @itemx C-x a
25044 @kindex C-x A
25045 @itemx C-x A
25046 Enter or leave the TUI mode. When leaving the TUI mode,
25047 the curses window management stops and @value{GDBN} operates using
25048 its standard mode, writing on the terminal directly. When reentering
25049 the TUI mode, control is given back to the curses windows.
25050 The screen is then refreshed.
25051
25052 @kindex C-x 1
25053 @item C-x 1
25054 Use a TUI layout with only one window. The layout will
25055 either be @samp{source} or @samp{assembly}. When the TUI mode
25056 is not active, it will switch to the TUI mode.
25057
25058 Think of this key binding as the Emacs @kbd{C-x 1} binding.
25059
25060 @kindex C-x 2
25061 @item C-x 2
25062 Use a TUI layout with at least two windows. When the current
25063 layout already has two windows, the next layout with two windows is used.
25064 When a new layout is chosen, one window will always be common to the
25065 previous layout and the new one.
25066
25067 Think of it as the Emacs @kbd{C-x 2} binding.
25068
25069 @kindex C-x o
25070 @item C-x o
25071 Change the active window. The TUI associates several key bindings
25072 (like scrolling and arrow keys) with the active window. This command
25073 gives the focus to the next TUI window.
25074
25075 Think of it as the Emacs @kbd{C-x o} binding.
25076
25077 @kindex C-x s
25078 @item C-x s
25079 Switch in and out of the TUI SingleKey mode that binds single
25080 keys to @value{GDBN} commands (@pxref{TUI Single Key Mode}).
25081 @end table
25082
25083 The following key bindings only work in the TUI mode:
25084
25085 @table @asis
25086 @kindex PgUp
25087 @item @key{PgUp}
25088 Scroll the active window one page up.
25089
25090 @kindex PgDn
25091 @item @key{PgDn}
25092 Scroll the active window one page down.
25093
25094 @kindex Up
25095 @item @key{Up}
25096 Scroll the active window one line up.
25097
25098 @kindex Down
25099 @item @key{Down}
25100 Scroll the active window one line down.
25101
25102 @kindex Left
25103 @item @key{Left}
25104 Scroll the active window one column left.
25105
25106 @kindex Right
25107 @item @key{Right}
25108 Scroll the active window one column right.
25109
25110 @kindex C-L
25111 @item @kbd{C-L}
25112 Refresh the screen.
25113 @end table
25114
25115 Because the arrow keys scroll the active window in the TUI mode, they
25116 are not available for their normal use by readline unless the command
25117 window has the focus. When another window is active, you must use
25118 other readline key bindings such as @kbd{C-p}, @kbd{C-n}, @kbd{C-b}
25119 and @kbd{C-f} to control the command window.
25120
25121 @node TUI Single Key Mode
25122 @section TUI Single Key Mode
25123 @cindex TUI single key mode
25124
25125 The TUI also provides a @dfn{SingleKey} mode, which binds several
25126 frequently used @value{GDBN} commands to single keys. Type @kbd{C-x s} to
25127 switch into this mode, where the following key bindings are used:
25128
25129 @table @kbd
25130 @kindex c @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
25131 @item c
25132 continue
25133
25134 @kindex d @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
25135 @item d
25136 down
25137
25138 @kindex f @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
25139 @item f
25140 finish
25141
25142 @kindex n @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
25143 @item n
25144 next
25145
25146 @kindex q @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
25147 @item q
25148 exit the SingleKey mode.
25149
25150 @kindex r @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
25151 @item r
25152 run
25153
25154 @kindex s @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
25155 @item s
25156 step
25157
25158 @kindex u @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
25159 @item u
25160 up
25161
25162 @kindex v @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
25163 @item v
25164 info locals
25165
25166 @kindex w @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
25167 @item w
25168 where
25169 @end table
25170
25171 Other keys temporarily switch to the @value{GDBN} command prompt.
25172 The key that was pressed is inserted in the editing buffer so that
25173 it is possible to type most @value{GDBN} commands without interaction
25174 with the TUI SingleKey mode. Once the command is entered the TUI
25175 SingleKey mode is restored. The only way to permanently leave
25176 this mode is by typing @kbd{q} or @kbd{C-x s}.
25177
25178
25179 @node TUI Commands
25180 @section TUI-specific Commands
25181 @cindex TUI commands
25182
25183 The TUI has specific commands to control the text windows.
25184 These commands are always available, even when @value{GDBN} is not in
25185 the TUI mode. When @value{GDBN} is in the standard mode, most
25186 of these commands will automatically switch to the TUI mode.
25187
25188 Note that if @value{GDBN}'s @code{stdout} is not connected to a
25189 terminal, or @value{GDBN} has been started with the machine interface
25190 interpreter (@pxref{GDB/MI, ,The @sc{gdb/mi} Interface}), most of
25191 these commands will fail with an error, because it would not be
25192 possible or desirable to enable curses window management.
25193
25194 @table @code
25195 @item info win
25196 @kindex info win
25197 List and give the size of all displayed windows.
25198
25199 @item layout next
25200 @kindex layout
25201 Display the next layout.
25202
25203 @item layout prev
25204 Display the previous layout.
25205
25206 @item layout src
25207 Display the source window only.
25208
25209 @item layout asm
25210 Display the assembly window only.
25211
25212 @item layout split
25213 Display the source and assembly window.
25214
25215 @item layout regs
25216 Display the register window together with the source or assembly window.
25217
25218 @item focus next
25219 @kindex focus
25220 Make the next window active for scrolling.
25221
25222 @item focus prev
25223 Make the previous window active for scrolling.
25224
25225 @item focus src
25226 Make the source window active for scrolling.
25227
25228 @item focus asm
25229 Make the assembly window active for scrolling.
25230
25231 @item focus regs
25232 Make the register window active for scrolling.
25233
25234 @item focus cmd
25235 Make the command window active for scrolling.
25236
25237 @item refresh
25238 @kindex refresh
25239 Refresh the screen. This is similar to typing @kbd{C-L}.
25240
25241 @item tui reg float
25242 @kindex tui reg
25243 Show the floating point registers in the register window.
25244
25245 @item tui reg general
25246 Show the general registers in the register window.
25247
25248 @item tui reg next
25249 Show the next register group. The list of register groups as well as
25250 their order is target specific. The predefined register groups are the
25251 following: @code{general}, @code{float}, @code{system}, @code{vector},
25252 @code{all}, @code{save}, @code{restore}.
25253
25254 @item tui reg system
25255 Show the system registers in the register window.
25256
25257 @item update
25258 @kindex update
25259 Update the source window and the current execution point.
25260
25261 @item winheight @var{name} +@var{count}
25262 @itemx winheight @var{name} -@var{count}
25263 @kindex winheight
25264 Change the height of the window @var{name} by @var{count}
25265 lines. Positive counts increase the height, while negative counts
25266 decrease it.
25267
25268 @item tabset @var{nchars}
25269 @kindex tabset
25270 Set the width of tab stops to be @var{nchars} characters.
25271 @end table
25272
25273 @node TUI Configuration
25274 @section TUI Configuration Variables
25275 @cindex TUI configuration variables
25276
25277 Several configuration variables control the appearance of TUI windows.
25278
25279 @table @code
25280 @item set tui border-kind @var{kind}
25281 @kindex set tui border-kind
25282 Select the border appearance for the source, assembly and register windows.
25283 The possible values are the following:
25284 @table @code
25285 @item space
25286 Use a space character to draw the border.
25287
25288 @item ascii
25289 Use @sc{ascii} characters @samp{+}, @samp{-} and @samp{|} to draw the border.
25290
25291 @item acs
25292 Use the Alternate Character Set to draw the border. The border is
25293 drawn using character line graphics if the terminal supports them.
25294 @end table
25295
25296 @item set tui border-mode @var{mode}
25297 @kindex set tui border-mode
25298 @itemx set tui active-border-mode @var{mode}
25299 @kindex set tui active-border-mode
25300 Select the display attributes for the borders of the inactive windows
25301 or the active window. The @var{mode} can be one of the following:
25302 @table @code
25303 @item normal
25304 Use normal attributes to display the border.
25305
25306 @item standout
25307 Use standout mode.
25308
25309 @item reverse
25310 Use reverse video mode.
25311
25312 @item half
25313 Use half bright mode.
25314
25315 @item half-standout
25316 Use half bright and standout mode.
25317
25318 @item bold
25319 Use extra bright or bold mode.
25320
25321 @item bold-standout
25322 Use extra bright or bold and standout mode.
25323 @end table
25324 @end table
25325
25326 @node Emacs
25327 @chapter Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs
25328
25329 @cindex Emacs
25330 @cindex @sc{gnu} Emacs
25331 A special interface allows you to use @sc{gnu} Emacs to view (and
25332 edit) the source files for the program you are debugging with
25333 @value{GDBN}.
25334
25335 To use this interface, use the command @kbd{M-x gdb} in Emacs. Give the
25336 executable file you want to debug as an argument. This command starts
25337 @value{GDBN} as a subprocess of Emacs, with input and output through a newly
25338 created Emacs buffer.
25339 @c (Do not use the @code{-tui} option to run @value{GDBN} from Emacs.)
25340
25341 Running @value{GDBN} under Emacs can be just like running @value{GDBN} normally except for two
25342 things:
25343
25344 @itemize @bullet
25345 @item
25346 All ``terminal'' input and output goes through an Emacs buffer, called
25347 the GUD buffer.
25348
25349 This applies both to @value{GDBN} commands and their output, and to the input
25350 and output done by the program you are debugging.
25351
25352 This is useful because it means that you can copy the text of previous
25353 commands and input them again; you can even use parts of the output
25354 in this way.
25355
25356 All the facilities of Emacs' Shell mode are available for interacting
25357 with your program. In particular, you can send signals the usual
25358 way---for example, @kbd{C-c C-c} for an interrupt, @kbd{C-c C-z} for a
25359 stop.
25360
25361 @item
25362 @value{GDBN} displays source code through Emacs.
25363
25364 Each time @value{GDBN} displays a stack frame, Emacs automatically finds the
25365 source file for that frame and puts an arrow (@samp{=>}) at the
25366 left margin of the current line. Emacs uses a separate buffer for
25367 source display, and splits the screen to show both your @value{GDBN} session
25368 and the source.
25369
25370 Explicit @value{GDBN} @code{list} or search commands still produce output as
25371 usual, but you probably have no reason to use them from Emacs.
25372 @end itemize
25373
25374 We call this @dfn{text command mode}. Emacs 22.1, and later, also uses
25375 a graphical mode, enabled by default, which provides further buffers
25376 that can control the execution and describe the state of your program.
25377 @xref{GDB Graphical Interface,,, Emacs, The @sc{gnu} Emacs Manual}.
25378
25379 If you specify an absolute file name when prompted for the @kbd{M-x
25380 gdb} argument, then Emacs sets your current working directory to where
25381 your program resides. If you only specify the file name, then Emacs
25382 sets your current working directory to the directory associated
25383 with the previous buffer. In this case, @value{GDBN} may find your
25384 program by searching your environment's @code{PATH} variable, but on
25385 some operating systems it might not find the source. So, although the
25386 @value{GDBN} input and output session proceeds normally, the auxiliary
25387 buffer does not display the current source and line of execution.
25388
25389 The initial working directory of @value{GDBN} is printed on the top
25390 line of the GUD buffer and this serves as a default for the commands
25391 that specify files for @value{GDBN} to operate on. @xref{Files,
25392 ,Commands to Specify Files}.
25393
25394 By default, @kbd{M-x gdb} calls the program called @file{gdb}. If you
25395 need to call @value{GDBN} by a different name (for example, if you
25396 keep several configurations around, with different names) you can
25397 customize the Emacs variable @code{gud-gdb-command-name} to run the
25398 one you want.
25399
25400 In the GUD buffer, you can use these special Emacs commands in
25401 addition to the standard Shell mode commands:
25402
25403 @table @kbd
25404 @item C-h m
25405 Describe the features of Emacs' GUD Mode.
25406
25407 @item C-c C-s
25408 Execute to another source line, like the @value{GDBN} @code{step} command; also
25409 update the display window to show the current file and location.
25410
25411 @item C-c C-n
25412 Execute to next source line in this function, skipping all function
25413 calls, like the @value{GDBN} @code{next} command. Then update the display window
25414 to show the current file and location.
25415
25416 @item C-c C-i
25417 Execute one instruction, like the @value{GDBN} @code{stepi} command; update
25418 display window accordingly.
25419
25420 @item C-c C-f
25421 Execute until exit from the selected stack frame, like the @value{GDBN}
25422 @code{finish} command.
25423
25424 @item C-c C-r
25425 Continue execution of your program, like the @value{GDBN} @code{continue}
25426 command.
25427
25428 @item C-c <
25429 Go up the number of frames indicated by the numeric argument
25430 (@pxref{Arguments, , Numeric Arguments, Emacs, The @sc{gnu} Emacs Manual}),
25431 like the @value{GDBN} @code{up} command.
25432
25433 @item C-c >
25434 Go down the number of frames indicated by the numeric argument, like the
25435 @value{GDBN} @code{down} command.
25436 @end table
25437
25438 In any source file, the Emacs command @kbd{C-x @key{SPC}} (@code{gud-break})
25439 tells @value{GDBN} to set a breakpoint on the source line point is on.
25440
25441 In text command mode, if you type @kbd{M-x speedbar}, Emacs displays a
25442 separate frame which shows a backtrace when the GUD buffer is current.
25443 Move point to any frame in the stack and type @key{RET} to make it
25444 become the current frame and display the associated source in the
25445 source buffer. Alternatively, click @kbd{Mouse-2} to make the
25446 selected frame become the current one. In graphical mode, the
25447 speedbar displays watch expressions.
25448
25449 If you accidentally delete the source-display buffer, an easy way to get
25450 it back is to type the command @code{f} in the @value{GDBN} buffer, to
25451 request a frame display; when you run under Emacs, this recreates
25452 the source buffer if necessary to show you the context of the current
25453 frame.
25454
25455 The source files displayed in Emacs are in ordinary Emacs buffers
25456 which are visiting the source files in the usual way. You can edit
25457 the files with these buffers if you wish; but keep in mind that @value{GDBN}
25458 communicates with Emacs in terms of line numbers. If you add or
25459 delete lines from the text, the line numbers that @value{GDBN} knows cease
25460 to correspond properly with the code.
25461
25462 A more detailed description of Emacs' interaction with @value{GDBN} is
25463 given in the Emacs manual (@pxref{Debuggers,,, Emacs, The @sc{gnu}
25464 Emacs Manual}).
25465
25466 @c The following dropped because Epoch is nonstandard. Reactivate
25467 @c if/when v19 does something similar. ---doc@cygnus.com 19dec1990
25468 @ignore
25469 @kindex Emacs Epoch environment
25470 @kindex Epoch
25471 @kindex inspect
25472
25473 Version 18 of @sc{gnu} Emacs has a built-in window system
25474 called the @code{epoch}
25475 environment. Users of this environment can use a new command,
25476 @code{inspect} which performs identically to @code{print} except that
25477 each value is printed in its own window.
25478 @end ignore
25479
25480
25481 @node GDB/MI
25482 @chapter The @sc{gdb/mi} Interface
25483
25484 @unnumberedsec Function and Purpose
25485
25486 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, its purpose
25487 @sc{gdb/mi} is a line based machine oriented text interface to
25488 @value{GDBN} and is activated by specifying using the
25489 @option{--interpreter} command line option (@pxref{Mode Options}). It
25490 is specifically intended to support the development of systems which
25491 use the debugger as just one small component of a larger system.
25492
25493 This chapter is a specification of the @sc{gdb/mi} interface. It is written
25494 in the form of a reference manual.
25495
25496 Note that @sc{gdb/mi} is still under construction, so some of the
25497 features described below are incomplete and subject to change
25498 (@pxref{GDB/MI Development and Front Ends, , @sc{gdb/mi} Development and Front Ends}).
25499
25500 @unnumberedsec Notation and Terminology
25501
25502 @cindex notational conventions, for @sc{gdb/mi}
25503 This chapter uses the following notation:
25504
25505 @itemize @bullet
25506 @item
25507 @code{|} separates two alternatives.
25508
25509 @item
25510 @code{[ @var{something} ]} indicates that @var{something} is optional:
25511 it may or may not be given.
25512
25513 @item
25514 @code{( @var{group} )*} means that @var{group} inside the parentheses
25515 may repeat zero or more times.
25516
25517 @item
25518 @code{( @var{group} )+} means that @var{group} inside the parentheses
25519 may repeat one or more times.
25520
25521 @item
25522 @code{"@var{string}"} means a literal @var{string}.
25523 @end itemize
25524
25525 @ignore
25526 @heading Dependencies
25527 @end ignore
25528
25529 @menu
25530 * GDB/MI General Design::
25531 * GDB/MI Command Syntax::
25532 * GDB/MI Compatibility with CLI::
25533 * GDB/MI Development and Front Ends::
25534 * GDB/MI Output Records::
25535 * GDB/MI Simple Examples::
25536 * GDB/MI Command Description Format::
25537 * GDB/MI Breakpoint Commands::
25538 * GDB/MI Program Context::
25539 * GDB/MI Thread Commands::
25540 * GDB/MI Ada Tasking Commands::
25541 * GDB/MI Program Execution::
25542 * GDB/MI Stack Manipulation::
25543 * GDB/MI Variable Objects::
25544 * GDB/MI Data Manipulation::
25545 * GDB/MI Tracepoint Commands::
25546 * GDB/MI Symbol Query::
25547 * GDB/MI File Commands::
25548 @ignore
25549 * GDB/MI Kod Commands::
25550 * GDB/MI Memory Overlay Commands::
25551 * GDB/MI Signal Handling Commands::
25552 @end ignore
25553 * GDB/MI Target Manipulation::
25554 * GDB/MI File Transfer Commands::
25555 * GDB/MI Miscellaneous Commands::
25556 @end menu
25557
25558 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
25559 @node GDB/MI General Design
25560 @section @sc{gdb/mi} General Design
25561 @cindex GDB/MI General Design
25562
25563 Interaction of a @sc{GDB/MI} frontend with @value{GDBN} involves three
25564 parts---commands sent to @value{GDBN}, responses to those commands
25565 and notifications. Each command results in exactly one response,
25566 indicating either successful completion of the command, or an error.
25567 For the commands that do not resume the target, the response contains the
25568 requested information. For the commands that resume the target, the
25569 response only indicates whether the target was successfully resumed.
25570 Notifications is the mechanism for reporting changes in the state of the
25571 target, or in @value{GDBN} state, that cannot conveniently be associated with
25572 a command and reported as part of that command response.
25573
25574 The important examples of notifications are:
25575 @itemize @bullet
25576
25577 @item
25578 Exec notifications. These are used to report changes in
25579 target state---when a target is resumed, or stopped. It would not
25580 be feasible to include this information in response of resuming
25581 commands, because one resume commands can result in multiple events in
25582 different threads. Also, quite some time may pass before any event
25583 happens in the target, while a frontend needs to know whether the resuming
25584 command itself was successfully executed.
25585
25586 @item
25587 Console output, and status notifications. Console output
25588 notifications are used to report output of CLI commands, as well as
25589 diagnostics for other commands. Status notifications are used to
25590 report the progress of a long-running operation. Naturally, including
25591 this information in command response would mean no output is produced
25592 until the command is finished, which is undesirable.
25593
25594 @item
25595 General notifications. Commands may have various side effects on
25596 the @value{GDBN} or target state beyond their official purpose. For example,
25597 a command may change the selected thread. Although such changes can
25598 be included in command response, using notification allows for more
25599 orthogonal frontend design.
25600
25601 @end itemize
25602
25603 There's no guarantee that whenever an MI command reports an error,
25604 @value{GDBN} or the target are in any specific state, and especially,
25605 the state is not reverted to the state before the MI command was
25606 processed. Therefore, whenever an MI command results in an error,
25607 we recommend that the frontend refreshes all the information shown in
25608 the user interface.
25609
25610
25611 @menu
25612 * Context management::
25613 * Asynchronous and non-stop modes::
25614 * Thread groups::
25615 @end menu
25616
25617 @node Context management
25618 @subsection Context management
25619
25620 In most cases when @value{GDBN} accesses the target, this access is
25621 done in context of a specific thread and frame (@pxref{Frames}).
25622 Often, even when accessing global data, the target requires that a thread
25623 be specified. The CLI interface maintains the selected thread and frame,
25624 and supplies them to target on each command. This is convenient,
25625 because a command line user would not want to specify that information
25626 explicitly on each command, and because user interacts with
25627 @value{GDBN} via a single terminal, so no confusion is possible as
25628 to what thread and frame are the current ones.
25629
25630 In the case of MI, the concept of selected thread and frame is less
25631 useful. First, a frontend can easily remember this information
25632 itself. Second, a graphical frontend can have more than one window,
25633 each one used for debugging a different thread, and the frontend might
25634 want to access additional threads for internal purposes. This
25635 increases the risk that by relying on implicitly selected thread, the
25636 frontend may be operating on a wrong one. Therefore, each MI command
25637 should explicitly specify which thread and frame to operate on. To
25638 make it possible, each MI command accepts the @samp{--thread} and
25639 @samp{--frame} options, the value to each is @value{GDBN} identifier
25640 for thread and frame to operate on.
25641
25642 Usually, each top-level window in a frontend allows the user to select
25643 a thread and a frame, and remembers the user selection for further
25644 operations. However, in some cases @value{GDBN} may suggest that the
25645 current thread be changed. For example, when stopping on a breakpoint
25646 it is reasonable to switch to the thread where breakpoint is hit. For
25647 another example, if the user issues the CLI @samp{thread} command via
25648 the frontend, it is desirable to change the frontend's selected thread to the
25649 one specified by user. @value{GDBN} communicates the suggestion to
25650 change current thread using the @samp{=thread-selected} notification.
25651 No such notification is available for the selected frame at the moment.
25652
25653 Note that historically, MI shares the selected thread with CLI, so
25654 frontends used the @code{-thread-select} to execute commands in the
25655 right context. However, getting this to work right is cumbersome. The
25656 simplest way is for frontend to emit @code{-thread-select} command
25657 before every command. This doubles the number of commands that need
25658 to be sent. The alternative approach is to suppress @code{-thread-select}
25659 if the selected thread in @value{GDBN} is supposed to be identical to the
25660 thread the frontend wants to operate on. However, getting this
25661 optimization right can be tricky. In particular, if the frontend
25662 sends several commands to @value{GDBN}, and one of the commands changes the
25663 selected thread, then the behaviour of subsequent commands will
25664 change. So, a frontend should either wait for response from such
25665 problematic commands, or explicitly add @code{-thread-select} for
25666 all subsequent commands. No frontend is known to do this exactly
25667 right, so it is suggested to just always pass the @samp{--thread} and
25668 @samp{--frame} options.
25669
25670 @node Asynchronous and non-stop modes
25671 @subsection Asynchronous command execution and non-stop mode
25672
25673 On some targets, @value{GDBN} is capable of processing MI commands
25674 even while the target is running. This is called @dfn{asynchronous
25675 command execution} (@pxref{Background Execution}). The frontend may
25676 specify a preferrence for asynchronous execution using the
25677 @code{-gdb-set target-async 1} command, which should be emitted before
25678 either running the executable or attaching to the target. After the
25679 frontend has started the executable or attached to the target, it can
25680 find if asynchronous execution is enabled using the
25681 @code{-list-target-features} command.
25682
25683 Even if @value{GDBN} can accept a command while target is running,
25684 many commands that access the target do not work when the target is
25685 running. Therefore, asynchronous command execution is most useful
25686 when combined with non-stop mode (@pxref{Non-Stop Mode}). Then,
25687 it is possible to examine the state of one thread, while other threads
25688 are running.
25689
25690 When a given thread is running, MI commands that try to access the
25691 target in the context of that thread may not work, or may work only on
25692 some targets. In particular, commands that try to operate on thread's
25693 stack will not work, on any target. Commands that read memory, or
25694 modify breakpoints, may work or not work, depending on the target. Note
25695 that even commands that operate on global state, such as @code{print},
25696 @code{set}, and breakpoint commands, still access the target in the
25697 context of a specific thread, so frontend should try to find a
25698 stopped thread and perform the operation on that thread (using the
25699 @samp{--thread} option).
25700
25701 Which commands will work in the context of a running thread is
25702 highly target dependent. However, the two commands
25703 @code{-exec-interrupt}, to stop a thread, and @code{-thread-info},
25704 to find the state of a thread, will always work.
25705
25706 @node Thread groups
25707 @subsection Thread groups
25708 @value{GDBN} may be used to debug several processes at the same time.
25709 On some platfroms, @value{GDBN} may support debugging of several
25710 hardware systems, each one having several cores with several different
25711 processes running on each core. This section describes the MI
25712 mechanism to support such debugging scenarios.
25713
25714 The key observation is that regardless of the structure of the
25715 target, MI can have a global list of threads, because most commands that
25716 accept the @samp{--thread} option do not need to know what process that
25717 thread belongs to. Therefore, it is not necessary to introduce
25718 neither additional @samp{--process} option, nor an notion of the
25719 current process in the MI interface. The only strictly new feature
25720 that is required is the ability to find how the threads are grouped
25721 into processes.
25722
25723 To allow the user to discover such grouping, and to support arbitrary
25724 hierarchy of machines/cores/processes, MI introduces the concept of a
25725 @dfn{thread group}. Thread group is a collection of threads and other
25726 thread groups. A thread group always has a string identifier, a type,
25727 and may have additional attributes specific to the type. A new
25728 command, @code{-list-thread-groups}, returns the list of top-level
25729 thread groups, which correspond to processes that @value{GDBN} is
25730 debugging at the moment. By passing an identifier of a thread group
25731 to the @code{-list-thread-groups} command, it is possible to obtain
25732 the members of specific thread group.
25733
25734 To allow the user to easily discover processes, and other objects, he
25735 wishes to debug, a concept of @dfn{available thread group} is
25736 introduced. Available thread group is an thread group that
25737 @value{GDBN} is not debugging, but that can be attached to, using the
25738 @code{-target-attach} command. The list of available top-level thread
25739 groups can be obtained using @samp{-list-thread-groups --available}.
25740 In general, the content of a thread group may be only retrieved only
25741 after attaching to that thread group.
25742
25743 Thread groups are related to inferiors (@pxref{Inferiors and
25744 Programs}). Each inferior corresponds to a thread group of a special
25745 type @samp{process}, and some additional operations are permitted on
25746 such thread groups.
25747
25748 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
25749 @node GDB/MI Command Syntax
25750 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Command Syntax
25751
25752 @menu
25753 * GDB/MI Input Syntax::
25754 * GDB/MI Output Syntax::
25755 @end menu
25756
25757 @node GDB/MI Input Syntax
25758 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Input Syntax
25759
25760 @cindex input syntax for @sc{gdb/mi}
25761 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, input syntax
25762 @table @code
25763 @item @var{command} @expansion{}
25764 @code{@var{cli-command} | @var{mi-command}}
25765
25766 @item @var{cli-command} @expansion{}
25767 @code{[ @var{token} ] @var{cli-command} @var{nl}}, where
25768 @var{cli-command} is any existing @value{GDBN} CLI command.
25769
25770 @item @var{mi-command} @expansion{}
25771 @code{[ @var{token} ] "-" @var{operation} ( " " @var{option} )*
25772 @code{[} " --" @code{]} ( " " @var{parameter} )* @var{nl}}
25773
25774 @item @var{token} @expansion{}
25775 "any sequence of digits"
25776
25777 @item @var{option} @expansion{}
25778 @code{"-" @var{parameter} [ " " @var{parameter} ]}
25779
25780 @item @var{parameter} @expansion{}
25781 @code{@var{non-blank-sequence} | @var{c-string}}
25782
25783 @item @var{operation} @expansion{}
25784 @emph{any of the operations described in this chapter}
25785
25786 @item @var{non-blank-sequence} @expansion{}
25787 @emph{anything, provided it doesn't contain special characters such as
25788 "-", @var{nl}, """ and of course " "}
25789
25790 @item @var{c-string} @expansion{}
25791 @code{""" @var{seven-bit-iso-c-string-content} """}
25792
25793 @item @var{nl} @expansion{}
25794 @code{CR | CR-LF}
25795 @end table
25796
25797 @noindent
25798 Notes:
25799
25800 @itemize @bullet
25801 @item
25802 The CLI commands are still handled by the @sc{mi} interpreter; their
25803 output is described below.
25804
25805 @item
25806 The @code{@var{token}}, when present, is passed back when the command
25807 finishes.
25808
25809 @item
25810 Some @sc{mi} commands accept optional arguments as part of the parameter
25811 list. Each option is identified by a leading @samp{-} (dash) and may be
25812 followed by an optional argument parameter. Options occur first in the
25813 parameter list and can be delimited from normal parameters using
25814 @samp{--} (this is useful when some parameters begin with a dash).
25815 @end itemize
25816
25817 Pragmatics:
25818
25819 @itemize @bullet
25820 @item
25821 We want easy access to the existing CLI syntax (for debugging).
25822
25823 @item
25824 We want it to be easy to spot a @sc{mi} operation.
25825 @end itemize
25826
25827 @node GDB/MI Output Syntax
25828 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Output Syntax
25829
25830 @cindex output syntax of @sc{gdb/mi}
25831 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, output syntax
25832 The output from @sc{gdb/mi} consists of zero or more out-of-band records
25833 followed, optionally, by a single result record. This result record
25834 is for the most recent command. The sequence of output records is
25835 terminated by @samp{(gdb)}.
25836
25837 If an input command was prefixed with a @code{@var{token}} then the
25838 corresponding output for that command will also be prefixed by that same
25839 @var{token}.
25840
25841 @table @code
25842 @item @var{output} @expansion{}
25843 @code{( @var{out-of-band-record} )* [ @var{result-record} ] "(gdb)" @var{nl}}
25844
25845 @item @var{result-record} @expansion{}
25846 @code{ [ @var{token} ] "^" @var{result-class} ( "," @var{result} )* @var{nl}}
25847
25848 @item @var{out-of-band-record} @expansion{}
25849 @code{@var{async-record} | @var{stream-record}}
25850
25851 @item @var{async-record} @expansion{}
25852 @code{@var{exec-async-output} | @var{status-async-output} | @var{notify-async-output}}
25853
25854 @item @var{exec-async-output} @expansion{}
25855 @code{[ @var{token} ] "*" @var{async-output}}
25856
25857 @item @var{status-async-output} @expansion{}
25858 @code{[ @var{token} ] "+" @var{async-output}}
25859
25860 @item @var{notify-async-output} @expansion{}
25861 @code{[ @var{token} ] "=" @var{async-output}}
25862
25863 @item @var{async-output} @expansion{}
25864 @code{@var{async-class} ( "," @var{result} )* @var{nl}}
25865
25866 @item @var{result-class} @expansion{}
25867 @code{"done" | "running" | "connected" | "error" | "exit"}
25868
25869 @item @var{async-class} @expansion{}
25870 @code{"stopped" | @var{others}} (where @var{others} will be added
25871 depending on the needs---this is still in development).
25872
25873 @item @var{result} @expansion{}
25874 @code{ @var{variable} "=" @var{value}}
25875
25876 @item @var{variable} @expansion{}
25877 @code{ @var{string} }
25878
25879 @item @var{value} @expansion{}
25880 @code{ @var{const} | @var{tuple} | @var{list} }
25881
25882 @item @var{const} @expansion{}
25883 @code{@var{c-string}}
25884
25885 @item @var{tuple} @expansion{}
25886 @code{ "@{@}" | "@{" @var{result} ( "," @var{result} )* "@}" }
25887
25888 @item @var{list} @expansion{}
25889 @code{ "[]" | "[" @var{value} ( "," @var{value} )* "]" | "["
25890 @var{result} ( "," @var{result} )* "]" }
25891
25892 @item @var{stream-record} @expansion{}
25893 @code{@var{console-stream-output} | @var{target-stream-output} | @var{log-stream-output}}
25894
25895 @item @var{console-stream-output} @expansion{}
25896 @code{"~" @var{c-string}}
25897
25898 @item @var{target-stream-output} @expansion{}
25899 @code{"@@" @var{c-string}}
25900
25901 @item @var{log-stream-output} @expansion{}
25902 @code{"&" @var{c-string}}
25903
25904 @item @var{nl} @expansion{}
25905 @code{CR | CR-LF}
25906
25907 @item @var{token} @expansion{}
25908 @emph{any sequence of digits}.
25909 @end table
25910
25911 @noindent
25912 Notes:
25913
25914 @itemize @bullet
25915 @item
25916 All output sequences end in a single line containing a period.
25917
25918 @item
25919 The @code{@var{token}} is from the corresponding request. Note that
25920 for all async output, while the token is allowed by the grammar and
25921 may be output by future versions of @value{GDBN} for select async
25922 output messages, it is generally omitted. Frontends should treat
25923 all async output as reporting general changes in the state of the
25924 target and there should be no need to associate async output to any
25925 prior command.
25926
25927 @item
25928 @cindex status output in @sc{gdb/mi}
25929 @var{status-async-output} contains on-going status information about the
25930 progress of a slow operation. It can be discarded. All status output is
25931 prefixed by @samp{+}.
25932
25933 @item
25934 @cindex async output in @sc{gdb/mi}
25935 @var{exec-async-output} contains asynchronous state change on the target
25936 (stopped, started, disappeared). All async output is prefixed by
25937 @samp{*}.
25938
25939 @item
25940 @cindex notify output in @sc{gdb/mi}
25941 @var{notify-async-output} contains supplementary information that the
25942 client should handle (e.g., a new breakpoint information). All notify
25943 output is prefixed by @samp{=}.
25944
25945 @item
25946 @cindex console output in @sc{gdb/mi}
25947 @var{console-stream-output} is output that should be displayed as is in the
25948 console. It is the textual response to a CLI command. All the console
25949 output is prefixed by @samp{~}.
25950
25951 @item
25952 @cindex target output in @sc{gdb/mi}
25953 @var{target-stream-output} is the output produced by the target program.
25954 All the target output is prefixed by @samp{@@}.
25955
25956 @item
25957 @cindex log output in @sc{gdb/mi}
25958 @var{log-stream-output} is output text coming from @value{GDBN}'s internals, for
25959 instance messages that should be displayed as part of an error log. All
25960 the log output is prefixed by @samp{&}.
25961
25962 @item
25963 @cindex list output in @sc{gdb/mi}
25964 New @sc{gdb/mi} commands should only output @var{lists} containing
25965 @var{values}.
25966
25967
25968 @end itemize
25969
25970 @xref{GDB/MI Stream Records, , @sc{gdb/mi} Stream Records}, for more
25971 details about the various output records.
25972
25973 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
25974 @node GDB/MI Compatibility with CLI
25975 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Compatibility with CLI
25976
25977 @cindex compatibility, @sc{gdb/mi} and CLI
25978 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, compatibility with CLI
25979
25980 For the developers convenience CLI commands can be entered directly,
25981 but there may be some unexpected behaviour. For example, commands
25982 that query the user will behave as if the user replied yes, breakpoint
25983 command lists are not executed and some CLI commands, such as
25984 @code{if}, @code{when} and @code{define}, prompt for further input with
25985 @samp{>}, which is not valid MI output.
25986
25987 This feature may be removed at some stage in the future and it is
25988 recommended that front ends use the @code{-interpreter-exec} command
25989 (@pxref{-interpreter-exec}).
25990
25991 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
25992 @node GDB/MI Development and Front Ends
25993 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Development and Front Ends
25994 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi} development
25995
25996 The application which takes the MI output and presents the state of the
25997 program being debugged to the user is called a @dfn{front end}.
25998
25999 Although @sc{gdb/mi} is still incomplete, it is currently being used
26000 by a variety of front ends to @value{GDBN}. This makes it difficult
26001 to introduce new functionality without breaking existing usage. This
26002 section tries to minimize the problems by describing how the protocol
26003 might change.
26004
26005 Some changes in MI need not break a carefully designed front end, and
26006 for these the MI version will remain unchanged. The following is a
26007 list of changes that may occur within one level, so front ends should
26008 parse MI output in a way that can handle them:
26009
26010 @itemize @bullet
26011 @item
26012 New MI commands may be added.
26013
26014 @item
26015 New fields may be added to the output of any MI command.
26016
26017 @item
26018 The range of values for fields with specified values, e.g.,
26019 @code{in_scope} (@pxref{-var-update}) may be extended.
26020
26021 @c The format of field's content e.g type prefix, may change so parse it
26022 @c at your own risk. Yes, in general?
26023
26024 @c The order of fields may change? Shouldn't really matter but it might
26025 @c resolve inconsistencies.
26026 @end itemize
26027
26028 If the changes are likely to break front ends, the MI version level
26029 will be increased by one. This will allow the front end to parse the
26030 output according to the MI version. Apart from mi0, new versions of
26031 @value{GDBN} will not support old versions of MI and it will be the
26032 responsibility of the front end to work with the new one.
26033
26034 @c Starting with mi3, add a new command -mi-version that prints the MI
26035 @c version?
26036
26037 The best way to avoid unexpected changes in MI that might break your front
26038 end is to make your project known to @value{GDBN} developers and
26039 follow development on @email{gdb@@sourceware.org} and
26040 @email{gdb-patches@@sourceware.org}.
26041 @cindex mailing lists
26042
26043 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
26044 @node GDB/MI Output Records
26045 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Output Records
26046
26047 @menu
26048 * GDB/MI Result Records::
26049 * GDB/MI Stream Records::
26050 * GDB/MI Async Records::
26051 * GDB/MI Frame Information::
26052 * GDB/MI Thread Information::
26053 * GDB/MI Ada Exception Information::
26054 @end menu
26055
26056 @node GDB/MI Result Records
26057 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Result Records
26058
26059 @cindex result records in @sc{gdb/mi}
26060 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, result records
26061 In addition to a number of out-of-band notifications, the response to a
26062 @sc{gdb/mi} command includes one of the following result indications:
26063
26064 @table @code
26065 @findex ^done
26066 @item "^done" [ "," @var{results} ]
26067 The synchronous operation was successful, @code{@var{results}} are the return
26068 values.
26069
26070 @item "^running"
26071 @findex ^running
26072 This result record is equivalent to @samp{^done}. Historically, it
26073 was output instead of @samp{^done} if the command has resumed the
26074 target. This behaviour is maintained for backward compatibility, but
26075 all frontends should treat @samp{^done} and @samp{^running}
26076 identically and rely on the @samp{*running} output record to determine
26077 which threads are resumed.
26078
26079 @item "^connected"
26080 @findex ^connected
26081 @value{GDBN} has connected to a remote target.
26082
26083 @item "^error" "," @var{c-string}
26084 @findex ^error
26085 The operation failed. The @code{@var{c-string}} contains the corresponding
26086 error message.
26087
26088 @item "^exit"
26089 @findex ^exit
26090 @value{GDBN} has terminated.
26091
26092 @end table
26093
26094 @node GDB/MI Stream Records
26095 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Stream Records
26096
26097 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, stream records
26098 @cindex stream records in @sc{gdb/mi}
26099 @value{GDBN} internally maintains a number of output streams: the console, the
26100 target, and the log. The output intended for each of these streams is
26101 funneled through the @sc{gdb/mi} interface using @dfn{stream records}.
26102
26103 Each stream record begins with a unique @dfn{prefix character} which
26104 identifies its stream (@pxref{GDB/MI Output Syntax, , @sc{gdb/mi} Output
26105 Syntax}). In addition to the prefix, each stream record contains a
26106 @code{@var{string-output}}. This is either raw text (with an implicit new
26107 line) or a quoted C string (which does not contain an implicit newline).
26108
26109 @table @code
26110 @item "~" @var{string-output}
26111 The console output stream contains text that should be displayed in the
26112 CLI console window. It contains the textual responses to CLI commands.
26113
26114 @item "@@" @var{string-output}
26115 The target output stream contains any textual output from the running
26116 target. This is only present when GDB's event loop is truly
26117 asynchronous, which is currently only the case for remote targets.
26118
26119 @item "&" @var{string-output}
26120 The log stream contains debugging messages being produced by @value{GDBN}'s
26121 internals.
26122 @end table
26123
26124 @node GDB/MI Async Records
26125 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Async Records
26126
26127 @cindex async records in @sc{gdb/mi}
26128 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, async records
26129 @dfn{Async} records are used to notify the @sc{gdb/mi} client of
26130 additional changes that have occurred. Those changes can either be a
26131 consequence of @sc{gdb/mi} commands (e.g., a breakpoint modified) or a result of
26132 target activity (e.g., target stopped).
26133
26134 The following is the list of possible async records:
26135
26136 @table @code
26137
26138 @item *running,thread-id="@var{thread}"
26139 The target is now running. The @var{thread} field tells which
26140 specific thread is now running, and can be @samp{all} if all threads
26141 are running. The frontend should assume that no interaction with a
26142 running thread is possible after this notification is produced.
26143 The frontend should not assume that this notification is output
26144 only once for any command. @value{GDBN} may emit this notification
26145 several times, either for different threads, because it cannot resume
26146 all threads together, or even for a single thread, if the thread must
26147 be stepped though some code before letting it run freely.
26148
26149 @item *stopped,reason="@var{reason}",thread-id="@var{id}",stopped-threads="@var{stopped}",core="@var{core}"
26150 The target has stopped. The @var{reason} field can have one of the
26151 following values:
26152
26153 @table @code
26154 @item breakpoint-hit
26155 A breakpoint was reached.
26156 @item watchpoint-trigger
26157 A watchpoint was triggered.
26158 @item read-watchpoint-trigger
26159 A read watchpoint was triggered.
26160 @item access-watchpoint-trigger
26161 An access watchpoint was triggered.
26162 @item function-finished
26163 An -exec-finish or similar CLI command was accomplished.
26164 @item location-reached
26165 An -exec-until or similar CLI command was accomplished.
26166 @item watchpoint-scope
26167 A watchpoint has gone out of scope.
26168 @item end-stepping-range
26169 An -exec-next, -exec-next-instruction, -exec-step, -exec-step-instruction or
26170 similar CLI command was accomplished.
26171 @item exited-signalled
26172 The inferior exited because of a signal.
26173 @item exited
26174 The inferior exited.
26175 @item exited-normally
26176 The inferior exited normally.
26177 @item signal-received
26178 A signal was received by the inferior.
26179 @item solib-event
26180 The inferior has stopped due to a library being loaded or unloaded.
26181 This can only happen when @code{stop-on-solib-events} (@pxref{Files})
26182 is set.
26183 @item fork
26184 The inferior has forked. This is reported when @code{catch fork}
26185 (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}) has been used.
26186 @item vfork
26187 The inferior has vforked. This is reported in when @code{catch vfork}
26188 (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}) has been used.
26189 @item syscall-entry
26190 The inferior entered a system call. This is reported when @code{catch
26191 syscall} (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}) has been used.
26192 @item syscall-entry
26193 The inferior returned from a system call. This is reported when
26194 @code{catch syscall} (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}) has been used.
26195 @item exec
26196 The inferior called @code{exec}. This is reported when @code{catch exec}
26197 (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}) has been used.
26198 @end table
26199
26200 The @var{id} field identifies the thread that directly caused the stop
26201 -- for example by hitting a breakpoint. Depending on whether all-stop
26202 mode is in effect (@pxref{All-Stop Mode}), @value{GDBN} may either
26203 stop all threads, or only the thread that directly triggered the stop.
26204 If all threads are stopped, the @var{stopped} field will have the
26205 value of @code{"all"}. Otherwise, the value of the @var{stopped}
26206 field will be a list of thread identifiers. Presently, this list will
26207 always include a single thread, but frontend should be prepared to see
26208 several threads in the list. The @var{core} field reports the
26209 processor core on which the stop event has happened. This field may be absent
26210 if such information is not available.
26211
26212 @item =thread-group-added,id="@var{id}"
26213 @itemx =thread-group-removed,id="@var{id}"
26214 A thread group was either added or removed. The @var{id} field
26215 contains the @value{GDBN} identifier of the thread group. When a thread
26216 group is added, it generally might not be associated with a running
26217 process. When a thread group is removed, its id becomes invalid and
26218 cannot be used in any way.
26219
26220 @item =thread-group-started,id="@var{id}",pid="@var{pid}"
26221 A thread group became associated with a running program,
26222 either because the program was just started or the thread group
26223 was attached to a program. The @var{id} field contains the
26224 @value{GDBN} identifier of the thread group. The @var{pid} field
26225 contains process identifier, specific to the operating system.
26226
26227 @item =thread-group-exited,id="@var{id}"[,exit-code="@var{code}"]
26228 A thread group is no longer associated with a running program,
26229 either because the program has exited, or because it was detached
26230 from. The @var{id} field contains the @value{GDBN} identifier of the
26231 thread group. @var{code} is the exit code of the inferior; it exists
26232 only when the inferior exited with some code.
26233
26234 @item =thread-created,id="@var{id}",group-id="@var{gid}"
26235 @itemx =thread-exited,id="@var{id}",group-id="@var{gid}"
26236 A thread either was created, or has exited. The @var{id} field
26237 contains the @value{GDBN} identifier of the thread. The @var{gid}
26238 field identifies the thread group this thread belongs to.
26239
26240 @item =thread-selected,id="@var{id}"
26241 Informs that the selected thread was changed as result of the last
26242 command. This notification is not emitted as result of @code{-thread-select}
26243 command but is emitted whenever an MI command that is not documented
26244 to change the selected thread actually changes it. In particular,
26245 invoking, directly or indirectly (via user-defined command), the CLI
26246 @code{thread} command, will generate this notification.
26247
26248 We suggest that in response to this notification, front ends
26249 highlight the selected thread and cause subsequent commands to apply to
26250 that thread.
26251
26252 @item =library-loaded,...
26253 Reports that a new library file was loaded by the program. This
26254 notification has 4 fields---@var{id}, @var{target-name},
26255 @var{host-name}, and @var{symbols-loaded}. The @var{id} field is an
26256 opaque identifier of the library. For remote debugging case,
26257 @var{target-name} and @var{host-name} fields give the name of the
26258 library file on the target, and on the host respectively. For native
26259 debugging, both those fields have the same value. The
26260 @var{symbols-loaded} field is emitted only for backward compatibility
26261 and should not be relied on to convey any useful information. The
26262 @var{thread-group} field, if present, specifies the id of the thread
26263 group in whose context the library was loaded. If the field is
26264 absent, it means the library was loaded in the context of all present
26265 thread groups.
26266
26267 @item =library-unloaded,...
26268 Reports that a library was unloaded by the program. This notification
26269 has 3 fields---@var{id}, @var{target-name} and @var{host-name} with
26270 the same meaning as for the @code{=library-loaded} notification.
26271 The @var{thread-group} field, if present, specifies the id of the
26272 thread group in whose context the library was unloaded. If the field is
26273 absent, it means the library was unloaded in the context of all present
26274 thread groups.
26275
26276 @item =breakpoint-created,bkpt=@{...@}
26277 @itemx =breakpoint-modified,bkpt=@{...@}
26278 @itemx =breakpoint-deleted,bkpt=@{...@}
26279 Reports that a breakpoint was created, modified, or deleted,
26280 respectively. Only user-visible breakpoints are reported to the MI
26281 user.
26282
26283 The @var{bkpt} argument is of the same form as returned by the various
26284 breakpoint commands; @xref{GDB/MI Breakpoint Commands}.
26285
26286 Note that if a breakpoint is emitted in the result record of a
26287 command, then it will not also be emitted in an async record.
26288
26289 @end table
26290
26291 @node GDB/MI Frame Information
26292 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Frame Information
26293
26294 Response from many MI commands includes an information about stack
26295 frame. This information is a tuple that may have the following
26296 fields:
26297
26298 @table @code
26299 @item level
26300 The level of the stack frame. The innermost frame has the level of
26301 zero. This field is always present.
26302
26303 @item func
26304 The name of the function corresponding to the frame. This field may
26305 be absent if @value{GDBN} is unable to determine the function name.
26306
26307 @item addr
26308 The code address for the frame. This field is always present.
26309
26310 @item file
26311 The name of the source files that correspond to the frame's code
26312 address. This field may be absent.
26313
26314 @item line
26315 The source line corresponding to the frames' code address. This field
26316 may be absent.
26317
26318 @item from
26319 The name of the binary file (either executable or shared library) the
26320 corresponds to the frame's code address. This field may be absent.
26321
26322 @end table
26323
26324 @node GDB/MI Thread Information
26325 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Thread Information
26326
26327 Whenever @value{GDBN} has to report an information about a thread, it
26328 uses a tuple with the following fields:
26329
26330 @table @code
26331 @item id
26332 The numeric id assigned to the thread by @value{GDBN}. This field is
26333 always present.
26334
26335 @item target-id
26336 Target-specific string identifying the thread. This field is always present.
26337
26338 @item details
26339 Additional information about the thread provided by the target.
26340 It is supposed to be human-readable and not interpreted by the
26341 frontend. This field is optional.
26342
26343 @item state
26344 Either @samp{stopped} or @samp{running}, depending on whether the
26345 thread is presently running. This field is always present.
26346
26347 @item core
26348 The value of this field is an integer number of the processor core the
26349 thread was last seen on. This field is optional.
26350 @end table
26351
26352 @node GDB/MI Ada Exception Information
26353 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Ada Exception Information
26354
26355 Whenever a @code{*stopped} record is emitted because the program
26356 stopped after hitting an exception catchpoint (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}),
26357 @value{GDBN} provides the name of the exception that was raised via
26358 the @code{exception-name} field.
26359
26360 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
26361 @node GDB/MI Simple Examples
26362 @section Simple Examples of @sc{gdb/mi} Interaction
26363 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, simple examples
26364
26365 This subsection presents several simple examples of interaction using
26366 the @sc{gdb/mi} interface. In these examples, @samp{->} means that the
26367 following line is passed to @sc{gdb/mi} as input, while @samp{<-} means
26368 the output received from @sc{gdb/mi}.
26369
26370 Note the line breaks shown in the examples are here only for
26371 readability, they don't appear in the real output.
26372
26373 @subheading Setting a Breakpoint
26374
26375 Setting a breakpoint generates synchronous output which contains detailed
26376 information of the breakpoint.
26377
26378 @smallexample
26379 -> -break-insert main
26380 <- ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
26381 enabled="y",addr="0x08048564",func="main",file="myprog.c",
26382 fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="68",times="0"@}
26383 <- (gdb)
26384 @end smallexample
26385
26386 @subheading Program Execution
26387
26388 Program execution generates asynchronous records and MI gives the
26389 reason that execution stopped.
26390
26391 @smallexample
26392 -> -exec-run
26393 <- ^running
26394 <- (gdb)
26395 <- *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",thread-id="0",
26396 frame=@{addr="0x08048564",func="main",
26397 args=[@{name="argc",value="1"@},@{name="argv",value="0xbfc4d4d4"@}],
26398 file="myprog.c",fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="68"@}
26399 <- (gdb)
26400 -> -exec-continue
26401 <- ^running
26402 <- (gdb)
26403 <- *stopped,reason="exited-normally"
26404 <- (gdb)
26405 @end smallexample
26406
26407 @subheading Quitting @value{GDBN}
26408
26409 Quitting @value{GDBN} just prints the result class @samp{^exit}.
26410
26411 @smallexample
26412 -> (gdb)
26413 <- -gdb-exit
26414 <- ^exit
26415 @end smallexample
26416
26417 Please note that @samp{^exit} is printed immediately, but it might
26418 take some time for @value{GDBN} to actually exit. During that time, @value{GDBN}
26419 performs necessary cleanups, including killing programs being debugged
26420 or disconnecting from debug hardware, so the frontend should wait till
26421 @value{GDBN} exits and should only forcibly kill @value{GDBN} if it
26422 fails to exit in reasonable time.
26423
26424 @subheading A Bad Command
26425
26426 Here's what happens if you pass a non-existent command:
26427
26428 @smallexample
26429 -> -rubbish
26430 <- ^error,msg="Undefined MI command: rubbish"
26431 <- (gdb)
26432 @end smallexample
26433
26434
26435 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
26436 @node GDB/MI Command Description Format
26437 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Command Description Format
26438
26439 The remaining sections describe blocks of commands. Each block of
26440 commands is laid out in a fashion similar to this section.
26441
26442 @subheading Motivation
26443
26444 The motivation for this collection of commands.
26445
26446 @subheading Introduction
26447
26448 A brief introduction to this collection of commands as a whole.
26449
26450 @subheading Commands
26451
26452 For each command in the block, the following is described:
26453
26454 @subsubheading Synopsis
26455
26456 @smallexample
26457 -command @var{args}@dots{}
26458 @end smallexample
26459
26460 @subsubheading Result
26461
26462 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26463
26464 The corresponding @value{GDBN} CLI command(s), if any.
26465
26466 @subsubheading Example
26467
26468 Example(s) formatted for readability. Some of the described commands have
26469 not been implemented yet and these are labeled N.A.@: (not available).
26470
26471
26472 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
26473 @node GDB/MI Breakpoint Commands
26474 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Breakpoint Commands
26475
26476 @cindex breakpoint commands for @sc{gdb/mi}
26477 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, breakpoint commands
26478 This section documents @sc{gdb/mi} commands for manipulating
26479 breakpoints.
26480
26481 @subheading The @code{-break-after} Command
26482 @findex -break-after
26483
26484 @subsubheading Synopsis
26485
26486 @smallexample
26487 -break-after @var{number} @var{count}
26488 @end smallexample
26489
26490 The breakpoint number @var{number} is not in effect until it has been
26491 hit @var{count} times. To see how this is reflected in the output of
26492 the @samp{-break-list} command, see the description of the
26493 @samp{-break-list} command below.
26494
26495 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26496
26497 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{ignore}.
26498
26499 @subsubheading Example
26500
26501 @smallexample
26502 (gdb)
26503 -break-insert main
26504 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
26505 enabled="y",addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",
26506 fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",line="5",times="0"@}
26507 (gdb)
26508 -break-after 1 3
26509 ~
26510 ^done
26511 (gdb)
26512 -break-list
26513 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
26514 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
26515 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
26516 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
26517 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
26518 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
26519 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
26520 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
26521 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
26522 line="5",times="0",ignore="3"@}]@}
26523 (gdb)
26524 @end smallexample
26525
26526 @ignore
26527 @subheading The @code{-break-catch} Command
26528 @findex -break-catch
26529 @end ignore
26530
26531 @subheading The @code{-break-commands} Command
26532 @findex -break-commands
26533
26534 @subsubheading Synopsis
26535
26536 @smallexample
26537 -break-commands @var{number} [ @var{command1} ... @var{commandN} ]
26538 @end smallexample
26539
26540 Specifies the CLI commands that should be executed when breakpoint
26541 @var{number} is hit. The parameters @var{command1} to @var{commandN}
26542 are the commands. If no command is specified, any previously-set
26543 commands are cleared. @xref{Break Commands}. Typical use of this
26544 functionality is tracing a program, that is, printing of values of
26545 some variables whenever breakpoint is hit and then continuing.
26546
26547 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26548
26549 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{commands}.
26550
26551 @subsubheading Example
26552
26553 @smallexample
26554 (gdb)
26555 -break-insert main
26556 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
26557 enabled="y",addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",
26558 fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",line="5",times="0"@}
26559 (gdb)
26560 -break-commands 1 "print v" "continue"
26561 ^done
26562 (gdb)
26563 @end smallexample
26564
26565 @subheading The @code{-break-condition} Command
26566 @findex -break-condition
26567
26568 @subsubheading Synopsis
26569
26570 @smallexample
26571 -break-condition @var{number} @var{expr}
26572 @end smallexample
26573
26574 Breakpoint @var{number} will stop the program only if the condition in
26575 @var{expr} is true. The condition becomes part of the
26576 @samp{-break-list} output (see the description of the @samp{-break-list}
26577 command below).
26578
26579 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26580
26581 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{condition}.
26582
26583 @subsubheading Example
26584
26585 @smallexample
26586 (gdb)
26587 -break-condition 1 1
26588 ^done
26589 (gdb)
26590 -break-list
26591 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
26592 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
26593 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
26594 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
26595 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
26596 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
26597 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
26598 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
26599 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
26600 line="5",cond="1",times="0",ignore="3"@}]@}
26601 (gdb)
26602 @end smallexample
26603
26604 @subheading The @code{-break-delete} Command
26605 @findex -break-delete
26606
26607 @subsubheading Synopsis
26608
26609 @smallexample
26610 -break-delete ( @var{breakpoint} )+
26611 @end smallexample
26612
26613 Delete the breakpoint(s) whose number(s) are specified in the argument
26614 list. This is obviously reflected in the breakpoint list.
26615
26616 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26617
26618 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{delete}.
26619
26620 @subsubheading Example
26621
26622 @smallexample
26623 (gdb)
26624 -break-delete 1
26625 ^done
26626 (gdb)
26627 -break-list
26628 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="0",nr_cols="6",
26629 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
26630 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
26631 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
26632 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
26633 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
26634 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
26635 body=[]@}
26636 (gdb)
26637 @end smallexample
26638
26639 @subheading The @code{-break-disable} Command
26640 @findex -break-disable
26641
26642 @subsubheading Synopsis
26643
26644 @smallexample
26645 -break-disable ( @var{breakpoint} )+
26646 @end smallexample
26647
26648 Disable the named @var{breakpoint}(s). The field @samp{enabled} in the
26649 break list is now set to @samp{n} for the named @var{breakpoint}(s).
26650
26651 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26652
26653 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{disable}.
26654
26655 @subsubheading Example
26656
26657 @smallexample
26658 (gdb)
26659 -break-disable 2
26660 ^done
26661 (gdb)
26662 -break-list
26663 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
26664 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
26665 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
26666 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
26667 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
26668 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
26669 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
26670 body=[bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="n",
26671 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
26672 line="5",times="0"@}]@}
26673 (gdb)
26674 @end smallexample
26675
26676 @subheading The @code{-break-enable} Command
26677 @findex -break-enable
26678
26679 @subsubheading Synopsis
26680
26681 @smallexample
26682 -break-enable ( @var{breakpoint} )+
26683 @end smallexample
26684
26685 Enable (previously disabled) @var{breakpoint}(s).
26686
26687 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26688
26689 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{enable}.
26690
26691 @subsubheading Example
26692
26693 @smallexample
26694 (gdb)
26695 -break-enable 2
26696 ^done
26697 (gdb)
26698 -break-list
26699 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
26700 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
26701 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
26702 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
26703 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
26704 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
26705 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
26706 body=[bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
26707 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
26708 line="5",times="0"@}]@}
26709 (gdb)
26710 @end smallexample
26711
26712 @subheading The @code{-break-info} Command
26713 @findex -break-info
26714
26715 @subsubheading Synopsis
26716
26717 @smallexample
26718 -break-info @var{breakpoint}
26719 @end smallexample
26720
26721 @c REDUNDANT???
26722 Get information about a single breakpoint.
26723
26724 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26725
26726 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info break @var{breakpoint}}.
26727
26728 @subsubheading Example
26729 N.A.
26730
26731 @subheading The @code{-break-insert} Command
26732 @findex -break-insert
26733
26734 @subsubheading Synopsis
26735
26736 @smallexample
26737 -break-insert [ -t ] [ -h ] [ -f ] [ -d ] [ -a ]
26738 [ -c @var{condition} ] [ -i @var{ignore-count} ]
26739 [ -p @var{thread} ] [ @var{location} ]
26740 @end smallexample
26741
26742 @noindent
26743 If specified, @var{location}, can be one of:
26744
26745 @itemize @bullet
26746 @item function
26747 @c @item +offset
26748 @c @item -offset
26749 @c @item linenum
26750 @item filename:linenum
26751 @item filename:function
26752 @item *address
26753 @end itemize
26754
26755 The possible optional parameters of this command are:
26756
26757 @table @samp
26758 @item -t
26759 Insert a temporary breakpoint.
26760 @item -h
26761 Insert a hardware breakpoint.
26762 @item -c @var{condition}
26763 Make the breakpoint conditional on @var{condition}.
26764 @item -i @var{ignore-count}
26765 Initialize the @var{ignore-count}.
26766 @item -f
26767 If @var{location} cannot be parsed (for example if it
26768 refers to unknown files or functions), create a pending
26769 breakpoint. Without this flag, @value{GDBN} will report
26770 an error, and won't create a breakpoint, if @var{location}
26771 cannot be parsed.
26772 @item -d
26773 Create a disabled breakpoint.
26774 @item -a
26775 Create a tracepoint. @xref{Tracepoints}. When this parameter
26776 is used together with @samp{-h}, a fast tracepoint is created.
26777 @end table
26778
26779 @subsubheading Result
26780
26781 The result is in the form:
26782
26783 @smallexample
26784 ^done,bkpt=@{number="@var{number}",type="@var{type}",disp="del"|"keep",
26785 enabled="y"|"n",addr="@var{hex}",func="@var{funcname}",file="@var{filename}",
26786 fullname="@var{full_filename}",line="@var{lineno}",[thread="@var{threadno},]
26787 times="@var{times}"@}
26788 @end smallexample
26789
26790 @noindent
26791 where @var{number} is the @value{GDBN} number for this breakpoint,
26792 @var{funcname} is the name of the function where the breakpoint was
26793 inserted, @var{filename} is the name of the source file which contains
26794 this function, @var{lineno} is the source line number within that file
26795 and @var{times} the number of times that the breakpoint has been hit
26796 (always 0 for -break-insert but may be greater for -break-info or -break-list
26797 which use the same output).
26798
26799 Note: this format is open to change.
26800 @c An out-of-band breakpoint instead of part of the result?
26801
26802 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26803
26804 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{break}, @samp{tbreak},
26805 @samp{hbreak}, @samp{thbreak}, and @samp{rbreak}.
26806
26807 @subsubheading Example
26808
26809 @smallexample
26810 (gdb)
26811 -break-insert main
26812 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",addr="0x0001072c",file="recursive2.c",
26813 fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c,line="4",times="0"@}
26814 (gdb)
26815 -break-insert -t foo
26816 ^done,bkpt=@{number="2",addr="0x00010774",file="recursive2.c",
26817 fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c,line="11",times="0"@}
26818 (gdb)
26819 -break-list
26820 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
26821 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
26822 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
26823 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
26824 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
26825 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
26826 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
26827 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
26828 addr="0x0001072c", func="main",file="recursive2.c",
26829 fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c,"line="4",times="0"@},
26830 bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="del",enabled="y",
26831 addr="0x00010774",func="foo",file="recursive2.c",
26832 fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c",line="11",times="0"@}]@}
26833 (gdb)
26834 -break-insert -r foo.*
26835 ~int foo(int, int);
26836 ^done,bkpt=@{number="3",addr="0x00010774",file="recursive2.c,
26837 "fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c",line="11",times="0"@}
26838 (gdb)
26839 @end smallexample
26840
26841 @subheading The @code{-break-list} Command
26842 @findex -break-list
26843
26844 @subsubheading Synopsis
26845
26846 @smallexample
26847 -break-list
26848 @end smallexample
26849
26850 Displays the list of inserted breakpoints, showing the following fields:
26851
26852 @table @samp
26853 @item Number
26854 number of the breakpoint
26855 @item Type
26856 type of the breakpoint: @samp{breakpoint} or @samp{watchpoint}
26857 @item Disposition
26858 should the breakpoint be deleted or disabled when it is hit: @samp{keep}
26859 or @samp{nokeep}
26860 @item Enabled
26861 is the breakpoint enabled or no: @samp{y} or @samp{n}
26862 @item Address
26863 memory location at which the breakpoint is set
26864 @item What
26865 logical location of the breakpoint, expressed by function name, file
26866 name, line number
26867 @item Times
26868 number of times the breakpoint has been hit
26869 @end table
26870
26871 If there are no breakpoints or watchpoints, the @code{BreakpointTable}
26872 @code{body} field is an empty list.
26873
26874 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26875
26876 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info break}.
26877
26878 @subsubheading Example
26879
26880 @smallexample
26881 (gdb)
26882 -break-list
26883 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
26884 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
26885 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
26886 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
26887 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
26888 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
26889 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
26890 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
26891 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",line="5",times="0"@},
26892 bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
26893 addr="0x00010114",func="foo",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
26894 line="13",times="0"@}]@}
26895 (gdb)
26896 @end smallexample
26897
26898 Here's an example of the result when there are no breakpoints:
26899
26900 @smallexample
26901 (gdb)
26902 -break-list
26903 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="0",nr_cols="6",
26904 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
26905 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
26906 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
26907 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
26908 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
26909 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
26910 body=[]@}
26911 (gdb)
26912 @end smallexample
26913
26914 @subheading The @code{-break-passcount} Command
26915 @findex -break-passcount
26916
26917 @subsubheading Synopsis
26918
26919 @smallexample
26920 -break-passcount @var{tracepoint-number} @var{passcount}
26921 @end smallexample
26922
26923 Set the passcount for tracepoint @var{tracepoint-number} to
26924 @var{passcount}. If the breakpoint referred to by @var{tracepoint-number}
26925 is not a tracepoint, error is emitted. This corresponds to CLI
26926 command @samp{passcount}.
26927
26928 @subheading The @code{-break-watch} Command
26929 @findex -break-watch
26930
26931 @subsubheading Synopsis
26932
26933 @smallexample
26934 -break-watch [ -a | -r ]
26935 @end smallexample
26936
26937 Create a watchpoint. With the @samp{-a} option it will create an
26938 @dfn{access} watchpoint, i.e., a watchpoint that triggers either on a
26939 read from or on a write to the memory location. With the @samp{-r}
26940 option, the watchpoint created is a @dfn{read} watchpoint, i.e., it will
26941 trigger only when the memory location is accessed for reading. Without
26942 either of the options, the watchpoint created is a regular watchpoint,
26943 i.e., it will trigger when the memory location is accessed for writing.
26944 @xref{Set Watchpoints, , Setting Watchpoints}.
26945
26946 Note that @samp{-break-list} will report a single list of watchpoints and
26947 breakpoints inserted.
26948
26949 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26950
26951 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{watch}, @samp{awatch}, and
26952 @samp{rwatch}.
26953
26954 @subsubheading Example
26955
26956 Setting a watchpoint on a variable in the @code{main} function:
26957
26958 @smallexample
26959 (gdb)
26960 -break-watch x
26961 ^done,wpt=@{number="2",exp="x"@}
26962 (gdb)
26963 -exec-continue
26964 ^running
26965 (gdb)
26966 *stopped,reason="watchpoint-trigger",wpt=@{number="2",exp="x"@},
26967 value=@{old="-268439212",new="55"@},
26968 frame=@{func="main",args=[],file="recursive2.c",
26969 fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="5"@}
26970 (gdb)
26971 @end smallexample
26972
26973 Setting a watchpoint on a variable local to a function. @value{GDBN} will stop
26974 the program execution twice: first for the variable changing value, then
26975 for the watchpoint going out of scope.
26976
26977 @smallexample
26978 (gdb)
26979 -break-watch C
26980 ^done,wpt=@{number="5",exp="C"@}
26981 (gdb)
26982 -exec-continue
26983 ^running
26984 (gdb)
26985 *stopped,reason="watchpoint-trigger",
26986 wpt=@{number="5",exp="C"@},value=@{old="-276895068",new="3"@},
26987 frame=@{func="callee4",args=[],
26988 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
26989 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="13"@}
26990 (gdb)
26991 -exec-continue
26992 ^running
26993 (gdb)
26994 *stopped,reason="watchpoint-scope",wpnum="5",
26995 frame=@{func="callee3",args=[@{name="strarg",
26996 value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}],
26997 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
26998 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="18"@}
26999 (gdb)
27000 @end smallexample
27001
27002 Listing breakpoints and watchpoints, at different points in the program
27003 execution. Note that once the watchpoint goes out of scope, it is
27004 deleted.
27005
27006 @smallexample
27007 (gdb)
27008 -break-watch C
27009 ^done,wpt=@{number="2",exp="C"@}
27010 (gdb)
27011 -break-list
27012 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
27013 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
27014 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
27015 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
27016 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
27017 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
27018 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
27019 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
27020 addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
27021 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
27022 fullname="/home/foo/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c"line="8",times="1"@},
27023 bkpt=@{number="2",type="watchpoint",disp="keep",
27024 enabled="y",addr="",what="C",times="0"@}]@}
27025 (gdb)
27026 -exec-continue
27027 ^running
27028 (gdb)
27029 *stopped,reason="watchpoint-trigger",wpt=@{number="2",exp="C"@},
27030 value=@{old="-276895068",new="3"@},
27031 frame=@{func="callee4",args=[],
27032 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
27033 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="13"@}
27034 (gdb)
27035 -break-list
27036 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
27037 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
27038 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
27039 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
27040 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
27041 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
27042 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
27043 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
27044 addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
27045 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
27046 fullname="/home/foo/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8",times="1"@},
27047 bkpt=@{number="2",type="watchpoint",disp="keep",
27048 enabled="y",addr="",what="C",times="-5"@}]@}
27049 (gdb)
27050 -exec-continue
27051 ^running
27052 ^done,reason="watchpoint-scope",wpnum="2",
27053 frame=@{func="callee3",args=[@{name="strarg",
27054 value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}],
27055 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
27056 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="18"@}
27057 (gdb)
27058 -break-list
27059 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
27060 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
27061 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
27062 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
27063 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
27064 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
27065 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
27066 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
27067 addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
27068 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
27069 fullname="/home/foo/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8",
27070 times="1"@}]@}
27071 (gdb)
27072 @end smallexample
27073
27074 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
27075 @node GDB/MI Program Context
27076 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Program Context
27077
27078 @subheading The @code{-exec-arguments} Command
27079 @findex -exec-arguments
27080
27081
27082 @subsubheading Synopsis
27083
27084 @smallexample
27085 -exec-arguments @var{args}
27086 @end smallexample
27087
27088 Set the inferior program arguments, to be used in the next
27089 @samp{-exec-run}.
27090
27091 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27092
27093 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{set args}.
27094
27095 @subsubheading Example
27096
27097 @smallexample
27098 (gdb)
27099 -exec-arguments -v word
27100 ^done
27101 (gdb)
27102 @end smallexample
27103
27104
27105 @ignore
27106 @subheading The @code{-exec-show-arguments} Command
27107 @findex -exec-show-arguments
27108
27109 @subsubheading Synopsis
27110
27111 @smallexample
27112 -exec-show-arguments
27113 @end smallexample
27114
27115 Print the arguments of the program.
27116
27117 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27118
27119 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{show args}.
27120
27121 @subsubheading Example
27122 N.A.
27123 @end ignore
27124
27125
27126 @subheading The @code{-environment-cd} Command
27127 @findex -environment-cd
27128
27129 @subsubheading Synopsis
27130
27131 @smallexample
27132 -environment-cd @var{pathdir}
27133 @end smallexample
27134
27135 Set @value{GDBN}'s working directory.
27136
27137 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27138
27139 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{cd}.
27140
27141 @subsubheading Example
27142
27143 @smallexample
27144 (gdb)
27145 -environment-cd /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb
27146 ^done
27147 (gdb)
27148 @end smallexample
27149
27150
27151 @subheading The @code{-environment-directory} Command
27152 @findex -environment-directory
27153
27154 @subsubheading Synopsis
27155
27156 @smallexample
27157 -environment-directory [ -r ] [ @var{pathdir} ]+
27158 @end smallexample
27159
27160 Add directories @var{pathdir} to beginning of search path for source files.
27161 If the @samp{-r} option is used, the search path is reset to the default
27162 search path. If directories @var{pathdir} are supplied in addition to the
27163 @samp{-r} option, the search path is first reset and then addition
27164 occurs as normal.
27165 Multiple directories may be specified, separated by blanks. Specifying
27166 multiple directories in a single command
27167 results in the directories added to the beginning of the
27168 search path in the same order they were presented in the command.
27169 If blanks are needed as
27170 part of a directory name, double-quotes should be used around
27171 the name. In the command output, the path will show up separated
27172 by the system directory-separator character. The directory-separator
27173 character must not be used
27174 in any directory name.
27175 If no directories are specified, the current search path is displayed.
27176
27177 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27178
27179 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{dir}.
27180
27181 @subsubheading Example
27182
27183 @smallexample
27184 (gdb)
27185 -environment-directory /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb
27186 ^done,source-path="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb:$cdir:$cwd"
27187 (gdb)
27188 -environment-directory ""
27189 ^done,source-path="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb:$cdir:$cwd"
27190 (gdb)
27191 -environment-directory -r /home/jjohnstn/src/gdb /usr/src
27192 ^done,source-path="/home/jjohnstn/src/gdb:/usr/src:$cdir:$cwd"
27193 (gdb)
27194 -environment-directory -r
27195 ^done,source-path="$cdir:$cwd"
27196 (gdb)
27197 @end smallexample
27198
27199
27200 @subheading The @code{-environment-path} Command
27201 @findex -environment-path
27202
27203 @subsubheading Synopsis
27204
27205 @smallexample
27206 -environment-path [ -r ] [ @var{pathdir} ]+
27207 @end smallexample
27208
27209 Add directories @var{pathdir} to beginning of search path for object files.
27210 If the @samp{-r} option is used, the search path is reset to the original
27211 search path that existed at gdb start-up. If directories @var{pathdir} are
27212 supplied in addition to the
27213 @samp{-r} option, the search path is first reset and then addition
27214 occurs as normal.
27215 Multiple directories may be specified, separated by blanks. Specifying
27216 multiple directories in a single command
27217 results in the directories added to the beginning of the
27218 search path in the same order they were presented in the command.
27219 If blanks are needed as
27220 part of a directory name, double-quotes should be used around
27221 the name. In the command output, the path will show up separated
27222 by the system directory-separator character. The directory-separator
27223 character must not be used
27224 in any directory name.
27225 If no directories are specified, the current path is displayed.
27226
27227
27228 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27229
27230 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{path}.
27231
27232 @subsubheading Example
27233
27234 @smallexample
27235 (gdb)
27236 -environment-path
27237 ^done,path="/usr/bin"
27238 (gdb)
27239 -environment-path /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/ppc-eabi/gdb /bin
27240 ^done,path="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/ppc-eabi/gdb:/bin:/usr/bin"
27241 (gdb)
27242 -environment-path -r /usr/local/bin
27243 ^done,path="/usr/local/bin:/usr/bin"
27244 (gdb)
27245 @end smallexample
27246
27247
27248 @subheading The @code{-environment-pwd} Command
27249 @findex -environment-pwd
27250
27251 @subsubheading Synopsis
27252
27253 @smallexample
27254 -environment-pwd
27255 @end smallexample
27256
27257 Show the current working directory.
27258
27259 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27260
27261 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{pwd}.
27262
27263 @subsubheading Example
27264
27265 @smallexample
27266 (gdb)
27267 -environment-pwd
27268 ^done,cwd="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb"
27269 (gdb)
27270 @end smallexample
27271
27272 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
27273 @node GDB/MI Thread Commands
27274 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Thread Commands
27275
27276
27277 @subheading The @code{-thread-info} Command
27278 @findex -thread-info
27279
27280 @subsubheading Synopsis
27281
27282 @smallexample
27283 -thread-info [ @var{thread-id} ]
27284 @end smallexample
27285
27286 Reports information about either a specific thread, if
27287 the @var{thread-id} parameter is present, or about all
27288 threads. When printing information about all threads,
27289 also reports the current thread.
27290
27291 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27292
27293 The @samp{info thread} command prints the same information
27294 about all threads.
27295
27296 @subsubheading Result
27297
27298 The result is a list of threads. The following attributes are
27299 defined for a given thread:
27300
27301 @table @samp
27302 @item current
27303 This field exists only for the current thread. It has the value @samp{*}.
27304
27305 @item id
27306 The identifier that @value{GDBN} uses to refer to the thread.
27307
27308 @item target-id
27309 The identifier that the target uses to refer to the thread.
27310
27311 @item details
27312 Extra information about the thread, in a target-specific format. This
27313 field is optional.
27314
27315 @item name
27316 The name of the thread. If the user specified a name using the
27317 @code{thread name} command, then this name is given. Otherwise, if
27318 @value{GDBN} can extract the thread name from the target, then that
27319 name is given. If @value{GDBN} cannot find the thread name, then this
27320 field is omitted.
27321
27322 @item frame
27323 The stack frame currently executing in the thread.
27324
27325 @item state
27326 The thread's state. The @samp{state} field may have the following
27327 values:
27328
27329 @table @code
27330 @item stopped
27331 The thread is stopped. Frame information is available for stopped
27332 threads.
27333
27334 @item running
27335 The thread is running. There's no frame information for running
27336 threads.
27337
27338 @end table
27339
27340 @item core
27341 If @value{GDBN} can find the CPU core on which this thread is running,
27342 then this field is the core identifier. This field is optional.
27343
27344 @end table
27345
27346 @subsubheading Example
27347
27348 @smallexample
27349 -thread-info
27350 ^done,threads=[
27351 @{id="2",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90 (LWP 21257)",
27352 frame=@{level="0",addr="0xffffe410",func="__kernel_vsyscall",
27353 args=[]@},state="running"@},
27354 @{id="1",target-id="Thread 0xb7e156b0 (LWP 21254)",
27355 frame=@{level="0",addr="0x0804891f",func="foo",
27356 args=[@{name="i",value="10"@}],
27357 file="/tmp/a.c",fullname="/tmp/a.c",line="158"@},
27358 state="running"@}],
27359 current-thread-id="1"
27360 (gdb)
27361 @end smallexample
27362
27363 @subheading The @code{-thread-list-ids} Command
27364 @findex -thread-list-ids
27365
27366 @subsubheading Synopsis
27367
27368 @smallexample
27369 -thread-list-ids
27370 @end smallexample
27371
27372 Produces a list of the currently known @value{GDBN} thread ids. At the
27373 end of the list it also prints the total number of such threads.
27374
27375 This command is retained for historical reasons, the
27376 @code{-thread-info} command should be used instead.
27377
27378 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27379
27380 Part of @samp{info threads} supplies the same information.
27381
27382 @subsubheading Example
27383
27384 @smallexample
27385 (gdb)
27386 -thread-list-ids
27387 ^done,thread-ids=@{thread-id="3",thread-id="2",thread-id="1"@},
27388 current-thread-id="1",number-of-threads="3"
27389 (gdb)
27390 @end smallexample
27391
27392
27393 @subheading The @code{-thread-select} Command
27394 @findex -thread-select
27395
27396 @subsubheading Synopsis
27397
27398 @smallexample
27399 -thread-select @var{threadnum}
27400 @end smallexample
27401
27402 Make @var{threadnum} the current thread. It prints the number of the new
27403 current thread, and the topmost frame for that thread.
27404
27405 This command is deprecated in favor of explicitly using the
27406 @samp{--thread} option to each command.
27407
27408 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27409
27410 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{thread}.
27411
27412 @subsubheading Example
27413
27414 @smallexample
27415 (gdb)
27416 -exec-next
27417 ^running
27418 (gdb)
27419 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",thread-id="2",line="187",
27420 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.threads/linux-dp.c"
27421 (gdb)
27422 -thread-list-ids
27423 ^done,
27424 thread-ids=@{thread-id="3",thread-id="2",thread-id="1"@},
27425 number-of-threads="3"
27426 (gdb)
27427 -thread-select 3
27428 ^done,new-thread-id="3",
27429 frame=@{level="0",func="vprintf",
27430 args=[@{name="format",value="0x8048e9c \"%*s%c %d %c\\n\""@},
27431 @{name="arg",value="0x2"@}],file="vprintf.c",line="31"@}
27432 (gdb)
27433 @end smallexample
27434
27435 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
27436 @node GDB/MI Ada Tasking Commands
27437 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Ada Tasking Commands
27438
27439 @subheading The @code{-ada-task-info} Command
27440 @findex -ada-task-info
27441
27442 @subsubheading Synopsis
27443
27444 @smallexample
27445 -ada-task-info [ @var{task-id} ]
27446 @end smallexample
27447
27448 Reports information about either a specific Ada task, if the
27449 @var{task-id} parameter is present, or about all Ada tasks.
27450
27451 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27452
27453 The @samp{info tasks} command prints the same information
27454 about all Ada tasks (@pxref{Ada Tasks}).
27455
27456 @subsubheading Result
27457
27458 The result is a table of Ada tasks. The following columns are
27459 defined for each Ada task:
27460
27461 @table @samp
27462 @item current
27463 This field exists only for the current thread. It has the value @samp{*}.
27464
27465 @item id
27466 The identifier that @value{GDBN} uses to refer to the Ada task.
27467
27468 @item task-id
27469 The identifier that the target uses to refer to the Ada task.
27470
27471 @item thread-id
27472 The identifier of the thread corresponding to the Ada task.
27473
27474 This field should always exist, as Ada tasks are always implemented
27475 on top of a thread. But if @value{GDBN} cannot find this corresponding
27476 thread for any reason, the field is omitted.
27477
27478 @item parent-id
27479 This field exists only when the task was created by another task.
27480 In this case, it provides the ID of the parent task.
27481
27482 @item priority
27483 The base priority of the task.
27484
27485 @item state
27486 The current state of the task. For a detailed description of the
27487 possible states, see @ref{Ada Tasks}.
27488
27489 @item name
27490 The name of the task.
27491
27492 @end table
27493
27494 @subsubheading Example
27495
27496 @smallexample
27497 -ada-task-info
27498 ^done,tasks=@{nr_rows="3",nr_cols="8",
27499 hdr=[@{width="1",alignment="-1",col_name="current",colhdr=""@},
27500 @{width="3",alignment="1",col_name="id",colhdr="ID"@},
27501 @{width="9",alignment="1",col_name="task-id",colhdr="TID"@},
27502 @{width="4",alignment="1",col_name="thread-id",colhdr=""@},
27503 @{width="4",alignment="1",col_name="parent-id",colhdr="P-ID"@},
27504 @{width="3",alignment="1",col_name="priority",colhdr="Pri"@},
27505 @{width="22",alignment="-1",col_name="state",colhdr="State"@},
27506 @{width="1",alignment="2",col_name="name",colhdr="Name"@}],
27507 body=[@{current="*",id="1",task-id=" 644010",thread-id="1",priority="48",
27508 state="Child Termination Wait",name="main_task"@}]@}
27509 (gdb)
27510 @end smallexample
27511
27512 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
27513 @node GDB/MI Program Execution
27514 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Program Execution
27515
27516 These are the asynchronous commands which generate the out-of-band
27517 record @samp{*stopped}. Currently @value{GDBN} only really executes
27518 asynchronously with remote targets and this interaction is mimicked in
27519 other cases.
27520
27521 @subheading The @code{-exec-continue} Command
27522 @findex -exec-continue
27523
27524 @subsubheading Synopsis
27525
27526 @smallexample
27527 -exec-continue [--reverse] [--all|--thread-group N]
27528 @end smallexample
27529
27530 Resumes the execution of the inferior program, which will continue
27531 to execute until it reaches a debugger stop event. If the
27532 @samp{--reverse} option is specified, execution resumes in reverse until
27533 it reaches a stop event. Stop events may include
27534 @itemize @bullet
27535 @item
27536 breakpoints or watchpoints
27537 @item
27538 signals or exceptions
27539 @item
27540 the end of the process (or its beginning under @samp{--reverse})
27541 @item
27542 the end or beginning of a replay log if one is being used.
27543 @end itemize
27544 In all-stop mode (@pxref{All-Stop
27545 Mode}), may resume only one thread, or all threads, depending on the
27546 value of the @samp{scheduler-locking} variable. If @samp{--all} is
27547 specified, all threads (in all inferiors) will be resumed. The @samp{--all} option is
27548 ignored in all-stop mode. If the @samp{--thread-group} options is
27549 specified, then all threads in that thread group are resumed.
27550
27551 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27552
27553 The corresponding @value{GDBN} corresponding is @samp{continue}.
27554
27555 @subsubheading Example
27556
27557 @smallexample
27558 -exec-continue
27559 ^running
27560 (gdb)
27561 @@Hello world
27562 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="2",frame=@{
27563 func="foo",args=[],file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/hello.c",
27564 line="13"@}
27565 (gdb)
27566 @end smallexample
27567
27568
27569 @subheading The @code{-exec-finish} Command
27570 @findex -exec-finish
27571
27572 @subsubheading Synopsis
27573
27574 @smallexample
27575 -exec-finish [--reverse]
27576 @end smallexample
27577
27578 Resumes the execution of the inferior program until the current
27579 function is exited. Displays the results returned by the function.
27580 If the @samp{--reverse} option is specified, resumes the reverse
27581 execution of the inferior program until the point where current
27582 function was called.
27583
27584 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27585
27586 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{finish}.
27587
27588 @subsubheading Example
27589
27590 Function returning @code{void}.
27591
27592 @smallexample
27593 -exec-finish
27594 ^running
27595 (gdb)
27596 @@hello from foo
27597 *stopped,reason="function-finished",frame=@{func="main",args=[],
27598 file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/hello.c",line="7"@}
27599 (gdb)
27600 @end smallexample
27601
27602 Function returning other than @code{void}. The name of the internal
27603 @value{GDBN} variable storing the result is printed, together with the
27604 value itself.
27605
27606 @smallexample
27607 -exec-finish
27608 ^running
27609 (gdb)
27610 *stopped,reason="function-finished",frame=@{addr="0x000107b0",func="foo",
27611 args=[@{name="a",value="1"],@{name="b",value="9"@}@},
27612 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
27613 gdb-result-var="$1",return-value="0"
27614 (gdb)
27615 @end smallexample
27616
27617
27618 @subheading The @code{-exec-interrupt} Command
27619 @findex -exec-interrupt
27620
27621 @subsubheading Synopsis
27622
27623 @smallexample
27624 -exec-interrupt [--all|--thread-group N]
27625 @end smallexample
27626
27627 Interrupts the background execution of the target. Note how the token
27628 associated with the stop message is the one for the execution command
27629 that has been interrupted. The token for the interrupt itself only
27630 appears in the @samp{^done} output. If the user is trying to
27631 interrupt a non-running program, an error message will be printed.
27632
27633 Note that when asynchronous execution is enabled, this command is
27634 asynchronous just like other execution commands. That is, first the
27635 @samp{^done} response will be printed, and the target stop will be
27636 reported after that using the @samp{*stopped} notification.
27637
27638 In non-stop mode, only the context thread is interrupted by default.
27639 All threads (in all inferiors) will be interrupted if the
27640 @samp{--all} option is specified. If the @samp{--thread-group}
27641 option is specified, all threads in that group will be interrupted.
27642
27643 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27644
27645 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{interrupt}.
27646
27647 @subsubheading Example
27648
27649 @smallexample
27650 (gdb)
27651 111-exec-continue
27652 111^running
27653
27654 (gdb)
27655 222-exec-interrupt
27656 222^done
27657 (gdb)
27658 111*stopped,signal-name="SIGINT",signal-meaning="Interrupt",
27659 frame=@{addr="0x00010140",func="foo",args=[],file="try.c",
27660 fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",line="13"@}
27661 (gdb)
27662
27663 (gdb)
27664 -exec-interrupt
27665 ^error,msg="mi_cmd_exec_interrupt: Inferior not executing."
27666 (gdb)
27667 @end smallexample
27668
27669 @subheading The @code{-exec-jump} Command
27670 @findex -exec-jump
27671
27672 @subsubheading Synopsis
27673
27674 @smallexample
27675 -exec-jump @var{location}
27676 @end smallexample
27677
27678 Resumes execution of the inferior program at the location specified by
27679 parameter. @xref{Specify Location}, for a description of the
27680 different forms of @var{location}.
27681
27682 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27683
27684 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{jump}.
27685
27686 @subsubheading Example
27687
27688 @smallexample
27689 -exec-jump foo.c:10
27690 *running,thread-id="all"
27691 ^running
27692 @end smallexample
27693
27694
27695 @subheading The @code{-exec-next} Command
27696 @findex -exec-next
27697
27698 @subsubheading Synopsis
27699
27700 @smallexample
27701 -exec-next [--reverse]
27702 @end smallexample
27703
27704 Resumes execution of the inferior program, stopping when the beginning
27705 of the next source line is reached.
27706
27707 If the @samp{--reverse} option is specified, resumes reverse execution
27708 of the inferior program, stopping at the beginning of the previous
27709 source line. If you issue this command on the first line of a
27710 function, it will take you back to the caller of that function, to the
27711 source line where the function was called.
27712
27713
27714 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27715
27716 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{next}.
27717
27718 @subsubheading Example
27719
27720 @smallexample
27721 -exec-next
27722 ^running
27723 (gdb)
27724 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",line="8",file="hello.c"
27725 (gdb)
27726 @end smallexample
27727
27728
27729 @subheading The @code{-exec-next-instruction} Command
27730 @findex -exec-next-instruction
27731
27732 @subsubheading Synopsis
27733
27734 @smallexample
27735 -exec-next-instruction [--reverse]
27736 @end smallexample
27737
27738 Executes one machine instruction. If the instruction is a function
27739 call, continues until the function returns. If the program stops at an
27740 instruction in the middle of a source line, the address will be
27741 printed as well.
27742
27743 If the @samp{--reverse} option is specified, resumes reverse execution
27744 of the inferior program, stopping at the previous instruction. If the
27745 previously executed instruction was a return from another function,
27746 it will continue to execute in reverse until the call to that function
27747 (from the current stack frame) is reached.
27748
27749 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27750
27751 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{nexti}.
27752
27753 @subsubheading Example
27754
27755 @smallexample
27756 (gdb)
27757 -exec-next-instruction
27758 ^running
27759
27760 (gdb)
27761 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
27762 addr="0x000100d4",line="5",file="hello.c"
27763 (gdb)
27764 @end smallexample
27765
27766
27767 @subheading The @code{-exec-return} Command
27768 @findex -exec-return
27769
27770 @subsubheading Synopsis
27771
27772 @smallexample
27773 -exec-return
27774 @end smallexample
27775
27776 Makes current function return immediately. Doesn't execute the inferior.
27777 Displays the new current frame.
27778
27779 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27780
27781 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{return}.
27782
27783 @subsubheading Example
27784
27785 @smallexample
27786 (gdb)
27787 200-break-insert callee4
27788 200^done,bkpt=@{number="1",addr="0x00010734",
27789 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8"@}
27790 (gdb)
27791 000-exec-run
27792 000^running
27793 (gdb)
27794 000*stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",
27795 frame=@{func="callee4",args=[],
27796 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
27797 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8"@}
27798 (gdb)
27799 205-break-delete
27800 205^done
27801 (gdb)
27802 111-exec-return
27803 111^done,frame=@{level="0",func="callee3",
27804 args=[@{name="strarg",
27805 value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}],
27806 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
27807 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="18"@}
27808 (gdb)
27809 @end smallexample
27810
27811
27812 @subheading The @code{-exec-run} Command
27813 @findex -exec-run
27814
27815 @subsubheading Synopsis
27816
27817 @smallexample
27818 -exec-run [--all | --thread-group N]
27819 @end smallexample
27820
27821 Starts execution of the inferior from the beginning. The inferior
27822 executes until either a breakpoint is encountered or the program
27823 exits. In the latter case the output will include an exit code, if
27824 the program has exited exceptionally.
27825
27826 When no option is specified, the current inferior is started. If the
27827 @samp{--thread-group} option is specified, it should refer to a thread
27828 group of type @samp{process}, and that thread group will be started.
27829 If the @samp{--all} option is specified, then all inferiors will be started.
27830
27831 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27832
27833 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{run}.
27834
27835 @subsubheading Examples
27836
27837 @smallexample
27838 (gdb)
27839 -break-insert main
27840 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",addr="0x0001072c",file="recursive2.c",line="4"@}
27841 (gdb)
27842 -exec-run
27843 ^running
27844 (gdb)
27845 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",
27846 frame=@{func="main",args=[],file="recursive2.c",
27847 fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="4"@}
27848 (gdb)
27849 @end smallexample
27850
27851 @noindent
27852 Program exited normally:
27853
27854 @smallexample
27855 (gdb)
27856 -exec-run
27857 ^running
27858 (gdb)
27859 x = 55
27860 *stopped,reason="exited-normally"
27861 (gdb)
27862 @end smallexample
27863
27864 @noindent
27865 Program exited exceptionally:
27866
27867 @smallexample
27868 (gdb)
27869 -exec-run
27870 ^running
27871 (gdb)
27872 x = 55
27873 *stopped,reason="exited",exit-code="01"
27874 (gdb)
27875 @end smallexample
27876
27877 Another way the program can terminate is if it receives a signal such as
27878 @code{SIGINT}. In this case, @sc{gdb/mi} displays this:
27879
27880 @smallexample
27881 (gdb)
27882 *stopped,reason="exited-signalled",signal-name="SIGINT",
27883 signal-meaning="Interrupt"
27884 @end smallexample
27885
27886
27887 @c @subheading -exec-signal
27888
27889
27890 @subheading The @code{-exec-step} Command
27891 @findex -exec-step
27892
27893 @subsubheading Synopsis
27894
27895 @smallexample
27896 -exec-step [--reverse]
27897 @end smallexample
27898
27899 Resumes execution of the inferior program, stopping when the beginning
27900 of the next source line is reached, if the next source line is not a
27901 function call. If it is, stop at the first instruction of the called
27902 function. If the @samp{--reverse} option is specified, resumes reverse
27903 execution of the inferior program, stopping at the beginning of the
27904 previously executed source line.
27905
27906 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27907
27908 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{step}.
27909
27910 @subsubheading Example
27911
27912 Stepping into a function:
27913
27914 @smallexample
27915 -exec-step
27916 ^running
27917 (gdb)
27918 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
27919 frame=@{func="foo",args=[@{name="a",value="10"@},
27920 @{name="b",value="0"@}],file="recursive2.c",
27921 fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="11"@}
27922 (gdb)
27923 @end smallexample
27924
27925 Regular stepping:
27926
27927 @smallexample
27928 -exec-step
27929 ^running
27930 (gdb)
27931 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",line="14",file="recursive2.c"
27932 (gdb)
27933 @end smallexample
27934
27935
27936 @subheading The @code{-exec-step-instruction} Command
27937 @findex -exec-step-instruction
27938
27939 @subsubheading Synopsis
27940
27941 @smallexample
27942 -exec-step-instruction [--reverse]
27943 @end smallexample
27944
27945 Resumes the inferior which executes one machine instruction. If the
27946 @samp{--reverse} option is specified, resumes reverse execution of the
27947 inferior program, stopping at the previously executed instruction.
27948 The output, once @value{GDBN} has stopped, will vary depending on
27949 whether we have stopped in the middle of a source line or not. In the
27950 former case, the address at which the program stopped will be printed
27951 as well.
27952
27953 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27954
27955 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{stepi}.
27956
27957 @subsubheading Example
27958
27959 @smallexample
27960 (gdb)
27961 -exec-step-instruction
27962 ^running
27963
27964 (gdb)
27965 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
27966 frame=@{func="foo",args=[],file="try.c",
27967 fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",line="10"@}
27968 (gdb)
27969 -exec-step-instruction
27970 ^running
27971
27972 (gdb)
27973 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
27974 frame=@{addr="0x000100f4",func="foo",args=[],file="try.c",
27975 fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",line="10"@}
27976 (gdb)
27977 @end smallexample
27978
27979
27980 @subheading The @code{-exec-until} Command
27981 @findex -exec-until
27982
27983 @subsubheading Synopsis
27984
27985 @smallexample
27986 -exec-until [ @var{location} ]
27987 @end smallexample
27988
27989 Executes the inferior until the @var{location} specified in the
27990 argument is reached. If there is no argument, the inferior executes
27991 until a source line greater than the current one is reached. The
27992 reason for stopping in this case will be @samp{location-reached}.
27993
27994 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27995
27996 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{until}.
27997
27998 @subsubheading Example
27999
28000 @smallexample
28001 (gdb)
28002 -exec-until recursive2.c:6
28003 ^running
28004 (gdb)
28005 x = 55
28006 *stopped,reason="location-reached",frame=@{func="main",args=[],
28007 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="6"@}
28008 (gdb)
28009 @end smallexample
28010
28011 @ignore
28012 @subheading -file-clear
28013 Is this going away????
28014 @end ignore
28015
28016 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
28017 @node GDB/MI Stack Manipulation
28018 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Stack Manipulation Commands
28019
28020
28021 @subheading The @code{-stack-info-frame} Command
28022 @findex -stack-info-frame
28023
28024 @subsubheading Synopsis
28025
28026 @smallexample
28027 -stack-info-frame
28028 @end smallexample
28029
28030 Get info on the selected frame.
28031
28032 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28033
28034 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info frame} or @samp{frame}
28035 (without arguments).
28036
28037 @subsubheading Example
28038
28039 @smallexample
28040 (gdb)
28041 -stack-info-frame
28042 ^done,frame=@{level="1",addr="0x0001076c",func="callee3",
28043 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
28044 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="17"@}
28045 (gdb)
28046 @end smallexample
28047
28048 @subheading The @code{-stack-info-depth} Command
28049 @findex -stack-info-depth
28050
28051 @subsubheading Synopsis
28052
28053 @smallexample
28054 -stack-info-depth [ @var{max-depth} ]
28055 @end smallexample
28056
28057 Return the depth of the stack. If the integer argument @var{max-depth}
28058 is specified, do not count beyond @var{max-depth} frames.
28059
28060 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28061
28062 There's no equivalent @value{GDBN} command.
28063
28064 @subsubheading Example
28065
28066 For a stack with frame levels 0 through 11:
28067
28068 @smallexample
28069 (gdb)
28070 -stack-info-depth
28071 ^done,depth="12"
28072 (gdb)
28073 -stack-info-depth 4
28074 ^done,depth="4"
28075 (gdb)
28076 -stack-info-depth 12
28077 ^done,depth="12"
28078 (gdb)
28079 -stack-info-depth 11
28080 ^done,depth="11"
28081 (gdb)
28082 -stack-info-depth 13
28083 ^done,depth="12"
28084 (gdb)
28085 @end smallexample
28086
28087 @subheading The @code{-stack-list-arguments} Command
28088 @findex -stack-list-arguments
28089
28090 @subsubheading Synopsis
28091
28092 @smallexample
28093 -stack-list-arguments @var{print-values}
28094 [ @var{low-frame} @var{high-frame} ]
28095 @end smallexample
28096
28097 Display a list of the arguments for the frames between @var{low-frame}
28098 and @var{high-frame} (inclusive). If @var{low-frame} and
28099 @var{high-frame} are not provided, list the arguments for the whole
28100 call stack. If the two arguments are equal, show the single frame
28101 at the corresponding level. It is an error if @var{low-frame} is
28102 larger than the actual number of frames. On the other hand,
28103 @var{high-frame} may be larger than the actual number of frames, in
28104 which case only existing frames will be returned.
28105
28106 If @var{print-values} is 0 or @code{--no-values}, print only the names of
28107 the variables; if it is 1 or @code{--all-values}, print also their
28108 values; and if it is 2 or @code{--simple-values}, print the name,
28109 type and value for simple data types, and the name and type for arrays,
28110 structures and unions.
28111
28112 Use of this command to obtain arguments in a single frame is
28113 deprecated in favor of the @samp{-stack-list-variables} command.
28114
28115 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28116
28117 @value{GDBN} does not have an equivalent command. @code{gdbtk} has a
28118 @samp{gdb_get_args} command which partially overlaps with the
28119 functionality of @samp{-stack-list-arguments}.
28120
28121 @subsubheading Example
28122
28123 @smallexample
28124 (gdb)
28125 -stack-list-frames
28126 ^done,
28127 stack=[
28128 frame=@{level="0",addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
28129 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
28130 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8"@},
28131 frame=@{level="1",addr="0x0001076c",func="callee3",
28132 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
28133 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="17"@},
28134 frame=@{level="2",addr="0x0001078c",func="callee2",
28135 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
28136 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="22"@},
28137 frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107b4",func="callee1",
28138 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
28139 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="27"@},
28140 frame=@{level="4",addr="0x000107e0",func="main",
28141 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
28142 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="32"@}]
28143 (gdb)
28144 -stack-list-arguments 0
28145 ^done,
28146 stack-args=[
28147 frame=@{level="0",args=[]@},
28148 frame=@{level="1",args=[name="strarg"]@},
28149 frame=@{level="2",args=[name="intarg",name="strarg"]@},
28150 frame=@{level="3",args=[name="intarg",name="strarg",name="fltarg"]@},
28151 frame=@{level="4",args=[]@}]
28152 (gdb)
28153 -stack-list-arguments 1
28154 ^done,
28155 stack-args=[
28156 frame=@{level="0",args=[]@},
28157 frame=@{level="1",
28158 args=[@{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}]@},
28159 frame=@{level="2",args=[
28160 @{name="intarg",value="2"@},
28161 @{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}]@},
28162 @{frame=@{level="3",args=[
28163 @{name="intarg",value="2"@},
28164 @{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@},
28165 @{name="fltarg",value="3.5"@}]@},
28166 frame=@{level="4",args=[]@}]
28167 (gdb)
28168 -stack-list-arguments 0 2 2
28169 ^done,stack-args=[frame=@{level="2",args=[name="intarg",name="strarg"]@}]
28170 (gdb)
28171 -stack-list-arguments 1 2 2
28172 ^done,stack-args=[frame=@{level="2",
28173 args=[@{name="intarg",value="2"@},
28174 @{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}]@}]
28175 (gdb)
28176 @end smallexample
28177
28178 @c @subheading -stack-list-exception-handlers
28179
28180
28181 @subheading The @code{-stack-list-frames} Command
28182 @findex -stack-list-frames
28183
28184 @subsubheading Synopsis
28185
28186 @smallexample
28187 -stack-list-frames [ @var{low-frame} @var{high-frame} ]
28188 @end smallexample
28189
28190 List the frames currently on the stack. For each frame it displays the
28191 following info:
28192
28193 @table @samp
28194 @item @var{level}
28195 The frame number, 0 being the topmost frame, i.e., the innermost function.
28196 @item @var{addr}
28197 The @code{$pc} value for that frame.
28198 @item @var{func}
28199 Function name.
28200 @item @var{file}
28201 File name of the source file where the function lives.
28202 @item @var{fullname}
28203 The full file name of the source file where the function lives.
28204 @item @var{line}
28205 Line number corresponding to the @code{$pc}.
28206 @item @var{from}
28207 The shared library where this function is defined. This is only given
28208 if the frame's function is not known.
28209 @end table
28210
28211 If invoked without arguments, this command prints a backtrace for the
28212 whole stack. If given two integer arguments, it shows the frames whose
28213 levels are between the two arguments (inclusive). If the two arguments
28214 are equal, it shows the single frame at the corresponding level. It is
28215 an error if @var{low-frame} is larger than the actual number of
28216 frames. On the other hand, @var{high-frame} may be larger than the
28217 actual number of frames, in which case only existing frames will be returned.
28218
28219 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28220
28221 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{backtrace} and @samp{where}.
28222
28223 @subsubheading Example
28224
28225 Full stack backtrace:
28226
28227 @smallexample
28228 (gdb)
28229 -stack-list-frames
28230 ^done,stack=
28231 [frame=@{level="0",addr="0x0001076c",func="foo",
28232 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="11"@},
28233 frame=@{level="1",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
28234 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
28235 frame=@{level="2",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
28236 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
28237 frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
28238 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
28239 frame=@{level="4",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
28240 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
28241 frame=@{level="5",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
28242 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
28243 frame=@{level="6",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
28244 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
28245 frame=@{level="7",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
28246 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
28247 frame=@{level="8",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
28248 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
28249 frame=@{level="9",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
28250 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
28251 frame=@{level="10",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
28252 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
28253 frame=@{level="11",addr="0x00010738",func="main",
28254 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="4"@}]
28255 (gdb)
28256 @end smallexample
28257
28258 Show frames between @var{low_frame} and @var{high_frame}:
28259
28260 @smallexample
28261 (gdb)
28262 -stack-list-frames 3 5
28263 ^done,stack=
28264 [frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
28265 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
28266 frame=@{level="4",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
28267 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
28268 frame=@{level="5",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
28269 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@}]
28270 (gdb)
28271 @end smallexample
28272
28273 Show a single frame:
28274
28275 @smallexample
28276 (gdb)
28277 -stack-list-frames 3 3
28278 ^done,stack=
28279 [frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
28280 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@}]
28281 (gdb)
28282 @end smallexample
28283
28284
28285 @subheading The @code{-stack-list-locals} Command
28286 @findex -stack-list-locals
28287
28288 @subsubheading Synopsis
28289
28290 @smallexample
28291 -stack-list-locals @var{print-values}
28292 @end smallexample
28293
28294 Display the local variable names for the selected frame. If
28295 @var{print-values} is 0 or @code{--no-values}, print only the names of
28296 the variables; if it is 1 or @code{--all-values}, print also their
28297 values; and if it is 2 or @code{--simple-values}, print the name,
28298 type and value for simple data types, and the name and type for arrays,
28299 structures and unions. In this last case, a frontend can immediately
28300 display the value of simple data types and create variable objects for
28301 other data types when the user wishes to explore their values in
28302 more detail.
28303
28304 This command is deprecated in favor of the
28305 @samp{-stack-list-variables} command.
28306
28307 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28308
28309 @samp{info locals} in @value{GDBN}, @samp{gdb_get_locals} in @code{gdbtk}.
28310
28311 @subsubheading Example
28312
28313 @smallexample
28314 (gdb)
28315 -stack-list-locals 0
28316 ^done,locals=[name="A",name="B",name="C"]
28317 (gdb)
28318 -stack-list-locals --all-values
28319 ^done,locals=[@{name="A",value="1"@},@{name="B",value="2"@},
28320 @{name="C",value="@{1, 2, 3@}"@}]
28321 -stack-list-locals --simple-values
28322 ^done,locals=[@{name="A",type="int",value="1"@},
28323 @{name="B",type="int",value="2"@},@{name="C",type="int [3]"@}]
28324 (gdb)
28325 @end smallexample
28326
28327 @subheading The @code{-stack-list-variables} Command
28328 @findex -stack-list-variables
28329
28330 @subsubheading Synopsis
28331
28332 @smallexample
28333 -stack-list-variables @var{print-values}
28334 @end smallexample
28335
28336 Display the names of local variables and function arguments for the selected frame. If
28337 @var{print-values} is 0 or @code{--no-values}, print only the names of
28338 the variables; if it is 1 or @code{--all-values}, print also their
28339 values; and if it is 2 or @code{--simple-values}, print the name,
28340 type and value for simple data types, and the name and type for arrays,
28341 structures and unions.
28342
28343 @subsubheading Example
28344
28345 @smallexample
28346 (gdb)
28347 -stack-list-variables --thread 1 --frame 0 --all-values
28348 ^done,variables=[@{name="x",value="11"@},@{name="s",value="@{a = 1, b = 2@}"@}]
28349 (gdb)
28350 @end smallexample
28351
28352
28353 @subheading The @code{-stack-select-frame} Command
28354 @findex -stack-select-frame
28355
28356 @subsubheading Synopsis
28357
28358 @smallexample
28359 -stack-select-frame @var{framenum}
28360 @end smallexample
28361
28362 Change the selected frame. Select a different frame @var{framenum} on
28363 the stack.
28364
28365 This command in deprecated in favor of passing the @samp{--frame}
28366 option to every command.
28367
28368 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28369
28370 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{frame}, @samp{up},
28371 @samp{down}, @samp{select-frame}, @samp{up-silent}, and @samp{down-silent}.
28372
28373 @subsubheading Example
28374
28375 @smallexample
28376 (gdb)
28377 -stack-select-frame 2
28378 ^done
28379 (gdb)
28380 @end smallexample
28381
28382 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
28383 @node GDB/MI Variable Objects
28384 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Variable Objects
28385
28386 @ignore
28387
28388 @subheading Motivation for Variable Objects in @sc{gdb/mi}
28389
28390 For the implementation of a variable debugger window (locals, watched
28391 expressions, etc.), we are proposing the adaptation of the existing code
28392 used by @code{Insight}.
28393
28394 The two main reasons for that are:
28395
28396 @enumerate 1
28397 @item
28398 It has been proven in practice (it is already on its second generation).
28399
28400 @item
28401 It will shorten development time (needless to say how important it is
28402 now).
28403 @end enumerate
28404
28405 The original interface was designed to be used by Tcl code, so it was
28406 slightly changed so it could be used through @sc{gdb/mi}. This section
28407 describes the @sc{gdb/mi} operations that will be available and gives some
28408 hints about their use.
28409
28410 @emph{Note}: In addition to the set of operations described here, we
28411 expect the @sc{gui} implementation of a variable window to require, at
28412 least, the following operations:
28413
28414 @itemize @bullet
28415 @item @code{-gdb-show} @code{output-radix}
28416 @item @code{-stack-list-arguments}
28417 @item @code{-stack-list-locals}
28418 @item @code{-stack-select-frame}
28419 @end itemize
28420
28421 @end ignore
28422
28423 @subheading Introduction to Variable Objects
28424
28425 @cindex variable objects in @sc{gdb/mi}
28426
28427 Variable objects are "object-oriented" MI interface for examining and
28428 changing values of expressions. Unlike some other MI interfaces that
28429 work with expressions, variable objects are specifically designed for
28430 simple and efficient presentation in the frontend. A variable object
28431 is identified by string name. When a variable object is created, the
28432 frontend specifies the expression for that variable object. The
28433 expression can be a simple variable, or it can be an arbitrary complex
28434 expression, and can even involve CPU registers. After creating a
28435 variable object, the frontend can invoke other variable object
28436 operations---for example to obtain or change the value of a variable
28437 object, or to change display format.
28438
28439 Variable objects have hierarchical tree structure. Any variable object
28440 that corresponds to a composite type, such as structure in C, has
28441 a number of child variable objects, for example corresponding to each
28442 element of a structure. A child variable object can itself have
28443 children, recursively. Recursion ends when we reach
28444 leaf variable objects, which always have built-in types. Child variable
28445 objects are created only by explicit request, so if a frontend
28446 is not interested in the children of a particular variable object, no
28447 child will be created.
28448
28449 For a leaf variable object it is possible to obtain its value as a
28450 string, or set the value from a string. String value can be also
28451 obtained for a non-leaf variable object, but it's generally a string
28452 that only indicates the type of the object, and does not list its
28453 contents. Assignment to a non-leaf variable object is not allowed.
28454
28455 A frontend does not need to read the values of all variable objects each time
28456 the program stops. Instead, MI provides an update command that lists all
28457 variable objects whose values has changed since the last update
28458 operation. This considerably reduces the amount of data that must
28459 be transferred to the frontend. As noted above, children variable
28460 objects are created on demand, and only leaf variable objects have a
28461 real value. As result, gdb will read target memory only for leaf
28462 variables that frontend has created.
28463
28464 The automatic update is not always desirable. For example, a frontend
28465 might want to keep a value of some expression for future reference,
28466 and never update it. For another example, fetching memory is
28467 relatively slow for embedded targets, so a frontend might want
28468 to disable automatic update for the variables that are either not
28469 visible on the screen, or ``closed''. This is possible using so
28470 called ``frozen variable objects''. Such variable objects are never
28471 implicitly updated.
28472
28473 Variable objects can be either @dfn{fixed} or @dfn{floating}. For the
28474 fixed variable object, the expression is parsed when the variable
28475 object is created, including associating identifiers to specific
28476 variables. The meaning of expression never changes. For a floating
28477 variable object the values of variables whose names appear in the
28478 expressions are re-evaluated every time in the context of the current
28479 frame. Consider this example:
28480
28481 @smallexample
28482 void do_work(...)
28483 @{
28484 struct work_state state;
28485
28486 if (...)
28487 do_work(...);
28488 @}
28489 @end smallexample
28490
28491 If a fixed variable object for the @code{state} variable is created in
28492 this function, and we enter the recursive call, the variable
28493 object will report the value of @code{state} in the top-level
28494 @code{do_work} invocation. On the other hand, a floating variable
28495 object will report the value of @code{state} in the current frame.
28496
28497 If an expression specified when creating a fixed variable object
28498 refers to a local variable, the variable object becomes bound to the
28499 thread and frame in which the variable object is created. When such
28500 variable object is updated, @value{GDBN} makes sure that the
28501 thread/frame combination the variable object is bound to still exists,
28502 and re-evaluates the variable object in context of that thread/frame.
28503
28504 The following is the complete set of @sc{gdb/mi} operations defined to
28505 access this functionality:
28506
28507 @multitable @columnfractions .4 .6
28508 @item @strong{Operation}
28509 @tab @strong{Description}
28510
28511 @item @code{-enable-pretty-printing}
28512 @tab enable Python-based pretty-printing
28513 @item @code{-var-create}
28514 @tab create a variable object
28515 @item @code{-var-delete}
28516 @tab delete the variable object and/or its children
28517 @item @code{-var-set-format}
28518 @tab set the display format of this variable
28519 @item @code{-var-show-format}
28520 @tab show the display format of this variable
28521 @item @code{-var-info-num-children}
28522 @tab tells how many children this object has
28523 @item @code{-var-list-children}
28524 @tab return a list of the object's children
28525 @item @code{-var-info-type}
28526 @tab show the type of this variable object
28527 @item @code{-var-info-expression}
28528 @tab print parent-relative expression that this variable object represents
28529 @item @code{-var-info-path-expression}
28530 @tab print full expression that this variable object represents
28531 @item @code{-var-show-attributes}
28532 @tab is this variable editable? does it exist here?
28533 @item @code{-var-evaluate-expression}
28534 @tab get the value of this variable
28535 @item @code{-var-assign}
28536 @tab set the value of this variable
28537 @item @code{-var-update}
28538 @tab update the variable and its children
28539 @item @code{-var-set-frozen}
28540 @tab set frozeness attribute
28541 @item @code{-var-set-update-range}
28542 @tab set range of children to display on update
28543 @end multitable
28544
28545 In the next subsection we describe each operation in detail and suggest
28546 how it can be used.
28547
28548 @subheading Description And Use of Operations on Variable Objects
28549
28550 @subheading The @code{-enable-pretty-printing} Command
28551 @findex -enable-pretty-printing
28552
28553 @smallexample
28554 -enable-pretty-printing
28555 @end smallexample
28556
28557 @value{GDBN} allows Python-based visualizers to affect the output of the
28558 MI variable object commands. However, because there was no way to
28559 implement this in a fully backward-compatible way, a front end must
28560 request that this functionality be enabled.
28561
28562 Once enabled, this feature cannot be disabled.
28563
28564 Note that if Python support has not been compiled into @value{GDBN},
28565 this command will still succeed (and do nothing).
28566
28567 This feature is currently (as of @value{GDBN} 7.0) experimental, and
28568 may work differently in future versions of @value{GDBN}.
28569
28570 @subheading The @code{-var-create} Command
28571 @findex -var-create
28572
28573 @subsubheading Synopsis
28574
28575 @smallexample
28576 -var-create @{@var{name} | "-"@}
28577 @{@var{frame-addr} | "*" | "@@"@} @var{expression}
28578 @end smallexample
28579
28580 This operation creates a variable object, which allows the monitoring of
28581 a variable, the result of an expression, a memory cell or a CPU
28582 register.
28583
28584 The @var{name} parameter is the string by which the object can be
28585 referenced. It must be unique. If @samp{-} is specified, the varobj
28586 system will generate a string ``varNNNNNN'' automatically. It will be
28587 unique provided that one does not specify @var{name} of that format.
28588 The command fails if a duplicate name is found.
28589
28590 The frame under which the expression should be evaluated can be
28591 specified by @var{frame-addr}. A @samp{*} indicates that the current
28592 frame should be used. A @samp{@@} indicates that a floating variable
28593 object must be created.
28594
28595 @var{expression} is any expression valid on the current language set (must not
28596 begin with a @samp{*}), or one of the following:
28597
28598 @itemize @bullet
28599 @item
28600 @samp{*@var{addr}}, where @var{addr} is the address of a memory cell
28601
28602 @item
28603 @samp{*@var{addr}-@var{addr}} --- a memory address range (TBD)
28604
28605 @item
28606 @samp{$@var{regname}} --- a CPU register name
28607 @end itemize
28608
28609 @cindex dynamic varobj
28610 A varobj's contents may be provided by a Python-based pretty-printer. In this
28611 case the varobj is known as a @dfn{dynamic varobj}. Dynamic varobjs
28612 have slightly different semantics in some cases. If the
28613 @code{-enable-pretty-printing} command is not sent, then @value{GDBN}
28614 will never create a dynamic varobj. This ensures backward
28615 compatibility for existing clients.
28616
28617 @subsubheading Result
28618
28619 This operation returns attributes of the newly-created varobj. These
28620 are:
28621
28622 @table @samp
28623 @item name
28624 The name of the varobj.
28625
28626 @item numchild
28627 The number of children of the varobj. This number is not necessarily
28628 reliable for a dynamic varobj. Instead, you must examine the
28629 @samp{has_more} attribute.
28630
28631 @item value
28632 The varobj's scalar value. For a varobj whose type is some sort of
28633 aggregate (e.g., a @code{struct}), or for a dynamic varobj, this value
28634 will not be interesting.
28635
28636 @item type
28637 The varobj's type. This is a string representation of the type, as
28638 would be printed by the @value{GDBN} CLI.
28639
28640 @item thread-id
28641 If a variable object is bound to a specific thread, then this is the
28642 thread's identifier.
28643
28644 @item has_more
28645 For a dynamic varobj, this indicates whether there appear to be any
28646 children available. For a non-dynamic varobj, this will be 0.
28647
28648 @item dynamic
28649 This attribute will be present and have the value @samp{1} if the
28650 varobj is a dynamic varobj. If the varobj is not a dynamic varobj,
28651 then this attribute will not be present.
28652
28653 @item displayhint
28654 A dynamic varobj can supply a display hint to the front end. The
28655 value comes directly from the Python pretty-printer object's
28656 @code{display_hint} method. @xref{Pretty Printing API}.
28657 @end table
28658
28659 Typical output will look like this:
28660
28661 @smallexample
28662 name="@var{name}",numchild="@var{N}",type="@var{type}",thread-id="@var{M}",
28663 has_more="@var{has_more}"
28664 @end smallexample
28665
28666
28667 @subheading The @code{-var-delete} Command
28668 @findex -var-delete
28669
28670 @subsubheading Synopsis
28671
28672 @smallexample
28673 -var-delete [ -c ] @var{name}
28674 @end smallexample
28675
28676 Deletes a previously created variable object and all of its children.
28677 With the @samp{-c} option, just deletes the children.
28678
28679 Returns an error if the object @var{name} is not found.
28680
28681
28682 @subheading The @code{-var-set-format} Command
28683 @findex -var-set-format
28684
28685 @subsubheading Synopsis
28686
28687 @smallexample
28688 -var-set-format @var{name} @var{format-spec}
28689 @end smallexample
28690
28691 Sets the output format for the value of the object @var{name} to be
28692 @var{format-spec}.
28693
28694 @anchor{-var-set-format}
28695 The syntax for the @var{format-spec} is as follows:
28696
28697 @smallexample
28698 @var{format-spec} @expansion{}
28699 @{binary | decimal | hexadecimal | octal | natural@}
28700 @end smallexample
28701
28702 The natural format is the default format choosen automatically
28703 based on the variable type (like decimal for an @code{int}, hex
28704 for pointers, etc.).
28705
28706 For a variable with children, the format is set only on the
28707 variable itself, and the children are not affected.
28708
28709 @subheading The @code{-var-show-format} Command
28710 @findex -var-show-format
28711
28712 @subsubheading Synopsis
28713
28714 @smallexample
28715 -var-show-format @var{name}
28716 @end smallexample
28717
28718 Returns the format used to display the value of the object @var{name}.
28719
28720 @smallexample
28721 @var{format} @expansion{}
28722 @var{format-spec}
28723 @end smallexample
28724
28725
28726 @subheading The @code{-var-info-num-children} Command
28727 @findex -var-info-num-children
28728
28729 @subsubheading Synopsis
28730
28731 @smallexample
28732 -var-info-num-children @var{name}
28733 @end smallexample
28734
28735 Returns the number of children of a variable object @var{name}:
28736
28737 @smallexample
28738 numchild=@var{n}
28739 @end smallexample
28740
28741 Note that this number is not completely reliable for a dynamic varobj.
28742 It will return the current number of children, but more children may
28743 be available.
28744
28745
28746 @subheading The @code{-var-list-children} Command
28747 @findex -var-list-children
28748
28749 @subsubheading Synopsis
28750
28751 @smallexample
28752 -var-list-children [@var{print-values}] @var{name} [@var{from} @var{to}]
28753 @end smallexample
28754 @anchor{-var-list-children}
28755
28756 Return a list of the children of the specified variable object and
28757 create variable objects for them, if they do not already exist. With
28758 a single argument or if @var{print-values} has a value of 0 or
28759 @code{--no-values}, print only the names of the variables; if
28760 @var{print-values} is 1 or @code{--all-values}, also print their
28761 values; and if it is 2 or @code{--simple-values} print the name and
28762 value for simple data types and just the name for arrays, structures
28763 and unions.
28764
28765 @var{from} and @var{to}, if specified, indicate the range of children
28766 to report. If @var{from} or @var{to} is less than zero, the range is
28767 reset and all children will be reported. Otherwise, children starting
28768 at @var{from} (zero-based) and up to and excluding @var{to} will be
28769 reported.
28770
28771 If a child range is requested, it will only affect the current call to
28772 @code{-var-list-children}, but not future calls to @code{-var-update}.
28773 For this, you must instead use @code{-var-set-update-range}. The
28774 intent of this approach is to enable a front end to implement any
28775 update approach it likes; for example, scrolling a view may cause the
28776 front end to request more children with @code{-var-list-children}, and
28777 then the front end could call @code{-var-set-update-range} with a
28778 different range to ensure that future updates are restricted to just
28779 the visible items.
28780
28781 For each child the following results are returned:
28782
28783 @table @var
28784
28785 @item name
28786 Name of the variable object created for this child.
28787
28788 @item exp
28789 The expression to be shown to the user by the front end to designate this child.
28790 For example this may be the name of a structure member.
28791
28792 For a dynamic varobj, this value cannot be used to form an
28793 expression. There is no way to do this at all with a dynamic varobj.
28794
28795 For C/C@t{++} structures there are several pseudo children returned to
28796 designate access qualifiers. For these pseudo children @var{exp} is
28797 @samp{public}, @samp{private}, or @samp{protected}. In this case the
28798 type and value are not present.
28799
28800 A dynamic varobj will not report the access qualifying
28801 pseudo-children, regardless of the language. This information is not
28802 available at all with a dynamic varobj.
28803
28804 @item numchild
28805 Number of children this child has. For a dynamic varobj, this will be
28806 0.
28807
28808 @item type
28809 The type of the child.
28810
28811 @item value
28812 If values were requested, this is the value.
28813
28814 @item thread-id
28815 If this variable object is associated with a thread, this is the thread id.
28816 Otherwise this result is not present.
28817
28818 @item frozen
28819 If the variable object is frozen, this variable will be present with a value of 1.
28820 @end table
28821
28822 The result may have its own attributes:
28823
28824 @table @samp
28825 @item displayhint
28826 A dynamic varobj can supply a display hint to the front end. The
28827 value comes directly from the Python pretty-printer object's
28828 @code{display_hint} method. @xref{Pretty Printing API}.
28829
28830 @item has_more
28831 This is an integer attribute which is nonzero if there are children
28832 remaining after the end of the selected range.
28833 @end table
28834
28835 @subsubheading Example
28836
28837 @smallexample
28838 (gdb)
28839 -var-list-children n
28840 ^done,numchild=@var{n},children=[child=@{name=@var{name},exp=@var{exp},
28841 numchild=@var{n},type=@var{type}@},@r{(repeats N times)}]
28842 (gdb)
28843 -var-list-children --all-values n
28844 ^done,numchild=@var{n},children=[child=@{name=@var{name},exp=@var{exp},
28845 numchild=@var{n},value=@var{value},type=@var{type}@},@r{(repeats N times)}]
28846 @end smallexample
28847
28848
28849 @subheading The @code{-var-info-type} Command
28850 @findex -var-info-type
28851
28852 @subsubheading Synopsis
28853
28854 @smallexample
28855 -var-info-type @var{name}
28856 @end smallexample
28857
28858 Returns the type of the specified variable @var{name}. The type is
28859 returned as a string in the same format as it is output by the
28860 @value{GDBN} CLI:
28861
28862 @smallexample
28863 type=@var{typename}
28864 @end smallexample
28865
28866
28867 @subheading The @code{-var-info-expression} Command
28868 @findex -var-info-expression
28869
28870 @subsubheading Synopsis
28871
28872 @smallexample
28873 -var-info-expression @var{name}
28874 @end smallexample
28875
28876 Returns a string that is suitable for presenting this
28877 variable object in user interface. The string is generally
28878 not valid expression in the current language, and cannot be evaluated.
28879
28880 For example, if @code{a} is an array, and variable object
28881 @code{A} was created for @code{a}, then we'll get this output:
28882
28883 @smallexample
28884 (gdb) -var-info-expression A.1
28885 ^done,lang="C",exp="1"
28886 @end smallexample
28887
28888 @noindent
28889 Here, the values of @code{lang} can be @code{@{"C" | "C++" | "Java"@}}.
28890
28891 Note that the output of the @code{-var-list-children} command also
28892 includes those expressions, so the @code{-var-info-expression} command
28893 is of limited use.
28894
28895 @subheading The @code{-var-info-path-expression} Command
28896 @findex -var-info-path-expression
28897
28898 @subsubheading Synopsis
28899
28900 @smallexample
28901 -var-info-path-expression @var{name}
28902 @end smallexample
28903
28904 Returns an expression that can be evaluated in the current
28905 context and will yield the same value that a variable object has.
28906 Compare this with the @code{-var-info-expression} command, which
28907 result can be used only for UI presentation. Typical use of
28908 the @code{-var-info-path-expression} command is creating a
28909 watchpoint from a variable object.
28910
28911 This command is currently not valid for children of a dynamic varobj,
28912 and will give an error when invoked on one.
28913
28914 For example, suppose @code{C} is a C@t{++} class, derived from class
28915 @code{Base}, and that the @code{Base} class has a member called
28916 @code{m_size}. Assume a variable @code{c} is has the type of
28917 @code{C} and a variable object @code{C} was created for variable
28918 @code{c}. Then, we'll get this output:
28919 @smallexample
28920 (gdb) -var-info-path-expression C.Base.public.m_size
28921 ^done,path_expr=((Base)c).m_size)
28922 @end smallexample
28923
28924 @subheading The @code{-var-show-attributes} Command
28925 @findex -var-show-attributes
28926
28927 @subsubheading Synopsis
28928
28929 @smallexample
28930 -var-show-attributes @var{name}
28931 @end smallexample
28932
28933 List attributes of the specified variable object @var{name}:
28934
28935 @smallexample
28936 status=@var{attr} [ ( ,@var{attr} )* ]
28937 @end smallexample
28938
28939 @noindent
28940 where @var{attr} is @code{@{ @{ editable | noneditable @} | TBD @}}.
28941
28942 @subheading The @code{-var-evaluate-expression} Command
28943 @findex -var-evaluate-expression
28944
28945 @subsubheading Synopsis
28946
28947 @smallexample
28948 -var-evaluate-expression [-f @var{format-spec}] @var{name}
28949 @end smallexample
28950
28951 Evaluates the expression that is represented by the specified variable
28952 object and returns its value as a string. The format of the string
28953 can be specified with the @samp{-f} option. The possible values of
28954 this option are the same as for @code{-var-set-format}
28955 (@pxref{-var-set-format}). If the @samp{-f} option is not specified,
28956 the current display format will be used. The current display format
28957 can be changed using the @code{-var-set-format} command.
28958
28959 @smallexample
28960 value=@var{value}
28961 @end smallexample
28962
28963 Note that one must invoke @code{-var-list-children} for a variable
28964 before the value of a child variable can be evaluated.
28965
28966 @subheading The @code{-var-assign} Command
28967 @findex -var-assign
28968
28969 @subsubheading Synopsis
28970
28971 @smallexample
28972 -var-assign @var{name} @var{expression}
28973 @end smallexample
28974
28975 Assigns the value of @var{expression} to the variable object specified
28976 by @var{name}. The object must be @samp{editable}. If the variable's
28977 value is altered by the assign, the variable will show up in any
28978 subsequent @code{-var-update} list.
28979
28980 @subsubheading Example
28981
28982 @smallexample
28983 (gdb)
28984 -var-assign var1 3
28985 ^done,value="3"
28986 (gdb)
28987 -var-update *
28988 ^done,changelist=[@{name="var1",in_scope="true",type_changed="false"@}]
28989 (gdb)
28990 @end smallexample
28991
28992 @subheading The @code{-var-update} Command
28993 @findex -var-update
28994
28995 @subsubheading Synopsis
28996
28997 @smallexample
28998 -var-update [@var{print-values}] @{@var{name} | "*"@}
28999 @end smallexample
29000
29001 Reevaluate the expressions corresponding to the variable object
29002 @var{name} and all its direct and indirect children, and return the
29003 list of variable objects whose values have changed; @var{name} must
29004 be a root variable object. Here, ``changed'' means that the result of
29005 @code{-var-evaluate-expression} before and after the
29006 @code{-var-update} is different. If @samp{*} is used as the variable
29007 object names, all existing variable objects are updated, except
29008 for frozen ones (@pxref{-var-set-frozen}). The option
29009 @var{print-values} determines whether both names and values, or just
29010 names are printed. The possible values of this option are the same
29011 as for @code{-var-list-children} (@pxref{-var-list-children}). It is
29012 recommended to use the @samp{--all-values} option, to reduce the
29013 number of MI commands needed on each program stop.
29014
29015 With the @samp{*} parameter, if a variable object is bound to a
29016 currently running thread, it will not be updated, without any
29017 diagnostic.
29018
29019 If @code{-var-set-update-range} was previously used on a varobj, then
29020 only the selected range of children will be reported.
29021
29022 @code{-var-update} reports all the changed varobjs in a tuple named
29023 @samp{changelist}.
29024
29025 Each item in the change list is itself a tuple holding:
29026
29027 @table @samp
29028 @item name
29029 The name of the varobj.
29030
29031 @item value
29032 If values were requested for this update, then this field will be
29033 present and will hold the value of the varobj.
29034
29035 @item in_scope
29036 @anchor{-var-update}
29037 This field is a string which may take one of three values:
29038
29039 @table @code
29040 @item "true"
29041 The variable object's current value is valid.
29042
29043 @item "false"
29044 The variable object does not currently hold a valid value but it may
29045 hold one in the future if its associated expression comes back into
29046 scope.
29047
29048 @item "invalid"
29049 The variable object no longer holds a valid value.
29050 This can occur when the executable file being debugged has changed,
29051 either through recompilation or by using the @value{GDBN} @code{file}
29052 command. The front end should normally choose to delete these variable
29053 objects.
29054 @end table
29055
29056 In the future new values may be added to this list so the front should
29057 be prepared for this possibility. @xref{GDB/MI Development and Front Ends, ,@sc{GDB/MI} Development and Front Ends}.
29058
29059 @item type_changed
29060 This is only present if the varobj is still valid. If the type
29061 changed, then this will be the string @samp{true}; otherwise it will
29062 be @samp{false}.
29063
29064 @item new_type
29065 If the varobj's type changed, then this field will be present and will
29066 hold the new type.
29067
29068 @item new_num_children
29069 For a dynamic varobj, if the number of children changed, or if the
29070 type changed, this will be the new number of children.
29071
29072 The @samp{numchild} field in other varobj responses is generally not
29073 valid for a dynamic varobj -- it will show the number of children that
29074 @value{GDBN} knows about, but because dynamic varobjs lazily
29075 instantiate their children, this will not reflect the number of
29076 children which may be available.
29077
29078 The @samp{new_num_children} attribute only reports changes to the
29079 number of children known by @value{GDBN}. This is the only way to
29080 detect whether an update has removed children (which necessarily can
29081 only happen at the end of the update range).
29082
29083 @item displayhint
29084 The display hint, if any.
29085
29086 @item has_more
29087 This is an integer value, which will be 1 if there are more children
29088 available outside the varobj's update range.
29089
29090 @item dynamic
29091 This attribute will be present and have the value @samp{1} if the
29092 varobj is a dynamic varobj. If the varobj is not a dynamic varobj,
29093 then this attribute will not be present.
29094
29095 @item new_children
29096 If new children were added to a dynamic varobj within the selected
29097 update range (as set by @code{-var-set-update-range}), then they will
29098 be listed in this attribute.
29099 @end table
29100
29101 @subsubheading Example
29102
29103 @smallexample
29104 (gdb)
29105 -var-assign var1 3
29106 ^done,value="3"
29107 (gdb)
29108 -var-update --all-values var1
29109 ^done,changelist=[@{name="var1",value="3",in_scope="true",
29110 type_changed="false"@}]
29111 (gdb)
29112 @end smallexample
29113
29114 @subheading The @code{-var-set-frozen} Command
29115 @findex -var-set-frozen
29116 @anchor{-var-set-frozen}
29117
29118 @subsubheading Synopsis
29119
29120 @smallexample
29121 -var-set-frozen @var{name} @var{flag}
29122 @end smallexample
29123
29124 Set the frozenness flag on the variable object @var{name}. The
29125 @var{flag} parameter should be either @samp{1} to make the variable
29126 frozen or @samp{0} to make it unfrozen. If a variable object is
29127 frozen, then neither itself, nor any of its children, are
29128 implicitly updated by @code{-var-update} of
29129 a parent variable or by @code{-var-update *}. Only
29130 @code{-var-update} of the variable itself will update its value and
29131 values of its children. After a variable object is unfrozen, it is
29132 implicitly updated by all subsequent @code{-var-update} operations.
29133 Unfreezing a variable does not update it, only subsequent
29134 @code{-var-update} does.
29135
29136 @subsubheading Example
29137
29138 @smallexample
29139 (gdb)
29140 -var-set-frozen V 1
29141 ^done
29142 (gdb)
29143 @end smallexample
29144
29145 @subheading The @code{-var-set-update-range} command
29146 @findex -var-set-update-range
29147 @anchor{-var-set-update-range}
29148
29149 @subsubheading Synopsis
29150
29151 @smallexample
29152 -var-set-update-range @var{name} @var{from} @var{to}
29153 @end smallexample
29154
29155 Set the range of children to be returned by future invocations of
29156 @code{-var-update}.
29157
29158 @var{from} and @var{to} indicate the range of children to report. If
29159 @var{from} or @var{to} is less than zero, the range is reset and all
29160 children will be reported. Otherwise, children starting at @var{from}
29161 (zero-based) and up to and excluding @var{to} will be reported.
29162
29163 @subsubheading Example
29164
29165 @smallexample
29166 (gdb)
29167 -var-set-update-range V 1 2
29168 ^done
29169 @end smallexample
29170
29171 @subheading The @code{-var-set-visualizer} command
29172 @findex -var-set-visualizer
29173 @anchor{-var-set-visualizer}
29174
29175 @subsubheading Synopsis
29176
29177 @smallexample
29178 -var-set-visualizer @var{name} @var{visualizer}
29179 @end smallexample
29180
29181 Set a visualizer for the variable object @var{name}.
29182
29183 @var{visualizer} is the visualizer to use. The special value
29184 @samp{None} means to disable any visualizer in use.
29185
29186 If not @samp{None}, @var{visualizer} must be a Python expression.
29187 This expression must evaluate to a callable object which accepts a
29188 single argument. @value{GDBN} will call this object with the value of
29189 the varobj @var{name} as an argument (this is done so that the same
29190 Python pretty-printing code can be used for both the CLI and MI).
29191 When called, this object must return an object which conforms to the
29192 pretty-printing interface (@pxref{Pretty Printing API}).
29193
29194 The pre-defined function @code{gdb.default_visualizer} may be used to
29195 select a visualizer by following the built-in process
29196 (@pxref{Selecting Pretty-Printers}). This is done automatically when
29197 a varobj is created, and so ordinarily is not needed.
29198
29199 This feature is only available if Python support is enabled. The MI
29200 command @code{-list-features} (@pxref{GDB/MI Miscellaneous Commands})
29201 can be used to check this.
29202
29203 @subsubheading Example
29204
29205 Resetting the visualizer:
29206
29207 @smallexample
29208 (gdb)
29209 -var-set-visualizer V None
29210 ^done
29211 @end smallexample
29212
29213 Reselecting the default (type-based) visualizer:
29214
29215 @smallexample
29216 (gdb)
29217 -var-set-visualizer V gdb.default_visualizer
29218 ^done
29219 @end smallexample
29220
29221 Suppose @code{SomeClass} is a visualizer class. A lambda expression
29222 can be used to instantiate this class for a varobj:
29223
29224 @smallexample
29225 (gdb)
29226 -var-set-visualizer V "lambda val: SomeClass()"
29227 ^done
29228 @end smallexample
29229
29230 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
29231 @node GDB/MI Data Manipulation
29232 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Data Manipulation
29233
29234 @cindex data manipulation, in @sc{gdb/mi}
29235 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, data manipulation
29236 This section describes the @sc{gdb/mi} commands that manipulate data:
29237 examine memory and registers, evaluate expressions, etc.
29238
29239 @c REMOVED FROM THE INTERFACE.
29240 @c @subheading -data-assign
29241 @c Change the value of a program variable. Plenty of side effects.
29242 @c @subsubheading GDB Command
29243 @c set variable
29244 @c @subsubheading Example
29245 @c N.A.
29246
29247 @subheading The @code{-data-disassemble} Command
29248 @findex -data-disassemble
29249
29250 @subsubheading Synopsis
29251
29252 @smallexample
29253 -data-disassemble
29254 [ -s @var{start-addr} -e @var{end-addr} ]
29255 | [ -f @var{filename} -l @var{linenum} [ -n @var{lines} ] ]
29256 -- @var{mode}
29257 @end smallexample
29258
29259 @noindent
29260 Where:
29261
29262 @table @samp
29263 @item @var{start-addr}
29264 is the beginning address (or @code{$pc})
29265 @item @var{end-addr}
29266 is the end address
29267 @item @var{filename}
29268 is the name of the file to disassemble
29269 @item @var{linenum}
29270 is the line number to disassemble around
29271 @item @var{lines}
29272 is the number of disassembly lines to be produced. If it is -1,
29273 the whole function will be disassembled, in case no @var{end-addr} is
29274 specified. If @var{end-addr} is specified as a non-zero value, and
29275 @var{lines} is lower than the number of disassembly lines between
29276 @var{start-addr} and @var{end-addr}, only @var{lines} lines are
29277 displayed; if @var{lines} is higher than the number of lines between
29278 @var{start-addr} and @var{end-addr}, only the lines up to @var{end-addr}
29279 are displayed.
29280 @item @var{mode}
29281 is either 0 (meaning only disassembly), 1 (meaning mixed source and
29282 disassembly), 2 (meaning disassembly with raw opcodes), or 3 (meaning
29283 mixed source and disassembly with raw opcodes).
29284 @end table
29285
29286 @subsubheading Result
29287
29288 The output for each instruction is composed of four fields:
29289
29290 @itemize @bullet
29291 @item Address
29292 @item Func-name
29293 @item Offset
29294 @item Instruction
29295 @end itemize
29296
29297 Note that whatever included in the instruction field, is not manipulated
29298 directly by @sc{gdb/mi}, i.e., it is not possible to adjust its format.
29299
29300 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29301
29302 There's no direct mapping from this command to the CLI.
29303
29304 @subsubheading Example
29305
29306 Disassemble from the current value of @code{$pc} to @code{$pc + 20}:
29307
29308 @smallexample
29309 (gdb)
29310 -data-disassemble -s $pc -e "$pc + 20" -- 0
29311 ^done,
29312 asm_insns=[
29313 @{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
29314 inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
29315 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
29316 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@},
29317 @{address="0x000107c8",func-name="main",offset="12",
29318 inst="or %o2, 0x140, %o1\t! 0x11940 <_lib_version+8>"@},
29319 @{address="0x000107cc",func-name="main",offset="16",
29320 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@},
29321 @{address="0x000107d0",func-name="main",offset="20",
29322 inst="or %o2, 0x168, %o4\t! 0x11968 <_lib_version+48>"@}]
29323 (gdb)
29324 @end smallexample
29325
29326 Disassemble the whole @code{main} function. Line 32 is part of
29327 @code{main}.
29328
29329 @smallexample
29330 -data-disassemble -f basics.c -l 32 -- 0
29331 ^done,asm_insns=[
29332 @{address="0x000107bc",func-name="main",offset="0",
29333 inst="save %sp, -112, %sp"@},
29334 @{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
29335 inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
29336 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
29337 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@},
29338 [@dots{}]
29339 @{address="0x0001081c",func-name="main",offset="96",inst="ret "@},
29340 @{address="0x00010820",func-name="main",offset="100",inst="restore "@}]
29341 (gdb)
29342 @end smallexample
29343
29344 Disassemble 3 instructions from the start of @code{main}:
29345
29346 @smallexample
29347 (gdb)
29348 -data-disassemble -f basics.c -l 32 -n 3 -- 0
29349 ^done,asm_insns=[
29350 @{address="0x000107bc",func-name="main",offset="0",
29351 inst="save %sp, -112, %sp"@},
29352 @{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
29353 inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
29354 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
29355 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@}]
29356 (gdb)
29357 @end smallexample
29358
29359 Disassemble 3 instructions from the start of @code{main} in mixed mode:
29360
29361 @smallexample
29362 (gdb)
29363 -data-disassemble -f basics.c -l 32 -n 3 -- 1
29364 ^done,asm_insns=[
29365 src_and_asm_line=@{line="31",
29366 file="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb/ \
29367 testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line_asm_insn=[
29368 @{address="0x000107bc",func-name="main",offset="0",
29369 inst="save %sp, -112, %sp"@}]@},
29370 src_and_asm_line=@{line="32",
29371 file="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb/ \
29372 testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line_asm_insn=[
29373 @{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
29374 inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
29375 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
29376 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@}]@}]
29377 (gdb)
29378 @end smallexample
29379
29380
29381 @subheading The @code{-data-evaluate-expression} Command
29382 @findex -data-evaluate-expression
29383
29384 @subsubheading Synopsis
29385
29386 @smallexample
29387 -data-evaluate-expression @var{expr}
29388 @end smallexample
29389
29390 Evaluate @var{expr} as an expression. The expression could contain an
29391 inferior function call. The function call will execute synchronously.
29392 If the expression contains spaces, it must be enclosed in double quotes.
29393
29394 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29395
29396 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{print}, @samp{output}, and
29397 @samp{call}. In @code{gdbtk} only, there's a corresponding
29398 @samp{gdb_eval} command.
29399
29400 @subsubheading Example
29401
29402 In the following example, the numbers that precede the commands are the
29403 @dfn{tokens} described in @ref{GDB/MI Command Syntax, ,@sc{gdb/mi}
29404 Command Syntax}. Notice how @sc{gdb/mi} returns the same tokens in its
29405 output.
29406
29407 @smallexample
29408 211-data-evaluate-expression A
29409 211^done,value="1"
29410 (gdb)
29411 311-data-evaluate-expression &A
29412 311^done,value="0xefffeb7c"
29413 (gdb)
29414 411-data-evaluate-expression A+3
29415 411^done,value="4"
29416 (gdb)
29417 511-data-evaluate-expression "A + 3"
29418 511^done,value="4"
29419 (gdb)
29420 @end smallexample
29421
29422
29423 @subheading The @code{-data-list-changed-registers} Command
29424 @findex -data-list-changed-registers
29425
29426 @subsubheading Synopsis
29427
29428 @smallexample
29429 -data-list-changed-registers
29430 @end smallexample
29431
29432 Display a list of the registers that have changed.
29433
29434 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29435
29436 @value{GDBN} doesn't have a direct analog for this command; @code{gdbtk}
29437 has the corresponding command @samp{gdb_changed_register_list}.
29438
29439 @subsubheading Example
29440
29441 On a PPC MBX board:
29442
29443 @smallexample
29444 (gdb)
29445 -exec-continue
29446 ^running
29447
29448 (gdb)
29449 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",frame=@{
29450 func="main",args=[],file="try.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",
29451 line="5"@}
29452 (gdb)
29453 -data-list-changed-registers
29454 ^done,changed-registers=["0","1","2","4","5","6","7","8","9",
29455 "10","11","13","14","15","16","17","18","19","20","21","22","23",
29456 "24","25","26","27","28","30","31","64","65","66","67","69"]
29457 (gdb)
29458 @end smallexample
29459
29460
29461 @subheading The @code{-data-list-register-names} Command
29462 @findex -data-list-register-names
29463
29464 @subsubheading Synopsis
29465
29466 @smallexample
29467 -data-list-register-names [ ( @var{regno} )+ ]
29468 @end smallexample
29469
29470 Show a list of register names for the current target. If no arguments
29471 are given, it shows a list of the names of all the registers. If
29472 integer numbers are given as arguments, it will print a list of the
29473 names of the registers corresponding to the arguments. To ensure
29474 consistency between a register name and its number, the output list may
29475 include empty register names.
29476
29477 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29478
29479 @value{GDBN} does not have a command which corresponds to
29480 @samp{-data-list-register-names}. In @code{gdbtk} there is a
29481 corresponding command @samp{gdb_regnames}.
29482
29483 @subsubheading Example
29484
29485 For the PPC MBX board:
29486 @smallexample
29487 (gdb)
29488 -data-list-register-names
29489 ^done,register-names=["r0","r1","r2","r3","r4","r5","r6","r7",
29490 "r8","r9","r10","r11","r12","r13","r14","r15","r16","r17","r18",
29491 "r19","r20","r21","r22","r23","r24","r25","r26","r27","r28","r29",
29492 "r30","r31","f0","f1","f2","f3","f4","f5","f6","f7","f8","f9",
29493 "f10","f11","f12","f13","f14","f15","f16","f17","f18","f19","f20",
29494 "f21","f22","f23","f24","f25","f26","f27","f28","f29","f30","f31",
29495 "", "pc","ps","cr","lr","ctr","xer"]
29496 (gdb)
29497 -data-list-register-names 1 2 3
29498 ^done,register-names=["r1","r2","r3"]
29499 (gdb)
29500 @end smallexample
29501
29502 @subheading The @code{-data-list-register-values} Command
29503 @findex -data-list-register-values
29504
29505 @subsubheading Synopsis
29506
29507 @smallexample
29508 -data-list-register-values @var{fmt} [ ( @var{regno} )*]
29509 @end smallexample
29510
29511 Display the registers' contents. @var{fmt} is the format according to
29512 which the registers' contents are to be returned, followed by an optional
29513 list of numbers specifying the registers to display. A missing list of
29514 numbers indicates that the contents of all the registers must be returned.
29515
29516 Allowed formats for @var{fmt} are:
29517
29518 @table @code
29519 @item x
29520 Hexadecimal
29521 @item o
29522 Octal
29523 @item t
29524 Binary
29525 @item d
29526 Decimal
29527 @item r
29528 Raw
29529 @item N
29530 Natural
29531 @end table
29532
29533 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29534
29535 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{info reg}, @samp{info
29536 all-reg}, and (in @code{gdbtk}) @samp{gdb_fetch_registers}.
29537
29538 @subsubheading Example
29539
29540 For a PPC MBX board (note: line breaks are for readability only, they
29541 don't appear in the actual output):
29542
29543 @smallexample
29544 (gdb)
29545 -data-list-register-values r 64 65
29546 ^done,register-values=[@{number="64",value="0xfe00a300"@},
29547 @{number="65",value="0x00029002"@}]
29548 (gdb)
29549 -data-list-register-values x
29550 ^done,register-values=[@{number="0",value="0xfe0043c8"@},
29551 @{number="1",value="0x3fff88"@},@{number="2",value="0xfffffffe"@},
29552 @{number="3",value="0x0"@},@{number="4",value="0xa"@},
29553 @{number="5",value="0x3fff68"@},@{number="6",value="0x3fff58"@},
29554 @{number="7",value="0xfe011e98"@},@{number="8",value="0x2"@},
29555 @{number="9",value="0xfa202820"@},@{number="10",value="0xfa202808"@},
29556 @{number="11",value="0x1"@},@{number="12",value="0x0"@},
29557 @{number="13",value="0x4544"@},@{number="14",value="0xffdfffff"@},
29558 @{number="15",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="16",value="0xfffffeff"@},
29559 @{number="17",value="0xefffffed"@},@{number="18",value="0xfffffffe"@},
29560 @{number="19",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="20",value="0xffffffff"@},
29561 @{number="21",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="22",value="0xfffffff7"@},
29562 @{number="23",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="24",value="0xffffffff"@},
29563 @{number="25",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="26",value="0xfffffffb"@},
29564 @{number="27",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="28",value="0xf7bfffff"@},
29565 @{number="29",value="0x0"@},@{number="30",value="0xfe010000"@},
29566 @{number="31",value="0x0"@},@{number="32",value="0x0"@},
29567 @{number="33",value="0x0"@},@{number="34",value="0x0"@},
29568 @{number="35",value="0x0"@},@{number="36",value="0x0"@},
29569 @{number="37",value="0x0"@},@{number="38",value="0x0"@},
29570 @{number="39",value="0x0"@},@{number="40",value="0x0"@},
29571 @{number="41",value="0x0"@},@{number="42",value="0x0"@},
29572 @{number="43",value="0x0"@},@{number="44",value="0x0"@},
29573 @{number="45",value="0x0"@},@{number="46",value="0x0"@},
29574 @{number="47",value="0x0"@},@{number="48",value="0x0"@},
29575 @{number="49",value="0x0"@},@{number="50",value="0x0"@},
29576 @{number="51",value="0x0"@},@{number="52",value="0x0"@},
29577 @{number="53",value="0x0"@},@{number="54",value="0x0"@},
29578 @{number="55",value="0x0"@},@{number="56",value="0x0"@},
29579 @{number="57",value="0x0"@},@{number="58",value="0x0"@},
29580 @{number="59",value="0x0"@},@{number="60",value="0x0"@},
29581 @{number="61",value="0x0"@},@{number="62",value="0x0"@},
29582 @{number="63",value="0x0"@},@{number="64",value="0xfe00a300"@},
29583 @{number="65",value="0x29002"@},@{number="66",value="0x202f04b5"@},
29584 @{number="67",value="0xfe0043b0"@},@{number="68",value="0xfe00b3e4"@},
29585 @{number="69",value="0x20002b03"@}]
29586 (gdb)
29587 @end smallexample
29588
29589
29590 @subheading The @code{-data-read-memory} Command
29591 @findex -data-read-memory
29592
29593 This command is deprecated, use @code{-data-read-memory-bytes} instead.
29594
29595 @subsubheading Synopsis
29596
29597 @smallexample
29598 -data-read-memory [ -o @var{byte-offset} ]
29599 @var{address} @var{word-format} @var{word-size}
29600 @var{nr-rows} @var{nr-cols} [ @var{aschar} ]
29601 @end smallexample
29602
29603 @noindent
29604 where:
29605
29606 @table @samp
29607 @item @var{address}
29608 An expression specifying the address of the first memory word to be
29609 read. Complex expressions containing embedded white space should be
29610 quoted using the C convention.
29611
29612 @item @var{word-format}
29613 The format to be used to print the memory words. The notation is the
29614 same as for @value{GDBN}'s @code{print} command (@pxref{Output Formats,
29615 ,Output Formats}).
29616
29617 @item @var{word-size}
29618 The size of each memory word in bytes.
29619
29620 @item @var{nr-rows}
29621 The number of rows in the output table.
29622
29623 @item @var{nr-cols}
29624 The number of columns in the output table.
29625
29626 @item @var{aschar}
29627 If present, indicates that each row should include an @sc{ascii} dump. The
29628 value of @var{aschar} is used as a padding character when a byte is not a
29629 member of the printable @sc{ascii} character set (printable @sc{ascii}
29630 characters are those whose code is between 32 and 126, inclusively).
29631
29632 @item @var{byte-offset}
29633 An offset to add to the @var{address} before fetching memory.
29634 @end table
29635
29636 This command displays memory contents as a table of @var{nr-rows} by
29637 @var{nr-cols} words, each word being @var{word-size} bytes. In total,
29638 @code{@var{nr-rows} * @var{nr-cols} * @var{word-size}} bytes are read
29639 (returned as @samp{total-bytes}). Should less than the requested number
29640 of bytes be returned by the target, the missing words are identified
29641 using @samp{N/A}. The number of bytes read from the target is returned
29642 in @samp{nr-bytes} and the starting address used to read memory in
29643 @samp{addr}.
29644
29645 The address of the next/previous row or page is available in
29646 @samp{next-row} and @samp{prev-row}, @samp{next-page} and
29647 @samp{prev-page}.
29648
29649 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29650
29651 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{x}. @code{gdbtk} has
29652 @samp{gdb_get_mem} memory read command.
29653
29654 @subsubheading Example
29655
29656 Read six bytes of memory starting at @code{bytes+6} but then offset by
29657 @code{-6} bytes. Format as three rows of two columns. One byte per
29658 word. Display each word in hex.
29659
29660 @smallexample
29661 (gdb)
29662 9-data-read-memory -o -6 -- bytes+6 x 1 3 2
29663 9^done,addr="0x00001390",nr-bytes="6",total-bytes="6",
29664 next-row="0x00001396",prev-row="0x0000138e",next-page="0x00001396",
29665 prev-page="0x0000138a",memory=[
29666 @{addr="0x00001390",data=["0x00","0x01"]@},
29667 @{addr="0x00001392",data=["0x02","0x03"]@},
29668 @{addr="0x00001394",data=["0x04","0x05"]@}]
29669 (gdb)
29670 @end smallexample
29671
29672 Read two bytes of memory starting at address @code{shorts + 64} and
29673 display as a single word formatted in decimal.
29674
29675 @smallexample
29676 (gdb)
29677 5-data-read-memory shorts+64 d 2 1 1
29678 5^done,addr="0x00001510",nr-bytes="2",total-bytes="2",
29679 next-row="0x00001512",prev-row="0x0000150e",
29680 next-page="0x00001512",prev-page="0x0000150e",memory=[
29681 @{addr="0x00001510",data=["128"]@}]
29682 (gdb)
29683 @end smallexample
29684
29685 Read thirty two bytes of memory starting at @code{bytes+16} and format
29686 as eight rows of four columns. Include a string encoding with @samp{x}
29687 used as the non-printable character.
29688
29689 @smallexample
29690 (gdb)
29691 4-data-read-memory bytes+16 x 1 8 4 x
29692 4^done,addr="0x000013a0",nr-bytes="32",total-bytes="32",
29693 next-row="0x000013c0",prev-row="0x0000139c",
29694 next-page="0x000013c0",prev-page="0x00001380",memory=[
29695 @{addr="0x000013a0",data=["0x10","0x11","0x12","0x13"],ascii="xxxx"@},
29696 @{addr="0x000013a4",data=["0x14","0x15","0x16","0x17"],ascii="xxxx"@},
29697 @{addr="0x000013a8",data=["0x18","0x19","0x1a","0x1b"],ascii="xxxx"@},
29698 @{addr="0x000013ac",data=["0x1c","0x1d","0x1e","0x1f"],ascii="xxxx"@},
29699 @{addr="0x000013b0",data=["0x20","0x21","0x22","0x23"],ascii=" !\"#"@},
29700 @{addr="0x000013b4",data=["0x24","0x25","0x26","0x27"],ascii="$%&'"@},
29701 @{addr="0x000013b8",data=["0x28","0x29","0x2a","0x2b"],ascii="()*+"@},
29702 @{addr="0x000013bc",data=["0x2c","0x2d","0x2e","0x2f"],ascii=",-./"@}]
29703 (gdb)
29704 @end smallexample
29705
29706 @subheading The @code{-data-read-memory-bytes} Command
29707 @findex -data-read-memory-bytes
29708
29709 @subsubheading Synopsis
29710
29711 @smallexample
29712 -data-read-memory-bytes [ -o @var{byte-offset} ]
29713 @var{address} @var{count}
29714 @end smallexample
29715
29716 @noindent
29717 where:
29718
29719 @table @samp
29720 @item @var{address}
29721 An expression specifying the address of the first memory word to be
29722 read. Complex expressions containing embedded white space should be
29723 quoted using the C convention.
29724
29725 @item @var{count}
29726 The number of bytes to read. This should be an integer literal.
29727
29728 @item @var{byte-offset}
29729 The offsets in bytes relative to @var{address} at which to start
29730 reading. This should be an integer literal. This option is provided
29731 so that a frontend is not required to first evaluate address and then
29732 perform address arithmetics itself.
29733
29734 @end table
29735
29736 This command attempts to read all accessible memory regions in the
29737 specified range. First, all regions marked as unreadable in the memory
29738 map (if one is defined) will be skipped. @xref{Memory Region
29739 Attributes}. Second, @value{GDBN} will attempt to read the remaining
29740 regions. For each one, if reading full region results in an errors,
29741 @value{GDBN} will try to read a subset of the region.
29742
29743 In general, every single byte in the region may be readable or not,
29744 and the only way to read every readable byte is to try a read at
29745 every address, which is not practical. Therefore, @value{GDBN} will
29746 attempt to read all accessible bytes at either beginning or the end
29747 of the region, using a binary division scheme. This heuristic works
29748 well for reading accross a memory map boundary. Note that if a region
29749 has a readable range that is neither at the beginning or the end,
29750 @value{GDBN} will not read it.
29751
29752 The result record (@pxref{GDB/MI Result Records}) that is output of
29753 the command includes a field named @samp{memory} whose content is a
29754 list of tuples. Each tuple represent a successfully read memory block
29755 and has the following fields:
29756
29757 @table @code
29758 @item begin
29759 The start address of the memory block, as hexadecimal literal.
29760
29761 @item end
29762 The end address of the memory block, as hexadecimal literal.
29763
29764 @item offset
29765 The offset of the memory block, as hexadecimal literal, relative to
29766 the start address passed to @code{-data-read-memory-bytes}.
29767
29768 @item contents
29769 The contents of the memory block, in hex.
29770
29771 @end table
29772
29773
29774
29775 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29776
29777 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{x}.
29778
29779 @subsubheading Example
29780
29781 @smallexample
29782 (gdb)
29783 -data-read-memory-bytes &a 10
29784 ^done,memory=[@{begin="0xbffff154",offset="0x00000000",
29785 end="0xbffff15e",
29786 contents="01000000020000000300"@}]
29787 (gdb)
29788 @end smallexample
29789
29790
29791 @subheading The @code{-data-write-memory-bytes} Command
29792 @findex -data-write-memory-bytes
29793
29794 @subsubheading Synopsis
29795
29796 @smallexample
29797 -data-write-memory-bytes @var{address} @var{contents}
29798 @end smallexample
29799
29800 @noindent
29801 where:
29802
29803 @table @samp
29804 @item @var{address}
29805 An expression specifying the address of the first memory word to be
29806 read. Complex expressions containing embedded white space should be
29807 quoted using the C convention.
29808
29809 @item @var{contents}
29810 The hex-encoded bytes to write.
29811
29812 @end table
29813
29814 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29815
29816 There's no corresponding @value{GDBN} command.
29817
29818 @subsubheading Example
29819
29820 @smallexample
29821 (gdb)
29822 -data-write-memory-bytes &a "aabbccdd"
29823 ^done
29824 (gdb)
29825 @end smallexample
29826
29827
29828 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
29829 @node GDB/MI Tracepoint Commands
29830 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Tracepoint Commands
29831
29832 The commands defined in this section implement MI support for
29833 tracepoints. For detailed introduction, see @ref{Tracepoints}.
29834
29835 @subheading The @code{-trace-find} Command
29836 @findex -trace-find
29837
29838 @subsubheading Synopsis
29839
29840 @smallexample
29841 -trace-find @var{mode} [@var{parameters}@dots{}]
29842 @end smallexample
29843
29844 Find a trace frame using criteria defined by @var{mode} and
29845 @var{parameters}. The following table lists permissible
29846 modes and their parameters. For details of operation, see @ref{tfind}.
29847
29848 @table @samp
29849
29850 @item none
29851 No parameters are required. Stops examining trace frames.
29852
29853 @item frame-number
29854 An integer is required as parameter. Selects tracepoint frame with
29855 that index.
29856
29857 @item tracepoint-number
29858 An integer is required as parameter. Finds next
29859 trace frame that corresponds to tracepoint with the specified number.
29860
29861 @item pc
29862 An address is required as parameter. Finds
29863 next trace frame that corresponds to any tracepoint at the specified
29864 address.
29865
29866 @item pc-inside-range
29867 Two addresses are required as parameters. Finds next trace
29868 frame that corresponds to a tracepoint at an address inside the
29869 specified range. Both bounds are considered to be inside the range.
29870
29871 @item pc-outside-range
29872 Two addresses are required as parameters. Finds
29873 next trace frame that corresponds to a tracepoint at an address outside
29874 the specified range. Both bounds are considered to be inside the range.
29875
29876 @item line
29877 Line specification is required as parameter. @xref{Specify Location}.
29878 Finds next trace frame that corresponds to a tracepoint at
29879 the specified location.
29880
29881 @end table
29882
29883 If @samp{none} was passed as @var{mode}, the response does not
29884 have fields. Otherwise, the response may have the following fields:
29885
29886 @table @samp
29887 @item found
29888 This field has either @samp{0} or @samp{1} as the value, depending
29889 on whether a matching tracepoint was found.
29890
29891 @item traceframe
29892 The index of the found traceframe. This field is present iff
29893 the @samp{found} field has value of @samp{1}.
29894
29895 @item tracepoint
29896 The index of the found tracepoint. This field is present iff
29897 the @samp{found} field has value of @samp{1}.
29898
29899 @item frame
29900 The information about the frame corresponding to the found trace
29901 frame. This field is present only if a trace frame was found.
29902 @xref{GDB/MI Frame Information}, for description of this field.
29903
29904 @end table
29905
29906 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29907
29908 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tfind}.
29909
29910 @subheading -trace-define-variable
29911 @findex -trace-define-variable
29912
29913 @subsubheading Synopsis
29914
29915 @smallexample
29916 -trace-define-variable @var{name} [ @var{value} ]
29917 @end smallexample
29918
29919 Create trace variable @var{name} if it does not exist. If
29920 @var{value} is specified, sets the initial value of the specified
29921 trace variable to that value. Note that the @var{name} should start
29922 with the @samp{$} character.
29923
29924 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29925
29926 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tvariable}.
29927
29928 @subheading -trace-list-variables
29929 @findex -trace-list-variables
29930
29931 @subsubheading Synopsis
29932
29933 @smallexample
29934 -trace-list-variables
29935 @end smallexample
29936
29937 Return a table of all defined trace variables. Each element of the
29938 table has the following fields:
29939
29940 @table @samp
29941 @item name
29942 The name of the trace variable. This field is always present.
29943
29944 @item initial
29945 The initial value. This is a 64-bit signed integer. This
29946 field is always present.
29947
29948 @item current
29949 The value the trace variable has at the moment. This is a 64-bit
29950 signed integer. This field is absent iff current value is
29951 not defined, for example if the trace was never run, or is
29952 presently running.
29953
29954 @end table
29955
29956 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29957
29958 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tvariables}.
29959
29960 @subsubheading Example
29961
29962 @smallexample
29963 (gdb)
29964 -trace-list-variables
29965 ^done,trace-variables=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="3",
29966 hdr=[@{width="15",alignment="-1",col_name="name",colhdr="Name"@},
29967 @{width="11",alignment="-1",col_name="initial",colhdr="Initial"@},
29968 @{width="11",alignment="-1",col_name="current",colhdr="Current"@}],
29969 body=[variable=@{name="$trace_timestamp",initial="0"@}
29970 variable=@{name="$foo",initial="10",current="15"@}]@}
29971 (gdb)
29972 @end smallexample
29973
29974 @subheading -trace-save
29975 @findex -trace-save
29976
29977 @subsubheading Synopsis
29978
29979 @smallexample
29980 -trace-save [-r ] @var{filename}
29981 @end smallexample
29982
29983 Saves the collected trace data to @var{filename}. Without the
29984 @samp{-r} option, the data is downloaded from the target and saved
29985 in a local file. With the @samp{-r} option the target is asked
29986 to perform the save.
29987
29988 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29989
29990 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tsave}.
29991
29992
29993 @subheading -trace-start
29994 @findex -trace-start
29995
29996 @subsubheading Synopsis
29997
29998 @smallexample
29999 -trace-start
30000 @end smallexample
30001
30002 Starts a tracing experiments. The result of this command does not
30003 have any fields.
30004
30005 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30006
30007 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tstart}.
30008
30009 @subheading -trace-status
30010 @findex -trace-status
30011
30012 @subsubheading Synopsis
30013
30014 @smallexample
30015 -trace-status
30016 @end smallexample
30017
30018 Obtains the status of a tracing experiment. The result may include
30019 the following fields:
30020
30021 @table @samp
30022
30023 @item supported
30024 May have a value of either @samp{0}, when no tracing operations are
30025 supported, @samp{1}, when all tracing operations are supported, or
30026 @samp{file} when examining trace file. In the latter case, examining
30027 of trace frame is possible but new tracing experiement cannot be
30028 started. This field is always present.
30029
30030 @item running
30031 May have a value of either @samp{0} or @samp{1} depending on whether
30032 tracing experiement is in progress on target. This field is present
30033 if @samp{supported} field is not @samp{0}.
30034
30035 @item stop-reason
30036 Report the reason why the tracing was stopped last time. This field
30037 may be absent iff tracing was never stopped on target yet. The
30038 value of @samp{request} means the tracing was stopped as result of
30039 the @code{-trace-stop} command. The value of @samp{overflow} means
30040 the tracing buffer is full. The value of @samp{disconnection} means
30041 tracing was automatically stopped when @value{GDBN} has disconnected.
30042 The value of @samp{passcount} means tracing was stopped when a
30043 tracepoint was passed a maximal number of times for that tracepoint.
30044 This field is present if @samp{supported} field is not @samp{0}.
30045
30046 @item stopping-tracepoint
30047 The number of tracepoint whose passcount as exceeded. This field is
30048 present iff the @samp{stop-reason} field has the value of
30049 @samp{passcount}.
30050
30051 @item frames
30052 @itemx frames-created
30053 The @samp{frames} field is a count of the total number of trace frames
30054 in the trace buffer, while @samp{frames-created} is the total created
30055 during the run, including ones that were discarded, such as when a
30056 circular trace buffer filled up. Both fields are optional.
30057
30058 @item buffer-size
30059 @itemx buffer-free
30060 These fields tell the current size of the tracing buffer and the
30061 remaining space. These fields are optional.
30062
30063 @item circular
30064 The value of the circular trace buffer flag. @code{1} means that the
30065 trace buffer is circular and old trace frames will be discarded if
30066 necessary to make room, @code{0} means that the trace buffer is linear
30067 and may fill up.
30068
30069 @item disconnected
30070 The value of the disconnected tracing flag. @code{1} means that
30071 tracing will continue after @value{GDBN} disconnects, @code{0} means
30072 that the trace run will stop.
30073
30074 @end table
30075
30076 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30077
30078 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tstatus}.
30079
30080 @subheading -trace-stop
30081 @findex -trace-stop
30082
30083 @subsubheading Synopsis
30084
30085 @smallexample
30086 -trace-stop
30087 @end smallexample
30088
30089 Stops a tracing experiment. The result of this command has the same
30090 fields as @code{-trace-status}, except that the @samp{supported} and
30091 @samp{running} fields are not output.
30092
30093 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30094
30095 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tstop}.
30096
30097
30098 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
30099 @node GDB/MI Symbol Query
30100 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Symbol Query Commands
30101
30102
30103 @ignore
30104 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-address} Command
30105 @findex -symbol-info-address
30106
30107 @subsubheading Synopsis
30108
30109 @smallexample
30110 -symbol-info-address @var{symbol}
30111 @end smallexample
30112
30113 Describe where @var{symbol} is stored.
30114
30115 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30116
30117 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info address}.
30118
30119 @subsubheading Example
30120 N.A.
30121
30122
30123 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-file} Command
30124 @findex -symbol-info-file
30125
30126 @subsubheading Synopsis
30127
30128 @smallexample
30129 -symbol-info-file
30130 @end smallexample
30131
30132 Show the file for the symbol.
30133
30134 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30135
30136 There's no equivalent @value{GDBN} command. @code{gdbtk} has
30137 @samp{gdb_find_file}.
30138
30139 @subsubheading Example
30140 N.A.
30141
30142
30143 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-function} Command
30144 @findex -symbol-info-function
30145
30146 @subsubheading Synopsis
30147
30148 @smallexample
30149 -symbol-info-function
30150 @end smallexample
30151
30152 Show which function the symbol lives in.
30153
30154 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30155
30156 @samp{gdb_get_function} in @code{gdbtk}.
30157
30158 @subsubheading Example
30159 N.A.
30160
30161
30162 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-line} Command
30163 @findex -symbol-info-line
30164
30165 @subsubheading Synopsis
30166
30167 @smallexample
30168 -symbol-info-line
30169 @end smallexample
30170
30171 Show the core addresses of the code for a source line.
30172
30173 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30174
30175 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info line}.
30176 @code{gdbtk} has the @samp{gdb_get_line} and @samp{gdb_get_file} commands.
30177
30178 @subsubheading Example
30179 N.A.
30180
30181
30182 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-symbol} Command
30183 @findex -symbol-info-symbol
30184
30185 @subsubheading Synopsis
30186
30187 @smallexample
30188 -symbol-info-symbol @var{addr}
30189 @end smallexample
30190
30191 Describe what symbol is at location @var{addr}.
30192
30193 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30194
30195 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info symbol}.
30196
30197 @subsubheading Example
30198 N.A.
30199
30200
30201 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-functions} Command
30202 @findex -symbol-list-functions
30203
30204 @subsubheading Synopsis
30205
30206 @smallexample
30207 -symbol-list-functions
30208 @end smallexample
30209
30210 List the functions in the executable.
30211
30212 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30213
30214 @samp{info functions} in @value{GDBN}, @samp{gdb_listfunc} and
30215 @samp{gdb_search} in @code{gdbtk}.
30216
30217 @subsubheading Example
30218 N.A.
30219 @end ignore
30220
30221
30222 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-lines} Command
30223 @findex -symbol-list-lines
30224
30225 @subsubheading Synopsis
30226
30227 @smallexample
30228 -symbol-list-lines @var{filename}
30229 @end smallexample
30230
30231 Print the list of lines that contain code and their associated program
30232 addresses for the given source filename. The entries are sorted in
30233 ascending PC order.
30234
30235 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30236
30237 There is no corresponding @value{GDBN} command.
30238
30239 @subsubheading Example
30240 @smallexample
30241 (gdb)
30242 -symbol-list-lines basics.c
30243 ^done,lines=[@{pc="0x08048554",line="7"@},@{pc="0x0804855a",line="8"@}]
30244 (gdb)
30245 @end smallexample
30246
30247
30248 @ignore
30249 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-types} Command
30250 @findex -symbol-list-types
30251
30252 @subsubheading Synopsis
30253
30254 @smallexample
30255 -symbol-list-types
30256 @end smallexample
30257
30258 List all the type names.
30259
30260 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30261
30262 The corresponding commands are @samp{info types} in @value{GDBN},
30263 @samp{gdb_search} in @code{gdbtk}.
30264
30265 @subsubheading Example
30266 N.A.
30267
30268
30269 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-variables} Command
30270 @findex -symbol-list-variables
30271
30272 @subsubheading Synopsis
30273
30274 @smallexample
30275 -symbol-list-variables
30276 @end smallexample
30277
30278 List all the global and static variable names.
30279
30280 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30281
30282 @samp{info variables} in @value{GDBN}, @samp{gdb_search} in @code{gdbtk}.
30283
30284 @subsubheading Example
30285 N.A.
30286
30287
30288 @subheading The @code{-symbol-locate} Command
30289 @findex -symbol-locate
30290
30291 @subsubheading Synopsis
30292
30293 @smallexample
30294 -symbol-locate
30295 @end smallexample
30296
30297 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30298
30299 @samp{gdb_loc} in @code{gdbtk}.
30300
30301 @subsubheading Example
30302 N.A.
30303
30304
30305 @subheading The @code{-symbol-type} Command
30306 @findex -symbol-type
30307
30308 @subsubheading Synopsis
30309
30310 @smallexample
30311 -symbol-type @var{variable}
30312 @end smallexample
30313
30314 Show type of @var{variable}.
30315
30316 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30317
30318 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{ptype}, @code{gdbtk} has
30319 @samp{gdb_obj_variable}.
30320
30321 @subsubheading Example
30322 N.A.
30323 @end ignore
30324
30325
30326 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
30327 @node GDB/MI File Commands
30328 @section @sc{gdb/mi} File Commands
30329
30330 This section describes the GDB/MI commands to specify executable file names
30331 and to read in and obtain symbol table information.
30332
30333 @subheading The @code{-file-exec-and-symbols} Command
30334 @findex -file-exec-and-symbols
30335
30336 @subsubheading Synopsis
30337
30338 @smallexample
30339 -file-exec-and-symbols @var{file}
30340 @end smallexample
30341
30342 Specify the executable file to be debugged. This file is the one from
30343 which the symbol table is also read. If no file is specified, the
30344 command clears the executable and symbol information. If breakpoints
30345 are set when using this command with no arguments, @value{GDBN} will produce
30346 error messages. Otherwise, no output is produced, except a completion
30347 notification.
30348
30349 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30350
30351 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{file}.
30352
30353 @subsubheading Example
30354
30355 @smallexample
30356 (gdb)
30357 -file-exec-and-symbols /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/TRUNK/mbx/hello.mbx
30358 ^done
30359 (gdb)
30360 @end smallexample
30361
30362
30363 @subheading The @code{-file-exec-file} Command
30364 @findex -file-exec-file
30365
30366 @subsubheading Synopsis
30367
30368 @smallexample
30369 -file-exec-file @var{file}
30370 @end smallexample
30371
30372 Specify the executable file to be debugged. Unlike
30373 @samp{-file-exec-and-symbols}, the symbol table is @emph{not} read
30374 from this file. If used without argument, @value{GDBN} clears the information
30375 about the executable file. No output is produced, except a completion
30376 notification.
30377
30378 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30379
30380 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{exec-file}.
30381
30382 @subsubheading Example
30383
30384 @smallexample
30385 (gdb)
30386 -file-exec-file /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/TRUNK/mbx/hello.mbx
30387 ^done
30388 (gdb)
30389 @end smallexample
30390
30391
30392 @ignore
30393 @subheading The @code{-file-list-exec-sections} Command
30394 @findex -file-list-exec-sections
30395
30396 @subsubheading Synopsis
30397
30398 @smallexample
30399 -file-list-exec-sections
30400 @end smallexample
30401
30402 List the sections of the current executable file.
30403
30404 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30405
30406 The @value{GDBN} command @samp{info file} shows, among the rest, the same
30407 information as this command. @code{gdbtk} has a corresponding command
30408 @samp{gdb_load_info}.
30409
30410 @subsubheading Example
30411 N.A.
30412 @end ignore
30413
30414
30415 @subheading The @code{-file-list-exec-source-file} Command
30416 @findex -file-list-exec-source-file
30417
30418 @subsubheading Synopsis
30419
30420 @smallexample
30421 -file-list-exec-source-file
30422 @end smallexample
30423
30424 List the line number, the current source file, and the absolute path
30425 to the current source file for the current executable. The macro
30426 information field has a value of @samp{1} or @samp{0} depending on
30427 whether or not the file includes preprocessor macro information.
30428
30429 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30430
30431 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{info source}
30432
30433 @subsubheading Example
30434
30435 @smallexample
30436 (gdb)
30437 123-file-list-exec-source-file
30438 123^done,line="1",file="foo.c",fullname="/home/bar/foo.c,macro-info="1"
30439 (gdb)
30440 @end smallexample
30441
30442
30443 @subheading The @code{-file-list-exec-source-files} Command
30444 @findex -file-list-exec-source-files
30445
30446 @subsubheading Synopsis
30447
30448 @smallexample
30449 -file-list-exec-source-files
30450 @end smallexample
30451
30452 List the source files for the current executable.
30453
30454 It will always output the filename, but only when @value{GDBN} can find
30455 the absolute file name of a source file, will it output the fullname.
30456
30457 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30458
30459 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{info sources}.
30460 @code{gdbtk} has an analogous command @samp{gdb_listfiles}.
30461
30462 @subsubheading Example
30463 @smallexample
30464 (gdb)
30465 -file-list-exec-source-files
30466 ^done,files=[
30467 @{file=foo.c,fullname=/home/foo.c@},
30468 @{file=/home/bar.c,fullname=/home/bar.c@},
30469 @{file=gdb_could_not_find_fullpath.c@}]
30470 (gdb)
30471 @end smallexample
30472
30473 @ignore
30474 @subheading The @code{-file-list-shared-libraries} Command
30475 @findex -file-list-shared-libraries
30476
30477 @subsubheading Synopsis
30478
30479 @smallexample
30480 -file-list-shared-libraries
30481 @end smallexample
30482
30483 List the shared libraries in the program.
30484
30485 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30486
30487 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info shared}.
30488
30489 @subsubheading Example
30490 N.A.
30491
30492
30493 @subheading The @code{-file-list-symbol-files} Command
30494 @findex -file-list-symbol-files
30495
30496 @subsubheading Synopsis
30497
30498 @smallexample
30499 -file-list-symbol-files
30500 @end smallexample
30501
30502 List symbol files.
30503
30504 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30505
30506 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info file} (part of it).
30507
30508 @subsubheading Example
30509 N.A.
30510 @end ignore
30511
30512
30513 @subheading The @code{-file-symbol-file} Command
30514 @findex -file-symbol-file
30515
30516 @subsubheading Synopsis
30517
30518 @smallexample
30519 -file-symbol-file @var{file}
30520 @end smallexample
30521
30522 Read symbol table info from the specified @var{file} argument. When
30523 used without arguments, clears @value{GDBN}'s symbol table info. No output is
30524 produced, except for a completion notification.
30525
30526 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30527
30528 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{symbol-file}.
30529
30530 @subsubheading Example
30531
30532 @smallexample
30533 (gdb)
30534 -file-symbol-file /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/TRUNK/mbx/hello.mbx
30535 ^done
30536 (gdb)
30537 @end smallexample
30538
30539 @ignore
30540 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
30541 @node GDB/MI Memory Overlay Commands
30542 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Memory Overlay Commands
30543
30544 The memory overlay commands are not implemented.
30545
30546 @c @subheading -overlay-auto
30547
30548 @c @subheading -overlay-list-mapping-state
30549
30550 @c @subheading -overlay-list-overlays
30551
30552 @c @subheading -overlay-map
30553
30554 @c @subheading -overlay-off
30555
30556 @c @subheading -overlay-on
30557
30558 @c @subheading -overlay-unmap
30559
30560 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
30561 @node GDB/MI Signal Handling Commands
30562 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Signal Handling Commands
30563
30564 Signal handling commands are not implemented.
30565
30566 @c @subheading -signal-handle
30567
30568 @c @subheading -signal-list-handle-actions
30569
30570 @c @subheading -signal-list-signal-types
30571 @end ignore
30572
30573
30574 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
30575 @node GDB/MI Target Manipulation
30576 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Target Manipulation Commands
30577
30578
30579 @subheading The @code{-target-attach} Command
30580 @findex -target-attach
30581
30582 @subsubheading Synopsis
30583
30584 @smallexample
30585 -target-attach @var{pid} | @var{gid} | @var{file}
30586 @end smallexample
30587
30588 Attach to a process @var{pid} or a file @var{file} outside of
30589 @value{GDBN}, or a thread group @var{gid}. If attaching to a thread
30590 group, the id previously returned by
30591 @samp{-list-thread-groups --available} must be used.
30592
30593 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30594
30595 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{attach}.
30596
30597 @subsubheading Example
30598 @smallexample
30599 (gdb)
30600 -target-attach 34
30601 =thread-created,id="1"
30602 *stopped,thread-id="1",frame=@{addr="0xb7f7e410",func="bar",args=[]@}
30603 ^done
30604 (gdb)
30605 @end smallexample
30606
30607 @ignore
30608 @subheading The @code{-target-compare-sections} Command
30609 @findex -target-compare-sections
30610
30611 @subsubheading Synopsis
30612
30613 @smallexample
30614 -target-compare-sections [ @var{section} ]
30615 @end smallexample
30616
30617 Compare data of section @var{section} on target to the exec file.
30618 Without the argument, all sections are compared.
30619
30620 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30621
30622 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{compare-sections}.
30623
30624 @subsubheading Example
30625 N.A.
30626 @end ignore
30627
30628
30629 @subheading The @code{-target-detach} Command
30630 @findex -target-detach
30631
30632 @subsubheading Synopsis
30633
30634 @smallexample
30635 -target-detach [ @var{pid} | @var{gid} ]
30636 @end smallexample
30637
30638 Detach from the remote target which normally resumes its execution.
30639 If either @var{pid} or @var{gid} is specified, detaches from either
30640 the specified process, or specified thread group. There's no output.
30641
30642 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30643
30644 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{detach}.
30645
30646 @subsubheading Example
30647
30648 @smallexample
30649 (gdb)
30650 -target-detach
30651 ^done
30652 (gdb)
30653 @end smallexample
30654
30655
30656 @subheading The @code{-target-disconnect} Command
30657 @findex -target-disconnect
30658
30659 @subsubheading Synopsis
30660
30661 @smallexample
30662 -target-disconnect
30663 @end smallexample
30664
30665 Disconnect from the remote target. There's no output and the target is
30666 generally not resumed.
30667
30668 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30669
30670 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{disconnect}.
30671
30672 @subsubheading Example
30673
30674 @smallexample
30675 (gdb)
30676 -target-disconnect
30677 ^done
30678 (gdb)
30679 @end smallexample
30680
30681
30682 @subheading The @code{-target-download} Command
30683 @findex -target-download
30684
30685 @subsubheading Synopsis
30686
30687 @smallexample
30688 -target-download
30689 @end smallexample
30690
30691 Loads the executable onto the remote target.
30692 It prints out an update message every half second, which includes the fields:
30693
30694 @table @samp
30695 @item section
30696 The name of the section.
30697 @item section-sent
30698 The size of what has been sent so far for that section.
30699 @item section-size
30700 The size of the section.
30701 @item total-sent
30702 The total size of what was sent so far (the current and the previous sections).
30703 @item total-size
30704 The size of the overall executable to download.
30705 @end table
30706
30707 @noindent
30708 Each message is sent as status record (@pxref{GDB/MI Output Syntax, ,
30709 @sc{gdb/mi} Output Syntax}).
30710
30711 In addition, it prints the name and size of the sections, as they are
30712 downloaded. These messages include the following fields:
30713
30714 @table @samp
30715 @item section
30716 The name of the section.
30717 @item section-size
30718 The size of the section.
30719 @item total-size
30720 The size of the overall executable to download.
30721 @end table
30722
30723 @noindent
30724 At the end, a summary is printed.
30725
30726 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30727
30728 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{load}.
30729
30730 @subsubheading Example
30731
30732 Note: each status message appears on a single line. Here the messages
30733 have been broken down so that they can fit onto a page.
30734
30735 @smallexample
30736 (gdb)
30737 -target-download
30738 +download,@{section=".text",section-size="6668",total-size="9880"@}
30739 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="512",section-size="6668",
30740 total-sent="512",total-size="9880"@}
30741 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="1024",section-size="6668",
30742 total-sent="1024",total-size="9880"@}
30743 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="1536",section-size="6668",
30744 total-sent="1536",total-size="9880"@}
30745 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="2048",section-size="6668",
30746 total-sent="2048",total-size="9880"@}
30747 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="2560",section-size="6668",
30748 total-sent="2560",total-size="9880"@}
30749 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="3072",section-size="6668",
30750 total-sent="3072",total-size="9880"@}
30751 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="3584",section-size="6668",
30752 total-sent="3584",total-size="9880"@}
30753 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="4096",section-size="6668",
30754 total-sent="4096",total-size="9880"@}
30755 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="4608",section-size="6668",
30756 total-sent="4608",total-size="9880"@}
30757 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="5120",section-size="6668",
30758 total-sent="5120",total-size="9880"@}
30759 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="5632",section-size="6668",
30760 total-sent="5632",total-size="9880"@}
30761 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="6144",section-size="6668",
30762 total-sent="6144",total-size="9880"@}
30763 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="6656",section-size="6668",
30764 total-sent="6656",total-size="9880"@}
30765 +download,@{section=".init",section-size="28",total-size="9880"@}
30766 +download,@{section=".fini",section-size="28",total-size="9880"@}
30767 +download,@{section=".data",section-size="3156",total-size="9880"@}
30768 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="512",section-size="3156",
30769 total-sent="7236",total-size="9880"@}
30770 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="1024",section-size="3156",
30771 total-sent="7748",total-size="9880"@}
30772 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="1536",section-size="3156",
30773 total-sent="8260",total-size="9880"@}
30774 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="2048",section-size="3156",
30775 total-sent="8772",total-size="9880"@}
30776 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="2560",section-size="3156",
30777 total-sent="9284",total-size="9880"@}
30778 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="3072",section-size="3156",
30779 total-sent="9796",total-size="9880"@}
30780 ^done,address="0x10004",load-size="9880",transfer-rate="6586",
30781 write-rate="429"
30782 (gdb)
30783 @end smallexample
30784
30785
30786 @ignore
30787 @subheading The @code{-target-exec-status} Command
30788 @findex -target-exec-status
30789
30790 @subsubheading Synopsis
30791
30792 @smallexample
30793 -target-exec-status
30794 @end smallexample
30795
30796 Provide information on the state of the target (whether it is running or
30797 not, for instance).
30798
30799 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30800
30801 There's no equivalent @value{GDBN} command.
30802
30803 @subsubheading Example
30804 N.A.
30805
30806
30807 @subheading The @code{-target-list-available-targets} Command
30808 @findex -target-list-available-targets
30809
30810 @subsubheading Synopsis
30811
30812 @smallexample
30813 -target-list-available-targets
30814 @end smallexample
30815
30816 List the possible targets to connect to.
30817
30818 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30819
30820 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{help target}.
30821
30822 @subsubheading Example
30823 N.A.
30824
30825
30826 @subheading The @code{-target-list-current-targets} Command
30827 @findex -target-list-current-targets
30828
30829 @subsubheading Synopsis
30830
30831 @smallexample
30832 -target-list-current-targets
30833 @end smallexample
30834
30835 Describe the current target.
30836
30837 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30838
30839 The corresponding information is printed by @samp{info file} (among
30840 other things).
30841
30842 @subsubheading Example
30843 N.A.
30844
30845
30846 @subheading The @code{-target-list-parameters} Command
30847 @findex -target-list-parameters
30848
30849 @subsubheading Synopsis
30850
30851 @smallexample
30852 -target-list-parameters
30853 @end smallexample
30854
30855 @c ????
30856 @end ignore
30857
30858 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30859
30860 No equivalent.
30861
30862 @subsubheading Example
30863 N.A.
30864
30865
30866 @subheading The @code{-target-select} Command
30867 @findex -target-select
30868
30869 @subsubheading Synopsis
30870
30871 @smallexample
30872 -target-select @var{type} @var{parameters @dots{}}
30873 @end smallexample
30874
30875 Connect @value{GDBN} to the remote target. This command takes two args:
30876
30877 @table @samp
30878 @item @var{type}
30879 The type of target, for instance @samp{remote}, etc.
30880 @item @var{parameters}
30881 Device names, host names and the like. @xref{Target Commands, ,
30882 Commands for Managing Targets}, for more details.
30883 @end table
30884
30885 The output is a connection notification, followed by the address at
30886 which the target program is, in the following form:
30887
30888 @smallexample
30889 ^connected,addr="@var{address}",func="@var{function name}",
30890 args=[@var{arg list}]
30891 @end smallexample
30892
30893 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30894
30895 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{target}.
30896
30897 @subsubheading Example
30898
30899 @smallexample
30900 (gdb)
30901 -target-select remote /dev/ttya
30902 ^connected,addr="0xfe00a300",func="??",args=[]
30903 (gdb)
30904 @end smallexample
30905
30906 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
30907 @node GDB/MI File Transfer Commands
30908 @section @sc{gdb/mi} File Transfer Commands
30909
30910
30911 @subheading The @code{-target-file-put} Command
30912 @findex -target-file-put
30913
30914 @subsubheading Synopsis
30915
30916 @smallexample
30917 -target-file-put @var{hostfile} @var{targetfile}
30918 @end smallexample
30919
30920 Copy file @var{hostfile} from the host system (the machine running
30921 @value{GDBN}) to @var{targetfile} on the target system.
30922
30923 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30924
30925 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{remote put}.
30926
30927 @subsubheading Example
30928
30929 @smallexample
30930 (gdb)
30931 -target-file-put localfile remotefile
30932 ^done
30933 (gdb)
30934 @end smallexample
30935
30936
30937 @subheading The @code{-target-file-get} Command
30938 @findex -target-file-get
30939
30940 @subsubheading Synopsis
30941
30942 @smallexample
30943 -target-file-get @var{targetfile} @var{hostfile}
30944 @end smallexample
30945
30946 Copy file @var{targetfile} from the target system to @var{hostfile}
30947 on the host system.
30948
30949 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30950
30951 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{remote get}.
30952
30953 @subsubheading Example
30954
30955 @smallexample
30956 (gdb)
30957 -target-file-get remotefile localfile
30958 ^done
30959 (gdb)
30960 @end smallexample
30961
30962
30963 @subheading The @code{-target-file-delete} Command
30964 @findex -target-file-delete
30965
30966 @subsubheading Synopsis
30967
30968 @smallexample
30969 -target-file-delete @var{targetfile}
30970 @end smallexample
30971
30972 Delete @var{targetfile} from the target system.
30973
30974 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30975
30976 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{remote delete}.
30977
30978 @subsubheading Example
30979
30980 @smallexample
30981 (gdb)
30982 -target-file-delete remotefile
30983 ^done
30984 (gdb)
30985 @end smallexample
30986
30987
30988 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
30989 @node GDB/MI Miscellaneous Commands
30990 @section Miscellaneous @sc{gdb/mi} Commands
30991
30992 @c @subheading -gdb-complete
30993
30994 @subheading The @code{-gdb-exit} Command
30995 @findex -gdb-exit
30996
30997 @subsubheading Synopsis
30998
30999 @smallexample
31000 -gdb-exit
31001 @end smallexample
31002
31003 Exit @value{GDBN} immediately.
31004
31005 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31006
31007 Approximately corresponds to @samp{quit}.
31008
31009 @subsubheading Example
31010
31011 @smallexample
31012 (gdb)
31013 -gdb-exit
31014 ^exit
31015 @end smallexample
31016
31017
31018 @ignore
31019 @subheading The @code{-exec-abort} Command
31020 @findex -exec-abort
31021
31022 @subsubheading Synopsis
31023
31024 @smallexample
31025 -exec-abort
31026 @end smallexample
31027
31028 Kill the inferior running program.
31029
31030 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31031
31032 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{kill}.
31033
31034 @subsubheading Example
31035 N.A.
31036 @end ignore
31037
31038
31039 @subheading The @code{-gdb-set} Command
31040 @findex -gdb-set
31041
31042 @subsubheading Synopsis
31043
31044 @smallexample
31045 -gdb-set
31046 @end smallexample
31047
31048 Set an internal @value{GDBN} variable.
31049 @c IS THIS A DOLLAR VARIABLE? OR SOMETHING LIKE ANNOTATE ?????
31050
31051 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31052
31053 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{set}.
31054
31055 @subsubheading Example
31056
31057 @smallexample
31058 (gdb)
31059 -gdb-set $foo=3
31060 ^done
31061 (gdb)
31062 @end smallexample
31063
31064
31065 @subheading The @code{-gdb-show} Command
31066 @findex -gdb-show
31067
31068 @subsubheading Synopsis
31069
31070 @smallexample
31071 -gdb-show
31072 @end smallexample
31073
31074 Show the current value of a @value{GDBN} variable.
31075
31076 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31077
31078 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{show}.
31079
31080 @subsubheading Example
31081
31082 @smallexample
31083 (gdb)
31084 -gdb-show annotate
31085 ^done,value="0"
31086 (gdb)
31087 @end smallexample
31088
31089 @c @subheading -gdb-source
31090
31091
31092 @subheading The @code{-gdb-version} Command
31093 @findex -gdb-version
31094
31095 @subsubheading Synopsis
31096
31097 @smallexample
31098 -gdb-version
31099 @end smallexample
31100
31101 Show version information for @value{GDBN}. Used mostly in testing.
31102
31103 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31104
31105 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{show version}. @value{GDBN} by
31106 default shows this information when you start an interactive session.
31107
31108 @subsubheading Example
31109
31110 @c This example modifies the actual output from GDB to avoid overfull
31111 @c box in TeX.
31112 @smallexample
31113 (gdb)
31114 -gdb-version
31115 ~GNU gdb 5.2.1
31116 ~Copyright 2000 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
31117 ~GDB is free software, covered by the GNU General Public License, and
31118 ~you are welcome to change it and/or distribute copies of it under
31119 ~ certain conditions.
31120 ~Type "show copying" to see the conditions.
31121 ~There is absolutely no warranty for GDB. Type "show warranty" for
31122 ~ details.
31123 ~This GDB was configured as
31124 "--host=sparc-sun-solaris2.5.1 --target=ppc-eabi".
31125 ^done
31126 (gdb)
31127 @end smallexample
31128
31129 @subheading The @code{-list-features} Command
31130 @findex -list-features
31131
31132 Returns a list of particular features of the MI protocol that
31133 this version of gdb implements. A feature can be a command,
31134 or a new field in an output of some command, or even an
31135 important bugfix. While a frontend can sometimes detect presence
31136 of a feature at runtime, it is easier to perform detection at debugger
31137 startup.
31138
31139 The command returns a list of strings, with each string naming an
31140 available feature. Each returned string is just a name, it does not
31141 have any internal structure. The list of possible feature names
31142 is given below.
31143
31144 Example output:
31145
31146 @smallexample
31147 (gdb) -list-features
31148 ^done,result=["feature1","feature2"]
31149 @end smallexample
31150
31151 The current list of features is:
31152
31153 @table @samp
31154 @item frozen-varobjs
31155 Indicates support for the @code{-var-set-frozen} command, as well
31156 as possible presense of the @code{frozen} field in the output
31157 of @code{-varobj-create}.
31158 @item pending-breakpoints
31159 Indicates support for the @option{-f} option to the @code{-break-insert}
31160 command.
31161 @item python
31162 Indicates Python scripting support, Python-based
31163 pretty-printing commands, and possible presence of the
31164 @samp{display_hint} field in the output of @code{-var-list-children}
31165 @item thread-info
31166 Indicates support for the @code{-thread-info} command.
31167 @item data-read-memory-bytes
31168 Indicates support for the @code{-data-read-memory-bytes} and the
31169 @code{-data-write-memory-bytes} commands.
31170 @item breakpoint-notifications
31171 Indicates that changes to breakpoints and breakpoints created via the
31172 CLI will be announced via async records.
31173 @item ada-task-info
31174 Indicates support for the @code{-ada-task-info} command.
31175 @end table
31176
31177 @subheading The @code{-list-target-features} Command
31178 @findex -list-target-features
31179
31180 Returns a list of particular features that are supported by the
31181 target. Those features affect the permitted MI commands, but
31182 unlike the features reported by the @code{-list-features} command, the
31183 features depend on which target GDB is using at the moment. Whenever
31184 a target can change, due to commands such as @code{-target-select},
31185 @code{-target-attach} or @code{-exec-run}, the list of target features
31186 may change, and the frontend should obtain it again.
31187 Example output:
31188
31189 @smallexample
31190 (gdb) -list-features
31191 ^done,result=["async"]
31192 @end smallexample
31193
31194 The current list of features is:
31195
31196 @table @samp
31197 @item async
31198 Indicates that the target is capable of asynchronous command
31199 execution, which means that @value{GDBN} will accept further commands
31200 while the target is running.
31201
31202 @item reverse
31203 Indicates that the target is capable of reverse execution.
31204 @xref{Reverse Execution}, for more information.
31205
31206 @end table
31207
31208 @subheading The @code{-list-thread-groups} Command
31209 @findex -list-thread-groups
31210
31211 @subheading Synopsis
31212
31213 @smallexample
31214 -list-thread-groups [ --available ] [ --recurse 1 ] [ @var{group} ... ]
31215 @end smallexample
31216
31217 Lists thread groups (@pxref{Thread groups}). When a single thread
31218 group is passed as the argument, lists the children of that group.
31219 When several thread group are passed, lists information about those
31220 thread groups. Without any parameters, lists information about all
31221 top-level thread groups.
31222
31223 Normally, thread groups that are being debugged are reported.
31224 With the @samp{--available} option, @value{GDBN} reports thread groups
31225 available on the target.
31226
31227 The output of this command may have either a @samp{threads} result or
31228 a @samp{groups} result. The @samp{thread} result has a list of tuples
31229 as value, with each tuple describing a thread (@pxref{GDB/MI Thread
31230 Information}). The @samp{groups} result has a list of tuples as value,
31231 each tuple describing a thread group. If top-level groups are
31232 requested (that is, no parameter is passed), or when several groups
31233 are passed, the output always has a @samp{groups} result. The format
31234 of the @samp{group} result is described below.
31235
31236 To reduce the number of roundtrips it's possible to list thread groups
31237 together with their children, by passing the @samp{--recurse} option
31238 and the recursion depth. Presently, only recursion depth of 1 is
31239 permitted. If this option is present, then every reported thread group
31240 will also include its children, either as @samp{group} or
31241 @samp{threads} field.
31242
31243 In general, any combination of option and parameters is permitted, with
31244 the following caveats:
31245
31246 @itemize @bullet
31247 @item
31248 When a single thread group is passed, the output will typically
31249 be the @samp{threads} result. Because threads may not contain
31250 anything, the @samp{recurse} option will be ignored.
31251
31252 @item
31253 When the @samp{--available} option is passed, limited information may
31254 be available. In particular, the list of threads of a process might
31255 be inaccessible. Further, specifying specific thread groups might
31256 not give any performance advantage over listing all thread groups.
31257 The frontend should assume that @samp{-list-thread-groups --available}
31258 is always an expensive operation and cache the results.
31259
31260 @end itemize
31261
31262 The @samp{groups} result is a list of tuples, where each tuple may
31263 have the following fields:
31264
31265 @table @code
31266 @item id
31267 Identifier of the thread group. This field is always present.
31268 The identifier is an opaque string; frontends should not try to
31269 convert it to an integer, even though it might look like one.
31270
31271 @item type
31272 The type of the thread group. At present, only @samp{process} is a
31273 valid type.
31274
31275 @item pid
31276 The target-specific process identifier. This field is only present
31277 for thread groups of type @samp{process} and only if the process exists.
31278
31279 @item num_children
31280 The number of children this thread group has. This field may be
31281 absent for an available thread group.
31282
31283 @item threads
31284 This field has a list of tuples as value, each tuple describing a
31285 thread. It may be present if the @samp{--recurse} option is
31286 specified, and it's actually possible to obtain the threads.
31287
31288 @item cores
31289 This field is a list of integers, each identifying a core that one
31290 thread of the group is running on. This field may be absent if
31291 such information is not available.
31292
31293 @item executable
31294 The name of the executable file that corresponds to this thread group.
31295 The field is only present for thread groups of type @samp{process},
31296 and only if there is a corresponding executable file.
31297
31298 @end table
31299
31300 @subheading Example
31301
31302 @smallexample
31303 @value{GDBP}
31304 -list-thread-groups
31305 ^done,groups=[@{id="17",type="process",pid="yyy",num_children="2"@}]
31306 -list-thread-groups 17
31307 ^done,threads=[@{id="2",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90 (LWP 21257)",
31308 frame=@{level="0",addr="0xffffe410",func="__kernel_vsyscall",args=[]@},state="running"@},
31309 @{id="1",target-id="Thread 0xb7e156b0 (LWP 21254)",
31310 frame=@{level="0",addr="0x0804891f",func="foo",args=[@{name="i",value="10"@}],
31311 file="/tmp/a.c",fullname="/tmp/a.c",line="158"@},state="running"@}]]
31312 -list-thread-groups --available
31313 ^done,groups=[@{id="17",type="process",pid="yyy",num_children="2",cores=[1,2]@}]
31314 -list-thread-groups --available --recurse 1
31315 ^done,groups=[@{id="17", types="process",pid="yyy",num_children="2",cores=[1,2],
31316 threads=[@{id="1",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90",cores=[1]@},
31317 @{id="2",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90",cores=[2]@}]@},..]
31318 -list-thread-groups --available --recurse 1 17 18
31319 ^done,groups=[@{id="17", types="process",pid="yyy",num_children="2",cores=[1,2],
31320 threads=[@{id="1",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90",cores=[1]@},
31321 @{id="2",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90",cores=[2]@}]@},...]
31322 @end smallexample
31323
31324
31325 @subheading The @code{-add-inferior} Command
31326 @findex -add-inferior
31327
31328 @subheading Synopsis
31329
31330 @smallexample
31331 -add-inferior
31332 @end smallexample
31333
31334 Creates a new inferior (@pxref{Inferiors and Programs}). The created
31335 inferior is not associated with any executable. Such association may
31336 be established with the @samp{-file-exec-and-symbols} command
31337 (@pxref{GDB/MI File Commands}). The command response has a single
31338 field, @samp{thread-group}, whose value is the identifier of the
31339 thread group corresponding to the new inferior.
31340
31341 @subheading Example
31342
31343 @smallexample
31344 @value{GDBP}
31345 -add-inferior
31346 ^done,thread-group="i3"
31347 @end smallexample
31348
31349 @subheading The @code{-interpreter-exec} Command
31350 @findex -interpreter-exec
31351
31352 @subheading Synopsis
31353
31354 @smallexample
31355 -interpreter-exec @var{interpreter} @var{command}
31356 @end smallexample
31357 @anchor{-interpreter-exec}
31358
31359 Execute the specified @var{command} in the given @var{interpreter}.
31360
31361 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
31362
31363 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{interpreter-exec}.
31364
31365 @subheading Example
31366
31367 @smallexample
31368 (gdb)
31369 -interpreter-exec console "break main"
31370 &"During symbol reading, couldn't parse type; debugger out of date?.\n"
31371 &"During symbol reading, bad structure-type format.\n"
31372 ~"Breakpoint 1 at 0x8074fc6: file ../../src/gdb/main.c, line 743.\n"
31373 ^done
31374 (gdb)
31375 @end smallexample
31376
31377 @subheading The @code{-inferior-tty-set} Command
31378 @findex -inferior-tty-set
31379
31380 @subheading Synopsis
31381
31382 @smallexample
31383 -inferior-tty-set /dev/pts/1
31384 @end smallexample
31385
31386 Set terminal for future runs of the program being debugged.
31387
31388 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
31389
31390 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{set inferior-tty} /dev/pts/1.
31391
31392 @subheading Example
31393
31394 @smallexample
31395 (gdb)
31396 -inferior-tty-set /dev/pts/1
31397 ^done
31398 (gdb)
31399 @end smallexample
31400
31401 @subheading The @code{-inferior-tty-show} Command
31402 @findex -inferior-tty-show
31403
31404 @subheading Synopsis
31405
31406 @smallexample
31407 -inferior-tty-show
31408 @end smallexample
31409
31410 Show terminal for future runs of program being debugged.
31411
31412 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
31413
31414 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{show inferior-tty}.
31415
31416 @subheading Example
31417
31418 @smallexample
31419 (gdb)
31420 -inferior-tty-set /dev/pts/1
31421 ^done
31422 (gdb)
31423 -inferior-tty-show
31424 ^done,inferior_tty_terminal="/dev/pts/1"
31425 (gdb)
31426 @end smallexample
31427
31428 @subheading The @code{-enable-timings} Command
31429 @findex -enable-timings
31430
31431 @subheading Synopsis
31432
31433 @smallexample
31434 -enable-timings [yes | no]
31435 @end smallexample
31436
31437 Toggle the printing of the wallclock, user and system times for an MI
31438 command as a field in its output. This command is to help frontend
31439 developers optimize the performance of their code. No argument is
31440 equivalent to @samp{yes}.
31441
31442 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
31443
31444 No equivalent.
31445
31446 @subheading Example
31447
31448 @smallexample
31449 (gdb)
31450 -enable-timings
31451 ^done
31452 (gdb)
31453 -break-insert main
31454 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
31455 addr="0x080484ed",func="main",file="myprog.c",
31456 fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="73",times="0"@},
31457 time=@{wallclock="0.05185",user="0.00800",system="0.00000"@}
31458 (gdb)
31459 -enable-timings no
31460 ^done
31461 (gdb)
31462 -exec-run
31463 ^running
31464 (gdb)
31465 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",thread-id="0",
31466 frame=@{addr="0x080484ed",func="main",args=[@{name="argc",value="1"@},
31467 @{name="argv",value="0xbfb60364"@}],file="myprog.c",
31468 fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="73"@}
31469 (gdb)
31470 @end smallexample
31471
31472 @node Annotations
31473 @chapter @value{GDBN} Annotations
31474
31475 This chapter describes annotations in @value{GDBN}. Annotations were
31476 designed to interface @value{GDBN} to graphical user interfaces or other
31477 similar programs which want to interact with @value{GDBN} at a
31478 relatively high level.
31479
31480 The annotation mechanism has largely been superseded by @sc{gdb/mi}
31481 (@pxref{GDB/MI}).
31482
31483 @ignore
31484 This is Edition @value{EDITION}, @value{DATE}.
31485 @end ignore
31486
31487 @menu
31488 * Annotations Overview:: What annotations are; the general syntax.
31489 * Server Prefix:: Issuing a command without affecting user state.
31490 * Prompting:: Annotations marking @value{GDBN}'s need for input.
31491 * Errors:: Annotations for error messages.
31492 * Invalidation:: Some annotations describe things now invalid.
31493 * Annotations for Running::
31494 Whether the program is running, how it stopped, etc.
31495 * Source Annotations:: Annotations describing source code.
31496 @end menu
31497
31498 @node Annotations Overview
31499 @section What is an Annotation?
31500 @cindex annotations
31501
31502 Annotations start with a newline character, two @samp{control-z}
31503 characters, and the name of the annotation. If there is no additional
31504 information associated with this annotation, the name of the annotation
31505 is followed immediately by a newline. If there is additional
31506 information, the name of the annotation is followed by a space, the
31507 additional information, and a newline. The additional information
31508 cannot contain newline characters.
31509
31510 Any output not beginning with a newline and two @samp{control-z}
31511 characters denotes literal output from @value{GDBN}. Currently there is
31512 no need for @value{GDBN} to output a newline followed by two
31513 @samp{control-z} characters, but if there was such a need, the
31514 annotations could be extended with an @samp{escape} annotation which
31515 means those three characters as output.
31516
31517 The annotation @var{level}, which is specified using the
31518 @option{--annotate} command line option (@pxref{Mode Options}), controls
31519 how much information @value{GDBN} prints together with its prompt,
31520 values of expressions, source lines, and other types of output. Level 0
31521 is for no annotations, level 1 is for use when @value{GDBN} is run as a
31522 subprocess of @sc{gnu} Emacs, level 3 is the maximum annotation suitable
31523 for programs that control @value{GDBN}, and level 2 annotations have
31524 been made obsolete (@pxref{Limitations, , Limitations of the Annotation
31525 Interface, annotate, GDB's Obsolete Annotations}).
31526
31527 @table @code
31528 @kindex set annotate
31529 @item set annotate @var{level}
31530 The @value{GDBN} command @code{set annotate} sets the level of
31531 annotations to the specified @var{level}.
31532
31533 @item show annotate
31534 @kindex show annotate
31535 Show the current annotation level.
31536 @end table
31537
31538 This chapter describes level 3 annotations.
31539
31540 A simple example of starting up @value{GDBN} with annotations is:
31541
31542 @smallexample
31543 $ @kbd{gdb --annotate=3}
31544 GNU gdb 6.0
31545 Copyright 2003 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
31546 GDB is free software, covered by the GNU General Public License,
31547 and you are welcome to change it and/or distribute copies of it
31548 under certain conditions.
31549 Type "show copying" to see the conditions.
31550 There is absolutely no warranty for GDB. Type "show warranty"
31551 for details.
31552 This GDB was configured as "i386-pc-linux-gnu"
31553
31554 ^Z^Zpre-prompt
31555 (@value{GDBP})
31556 ^Z^Zprompt
31557 @kbd{quit}
31558
31559 ^Z^Zpost-prompt
31560 $
31561 @end smallexample
31562
31563 Here @samp{quit} is input to @value{GDBN}; the rest is output from
31564 @value{GDBN}. The three lines beginning @samp{^Z^Z} (where @samp{^Z}
31565 denotes a @samp{control-z} character) are annotations; the rest is
31566 output from @value{GDBN}.
31567
31568 @node Server Prefix
31569 @section The Server Prefix
31570 @cindex server prefix
31571
31572 If you prefix a command with @samp{server } then it will not affect
31573 the command history, nor will it affect @value{GDBN}'s notion of which
31574 command to repeat if @key{RET} is pressed on a line by itself. This
31575 means that commands can be run behind a user's back by a front-end in
31576 a transparent manner.
31577
31578 The @code{server } prefix does not affect the recording of values into
31579 the value history; to print a value without recording it into the
31580 value history, use the @code{output} command instead of the
31581 @code{print} command.
31582
31583 Using this prefix also disables confirmation requests
31584 (@pxref{confirmation requests}).
31585
31586 @node Prompting
31587 @section Annotation for @value{GDBN} Input
31588
31589 @cindex annotations for prompts
31590 When @value{GDBN} prompts for input, it annotates this fact so it is possible
31591 to know when to send output, when the output from a given command is
31592 over, etc.
31593
31594 Different kinds of input each have a different @dfn{input type}. Each
31595 input type has three annotations: a @code{pre-} annotation, which
31596 denotes the beginning of any prompt which is being output, a plain
31597 annotation, which denotes the end of the prompt, and then a @code{post-}
31598 annotation which denotes the end of any echo which may (or may not) be
31599 associated with the input. For example, the @code{prompt} input type
31600 features the following annotations:
31601
31602 @smallexample
31603 ^Z^Zpre-prompt
31604 ^Z^Zprompt
31605 ^Z^Zpost-prompt
31606 @end smallexample
31607
31608 The input types are
31609
31610 @table @code
31611 @findex pre-prompt annotation
31612 @findex prompt annotation
31613 @findex post-prompt annotation
31614 @item prompt
31615 When @value{GDBN} is prompting for a command (the main @value{GDBN} prompt).
31616
31617 @findex pre-commands annotation
31618 @findex commands annotation
31619 @findex post-commands annotation
31620 @item commands
31621 When @value{GDBN} prompts for a set of commands, like in the @code{commands}
31622 command. The annotations are repeated for each command which is input.
31623
31624 @findex pre-overload-choice annotation
31625 @findex overload-choice annotation
31626 @findex post-overload-choice annotation
31627 @item overload-choice
31628 When @value{GDBN} wants the user to select between various overloaded functions.
31629
31630 @findex pre-query annotation
31631 @findex query annotation
31632 @findex post-query annotation
31633 @item query
31634 When @value{GDBN} wants the user to confirm a potentially dangerous operation.
31635
31636 @findex pre-prompt-for-continue annotation
31637 @findex prompt-for-continue annotation
31638 @findex post-prompt-for-continue annotation
31639 @item prompt-for-continue
31640 When @value{GDBN} is asking the user to press return to continue. Note: Don't
31641 expect this to work well; instead use @code{set height 0} to disable
31642 prompting. This is because the counting of lines is buggy in the
31643 presence of annotations.
31644 @end table
31645
31646 @node Errors
31647 @section Errors
31648 @cindex annotations for errors, warnings and interrupts
31649
31650 @findex quit annotation
31651 @smallexample
31652 ^Z^Zquit
31653 @end smallexample
31654
31655 This annotation occurs right before @value{GDBN} responds to an interrupt.
31656
31657 @findex error annotation
31658 @smallexample
31659 ^Z^Zerror
31660 @end smallexample
31661
31662 This annotation occurs right before @value{GDBN} responds to an error.
31663
31664 Quit and error annotations indicate that any annotations which @value{GDBN} was
31665 in the middle of may end abruptly. For example, if a
31666 @code{value-history-begin} annotation is followed by a @code{error}, one
31667 cannot expect to receive the matching @code{value-history-end}. One
31668 cannot expect not to receive it either, however; an error annotation
31669 does not necessarily mean that @value{GDBN} is immediately returning all the way
31670 to the top level.
31671
31672 @findex error-begin annotation
31673 A quit or error annotation may be preceded by
31674
31675 @smallexample
31676 ^Z^Zerror-begin
31677 @end smallexample
31678
31679 Any output between that and the quit or error annotation is the error
31680 message.
31681
31682 Warning messages are not yet annotated.
31683 @c If we want to change that, need to fix warning(), type_error(),
31684 @c range_error(), and possibly other places.
31685
31686 @node Invalidation
31687 @section Invalidation Notices
31688
31689 @cindex annotations for invalidation messages
31690 The following annotations say that certain pieces of state may have
31691 changed.
31692
31693 @table @code
31694 @findex frames-invalid annotation
31695 @item ^Z^Zframes-invalid
31696
31697 The frames (for example, output from the @code{backtrace} command) may
31698 have changed.
31699
31700 @findex breakpoints-invalid annotation
31701 @item ^Z^Zbreakpoints-invalid
31702
31703 The breakpoints may have changed. For example, the user just added or
31704 deleted a breakpoint.
31705 @end table
31706
31707 @node Annotations for Running
31708 @section Running the Program
31709 @cindex annotations for running programs
31710
31711 @findex starting annotation
31712 @findex stopping annotation
31713 When the program starts executing due to a @value{GDBN} command such as
31714 @code{step} or @code{continue},
31715
31716 @smallexample
31717 ^Z^Zstarting
31718 @end smallexample
31719
31720 is output. When the program stops,
31721
31722 @smallexample
31723 ^Z^Zstopped
31724 @end smallexample
31725
31726 is output. Before the @code{stopped} annotation, a variety of
31727 annotations describe how the program stopped.
31728
31729 @table @code
31730 @findex exited annotation
31731 @item ^Z^Zexited @var{exit-status}
31732 The program exited, and @var{exit-status} is the exit status (zero for
31733 successful exit, otherwise nonzero).
31734
31735 @findex signalled annotation
31736 @findex signal-name annotation
31737 @findex signal-name-end annotation
31738 @findex signal-string annotation
31739 @findex signal-string-end annotation
31740 @item ^Z^Zsignalled
31741 The program exited with a signal. After the @code{^Z^Zsignalled}, the
31742 annotation continues:
31743
31744 @smallexample
31745 @var{intro-text}
31746 ^Z^Zsignal-name
31747 @var{name}
31748 ^Z^Zsignal-name-end
31749 @var{middle-text}
31750 ^Z^Zsignal-string
31751 @var{string}
31752 ^Z^Zsignal-string-end
31753 @var{end-text}
31754 @end smallexample
31755
31756 @noindent
31757 where @var{name} is the name of the signal, such as @code{SIGILL} or
31758 @code{SIGSEGV}, and @var{string} is the explanation of the signal, such
31759 as @code{Illegal Instruction} or @code{Segmentation fault}.
31760 @var{intro-text}, @var{middle-text}, and @var{end-text} are for the
31761 user's benefit and have no particular format.
31762
31763 @findex signal annotation
31764 @item ^Z^Zsignal
31765 The syntax of this annotation is just like @code{signalled}, but @value{GDBN} is
31766 just saying that the program received the signal, not that it was
31767 terminated with it.
31768
31769 @findex breakpoint annotation
31770 @item ^Z^Zbreakpoint @var{number}
31771 The program hit breakpoint number @var{number}.
31772
31773 @findex watchpoint annotation
31774 @item ^Z^Zwatchpoint @var{number}
31775 The program hit watchpoint number @var{number}.
31776 @end table
31777
31778 @node Source Annotations
31779 @section Displaying Source
31780 @cindex annotations for source display
31781
31782 @findex source annotation
31783 The following annotation is used instead of displaying source code:
31784
31785 @smallexample
31786 ^Z^Zsource @var{filename}:@var{line}:@var{character}:@var{middle}:@var{addr}
31787 @end smallexample
31788
31789 where @var{filename} is an absolute file name indicating which source
31790 file, @var{line} is the line number within that file (where 1 is the
31791 first line in the file), @var{character} is the character position
31792 within the file (where 0 is the first character in the file) (for most
31793 debug formats this will necessarily point to the beginning of a line),
31794 @var{middle} is @samp{middle} if @var{addr} is in the middle of the
31795 line, or @samp{beg} if @var{addr} is at the beginning of the line, and
31796 @var{addr} is the address in the target program associated with the
31797 source which is being displayed. @var{addr} is in the form @samp{0x}
31798 followed by one or more lowercase hex digits (note that this does not
31799 depend on the language).
31800
31801 @node JIT Interface
31802 @chapter JIT Compilation Interface
31803 @cindex just-in-time compilation
31804 @cindex JIT compilation interface
31805
31806 This chapter documents @value{GDBN}'s @dfn{just-in-time} (JIT) compilation
31807 interface. A JIT compiler is a program or library that generates native
31808 executable code at runtime and executes it, usually in order to achieve good
31809 performance while maintaining platform independence.
31810
31811 Programs that use JIT compilation are normally difficult to debug because
31812 portions of their code are generated at runtime, instead of being loaded from
31813 object files, which is where @value{GDBN} normally finds the program's symbols
31814 and debug information. In order to debug programs that use JIT compilation,
31815 @value{GDBN} has an interface that allows the program to register in-memory
31816 symbol files with @value{GDBN} at runtime.
31817
31818 If you are using @value{GDBN} to debug a program that uses this interface, then
31819 it should work transparently so long as you have not stripped the binary. If
31820 you are developing a JIT compiler, then the interface is documented in the rest
31821 of this chapter. At this time, the only known client of this interface is the
31822 LLVM JIT.
31823
31824 Broadly speaking, the JIT interface mirrors the dynamic loader interface. The
31825 JIT compiler communicates with @value{GDBN} by writing data into a global
31826 variable and calling a fuction at a well-known symbol. When @value{GDBN}
31827 attaches, it reads a linked list of symbol files from the global variable to
31828 find existing code, and puts a breakpoint in the function so that it can find
31829 out about additional code.
31830
31831 @menu
31832 * Declarations:: Relevant C struct declarations
31833 * Registering Code:: Steps to register code
31834 * Unregistering Code:: Steps to unregister code
31835 * Custom Debug Info:: Emit debug information in a custom format
31836 @end menu
31837
31838 @node Declarations
31839 @section JIT Declarations
31840
31841 These are the relevant struct declarations that a C program should include to
31842 implement the interface:
31843
31844 @smallexample
31845 typedef enum
31846 @{
31847 JIT_NOACTION = 0,
31848 JIT_REGISTER_FN,
31849 JIT_UNREGISTER_FN
31850 @} jit_actions_t;
31851
31852 struct jit_code_entry
31853 @{
31854 struct jit_code_entry *next_entry;
31855 struct jit_code_entry *prev_entry;
31856 const char *symfile_addr;
31857 uint64_t symfile_size;
31858 @};
31859
31860 struct jit_descriptor
31861 @{
31862 uint32_t version;
31863 /* This type should be jit_actions_t, but we use uint32_t
31864 to be explicit about the bitwidth. */
31865 uint32_t action_flag;
31866 struct jit_code_entry *relevant_entry;
31867 struct jit_code_entry *first_entry;
31868 @};
31869
31870 /* GDB puts a breakpoint in this function. */
31871 void __attribute__((noinline)) __jit_debug_register_code() @{ @};
31872
31873 /* Make sure to specify the version statically, because the
31874 debugger may check the version before we can set it. */
31875 struct jit_descriptor __jit_debug_descriptor = @{ 1, 0, 0, 0 @};
31876 @end smallexample
31877
31878 If the JIT is multi-threaded, then it is important that the JIT synchronize any
31879 modifications to this global data properly, which can easily be done by putting
31880 a global mutex around modifications to these structures.
31881
31882 @node Registering Code
31883 @section Registering Code
31884
31885 To register code with @value{GDBN}, the JIT should follow this protocol:
31886
31887 @itemize @bullet
31888 @item
31889 Generate an object file in memory with symbols and other desired debug
31890 information. The file must include the virtual addresses of the sections.
31891
31892 @item
31893 Create a code entry for the file, which gives the start and size of the symbol
31894 file.
31895
31896 @item
31897 Add it to the linked list in the JIT descriptor.
31898
31899 @item
31900 Point the relevant_entry field of the descriptor at the entry.
31901
31902 @item
31903 Set @code{action_flag} to @code{JIT_REGISTER} and call
31904 @code{__jit_debug_register_code}.
31905 @end itemize
31906
31907 When @value{GDBN} is attached and the breakpoint fires, @value{GDBN} uses the
31908 @code{relevant_entry} pointer so it doesn't have to walk the list looking for
31909 new code. However, the linked list must still be maintained in order to allow
31910 @value{GDBN} to attach to a running process and still find the symbol files.
31911
31912 @node Unregistering Code
31913 @section Unregistering Code
31914
31915 If code is freed, then the JIT should use the following protocol:
31916
31917 @itemize @bullet
31918 @item
31919 Remove the code entry corresponding to the code from the linked list.
31920
31921 @item
31922 Point the @code{relevant_entry} field of the descriptor at the code entry.
31923
31924 @item
31925 Set @code{action_flag} to @code{JIT_UNREGISTER} and call
31926 @code{__jit_debug_register_code}.
31927 @end itemize
31928
31929 If the JIT frees or recompiles code without unregistering it, then @value{GDBN}
31930 and the JIT will leak the memory used for the associated symbol files.
31931
31932 @node Custom Debug Info
31933 @section Custom Debug Info
31934 @cindex custom JIT debug info
31935 @cindex JIT debug info reader
31936
31937 Generating debug information in platform-native file formats (like ELF
31938 or COFF) may be an overkill for JIT compilers; especially if all the
31939 debug info is used for is displaying a meaningful backtrace. The
31940 issue can be resolved by having the JIT writers decide on a debug info
31941 format and also provide a reader that parses the debug info generated
31942 by the JIT compiler. This section gives a brief overview on writing
31943 such a parser. More specific details can be found in the source file
31944 @file{gdb/jit-reader.in}, which is also installed as a header at
31945 @file{@var{includedir}/gdb/jit-reader.h} for easy inclusion.
31946
31947 The reader is implemented as a shared object (so this functionality is
31948 not available on platforms which don't allow loading shared objects at
31949 runtime). Two @value{GDBN} commands, @code{jit-reader-load} and
31950 @code{jit-reader-unload} are provided, to be used to load and unload
31951 the readers from a preconfigured directory. Once loaded, the shared
31952 object is used the parse the debug information emitted by the JIT
31953 compiler.
31954
31955 @menu
31956 * Using JIT Debug Info Readers:: How to use supplied readers correctly
31957 * Writing JIT Debug Info Readers:: Creating a debug-info reader
31958 @end menu
31959
31960 @node Using JIT Debug Info Readers
31961 @subsection Using JIT Debug Info Readers
31962 @kindex jit-reader-load
31963 @kindex jit-reader-unload
31964
31965 Readers can be loaded and unloaded using the @code{jit-reader-load}
31966 and @code{jit-reader-unload} commands.
31967
31968 @table @code
31969 @item jit-reader-load @var{reader-name}
31970 Load the JIT reader named @var{reader-name}. On a UNIX system, this
31971 will usually load @file{@var{libdir}/gdb/@var{reader-name}}, where
31972 @var{libdir} is the system library directory, usually
31973 @file{/usr/local/lib}. Only one reader can be active at a time;
31974 trying to load a second reader when one is already loaded will result
31975 in @value{GDBN} reporting an error. A new JIT reader can be loaded by
31976 first unloading the current one using @code{jit-reader-load} and then
31977 invoking @code{jit-reader-load}.
31978
31979 @item jit-reader-unload
31980 Unload the currently loaded JIT reader.
31981
31982 @end table
31983
31984 @node Writing JIT Debug Info Readers
31985 @subsection Writing JIT Debug Info Readers
31986 @cindex writing JIT debug info readers
31987
31988 As mentioned, a reader is essentially a shared object conforming to a
31989 certain ABI. This ABI is described in @file{jit-reader.h}.
31990
31991 @file{jit-reader.h} defines the structures, macros and functions
31992 required to write a reader. It is installed (along with
31993 @value{GDBN}), in @file{@var{includedir}/gdb} where @var{includedir} is
31994 the system include directory.
31995
31996 Readers need to be released under a GPL compatible license. A reader
31997 can be declared as released under such a license by placing the macro
31998 @code{GDB_DECLARE_GPL_COMPATIBLE_READER} in a source file.
31999
32000 The entry point for readers is the symbol @code{gdb_init_reader},
32001 which is expected to be a function with the prototype
32002
32003 @findex gdb_init_reader
32004 @smallexample
32005 extern struct gdb_reader_funcs *gdb_init_reader (void);
32006 @end smallexample
32007
32008 @cindex @code{struct gdb_reader_funcs}
32009
32010 @code{struct gdb_reader_funcs} contains a set of pointers to callback
32011 functions. These functions are executed to read the debug info
32012 generated by the JIT compiler (@code{read}), to unwind stack frames
32013 (@code{unwind}) and to create canonical frame IDs
32014 (@code{get_Frame_id}). It also has a callback that is called when the
32015 reader is being unloaded (@code{destroy}). The struct looks like this
32016
32017 @smallexample
32018 struct gdb_reader_funcs
32019 @{
32020 /* Must be set to GDB_READER_INTERFACE_VERSION. */
32021 int reader_version;
32022
32023 /* For use by the reader. */
32024 void *priv_data;
32025
32026 gdb_read_debug_info *read;
32027 gdb_unwind_frame *unwind;
32028 gdb_get_frame_id *get_frame_id;
32029 gdb_destroy_reader *destroy;
32030 @};
32031 @end smallexample
32032
32033 @cindex @code{struct gdb_symbol_callbacks}
32034 @cindex @code{struct gdb_unwind_callbacks}
32035
32036 The callbacks are provided with another set of callbacks by
32037 @value{GDBN} to do their job. For @code{read}, these callbacks are
32038 passed in a @code{struct gdb_symbol_callbacks} and for @code{unwind}
32039 and @code{get_frame_id}, in a @code{struct gdb_unwind_callbacks}.
32040 @code{struct gdb_symbol_callbacks} has callbacks to create new object
32041 files and new symbol tables inside those object files. @code{struct
32042 gdb_unwind_callbacks} has callbacks to read registers off the current
32043 frame and to write out the values of the registers in the previous
32044 frame. Both have a callback (@code{target_read}) to read bytes off the
32045 target's address space.
32046
32047 @node GDB Bugs
32048 @chapter Reporting Bugs in @value{GDBN}
32049 @cindex bugs in @value{GDBN}
32050 @cindex reporting bugs in @value{GDBN}
32051
32052 Your bug reports play an essential role in making @value{GDBN} reliable.
32053
32054 Reporting a bug may help you by bringing a solution to your problem, or it
32055 may not. But in any case the principal function of a bug report is to help
32056 the entire community by making the next version of @value{GDBN} work better. Bug
32057 reports are your contribution to the maintenance of @value{GDBN}.
32058
32059 In order for a bug report to serve its purpose, you must include the
32060 information that enables us to fix the bug.
32061
32062 @menu
32063 * Bug Criteria:: Have you found a bug?
32064 * Bug Reporting:: How to report bugs
32065 @end menu
32066
32067 @node Bug Criteria
32068 @section Have You Found a Bug?
32069 @cindex bug criteria
32070
32071 If you are not sure whether you have found a bug, here are some guidelines:
32072
32073 @itemize @bullet
32074 @cindex fatal signal
32075 @cindex debugger crash
32076 @cindex crash of debugger
32077 @item
32078 If the debugger gets a fatal signal, for any input whatever, that is a
32079 @value{GDBN} bug. Reliable debuggers never crash.
32080
32081 @cindex error on valid input
32082 @item
32083 If @value{GDBN} produces an error message for valid input, that is a
32084 bug. (Note that if you're cross debugging, the problem may also be
32085 somewhere in the connection to the target.)
32086
32087 @cindex invalid input
32088 @item
32089 If @value{GDBN} does not produce an error message for invalid input,
32090 that is a bug. However, you should note that your idea of
32091 ``invalid input'' might be our idea of ``an extension'' or ``support
32092 for traditional practice''.
32093
32094 @item
32095 If you are an experienced user of debugging tools, your suggestions
32096 for improvement of @value{GDBN} are welcome in any case.
32097 @end itemize
32098
32099 @node Bug Reporting
32100 @section How to Report Bugs
32101 @cindex bug reports
32102 @cindex @value{GDBN} bugs, reporting
32103
32104 A number of companies and individuals offer support for @sc{gnu} products.
32105 If you obtained @value{GDBN} from a support organization, we recommend you
32106 contact that organization first.
32107
32108 You can find contact information for many support companies and
32109 individuals in the file @file{etc/SERVICE} in the @sc{gnu} Emacs
32110 distribution.
32111 @c should add a web page ref...
32112
32113 @ifset BUGURL
32114 @ifset BUGURL_DEFAULT
32115 In any event, we also recommend that you submit bug reports for
32116 @value{GDBN}. The preferred method is to submit them directly using
32117 @uref{http://www.gnu.org/software/gdb/bugs/, @value{GDBN}'s Bugs web
32118 page}. Alternatively, the @email{bug-gdb@@gnu.org, e-mail gateway} can
32119 be used.
32120
32121 @strong{Do not send bug reports to @samp{info-gdb}, or to
32122 @samp{help-gdb}, or to any newsgroups.} Most users of @value{GDBN} do
32123 not want to receive bug reports. Those that do have arranged to receive
32124 @samp{bug-gdb}.
32125
32126 The mailing list @samp{bug-gdb} has a newsgroup @samp{gnu.gdb.bug} which
32127 serves as a repeater. The mailing list and the newsgroup carry exactly
32128 the same messages. Often people think of posting bug reports to the
32129 newsgroup instead of mailing them. This appears to work, but it has one
32130 problem which can be crucial: a newsgroup posting often lacks a mail
32131 path back to the sender. Thus, if we need to ask for more information,
32132 we may be unable to reach you. For this reason, it is better to send
32133 bug reports to the mailing list.
32134 @end ifset
32135 @ifclear BUGURL_DEFAULT
32136 In any event, we also recommend that you submit bug reports for
32137 @value{GDBN} to @value{BUGURL}.
32138 @end ifclear
32139 @end ifset
32140
32141 The fundamental principle of reporting bugs usefully is this:
32142 @strong{report all the facts}. If you are not sure whether to state a
32143 fact or leave it out, state it!
32144
32145 Often people omit facts because they think they know what causes the
32146 problem and assume that some details do not matter. Thus, you might
32147 assume that the name of the variable you use in an example does not matter.
32148 Well, probably it does not, but one cannot be sure. Perhaps the bug is a
32149 stray memory reference which happens to fetch from the location where that
32150 name is stored in memory; perhaps, if the name were different, the contents
32151 of that location would fool the debugger into doing the right thing despite
32152 the bug. Play it safe and give a specific, complete example. That is the
32153 easiest thing for you to do, and the most helpful.
32154
32155 Keep in mind that the purpose of a bug report is to enable us to fix the
32156 bug. It may be that the bug has been reported previously, but neither
32157 you nor we can know that unless your bug report is complete and
32158 self-contained.
32159
32160 Sometimes people give a few sketchy facts and ask, ``Does this ring a
32161 bell?'' Those bug reports are useless, and we urge everyone to
32162 @emph{refuse to respond to them} except to chide the sender to report
32163 bugs properly.
32164
32165 To enable us to fix the bug, you should include all these things:
32166
32167 @itemize @bullet
32168 @item
32169 The version of @value{GDBN}. @value{GDBN} announces it if you start
32170 with no arguments; you can also print it at any time using @code{show
32171 version}.
32172
32173 Without this, we will not know whether there is any point in looking for
32174 the bug in the current version of @value{GDBN}.
32175
32176 @item
32177 The type of machine you are using, and the operating system name and
32178 version number.
32179
32180 @item
32181 What compiler (and its version) was used to compile @value{GDBN}---e.g.@:
32182 ``@value{GCC}--2.8.1''.
32183
32184 @item
32185 What compiler (and its version) was used to compile the program you are
32186 debugging---e.g.@: ``@value{GCC}--2.8.1'', or ``HP92453-01 A.10.32.03 HP
32187 C Compiler''. For @value{NGCC}, you can say @kbd{@value{GCC} --version}
32188 to get this information; for other compilers, see the documentation for
32189 those compilers.
32190
32191 @item
32192 The command arguments you gave the compiler to compile your example and
32193 observe the bug. For example, did you use @samp{-O}? To guarantee
32194 you will not omit something important, list them all. A copy of the
32195 Makefile (or the output from make) is sufficient.
32196
32197 If we were to try to guess the arguments, we would probably guess wrong
32198 and then we might not encounter the bug.
32199
32200 @item
32201 A complete input script, and all necessary source files, that will
32202 reproduce the bug.
32203
32204 @item
32205 A description of what behavior you observe that you believe is
32206 incorrect. For example, ``It gets a fatal signal.''
32207
32208 Of course, if the bug is that @value{GDBN} gets a fatal signal, then we
32209 will certainly notice it. But if the bug is incorrect output, we might
32210 not notice unless it is glaringly wrong. You might as well not give us
32211 a chance to make a mistake.
32212
32213 Even if the problem you experience is a fatal signal, you should still
32214 say so explicitly. Suppose something strange is going on, such as, your
32215 copy of @value{GDBN} is out of synch, or you have encountered a bug in
32216 the C library on your system. (This has happened!) Your copy might
32217 crash and ours would not. If you told us to expect a crash, then when
32218 ours fails to crash, we would know that the bug was not happening for
32219 us. If you had not told us to expect a crash, then we would not be able
32220 to draw any conclusion from our observations.
32221
32222 @pindex script
32223 @cindex recording a session script
32224 To collect all this information, you can use a session recording program
32225 such as @command{script}, which is available on many Unix systems.
32226 Just run your @value{GDBN} session inside @command{script} and then
32227 include the @file{typescript} file with your bug report.
32228
32229 Another way to record a @value{GDBN} session is to run @value{GDBN}
32230 inside Emacs and then save the entire buffer to a file.
32231
32232 @item
32233 If you wish to suggest changes to the @value{GDBN} source, send us context
32234 diffs. If you even discuss something in the @value{GDBN} source, refer to
32235 it by context, not by line number.
32236
32237 The line numbers in our development sources will not match those in your
32238 sources. Your line numbers would convey no useful information to us.
32239
32240 @end itemize
32241
32242 Here are some things that are not necessary:
32243
32244 @itemize @bullet
32245 @item
32246 A description of the envelope of the bug.
32247
32248 Often people who encounter a bug spend a lot of time investigating
32249 which changes to the input file will make the bug go away and which
32250 changes will not affect it.
32251
32252 This is often time consuming and not very useful, because the way we
32253 will find the bug is by running a single example under the debugger
32254 with breakpoints, not by pure deduction from a series of examples.
32255 We recommend that you save your time for something else.
32256
32257 Of course, if you can find a simpler example to report @emph{instead}
32258 of the original one, that is a convenience for us. Errors in the
32259 output will be easier to spot, running under the debugger will take
32260 less time, and so on.
32261
32262 However, simplification is not vital; if you do not want to do this,
32263 report the bug anyway and send us the entire test case you used.
32264
32265 @item
32266 A patch for the bug.
32267
32268 A patch for the bug does help us if it is a good one. But do not omit
32269 the necessary information, such as the test case, on the assumption that
32270 a patch is all we need. We might see problems with your patch and decide
32271 to fix the problem another way, or we might not understand it at all.
32272
32273 Sometimes with a program as complicated as @value{GDBN} it is very hard to
32274 construct an example that will make the program follow a certain path
32275 through the code. If you do not send us the example, we will not be able
32276 to construct one, so we will not be able to verify that the bug is fixed.
32277
32278 And if we cannot understand what bug you are trying to fix, or why your
32279 patch should be an improvement, we will not install it. A test case will
32280 help us to understand.
32281
32282 @item
32283 A guess about what the bug is or what it depends on.
32284
32285 Such guesses are usually wrong. Even we cannot guess right about such
32286 things without first using the debugger to find the facts.
32287 @end itemize
32288
32289 @c The readline documentation is distributed with the readline code
32290 @c and consists of the two following files:
32291 @c rluser.texi
32292 @c hsuser.texi
32293 @c Use -I with makeinfo to point to the appropriate directory,
32294 @c environment var TEXINPUTS with TeX.
32295 @ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
32296 @include rluser.texi
32297 @include hsuser.texi
32298 @end ifclear
32299
32300 @node In Memoriam
32301 @appendix In Memoriam
32302
32303 The @value{GDBN} project mourns the loss of the following long-time
32304 contributors:
32305
32306 @table @code
32307 @item Fred Fish
32308 Fred was a long-standing contributor to @value{GDBN} (1991-2006), and
32309 to Free Software in general. Outside of @value{GDBN}, he was known in
32310 the Amiga world for his series of Fish Disks, and the GeekGadget project.
32311
32312 @item Michael Snyder
32313 Michael was one of the Global Maintainers of the @value{GDBN} project,
32314 with contributions recorded as early as 1996, until 2011. In addition
32315 to his day to day participation, he was a large driving force behind
32316 adding Reverse Debugging to @value{GDBN}.
32317 @end table
32318
32319 Beyond their technical contributions to the project, they were also
32320 enjoyable members of the Free Software Community. We will miss them.
32321
32322 @node Formatting Documentation
32323 @appendix Formatting Documentation
32324
32325 @cindex @value{GDBN} reference card
32326 @cindex reference card
32327 The @value{GDBN} 4 release includes an already-formatted reference card, ready
32328 for printing with PostScript or Ghostscript, in the @file{gdb}
32329 subdirectory of the main source directory@footnote{In
32330 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/refcard.ps} of the version @value{GDBVN}
32331 release.}. If you can use PostScript or Ghostscript with your printer,
32332 you can print the reference card immediately with @file{refcard.ps}.
32333
32334 The release also includes the source for the reference card. You
32335 can format it, using @TeX{}, by typing:
32336
32337 @smallexample
32338 make refcard.dvi
32339 @end smallexample
32340
32341 The @value{GDBN} reference card is designed to print in @dfn{landscape}
32342 mode on US ``letter'' size paper;
32343 that is, on a sheet 11 inches wide by 8.5 inches
32344 high. You will need to specify this form of printing as an option to
32345 your @sc{dvi} output program.
32346
32347 @cindex documentation
32348
32349 All the documentation for @value{GDBN} comes as part of the machine-readable
32350 distribution. The documentation is written in Texinfo format, which is
32351 a documentation system that uses a single source file to produce both
32352 on-line information and a printed manual. You can use one of the Info
32353 formatting commands to create the on-line version of the documentation
32354 and @TeX{} (or @code{texi2roff}) to typeset the printed version.
32355
32356 @value{GDBN} includes an already formatted copy of the on-line Info
32357 version of this manual in the @file{gdb} subdirectory. The main Info
32358 file is @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/gdb.info}, and it refers to
32359 subordinate files matching @samp{gdb.info*} in the same directory. If
32360 necessary, you can print out these files, or read them with any editor;
32361 but they are easier to read using the @code{info} subsystem in @sc{gnu}
32362 Emacs or the standalone @code{info} program, available as part of the
32363 @sc{gnu} Texinfo distribution.
32364
32365 If you want to format these Info files yourself, you need one of the
32366 Info formatting programs, such as @code{texinfo-format-buffer} or
32367 @code{makeinfo}.
32368
32369 If you have @code{makeinfo} installed, and are in the top level
32370 @value{GDBN} source directory (@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}}, in the case of
32371 version @value{GDBVN}), you can make the Info file by typing:
32372
32373 @smallexample
32374 cd gdb
32375 make gdb.info
32376 @end smallexample
32377
32378 If you want to typeset and print copies of this manual, you need @TeX{},
32379 a program to print its @sc{dvi} output files, and @file{texinfo.tex}, the
32380 Texinfo definitions file.
32381
32382 @TeX{} is a typesetting program; it does not print files directly, but
32383 produces output files called @sc{dvi} files. To print a typeset
32384 document, you need a program to print @sc{dvi} files. If your system
32385 has @TeX{} installed, chances are it has such a program. The precise
32386 command to use depends on your system; @kbd{lpr -d} is common; another
32387 (for PostScript devices) is @kbd{dvips}. The @sc{dvi} print command may
32388 require a file name without any extension or a @samp{.dvi} extension.
32389
32390 @TeX{} also requires a macro definitions file called
32391 @file{texinfo.tex}. This file tells @TeX{} how to typeset a document
32392 written in Texinfo format. On its own, @TeX{} cannot either read or
32393 typeset a Texinfo file. @file{texinfo.tex} is distributed with GDB
32394 and is located in the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}/texinfo}
32395 directory.
32396
32397 If you have @TeX{} and a @sc{dvi} printer program installed, you can
32398 typeset and print this manual. First switch to the @file{gdb}
32399 subdirectory of the main source directory (for example, to
32400 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb}) and type:
32401
32402 @smallexample
32403 make gdb.dvi
32404 @end smallexample
32405
32406 Then give @file{gdb.dvi} to your @sc{dvi} printing program.
32407
32408 @node Installing GDB
32409 @appendix Installing @value{GDBN}
32410 @cindex installation
32411
32412 @menu
32413 * Requirements:: Requirements for building @value{GDBN}
32414 * Running Configure:: Invoking the @value{GDBN} @file{configure} script
32415 * Separate Objdir:: Compiling @value{GDBN} in another directory
32416 * Config Names:: Specifying names for hosts and targets
32417 * Configure Options:: Summary of options for configure
32418 * System-wide configuration:: Having a system-wide init file
32419 @end menu
32420
32421 @node Requirements
32422 @section Requirements for Building @value{GDBN}
32423 @cindex building @value{GDBN}, requirements for
32424
32425 Building @value{GDBN} requires various tools and packages to be available.
32426 Other packages will be used only if they are found.
32427
32428 @heading Tools/Packages Necessary for Building @value{GDBN}
32429 @table @asis
32430 @item ISO C90 compiler
32431 @value{GDBN} is written in ISO C90. It should be buildable with any
32432 working C90 compiler, e.g.@: GCC.
32433
32434 @end table
32435
32436 @heading Tools/Packages Optional for Building @value{GDBN}
32437 @table @asis
32438 @item Expat
32439 @anchor{Expat}
32440 @value{GDBN} can use the Expat XML parsing library. This library may be
32441 included with your operating system distribution; if it is not, you
32442 can get the latest version from @url{http://expat.sourceforge.net}.
32443 The @file{configure} script will search for this library in several
32444 standard locations; if it is installed in an unusual path, you can
32445 use the @option{--with-libexpat-prefix} option to specify its location.
32446
32447 Expat is used for:
32448
32449 @itemize @bullet
32450 @item
32451 Remote protocol memory maps (@pxref{Memory Map Format})
32452 @item
32453 Target descriptions (@pxref{Target Descriptions})
32454 @item
32455 Remote shared library lists (@xref{Library List Format},
32456 or alternatively @pxref{Library List Format for SVR4 Targets})
32457 @item
32458 MS-Windows shared libraries (@pxref{Shared Libraries})
32459 @item
32460 Traceframe info (@pxref{Traceframe Info Format})
32461 @end itemize
32462
32463 @item zlib
32464 @cindex compressed debug sections
32465 @value{GDBN} will use the @samp{zlib} library, if available, to read
32466 compressed debug sections. Some linkers, such as GNU gold, are capable
32467 of producing binaries with compressed debug sections. If @value{GDBN}
32468 is compiled with @samp{zlib}, it will be able to read the debug
32469 information in such binaries.
32470
32471 The @samp{zlib} library is likely included with your operating system
32472 distribution; if it is not, you can get the latest version from
32473 @url{http://zlib.net}.
32474
32475 @item iconv
32476 @value{GDBN}'s features related to character sets (@pxref{Character
32477 Sets}) require a functioning @code{iconv} implementation. If you are
32478 on a GNU system, then this is provided by the GNU C Library. Some
32479 other systems also provide a working @code{iconv}.
32480
32481 If @value{GDBN} is using the @code{iconv} program which is installed
32482 in a non-standard place, you will need to tell @value{GDBN} where to find it.
32483 This is done with @option{--with-iconv-bin} which specifies the
32484 directory that contains the @code{iconv} program.
32485
32486 On systems without @code{iconv}, you can install GNU Libiconv. If you
32487 have previously installed Libiconv, you can use the
32488 @option{--with-libiconv-prefix} option to configure.
32489
32490 @value{GDBN}'s top-level @file{configure} and @file{Makefile} will
32491 arrange to build Libiconv if a directory named @file{libiconv} appears
32492 in the top-most source directory. If Libiconv is built this way, and
32493 if the operating system does not provide a suitable @code{iconv}
32494 implementation, then the just-built library will automatically be used
32495 by @value{GDBN}. One easy way to set this up is to download GNU
32496 Libiconv, unpack it, and then rename the directory holding the
32497 Libiconv source code to @samp{libiconv}.
32498 @end table
32499
32500 @node Running Configure
32501 @section Invoking the @value{GDBN} @file{configure} Script
32502 @cindex configuring @value{GDBN}
32503 @value{GDBN} comes with a @file{configure} script that automates the process
32504 of preparing @value{GDBN} for installation; you can then use @code{make} to
32505 build the @code{gdb} program.
32506 @iftex
32507 @c irrelevant in info file; it's as current as the code it lives with.
32508 @footnote{If you have a more recent version of @value{GDBN} than @value{GDBVN},
32509 look at the @file{README} file in the sources; we may have improved the
32510 installation procedures since publishing this manual.}
32511 @end iftex
32512
32513 The @value{GDBN} distribution includes all the source code you need for
32514 @value{GDBN} in a single directory, whose name is usually composed by
32515 appending the version number to @samp{gdb}.
32516
32517 For example, the @value{GDBN} version @value{GDBVN} distribution is in the
32518 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} directory. That directory contains:
32519
32520 @table @code
32521 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/configure @r{(and supporting files)}
32522 script for configuring @value{GDBN} and all its supporting libraries
32523
32524 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb
32525 the source specific to @value{GDBN} itself
32526
32527 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/bfd
32528 source for the Binary File Descriptor library
32529
32530 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/include
32531 @sc{gnu} include files
32532
32533 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/libiberty
32534 source for the @samp{-liberty} free software library
32535
32536 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/opcodes
32537 source for the library of opcode tables and disassemblers
32538
32539 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/readline
32540 source for the @sc{gnu} command-line interface
32541
32542 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/glob
32543 source for the @sc{gnu} filename pattern-matching subroutine
32544
32545 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/mmalloc
32546 source for the @sc{gnu} memory-mapped malloc package
32547 @end table
32548
32549 The simplest way to configure and build @value{GDBN} is to run @file{configure}
32550 from the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} source directory, which in
32551 this example is the @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} directory.
32552
32553 First switch to the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} source directory
32554 if you are not already in it; then run @file{configure}. Pass the
32555 identifier for the platform on which @value{GDBN} will run as an
32556 argument.
32557
32558 For example:
32559
32560 @smallexample
32561 cd gdb-@value{GDBVN}
32562 ./configure @var{host}
32563 make
32564 @end smallexample
32565
32566 @noindent
32567 where @var{host} is an identifier such as @samp{sun4} or
32568 @samp{decstation}, that identifies the platform where @value{GDBN} will run.
32569 (You can often leave off @var{host}; @file{configure} tries to guess the
32570 correct value by examining your system.)
32571
32572 Running @samp{configure @var{host}} and then running @code{make} builds the
32573 @file{bfd}, @file{readline}, @file{mmalloc}, and @file{libiberty}
32574 libraries, then @code{gdb} itself. The configured source files, and the
32575 binaries, are left in the corresponding source directories.
32576
32577 @need 750
32578 @file{configure} is a Bourne-shell (@code{/bin/sh}) script; if your
32579 system does not recognize this automatically when you run a different
32580 shell, you may need to run @code{sh} on it explicitly:
32581
32582 @smallexample
32583 sh configure @var{host}
32584 @end smallexample
32585
32586 If you run @file{configure} from a directory that contains source
32587 directories for multiple libraries or programs, such as the
32588 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} source directory for version @value{GDBVN},
32589 @file{configure}
32590 creates configuration files for every directory level underneath (unless
32591 you tell it not to, with the @samp{--norecursion} option).
32592
32593 You should run the @file{configure} script from the top directory in the
32594 source tree, the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} directory. If you run
32595 @file{configure} from one of the subdirectories, you will configure only
32596 that subdirectory. That is usually not what you want. In particular,
32597 if you run the first @file{configure} from the @file{gdb} subdirectory
32598 of the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} directory, you will omit the
32599 configuration of @file{bfd}, @file{readline}, and other sibling
32600 directories of the @file{gdb} subdirectory. This leads to build errors
32601 about missing include files such as @file{bfd/bfd.h}.
32602
32603 You can install @code{@value{GDBP}} anywhere; it has no hardwired paths.
32604 However, you should make sure that the shell on your path (named by
32605 the @samp{SHELL} environment variable) is publicly readable. Remember
32606 that @value{GDBN} uses the shell to start your program---some systems refuse to
32607 let @value{GDBN} debug child processes whose programs are not readable.
32608
32609 @node Separate Objdir
32610 @section Compiling @value{GDBN} in Another Directory
32611
32612 If you want to run @value{GDBN} versions for several host or target machines,
32613 you need a different @code{gdb} compiled for each combination of
32614 host and target. @file{configure} is designed to make this easy by
32615 allowing you to generate each configuration in a separate subdirectory,
32616 rather than in the source directory. If your @code{make} program
32617 handles the @samp{VPATH} feature (@sc{gnu} @code{make} does), running
32618 @code{make} in each of these directories builds the @code{gdb}
32619 program specified there.
32620
32621 To build @code{gdb} in a separate directory, run @file{configure}
32622 with the @samp{--srcdir} option to specify where to find the source.
32623 (You also need to specify a path to find @file{configure}
32624 itself from your working directory. If the path to @file{configure}
32625 would be the same as the argument to @samp{--srcdir}, you can leave out
32626 the @samp{--srcdir} option; it is assumed.)
32627
32628 For example, with version @value{GDBVN}, you can build @value{GDBN} in a
32629 separate directory for a Sun 4 like this:
32630
32631 @smallexample
32632 @group
32633 cd gdb-@value{GDBVN}
32634 mkdir ../gdb-sun4
32635 cd ../gdb-sun4
32636 ../gdb-@value{GDBVN}/configure sun4
32637 make
32638 @end group
32639 @end smallexample
32640
32641 When @file{configure} builds a configuration using a remote source
32642 directory, it creates a tree for the binaries with the same structure
32643 (and using the same names) as the tree under the source directory. In
32644 the example, you'd find the Sun 4 library @file{libiberty.a} in the
32645 directory @file{gdb-sun4/libiberty}, and @value{GDBN} itself in
32646 @file{gdb-sun4/gdb}.
32647
32648 Make sure that your path to the @file{configure} script has just one
32649 instance of @file{gdb} in it. If your path to @file{configure} looks
32650 like @file{../gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/configure}, you are configuring only
32651 one subdirectory of @value{GDBN}, not the whole package. This leads to
32652 build errors about missing include files such as @file{bfd/bfd.h}.
32653
32654 One popular reason to build several @value{GDBN} configurations in separate
32655 directories is to configure @value{GDBN} for cross-compiling (where
32656 @value{GDBN} runs on one machine---the @dfn{host}---while debugging
32657 programs that run on another machine---the @dfn{target}).
32658 You specify a cross-debugging target by
32659 giving the @samp{--target=@var{target}} option to @file{configure}.
32660
32661 When you run @code{make} to build a program or library, you must run
32662 it in a configured directory---whatever directory you were in when you
32663 called @file{configure} (or one of its subdirectories).
32664
32665 The @code{Makefile} that @file{configure} generates in each source
32666 directory also runs recursively. If you type @code{make} in a source
32667 directory such as @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} (or in a separate configured
32668 directory configured with @samp{--srcdir=@var{dirname}/gdb-@value{GDBVN}}), you
32669 will build all the required libraries, and then build GDB.
32670
32671 When you have multiple hosts or targets configured in separate
32672 directories, you can run @code{make} on them in parallel (for example,
32673 if they are NFS-mounted on each of the hosts); they will not interfere
32674 with each other.
32675
32676 @node Config Names
32677 @section Specifying Names for Hosts and Targets
32678
32679 The specifications used for hosts and targets in the @file{configure}
32680 script are based on a three-part naming scheme, but some short predefined
32681 aliases are also supported. The full naming scheme encodes three pieces
32682 of information in the following pattern:
32683
32684 @smallexample
32685 @var{architecture}-@var{vendor}-@var{os}
32686 @end smallexample
32687
32688 For example, you can use the alias @code{sun4} as a @var{host} argument,
32689 or as the value for @var{target} in a @code{--target=@var{target}}
32690 option. The equivalent full name is @samp{sparc-sun-sunos4}.
32691
32692 The @file{configure} script accompanying @value{GDBN} does not provide
32693 any query facility to list all supported host and target names or
32694 aliases. @file{configure} calls the Bourne shell script
32695 @code{config.sub} to map abbreviations to full names; you can read the
32696 script, if you wish, or you can use it to test your guesses on
32697 abbreviations---for example:
32698
32699 @smallexample
32700 % sh config.sub i386-linux
32701 i386-pc-linux-gnu
32702 % sh config.sub alpha-linux
32703 alpha-unknown-linux-gnu
32704 % sh config.sub hp9k700
32705 hppa1.1-hp-hpux
32706 % sh config.sub sun4
32707 sparc-sun-sunos4.1.1
32708 % sh config.sub sun3
32709 m68k-sun-sunos4.1.1
32710 % sh config.sub i986v
32711 Invalid configuration `i986v': machine `i986v' not recognized
32712 @end smallexample
32713
32714 @noindent
32715 @code{config.sub} is also distributed in the @value{GDBN} source
32716 directory (@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}}, for version @value{GDBVN}).
32717
32718 @node Configure Options
32719 @section @file{configure} Options
32720
32721 Here is a summary of the @file{configure} options and arguments that
32722 are most often useful for building @value{GDBN}. @file{configure} also has
32723 several other options not listed here. @inforef{What Configure
32724 Does,,configure.info}, for a full explanation of @file{configure}.
32725
32726 @smallexample
32727 configure @r{[}--help@r{]}
32728 @r{[}--prefix=@var{dir}@r{]}
32729 @r{[}--exec-prefix=@var{dir}@r{]}
32730 @r{[}--srcdir=@var{dirname}@r{]}
32731 @r{[}--norecursion@r{]} @r{[}--rm@r{]}
32732 @r{[}--target=@var{target}@r{]}
32733 @var{host}
32734 @end smallexample
32735
32736 @noindent
32737 You may introduce options with a single @samp{-} rather than
32738 @samp{--} if you prefer; but you may abbreviate option names if you use
32739 @samp{--}.
32740
32741 @table @code
32742 @item --help
32743 Display a quick summary of how to invoke @file{configure}.
32744
32745 @item --prefix=@var{dir}
32746 Configure the source to install programs and files under directory
32747 @file{@var{dir}}.
32748
32749 @item --exec-prefix=@var{dir}
32750 Configure the source to install programs under directory
32751 @file{@var{dir}}.
32752
32753 @c avoid splitting the warning from the explanation:
32754 @need 2000
32755 @item --srcdir=@var{dirname}
32756 @strong{Warning: using this option requires @sc{gnu} @code{make}, or another
32757 @code{make} that implements the @code{VPATH} feature.}@*
32758 Use this option to make configurations in directories separate from the
32759 @value{GDBN} source directories. Among other things, you can use this to
32760 build (or maintain) several configurations simultaneously, in separate
32761 directories. @file{configure} writes configuration-specific files in
32762 the current directory, but arranges for them to use the source in the
32763 directory @var{dirname}. @file{configure} creates directories under
32764 the working directory in parallel to the source directories below
32765 @var{dirname}.
32766
32767 @item --norecursion
32768 Configure only the directory level where @file{configure} is executed; do not
32769 propagate configuration to subdirectories.
32770
32771 @item --target=@var{target}
32772 Configure @value{GDBN} for cross-debugging programs running on the specified
32773 @var{target}. Without this option, @value{GDBN} is configured to debug
32774 programs that run on the same machine (@var{host}) as @value{GDBN} itself.
32775
32776 There is no convenient way to generate a list of all available targets.
32777
32778 @item @var{host} @dots{}
32779 Configure @value{GDBN} to run on the specified @var{host}.
32780
32781 There is no convenient way to generate a list of all available hosts.
32782 @end table
32783
32784 There are many other options available as well, but they are generally
32785 needed for special purposes only.
32786
32787 @node System-wide configuration
32788 @section System-wide configuration and settings
32789 @cindex system-wide init file
32790
32791 @value{GDBN} can be configured to have a system-wide init file;
32792 this file will be read and executed at startup (@pxref{Startup, , What
32793 @value{GDBN} does during startup}).
32794
32795 Here is the corresponding configure option:
32796
32797 @table @code
32798 @item --with-system-gdbinit=@var{file}
32799 Specify that the default location of the system-wide init file is
32800 @var{file}.
32801 @end table
32802
32803 If @value{GDBN} has been configured with the option @option{--prefix=$prefix},
32804 it may be subject to relocation. Two possible cases:
32805
32806 @itemize @bullet
32807 @item
32808 If the default location of this init file contains @file{$prefix},
32809 it will be subject to relocation. Suppose that the configure options
32810 are @option{--prefix=$prefix --with-system-gdbinit=$prefix/etc/gdbinit};
32811 if @value{GDBN} is moved from @file{$prefix} to @file{$install}, the system
32812 init file is looked for as @file{$install/etc/gdbinit} instead of
32813 @file{$prefix/etc/gdbinit}.
32814
32815 @item
32816 By contrast, if the default location does not contain the prefix,
32817 it will not be relocated. E.g.@: if @value{GDBN} has been configured with
32818 @option{--prefix=/usr/local --with-system-gdbinit=/usr/share/gdb/gdbinit},
32819 then @value{GDBN} will always look for @file{/usr/share/gdb/gdbinit},
32820 wherever @value{GDBN} is installed.
32821 @end itemize
32822
32823 @node Maintenance Commands
32824 @appendix Maintenance Commands
32825 @cindex maintenance commands
32826 @cindex internal commands
32827
32828 In addition to commands intended for @value{GDBN} users, @value{GDBN}
32829 includes a number of commands intended for @value{GDBN} developers,
32830 that are not documented elsewhere in this manual. These commands are
32831 provided here for reference. (For commands that turn on debugging
32832 messages, see @ref{Debugging Output}.)
32833
32834 @table @code
32835 @kindex maint agent
32836 @kindex maint agent-eval
32837 @item maint agent @var{expression}
32838 @itemx maint agent-eval @var{expression}
32839 Translate the given @var{expression} into remote agent bytecodes.
32840 This command is useful for debugging the Agent Expression mechanism
32841 (@pxref{Agent Expressions}). The @samp{agent} version produces an
32842 expression useful for data collection, such as by tracepoints, while
32843 @samp{maint agent-eval} produces an expression that evaluates directly
32844 to a result. For instance, a collection expression for @code{globa +
32845 globb} will include bytecodes to record four bytes of memory at each
32846 of the addresses of @code{globa} and @code{globb}, while discarding
32847 the result of the addition, while an evaluation expression will do the
32848 addition and return the sum.
32849
32850 @kindex maint info breakpoints
32851 @item @anchor{maint info breakpoints}maint info breakpoints
32852 Using the same format as @samp{info breakpoints}, display both the
32853 breakpoints you've set explicitly, and those @value{GDBN} is using for
32854 internal purposes. Internal breakpoints are shown with negative
32855 breakpoint numbers. The type column identifies what kind of breakpoint
32856 is shown:
32857
32858 @table @code
32859 @item breakpoint
32860 Normal, explicitly set breakpoint.
32861
32862 @item watchpoint
32863 Normal, explicitly set watchpoint.
32864
32865 @item longjmp
32866 Internal breakpoint, used to handle correctly stepping through
32867 @code{longjmp} calls.
32868
32869 @item longjmp resume
32870 Internal breakpoint at the target of a @code{longjmp}.
32871
32872 @item until
32873 Temporary internal breakpoint used by the @value{GDBN} @code{until} command.
32874
32875 @item finish
32876 Temporary internal breakpoint used by the @value{GDBN} @code{finish} command.
32877
32878 @item shlib events
32879 Shared library events.
32880
32881 @end table
32882
32883 @kindex set displaced-stepping
32884 @kindex show displaced-stepping
32885 @cindex displaced stepping support
32886 @cindex out-of-line single-stepping
32887 @item set displaced-stepping
32888 @itemx show displaced-stepping
32889 Control whether or not @value{GDBN} will do @dfn{displaced stepping}
32890 if the target supports it. Displaced stepping is a way to single-step
32891 over breakpoints without removing them from the inferior, by executing
32892 an out-of-line copy of the instruction that was originally at the
32893 breakpoint location. It is also known as out-of-line single-stepping.
32894
32895 @table @code
32896 @item set displaced-stepping on
32897 If the target architecture supports it, @value{GDBN} will use
32898 displaced stepping to step over breakpoints.
32899
32900 @item set displaced-stepping off
32901 @value{GDBN} will not use displaced stepping to step over breakpoints,
32902 even if such is supported by the target architecture.
32903
32904 @cindex non-stop mode, and @samp{set displaced-stepping}
32905 @item set displaced-stepping auto
32906 This is the default mode. @value{GDBN} will use displaced stepping
32907 only if non-stop mode is active (@pxref{Non-Stop Mode}) and the target
32908 architecture supports displaced stepping.
32909 @end table
32910
32911 @kindex maint check-symtabs
32912 @item maint check-symtabs
32913 Check the consistency of psymtabs and symtabs.
32914
32915 @kindex maint cplus first_component
32916 @item maint cplus first_component @var{name}
32917 Print the first C@t{++} class/namespace component of @var{name}.
32918
32919 @kindex maint cplus namespace
32920 @item maint cplus namespace
32921 Print the list of possible C@t{++} namespaces.
32922
32923 @kindex maint demangle
32924 @item maint demangle @var{name}
32925 Demangle a C@t{++} or Objective-C mangled @var{name}.
32926
32927 @kindex maint deprecate
32928 @kindex maint undeprecate
32929 @cindex deprecated commands
32930 @item maint deprecate @var{command} @r{[}@var{replacement}@r{]}
32931 @itemx maint undeprecate @var{command}
32932 Deprecate or undeprecate the named @var{command}. Deprecated commands
32933 cause @value{GDBN} to issue a warning when you use them. The optional
32934 argument @var{replacement} says which newer command should be used in
32935 favor of the deprecated one; if it is given, @value{GDBN} will mention
32936 the replacement as part of the warning.
32937
32938 @kindex maint dump-me
32939 @item maint dump-me
32940 @cindex @code{SIGQUIT} signal, dump core of @value{GDBN}
32941 Cause a fatal signal in the debugger and force it to dump its core.
32942 This is supported only on systems which support aborting a program
32943 with the @code{SIGQUIT} signal.
32944
32945 @kindex maint internal-error
32946 @kindex maint internal-warning
32947 @item maint internal-error @r{[}@var{message-text}@r{]}
32948 @itemx maint internal-warning @r{[}@var{message-text}@r{]}
32949 Cause @value{GDBN} to call the internal function @code{internal_error}
32950 or @code{internal_warning} and hence behave as though an internal error
32951 or internal warning has been detected. In addition to reporting the
32952 internal problem, these functions give the user the opportunity to
32953 either quit @value{GDBN} or create a core file of the current
32954 @value{GDBN} session.
32955
32956 These commands take an optional parameter @var{message-text} that is
32957 used as the text of the error or warning message.
32958
32959 Here's an example of using @code{internal-error}:
32960
32961 @smallexample
32962 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{maint internal-error testing, 1, 2}
32963 @dots{}/maint.c:121: internal-error: testing, 1, 2
32964 A problem internal to GDB has been detected. Further
32965 debugging may prove unreliable.
32966 Quit this debugging session? (y or n) @kbd{n}
32967 Create a core file? (y or n) @kbd{n}
32968 (@value{GDBP})
32969 @end smallexample
32970
32971 @cindex @value{GDBN} internal error
32972 @cindex internal errors, control of @value{GDBN} behavior
32973
32974 @kindex maint set internal-error
32975 @kindex maint show internal-error
32976 @kindex maint set internal-warning
32977 @kindex maint show internal-warning
32978 @item maint set internal-error @var{action} [ask|yes|no]
32979 @itemx maint show internal-error @var{action}
32980 @itemx maint set internal-warning @var{action} [ask|yes|no]
32981 @itemx maint show internal-warning @var{action}
32982 When @value{GDBN} reports an internal problem (error or warning) it
32983 gives the user the opportunity to both quit @value{GDBN} and create a
32984 core file of the current @value{GDBN} session. These commands let you
32985 override the default behaviour for each particular @var{action},
32986 described in the table below.
32987
32988 @table @samp
32989 @item quit
32990 You can specify that @value{GDBN} should always (yes) or never (no)
32991 quit. The default is to ask the user what to do.
32992
32993 @item corefile
32994 You can specify that @value{GDBN} should always (yes) or never (no)
32995 create a core file. The default is to ask the user what to do.
32996 @end table
32997
32998 @kindex maint packet
32999 @item maint packet @var{text}
33000 If @value{GDBN} is talking to an inferior via the serial protocol,
33001 then this command sends the string @var{text} to the inferior, and
33002 displays the response packet. @value{GDBN} supplies the initial
33003 @samp{$} character, the terminating @samp{#} character, and the
33004 checksum.
33005
33006 @kindex maint print architecture
33007 @item maint print architecture @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
33008 Print the entire architecture configuration. The optional argument
33009 @var{file} names the file where the output goes.
33010
33011 @kindex maint print c-tdesc
33012 @item maint print c-tdesc
33013 Print the current target description (@pxref{Target Descriptions}) as
33014 a C source file. The created source file can be used in @value{GDBN}
33015 when an XML parser is not available to parse the description.
33016
33017 @kindex maint print dummy-frames
33018 @item maint print dummy-frames
33019 Prints the contents of @value{GDBN}'s internal dummy-frame stack.
33020
33021 @smallexample
33022 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{b add}
33023 @dots{}
33024 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{print add(2,3)}
33025 Breakpoint 2, add (a=2, b=3) at @dots{}
33026 58 return (a + b);
33027 The program being debugged stopped while in a function called from GDB.
33028 @dots{}
33029 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{maint print dummy-frames}
33030 0x1a57c80: pc=0x01014068 fp=0x0200bddc sp=0x0200bdd6
33031 top=0x0200bdd4 id=@{stack=0x200bddc,code=0x101405c@}
33032 call_lo=0x01014000 call_hi=0x01014001
33033 (@value{GDBP})
33034 @end smallexample
33035
33036 Takes an optional file parameter.
33037
33038 @kindex maint print registers
33039 @kindex maint print raw-registers
33040 @kindex maint print cooked-registers
33041 @kindex maint print register-groups
33042 @kindex maint print remote-registers
33043 @item maint print registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
33044 @itemx maint print raw-registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
33045 @itemx maint print cooked-registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
33046 @itemx maint print register-groups @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
33047 @itemx maint print remote-registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
33048 Print @value{GDBN}'s internal register data structures.
33049
33050 The command @code{maint print raw-registers} includes the contents of
33051 the raw register cache; the command @code{maint print
33052 cooked-registers} includes the (cooked) value of all registers,
33053 including registers which aren't available on the target nor visible
33054 to user; the command @code{maint print register-groups} includes the
33055 groups that each register is a member of; and the command @code{maint
33056 print remote-registers} includes the remote target's register numbers
33057 and offsets in the `G' packets. @xref{Registers,, Registers, gdbint,
33058 @value{GDBN} Internals}.
33059
33060 These commands take an optional parameter, a file name to which to
33061 write the information.
33062
33063 @kindex maint print reggroups
33064 @item maint print reggroups @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
33065 Print @value{GDBN}'s internal register group data structures. The
33066 optional argument @var{file} tells to what file to write the
33067 information.
33068
33069 The register groups info looks like this:
33070
33071 @smallexample
33072 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{maint print reggroups}
33073 Group Type
33074 general user
33075 float user
33076 all user
33077 vector user
33078 system user
33079 save internal
33080 restore internal
33081 @end smallexample
33082
33083 @kindex flushregs
33084 @item flushregs
33085 This command forces @value{GDBN} to flush its internal register cache.
33086
33087 @kindex maint print objfiles
33088 @cindex info for known object files
33089 @item maint print objfiles
33090 Print a dump of all known object files. For each object file, this
33091 command prints its name, address in memory, and all of its psymtabs
33092 and symtabs.
33093
33094 @kindex maint print section-scripts
33095 @cindex info for known .debug_gdb_scripts-loaded scripts
33096 @item maint print section-scripts [@var{regexp}]
33097 Print a dump of scripts specified in the @code{.debug_gdb_section} section.
33098 If @var{regexp} is specified, only print scripts loaded by object files
33099 matching @var{regexp}.
33100 For each script, this command prints its name as specified in the objfile,
33101 and the full path if known.
33102 @xref{.debug_gdb_scripts section}.
33103
33104 @kindex maint print statistics
33105 @cindex bcache statistics
33106 @item maint print statistics
33107 This command prints, for each object file in the program, various data
33108 about that object file followed by the byte cache (@dfn{bcache})
33109 statistics for the object file. The objfile data includes the number
33110 of minimal, partial, full, and stabs symbols, the number of types
33111 defined by the objfile, the number of as yet unexpanded psym tables,
33112 the number of line tables and string tables, and the amount of memory
33113 used by the various tables. The bcache statistics include the counts,
33114 sizes, and counts of duplicates of all and unique objects, max,
33115 average, and median entry size, total memory used and its overhead and
33116 savings, and various measures of the hash table size and chain
33117 lengths.
33118
33119 @kindex maint print target-stack
33120 @cindex target stack description
33121 @item maint print target-stack
33122 A @dfn{target} is an interface between the debugger and a particular
33123 kind of file or process. Targets can be stacked in @dfn{strata},
33124 so that more than one target can potentially respond to a request.
33125 In particular, memory accesses will walk down the stack of targets
33126 until they find a target that is interested in handling that particular
33127 address.
33128
33129 This command prints a short description of each layer that was pushed on
33130 the @dfn{target stack}, starting from the top layer down to the bottom one.
33131
33132 @kindex maint print type
33133 @cindex type chain of a data type
33134 @item maint print type @var{expr}
33135 Print the type chain for a type specified by @var{expr}. The argument
33136 can be either a type name or a symbol. If it is a symbol, the type of
33137 that symbol is described. The type chain produced by this command is
33138 a recursive definition of the data type as stored in @value{GDBN}'s
33139 data structures, including its flags and contained types.
33140
33141 @kindex maint set dwarf2 always-disassemble
33142 @kindex maint show dwarf2 always-disassemble
33143 @item maint set dwarf2 always-disassemble
33144 @item maint show dwarf2 always-disassemble
33145 Control the behavior of @code{info address} when using DWARF debugging
33146 information.
33147
33148 The default is @code{off}, which means that @value{GDBN} should try to
33149 describe a variable's location in an easily readable format. When
33150 @code{on}, @value{GDBN} will instead display the DWARF location
33151 expression in an assembly-like format. Note that some locations are
33152 too complex for @value{GDBN} to describe simply; in this case you will
33153 always see the disassembly form.
33154
33155 Here is an example of the resulting disassembly:
33156
33157 @smallexample
33158 (gdb) info addr argc
33159 Symbol "argc" is a complex DWARF expression:
33160 1: DW_OP_fbreg 0
33161 @end smallexample
33162
33163 For more information on these expressions, see
33164 @uref{http://www.dwarfstd.org/, the DWARF standard}.
33165
33166 @kindex maint set dwarf2 max-cache-age
33167 @kindex maint show dwarf2 max-cache-age
33168 @item maint set dwarf2 max-cache-age
33169 @itemx maint show dwarf2 max-cache-age
33170 Control the DWARF 2 compilation unit cache.
33171
33172 @cindex DWARF 2 compilation units cache
33173 In object files with inter-compilation-unit references, such as those
33174 produced by the GCC option @samp{-feliminate-dwarf2-dups}, the DWARF 2
33175 reader needs to frequently refer to previously read compilation units.
33176 This setting controls how long a compilation unit will remain in the
33177 cache if it is not referenced. A higher limit means that cached
33178 compilation units will be stored in memory longer, and more total
33179 memory will be used. Setting it to zero disables caching, which will
33180 slow down @value{GDBN} startup, but reduce memory consumption.
33181
33182 @kindex maint set profile
33183 @kindex maint show profile
33184 @cindex profiling GDB
33185 @item maint set profile
33186 @itemx maint show profile
33187 Control profiling of @value{GDBN}.
33188
33189 Profiling will be disabled until you use the @samp{maint set profile}
33190 command to enable it. When you enable profiling, the system will begin
33191 collecting timing and execution count data; when you disable profiling or
33192 exit @value{GDBN}, the results will be written to a log file. Remember that
33193 if you use profiling, @value{GDBN} will overwrite the profiling log file
33194 (often called @file{gmon.out}). If you have a record of important profiling
33195 data in a @file{gmon.out} file, be sure to move it to a safe location.
33196
33197 Configuring with @samp{--enable-profiling} arranges for @value{GDBN} to be
33198 compiled with the @samp{-pg} compiler option.
33199
33200 @kindex maint set show-debug-regs
33201 @kindex maint show show-debug-regs
33202 @cindex hardware debug registers
33203 @item maint set show-debug-regs
33204 @itemx maint show show-debug-regs
33205 Control whether to show variables that mirror the hardware debug
33206 registers. Use @code{ON} to enable, @code{OFF} to disable. If
33207 enabled, the debug registers values are shown when @value{GDBN} inserts or
33208 removes a hardware breakpoint or watchpoint, and when the inferior
33209 triggers a hardware-assisted breakpoint or watchpoint.
33210
33211 @kindex maint set show-all-tib
33212 @kindex maint show show-all-tib
33213 @item maint set show-all-tib
33214 @itemx maint show show-all-tib
33215 Control whether to show all non zero areas within a 1k block starting
33216 at thread local base, when using the @samp{info w32 thread-information-block}
33217 command.
33218
33219 @kindex maint space
33220 @cindex memory used by commands
33221 @item maint space
33222 Control whether to display memory usage for each command. If set to a
33223 nonzero value, @value{GDBN} will display how much memory each command
33224 took, following the command's own output. This can also be requested
33225 by invoking @value{GDBN} with the @option{--statistics} command-line
33226 switch (@pxref{Mode Options}).
33227
33228 @kindex maint time
33229 @cindex time of command execution
33230 @item maint time
33231 Control whether to display the execution time of @value{GDBN} for each command.
33232 If set to a nonzero value, @value{GDBN} will display how much time it
33233 took to execute each command, following the command's own output.
33234 Both CPU time and wallclock time are printed.
33235 Printing both is useful when trying to determine whether the cost is
33236 CPU or, e.g., disk/network, latency.
33237 Note that the CPU time printed is for @value{GDBN} only, it does not include
33238 the execution time of the inferior because there's no mechanism currently
33239 to compute how much time was spent by @value{GDBN} and how much time was
33240 spent by the program been debugged.
33241 This can also be requested by invoking @value{GDBN} with the
33242 @option{--statistics} command-line switch (@pxref{Mode Options}).
33243
33244 @kindex maint translate-address
33245 @item maint translate-address @r{[}@var{section}@r{]} @var{addr}
33246 Find the symbol stored at the location specified by the address
33247 @var{addr} and an optional section name @var{section}. If found,
33248 @value{GDBN} prints the name of the closest symbol and an offset from
33249 the symbol's location to the specified address. This is similar to
33250 the @code{info address} command (@pxref{Symbols}), except that this
33251 command also allows to find symbols in other sections.
33252
33253 If section was not specified, the section in which the symbol was found
33254 is also printed. For dynamically linked executables, the name of
33255 executable or shared library containing the symbol is printed as well.
33256
33257 @end table
33258
33259 The following command is useful for non-interactive invocations of
33260 @value{GDBN}, such as in the test suite.
33261
33262 @table @code
33263 @item set watchdog @var{nsec}
33264 @kindex set watchdog
33265 @cindex watchdog timer
33266 @cindex timeout for commands
33267 Set the maximum number of seconds @value{GDBN} will wait for the
33268 target operation to finish. If this time expires, @value{GDBN}
33269 reports and error and the command is aborted.
33270
33271 @item show watchdog
33272 Show the current setting of the target wait timeout.
33273 @end table
33274
33275 @node Remote Protocol
33276 @appendix @value{GDBN} Remote Serial Protocol
33277
33278 @menu
33279 * Overview::
33280 * Packets::
33281 * Stop Reply Packets::
33282 * General Query Packets::
33283 * Architecture-Specific Protocol Details::
33284 * Tracepoint Packets::
33285 * Host I/O Packets::
33286 * Interrupts::
33287 * Notification Packets::
33288 * Remote Non-Stop::
33289 * Packet Acknowledgment::
33290 * Examples::
33291 * File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension::
33292 * Library List Format::
33293 * Library List Format for SVR4 Targets::
33294 * Memory Map Format::
33295 * Thread List Format::
33296 * Traceframe Info Format::
33297 @end menu
33298
33299 @node Overview
33300 @section Overview
33301
33302 There may be occasions when you need to know something about the
33303 protocol---for example, if there is only one serial port to your target
33304 machine, you might want your program to do something special if it
33305 recognizes a packet meant for @value{GDBN}.
33306
33307 In the examples below, @samp{->} and @samp{<-} are used to indicate
33308 transmitted and received data, respectively.
33309
33310 @cindex protocol, @value{GDBN} remote serial
33311 @cindex serial protocol, @value{GDBN} remote
33312 @cindex remote serial protocol
33313 All @value{GDBN} commands and responses (other than acknowledgments
33314 and notifications, see @ref{Notification Packets}) are sent as a
33315 @var{packet}. A @var{packet} is introduced with the character
33316 @samp{$}, the actual @var{packet-data}, and the terminating character
33317 @samp{#} followed by a two-digit @var{checksum}:
33318
33319 @smallexample
33320 @code{$}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
33321 @end smallexample
33322 @noindent
33323
33324 @cindex checksum, for @value{GDBN} remote
33325 @noindent
33326 The two-digit @var{checksum} is computed as the modulo 256 sum of all
33327 characters between the leading @samp{$} and the trailing @samp{#} (an
33328 eight bit unsigned checksum).
33329
33330 Implementors should note that prior to @value{GDBN} 5.0 the protocol
33331 specification also included an optional two-digit @var{sequence-id}:
33332
33333 @smallexample
33334 @code{$}@var{sequence-id}@code{:}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
33335 @end smallexample
33336
33337 @cindex sequence-id, for @value{GDBN} remote
33338 @noindent
33339 That @var{sequence-id} was appended to the acknowledgment. @value{GDBN}
33340 has never output @var{sequence-id}s. Stubs that handle packets added
33341 since @value{GDBN} 5.0 must not accept @var{sequence-id}.
33342
33343 When either the host or the target machine receives a packet, the first
33344 response expected is an acknowledgment: either @samp{+} (to indicate
33345 the package was received correctly) or @samp{-} (to request
33346 retransmission):
33347
33348 @smallexample
33349 -> @code{$}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
33350 <- @code{+}
33351 @end smallexample
33352 @noindent
33353
33354 The @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgments can be disabled
33355 once a connection is established.
33356 @xref{Packet Acknowledgment}, for details.
33357
33358 The host (@value{GDBN}) sends @var{command}s, and the target (the
33359 debugging stub incorporated in your program) sends a @var{response}. In
33360 the case of step and continue @var{command}s, the response is only sent
33361 when the operation has completed, and the target has again stopped all
33362 threads in all attached processes. This is the default all-stop mode
33363 behavior, but the remote protocol also supports @value{GDBN}'s non-stop
33364 execution mode; see @ref{Remote Non-Stop}, for details.
33365
33366 @var{packet-data} consists of a sequence of characters with the
33367 exception of @samp{#} and @samp{$} (see @samp{X} packet for additional
33368 exceptions).
33369
33370 @cindex remote protocol, field separator
33371 Fields within the packet should be separated using @samp{,} @samp{;} or
33372 @samp{:}. Except where otherwise noted all numbers are represented in
33373 @sc{hex} with leading zeros suppressed.
33374
33375 Implementors should note that prior to @value{GDBN} 5.0, the character
33376 @samp{:} could not appear as the third character in a packet (as it
33377 would potentially conflict with the @var{sequence-id}).
33378
33379 @cindex remote protocol, binary data
33380 @anchor{Binary Data}
33381 Binary data in most packets is encoded either as two hexadecimal
33382 digits per byte of binary data. This allowed the traditional remote
33383 protocol to work over connections which were only seven-bit clean.
33384 Some packets designed more recently assume an eight-bit clean
33385 connection, and use a more efficient encoding to send and receive
33386 binary data.
33387
33388 The binary data representation uses @code{7d} (@sc{ascii} @samp{@}})
33389 as an escape character. Any escaped byte is transmitted as the escape
33390 character followed by the original character XORed with @code{0x20}.
33391 For example, the byte @code{0x7d} would be transmitted as the two
33392 bytes @code{0x7d 0x5d}. The bytes @code{0x23} (@sc{ascii} @samp{#}),
33393 @code{0x24} (@sc{ascii} @samp{$}), and @code{0x7d} (@sc{ascii}
33394 @samp{@}}) must always be escaped. Responses sent by the stub
33395 must also escape @code{0x2a} (@sc{ascii} @samp{*}), so that it
33396 is not interpreted as the start of a run-length encoded sequence
33397 (described next).
33398
33399 Response @var{data} can be run-length encoded to save space.
33400 Run-length encoding replaces runs of identical characters with one
33401 instance of the repeated character, followed by a @samp{*} and a
33402 repeat count. The repeat count is itself sent encoded, to avoid
33403 binary characters in @var{data}: a value of @var{n} is sent as
33404 @code{@var{n}+29}. For a repeat count greater or equal to 3, this
33405 produces a printable @sc{ascii} character, e.g.@: a space (@sc{ascii}
33406 code 32) for a repeat count of 3. (This is because run-length
33407 encoding starts to win for counts 3 or more.) Thus, for example,
33408 @samp{0* } is a run-length encoding of ``0000'': the space character
33409 after @samp{*} means repeat the leading @code{0} @w{@code{32 - 29 =
33410 3}} more times.
33411
33412 The printable characters @samp{#} and @samp{$} or with a numeric value
33413 greater than 126 must not be used. Runs of six repeats (@samp{#}) or
33414 seven repeats (@samp{$}) can be expanded using a repeat count of only
33415 five (@samp{"}). For example, @samp{00000000} can be encoded as
33416 @samp{0*"00}.
33417
33418 The error response returned for some packets includes a two character
33419 error number. That number is not well defined.
33420
33421 @cindex empty response, for unsupported packets
33422 For any @var{command} not supported by the stub, an empty response
33423 (@samp{$#00}) should be returned. That way it is possible to extend the
33424 protocol. A newer @value{GDBN} can tell if a packet is supported based
33425 on that response.
33426
33427 At a minimum, a stub is required to support the @samp{g} and @samp{G}
33428 commands for register access, and the @samp{m} and @samp{M} commands
33429 for memory access. Stubs that only control single-threaded targets
33430 can implement run control with the @samp{c} (continue), and @samp{s}
33431 (step) commands. Stubs that support multi-threading targets should
33432 support the @samp{vCont} command. All other commands are optional.
33433
33434 @node Packets
33435 @section Packets
33436
33437 The following table provides a complete list of all currently defined
33438 @var{command}s and their corresponding response @var{data}.
33439 @xref{File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension}, for details about the File
33440 I/O extension of the remote protocol.
33441
33442 Each packet's description has a template showing the packet's overall
33443 syntax, followed by an explanation of the packet's meaning. We
33444 include spaces in some of the templates for clarity; these are not
33445 part of the packet's syntax. No @value{GDBN} packet uses spaces to
33446 separate its components. For example, a template like @samp{foo
33447 @var{bar} @var{baz}} describes a packet beginning with the three ASCII
33448 bytes @samp{foo}, followed by a @var{bar}, followed directly by a
33449 @var{baz}. @value{GDBN} does not transmit a space character between the
33450 @samp{foo} and the @var{bar}, or between the @var{bar} and the
33451 @var{baz}.
33452
33453 @cindex @var{thread-id}, in remote protocol
33454 @anchor{thread-id syntax}
33455 Several packets and replies include a @var{thread-id} field to identify
33456 a thread. Normally these are positive numbers with a target-specific
33457 interpretation, formatted as big-endian hex strings. A @var{thread-id}
33458 can also be a literal @samp{-1} to indicate all threads, or @samp{0} to
33459 pick any thread.
33460
33461 In addition, the remote protocol supports a multiprocess feature in
33462 which the @var{thread-id} syntax is extended to optionally include both
33463 process and thread ID fields, as @samp{p@var{pid}.@var{tid}}.
33464 The @var{pid} (process) and @var{tid} (thread) components each have the
33465 format described above: a positive number with target-specific
33466 interpretation formatted as a big-endian hex string, literal @samp{-1}
33467 to indicate all processes or threads (respectively), or @samp{0} to
33468 indicate an arbitrary process or thread. Specifying just a process, as
33469 @samp{p@var{pid}}, is equivalent to @samp{p@var{pid}.-1}. It is an
33470 error to specify all processes but a specific thread, such as
33471 @samp{p-1.@var{tid}}. Note that the @samp{p} prefix is @emph{not} used
33472 for those packets and replies explicitly documented to include a process
33473 ID, rather than a @var{thread-id}.
33474
33475 The multiprocess @var{thread-id} syntax extensions are only used if both
33476 @value{GDBN} and the stub report support for the @samp{multiprocess}
33477 feature using @samp{qSupported}. @xref{multiprocess extensions}, for
33478 more information.
33479
33480 Note that all packet forms beginning with an upper- or lower-case
33481 letter, other than those described here, are reserved for future use.
33482
33483 Here are the packet descriptions.
33484
33485 @table @samp
33486
33487 @item !
33488 @cindex @samp{!} packet
33489 @anchor{extended mode}
33490 Enable extended mode. In extended mode, the remote server is made
33491 persistent. The @samp{R} packet is used to restart the program being
33492 debugged.
33493
33494 Reply:
33495 @table @samp
33496 @item OK
33497 The remote target both supports and has enabled extended mode.
33498 @end table
33499
33500 @item ?
33501 @cindex @samp{?} packet
33502 Indicate the reason the target halted. The reply is the same as for
33503 step and continue. This packet has a special interpretation when the
33504 target is in non-stop mode; see @ref{Remote Non-Stop}.
33505
33506 Reply:
33507 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
33508
33509 @item A @var{arglen},@var{argnum},@var{arg},@dots{}
33510 @cindex @samp{A} packet
33511 Initialized @code{argv[]} array passed into program. @var{arglen}
33512 specifies the number of bytes in the hex encoded byte stream
33513 @var{arg}. See @code{gdbserver} for more details.
33514
33515 Reply:
33516 @table @samp
33517 @item OK
33518 The arguments were set.
33519 @item E @var{NN}
33520 An error occurred.
33521 @end table
33522
33523 @item b @var{baud}
33524 @cindex @samp{b} packet
33525 (Don't use this packet; its behavior is not well-defined.)
33526 Change the serial line speed to @var{baud}.
33527
33528 JTC: @emph{When does the transport layer state change? When it's
33529 received, or after the ACK is transmitted. In either case, there are
33530 problems if the command or the acknowledgment packet is dropped.}
33531
33532 Stan: @emph{If people really wanted to add something like this, and get
33533 it working for the first time, they ought to modify ser-unix.c to send
33534 some kind of out-of-band message to a specially-setup stub and have the
33535 switch happen "in between" packets, so that from remote protocol's point
33536 of view, nothing actually happened.}
33537
33538 @item B @var{addr},@var{mode}
33539 @cindex @samp{B} packet
33540 Set (@var{mode} is @samp{S}) or clear (@var{mode} is @samp{C}) a
33541 breakpoint at @var{addr}.
33542
33543 Don't use this packet. Use the @samp{Z} and @samp{z} packets instead
33544 (@pxref{insert breakpoint or watchpoint packet}).
33545
33546 @cindex @samp{bc} packet
33547 @anchor{bc}
33548 @item bc
33549 Backward continue. Execute the target system in reverse. No parameter.
33550 @xref{Reverse Execution}, for more information.
33551
33552 Reply:
33553 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
33554
33555 @cindex @samp{bs} packet
33556 @anchor{bs}
33557 @item bs
33558 Backward single step. Execute one instruction in reverse. No parameter.
33559 @xref{Reverse Execution}, for more information.
33560
33561 Reply:
33562 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
33563
33564 @item c @r{[}@var{addr}@r{]}
33565 @cindex @samp{c} packet
33566 Continue. @var{addr} is address to resume. If @var{addr} is omitted,
33567 resume at current address.
33568
33569 This packet is deprecated for multi-threading support. @xref{vCont
33570 packet}.
33571
33572 Reply:
33573 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
33574
33575 @item C @var{sig}@r{[};@var{addr}@r{]}
33576 @cindex @samp{C} packet
33577 Continue with signal @var{sig} (hex signal number). If
33578 @samp{;@var{addr}} is omitted, resume at same address.
33579
33580 This packet is deprecated for multi-threading support. @xref{vCont
33581 packet}.
33582
33583 Reply:
33584 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
33585
33586 @item d
33587 @cindex @samp{d} packet
33588 Toggle debug flag.
33589
33590 Don't use this packet; instead, define a general set packet
33591 (@pxref{General Query Packets}).
33592
33593 @item D
33594 @itemx D;@var{pid}
33595 @cindex @samp{D} packet
33596 The first form of the packet is used to detach @value{GDBN} from the
33597 remote system. It is sent to the remote target
33598 before @value{GDBN} disconnects via the @code{detach} command.
33599
33600 The second form, including a process ID, is used when multiprocess
33601 protocol extensions are enabled (@pxref{multiprocess extensions}), to
33602 detach only a specific process. The @var{pid} is specified as a
33603 big-endian hex string.
33604
33605 Reply:
33606 @table @samp
33607 @item OK
33608 for success
33609 @item E @var{NN}
33610 for an error
33611 @end table
33612
33613 @item F @var{RC},@var{EE},@var{CF};@var{XX}
33614 @cindex @samp{F} packet
33615 A reply from @value{GDBN} to an @samp{F} packet sent by the target.
33616 This is part of the File-I/O protocol extension. @xref{File-I/O
33617 Remote Protocol Extension}, for the specification.
33618
33619 @item g
33620 @anchor{read registers packet}
33621 @cindex @samp{g} packet
33622 Read general registers.
33623
33624 Reply:
33625 @table @samp
33626 @item @var{XX@dots{}}
33627 Each byte of register data is described by two hex digits. The bytes
33628 with the register are transmitted in target byte order. The size of
33629 each register and their position within the @samp{g} packet are
33630 determined by the @value{GDBN} internal gdbarch functions
33631 @code{DEPRECATED_REGISTER_RAW_SIZE} and @code{gdbarch_register_name}. The
33632 specification of several standard @samp{g} packets is specified below.
33633
33634 When reading registers from a trace frame (@pxref{Analyze Collected
33635 Data,,Using the Collected Data}), the stub may also return a string of
33636 literal @samp{x}'s in place of the register data digits, to indicate
33637 that the corresponding register has not been collected, thus its value
33638 is unavailable. For example, for an architecture with 4 registers of
33639 4 bytes each, the following reply indicates to @value{GDBN} that
33640 registers 0 and 2 have not been collected, while registers 1 and 3
33641 have been collected, and both have zero value:
33642
33643 @smallexample
33644 -> @code{g}
33645 <- @code{xxxxxxxx00000000xxxxxxxx00000000}
33646 @end smallexample
33647
33648 @item E @var{NN}
33649 for an error.
33650 @end table
33651
33652 @item G @var{XX@dots{}}
33653 @cindex @samp{G} packet
33654 Write general registers. @xref{read registers packet}, for a
33655 description of the @var{XX@dots{}} data.
33656
33657 Reply:
33658 @table @samp
33659 @item OK
33660 for success
33661 @item E @var{NN}
33662 for an error
33663 @end table
33664
33665 @item H @var{op} @var{thread-id}
33666 @cindex @samp{H} packet
33667 Set thread for subsequent operations (@samp{m}, @samp{M}, @samp{g},
33668 @samp{G}, et.al.). @var{op} depends on the operation to be performed:
33669 it should be @samp{c} for step and continue operations (note that this
33670 is deprecated, supporting the @samp{vCont} command is a better
33671 option), @samp{g} for other operations. The thread designator
33672 @var{thread-id} has the format and interpretation described in
33673 @ref{thread-id syntax}.
33674
33675 Reply:
33676 @table @samp
33677 @item OK
33678 for success
33679 @item E @var{NN}
33680 for an error
33681 @end table
33682
33683 @c FIXME: JTC:
33684 @c 'H': How restrictive (or permissive) is the thread model. If a
33685 @c thread is selected and stopped, are other threads allowed
33686 @c to continue to execute? As I mentioned above, I think the
33687 @c semantics of each command when a thread is selected must be
33688 @c described. For example:
33689 @c
33690 @c 'g': If the stub supports threads and a specific thread is
33691 @c selected, returns the register block from that thread;
33692 @c otherwise returns current registers.
33693 @c
33694 @c 'G' If the stub supports threads and a specific thread is
33695 @c selected, sets the registers of the register block of
33696 @c that thread; otherwise sets current registers.
33697
33698 @item i @r{[}@var{addr}@r{[},@var{nnn}@r{]]}
33699 @anchor{cycle step packet}
33700 @cindex @samp{i} packet
33701 Step the remote target by a single clock cycle. If @samp{,@var{nnn}} is
33702 present, cycle step @var{nnn} cycles. If @var{addr} is present, cycle
33703 step starting at that address.
33704
33705 @item I
33706 @cindex @samp{I} packet
33707 Signal, then cycle step. @xref{step with signal packet}. @xref{cycle
33708 step packet}.
33709
33710 @item k
33711 @cindex @samp{k} packet
33712 Kill request.
33713
33714 FIXME: @emph{There is no description of how to operate when a specific
33715 thread context has been selected (i.e.@: does 'k' kill only that
33716 thread?)}.
33717
33718 @item m @var{addr},@var{length}
33719 @cindex @samp{m} packet
33720 Read @var{length} bytes of memory starting at address @var{addr}.
33721 Note that @var{addr} may not be aligned to any particular boundary.
33722
33723 The stub need not use any particular size or alignment when gathering
33724 data from memory for the response; even if @var{addr} is word-aligned
33725 and @var{length} is a multiple of the word size, the stub is free to
33726 use byte accesses, or not. For this reason, this packet may not be
33727 suitable for accessing memory-mapped I/O devices.
33728 @cindex alignment of remote memory accesses
33729 @cindex size of remote memory accesses
33730 @cindex memory, alignment and size of remote accesses
33731
33732 Reply:
33733 @table @samp
33734 @item @var{XX@dots{}}
33735 Memory contents; each byte is transmitted as a two-digit hexadecimal
33736 number. The reply may contain fewer bytes than requested if the
33737 server was able to read only part of the region of memory.
33738 @item E @var{NN}
33739 @var{NN} is errno
33740 @end table
33741
33742 @item M @var{addr},@var{length}:@var{XX@dots{}}
33743 @cindex @samp{M} packet
33744 Write @var{length} bytes of memory starting at address @var{addr}.
33745 @var{XX@dots{}} is the data; each byte is transmitted as a two-digit
33746 hexadecimal number.
33747
33748 Reply:
33749 @table @samp
33750 @item OK
33751 for success
33752 @item E @var{NN}
33753 for an error (this includes the case where only part of the data was
33754 written).
33755 @end table
33756
33757 @item p @var{n}
33758 @cindex @samp{p} packet
33759 Read the value of register @var{n}; @var{n} is in hex.
33760 @xref{read registers packet}, for a description of how the returned
33761 register value is encoded.
33762
33763 Reply:
33764 @table @samp
33765 @item @var{XX@dots{}}
33766 the register's value
33767 @item E @var{NN}
33768 for an error
33769 @item
33770 Indicating an unrecognized @var{query}.
33771 @end table
33772
33773 @item P @var{n@dots{}}=@var{r@dots{}}
33774 @anchor{write register packet}
33775 @cindex @samp{P} packet
33776 Write register @var{n@dots{}} with value @var{r@dots{}}. The register
33777 number @var{n} is in hexadecimal, and @var{r@dots{}} contains two hex
33778 digits for each byte in the register (target byte order).
33779
33780 Reply:
33781 @table @samp
33782 @item OK
33783 for success
33784 @item E @var{NN}
33785 for an error
33786 @end table
33787
33788 @item q @var{name} @var{params}@dots{}
33789 @itemx Q @var{name} @var{params}@dots{}
33790 @cindex @samp{q} packet
33791 @cindex @samp{Q} packet
33792 General query (@samp{q}) and set (@samp{Q}). These packets are
33793 described fully in @ref{General Query Packets}.
33794
33795 @item r
33796 @cindex @samp{r} packet
33797 Reset the entire system.
33798
33799 Don't use this packet; use the @samp{R} packet instead.
33800
33801 @item R @var{XX}
33802 @cindex @samp{R} packet
33803 Restart the program being debugged. @var{XX}, while needed, is ignored.
33804 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended mode}).
33805
33806 The @samp{R} packet has no reply.
33807
33808 @item s @r{[}@var{addr}@r{]}
33809 @cindex @samp{s} packet
33810 Single step. @var{addr} is the address at which to resume. If
33811 @var{addr} is omitted, resume at same address.
33812
33813 This packet is deprecated for multi-threading support. @xref{vCont
33814 packet}.
33815
33816 Reply:
33817 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
33818
33819 @item S @var{sig}@r{[};@var{addr}@r{]}
33820 @anchor{step with signal packet}
33821 @cindex @samp{S} packet
33822 Step with signal. This is analogous to the @samp{C} packet, but
33823 requests a single-step, rather than a normal resumption of execution.
33824
33825 This packet is deprecated for multi-threading support. @xref{vCont
33826 packet}.
33827
33828 Reply:
33829 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
33830
33831 @item t @var{addr}:@var{PP},@var{MM}
33832 @cindex @samp{t} packet
33833 Search backwards starting at address @var{addr} for a match with pattern
33834 @var{PP} and mask @var{MM}. @var{PP} and @var{MM} are 4 bytes.
33835 @var{addr} must be at least 3 digits.
33836
33837 @item T @var{thread-id}
33838 @cindex @samp{T} packet
33839 Find out if the thread @var{thread-id} is alive. @xref{thread-id syntax}.
33840
33841 Reply:
33842 @table @samp
33843 @item OK
33844 thread is still alive
33845 @item E @var{NN}
33846 thread is dead
33847 @end table
33848
33849 @item v
33850 Packets starting with @samp{v} are identified by a multi-letter name,
33851 up to the first @samp{;} or @samp{?} (or the end of the packet).
33852
33853 @item vAttach;@var{pid}
33854 @cindex @samp{vAttach} packet
33855 Attach to a new process with the specified process ID @var{pid}.
33856 The process ID is a
33857 hexadecimal integer identifying the process. In all-stop mode, all
33858 threads in the attached process are stopped; in non-stop mode, it may be
33859 attached without being stopped if that is supported by the target.
33860
33861 @c In non-stop mode, on a successful vAttach, the stub should set the
33862 @c current thread to a thread of the newly-attached process. After
33863 @c attaching, GDB queries for the attached process's thread ID with qC.
33864 @c Also note that, from a user perspective, whether or not the
33865 @c target is stopped on attach in non-stop mode depends on whether you
33866 @c use the foreground or background version of the attach command, not
33867 @c on what vAttach does; GDB does the right thing with respect to either
33868 @c stopping or restarting threads.
33869
33870 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended mode}).
33871
33872 Reply:
33873 @table @samp
33874 @item E @var{nn}
33875 for an error
33876 @item @r{Any stop packet}
33877 for success in all-stop mode (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets})
33878 @item OK
33879 for success in non-stop mode (@pxref{Remote Non-Stop})
33880 @end table
33881
33882 @item vCont@r{[};@var{action}@r{[}:@var{thread-id}@r{]]}@dots{}
33883 @cindex @samp{vCont} packet
33884 @anchor{vCont packet}
33885 Resume the inferior, specifying different actions for each thread.
33886 If an action is specified with no @var{thread-id}, then it is applied to any
33887 threads that don't have a specific action specified; if no default action is
33888 specified then other threads should remain stopped in all-stop mode and
33889 in their current state in non-stop mode.
33890 Specifying multiple
33891 default actions is an error; specifying no actions is also an error.
33892 Thread IDs are specified using the syntax described in @ref{thread-id syntax}.
33893
33894 Currently supported actions are:
33895
33896 @table @samp
33897 @item c
33898 Continue.
33899 @item C @var{sig}
33900 Continue with signal @var{sig}. The signal @var{sig} should be two hex digits.
33901 @item s
33902 Step.
33903 @item S @var{sig}
33904 Step with signal @var{sig}. The signal @var{sig} should be two hex digits.
33905 @item t
33906 Stop.
33907 @end table
33908
33909 The optional argument @var{addr} normally associated with the
33910 @samp{c}, @samp{C}, @samp{s}, and @samp{S} packets is
33911 not supported in @samp{vCont}.
33912
33913 The @samp{t} action is only relevant in non-stop mode
33914 (@pxref{Remote Non-Stop}) and may be ignored by the stub otherwise.
33915 A stop reply should be generated for any affected thread not already stopped.
33916 When a thread is stopped by means of a @samp{t} action,
33917 the corresponding stop reply should indicate that the thread has stopped with
33918 signal @samp{0}, regardless of whether the target uses some other signal
33919 as an implementation detail.
33920
33921 Reply:
33922 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
33923
33924 @item vCont?
33925 @cindex @samp{vCont?} packet
33926 Request a list of actions supported by the @samp{vCont} packet.
33927
33928 Reply:
33929 @table @samp
33930 @item vCont@r{[};@var{action}@dots{}@r{]}
33931 The @samp{vCont} packet is supported. Each @var{action} is a supported
33932 command in the @samp{vCont} packet.
33933 @item
33934 The @samp{vCont} packet is not supported.
33935 @end table
33936
33937 @item vFile:@var{operation}:@var{parameter}@dots{}
33938 @cindex @samp{vFile} packet
33939 Perform a file operation on the target system. For details,
33940 see @ref{Host I/O Packets}.
33941
33942 @item vFlashErase:@var{addr},@var{length}
33943 @cindex @samp{vFlashErase} packet
33944 Direct the stub to erase @var{length} bytes of flash starting at
33945 @var{addr}. The region may enclose any number of flash blocks, but
33946 its start and end must fall on block boundaries, as indicated by the
33947 flash block size appearing in the memory map (@pxref{Memory Map
33948 Format}). @value{GDBN} groups flash memory programming operations
33949 together, and sends a @samp{vFlashDone} request after each group; the
33950 stub is allowed to delay erase operation until the @samp{vFlashDone}
33951 packet is received.
33952
33953 The stub must support @samp{vCont} if it reports support for
33954 multiprocess extensions (@pxref{multiprocess extensions}). Note that in
33955 this case @samp{vCont} actions can be specified to apply to all threads
33956 in a process by using the @samp{p@var{pid}.-1} form of the
33957 @var{thread-id}.
33958
33959 Reply:
33960 @table @samp
33961 @item OK
33962 for success
33963 @item E @var{NN}
33964 for an error
33965 @end table
33966
33967 @item vFlashWrite:@var{addr}:@var{XX@dots{}}
33968 @cindex @samp{vFlashWrite} packet
33969 Direct the stub to write data to flash address @var{addr}. The data
33970 is passed in binary form using the same encoding as for the @samp{X}
33971 packet (@pxref{Binary Data}). The memory ranges specified by
33972 @samp{vFlashWrite} packets preceding a @samp{vFlashDone} packet must
33973 not overlap, and must appear in order of increasing addresses
33974 (although @samp{vFlashErase} packets for higher addresses may already
33975 have been received; the ordering is guaranteed only between
33976 @samp{vFlashWrite} packets). If a packet writes to an address that was
33977 neither erased by a preceding @samp{vFlashErase} packet nor by some other
33978 target-specific method, the results are unpredictable.
33979
33980
33981 Reply:
33982 @table @samp
33983 @item OK
33984 for success
33985 @item E.memtype
33986 for vFlashWrite addressing non-flash memory
33987 @item E @var{NN}
33988 for an error
33989 @end table
33990
33991 @item vFlashDone
33992 @cindex @samp{vFlashDone} packet
33993 Indicate to the stub that flash programming operation is finished.
33994 The stub is permitted to delay or batch the effects of a group of
33995 @samp{vFlashErase} and @samp{vFlashWrite} packets until a
33996 @samp{vFlashDone} packet is received. The contents of the affected
33997 regions of flash memory are unpredictable until the @samp{vFlashDone}
33998 request is completed.
33999
34000 @item vKill;@var{pid}
34001 @cindex @samp{vKill} packet
34002 Kill the process with the specified process ID. @var{pid} is a
34003 hexadecimal integer identifying the process. This packet is used in
34004 preference to @samp{k} when multiprocess protocol extensions are
34005 supported; see @ref{multiprocess extensions}.
34006
34007 Reply:
34008 @table @samp
34009 @item E @var{nn}
34010 for an error
34011 @item OK
34012 for success
34013 @end table
34014
34015 @item vRun;@var{filename}@r{[};@var{argument}@r{]}@dots{}
34016 @cindex @samp{vRun} packet
34017 Run the program @var{filename}, passing it each @var{argument} on its
34018 command line. The file and arguments are hex-encoded strings. If
34019 @var{filename} is an empty string, the stub may use a default program
34020 (e.g.@: the last program run). The program is created in the stopped
34021 state.
34022
34023 @c FIXME: What about non-stop mode?
34024
34025 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended mode}).
34026
34027 Reply:
34028 @table @samp
34029 @item E @var{nn}
34030 for an error
34031 @item @r{Any stop packet}
34032 for success (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets})
34033 @end table
34034
34035 @item vStopped
34036 @anchor{vStopped packet}
34037 @cindex @samp{vStopped} packet
34038
34039 In non-stop mode (@pxref{Remote Non-Stop}), acknowledge a previous stop
34040 reply and prompt for the stub to report another one.
34041
34042 Reply:
34043 @table @samp
34044 @item @r{Any stop packet}
34045 if there is another unreported stop event (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets})
34046 @item OK
34047 if there are no unreported stop events
34048 @end table
34049
34050 @item X @var{addr},@var{length}:@var{XX@dots{}}
34051 @anchor{X packet}
34052 @cindex @samp{X} packet
34053 Write data to memory, where the data is transmitted in binary.
34054 @var{addr} is address, @var{length} is number of bytes,
34055 @samp{@var{XX}@dots{}} is binary data (@pxref{Binary Data}).
34056
34057 Reply:
34058 @table @samp
34059 @item OK
34060 for success
34061 @item E @var{NN}
34062 for an error
34063 @end table
34064
34065 @item z @var{type},@var{addr},@var{kind}
34066 @itemx Z @var{type},@var{addr},@var{kind}
34067 @anchor{insert breakpoint or watchpoint packet}
34068 @cindex @samp{z} packet
34069 @cindex @samp{Z} packets
34070 Insert (@samp{Z}) or remove (@samp{z}) a @var{type} breakpoint or
34071 watchpoint starting at address @var{address} of kind @var{kind}.
34072
34073 Each breakpoint and watchpoint packet @var{type} is documented
34074 separately.
34075
34076 @emph{Implementation notes: A remote target shall return an empty string
34077 for an unrecognized breakpoint or watchpoint packet @var{type}. A
34078 remote target shall support either both or neither of a given
34079 @samp{Z@var{type}@dots{}} and @samp{z@var{type}@dots{}} packet pair. To
34080 avoid potential problems with duplicate packets, the operations should
34081 be implemented in an idempotent way.}
34082
34083 @item z0,@var{addr},@var{kind}
34084 @itemx Z0,@var{addr},@var{kind}
34085 @cindex @samp{z0} packet
34086 @cindex @samp{Z0} packet
34087 Insert (@samp{Z0}) or remove (@samp{z0}) a memory breakpoint at address
34088 @var{addr} of type @var{kind}.
34089
34090 A memory breakpoint is implemented by replacing the instruction at
34091 @var{addr} with a software breakpoint or trap instruction. The
34092 @var{kind} is target-specific and typically indicates the size of
34093 the breakpoint in bytes that should be inserted. E.g., the @sc{arm}
34094 and @sc{mips} can insert either a 2 or 4 byte breakpoint. Some
34095 architectures have additional meanings for @var{kind};
34096 see @ref{Architecture-Specific Protocol Details}.
34097
34098 @emph{Implementation note: It is possible for a target to copy or move
34099 code that contains memory breakpoints (e.g., when implementing
34100 overlays). The behavior of this packet, in the presence of such a
34101 target, is not defined.}
34102
34103 Reply:
34104 @table @samp
34105 @item OK
34106 success
34107 @item
34108 not supported
34109 @item E @var{NN}
34110 for an error
34111 @end table
34112
34113 @item z1,@var{addr},@var{kind}
34114 @itemx Z1,@var{addr},@var{kind}
34115 @cindex @samp{z1} packet
34116 @cindex @samp{Z1} packet
34117 Insert (@samp{Z1}) or remove (@samp{z1}) a hardware breakpoint at
34118 address @var{addr}.
34119
34120 A hardware breakpoint is implemented using a mechanism that is not
34121 dependant on being able to modify the target's memory. @var{kind}
34122 has the same meaning as in @samp{Z0} packets.
34123
34124 @emph{Implementation note: A hardware breakpoint is not affected by code
34125 movement.}
34126
34127 Reply:
34128 @table @samp
34129 @item OK
34130 success
34131 @item
34132 not supported
34133 @item E @var{NN}
34134 for an error
34135 @end table
34136
34137 @item z2,@var{addr},@var{kind}
34138 @itemx Z2,@var{addr},@var{kind}
34139 @cindex @samp{z2} packet
34140 @cindex @samp{Z2} packet
34141 Insert (@samp{Z2}) or remove (@samp{z2}) a write watchpoint at @var{addr}.
34142 @var{kind} is interpreted as the number of bytes to watch.
34143
34144 Reply:
34145 @table @samp
34146 @item OK
34147 success
34148 @item
34149 not supported
34150 @item E @var{NN}
34151 for an error
34152 @end table
34153
34154 @item z3,@var{addr},@var{kind}
34155 @itemx Z3,@var{addr},@var{kind}
34156 @cindex @samp{z3} packet
34157 @cindex @samp{Z3} packet
34158 Insert (@samp{Z3}) or remove (@samp{z3}) a read watchpoint at @var{addr}.
34159 @var{kind} is interpreted as the number of bytes to watch.
34160
34161 Reply:
34162 @table @samp
34163 @item OK
34164 success
34165 @item
34166 not supported
34167 @item E @var{NN}
34168 for an error
34169 @end table
34170
34171 @item z4,@var{addr},@var{kind}
34172 @itemx Z4,@var{addr},@var{kind}
34173 @cindex @samp{z4} packet
34174 @cindex @samp{Z4} packet
34175 Insert (@samp{Z4}) or remove (@samp{z4}) an access watchpoint at @var{addr}.
34176 @var{kind} is interpreted as the number of bytes to watch.
34177
34178 Reply:
34179 @table @samp
34180 @item OK
34181 success
34182 @item
34183 not supported
34184 @item E @var{NN}
34185 for an error
34186 @end table
34187
34188 @end table
34189
34190 @node Stop Reply Packets
34191 @section Stop Reply Packets
34192 @cindex stop reply packets
34193
34194 The @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S}, @samp{s}, @samp{vCont},
34195 @samp{vAttach}, @samp{vRun}, @samp{vStopped}, and @samp{?} packets can
34196 receive any of the below as a reply. Except for @samp{?}
34197 and @samp{vStopped}, that reply is only returned
34198 when the target halts. In the below the exact meaning of @dfn{signal
34199 number} is defined by the header @file{include/gdb/signals.h} in the
34200 @value{GDBN} source code.
34201
34202 As in the description of request packets, we include spaces in the
34203 reply templates for clarity; these are not part of the reply packet's
34204 syntax. No @value{GDBN} stop reply packet uses spaces to separate its
34205 components.
34206
34207 @table @samp
34208
34209 @item S @var{AA}
34210 The program received signal number @var{AA} (a two-digit hexadecimal
34211 number). This is equivalent to a @samp{T} response with no
34212 @var{n}:@var{r} pairs.
34213
34214 @item T @var{AA} @var{n1}:@var{r1};@var{n2}:@var{r2};@dots{}
34215 @cindex @samp{T} packet reply
34216 The program received signal number @var{AA} (a two-digit hexadecimal
34217 number). This is equivalent to an @samp{S} response, except that the
34218 @samp{@var{n}:@var{r}} pairs can carry values of important registers
34219 and other information directly in the stop reply packet, reducing
34220 round-trip latency. Single-step and breakpoint traps are reported
34221 this way. Each @samp{@var{n}:@var{r}} pair is interpreted as follows:
34222
34223 @itemize @bullet
34224 @item
34225 If @var{n} is a hexadecimal number, it is a register number, and the
34226 corresponding @var{r} gives that register's value. @var{r} is a
34227 series of bytes in target byte order, with each byte given by a
34228 two-digit hex number.
34229
34230 @item
34231 If @var{n} is @samp{thread}, then @var{r} is the @var{thread-id} of
34232 the stopped thread, as specified in @ref{thread-id syntax}.
34233
34234 @item
34235 If @var{n} is @samp{core}, then @var{r} is the hexadecimal number of
34236 the core on which the stop event was detected.
34237
34238 @item
34239 If @var{n} is a recognized @dfn{stop reason}, it describes a more
34240 specific event that stopped the target. The currently defined stop
34241 reasons are listed below. @var{aa} should be @samp{05}, the trap
34242 signal. At most one stop reason should be present.
34243
34244 @item
34245 Otherwise, @value{GDBN} should ignore this @samp{@var{n}:@var{r}} pair
34246 and go on to the next; this allows us to extend the protocol in the
34247 future.
34248 @end itemize
34249
34250 The currently defined stop reasons are:
34251
34252 @table @samp
34253 @item watch
34254 @itemx rwatch
34255 @itemx awatch
34256 The packet indicates a watchpoint hit, and @var{r} is the data address, in
34257 hex.
34258
34259 @cindex shared library events, remote reply
34260 @item library
34261 The packet indicates that the loaded libraries have changed.
34262 @value{GDBN} should use @samp{qXfer:libraries:read} to fetch a new
34263 list of loaded libraries. @var{r} is ignored.
34264
34265 @cindex replay log events, remote reply
34266 @item replaylog
34267 The packet indicates that the target cannot continue replaying
34268 logged execution events, because it has reached the end (or the
34269 beginning when executing backward) of the log. The value of @var{r}
34270 will be either @samp{begin} or @samp{end}. @xref{Reverse Execution},
34271 for more information.
34272 @end table
34273
34274 @item W @var{AA}
34275 @itemx W @var{AA} ; process:@var{pid}
34276 The process exited, and @var{AA} is the exit status. This is only
34277 applicable to certain targets.
34278
34279 The second form of the response, including the process ID of the exited
34280 process, can be used only when @value{GDBN} has reported support for
34281 multiprocess protocol extensions; see @ref{multiprocess extensions}.
34282 The @var{pid} is formatted as a big-endian hex string.
34283
34284 @item X @var{AA}
34285 @itemx X @var{AA} ; process:@var{pid}
34286 The process terminated with signal @var{AA}.
34287
34288 The second form of the response, including the process ID of the
34289 terminated process, can be used only when @value{GDBN} has reported
34290 support for multiprocess protocol extensions; see @ref{multiprocess
34291 extensions}. The @var{pid} is formatted as a big-endian hex string.
34292
34293 @item O @var{XX}@dots{}
34294 @samp{@var{XX}@dots{}} is hex encoding of @sc{ascii} data, to be
34295 written as the program's console output. This can happen at any time
34296 while the program is running and the debugger should continue to wait
34297 for @samp{W}, @samp{T}, etc. This reply is not permitted in non-stop mode.
34298
34299 @item F @var{call-id},@var{parameter}@dots{}
34300 @var{call-id} is the identifier which says which host system call should
34301 be called. This is just the name of the function. Translation into the
34302 correct system call is only applicable as it's defined in @value{GDBN}.
34303 @xref{File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension}, for a list of implemented
34304 system calls.
34305
34306 @samp{@var{parameter}@dots{}} is a list of parameters as defined for
34307 this very system call.
34308
34309 The target replies with this packet when it expects @value{GDBN} to
34310 call a host system call on behalf of the target. @value{GDBN} replies
34311 with an appropriate @samp{F} packet and keeps up waiting for the next
34312 reply packet from the target. The latest @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S}
34313 or @samp{s} action is expected to be continued. @xref{File-I/O Remote
34314 Protocol Extension}, for more details.
34315
34316 @end table
34317
34318 @node General Query Packets
34319 @section General Query Packets
34320 @cindex remote query requests
34321
34322 Packets starting with @samp{q} are @dfn{general query packets};
34323 packets starting with @samp{Q} are @dfn{general set packets}. General
34324 query and set packets are a semi-unified form for retrieving and
34325 sending information to and from the stub.
34326
34327 The initial letter of a query or set packet is followed by a name
34328 indicating what sort of thing the packet applies to. For example,
34329 @value{GDBN} may use a @samp{qSymbol} packet to exchange symbol
34330 definitions with the stub. These packet names follow some
34331 conventions:
34332
34333 @itemize @bullet
34334 @item
34335 The name must not contain commas, colons or semicolons.
34336 @item
34337 Most @value{GDBN} query and set packets have a leading upper case
34338 letter.
34339 @item
34340 The names of custom vendor packets should use a company prefix, in
34341 lower case, followed by a period. For example, packets designed at
34342 the Acme Corporation might begin with @samp{qacme.foo} (for querying
34343 foos) or @samp{Qacme.bar} (for setting bars).
34344 @end itemize
34345
34346 The name of a query or set packet should be separated from any
34347 parameters by a @samp{:}; the parameters themselves should be
34348 separated by @samp{,} or @samp{;}. Stubs must be careful to match the
34349 full packet name, and check for a separator or the end of the packet,
34350 in case two packet names share a common prefix. New packets should not begin
34351 with @samp{qC}, @samp{qP}, or @samp{qL}@footnote{The @samp{qP} and @samp{qL}
34352 packets predate these conventions, and have arguments without any terminator
34353 for the packet name; we suspect they are in widespread use in places that
34354 are difficult to upgrade. The @samp{qC} packet has no arguments, but some
34355 existing stubs (e.g.@: RedBoot) are known to not check for the end of the
34356 packet.}.
34357
34358 Like the descriptions of the other packets, each description here
34359 has a template showing the packet's overall syntax, followed by an
34360 explanation of the packet's meaning. We include spaces in some of the
34361 templates for clarity; these are not part of the packet's syntax. No
34362 @value{GDBN} packet uses spaces to separate its components.
34363
34364 Here are the currently defined query and set packets:
34365
34366 @table @samp
34367
34368 @item QAllow:@var{op}:@var{val}@dots{}
34369 @cindex @samp{QAllow} packet
34370 Specify which operations @value{GDBN} expects to request of the
34371 target, as a semicolon-separated list of operation name and value
34372 pairs. Possible values for @var{op} include @samp{WriteReg},
34373 @samp{WriteMem}, @samp{InsertBreak}, @samp{InsertTrace},
34374 @samp{InsertFastTrace}, and @samp{Stop}. @var{val} is either 0,
34375 indicating that @value{GDBN} will not request the operation, or 1,
34376 indicating that it may. (The target can then use this to set up its
34377 own internals optimally, for instance if the debugger never expects to
34378 insert breakpoints, it may not need to install its own trap handler.)
34379
34380 @item qC
34381 @cindex current thread, remote request
34382 @cindex @samp{qC} packet
34383 Return the current thread ID.
34384
34385 Reply:
34386 @table @samp
34387 @item QC @var{thread-id}
34388 Where @var{thread-id} is a thread ID as documented in
34389 @ref{thread-id syntax}.
34390 @item @r{(anything else)}
34391 Any other reply implies the old thread ID.
34392 @end table
34393
34394 @item qCRC:@var{addr},@var{length}
34395 @cindex CRC of memory block, remote request
34396 @cindex @samp{qCRC} packet
34397 Compute the CRC checksum of a block of memory using CRC-32 defined in
34398 IEEE 802.3. The CRC is computed byte at a time, taking the most
34399 significant bit of each byte first. The initial pattern code
34400 @code{0xffffffff} is used to ensure leading zeros affect the CRC.
34401
34402 @emph{Note:} This is the same CRC used in validating separate debug
34403 files (@pxref{Separate Debug Files, , Debugging Information in Separate
34404 Files}). However the algorithm is slightly different. When validating
34405 separate debug files, the CRC is computed taking the @emph{least}
34406 significant bit of each byte first, and the final result is inverted to
34407 detect trailing zeros.
34408
34409 Reply:
34410 @table @samp
34411 @item E @var{NN}
34412 An error (such as memory fault)
34413 @item C @var{crc32}
34414 The specified memory region's checksum is @var{crc32}.
34415 @end table
34416
34417 @item QDisableRandomization:@var{value}
34418 @cindex disable address space randomization, remote request
34419 @cindex @samp{QDisableRandomization} packet
34420 Some target operating systems will randomize the virtual address space
34421 of the inferior process as a security feature, but provide a feature
34422 to disable such randomization, e.g.@: to allow for a more deterministic
34423 debugging experience. On such systems, this packet with a @var{value}
34424 of 1 directs the target to disable address space randomization for
34425 processes subsequently started via @samp{vRun} packets, while a packet
34426 with a @var{value} of 0 tells the target to enable address space
34427 randomization.
34428
34429 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended mode}).
34430
34431 Reply:
34432 @table @samp
34433 @item OK
34434 The request succeeded.
34435
34436 @item E @var{nn}
34437 An error occurred. @var{nn} are hex digits.
34438
34439 @item
34440 An empty reply indicates that @samp{QDisableRandomization} is not supported
34441 by the stub.
34442 @end table
34443
34444 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
34445 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
34446 This should only be done on targets that actually support disabling
34447 address space randomization.
34448
34449 @item qfThreadInfo
34450 @itemx qsThreadInfo
34451 @cindex list active threads, remote request
34452 @cindex @samp{qfThreadInfo} packet
34453 @cindex @samp{qsThreadInfo} packet
34454 Obtain a list of all active thread IDs from the target (OS). Since there
34455 may be too many active threads to fit into one reply packet, this query
34456 works iteratively: it may require more than one query/reply sequence to
34457 obtain the entire list of threads. The first query of the sequence will
34458 be the @samp{qfThreadInfo} query; subsequent queries in the
34459 sequence will be the @samp{qsThreadInfo} query.
34460
34461 NOTE: This packet replaces the @samp{qL} query (see below).
34462
34463 Reply:
34464 @table @samp
34465 @item m @var{thread-id}
34466 A single thread ID
34467 @item m @var{thread-id},@var{thread-id}@dots{}
34468 a comma-separated list of thread IDs
34469 @item l
34470 (lower case letter @samp{L}) denotes end of list.
34471 @end table
34472
34473 In response to each query, the target will reply with a list of one or
34474 more thread IDs, separated by commas.
34475 @value{GDBN} will respond to each reply with a request for more thread
34476 ids (using the @samp{qs} form of the query), until the target responds
34477 with @samp{l} (lower-case ell, for @dfn{last}).
34478 Refer to @ref{thread-id syntax}, for the format of the @var{thread-id}
34479 fields.
34480
34481 @item qGetTLSAddr:@var{thread-id},@var{offset},@var{lm}
34482 @cindex get thread-local storage address, remote request
34483 @cindex @samp{qGetTLSAddr} packet
34484 Fetch the address associated with thread local storage specified
34485 by @var{thread-id}, @var{offset}, and @var{lm}.
34486
34487 @var{thread-id} is the thread ID associated with the
34488 thread for which to fetch the TLS address. @xref{thread-id syntax}.
34489
34490 @var{offset} is the (big endian, hex encoded) offset associated with the
34491 thread local variable. (This offset is obtained from the debug
34492 information associated with the variable.)
34493
34494 @var{lm} is the (big endian, hex encoded) OS/ABI-specific encoding of the
34495 load module associated with the thread local storage. For example,
34496 a @sc{gnu}/Linux system will pass the link map address of the shared
34497 object associated with the thread local storage under consideration.
34498 Other operating environments may choose to represent the load module
34499 differently, so the precise meaning of this parameter will vary.
34500
34501 Reply:
34502 @table @samp
34503 @item @var{XX}@dots{}
34504 Hex encoded (big endian) bytes representing the address of the thread
34505 local storage requested.
34506
34507 @item E @var{nn}
34508 An error occurred. @var{nn} are hex digits.
34509
34510 @item
34511 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qGetTLSAddr} is not supported by the stub.
34512 @end table
34513
34514 @item qGetTIBAddr:@var{thread-id}
34515 @cindex get thread information block address
34516 @cindex @samp{qGetTIBAddr} packet
34517 Fetch address of the Windows OS specific Thread Information Block.
34518
34519 @var{thread-id} is the thread ID associated with the thread.
34520
34521 Reply:
34522 @table @samp
34523 @item @var{XX}@dots{}
34524 Hex encoded (big endian) bytes representing the linear address of the
34525 thread information block.
34526
34527 @item E @var{nn}
34528 An error occured. This means that either the thread was not found, or the
34529 address could not be retrieved.
34530
34531 @item
34532 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qGetTIBAddr} is not supported by the stub.
34533 @end table
34534
34535 @item qL @var{startflag} @var{threadcount} @var{nextthread}
34536 Obtain thread information from RTOS. Where: @var{startflag} (one hex
34537 digit) is one to indicate the first query and zero to indicate a
34538 subsequent query; @var{threadcount} (two hex digits) is the maximum
34539 number of threads the response packet can contain; and @var{nextthread}
34540 (eight hex digits), for subsequent queries (@var{startflag} is zero), is
34541 returned in the response as @var{argthread}.
34542
34543 Don't use this packet; use the @samp{qfThreadInfo} query instead (see above).
34544
34545 Reply:
34546 @table @samp
34547 @item qM @var{count} @var{done} @var{argthread} @var{thread}@dots{}
34548 Where: @var{count} (two hex digits) is the number of threads being
34549 returned; @var{done} (one hex digit) is zero to indicate more threads
34550 and one indicates no further threads; @var{argthreadid} (eight hex
34551 digits) is @var{nextthread} from the request packet; @var{thread}@dots{}
34552 is a sequence of thread IDs from the target. @var{threadid} (eight hex
34553 digits). See @code{remote.c:parse_threadlist_response()}.
34554 @end table
34555
34556 @item qOffsets
34557 @cindex section offsets, remote request
34558 @cindex @samp{qOffsets} packet
34559 Get section offsets that the target used when relocating the downloaded
34560 image.
34561
34562 Reply:
34563 @table @samp
34564 @item Text=@var{xxx};Data=@var{yyy}@r{[};Bss=@var{zzz}@r{]}
34565 Relocate the @code{Text} section by @var{xxx} from its original address.
34566 Relocate the @code{Data} section by @var{yyy} from its original address.
34567 If the object file format provides segment information (e.g.@: @sc{elf}
34568 @samp{PT_LOAD} program headers), @value{GDBN} will relocate entire
34569 segments by the supplied offsets.
34570
34571 @emph{Note: while a @code{Bss} offset may be included in the response,
34572 @value{GDBN} ignores this and instead applies the @code{Data} offset
34573 to the @code{Bss} section.}
34574
34575 @item TextSeg=@var{xxx}@r{[};DataSeg=@var{yyy}@r{]}
34576 Relocate the first segment of the object file, which conventionally
34577 contains program code, to a starting address of @var{xxx}. If
34578 @samp{DataSeg} is specified, relocate the second segment, which
34579 conventionally contains modifiable data, to a starting address of
34580 @var{yyy}. @value{GDBN} will report an error if the object file
34581 does not contain segment information, or does not contain at least
34582 as many segments as mentioned in the reply. Extra segments are
34583 kept at fixed offsets relative to the last relocated segment.
34584 @end table
34585
34586 @item qP @var{mode} @var{thread-id}
34587 @cindex thread information, remote request
34588 @cindex @samp{qP} packet
34589 Returns information on @var{thread-id}. Where: @var{mode} is a hex
34590 encoded 32 bit mode; @var{thread-id} is a thread ID
34591 (@pxref{thread-id syntax}).
34592
34593 Don't use this packet; use the @samp{qThreadExtraInfo} query instead
34594 (see below).
34595
34596 Reply: see @code{remote.c:remote_unpack_thread_info_response()}.
34597
34598 @item QNonStop:1
34599 @item QNonStop:0
34600 @cindex non-stop mode, remote request
34601 @cindex @samp{QNonStop} packet
34602 @anchor{QNonStop}
34603 Enter non-stop (@samp{QNonStop:1}) or all-stop (@samp{QNonStop:0}) mode.
34604 @xref{Remote Non-Stop}, for more information.
34605
34606 Reply:
34607 @table @samp
34608 @item OK
34609 The request succeeded.
34610
34611 @item E @var{nn}
34612 An error occurred. @var{nn} are hex digits.
34613
34614 @item
34615 An empty reply indicates that @samp{QNonStop} is not supported by
34616 the stub.
34617 @end table
34618
34619 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
34620 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
34621 Use of this packet is controlled by the @code{set non-stop} command;
34622 @pxref{Non-Stop Mode}.
34623
34624 @item QPassSignals: @var{signal} @r{[};@var{signal}@r{]}@dots{}
34625 @cindex pass signals to inferior, remote request
34626 @cindex @samp{QPassSignals} packet
34627 @anchor{QPassSignals}
34628 Each listed @var{signal} should be passed directly to the inferior process.
34629 Signals are numbered identically to continue packets and stop replies
34630 (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets}). Each @var{signal} list item should be
34631 strictly greater than the previous item. These signals do not need to stop
34632 the inferior, or be reported to @value{GDBN}. All other signals should be
34633 reported to @value{GDBN}. Multiple @samp{QPassSignals} packets do not
34634 combine; any earlier @samp{QPassSignals} list is completely replaced by the
34635 new list. This packet improves performance when using @samp{handle
34636 @var{signal} nostop noprint pass}.
34637
34638 Reply:
34639 @table @samp
34640 @item OK
34641 The request succeeded.
34642
34643 @item E @var{nn}
34644 An error occurred. @var{nn} are hex digits.
34645
34646 @item
34647 An empty reply indicates that @samp{QPassSignals} is not supported by
34648 the stub.
34649 @end table
34650
34651 Use of this packet is controlled by the @code{set remote pass-signals}
34652 command (@pxref{Remote Configuration, set remote pass-signals}).
34653 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
34654 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
34655
34656 @item qRcmd,@var{command}
34657 @cindex execute remote command, remote request
34658 @cindex @samp{qRcmd} packet
34659 @var{command} (hex encoded) is passed to the local interpreter for
34660 execution. Invalid commands should be reported using the output
34661 string. Before the final result packet, the target may also respond
34662 with a number of intermediate @samp{O@var{output}} console output
34663 packets. @emph{Implementors should note that providing access to a
34664 stubs's interpreter may have security implications}.
34665
34666 Reply:
34667 @table @samp
34668 @item OK
34669 A command response with no output.
34670 @item @var{OUTPUT}
34671 A command response with the hex encoded output string @var{OUTPUT}.
34672 @item E @var{NN}
34673 Indicate a badly formed request.
34674 @item
34675 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qRcmd} is not recognized.
34676 @end table
34677
34678 (Note that the @code{qRcmd} packet's name is separated from the
34679 command by a @samp{,}, not a @samp{:}, contrary to the naming
34680 conventions above. Please don't use this packet as a model for new
34681 packets.)
34682
34683 @item qSearch:memory:@var{address};@var{length};@var{search-pattern}
34684 @cindex searching memory, in remote debugging
34685 @cindex @samp{qSearch:memory} packet
34686 @anchor{qSearch memory}
34687 Search @var{length} bytes at @var{address} for @var{search-pattern}.
34688 @var{address} and @var{length} are encoded in hex.
34689 @var{search-pattern} is a sequence of bytes, hex encoded.
34690
34691 Reply:
34692 @table @samp
34693 @item 0
34694 The pattern was not found.
34695 @item 1,address
34696 The pattern was found at @var{address}.
34697 @item E @var{NN}
34698 A badly formed request or an error was encountered while searching memory.
34699 @item
34700 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qSearch:memory} is not recognized.
34701 @end table
34702
34703 @item QStartNoAckMode
34704 @cindex @samp{QStartNoAckMode} packet
34705 @anchor{QStartNoAckMode}
34706 Request that the remote stub disable the normal @samp{+}/@samp{-}
34707 protocol acknowledgments (@pxref{Packet Acknowledgment}).
34708
34709 Reply:
34710 @table @samp
34711 @item OK
34712 The stub has switched to no-acknowledgment mode.
34713 @value{GDBN} acknowledges this reponse,
34714 but neither the stub nor @value{GDBN} shall send or expect further
34715 @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgments in the current connection.
34716 @item
34717 An empty reply indicates that the stub does not support no-acknowledgment mode.
34718 @end table
34719
34720 @item qSupported @r{[}:@var{gdbfeature} @r{[};@var{gdbfeature}@r{]}@dots{} @r{]}
34721 @cindex supported packets, remote query
34722 @cindex features of the remote protocol
34723 @cindex @samp{qSupported} packet
34724 @anchor{qSupported}
34725 Tell the remote stub about features supported by @value{GDBN}, and
34726 query the stub for features it supports. This packet allows
34727 @value{GDBN} and the remote stub to take advantage of each others'
34728 features. @samp{qSupported} also consolidates multiple feature probes
34729 at startup, to improve @value{GDBN} performance---a single larger
34730 packet performs better than multiple smaller probe packets on
34731 high-latency links. Some features may enable behavior which must not
34732 be on by default, e.g.@: because it would confuse older clients or
34733 stubs. Other features may describe packets which could be
34734 automatically probed for, but are not. These features must be
34735 reported before @value{GDBN} will use them. This ``default
34736 unsupported'' behavior is not appropriate for all packets, but it
34737 helps to keep the initial connection time under control with new
34738 versions of @value{GDBN} which support increasing numbers of packets.
34739
34740 Reply:
34741 @table @samp
34742 @item @var{stubfeature} @r{[};@var{stubfeature}@r{]}@dots{}
34743 The stub supports or does not support each returned @var{stubfeature},
34744 depending on the form of each @var{stubfeature} (see below for the
34745 possible forms).
34746 @item
34747 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qSupported} is not recognized,
34748 or that no features needed to be reported to @value{GDBN}.
34749 @end table
34750
34751 The allowed forms for each feature (either a @var{gdbfeature} in the
34752 @samp{qSupported} packet, or a @var{stubfeature} in the response)
34753 are:
34754
34755 @table @samp
34756 @item @var{name}=@var{value}
34757 The remote protocol feature @var{name} is supported, and associated
34758 with the specified @var{value}. The format of @var{value} depends
34759 on the feature, but it must not include a semicolon.
34760 @item @var{name}+
34761 The remote protocol feature @var{name} is supported, and does not
34762 need an associated value.
34763 @item @var{name}-
34764 The remote protocol feature @var{name} is not supported.
34765 @item @var{name}?
34766 The remote protocol feature @var{name} may be supported, and
34767 @value{GDBN} should auto-detect support in some other way when it is
34768 needed. This form will not be used for @var{gdbfeature} notifications,
34769 but may be used for @var{stubfeature} responses.
34770 @end table
34771
34772 Whenever the stub receives a @samp{qSupported} request, the
34773 supplied set of @value{GDBN} features should override any previous
34774 request. This allows @value{GDBN} to put the stub in a known
34775 state, even if the stub had previously been communicating with
34776 a different version of @value{GDBN}.
34777
34778 The following values of @var{gdbfeature} (for the packet sent by @value{GDBN})
34779 are defined:
34780
34781 @table @samp
34782 @item multiprocess
34783 This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} supports multiprocess
34784 extensions to the remote protocol. @value{GDBN} does not use such
34785 extensions unless the stub also reports that it supports them by
34786 including @samp{multiprocess+} in its @samp{qSupported} reply.
34787 @xref{multiprocess extensions}, for details.
34788
34789 @item xmlRegisters
34790 This feature indicates that @value{GDBN} supports the XML target
34791 description. If the stub sees @samp{xmlRegisters=} with target
34792 specific strings separated by a comma, it will report register
34793 description.
34794
34795 @item qRelocInsn
34796 This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} supports the
34797 @samp{qRelocInsn} packet (@pxref{Tracepoint Packets,,Relocate
34798 instruction reply packet}).
34799 @end table
34800
34801 Stubs should ignore any unknown values for
34802 @var{gdbfeature}. Any @value{GDBN} which sends a @samp{qSupported}
34803 packet supports receiving packets of unlimited length (earlier
34804 versions of @value{GDBN} may reject overly long responses). Additional values
34805 for @var{gdbfeature} may be defined in the future to let the stub take
34806 advantage of new features in @value{GDBN}, e.g.@: incompatible
34807 improvements in the remote protocol---the @samp{multiprocess} feature is
34808 an example of such a feature. The stub's reply should be independent
34809 of the @var{gdbfeature} entries sent by @value{GDBN}; first @value{GDBN}
34810 describes all the features it supports, and then the stub replies with
34811 all the features it supports.
34812
34813 Similarly, @value{GDBN} will silently ignore unrecognized stub feature
34814 responses, as long as each response uses one of the standard forms.
34815
34816 Some features are flags. A stub which supports a flag feature
34817 should respond with a @samp{+} form response. Other features
34818 require values, and the stub should respond with an @samp{=}
34819 form response.
34820
34821 Each feature has a default value, which @value{GDBN} will use if
34822 @samp{qSupported} is not available or if the feature is not mentioned
34823 in the @samp{qSupported} response. The default values are fixed; a
34824 stub is free to omit any feature responses that match the defaults.
34825
34826 Not all features can be probed, but for those which can, the probing
34827 mechanism is useful: in some cases, a stub's internal
34828 architecture may not allow the protocol layer to know some information
34829 about the underlying target in advance. This is especially common in
34830 stubs which may be configured for multiple targets.
34831
34832 These are the currently defined stub features and their properties:
34833
34834 @multitable @columnfractions 0.35 0.2 0.12 0.2
34835 @c NOTE: The first row should be @headitem, but we do not yet require
34836 @c a new enough version of Texinfo (4.7) to use @headitem.
34837 @item Feature Name
34838 @tab Value Required
34839 @tab Default
34840 @tab Probe Allowed
34841
34842 @item @samp{PacketSize}
34843 @tab Yes
34844 @tab @samp{-}
34845 @tab No
34846
34847 @item @samp{qXfer:auxv:read}
34848 @tab No
34849 @tab @samp{-}
34850 @tab Yes
34851
34852 @item @samp{qXfer:features:read}
34853 @tab No
34854 @tab @samp{-}
34855 @tab Yes
34856
34857 @item @samp{qXfer:libraries:read}
34858 @tab No
34859 @tab @samp{-}
34860 @tab Yes
34861
34862 @item @samp{qXfer:memory-map:read}
34863 @tab No
34864 @tab @samp{-}
34865 @tab Yes
34866
34867 @item @samp{qXfer:sdata:read}
34868 @tab No
34869 @tab @samp{-}
34870 @tab Yes
34871
34872 @item @samp{qXfer:spu:read}
34873 @tab No
34874 @tab @samp{-}
34875 @tab Yes
34876
34877 @item @samp{qXfer:spu:write}
34878 @tab No
34879 @tab @samp{-}
34880 @tab Yes
34881
34882 @item @samp{qXfer:siginfo:read}
34883 @tab No
34884 @tab @samp{-}
34885 @tab Yes
34886
34887 @item @samp{qXfer:siginfo:write}
34888 @tab No
34889 @tab @samp{-}
34890 @tab Yes
34891
34892 @item @samp{qXfer:threads:read}
34893 @tab No
34894 @tab @samp{-}
34895 @tab Yes
34896
34897 @item @samp{qXfer:traceframe-info:read}
34898 @tab No
34899 @tab @samp{-}
34900 @tab Yes
34901
34902 @item @samp{qXfer:fdpic:read}
34903 @tab No
34904 @tab @samp{-}
34905 @tab Yes
34906
34907 @item @samp{QNonStop}
34908 @tab No
34909 @tab @samp{-}
34910 @tab Yes
34911
34912 @item @samp{QPassSignals}
34913 @tab No
34914 @tab @samp{-}
34915 @tab Yes
34916
34917 @item @samp{QStartNoAckMode}
34918 @tab No
34919 @tab @samp{-}
34920 @tab Yes
34921
34922 @item @samp{multiprocess}
34923 @tab No
34924 @tab @samp{-}
34925 @tab No
34926
34927 @item @samp{ConditionalTracepoints}
34928 @tab No
34929 @tab @samp{-}
34930 @tab No
34931
34932 @item @samp{ReverseContinue}
34933 @tab No
34934 @tab @samp{-}
34935 @tab No
34936
34937 @item @samp{ReverseStep}
34938 @tab No
34939 @tab @samp{-}
34940 @tab No
34941
34942 @item @samp{TracepointSource}
34943 @tab No
34944 @tab @samp{-}
34945 @tab No
34946
34947 @item @samp{QAllow}
34948 @tab No
34949 @tab @samp{-}
34950 @tab No
34951
34952 @item @samp{QDisableRandomization}
34953 @tab No
34954 @tab @samp{-}
34955 @tab No
34956
34957 @item @samp{EnableDisableTracepoints}
34958 @tab No
34959 @tab @samp{-}
34960 @tab No
34961
34962 @item @samp{tracenz}
34963 @tab No
34964 @tab @samp{-}
34965 @tab No
34966
34967 @end multitable
34968
34969 These are the currently defined stub features, in more detail:
34970
34971 @table @samp
34972 @cindex packet size, remote protocol
34973 @item PacketSize=@var{bytes}
34974 The remote stub can accept packets up to at least @var{bytes} in
34975 length. @value{GDBN} will send packets up to this size for bulk
34976 transfers, and will never send larger packets. This is a limit on the
34977 data characters in the packet, including the frame and checksum.
34978 There is no trailing NUL byte in a remote protocol packet; if the stub
34979 stores packets in a NUL-terminated format, it should allow an extra
34980 byte in its buffer for the NUL. If this stub feature is not supported,
34981 @value{GDBN} guesses based on the size of the @samp{g} packet response.
34982
34983 @item qXfer:auxv:read
34984 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:auxv:read} packet
34985 (@pxref{qXfer auxiliary vector read}).
34986
34987 @item qXfer:features:read
34988 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:features:read} packet
34989 (@pxref{qXfer target description read}).
34990
34991 @item qXfer:libraries:read
34992 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:libraries:read} packet
34993 (@pxref{qXfer library list read}).
34994
34995 @item qXfer:libraries-svr4:read
34996 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:libraries-svr4:read} packet
34997 (@pxref{qXfer svr4 library list read}).
34998
34999 @item qXfer:memory-map:read
35000 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:memory-map:read} packet
35001 (@pxref{qXfer memory map read}).
35002
35003 @item qXfer:sdata:read
35004 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:sdata:read} packet
35005 (@pxref{qXfer sdata read}).
35006
35007 @item qXfer:spu:read
35008 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:spu:read} packet
35009 (@pxref{qXfer spu read}).
35010
35011 @item qXfer:spu:write
35012 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:spu:write} packet
35013 (@pxref{qXfer spu write}).
35014
35015 @item qXfer:siginfo:read
35016 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:siginfo:read} packet
35017 (@pxref{qXfer siginfo read}).
35018
35019 @item qXfer:siginfo:write
35020 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:siginfo:write} packet
35021 (@pxref{qXfer siginfo write}).
35022
35023 @item qXfer:threads:read
35024 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:threads:read} packet
35025 (@pxref{qXfer threads read}).
35026
35027 @item qXfer:traceframe-info:read
35028 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:traceframe-info:read}
35029 packet (@pxref{qXfer traceframe info read}).
35030
35031 @item qXfer:fdpic:read
35032 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:fdpic:read}
35033 packet (@pxref{qXfer fdpic loadmap read}).
35034
35035 @item QNonStop
35036 The remote stub understands the @samp{QNonStop} packet
35037 (@pxref{QNonStop}).
35038
35039 @item QPassSignals
35040 The remote stub understands the @samp{QPassSignals} packet
35041 (@pxref{QPassSignals}).
35042
35043 @item QStartNoAckMode
35044 The remote stub understands the @samp{QStartNoAckMode} packet and
35045 prefers to operate in no-acknowledgment mode. @xref{Packet Acknowledgment}.
35046
35047 @item multiprocess
35048 @anchor{multiprocess extensions}
35049 @cindex multiprocess extensions, in remote protocol
35050 The remote stub understands the multiprocess extensions to the remote
35051 protocol syntax. The multiprocess extensions affect the syntax of
35052 thread IDs in both packets and replies (@pxref{thread-id syntax}), and
35053 add process IDs to the @samp{D} packet and @samp{W} and @samp{X}
35054 replies. Note that reporting this feature indicates support for the
35055 syntactic extensions only, not that the stub necessarily supports
35056 debugging of more than one process at a time. The stub must not use
35057 multiprocess extensions in packet replies unless @value{GDBN} has also
35058 indicated it supports them in its @samp{qSupported} request.
35059
35060 @item qXfer:osdata:read
35061 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:osdata:read} packet
35062 ((@pxref{qXfer osdata read}).
35063
35064 @item ConditionalTracepoints
35065 The remote stub accepts and implements conditional expressions defined
35066 for tracepoints (@pxref{Tracepoint Conditions}).
35067
35068 @item ReverseContinue
35069 The remote stub accepts and implements the reverse continue packet
35070 (@pxref{bc}).
35071
35072 @item ReverseStep
35073 The remote stub accepts and implements the reverse step packet
35074 (@pxref{bs}).
35075
35076 @item TracepointSource
35077 The remote stub understands the @samp{QTDPsrc} packet that supplies
35078 the source form of tracepoint definitions.
35079
35080 @item QAllow
35081 The remote stub understands the @samp{QAllow} packet.
35082
35083 @item QDisableRandomization
35084 The remote stub understands the @samp{QDisableRandomization} packet.
35085
35086 @item StaticTracepoint
35087 @cindex static tracepoints, in remote protocol
35088 The remote stub supports static tracepoints.
35089
35090 @item InstallInTrace
35091 @anchor{install tracepoint in tracing}
35092 The remote stub supports installing tracepoint in tracing.
35093
35094 @item EnableDisableTracepoints
35095 The remote stub supports the @samp{QTEnable} (@pxref{QTEnable}) and
35096 @samp{QTDisable} (@pxref{QTDisable}) packets that allow tracepoints
35097 to be enabled and disabled while a trace experiment is running.
35098
35099 @item tracenz
35100 @cindex string tracing, in remote protocol
35101 The remote stub supports the @samp{tracenz} bytecode for collecting strings.
35102 See @ref{Bytecode Descriptions} for details about the bytecode.
35103
35104 @end table
35105
35106 @item qSymbol::
35107 @cindex symbol lookup, remote request
35108 @cindex @samp{qSymbol} packet
35109 Notify the target that @value{GDBN} is prepared to serve symbol lookup
35110 requests. Accept requests from the target for the values of symbols.
35111
35112 Reply:
35113 @table @samp
35114 @item OK
35115 The target does not need to look up any (more) symbols.
35116 @item qSymbol:@var{sym_name}
35117 The target requests the value of symbol @var{sym_name} (hex encoded).
35118 @value{GDBN} may provide the value by using the
35119 @samp{qSymbol:@var{sym_value}:@var{sym_name}} message, described
35120 below.
35121 @end table
35122
35123 @item qSymbol:@var{sym_value}:@var{sym_name}
35124 Set the value of @var{sym_name} to @var{sym_value}.
35125
35126 @var{sym_name} (hex encoded) is the name of a symbol whose value the
35127 target has previously requested.
35128
35129 @var{sym_value} (hex) is the value for symbol @var{sym_name}. If
35130 @value{GDBN} cannot supply a value for @var{sym_name}, then this field
35131 will be empty.
35132
35133 Reply:
35134 @table @samp
35135 @item OK
35136 The target does not need to look up any (more) symbols.
35137 @item qSymbol:@var{sym_name}
35138 The target requests the value of a new symbol @var{sym_name} (hex
35139 encoded). @value{GDBN} will continue to supply the values of symbols
35140 (if available), until the target ceases to request them.
35141 @end table
35142
35143 @item qTBuffer
35144 @item QTBuffer
35145 @item QTDisconnected
35146 @itemx QTDP
35147 @itemx QTDPsrc
35148 @itemx QTDV
35149 @itemx qTfP
35150 @itemx qTfV
35151 @itemx QTFrame
35152 @itemx qTMinFTPILen
35153
35154 @xref{Tracepoint Packets}.
35155
35156 @item qThreadExtraInfo,@var{thread-id}
35157 @cindex thread attributes info, remote request
35158 @cindex @samp{qThreadExtraInfo} packet
35159 Obtain a printable string description of a thread's attributes from
35160 the target OS. @var{thread-id} is a thread ID;
35161 see @ref{thread-id syntax}. This
35162 string may contain anything that the target OS thinks is interesting
35163 for @value{GDBN} to tell the user about the thread. The string is
35164 displayed in @value{GDBN}'s @code{info threads} display. Some
35165 examples of possible thread extra info strings are @samp{Runnable}, or
35166 @samp{Blocked on Mutex}.
35167
35168 Reply:
35169 @table @samp
35170 @item @var{XX}@dots{}
35171 Where @samp{@var{XX}@dots{}} is a hex encoding of @sc{ascii} data,
35172 comprising the printable string containing the extra information about
35173 the thread's attributes.
35174 @end table
35175
35176 (Note that the @code{qThreadExtraInfo} packet's name is separated from
35177 the command by a @samp{,}, not a @samp{:}, contrary to the naming
35178 conventions above. Please don't use this packet as a model for new
35179 packets.)
35180
35181 @item QTNotes
35182 @item qTP
35183 @item QTSave
35184 @item qTsP
35185 @item qTsV
35186 @itemx QTStart
35187 @itemx QTStop
35188 @itemx QTEnable
35189 @itemx QTDisable
35190 @itemx QTinit
35191 @itemx QTro
35192 @itemx qTStatus
35193 @itemx qTV
35194 @itemx qTfSTM
35195 @itemx qTsSTM
35196 @itemx qTSTMat
35197 @xref{Tracepoint Packets}.
35198
35199 @item qXfer:@var{object}:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
35200 @cindex read special object, remote request
35201 @cindex @samp{qXfer} packet
35202 @anchor{qXfer read}
35203 Read uninterpreted bytes from the target's special data area
35204 identified by the keyword @var{object}. Request @var{length} bytes
35205 starting at @var{offset} bytes into the data. The content and
35206 encoding of @var{annex} is specific to @var{object}; it can supply
35207 additional details about what data to access.
35208
35209 Here are the specific requests of this form defined so far. All
35210 @samp{qXfer:@var{object}:read:@dots{}} requests use the same reply
35211 formats, listed below.
35212
35213 @table @samp
35214 @item qXfer:auxv:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
35215 @anchor{qXfer auxiliary vector read}
35216 Access the target's @dfn{auxiliary vector}. @xref{OS Information,
35217 auxiliary vector}. Note @var{annex} must be empty.
35218
35219 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
35220 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
35221
35222 @item qXfer:features:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
35223 @anchor{qXfer target description read}
35224 Access the @dfn{target description}. @xref{Target Descriptions}. The
35225 annex specifies which XML document to access. The main description is
35226 always loaded from the @samp{target.xml} annex.
35227
35228 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
35229 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
35230
35231 @item qXfer:libraries:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
35232 @anchor{qXfer library list read}
35233 Access the target's list of loaded libraries. @xref{Library List Format}.
35234 The annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty
35235 (@pxref{qXfer read}).
35236
35237 Targets which maintain a list of libraries in the program's memory do
35238 not need to implement this packet; it is designed for platforms where
35239 the operating system manages the list of loaded libraries.
35240
35241 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
35242 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
35243
35244 @item qXfer:libraries-svr4:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
35245 @anchor{qXfer svr4 library list read}
35246 Access the target's list of loaded libraries when the target is an SVR4
35247 platform. @xref{Library List Format for SVR4 Targets}. The annex part
35248 of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty (@pxref{qXfer read}).
35249
35250 This packet is optional for better performance on SVR4 targets.
35251 @value{GDBN} uses memory read packets to read the SVR4 library list otherwise.
35252
35253 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
35254 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
35255
35256 @item qXfer:memory-map:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
35257 @anchor{qXfer memory map read}
35258 Access the target's @dfn{memory-map}. @xref{Memory Map Format}. The
35259 annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty
35260 (@pxref{qXfer read}).
35261
35262 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
35263 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
35264
35265 @item qXfer:sdata:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
35266 @anchor{qXfer sdata read}
35267
35268 Read contents of the extra collected static tracepoint marker
35269 information. The annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must
35270 be empty (@pxref{qXfer read}). @xref{Tracepoint Actions,,Tracepoint
35271 Action Lists}.
35272
35273 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
35274 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
35275 (@pxref{qSupported}).
35276
35277 @item qXfer:siginfo:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
35278 @anchor{qXfer siginfo read}
35279 Read contents of the extra signal information on the target
35280 system. The annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be
35281 empty (@pxref{qXfer read}).
35282
35283 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
35284 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
35285 (@pxref{qSupported}).
35286
35287 @item qXfer:spu:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
35288 @anchor{qXfer spu read}
35289 Read contents of an @code{spufs} file on the target system. The
35290 annex specifies which file to read; it must be of the form
35291 @file{@var{id}/@var{name}}, where @var{id} specifies an SPU context ID
35292 in the target process, and @var{name} identifes the @code{spufs} file
35293 in that context to be accessed.
35294
35295 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
35296 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
35297 (@pxref{qSupported}).
35298
35299 @item qXfer:threads:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
35300 @anchor{qXfer threads read}
35301 Access the list of threads on target. @xref{Thread List Format}. The
35302 annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty
35303 (@pxref{qXfer read}).
35304
35305 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
35306 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
35307
35308 @item qXfer:traceframe-info:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
35309 @anchor{qXfer traceframe info read}
35310
35311 Return a description of the current traceframe's contents.
35312 @xref{Traceframe Info Format}. The annex part of the generic
35313 @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty (@pxref{qXfer read}).
35314
35315 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
35316 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
35317
35318 @item qXfer:fdpic:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
35319 @anchor{qXfer fdpic loadmap read}
35320 Read contents of @code{loadmap}s on the target system. The
35321 annex, either @samp{exec} or @samp{interp}, specifies which @code{loadmap},
35322 executable @code{loadmap} or interpreter @code{loadmap} to read.
35323
35324 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
35325 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
35326
35327 @item qXfer:osdata:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
35328 @anchor{qXfer osdata read}
35329 Access the target's @dfn{operating system information}.
35330 @xref{Operating System Information}.
35331
35332 @end table
35333
35334 Reply:
35335 @table @samp
35336 @item m @var{data}
35337 Data @var{data} (@pxref{Binary Data}) has been read from the
35338 target. There may be more data at a higher address (although
35339 it is permitted to return @samp{m} even for the last valid
35340 block of data, as long as at least one byte of data was read).
35341 @var{data} may have fewer bytes than the @var{length} in the
35342 request.
35343
35344 @item l @var{data}
35345 Data @var{data} (@pxref{Binary Data}) has been read from the target.
35346 There is no more data to be read. @var{data} may have fewer bytes
35347 than the @var{length} in the request.
35348
35349 @item l
35350 The @var{offset} in the request is at the end of the data.
35351 There is no more data to be read.
35352
35353 @item E00
35354 The request was malformed, or @var{annex} was invalid.
35355
35356 @item E @var{nn}
35357 The offset was invalid, or there was an error encountered reading the data.
35358 @var{nn} is a hex-encoded @code{errno} value.
35359
35360 @item
35361 An empty reply indicates the @var{object} string was not recognized by
35362 the stub, or that the object does not support reading.
35363 @end table
35364
35365 @item qXfer:@var{object}:write:@var{annex}:@var{offset}:@var{data}@dots{}
35366 @cindex write data into object, remote request
35367 @anchor{qXfer write}
35368 Write uninterpreted bytes into the target's special data area
35369 identified by the keyword @var{object}, starting at @var{offset} bytes
35370 into the data. @var{data}@dots{} is the binary-encoded data
35371 (@pxref{Binary Data}) to be written. The content and encoding of @var{annex}
35372 is specific to @var{object}; it can supply additional details about what data
35373 to access.
35374
35375 Here are the specific requests of this form defined so far. All
35376 @samp{qXfer:@var{object}:write:@dots{}} requests use the same reply
35377 formats, listed below.
35378
35379 @table @samp
35380 @item qXfer:siginfo:write::@var{offset}:@var{data}@dots{}
35381 @anchor{qXfer siginfo write}
35382 Write @var{data} to the extra signal information on the target system.
35383 The annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be
35384 empty (@pxref{qXfer write}).
35385
35386 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
35387 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
35388 (@pxref{qSupported}).
35389
35390 @item qXfer:spu:write:@var{annex}:@var{offset}:@var{data}@dots{}
35391 @anchor{qXfer spu write}
35392 Write @var{data} to an @code{spufs} file on the target system. The
35393 annex specifies which file to write; it must be of the form
35394 @file{@var{id}/@var{name}}, where @var{id} specifies an SPU context ID
35395 in the target process, and @var{name} identifes the @code{spufs} file
35396 in that context to be accessed.
35397
35398 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
35399 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
35400 @end table
35401
35402 Reply:
35403 @table @samp
35404 @item @var{nn}
35405 @var{nn} (hex encoded) is the number of bytes written.
35406 This may be fewer bytes than supplied in the request.
35407
35408 @item E00
35409 The request was malformed, or @var{annex} was invalid.
35410
35411 @item E @var{nn}
35412 The offset was invalid, or there was an error encountered writing the data.
35413 @var{nn} is a hex-encoded @code{errno} value.
35414
35415 @item
35416 An empty reply indicates the @var{object} string was not
35417 recognized by the stub, or that the object does not support writing.
35418 @end table
35419
35420 @item qXfer:@var{object}:@var{operation}:@dots{}
35421 Requests of this form may be added in the future. When a stub does
35422 not recognize the @var{object} keyword, or its support for
35423 @var{object} does not recognize the @var{operation} keyword, the stub
35424 must respond with an empty packet.
35425
35426 @item qAttached:@var{pid}
35427 @cindex query attached, remote request
35428 @cindex @samp{qAttached} packet
35429 Return an indication of whether the remote server attached to an
35430 existing process or created a new process. When the multiprocess
35431 protocol extensions are supported (@pxref{multiprocess extensions}),
35432 @var{pid} is an integer in hexadecimal format identifying the target
35433 process. Otherwise, @value{GDBN} will omit the @var{pid} field and
35434 the query packet will be simplified as @samp{qAttached}.
35435
35436 This query is used, for example, to know whether the remote process
35437 should be detached or killed when a @value{GDBN} session is ended with
35438 the @code{quit} command.
35439
35440 Reply:
35441 @table @samp
35442 @item 1
35443 The remote server attached to an existing process.
35444 @item 0
35445 The remote server created a new process.
35446 @item E @var{NN}
35447 A badly formed request or an error was encountered.
35448 @end table
35449
35450 @end table
35451
35452 @node Architecture-Specific Protocol Details
35453 @section Architecture-Specific Protocol Details
35454
35455 This section describes how the remote protocol is applied to specific
35456 target architectures. Also see @ref{Standard Target Features}, for
35457 details of XML target descriptions for each architecture.
35458
35459 @subsection ARM
35460
35461 @subsubsection Breakpoint Kinds
35462
35463 These breakpoint kinds are defined for the @samp{Z0} and @samp{Z1} packets.
35464
35465 @table @r
35466
35467 @item 2
35468 16-bit Thumb mode breakpoint.
35469
35470 @item 3
35471 32-bit Thumb mode (Thumb-2) breakpoint.
35472
35473 @item 4
35474 32-bit ARM mode breakpoint.
35475
35476 @end table
35477
35478 @subsection MIPS
35479
35480 @subsubsection Register Packet Format
35481
35482 The following @code{g}/@code{G} packets have previously been defined.
35483 In the below, some thirty-two bit registers are transferred as
35484 sixty-four bits. Those registers should be zero/sign extended (which?)
35485 to fill the space allocated. Register bytes are transferred in target
35486 byte order. The two nibbles within a register byte are transferred
35487 most-significant - least-significant.
35488
35489 @table @r
35490
35491 @item MIPS32
35492
35493 All registers are transferred as thirty-two bit quantities in the order:
35494 32 general-purpose; sr; lo; hi; bad; cause; pc; 32 floating-point
35495 registers; fsr; fir; fp.
35496
35497 @item MIPS64
35498
35499 All registers are transferred as sixty-four bit quantities (including
35500 thirty-two bit registers such as @code{sr}). The ordering is the same
35501 as @code{MIPS32}.
35502
35503 @end table
35504
35505 @node Tracepoint Packets
35506 @section Tracepoint Packets
35507 @cindex tracepoint packets
35508 @cindex packets, tracepoint
35509
35510 Here we describe the packets @value{GDBN} uses to implement
35511 tracepoints (@pxref{Tracepoints}).
35512
35513 @table @samp
35514
35515 @item QTDP:@var{n}:@var{addr}:@var{ena}:@var{step}:@var{pass}[:F@var{flen}][:X@var{len},@var{bytes}]@r{[}-@r{]}
35516 Create a new tracepoint, number @var{n}, at @var{addr}. If @var{ena}
35517 is @samp{E}, then the tracepoint is enabled; if it is @samp{D}, then
35518 the tracepoint is disabled. @var{step} is the tracepoint's step
35519 count, and @var{pass} is its pass count. If an @samp{F} is present,
35520 then the tracepoint is to be a fast tracepoint, and the @var{flen} is
35521 the number of bytes that the target should copy elsewhere to make room
35522 for the tracepoint. If an @samp{X} is present, it introduces a
35523 tracepoint condition, which consists of a hexadecimal length, followed
35524 by a comma and hex-encoded bytes, in a manner similar to action
35525 encodings as described below. If the trailing @samp{-} is present,
35526 further @samp{QTDP} packets will follow to specify this tracepoint's
35527 actions.
35528
35529 Replies:
35530 @table @samp
35531 @item OK
35532 The packet was understood and carried out.
35533 @item qRelocInsn
35534 @xref{Tracepoint Packets,,Relocate instruction reply packet}.
35535 @item
35536 The packet was not recognized.
35537 @end table
35538
35539 @item QTDP:-@var{n}:@var{addr}:@r{[}S@r{]}@var{action}@dots{}@r{[}-@r{]}
35540 Define actions to be taken when a tracepoint is hit. @var{n} and
35541 @var{addr} must be the same as in the initial @samp{QTDP} packet for
35542 this tracepoint. This packet may only be sent immediately after
35543 another @samp{QTDP} packet that ended with a @samp{-}. If the
35544 trailing @samp{-} is present, further @samp{QTDP} packets will follow,
35545 specifying more actions for this tracepoint.
35546
35547 In the series of action packets for a given tracepoint, at most one
35548 can have an @samp{S} before its first @var{action}. If such a packet
35549 is sent, it and the following packets define ``while-stepping''
35550 actions. Any prior packets define ordinary actions --- that is, those
35551 taken when the tracepoint is first hit. If no action packet has an
35552 @samp{S}, then all the packets in the series specify ordinary
35553 tracepoint actions.
35554
35555 The @samp{@var{action}@dots{}} portion of the packet is a series of
35556 actions, concatenated without separators. Each action has one of the
35557 following forms:
35558
35559 @table @samp
35560
35561 @item R @var{mask}
35562 Collect the registers whose bits are set in @var{mask}. @var{mask} is
35563 a hexadecimal number whose @var{i}'th bit is set if register number
35564 @var{i} should be collected. (The least significant bit is numbered
35565 zero.) Note that @var{mask} may be any number of digits long; it may
35566 not fit in a 32-bit word.
35567
35568 @item M @var{basereg},@var{offset},@var{len}
35569 Collect @var{len} bytes of memory starting at the address in register
35570 number @var{basereg}, plus @var{offset}. If @var{basereg} is
35571 @samp{-1}, then the range has a fixed address: @var{offset} is the
35572 address of the lowest byte to collect. The @var{basereg},
35573 @var{offset}, and @var{len} parameters are all unsigned hexadecimal
35574 values (the @samp{-1} value for @var{basereg} is a special case).
35575
35576 @item X @var{len},@var{expr}
35577 Evaluate @var{expr}, whose length is @var{len}, and collect memory as
35578 it directs. @var{expr} is an agent expression, as described in
35579 @ref{Agent Expressions}. Each byte of the expression is encoded as a
35580 two-digit hex number in the packet; @var{len} is the number of bytes
35581 in the expression (and thus one-half the number of hex digits in the
35582 packet).
35583
35584 @end table
35585
35586 Any number of actions may be packed together in a single @samp{QTDP}
35587 packet, as long as the packet does not exceed the maximum packet
35588 length (400 bytes, for many stubs). There may be only one @samp{R}
35589 action per tracepoint, and it must precede any @samp{M} or @samp{X}
35590 actions. Any registers referred to by @samp{M} and @samp{X} actions
35591 must be collected by a preceding @samp{R} action. (The
35592 ``while-stepping'' actions are treated as if they were attached to a
35593 separate tracepoint, as far as these restrictions are concerned.)
35594
35595 Replies:
35596 @table @samp
35597 @item OK
35598 The packet was understood and carried out.
35599 @item qRelocInsn
35600 @xref{Tracepoint Packets,,Relocate instruction reply packet}.
35601 @item
35602 The packet was not recognized.
35603 @end table
35604
35605 @item QTDPsrc:@var{n}:@var{addr}:@var{type}:@var{start}:@var{slen}:@var{bytes}
35606 @cindex @samp{QTDPsrc} packet
35607 Specify a source string of tracepoint @var{n} at address @var{addr}.
35608 This is useful to get accurate reproduction of the tracepoints
35609 originally downloaded at the beginning of the trace run. @var{type}
35610 is the name of the tracepoint part, such as @samp{cond} for the
35611 tracepoint's conditional expression (see below for a list of types), while
35612 @var{bytes} is the string, encoded in hexadecimal.
35613
35614 @var{start} is the offset of the @var{bytes} within the overall source
35615 string, while @var{slen} is the total length of the source string.
35616 This is intended for handling source strings that are longer than will
35617 fit in a single packet.
35618 @c Add detailed example when this info is moved into a dedicated
35619 @c tracepoint descriptions section.
35620
35621 The available string types are @samp{at} for the location,
35622 @samp{cond} for the conditional, and @samp{cmd} for an action command.
35623 @value{GDBN} sends a separate packet for each command in the action
35624 list, in the same order in which the commands are stored in the list.
35625
35626 The target does not need to do anything with source strings except
35627 report them back as part of the replies to the @samp{qTfP}/@samp{qTsP}
35628 query packets.
35629
35630 Although this packet is optional, and @value{GDBN} will only send it
35631 if the target replies with @samp{TracepointSource} @xref{General
35632 Query Packets}, it makes both disconnected tracing and trace files
35633 much easier to use. Otherwise the user must be careful that the
35634 tracepoints in effect while looking at trace frames are identical to
35635 the ones in effect during the trace run; even a small discrepancy
35636 could cause @samp{tdump} not to work, or a particular trace frame not
35637 be found.
35638
35639 @item QTDV:@var{n}:@var{value}
35640 @cindex define trace state variable, remote request
35641 @cindex @samp{QTDV} packet
35642 Create a new trace state variable, number @var{n}, with an initial
35643 value of @var{value}, which is a 64-bit signed integer. Both @var{n}
35644 and @var{value} are encoded as hexadecimal values. @value{GDBN} has
35645 the option of not using this packet for initial values of zero; the
35646 target should simply create the trace state variables as they are
35647 mentioned in expressions.
35648
35649 @item QTFrame:@var{n}
35650 Select the @var{n}'th tracepoint frame from the buffer, and use the
35651 register and memory contents recorded there to answer subsequent
35652 request packets from @value{GDBN}.
35653
35654 A successful reply from the stub indicates that the stub has found the
35655 requested frame. The response is a series of parts, concatenated
35656 without separators, describing the frame we selected. Each part has
35657 one of the following forms:
35658
35659 @table @samp
35660 @item F @var{f}
35661 The selected frame is number @var{n} in the trace frame buffer;
35662 @var{f} is a hexadecimal number. If @var{f} is @samp{-1}, then there
35663 was no frame matching the criteria in the request packet.
35664
35665 @item T @var{t}
35666 The selected trace frame records a hit of tracepoint number @var{t};
35667 @var{t} is a hexadecimal number.
35668
35669 @end table
35670
35671 @item QTFrame:pc:@var{addr}
35672 Like @samp{QTFrame:@var{n}}, but select the first tracepoint frame after the
35673 currently selected frame whose PC is @var{addr};
35674 @var{addr} is a hexadecimal number.
35675
35676 @item QTFrame:tdp:@var{t}
35677 Like @samp{QTFrame:@var{n}}, but select the first tracepoint frame after the
35678 currently selected frame that is a hit of tracepoint @var{t}; @var{t}
35679 is a hexadecimal number.
35680
35681 @item QTFrame:range:@var{start}:@var{end}
35682 Like @samp{QTFrame:@var{n}}, but select the first tracepoint frame after the
35683 currently selected frame whose PC is between @var{start} (inclusive)
35684 and @var{end} (inclusive); @var{start} and @var{end} are hexadecimal
35685 numbers.
35686
35687 @item QTFrame:outside:@var{start}:@var{end}
35688 Like @samp{QTFrame:range:@var{start}:@var{end}}, but select the first
35689 frame @emph{outside} the given range of addresses (exclusive).
35690
35691 @item qTMinFTPILen
35692 This packet requests the minimum length of instruction at which a fast
35693 tracepoint (@pxref{Set Tracepoints}) may be placed. For instance, on
35694 the 32-bit x86 architecture, it is possible to use a 4-byte jump, but
35695 it depends on the target system being able to create trampolines in
35696 the first 64K of memory, which might or might not be possible for that
35697 system. So the reply to this packet will be 4 if it is able to
35698 arrange for that.
35699
35700 Replies:
35701
35702 @table @samp
35703 @item 0
35704 The minimum instruction length is currently unknown.
35705 @item @var{length}
35706 The minimum instruction length is @var{length}, where @var{length} is greater
35707 or equal to 1. @var{length} is a hexadecimal number. A reply of 1 means
35708 that a fast tracepoint may be placed on any instruction regardless of size.
35709 @item E
35710 An error has occurred.
35711 @item
35712 An empty reply indicates that the request is not supported by the stub.
35713 @end table
35714
35715 @item QTStart
35716 Begin the tracepoint experiment. Begin collecting data from
35717 tracepoint hits in the trace frame buffer. This packet supports the
35718 @samp{qRelocInsn} reply (@pxref{Tracepoint Packets,,Relocate
35719 instruction reply packet}).
35720
35721 @item QTStop
35722 End the tracepoint experiment. Stop collecting trace frames.
35723
35724 @item QTEnable:@var{n}:@var{addr}
35725 @anchor{QTEnable}
35726 Enable tracepoint @var{n} at address @var{addr} in a started tracepoint
35727 experiment. If the tracepoint was previously disabled, then collection
35728 of data from it will resume.
35729
35730 @item QTDisable:@var{n}:@var{addr}
35731 @anchor{QTDisable}
35732 Disable tracepoint @var{n} at address @var{addr} in a started tracepoint
35733 experiment. No more data will be collected from the tracepoint unless
35734 @samp{QTEnable:@var{n}:@var{addr}} is subsequently issued.
35735
35736 @item QTinit
35737 Clear the table of tracepoints, and empty the trace frame buffer.
35738
35739 @item QTro:@var{start1},@var{end1}:@var{start2},@var{end2}:@dots{}
35740 Establish the given ranges of memory as ``transparent''. The stub
35741 will answer requests for these ranges from memory's current contents,
35742 if they were not collected as part of the tracepoint hit.
35743
35744 @value{GDBN} uses this to mark read-only regions of memory, like those
35745 containing program code. Since these areas never change, they should
35746 still have the same contents they did when the tracepoint was hit, so
35747 there's no reason for the stub to refuse to provide their contents.
35748
35749 @item QTDisconnected:@var{value}
35750 Set the choice to what to do with the tracing run when @value{GDBN}
35751 disconnects from the target. A @var{value} of 1 directs the target to
35752 continue the tracing run, while 0 tells the target to stop tracing if
35753 @value{GDBN} is no longer in the picture.
35754
35755 @item qTStatus
35756 Ask the stub if there is a trace experiment running right now.
35757
35758 The reply has the form:
35759
35760 @table @samp
35761
35762 @item T@var{running}@r{[};@var{field}@r{]}@dots{}
35763 @var{running} is a single digit @code{1} if the trace is presently
35764 running, or @code{0} if not. It is followed by semicolon-separated
35765 optional fields that an agent may use to report additional status.
35766
35767 @end table
35768
35769 If the trace is not running, the agent may report any of several
35770 explanations as one of the optional fields:
35771
35772 @table @samp
35773
35774 @item tnotrun:0
35775 No trace has been run yet.
35776
35777 @item tstop[:@var{text}]:0
35778 The trace was stopped by a user-originated stop command. The optional
35779 @var{text} field is a user-supplied string supplied as part of the
35780 stop command (for instance, an explanation of why the trace was
35781 stopped manually). It is hex-encoded.
35782
35783 @item tfull:0
35784 The trace stopped because the trace buffer filled up.
35785
35786 @item tdisconnected:0
35787 The trace stopped because @value{GDBN} disconnected from the target.
35788
35789 @item tpasscount:@var{tpnum}
35790 The trace stopped because tracepoint @var{tpnum} exceeded its pass count.
35791
35792 @item terror:@var{text}:@var{tpnum}
35793 The trace stopped because tracepoint @var{tpnum} had an error. The
35794 string @var{text} is available to describe the nature of the error
35795 (for instance, a divide by zero in the condition expression).
35796 @var{text} is hex encoded.
35797
35798 @item tunknown:0
35799 The trace stopped for some other reason.
35800
35801 @end table
35802
35803 Additional optional fields supply statistical and other information.
35804 Although not required, they are extremely useful for users monitoring
35805 the progress of a trace run. If a trace has stopped, and these
35806 numbers are reported, they must reflect the state of the just-stopped
35807 trace.
35808
35809 @table @samp
35810
35811 @item tframes:@var{n}
35812 The number of trace frames in the buffer.
35813
35814 @item tcreated:@var{n}
35815 The total number of trace frames created during the run. This may
35816 be larger than the trace frame count, if the buffer is circular.
35817
35818 @item tsize:@var{n}
35819 The total size of the trace buffer, in bytes.
35820
35821 @item tfree:@var{n}
35822 The number of bytes still unused in the buffer.
35823
35824 @item circular:@var{n}
35825 The value of the circular trace buffer flag. @code{1} means that the
35826 trace buffer is circular and old trace frames will be discarded if
35827 necessary to make room, @code{0} means that the trace buffer is linear
35828 and may fill up.
35829
35830 @item disconn:@var{n}
35831 The value of the disconnected tracing flag. @code{1} means that
35832 tracing will continue after @value{GDBN} disconnects, @code{0} means
35833 that the trace run will stop.
35834
35835 @end table
35836
35837 @item qTP:@var{tp}:@var{addr}
35838 @cindex tracepoint status, remote request
35839 @cindex @samp{qTP} packet
35840 Ask the stub for the current state of tracepoint number @var{tp} at
35841 address @var{addr}.
35842
35843 Replies:
35844 @table @samp
35845 @item V@var{hits}:@var{usage}
35846 The tracepoint has been hit @var{hits} times so far during the trace
35847 run, and accounts for @var{usage} in the trace buffer. Note that
35848 @code{while-stepping} steps are not counted as separate hits, but the
35849 steps' space consumption is added into the usage number.
35850
35851 @end table
35852
35853 @item qTV:@var{var}
35854 @cindex trace state variable value, remote request
35855 @cindex @samp{qTV} packet
35856 Ask the stub for the value of the trace state variable number @var{var}.
35857
35858 Replies:
35859 @table @samp
35860 @item V@var{value}
35861 The value of the variable is @var{value}. This will be the current
35862 value of the variable if the user is examining a running target, or a
35863 saved value if the variable was collected in the trace frame that the
35864 user is looking at. Note that multiple requests may result in
35865 different reply values, such as when requesting values while the
35866 program is running.
35867
35868 @item U
35869 The value of the variable is unknown. This would occur, for example,
35870 if the user is examining a trace frame in which the requested variable
35871 was not collected.
35872 @end table
35873
35874 @item qTfP
35875 @itemx qTsP
35876 These packets request data about tracepoints that are being used by
35877 the target. @value{GDBN} sends @code{qTfP} to get the first piece
35878 of data, and multiple @code{qTsP} to get additional pieces. Replies
35879 to these packets generally take the form of the @code{QTDP} packets
35880 that define tracepoints. (FIXME add detailed syntax)
35881
35882 @item qTfV
35883 @itemx qTsV
35884 These packets request data about trace state variables that are on the
35885 target. @value{GDBN} sends @code{qTfV} to get the first vari of data,
35886 and multiple @code{qTsV} to get additional variables. Replies to
35887 these packets follow the syntax of the @code{QTDV} packets that define
35888 trace state variables.
35889
35890 @item qTfSTM
35891 @itemx qTsSTM
35892 These packets request data about static tracepoint markers that exist
35893 in the target program. @value{GDBN} sends @code{qTfSTM} to get the
35894 first piece of data, and multiple @code{qTsSTM} to get additional
35895 pieces. Replies to these packets take the following form:
35896
35897 Reply:
35898 @table @samp
35899 @item m @var{address}:@var{id}:@var{extra}
35900 A single marker
35901 @item m @var{address}:@var{id}:@var{extra},@var{address}:@var{id}:@var{extra}@dots{}
35902 a comma-separated list of markers
35903 @item l
35904 (lower case letter @samp{L}) denotes end of list.
35905 @item E @var{nn}
35906 An error occurred. @var{nn} are hex digits.
35907 @item
35908 An empty reply indicates that the request is not supported by the
35909 stub.
35910 @end table
35911
35912 @var{address} is encoded in hex.
35913 @var{id} and @var{extra} are strings encoded in hex.
35914
35915 In response to each query, the target will reply with a list of one or
35916 more markers, separated by commas. @value{GDBN} will respond to each
35917 reply with a request for more markers (using the @samp{qs} form of the
35918 query), until the target responds with @samp{l} (lower-case ell, for
35919 @dfn{last}).
35920
35921 @item qTSTMat:@var{address}
35922 This packets requests data about static tracepoint markers in the
35923 target program at @var{address}. Replies to this packet follow the
35924 syntax of the @samp{qTfSTM} and @code{qTsSTM} packets that list static
35925 tracepoint markers.
35926
35927 @item QTSave:@var{filename}
35928 This packet directs the target to save trace data to the file name
35929 @var{filename} in the target's filesystem. @var{filename} is encoded
35930 as a hex string; the interpretation of the file name (relative vs
35931 absolute, wild cards, etc) is up to the target.
35932
35933 @item qTBuffer:@var{offset},@var{len}
35934 Return up to @var{len} bytes of the current contents of trace buffer,
35935 starting at @var{offset}. The trace buffer is treated as if it were
35936 a contiguous collection of traceframes, as per the trace file format.
35937 The reply consists as many hex-encoded bytes as the target can deliver
35938 in a packet; it is not an error to return fewer than were asked for.
35939 A reply consisting of just @code{l} indicates that no bytes are
35940 available.
35941
35942 @item QTBuffer:circular:@var{value}
35943 This packet directs the target to use a circular trace buffer if
35944 @var{value} is 1, or a linear buffer if the value is 0.
35945
35946 @item QTNotes:@r{[}@var{type}:@var{text}@r{]}@r{[};@var{type}:@var{text}@r{]}@dots{}
35947 This packet adds optional textual notes to the trace run. Allowable
35948 types include @code{user}, @code{notes}, and @code{tstop}, the
35949 @var{text} fields are arbitrary strings, hex-encoded.
35950
35951 @end table
35952
35953 @subsection Relocate instruction reply packet
35954 When installing fast tracepoints in memory, the target may need to
35955 relocate the instruction currently at the tracepoint address to a
35956 different address in memory. For most instructions, a simple copy is
35957 enough, but, for example, call instructions that implicitly push the
35958 return address on the stack, and relative branches or other
35959 PC-relative instructions require offset adjustment, so that the effect
35960 of executing the instruction at a different address is the same as if
35961 it had executed in the original location.
35962
35963 In response to several of the tracepoint packets, the target may also
35964 respond with a number of intermediate @samp{qRelocInsn} request
35965 packets before the final result packet, to have @value{GDBN} handle
35966 this relocation operation. If a packet supports this mechanism, its
35967 documentation will explicitly say so. See for example the above
35968 descriptions for the @samp{QTStart} and @samp{QTDP} packets. The
35969 format of the request is:
35970
35971 @table @samp
35972 @item qRelocInsn:@var{from};@var{to}
35973
35974 This requests @value{GDBN} to copy instruction at address @var{from}
35975 to address @var{to}, possibly adjusted so that executing the
35976 instruction at @var{to} has the same effect as executing it at
35977 @var{from}. @value{GDBN} writes the adjusted instruction to target
35978 memory starting at @var{to}.
35979 @end table
35980
35981 Replies:
35982 @table @samp
35983 @item qRelocInsn:@var{adjusted_size}
35984 Informs the stub the relocation is complete. @var{adjusted_size} is
35985 the length in bytes of resulting relocated instruction sequence.
35986 @item E @var{NN}
35987 A badly formed request was detected, or an error was encountered while
35988 relocating the instruction.
35989 @end table
35990
35991 @node Host I/O Packets
35992 @section Host I/O Packets
35993 @cindex Host I/O, remote protocol
35994 @cindex file transfer, remote protocol
35995
35996 The @dfn{Host I/O} packets allow @value{GDBN} to perform I/O
35997 operations on the far side of a remote link. For example, Host I/O is
35998 used to upload and download files to a remote target with its own
35999 filesystem. Host I/O uses the same constant values and data structure
36000 layout as the target-initiated File-I/O protocol. However, the
36001 Host I/O packets are structured differently. The target-initiated
36002 protocol relies on target memory to store parameters and buffers.
36003 Host I/O requests are initiated by @value{GDBN}, and the
36004 target's memory is not involved. @xref{File-I/O Remote Protocol
36005 Extension}, for more details on the target-initiated protocol.
36006
36007 The Host I/O request packets all encode a single operation along with
36008 its arguments. They have this format:
36009
36010 @table @samp
36011
36012 @item vFile:@var{operation}: @var{parameter}@dots{}
36013 @var{operation} is the name of the particular request; the target
36014 should compare the entire packet name up to the second colon when checking
36015 for a supported operation. The format of @var{parameter} depends on
36016 the operation. Numbers are always passed in hexadecimal. Negative
36017 numbers have an explicit minus sign (i.e.@: two's complement is not
36018 used). Strings (e.g.@: filenames) are encoded as a series of
36019 hexadecimal bytes. The last argument to a system call may be a
36020 buffer of escaped binary data (@pxref{Binary Data}).
36021
36022 @end table
36023
36024 The valid responses to Host I/O packets are:
36025
36026 @table @samp
36027
36028 @item F @var{result} [, @var{errno}] [; @var{attachment}]
36029 @var{result} is the integer value returned by this operation, usually
36030 non-negative for success and -1 for errors. If an error has occured,
36031 @var{errno} will be included in the result. @var{errno} will have a
36032 value defined by the File-I/O protocol (@pxref{Errno Values}). For
36033 operations which return data, @var{attachment} supplies the data as a
36034 binary buffer. Binary buffers in response packets are escaped in the
36035 normal way (@pxref{Binary Data}). See the individual packet
36036 documentation for the interpretation of @var{result} and
36037 @var{attachment}.
36038
36039 @item
36040 An empty response indicates that this operation is not recognized.
36041
36042 @end table
36043
36044 These are the supported Host I/O operations:
36045
36046 @table @samp
36047 @item vFile:open: @var{pathname}, @var{flags}, @var{mode}
36048 Open a file at @var{pathname} and return a file descriptor for it, or
36049 return -1 if an error occurs. @var{pathname} is a string,
36050 @var{flags} is an integer indicating a mask of open flags
36051 (@pxref{Open Flags}), and @var{mode} is an integer indicating a mask
36052 of mode bits to use if the file is created (@pxref{mode_t Values}).
36053 @xref{open}, for details of the open flags and mode values.
36054
36055 @item vFile:close: @var{fd}
36056 Close the open file corresponding to @var{fd} and return 0, or
36057 -1 if an error occurs.
36058
36059 @item vFile:pread: @var{fd}, @var{count}, @var{offset}
36060 Read data from the open file corresponding to @var{fd}. Up to
36061 @var{count} bytes will be read from the file, starting at @var{offset}
36062 relative to the start of the file. The target may read fewer bytes;
36063 common reasons include packet size limits and an end-of-file
36064 condition. The number of bytes read is returned. Zero should only be
36065 returned for a successful read at the end of the file, or if
36066 @var{count} was zero.
36067
36068 The data read should be returned as a binary attachment on success.
36069 If zero bytes were read, the response should include an empty binary
36070 attachment (i.e.@: a trailing semicolon). The return value is the
36071 number of target bytes read; the binary attachment may be longer if
36072 some characters were escaped.
36073
36074 @item vFile:pwrite: @var{fd}, @var{offset}, @var{data}
36075 Write @var{data} (a binary buffer) to the open file corresponding
36076 to @var{fd}. Start the write at @var{offset} from the start of the
36077 file. Unlike many @code{write} system calls, there is no
36078 separate @var{count} argument; the length of @var{data} in the
36079 packet is used. @samp{vFile:write} returns the number of bytes written,
36080 which may be shorter than the length of @var{data}, or -1 if an
36081 error occurred.
36082
36083 @item vFile:unlink: @var{pathname}
36084 Delete the file at @var{pathname} on the target. Return 0,
36085 or -1 if an error occurs. @var{pathname} is a string.
36086
36087 @end table
36088
36089 @node Interrupts
36090 @section Interrupts
36091 @cindex interrupts (remote protocol)
36092
36093 When a program on the remote target is running, @value{GDBN} may
36094 attempt to interrupt it by sending a @samp{Ctrl-C}, @code{BREAK} or
36095 a @code{BREAK} followed by @code{g},
36096 control of which is specified via @value{GDBN}'s @samp{interrupt-sequence}.
36097
36098 The precise meaning of @code{BREAK} is defined by the transport
36099 mechanism and may, in fact, be undefined. @value{GDBN} does not
36100 currently define a @code{BREAK} mechanism for any of the network
36101 interfaces except for TCP, in which case @value{GDBN} sends the
36102 @code{telnet} BREAK sequence.
36103
36104 @samp{Ctrl-C}, on the other hand, is defined and implemented for all
36105 transport mechanisms. It is represented by sending the single byte
36106 @code{0x03} without any of the usual packet overhead described in
36107 the Overview section (@pxref{Overview}). When a @code{0x03} byte is
36108 transmitted as part of a packet, it is considered to be packet data
36109 and does @emph{not} represent an interrupt. E.g., an @samp{X} packet
36110 (@pxref{X packet}), used for binary downloads, may include an unescaped
36111 @code{0x03} as part of its packet.
36112
36113 @code{BREAK} followed by @code{g} is also known as Magic SysRq g.
36114 When Linux kernel receives this sequence from serial port,
36115 it stops execution and connects to gdb.
36116
36117 Stubs are not required to recognize these interrupt mechanisms and the
36118 precise meaning associated with receipt of the interrupt is
36119 implementation defined. If the target supports debugging of multiple
36120 threads and/or processes, it should attempt to interrupt all
36121 currently-executing threads and processes.
36122 If the stub is successful at interrupting the
36123 running program, it should send one of the stop
36124 reply packets (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets}) to @value{GDBN} as a result
36125 of successfully stopping the program in all-stop mode, and a stop reply
36126 for each stopped thread in non-stop mode.
36127 Interrupts received while the
36128 program is stopped are discarded.
36129
36130 @node Notification Packets
36131 @section Notification Packets
36132 @cindex notification packets
36133 @cindex packets, notification
36134
36135 The @value{GDBN} remote serial protocol includes @dfn{notifications},
36136 packets that require no acknowledgment. Both the GDB and the stub
36137 may send notifications (although the only notifications defined at
36138 present are sent by the stub). Notifications carry information
36139 without incurring the round-trip latency of an acknowledgment, and so
36140 are useful for low-impact communications where occasional packet loss
36141 is not a problem.
36142
36143 A notification packet has the form @samp{% @var{data} #
36144 @var{checksum}}, where @var{data} is the content of the notification,
36145 and @var{checksum} is a checksum of @var{data}, computed and formatted
36146 as for ordinary @value{GDBN} packets. A notification's @var{data}
36147 never contains @samp{$}, @samp{%} or @samp{#} characters. Upon
36148 receiving a notification, the recipient sends no @samp{+} or @samp{-}
36149 to acknowledge the notification's receipt or to report its corruption.
36150
36151 Every notification's @var{data} begins with a name, which contains no
36152 colon characters, followed by a colon character.
36153
36154 Recipients should silently ignore corrupted notifications and
36155 notifications they do not understand. Recipients should restart
36156 timeout periods on receipt of a well-formed notification, whether or
36157 not they understand it.
36158
36159 Senders should only send the notifications described here when this
36160 protocol description specifies that they are permitted. In the
36161 future, we may extend the protocol to permit existing notifications in
36162 new contexts; this rule helps older senders avoid confusing newer
36163 recipients.
36164
36165 (Older versions of @value{GDBN} ignore bytes received until they see
36166 the @samp{$} byte that begins an ordinary packet, so new stubs may
36167 transmit notifications without fear of confusing older clients. There
36168 are no notifications defined for @value{GDBN} to send at the moment, but we
36169 assume that most older stubs would ignore them, as well.)
36170
36171 The following notification packets from the stub to @value{GDBN} are
36172 defined:
36173
36174 @table @samp
36175 @item Stop: @var{reply}
36176 Report an asynchronous stop event in non-stop mode.
36177 The @var{reply} has the form of a stop reply, as
36178 described in @ref{Stop Reply Packets}. Refer to @ref{Remote Non-Stop},
36179 for information on how these notifications are acknowledged by
36180 @value{GDBN}.
36181 @end table
36182
36183 @node Remote Non-Stop
36184 @section Remote Protocol Support for Non-Stop Mode
36185
36186 @value{GDBN}'s remote protocol supports non-stop debugging of
36187 multi-threaded programs, as described in @ref{Non-Stop Mode}. If the stub
36188 supports non-stop mode, it should report that to @value{GDBN} by including
36189 @samp{QNonStop+} in its @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
36190
36191 @value{GDBN} typically sends a @samp{QNonStop} packet only when
36192 establishing a new connection with the stub. Entering non-stop mode
36193 does not alter the state of any currently-running threads, but targets
36194 must stop all threads in any already-attached processes when entering
36195 all-stop mode. @value{GDBN} uses the @samp{?} packet as necessary to
36196 probe the target state after a mode change.
36197
36198 In non-stop mode, when an attached process encounters an event that
36199 would otherwise be reported with a stop reply, it uses the
36200 asynchronous notification mechanism (@pxref{Notification Packets}) to
36201 inform @value{GDBN}. In contrast to all-stop mode, where all threads
36202 in all processes are stopped when a stop reply is sent, in non-stop
36203 mode only the thread reporting the stop event is stopped. That is,
36204 when reporting a @samp{S} or @samp{T} response to indicate completion
36205 of a step operation, hitting a breakpoint, or a fault, only the
36206 affected thread is stopped; any other still-running threads continue
36207 to run. When reporting a @samp{W} or @samp{X} response, all running
36208 threads belonging to other attached processes continue to run.
36209
36210 Only one stop reply notification at a time may be pending; if
36211 additional stop events occur before @value{GDBN} has acknowledged the
36212 previous notification, they must be queued by the stub for later
36213 synchronous transmission in response to @samp{vStopped} packets from
36214 @value{GDBN}. Because the notification mechanism is unreliable,
36215 the stub is permitted to resend a stop reply notification
36216 if it believes @value{GDBN} may not have received it. @value{GDBN}
36217 ignores additional stop reply notifications received before it has
36218 finished processing a previous notification and the stub has completed
36219 sending any queued stop events.
36220
36221 Otherwise, @value{GDBN} must be prepared to receive a stop reply
36222 notification at any time. Specifically, they may appear when
36223 @value{GDBN} is not otherwise reading input from the stub, or when
36224 @value{GDBN} is expecting to read a normal synchronous response or a
36225 @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgment to a packet it has sent.
36226 Notification packets are distinct from any other communication from
36227 the stub so there is no ambiguity.
36228
36229 After receiving a stop reply notification, @value{GDBN} shall
36230 acknowledge it by sending a @samp{vStopped} packet (@pxref{vStopped packet})
36231 as a regular, synchronous request to the stub. Such acknowledgment
36232 is not required to happen immediately, as @value{GDBN} is permitted to
36233 send other, unrelated packets to the stub first, which the stub should
36234 process normally.
36235
36236 Upon receiving a @samp{vStopped} packet, if the stub has other queued
36237 stop events to report to @value{GDBN}, it shall respond by sending a
36238 normal stop reply response. @value{GDBN} shall then send another
36239 @samp{vStopped} packet to solicit further responses; again, it is
36240 permitted to send other, unrelated packets as well which the stub
36241 should process normally.
36242
36243 If the stub receives a @samp{vStopped} packet and there are no
36244 additional stop events to report, the stub shall return an @samp{OK}
36245 response. At this point, if further stop events occur, the stub shall
36246 send a new stop reply notification, @value{GDBN} shall accept the
36247 notification, and the process shall be repeated.
36248
36249 In non-stop mode, the target shall respond to the @samp{?} packet as
36250 follows. First, any incomplete stop reply notification/@samp{vStopped}
36251 sequence in progress is abandoned. The target must begin a new
36252 sequence reporting stop events for all stopped threads, whether or not
36253 it has previously reported those events to @value{GDBN}. The first
36254 stop reply is sent as a synchronous reply to the @samp{?} packet, and
36255 subsequent stop replies are sent as responses to @samp{vStopped} packets
36256 using the mechanism described above. The target must not send
36257 asynchronous stop reply notifications until the sequence is complete.
36258 If all threads are running when the target receives the @samp{?} packet,
36259 or if the target is not attached to any process, it shall respond
36260 @samp{OK}.
36261
36262 @node Packet Acknowledgment
36263 @section Packet Acknowledgment
36264
36265 @cindex acknowledgment, for @value{GDBN} remote
36266 @cindex packet acknowledgment, for @value{GDBN} remote
36267 By default, when either the host or the target machine receives a packet,
36268 the first response expected is an acknowledgment: either @samp{+} (to indicate
36269 the package was received correctly) or @samp{-} (to request retransmission).
36270 This mechanism allows the @value{GDBN} remote protocol to operate over
36271 unreliable transport mechanisms, such as a serial line.
36272
36273 In cases where the transport mechanism is itself reliable (such as a pipe or
36274 TCP connection), the @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgments are redundant.
36275 It may be desirable to disable them in that case to reduce communication
36276 overhead, or for other reasons. This can be accomplished by means of the
36277 @samp{QStartNoAckMode} packet; @pxref{QStartNoAckMode}.
36278
36279 When in no-acknowledgment mode, neither the stub nor @value{GDBN} shall send or
36280 expect @samp{+}/@samp{-} protocol acknowledgments. The packet
36281 and response format still includes the normal checksum, as described in
36282 @ref{Overview}, but the checksum may be ignored by the receiver.
36283
36284 If the stub supports @samp{QStartNoAckMode} and prefers to operate in
36285 no-acknowledgment mode, it should report that to @value{GDBN}
36286 by including @samp{QStartNoAckMode+} in its response to @samp{qSupported};
36287 @pxref{qSupported}.
36288 If @value{GDBN} also supports @samp{QStartNoAckMode} and it has not been
36289 disabled via the @code{set remote noack-packet off} command
36290 (@pxref{Remote Configuration}),
36291 @value{GDBN} may then send a @samp{QStartNoAckMode} packet to the stub.
36292 Only then may the stub actually turn off packet acknowledgments.
36293 @value{GDBN} sends a final @samp{+} acknowledgment of the stub's @samp{OK}
36294 response, which can be safely ignored by the stub.
36295
36296 Note that @code{set remote noack-packet} command only affects negotiation
36297 between @value{GDBN} and the stub when subsequent connections are made;
36298 it does not affect the protocol acknowledgment state for any current
36299 connection.
36300 Since @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgments are enabled by default when a
36301 new connection is established,
36302 there is also no protocol request to re-enable the acknowledgments
36303 for the current connection, once disabled.
36304
36305 @node Examples
36306 @section Examples
36307
36308 Example sequence of a target being re-started. Notice how the restart
36309 does not get any direct output:
36310
36311 @smallexample
36312 -> @code{R00}
36313 <- @code{+}
36314 @emph{target restarts}
36315 -> @code{?}
36316 <- @code{+}
36317 <- @code{T001:1234123412341234}
36318 -> @code{+}
36319 @end smallexample
36320
36321 Example sequence of a target being stepped by a single instruction:
36322
36323 @smallexample
36324 -> @code{G1445@dots{}}
36325 <- @code{+}
36326 -> @code{s}
36327 <- @code{+}
36328 @emph{time passes}
36329 <- @code{T001:1234123412341234}
36330 -> @code{+}
36331 -> @code{g}
36332 <- @code{+}
36333 <- @code{1455@dots{}}
36334 -> @code{+}
36335 @end smallexample
36336
36337 @node File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension
36338 @section File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension
36339 @cindex File-I/O remote protocol extension
36340
36341 @menu
36342 * File-I/O Overview::
36343 * Protocol Basics::
36344 * The F Request Packet::
36345 * The F Reply Packet::
36346 * The Ctrl-C Message::
36347 * Console I/O::
36348 * List of Supported Calls::
36349 * Protocol-specific Representation of Datatypes::
36350 * Constants::
36351 * File-I/O Examples::
36352 @end menu
36353
36354 @node File-I/O Overview
36355 @subsection File-I/O Overview
36356 @cindex file-i/o overview
36357
36358 The @dfn{File I/O remote protocol extension} (short: File-I/O) allows the
36359 target to use the host's file system and console I/O to perform various
36360 system calls. System calls on the target system are translated into a
36361 remote protocol packet to the host system, which then performs the needed
36362 actions and returns a response packet to the target system.
36363 This simulates file system operations even on targets that lack file systems.
36364
36365 The protocol is defined to be independent of both the host and target systems.
36366 It uses its own internal representation of datatypes and values. Both
36367 @value{GDBN} and the target's @value{GDBN} stub are responsible for
36368 translating the system-dependent value representations into the internal
36369 protocol representations when data is transmitted.
36370
36371 The communication is synchronous. A system call is possible only when
36372 @value{GDBN} is waiting for a response from the @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S}
36373 or @samp{s} packets. While @value{GDBN} handles the request for a system call,
36374 the target is stopped to allow deterministic access to the target's
36375 memory. Therefore File-I/O is not interruptible by target signals. On
36376 the other hand, it is possible to interrupt File-I/O by a user interrupt
36377 (@samp{Ctrl-C}) within @value{GDBN}.
36378
36379 The target's request to perform a host system call does not finish
36380 the latest @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S} or @samp{s} action. That means,
36381 after finishing the system call, the target returns to continuing the
36382 previous activity (continue, step). No additional continue or step
36383 request from @value{GDBN} is required.
36384
36385 @smallexample
36386 (@value{GDBP}) continue
36387 <- target requests 'system call X'
36388 target is stopped, @value{GDBN} executes system call
36389 -> @value{GDBN} returns result
36390 ... target continues, @value{GDBN} returns to wait for the target
36391 <- target hits breakpoint and sends a Txx packet
36392 @end smallexample
36393
36394 The protocol only supports I/O on the console and to regular files on
36395 the host file system. Character or block special devices, pipes,
36396 named pipes, sockets or any other communication method on the host
36397 system are not supported by this protocol.
36398
36399 File I/O is not supported in non-stop mode.
36400
36401 @node Protocol Basics
36402 @subsection Protocol Basics
36403 @cindex protocol basics, file-i/o
36404
36405 The File-I/O protocol uses the @code{F} packet as the request as well
36406 as reply packet. Since a File-I/O system call can only occur when
36407 @value{GDBN} is waiting for a response from the continuing or stepping target,
36408 the File-I/O request is a reply that @value{GDBN} has to expect as a result
36409 of a previous @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S} or @samp{s} packet.
36410 This @code{F} packet contains all information needed to allow @value{GDBN}
36411 to call the appropriate host system call:
36412
36413 @itemize @bullet
36414 @item
36415 A unique identifier for the requested system call.
36416
36417 @item
36418 All parameters to the system call. Pointers are given as addresses
36419 in the target memory address space. Pointers to strings are given as
36420 pointer/length pair. Numerical values are given as they are.
36421 Numerical control flags are given in a protocol-specific representation.
36422
36423 @end itemize
36424
36425 At this point, @value{GDBN} has to perform the following actions.
36426
36427 @itemize @bullet
36428 @item
36429 If the parameters include pointer values to data needed as input to a
36430 system call, @value{GDBN} requests this data from the target with a
36431 standard @code{m} packet request. This additional communication has to be
36432 expected by the target implementation and is handled as any other @code{m}
36433 packet.
36434
36435 @item
36436 @value{GDBN} translates all value from protocol representation to host
36437 representation as needed. Datatypes are coerced into the host types.
36438
36439 @item
36440 @value{GDBN} calls the system call.
36441
36442 @item
36443 It then coerces datatypes back to protocol representation.
36444
36445 @item
36446 If the system call is expected to return data in buffer space specified
36447 by pointer parameters to the call, the data is transmitted to the
36448 target using a @code{M} or @code{X} packet. This packet has to be expected
36449 by the target implementation and is handled as any other @code{M} or @code{X}
36450 packet.
36451
36452 @end itemize
36453
36454 Eventually @value{GDBN} replies with another @code{F} packet which contains all
36455 necessary information for the target to continue. This at least contains
36456
36457 @itemize @bullet
36458 @item
36459 Return value.
36460
36461 @item
36462 @code{errno}, if has been changed by the system call.
36463
36464 @item
36465 ``Ctrl-C'' flag.
36466
36467 @end itemize
36468
36469 After having done the needed type and value coercion, the target continues
36470 the latest continue or step action.
36471
36472 @node The F Request Packet
36473 @subsection The @code{F} Request Packet
36474 @cindex file-i/o request packet
36475 @cindex @code{F} request packet
36476
36477 The @code{F} request packet has the following format:
36478
36479 @table @samp
36480 @item F@var{call-id},@var{parameter@dots{}}
36481
36482 @var{call-id} is the identifier to indicate the host system call to be called.
36483 This is just the name of the function.
36484
36485 @var{parameter@dots{}} are the parameters to the system call.
36486 Parameters are hexadecimal integer values, either the actual values in case
36487 of scalar datatypes, pointers to target buffer space in case of compound
36488 datatypes and unspecified memory areas, or pointer/length pairs in case
36489 of string parameters. These are appended to the @var{call-id} as a
36490 comma-delimited list. All values are transmitted in ASCII
36491 string representation, pointer/length pairs separated by a slash.
36492
36493 @end table
36494
36495
36496
36497 @node The F Reply Packet
36498 @subsection The @code{F} Reply Packet
36499 @cindex file-i/o reply packet
36500 @cindex @code{F} reply packet
36501
36502 The @code{F} reply packet has the following format:
36503
36504 @table @samp
36505
36506 @item F@var{retcode},@var{errno},@var{Ctrl-C flag};@var{call-specific attachment}
36507
36508 @var{retcode} is the return code of the system call as hexadecimal value.
36509
36510 @var{errno} is the @code{errno} set by the call, in protocol-specific
36511 representation.
36512 This parameter can be omitted if the call was successful.
36513
36514 @var{Ctrl-C flag} is only sent if the user requested a break. In this
36515 case, @var{errno} must be sent as well, even if the call was successful.
36516 The @var{Ctrl-C flag} itself consists of the character @samp{C}:
36517
36518 @smallexample
36519 F0,0,C
36520 @end smallexample
36521
36522 @noindent
36523 or, if the call was interrupted before the host call has been performed:
36524
36525 @smallexample
36526 F-1,4,C
36527 @end smallexample
36528
36529 @noindent
36530 assuming 4 is the protocol-specific representation of @code{EINTR}.
36531
36532 @end table
36533
36534
36535 @node The Ctrl-C Message
36536 @subsection The @samp{Ctrl-C} Message
36537 @cindex ctrl-c message, in file-i/o protocol
36538
36539 If the @samp{Ctrl-C} flag is set in the @value{GDBN}
36540 reply packet (@pxref{The F Reply Packet}),
36541 the target should behave as if it had
36542 gotten a break message. The meaning for the target is ``system call
36543 interrupted by @code{SIGINT}''. Consequentially, the target should actually stop
36544 (as with a break message) and return to @value{GDBN} with a @code{T02}
36545 packet.
36546
36547 It's important for the target to know in which
36548 state the system call was interrupted. There are two possible cases:
36549
36550 @itemize @bullet
36551 @item
36552 The system call hasn't been performed on the host yet.
36553
36554 @item
36555 The system call on the host has been finished.
36556
36557 @end itemize
36558
36559 These two states can be distinguished by the target by the value of the
36560 returned @code{errno}. If it's the protocol representation of @code{EINTR}, the system
36561 call hasn't been performed. This is equivalent to the @code{EINTR} handling
36562 on POSIX systems. In any other case, the target may presume that the
36563 system call has been finished --- successfully or not --- and should behave
36564 as if the break message arrived right after the system call.
36565
36566 @value{GDBN} must behave reliably. If the system call has not been called
36567 yet, @value{GDBN} may send the @code{F} reply immediately, setting @code{EINTR} as
36568 @code{errno} in the packet. If the system call on the host has been finished
36569 before the user requests a break, the full action must be finished by
36570 @value{GDBN}. This requires sending @code{M} or @code{X} packets as necessary.
36571 The @code{F} packet may only be sent when either nothing has happened
36572 or the full action has been completed.
36573
36574 @node Console I/O
36575 @subsection Console I/O
36576 @cindex console i/o as part of file-i/o
36577
36578 By default and if not explicitly closed by the target system, the file
36579 descriptors 0, 1 and 2 are connected to the @value{GDBN} console. Output
36580 on the @value{GDBN} console is handled as any other file output operation
36581 (@code{write(1, @dots{})} or @code{write(2, @dots{})}). Console input is handled
36582 by @value{GDBN} so that after the target read request from file descriptor
36583 0 all following typing is buffered until either one of the following
36584 conditions is met:
36585
36586 @itemize @bullet
36587 @item
36588 The user types @kbd{Ctrl-c}. The behaviour is as explained above, and the
36589 @code{read}
36590 system call is treated as finished.
36591
36592 @item
36593 The user presses @key{RET}. This is treated as end of input with a trailing
36594 newline.
36595
36596 @item
36597 The user types @kbd{Ctrl-d}. This is treated as end of input. No trailing
36598 character (neither newline nor @samp{Ctrl-D}) is appended to the input.
36599
36600 @end itemize
36601
36602 If the user has typed more characters than fit in the buffer given to
36603 the @code{read} call, the trailing characters are buffered in @value{GDBN} until
36604 either another @code{read(0, @dots{})} is requested by the target, or debugging
36605 is stopped at the user's request.
36606
36607
36608 @node List of Supported Calls
36609 @subsection List of Supported Calls
36610 @cindex list of supported file-i/o calls
36611
36612 @menu
36613 * open::
36614 * close::
36615 * read::
36616 * write::
36617 * lseek::
36618 * rename::
36619 * unlink::
36620 * stat/fstat::
36621 * gettimeofday::
36622 * isatty::
36623 * system::
36624 @end menu
36625
36626 @node open
36627 @unnumberedsubsubsec open
36628 @cindex open, file-i/o system call
36629
36630 @table @asis
36631 @item Synopsis:
36632 @smallexample
36633 int open(const char *pathname, int flags);
36634 int open(const char *pathname, int flags, mode_t mode);
36635 @end smallexample
36636
36637 @item Request:
36638 @samp{Fopen,@var{pathptr}/@var{len},@var{flags},@var{mode}}
36639
36640 @noindent
36641 @var{flags} is the bitwise @code{OR} of the following values:
36642
36643 @table @code
36644 @item O_CREAT
36645 If the file does not exist it will be created. The host
36646 rules apply as far as file ownership and time stamps
36647 are concerned.
36648
36649 @item O_EXCL
36650 When used with @code{O_CREAT}, if the file already exists it is
36651 an error and open() fails.
36652
36653 @item O_TRUNC
36654 If the file already exists and the open mode allows
36655 writing (@code{O_RDWR} or @code{O_WRONLY} is given) it will be
36656 truncated to zero length.
36657
36658 @item O_APPEND
36659 The file is opened in append mode.
36660
36661 @item O_RDONLY
36662 The file is opened for reading only.
36663
36664 @item O_WRONLY
36665 The file is opened for writing only.
36666
36667 @item O_RDWR
36668 The file is opened for reading and writing.
36669 @end table
36670
36671 @noindent
36672 Other bits are silently ignored.
36673
36674
36675 @noindent
36676 @var{mode} is the bitwise @code{OR} of the following values:
36677
36678 @table @code
36679 @item S_IRUSR
36680 User has read permission.
36681
36682 @item S_IWUSR
36683 User has write permission.
36684
36685 @item S_IRGRP
36686 Group has read permission.
36687
36688 @item S_IWGRP
36689 Group has write permission.
36690
36691 @item S_IROTH
36692 Others have read permission.
36693
36694 @item S_IWOTH
36695 Others have write permission.
36696 @end table
36697
36698 @noindent
36699 Other bits are silently ignored.
36700
36701
36702 @item Return value:
36703 @code{open} returns the new file descriptor or -1 if an error
36704 occurred.
36705
36706 @item Errors:
36707
36708 @table @code
36709 @item EEXIST
36710 @var{pathname} already exists and @code{O_CREAT} and @code{O_EXCL} were used.
36711
36712 @item EISDIR
36713 @var{pathname} refers to a directory.
36714
36715 @item EACCES
36716 The requested access is not allowed.
36717
36718 @item ENAMETOOLONG
36719 @var{pathname} was too long.
36720
36721 @item ENOENT
36722 A directory component in @var{pathname} does not exist.
36723
36724 @item ENODEV
36725 @var{pathname} refers to a device, pipe, named pipe or socket.
36726
36727 @item EROFS
36728 @var{pathname} refers to a file on a read-only filesystem and
36729 write access was requested.
36730
36731 @item EFAULT
36732 @var{pathname} is an invalid pointer value.
36733
36734 @item ENOSPC
36735 No space on device to create the file.
36736
36737 @item EMFILE
36738 The process already has the maximum number of files open.
36739
36740 @item ENFILE
36741 The limit on the total number of files open on the system
36742 has been reached.
36743
36744 @item EINTR
36745 The call was interrupted by the user.
36746 @end table
36747
36748 @end table
36749
36750 @node close
36751 @unnumberedsubsubsec close
36752 @cindex close, file-i/o system call
36753
36754 @table @asis
36755 @item Synopsis:
36756 @smallexample
36757 int close(int fd);
36758 @end smallexample
36759
36760 @item Request:
36761 @samp{Fclose,@var{fd}}
36762
36763 @item Return value:
36764 @code{close} returns zero on success, or -1 if an error occurred.
36765
36766 @item Errors:
36767
36768 @table @code
36769 @item EBADF
36770 @var{fd} isn't a valid open file descriptor.
36771
36772 @item EINTR
36773 The call was interrupted by the user.
36774 @end table
36775
36776 @end table
36777
36778 @node read
36779 @unnumberedsubsubsec read
36780 @cindex read, file-i/o system call
36781
36782 @table @asis
36783 @item Synopsis:
36784 @smallexample
36785 int read(int fd, void *buf, unsigned int count);
36786 @end smallexample
36787
36788 @item Request:
36789 @samp{Fread,@var{fd},@var{bufptr},@var{count}}
36790
36791 @item Return value:
36792 On success, the number of bytes read is returned.
36793 Zero indicates end of file. If count is zero, read
36794 returns zero as well. On error, -1 is returned.
36795
36796 @item Errors:
36797
36798 @table @code
36799 @item EBADF
36800 @var{fd} is not a valid file descriptor or is not open for
36801 reading.
36802
36803 @item EFAULT
36804 @var{bufptr} is an invalid pointer value.
36805
36806 @item EINTR
36807 The call was interrupted by the user.
36808 @end table
36809
36810 @end table
36811
36812 @node write
36813 @unnumberedsubsubsec write
36814 @cindex write, file-i/o system call
36815
36816 @table @asis
36817 @item Synopsis:
36818 @smallexample
36819 int write(int fd, const void *buf, unsigned int count);
36820 @end smallexample
36821
36822 @item Request:
36823 @samp{Fwrite,@var{fd},@var{bufptr},@var{count}}
36824
36825 @item Return value:
36826 On success, the number of bytes written are returned.
36827 Zero indicates nothing was written. On error, -1
36828 is returned.
36829
36830 @item Errors:
36831
36832 @table @code
36833 @item EBADF
36834 @var{fd} is not a valid file descriptor or is not open for
36835 writing.
36836
36837 @item EFAULT
36838 @var{bufptr} is an invalid pointer value.
36839
36840 @item EFBIG
36841 An attempt was made to write a file that exceeds the
36842 host-specific maximum file size allowed.
36843
36844 @item ENOSPC
36845 No space on device to write the data.
36846
36847 @item EINTR
36848 The call was interrupted by the user.
36849 @end table
36850
36851 @end table
36852
36853 @node lseek
36854 @unnumberedsubsubsec lseek
36855 @cindex lseek, file-i/o system call
36856
36857 @table @asis
36858 @item Synopsis:
36859 @smallexample
36860 long lseek (int fd, long offset, int flag);
36861 @end smallexample
36862
36863 @item Request:
36864 @samp{Flseek,@var{fd},@var{offset},@var{flag}}
36865
36866 @var{flag} is one of:
36867
36868 @table @code
36869 @item SEEK_SET
36870 The offset is set to @var{offset} bytes.
36871
36872 @item SEEK_CUR
36873 The offset is set to its current location plus @var{offset}
36874 bytes.
36875
36876 @item SEEK_END
36877 The offset is set to the size of the file plus @var{offset}
36878 bytes.
36879 @end table
36880
36881 @item Return value:
36882 On success, the resulting unsigned offset in bytes from
36883 the beginning of the file is returned. Otherwise, a
36884 value of -1 is returned.
36885
36886 @item Errors:
36887
36888 @table @code
36889 @item EBADF
36890 @var{fd} is not a valid open file descriptor.
36891
36892 @item ESPIPE
36893 @var{fd} is associated with the @value{GDBN} console.
36894
36895 @item EINVAL
36896 @var{flag} is not a proper value.
36897
36898 @item EINTR
36899 The call was interrupted by the user.
36900 @end table
36901
36902 @end table
36903
36904 @node rename
36905 @unnumberedsubsubsec rename
36906 @cindex rename, file-i/o system call
36907
36908 @table @asis
36909 @item Synopsis:
36910 @smallexample
36911 int rename(const char *oldpath, const char *newpath);
36912 @end smallexample
36913
36914 @item Request:
36915 @samp{Frename,@var{oldpathptr}/@var{len},@var{newpathptr}/@var{len}}
36916
36917 @item Return value:
36918 On success, zero is returned. On error, -1 is returned.
36919
36920 @item Errors:
36921
36922 @table @code
36923 @item EISDIR
36924 @var{newpath} is an existing directory, but @var{oldpath} is not a
36925 directory.
36926
36927 @item EEXIST
36928 @var{newpath} is a non-empty directory.
36929
36930 @item EBUSY
36931 @var{oldpath} or @var{newpath} is a directory that is in use by some
36932 process.
36933
36934 @item EINVAL
36935 An attempt was made to make a directory a subdirectory
36936 of itself.
36937
36938 @item ENOTDIR
36939 A component used as a directory in @var{oldpath} or new
36940 path is not a directory. Or @var{oldpath} is a directory
36941 and @var{newpath} exists but is not a directory.
36942
36943 @item EFAULT
36944 @var{oldpathptr} or @var{newpathptr} are invalid pointer values.
36945
36946 @item EACCES
36947 No access to the file or the path of the file.
36948
36949 @item ENAMETOOLONG
36950
36951 @var{oldpath} or @var{newpath} was too long.
36952
36953 @item ENOENT
36954 A directory component in @var{oldpath} or @var{newpath} does not exist.
36955
36956 @item EROFS
36957 The file is on a read-only filesystem.
36958
36959 @item ENOSPC
36960 The device containing the file has no room for the new
36961 directory entry.
36962
36963 @item EINTR
36964 The call was interrupted by the user.
36965 @end table
36966
36967 @end table
36968
36969 @node unlink
36970 @unnumberedsubsubsec unlink
36971 @cindex unlink, file-i/o system call
36972
36973 @table @asis
36974 @item Synopsis:
36975 @smallexample
36976 int unlink(const char *pathname);
36977 @end smallexample
36978
36979 @item Request:
36980 @samp{Funlink,@var{pathnameptr}/@var{len}}
36981
36982 @item Return value:
36983 On success, zero is returned. On error, -1 is returned.
36984
36985 @item Errors:
36986
36987 @table @code
36988 @item EACCES
36989 No access to the file or the path of the file.
36990
36991 @item EPERM
36992 The system does not allow unlinking of directories.
36993
36994 @item EBUSY
36995 The file @var{pathname} cannot be unlinked because it's
36996 being used by another process.
36997
36998 @item EFAULT
36999 @var{pathnameptr} is an invalid pointer value.
37000
37001 @item ENAMETOOLONG
37002 @var{pathname} was too long.
37003
37004 @item ENOENT
37005 A directory component in @var{pathname} does not exist.
37006
37007 @item ENOTDIR
37008 A component of the path is not a directory.
37009
37010 @item EROFS
37011 The file is on a read-only filesystem.
37012
37013 @item EINTR
37014 The call was interrupted by the user.
37015 @end table
37016
37017 @end table
37018
37019 @node stat/fstat
37020 @unnumberedsubsubsec stat/fstat
37021 @cindex fstat, file-i/o system call
37022 @cindex stat, file-i/o system call
37023
37024 @table @asis
37025 @item Synopsis:
37026 @smallexample
37027 int stat(const char *pathname, struct stat *buf);
37028 int fstat(int fd, struct stat *buf);
37029 @end smallexample
37030
37031 @item Request:
37032 @samp{Fstat,@var{pathnameptr}/@var{len},@var{bufptr}}@*
37033 @samp{Ffstat,@var{fd},@var{bufptr}}
37034
37035 @item Return value:
37036 On success, zero is returned. On error, -1 is returned.
37037
37038 @item Errors:
37039
37040 @table @code
37041 @item EBADF
37042 @var{fd} is not a valid open file.
37043
37044 @item ENOENT
37045 A directory component in @var{pathname} does not exist or the
37046 path is an empty string.
37047
37048 @item ENOTDIR
37049 A component of the path is not a directory.
37050
37051 @item EFAULT
37052 @var{pathnameptr} is an invalid pointer value.
37053
37054 @item EACCES
37055 No access to the file or the path of the file.
37056
37057 @item ENAMETOOLONG
37058 @var{pathname} was too long.
37059
37060 @item EINTR
37061 The call was interrupted by the user.
37062 @end table
37063
37064 @end table
37065
37066 @node gettimeofday
37067 @unnumberedsubsubsec gettimeofday
37068 @cindex gettimeofday, file-i/o system call
37069
37070 @table @asis
37071 @item Synopsis:
37072 @smallexample
37073 int gettimeofday(struct timeval *tv, void *tz);
37074 @end smallexample
37075
37076 @item Request:
37077 @samp{Fgettimeofday,@var{tvptr},@var{tzptr}}
37078
37079 @item Return value:
37080 On success, 0 is returned, -1 otherwise.
37081
37082 @item Errors:
37083
37084 @table @code
37085 @item EINVAL
37086 @var{tz} is a non-NULL pointer.
37087
37088 @item EFAULT
37089 @var{tvptr} and/or @var{tzptr} is an invalid pointer value.
37090 @end table
37091
37092 @end table
37093
37094 @node isatty
37095 @unnumberedsubsubsec isatty
37096 @cindex isatty, file-i/o system call
37097
37098 @table @asis
37099 @item Synopsis:
37100 @smallexample
37101 int isatty(int fd);
37102 @end smallexample
37103
37104 @item Request:
37105 @samp{Fisatty,@var{fd}}
37106
37107 @item Return value:
37108 Returns 1 if @var{fd} refers to the @value{GDBN} console, 0 otherwise.
37109
37110 @item Errors:
37111
37112 @table @code
37113 @item EINTR
37114 The call was interrupted by the user.
37115 @end table
37116
37117 @end table
37118
37119 Note that the @code{isatty} call is treated as a special case: it returns
37120 1 to the target if the file descriptor is attached
37121 to the @value{GDBN} console, 0 otherwise. Implementing through system calls
37122 would require implementing @code{ioctl} and would be more complex than
37123 needed.
37124
37125
37126 @node system
37127 @unnumberedsubsubsec system
37128 @cindex system, file-i/o system call
37129
37130 @table @asis
37131 @item Synopsis:
37132 @smallexample
37133 int system(const char *command);
37134 @end smallexample
37135
37136 @item Request:
37137 @samp{Fsystem,@var{commandptr}/@var{len}}
37138
37139 @item Return value:
37140 If @var{len} is zero, the return value indicates whether a shell is
37141 available. A zero return value indicates a shell is not available.
37142 For non-zero @var{len}, the value returned is -1 on error and the
37143 return status of the command otherwise. Only the exit status of the
37144 command is returned, which is extracted from the host's @code{system}
37145 return value by calling @code{WEXITSTATUS(retval)}. In case
37146 @file{/bin/sh} could not be executed, 127 is returned.
37147
37148 @item Errors:
37149
37150 @table @code
37151 @item EINTR
37152 The call was interrupted by the user.
37153 @end table
37154
37155 @end table
37156
37157 @value{GDBN} takes over the full task of calling the necessary host calls
37158 to perform the @code{system} call. The return value of @code{system} on
37159 the host is simplified before it's returned
37160 to the target. Any termination signal information from the child process
37161 is discarded, and the return value consists
37162 entirely of the exit status of the called command.
37163
37164 Due to security concerns, the @code{system} call is by default refused
37165 by @value{GDBN}. The user has to allow this call explicitly with the
37166 @code{set remote system-call-allowed 1} command.
37167
37168 @table @code
37169 @item set remote system-call-allowed
37170 @kindex set remote system-call-allowed
37171 Control whether to allow the @code{system} calls in the File I/O
37172 protocol for the remote target. The default is zero (disabled).
37173
37174 @item show remote system-call-allowed
37175 @kindex show remote system-call-allowed
37176 Show whether the @code{system} calls are allowed in the File I/O
37177 protocol.
37178 @end table
37179
37180 @node Protocol-specific Representation of Datatypes
37181 @subsection Protocol-specific Representation of Datatypes
37182 @cindex protocol-specific representation of datatypes, in file-i/o protocol
37183
37184 @menu
37185 * Integral Datatypes::
37186 * Pointer Values::
37187 * Memory Transfer::
37188 * struct stat::
37189 * struct timeval::
37190 @end menu
37191
37192 @node Integral Datatypes
37193 @unnumberedsubsubsec Integral Datatypes
37194 @cindex integral datatypes, in file-i/o protocol
37195
37196 The integral datatypes used in the system calls are @code{int},
37197 @code{unsigned int}, @code{long}, @code{unsigned long},
37198 @code{mode_t}, and @code{time_t}.
37199
37200 @code{int}, @code{unsigned int}, @code{mode_t} and @code{time_t} are
37201 implemented as 32 bit values in this protocol.
37202
37203 @code{long} and @code{unsigned long} are implemented as 64 bit types.
37204
37205 @xref{Limits}, for corresponding MIN and MAX values (similar to those
37206 in @file{limits.h}) to allow range checking on host and target.
37207
37208 @code{time_t} datatypes are defined as seconds since the Epoch.
37209
37210 All integral datatypes transferred as part of a memory read or write of a
37211 structured datatype e.g.@: a @code{struct stat} have to be given in big endian
37212 byte order.
37213
37214 @node Pointer Values
37215 @unnumberedsubsubsec Pointer Values
37216 @cindex pointer values, in file-i/o protocol
37217
37218 Pointers to target data are transmitted as they are. An exception
37219 is made for pointers to buffers for which the length isn't
37220 transmitted as part of the function call, namely strings. Strings
37221 are transmitted as a pointer/length pair, both as hex values, e.g.@:
37222
37223 @smallexample
37224 @code{1aaf/12}
37225 @end smallexample
37226
37227 @noindent
37228 which is a pointer to data of length 18 bytes at position 0x1aaf.
37229 The length is defined as the full string length in bytes, including
37230 the trailing null byte. For example, the string @code{"hello world"}
37231 at address 0x123456 is transmitted as
37232
37233 @smallexample
37234 @code{123456/d}
37235 @end smallexample
37236
37237 @node Memory Transfer
37238 @unnumberedsubsubsec Memory Transfer
37239 @cindex memory transfer, in file-i/o protocol
37240
37241 Structured data which is transferred using a memory read or write (for
37242 example, a @code{struct stat}) is expected to be in a protocol-specific format
37243 with all scalar multibyte datatypes being big endian. Translation to
37244 this representation needs to be done both by the target before the @code{F}
37245 packet is sent, and by @value{GDBN} before
37246 it transfers memory to the target. Transferred pointers to structured
37247 data should point to the already-coerced data at any time.
37248
37249
37250 @node struct stat
37251 @unnumberedsubsubsec struct stat
37252 @cindex struct stat, in file-i/o protocol
37253
37254 The buffer of type @code{struct stat} used by the target and @value{GDBN}
37255 is defined as follows:
37256
37257 @smallexample
37258 struct stat @{
37259 unsigned int st_dev; /* device */
37260 unsigned int st_ino; /* inode */
37261 mode_t st_mode; /* protection */
37262 unsigned int st_nlink; /* number of hard links */
37263 unsigned int st_uid; /* user ID of owner */
37264 unsigned int st_gid; /* group ID of owner */
37265 unsigned int st_rdev; /* device type (if inode device) */
37266 unsigned long st_size; /* total size, in bytes */
37267 unsigned long st_blksize; /* blocksize for filesystem I/O */
37268 unsigned long st_blocks; /* number of blocks allocated */
37269 time_t st_atime; /* time of last access */
37270 time_t st_mtime; /* time of last modification */
37271 time_t st_ctime; /* time of last change */
37272 @};
37273 @end smallexample
37274
37275 The integral datatypes conform to the definitions given in the
37276 appropriate section (see @ref{Integral Datatypes}, for details) so this
37277 structure is of size 64 bytes.
37278
37279 The values of several fields have a restricted meaning and/or
37280 range of values.
37281
37282 @table @code
37283
37284 @item st_dev
37285 A value of 0 represents a file, 1 the console.
37286
37287 @item st_ino
37288 No valid meaning for the target. Transmitted unchanged.
37289
37290 @item st_mode
37291 Valid mode bits are described in @ref{Constants}. Any other
37292 bits have currently no meaning for the target.
37293
37294 @item st_uid
37295 @itemx st_gid
37296 @itemx st_rdev
37297 No valid meaning for the target. Transmitted unchanged.
37298
37299 @item st_atime
37300 @itemx st_mtime
37301 @itemx st_ctime
37302 These values have a host and file system dependent
37303 accuracy. Especially on Windows hosts, the file system may not
37304 support exact timing values.
37305 @end table
37306
37307 The target gets a @code{struct stat} of the above representation and is
37308 responsible for coercing it to the target representation before
37309 continuing.
37310
37311 Note that due to size differences between the host, target, and protocol
37312 representations of @code{struct stat} members, these members could eventually
37313 get truncated on the target.
37314
37315 @node struct timeval
37316 @unnumberedsubsubsec struct timeval
37317 @cindex struct timeval, in file-i/o protocol
37318
37319 The buffer of type @code{struct timeval} used by the File-I/O protocol
37320 is defined as follows:
37321
37322 @smallexample
37323 struct timeval @{
37324 time_t tv_sec; /* second */
37325 long tv_usec; /* microsecond */
37326 @};
37327 @end smallexample
37328
37329 The integral datatypes conform to the definitions given in the
37330 appropriate section (see @ref{Integral Datatypes}, for details) so this
37331 structure is of size 8 bytes.
37332
37333 @node Constants
37334 @subsection Constants
37335 @cindex constants, in file-i/o protocol
37336
37337 The following values are used for the constants inside of the
37338 protocol. @value{GDBN} and target are responsible for translating these
37339 values before and after the call as needed.
37340
37341 @menu
37342 * Open Flags::
37343 * mode_t Values::
37344 * Errno Values::
37345 * Lseek Flags::
37346 * Limits::
37347 @end menu
37348
37349 @node Open Flags
37350 @unnumberedsubsubsec Open Flags
37351 @cindex open flags, in file-i/o protocol
37352
37353 All values are given in hexadecimal representation.
37354
37355 @smallexample
37356 O_RDONLY 0x0
37357 O_WRONLY 0x1
37358 O_RDWR 0x2
37359 O_APPEND 0x8
37360 O_CREAT 0x200
37361 O_TRUNC 0x400
37362 O_EXCL 0x800
37363 @end smallexample
37364
37365 @node mode_t Values
37366 @unnumberedsubsubsec mode_t Values
37367 @cindex mode_t values, in file-i/o protocol
37368
37369 All values are given in octal representation.
37370
37371 @smallexample
37372 S_IFREG 0100000
37373 S_IFDIR 040000
37374 S_IRUSR 0400
37375 S_IWUSR 0200
37376 S_IXUSR 0100
37377 S_IRGRP 040
37378 S_IWGRP 020
37379 S_IXGRP 010
37380 S_IROTH 04
37381 S_IWOTH 02
37382 S_IXOTH 01
37383 @end smallexample
37384
37385 @node Errno Values
37386 @unnumberedsubsubsec Errno Values
37387 @cindex errno values, in file-i/o protocol
37388
37389 All values are given in decimal representation.
37390
37391 @smallexample
37392 EPERM 1
37393 ENOENT 2
37394 EINTR 4
37395 EBADF 9
37396 EACCES 13
37397 EFAULT 14
37398 EBUSY 16
37399 EEXIST 17
37400 ENODEV 19
37401 ENOTDIR 20
37402 EISDIR 21
37403 EINVAL 22
37404 ENFILE 23
37405 EMFILE 24
37406 EFBIG 27
37407 ENOSPC 28
37408 ESPIPE 29
37409 EROFS 30
37410 ENAMETOOLONG 91
37411 EUNKNOWN 9999
37412 @end smallexample
37413
37414 @code{EUNKNOWN} is used as a fallback error value if a host system returns
37415 any error value not in the list of supported error numbers.
37416
37417 @node Lseek Flags
37418 @unnumberedsubsubsec Lseek Flags
37419 @cindex lseek flags, in file-i/o protocol
37420
37421 @smallexample
37422 SEEK_SET 0
37423 SEEK_CUR 1
37424 SEEK_END 2
37425 @end smallexample
37426
37427 @node Limits
37428 @unnumberedsubsubsec Limits
37429 @cindex limits, in file-i/o protocol
37430
37431 All values are given in decimal representation.
37432
37433 @smallexample
37434 INT_MIN -2147483648
37435 INT_MAX 2147483647
37436 UINT_MAX 4294967295
37437 LONG_MIN -9223372036854775808
37438 LONG_MAX 9223372036854775807
37439 ULONG_MAX 18446744073709551615
37440 @end smallexample
37441
37442 @node File-I/O Examples
37443 @subsection File-I/O Examples
37444 @cindex file-i/o examples
37445
37446 Example sequence of a write call, file descriptor 3, buffer is at target
37447 address 0x1234, 6 bytes should be written:
37448
37449 @smallexample
37450 <- @code{Fwrite,3,1234,6}
37451 @emph{request memory read from target}
37452 -> @code{m1234,6}
37453 <- XXXXXX
37454 @emph{return "6 bytes written"}
37455 -> @code{F6}
37456 @end smallexample
37457
37458 Example sequence of a read call, file descriptor 3, buffer is at target
37459 address 0x1234, 6 bytes should be read:
37460
37461 @smallexample
37462 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
37463 @emph{request memory write to target}
37464 -> @code{X1234,6:XXXXXX}
37465 @emph{return "6 bytes read"}
37466 -> @code{F6}
37467 @end smallexample
37468
37469 Example sequence of a read call, call fails on the host due to invalid
37470 file descriptor (@code{EBADF}):
37471
37472 @smallexample
37473 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
37474 -> @code{F-1,9}
37475 @end smallexample
37476
37477 Example sequence of a read call, user presses @kbd{Ctrl-c} before syscall on
37478 host is called:
37479
37480 @smallexample
37481 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
37482 -> @code{F-1,4,C}
37483 <- @code{T02}
37484 @end smallexample
37485
37486 Example sequence of a read call, user presses @kbd{Ctrl-c} after syscall on
37487 host is called:
37488
37489 @smallexample
37490 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
37491 -> @code{X1234,6:XXXXXX}
37492 <- @code{T02}
37493 @end smallexample
37494
37495 @node Library List Format
37496 @section Library List Format
37497 @cindex library list format, remote protocol
37498
37499 On some platforms, a dynamic loader (e.g.@: @file{ld.so}) runs in the
37500 same process as your application to manage libraries. In this case,
37501 @value{GDBN} can use the loader's symbol table and normal memory
37502 operations to maintain a list of shared libraries. On other
37503 platforms, the operating system manages loaded libraries.
37504 @value{GDBN} can not retrieve the list of currently loaded libraries
37505 through memory operations, so it uses the @samp{qXfer:libraries:read}
37506 packet (@pxref{qXfer library list read}) instead. The remote stub
37507 queries the target's operating system and reports which libraries
37508 are loaded.
37509
37510 The @samp{qXfer:libraries:read} packet returns an XML document which
37511 lists loaded libraries and their offsets. Each library has an
37512 associated name and one or more segment or section base addresses,
37513 which report where the library was loaded in memory.
37514
37515 For the common case of libraries that are fully linked binaries, the
37516 library should have a list of segments. If the target supports
37517 dynamic linking of a relocatable object file, its library XML element
37518 should instead include a list of allocated sections. The segment or
37519 section bases are start addresses, not relocation offsets; they do not
37520 depend on the library's link-time base addresses.
37521
37522 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
37523 library lists. @xref{Expat}.
37524
37525 A simple memory map, with one loaded library relocated by a single
37526 offset, looks like this:
37527
37528 @smallexample
37529 <library-list>
37530 <library name="/lib/libc.so.6">
37531 <segment address="0x10000000"/>
37532 </library>
37533 </library-list>
37534 @end smallexample
37535
37536 Another simple memory map, with one loaded library with three
37537 allocated sections (.text, .data, .bss), looks like this:
37538
37539 @smallexample
37540 <library-list>
37541 <library name="sharedlib.o">
37542 <section address="0x10000000"/>
37543 <section address="0x20000000"/>
37544 <section address="0x30000000"/>
37545 </library>
37546 </library-list>
37547 @end smallexample
37548
37549 The format of a library list is described by this DTD:
37550
37551 @smallexample
37552 <!-- library-list: Root element with versioning -->
37553 <!ELEMENT library-list (library)*>
37554 <!ATTLIST library-list version CDATA #FIXED "1.0">
37555 <!ELEMENT library (segment*, section*)>
37556 <!ATTLIST library name CDATA #REQUIRED>
37557 <!ELEMENT segment EMPTY>
37558 <!ATTLIST segment address CDATA #REQUIRED>
37559 <!ELEMENT section EMPTY>
37560 <!ATTLIST section address CDATA #REQUIRED>
37561 @end smallexample
37562
37563 In addition, segments and section descriptors cannot be mixed within a
37564 single library element, and you must supply at least one segment or
37565 section for each library.
37566
37567 @node Library List Format for SVR4 Targets
37568 @section Library List Format for SVR4 Targets
37569 @cindex library list format, remote protocol
37570
37571 On SVR4 platforms @value{GDBN} can use the symbol table of a dynamic loader
37572 (e.g.@: @file{ld.so}) and normal memory operations to maintain a list of
37573 shared libraries. Still a special library list provided by this packet is
37574 more efficient for the @value{GDBN} remote protocol.
37575
37576 The @samp{qXfer:libraries-svr4:read} packet returns an XML document which lists
37577 loaded libraries and their SVR4 linker parameters. For each library on SVR4
37578 target, the following parameters are reported:
37579
37580 @itemize @minus
37581 @item
37582 @code{name}, the absolute file name from the @code{l_name} field of
37583 @code{struct link_map}.
37584 @item
37585 @code{lm} with address of @code{struct link_map} used for TLS
37586 (Thread Local Storage) access.
37587 @item
37588 @code{l_addr}, the displacement as read from the field @code{l_addr} of
37589 @code{struct link_map}. For prelinked libraries this is not an absolute
37590 memory address. It is a displacement of absolute memory address against
37591 address the file was prelinked to during the library load.
37592 @item
37593 @code{l_ld}, which is memory address of the @code{PT_DYNAMIC} segment
37594 @end itemize
37595
37596 Additionally the single @code{main-lm} attribute specifies address of
37597 @code{struct link_map} used for the main executable. This parameter is used
37598 for TLS access and its presence is optional.
37599
37600 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
37601 SVR4 library lists. @xref{Expat}.
37602
37603 A simple memory map, with two loaded libraries (which do not use prelink),
37604 looks like this:
37605
37606 @smallexample
37607 <library-list-svr4 version="1.0" main-lm="0xe4f8f8">
37608 <library name="/lib/ld-linux.so.2" lm="0xe4f51c" l_addr="0xe2d000"
37609 l_ld="0xe4eefc"/>
37610 <library name="/lib/libc.so.6" lm="0xe4fbe8" l_addr="0x154000"
37611 l_ld="0x152350"/>
37612 </library-list-svr>
37613 @end smallexample
37614
37615 The format of an SVR4 library list is described by this DTD:
37616
37617 @smallexample
37618 <!-- library-list-svr4: Root element with versioning -->
37619 <!ELEMENT library-list-svr4 (library)*>
37620 <!ATTLIST library-list-svr4 version CDATA #FIXED "1.0">
37621 <!ATTLIST library-list-svr4 main-lm CDATA #IMPLIED>
37622 <!ELEMENT library EMPTY>
37623 <!ATTLIST library name CDATA #REQUIRED>
37624 <!ATTLIST library lm CDATA #REQUIRED>
37625 <!ATTLIST library l_addr CDATA #REQUIRED>
37626 <!ATTLIST library l_ld CDATA #REQUIRED>
37627 @end smallexample
37628
37629 @node Memory Map Format
37630 @section Memory Map Format
37631 @cindex memory map format
37632
37633 To be able to write into flash memory, @value{GDBN} needs to obtain a
37634 memory map from the target. This section describes the format of the
37635 memory map.
37636
37637 The memory map is obtained using the @samp{qXfer:memory-map:read}
37638 (@pxref{qXfer memory map read}) packet and is an XML document that
37639 lists memory regions.
37640
37641 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
37642 memory maps. @xref{Expat}.
37643
37644 The top-level structure of the document is shown below:
37645
37646 @smallexample
37647 <?xml version="1.0"?>
37648 <!DOCTYPE memory-map
37649 PUBLIC "+//IDN gnu.org//DTD GDB Memory Map V1.0//EN"
37650 "http://sourceware.org/gdb/gdb-memory-map.dtd">
37651 <memory-map>
37652 region...
37653 </memory-map>
37654 @end smallexample
37655
37656 Each region can be either:
37657
37658 @itemize
37659
37660 @item
37661 A region of RAM starting at @var{addr} and extending for @var{length}
37662 bytes from there:
37663
37664 @smallexample
37665 <memory type="ram" start="@var{addr}" length="@var{length}"/>
37666 @end smallexample
37667
37668
37669 @item
37670 A region of read-only memory:
37671
37672 @smallexample
37673 <memory type="rom" start="@var{addr}" length="@var{length}"/>
37674 @end smallexample
37675
37676
37677 @item
37678 A region of flash memory, with erasure blocks @var{blocksize}
37679 bytes in length:
37680
37681 @smallexample
37682 <memory type="flash" start="@var{addr}" length="@var{length}">
37683 <property name="blocksize">@var{blocksize}</property>
37684 </memory>
37685 @end smallexample
37686
37687 @end itemize
37688
37689 Regions must not overlap. @value{GDBN} assumes that areas of memory not covered
37690 by the memory map are RAM, and uses the ordinary @samp{M} and @samp{X}
37691 packets to write to addresses in such ranges.
37692
37693 The formal DTD for memory map format is given below:
37694
37695 @smallexample
37696 <!-- ................................................... -->
37697 <!-- Memory Map XML DTD ................................ -->
37698 <!-- File: memory-map.dtd .............................. -->
37699 <!-- .................................... .............. -->
37700 <!-- memory-map.dtd -->
37701 <!-- memory-map: Root element with versioning -->
37702 <!ELEMENT memory-map (memory | property)>
37703 <!ATTLIST memory-map version CDATA #FIXED "1.0.0">
37704 <!ELEMENT memory (property)>
37705 <!-- memory: Specifies a memory region,
37706 and its type, or device. -->
37707 <!ATTLIST memory type CDATA #REQUIRED
37708 start CDATA #REQUIRED
37709 length CDATA #REQUIRED
37710 device CDATA #IMPLIED>
37711 <!-- property: Generic attribute tag -->
37712 <!ELEMENT property (#PCDATA | property)*>
37713 <!ATTLIST property name CDATA #REQUIRED>
37714 @end smallexample
37715
37716 @node Thread List Format
37717 @section Thread List Format
37718 @cindex thread list format
37719
37720 To efficiently update the list of threads and their attributes,
37721 @value{GDBN} issues the @samp{qXfer:threads:read} packet
37722 (@pxref{qXfer threads read}) and obtains the XML document with
37723 the following structure:
37724
37725 @smallexample
37726 <?xml version="1.0"?>
37727 <threads>
37728 <thread id="id" core="0">
37729 ... description ...
37730 </thread>
37731 </threads>
37732 @end smallexample
37733
37734 Each @samp{thread} element must have the @samp{id} attribute that
37735 identifies the thread (@pxref{thread-id syntax}). The
37736 @samp{core} attribute, if present, specifies which processor core
37737 the thread was last executing on. The content of the of @samp{thread}
37738 element is interpreted as human-readable auxilliary information.
37739
37740 @node Traceframe Info Format
37741 @section Traceframe Info Format
37742 @cindex traceframe info format
37743
37744 To be able to know which objects in the inferior can be examined when
37745 inspecting a tracepoint hit, @value{GDBN} needs to obtain the list of
37746 memory ranges, registers and trace state variables that have been
37747 collected in a traceframe.
37748
37749 This list is obtained using the @samp{qXfer:traceframe-info:read}
37750 (@pxref{qXfer traceframe info read}) packet and is an XML document.
37751
37752 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
37753 traceframe info discovery. @xref{Expat}.
37754
37755 The top-level structure of the document is shown below:
37756
37757 @smallexample
37758 <?xml version="1.0"?>
37759 <!DOCTYPE traceframe-info
37760 PUBLIC "+//IDN gnu.org//DTD GDB Memory Map V1.0//EN"
37761 "http://sourceware.org/gdb/gdb-traceframe-info.dtd">
37762 <traceframe-info>
37763 block...
37764 </traceframe-info>
37765 @end smallexample
37766
37767 Each traceframe block can be either:
37768
37769 @itemize
37770
37771 @item
37772 A region of collected memory starting at @var{addr} and extending for
37773 @var{length} bytes from there:
37774
37775 @smallexample
37776 <memory start="@var{addr}" length="@var{length}"/>
37777 @end smallexample
37778
37779 @end itemize
37780
37781 The formal DTD for the traceframe info format is given below:
37782
37783 @smallexample
37784 <!ELEMENT traceframe-info (memory)* >
37785 <!ATTLIST traceframe-info version CDATA #FIXED "1.0">
37786
37787 <!ELEMENT memory EMPTY>
37788 <!ATTLIST memory start CDATA #REQUIRED
37789 length CDATA #REQUIRED>
37790 @end smallexample
37791
37792 @include agentexpr.texi
37793
37794 @node Target Descriptions
37795 @appendix Target Descriptions
37796 @cindex target descriptions
37797
37798 One of the challenges of using @value{GDBN} to debug embedded systems
37799 is that there are so many minor variants of each processor
37800 architecture in use. It is common practice for vendors to start with
37801 a standard processor core --- ARM, PowerPC, or MIPS, for example ---
37802 and then make changes to adapt it to a particular market niche. Some
37803 architectures have hundreds of variants, available from dozens of
37804 vendors. This leads to a number of problems:
37805
37806 @itemize @bullet
37807 @item
37808 With so many different customized processors, it is difficult for
37809 the @value{GDBN} maintainers to keep up with the changes.
37810 @item
37811 Since individual variants may have short lifetimes or limited
37812 audiences, it may not be worthwhile to carry information about every
37813 variant in the @value{GDBN} source tree.
37814 @item
37815 When @value{GDBN} does support the architecture of the embedded system
37816 at hand, the task of finding the correct architecture name to give the
37817 @command{set architecture} command can be error-prone.
37818 @end itemize
37819
37820 To address these problems, the @value{GDBN} remote protocol allows a
37821 target system to not only identify itself to @value{GDBN}, but to
37822 actually describe its own features. This lets @value{GDBN} support
37823 processor variants it has never seen before --- to the extent that the
37824 descriptions are accurate, and that @value{GDBN} understands them.
37825
37826 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
37827 target descriptions. @xref{Expat}.
37828
37829 @menu
37830 * Retrieving Descriptions:: How descriptions are fetched from a target.
37831 * Target Description Format:: The contents of a target description.
37832 * Predefined Target Types:: Standard types available for target
37833 descriptions.
37834 * Standard Target Features:: Features @value{GDBN} knows about.
37835 @end menu
37836
37837 @node Retrieving Descriptions
37838 @section Retrieving Descriptions
37839
37840 Target descriptions can be read from the target automatically, or
37841 specified by the user manually. The default behavior is to read the
37842 description from the target. @value{GDBN} retrieves it via the remote
37843 protocol using @samp{qXfer} requests (@pxref{General Query Packets,
37844 qXfer}). The @var{annex} in the @samp{qXfer} packet will be
37845 @samp{target.xml}. The contents of the @samp{target.xml} annex are an
37846 XML document, of the form described in @ref{Target Description
37847 Format}.
37848
37849 Alternatively, you can specify a file to read for the target description.
37850 If a file is set, the target will not be queried. The commands to
37851 specify a file are:
37852
37853 @table @code
37854 @cindex set tdesc filename
37855 @item set tdesc filename @var{path}
37856 Read the target description from @var{path}.
37857
37858 @cindex unset tdesc filename
37859 @item unset tdesc filename
37860 Do not read the XML target description from a file. @value{GDBN}
37861 will use the description supplied by the current target.
37862
37863 @cindex show tdesc filename
37864 @item show tdesc filename
37865 Show the filename to read for a target description, if any.
37866 @end table
37867
37868
37869 @node Target Description Format
37870 @section Target Description Format
37871 @cindex target descriptions, XML format
37872
37873 A target description annex is an @uref{http://www.w3.org/XML/, XML}
37874 document which complies with the Document Type Definition provided in
37875 the @value{GDBN} sources in @file{gdb/features/gdb-target.dtd}. This
37876 means you can use generally available tools like @command{xmllint} to
37877 check that your feature descriptions are well-formed and valid.
37878 However, to help people unfamiliar with XML write descriptions for
37879 their targets, we also describe the grammar here.
37880
37881 Target descriptions can identify the architecture of the remote target
37882 and (for some architectures) provide information about custom register
37883 sets. They can also identify the OS ABI of the remote target.
37884 @value{GDBN} can use this information to autoconfigure for your
37885 target, or to warn you if you connect to an unsupported target.
37886
37887 Here is a simple target description:
37888
37889 @smallexample
37890 <target version="1.0">
37891 <architecture>i386:x86-64</architecture>
37892 </target>
37893 @end smallexample
37894
37895 @noindent
37896 This minimal description only says that the target uses
37897 the x86-64 architecture.
37898
37899 A target description has the following overall form, with [ ] marking
37900 optional elements and @dots{} marking repeatable elements. The elements
37901 are explained further below.
37902
37903 @smallexample
37904 <?xml version="1.0"?>
37905 <!DOCTYPE target SYSTEM "gdb-target.dtd">
37906 <target version="1.0">
37907 @r{[}@var{architecture}@r{]}
37908 @r{[}@var{osabi}@r{]}
37909 @r{[}@var{compatible}@r{]}
37910 @r{[}@var{feature}@dots{}@r{]}
37911 </target>
37912 @end smallexample
37913
37914 @noindent
37915 The description is generally insensitive to whitespace and line
37916 breaks, under the usual common-sense rules. The XML version
37917 declaration and document type declaration can generally be omitted
37918 (@value{GDBN} does not require them), but specifying them may be
37919 useful for XML validation tools. The @samp{version} attribute for
37920 @samp{<target>} may also be omitted, but we recommend
37921 including it; if future versions of @value{GDBN} use an incompatible
37922 revision of @file{gdb-target.dtd}, they will detect and report
37923 the version mismatch.
37924
37925 @subsection Inclusion
37926 @cindex target descriptions, inclusion
37927 @cindex XInclude
37928 @ifnotinfo
37929 @cindex <xi:include>
37930 @end ifnotinfo
37931
37932 It can sometimes be valuable to split a target description up into
37933 several different annexes, either for organizational purposes, or to
37934 share files between different possible target descriptions. You can
37935 divide a description into multiple files by replacing any element of
37936 the target description with an inclusion directive of the form:
37937
37938 @smallexample
37939 <xi:include href="@var{document}"/>
37940 @end smallexample
37941
37942 @noindent
37943 When @value{GDBN} encounters an element of this form, it will retrieve
37944 the named XML @var{document}, and replace the inclusion directive with
37945 the contents of that document. If the current description was read
37946 using @samp{qXfer}, then so will be the included document;
37947 @var{document} will be interpreted as the name of an annex. If the
37948 current description was read from a file, @value{GDBN} will look for
37949 @var{document} as a file in the same directory where it found the
37950 original description.
37951
37952 @subsection Architecture
37953 @cindex <architecture>
37954
37955 An @samp{<architecture>} element has this form:
37956
37957 @smallexample
37958 <architecture>@var{arch}</architecture>
37959 @end smallexample
37960
37961 @var{arch} is one of the architectures from the set accepted by
37962 @code{set architecture} (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
37963
37964 @subsection OS ABI
37965 @cindex @code{<osabi>}
37966
37967 This optional field was introduced in @value{GDBN} version 7.0.
37968 Previous versions of @value{GDBN} ignore it.
37969
37970 An @samp{<osabi>} element has this form:
37971
37972 @smallexample
37973 <osabi>@var{abi-name}</osabi>
37974 @end smallexample
37975
37976 @var{abi-name} is an OS ABI name from the same selection accepted by
37977 @w{@code{set osabi}} (@pxref{ABI, ,Configuring the Current ABI}).
37978
37979 @subsection Compatible Architecture
37980 @cindex @code{<compatible>}
37981
37982 This optional field was introduced in @value{GDBN} version 7.0.
37983 Previous versions of @value{GDBN} ignore it.
37984
37985 A @samp{<compatible>} element has this form:
37986
37987 @smallexample
37988 <compatible>@var{arch}</compatible>
37989 @end smallexample
37990
37991 @var{arch} is one of the architectures from the set accepted by
37992 @code{set architecture} (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
37993
37994 A @samp{<compatible>} element is used to specify that the target
37995 is able to run binaries in some other than the main target architecture
37996 given by the @samp{<architecture>} element. For example, on the
37997 Cell Broadband Engine, the main architecture is @code{powerpc:common}
37998 or @code{powerpc:common64}, but the system is able to run binaries
37999 in the @code{spu} architecture as well. The way to describe this
38000 capability with @samp{<compatible>} is as follows:
38001
38002 @smallexample
38003 <architecture>powerpc:common</architecture>
38004 <compatible>spu</compatible>
38005 @end smallexample
38006
38007 @subsection Features
38008 @cindex <feature>
38009
38010 Each @samp{<feature>} describes some logical portion of the target
38011 system. Features are currently used to describe available CPU
38012 registers and the types of their contents. A @samp{<feature>} element
38013 has this form:
38014
38015 @smallexample
38016 <feature name="@var{name}">
38017 @r{[}@var{type}@dots{}@r{]}
38018 @var{reg}@dots{}
38019 </feature>
38020 @end smallexample
38021
38022 @noindent
38023 Each feature's name should be unique within the description. The name
38024 of a feature does not matter unless @value{GDBN} has some special
38025 knowledge of the contents of that feature; if it does, the feature
38026 should have its standard name. @xref{Standard Target Features}.
38027
38028 @subsection Types
38029
38030 Any register's value is a collection of bits which @value{GDBN} must
38031 interpret. The default interpretation is a two's complement integer,
38032 but other types can be requested by name in the register description.
38033 Some predefined types are provided by @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Predefined
38034 Target Types}), and the description can define additional composite types.
38035
38036 Each type element must have an @samp{id} attribute, which gives
38037 a unique (within the containing @samp{<feature>}) name to the type.
38038 Types must be defined before they are used.
38039
38040 @cindex <vector>
38041 Some targets offer vector registers, which can be treated as arrays
38042 of scalar elements. These types are written as @samp{<vector>} elements,
38043 specifying the array element type, @var{type}, and the number of elements,
38044 @var{count}:
38045
38046 @smallexample
38047 <vector id="@var{id}" type="@var{type}" count="@var{count}"/>
38048 @end smallexample
38049
38050 @cindex <union>
38051 If a register's value is usefully viewed in multiple ways, define it
38052 with a union type containing the useful representations. The
38053 @samp{<union>} element contains one or more @samp{<field>} elements,
38054 each of which has a @var{name} and a @var{type}:
38055
38056 @smallexample
38057 <union id="@var{id}">
38058 <field name="@var{name}" type="@var{type}"/>
38059 @dots{}
38060 </union>
38061 @end smallexample
38062
38063 @cindex <struct>
38064 If a register's value is composed from several separate values, define
38065 it with a structure type. There are two forms of the @samp{<struct>}
38066 element; a @samp{<struct>} element must either contain only bitfields
38067 or contain no bitfields. If the structure contains only bitfields,
38068 its total size in bytes must be specified, each bitfield must have an
38069 explicit start and end, and bitfields are automatically assigned an
38070 integer type. The field's @var{start} should be less than or
38071 equal to its @var{end}, and zero represents the least significant bit.
38072
38073 @smallexample
38074 <struct id="@var{id}" size="@var{size}">
38075 <field name="@var{name}" start="@var{start}" end="@var{end}"/>
38076 @dots{}
38077 </struct>
38078 @end smallexample
38079
38080 If the structure contains no bitfields, then each field has an
38081 explicit type, and no implicit padding is added.
38082
38083 @smallexample
38084 <struct id="@var{id}">
38085 <field name="@var{name}" type="@var{type}"/>
38086 @dots{}
38087 </struct>
38088 @end smallexample
38089
38090 @cindex <flags>
38091 If a register's value is a series of single-bit flags, define it with
38092 a flags type. The @samp{<flags>} element has an explicit @var{size}
38093 and contains one or more @samp{<field>} elements. Each field has a
38094 @var{name}, a @var{start}, and an @var{end}. Only single-bit flags
38095 are supported.
38096
38097 @smallexample
38098 <flags id="@var{id}" size="@var{size}">
38099 <field name="@var{name}" start="@var{start}" end="@var{end}"/>
38100 @dots{}
38101 </flags>
38102 @end smallexample
38103
38104 @subsection Registers
38105 @cindex <reg>
38106
38107 Each register is represented as an element with this form:
38108
38109 @smallexample
38110 <reg name="@var{name}"
38111 bitsize="@var{size}"
38112 @r{[}regnum="@var{num}"@r{]}
38113 @r{[}save-restore="@var{save-restore}"@r{]}
38114 @r{[}type="@var{type}"@r{]}
38115 @r{[}group="@var{group}"@r{]}/>
38116 @end smallexample
38117
38118 @noindent
38119 The components are as follows:
38120
38121 @table @var
38122
38123 @item name
38124 The register's name; it must be unique within the target description.
38125
38126 @item bitsize
38127 The register's size, in bits.
38128
38129 @item regnum
38130 The register's number. If omitted, a register's number is one greater
38131 than that of the previous register (either in the current feature or in
38132 a preceding feature); the first register in the target description
38133 defaults to zero. This register number is used to read or write
38134 the register; e.g.@: it is used in the remote @code{p} and @code{P}
38135 packets, and registers appear in the @code{g} and @code{G} packets
38136 in order of increasing register number.
38137
38138 @item save-restore
38139 Whether the register should be preserved across inferior function
38140 calls; this must be either @code{yes} or @code{no}. The default is
38141 @code{yes}, which is appropriate for most registers except for
38142 some system control registers; this is not related to the target's
38143 ABI.
38144
38145 @item type
38146 The type of the register. @var{type} may be a predefined type, a type
38147 defined in the current feature, or one of the special types @code{int}
38148 and @code{float}. @code{int} is an integer type of the correct size
38149 for @var{bitsize}, and @code{float} is a floating point type (in the
38150 architecture's normal floating point format) of the correct size for
38151 @var{bitsize}. The default is @code{int}.
38152
38153 @item group
38154 The register group to which this register belongs. @var{group} must
38155 be either @code{general}, @code{float}, or @code{vector}. If no
38156 @var{group} is specified, @value{GDBN} will not display the register
38157 in @code{info registers}.
38158
38159 @end table
38160
38161 @node Predefined Target Types
38162 @section Predefined Target Types
38163 @cindex target descriptions, predefined types
38164
38165 Type definitions in the self-description can build up composite types
38166 from basic building blocks, but can not define fundamental types. Instead,
38167 standard identifiers are provided by @value{GDBN} for the fundamental
38168 types. The currently supported types are:
38169
38170 @table @code
38171
38172 @item int8
38173 @itemx int16
38174 @itemx int32
38175 @itemx int64
38176 @itemx int128
38177 Signed integer types holding the specified number of bits.
38178
38179 @item uint8
38180 @itemx uint16
38181 @itemx uint32
38182 @itemx uint64
38183 @itemx uint128
38184 Unsigned integer types holding the specified number of bits.
38185
38186 @item code_ptr
38187 @itemx data_ptr
38188 Pointers to unspecified code and data. The program counter and
38189 any dedicated return address register may be marked as code
38190 pointers; printing a code pointer converts it into a symbolic
38191 address. The stack pointer and any dedicated address registers
38192 may be marked as data pointers.
38193
38194 @item ieee_single
38195 Single precision IEEE floating point.
38196
38197 @item ieee_double
38198 Double precision IEEE floating point.
38199
38200 @item arm_fpa_ext
38201 The 12-byte extended precision format used by ARM FPA registers.
38202
38203 @item i387_ext
38204 The 10-byte extended precision format used by x87 registers.
38205
38206 @item i386_eflags
38207 32bit @sc{eflags} register used by x86.
38208
38209 @item i386_mxcsr
38210 32bit @sc{mxcsr} register used by x86.
38211
38212 @end table
38213
38214 @node Standard Target Features
38215 @section Standard Target Features
38216 @cindex target descriptions, standard features
38217
38218 A target description must contain either no registers or all the
38219 target's registers. If the description contains no registers, then
38220 @value{GDBN} will assume a default register layout, selected based on
38221 the architecture. If the description contains any registers, the
38222 default layout will not be used; the standard registers must be
38223 described in the target description, in such a way that @value{GDBN}
38224 can recognize them.
38225
38226 This is accomplished by giving specific names to feature elements
38227 which contain standard registers. @value{GDBN} will look for features
38228 with those names and verify that they contain the expected registers;
38229 if any known feature is missing required registers, or if any required
38230 feature is missing, @value{GDBN} will reject the target
38231 description. You can add additional registers to any of the
38232 standard features --- @value{GDBN} will display them just as if
38233 they were added to an unrecognized feature.
38234
38235 This section lists the known features and their expected contents.
38236 Sample XML documents for these features are included in the
38237 @value{GDBN} source tree, in the directory @file{gdb/features}.
38238
38239 Names recognized by @value{GDBN} should include the name of the
38240 company or organization which selected the name, and the overall
38241 architecture to which the feature applies; so e.g.@: the feature
38242 containing ARM core registers is named @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.core}.
38243
38244 The names of registers are not case sensitive for the purpose
38245 of recognizing standard features, but @value{GDBN} will only display
38246 registers using the capitalization used in the description.
38247
38248 @menu
38249 * ARM Features::
38250 * i386 Features::
38251 * MIPS Features::
38252 * M68K Features::
38253 * PowerPC Features::
38254 * TIC6x Features::
38255 @end menu
38256
38257
38258 @node ARM Features
38259 @subsection ARM Features
38260 @cindex target descriptions, ARM features
38261
38262 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.core} feature is required for non-M-profile
38263 ARM targets.
38264 It should contain registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r13}, @samp{sp},
38265 @samp{lr}, @samp{pc}, and @samp{cpsr}.
38266
38267 For M-profile targets (e.g. Cortex-M3), the @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.core}
38268 feature is replaced by @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.m-profile}. It should contain
38269 registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r13}, @samp{sp}, @samp{lr}, @samp{pc},
38270 and @samp{xpsr}.
38271
38272 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.fpa} feature is optional. If present, it
38273 should contain registers @samp{f0} through @samp{f7} and @samp{fps}.
38274
38275 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.xscale.iwmmxt} feature is optional. If present,
38276 it should contain at least registers @samp{wR0} through @samp{wR15} and
38277 @samp{wCGR0} through @samp{wCGR3}. The @samp{wCID}, @samp{wCon},
38278 @samp{wCSSF}, and @samp{wCASF} registers are optional.
38279
38280 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.vfp} feature is optional. If present, it
38281 should contain at least registers @samp{d0} through @samp{d15}. If
38282 they are present, @samp{d16} through @samp{d31} should also be included.
38283 @value{GDBN} will synthesize the single-precision registers from
38284 halves of the double-precision registers.
38285
38286 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.neon} feature is optional. It does not
38287 need to contain registers; it instructs @value{GDBN} to display the
38288 VFP double-precision registers as vectors and to synthesize the
38289 quad-precision registers from pairs of double-precision registers.
38290 If this feature is present, @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.vfp} must also
38291 be present and include 32 double-precision registers.
38292
38293 @node i386 Features
38294 @subsection i386 Features
38295 @cindex target descriptions, i386 features
38296
38297 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.core} feature is required for i386/amd64
38298 targets. It should describe the following registers:
38299
38300 @itemize @minus
38301 @item
38302 @samp{eax} through @samp{edi} plus @samp{eip} for i386
38303 @item
38304 @samp{rax} through @samp{r15} plus @samp{rip} for amd64
38305 @item
38306 @samp{eflags}, @samp{cs}, @samp{ss}, @samp{ds}, @samp{es},
38307 @samp{fs}, @samp{gs}
38308 @item
38309 @samp{st0} through @samp{st7}
38310 @item
38311 @samp{fctrl}, @samp{fstat}, @samp{ftag}, @samp{fiseg}, @samp{fioff},
38312 @samp{foseg}, @samp{fooff} and @samp{fop}
38313 @end itemize
38314
38315 The register sets may be different, depending on the target.
38316
38317 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.sse} feature is optional. It should
38318 describe registers:
38319
38320 @itemize @minus
38321 @item
38322 @samp{xmm0} through @samp{xmm7} for i386
38323 @item
38324 @samp{xmm0} through @samp{xmm15} for amd64
38325 @item
38326 @samp{mxcsr}
38327 @end itemize
38328
38329 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.avx} feature is optional and requires the
38330 @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.sse} feature. It should
38331 describe the upper 128 bits of @sc{ymm} registers:
38332
38333 @itemize @minus
38334 @item
38335 @samp{ymm0h} through @samp{ymm7h} for i386
38336 @item
38337 @samp{ymm0h} through @samp{ymm15h} for amd64
38338 @end itemize
38339
38340 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.linux} feature is optional. It should
38341 describe a single register, @samp{orig_eax}.
38342
38343 @node MIPS Features
38344 @subsection MIPS Features
38345 @cindex target descriptions, MIPS features
38346
38347 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.cpu} feature is required for MIPS targets.
38348 It should contain registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r31}, @samp{lo},
38349 @samp{hi}, and @samp{pc}. They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending
38350 on the target.
38351
38352 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.cp0} feature is also required. It should
38353 contain at least the @samp{status}, @samp{badvaddr}, and @samp{cause}
38354 registers. They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending on the target.
38355
38356 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.fpu} feature is currently required, though
38357 it may be optional in a future version of @value{GDBN}. It should
38358 contain registers @samp{f0} through @samp{f31}, @samp{fcsr}, and
38359 @samp{fir}. They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending on the target.
38360
38361 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.linux} feature is optional. It should
38362 contain a single register, @samp{restart}, which is used by the
38363 Linux kernel to control restartable syscalls.
38364
38365 @node M68K Features
38366 @subsection M68K Features
38367 @cindex target descriptions, M68K features
38368
38369 @table @code
38370 @item @samp{org.gnu.gdb.m68k.core}
38371 @itemx @samp{org.gnu.gdb.coldfire.core}
38372 @itemx @samp{org.gnu.gdb.fido.core}
38373 One of those features must be always present.
38374 The feature that is present determines which flavor of m68k is
38375 used. The feature that is present should contain registers
38376 @samp{d0} through @samp{d7}, @samp{a0} through @samp{a5}, @samp{fp},
38377 @samp{sp}, @samp{ps} and @samp{pc}.
38378
38379 @item @samp{org.gnu.gdb.coldfire.fp}
38380 This feature is optional. If present, it should contain registers
38381 @samp{fp0} through @samp{fp7}, @samp{fpcontrol}, @samp{fpstatus} and
38382 @samp{fpiaddr}.
38383 @end table
38384
38385 @node PowerPC Features
38386 @subsection PowerPC Features
38387 @cindex target descriptions, PowerPC features
38388
38389 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.core} feature is required for PowerPC
38390 targets. It should contain registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r31},
38391 @samp{pc}, @samp{msr}, @samp{cr}, @samp{lr}, @samp{ctr}, and
38392 @samp{xer}. They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending on the target.
38393
38394 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.fpu} feature is optional. It should
38395 contain registers @samp{f0} through @samp{f31} and @samp{fpscr}.
38396
38397 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.altivec} feature is optional. It should
38398 contain registers @samp{vr0} through @samp{vr31}, @samp{vscr},
38399 and @samp{vrsave}.
38400
38401 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.vsx} feature is optional. It should
38402 contain registers @samp{vs0h} through @samp{vs31h}. @value{GDBN}
38403 will combine these registers with the floating point registers
38404 (@samp{f0} through @samp{f31}) and the altivec registers (@samp{vr0}
38405 through @samp{vr31}) to present the 128-bit wide registers @samp{vs0}
38406 through @samp{vs63}, the set of vector registers for POWER7.
38407
38408 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.spe} feature is optional. It should
38409 contain registers @samp{ev0h} through @samp{ev31h}, @samp{acc}, and
38410 @samp{spefscr}. SPE targets should provide 32-bit registers in
38411 @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.core} and provide the upper halves in
38412 @samp{ev0h} through @samp{ev31h}. @value{GDBN} will combine
38413 these to present registers @samp{ev0} through @samp{ev31} to the
38414 user.
38415
38416 @node TIC6x Features
38417 @subsection TMS320C6x Features
38418 @cindex target descriptions, TIC6x features
38419 @cindex target descriptions, TMS320C6x features
38420 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.tic6x.core} feature is required for TMS320C6x
38421 targets. It should contain registers @samp{A0} through @samp{A15},
38422 registers @samp{B0} through @samp{B15}, @samp{CSR} and @samp{PC}.
38423
38424 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.tic6x.gp} feature is optional. It should
38425 contain registers @samp{A16} through @samp{A31} and @samp{B16}
38426 through @samp{B31}.
38427
38428 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.tic6x.c6xp} feature is optional. It should
38429 contain registers @samp{TSR}, @samp{ILC} and @samp{RILC}.
38430
38431 @node Operating System Information
38432 @appendix Operating System Information
38433 @cindex operating system information
38434
38435 @menu
38436 * Process list::
38437 @end menu
38438
38439 Users of @value{GDBN} often wish to obtain information about the state of
38440 the operating system running on the target---for example the list of
38441 processes, or the list of open files. This section describes the
38442 mechanism that makes it possible. This mechanism is similar to the
38443 target features mechanism (@pxref{Target Descriptions}), but focuses
38444 on a different aspect of target.
38445
38446 Operating system information is retrived from the target via the
38447 remote protocol, using @samp{qXfer} requests (@pxref{qXfer osdata
38448 read}). The object name in the request should be @samp{osdata}, and
38449 the @var{annex} identifies the data to be fetched.
38450
38451 @node Process list
38452 @appendixsection Process list
38453 @cindex operating system information, process list
38454
38455 When requesting the process list, the @var{annex} field in the
38456 @samp{qXfer} request should be @samp{processes}. The returned data is
38457 an XML document. The formal syntax of this document is defined in
38458 @file{gdb/features/osdata.dtd}.
38459
38460 An example document is:
38461
38462 @smallexample
38463 <?xml version="1.0"?>
38464 <!DOCTYPE target SYSTEM "osdata.dtd">
38465 <osdata type="processes">
38466 <item>
38467 <column name="pid">1</column>
38468 <column name="user">root</column>
38469 <column name="command">/sbin/init</column>
38470 <column name="cores">1,2,3</column>
38471 </item>
38472 </osdata>
38473 @end smallexample
38474
38475 Each item should include a column whose name is @samp{pid}. The value
38476 of that column should identify the process on the target. The
38477 @samp{user} and @samp{command} columns are optional, and will be
38478 displayed by @value{GDBN}. The @samp{cores} column, if present,
38479 should contain a comma-separated list of cores that this process
38480 is running on. Target may provide additional columns,
38481 which @value{GDBN} currently ignores.
38482
38483 @node Trace File Format
38484 @appendix Trace File Format
38485 @cindex trace file format
38486
38487 The trace file comes in three parts: a header, a textual description
38488 section, and a trace frame section with binary data.
38489
38490 The header has the form @code{\x7fTRACE0\n}. The first byte is
38491 @code{0x7f} so as to indicate that the file contains binary data,
38492 while the @code{0} is a version number that may have different values
38493 in the future.
38494
38495 The description section consists of multiple lines of @sc{ascii} text
38496 separated by newline characters (@code{0xa}). The lines may include a
38497 variety of optional descriptive or context-setting information, such
38498 as tracepoint definitions or register set size. @value{GDBN} will
38499 ignore any line that it does not recognize. An empty line marks the end
38500 of this section.
38501
38502 @c FIXME add some specific types of data
38503
38504 The trace frame section consists of a number of consecutive frames.
38505 Each frame begins with a two-byte tracepoint number, followed by a
38506 four-byte size giving the amount of data in the frame. The data in
38507 the frame consists of a number of blocks, each introduced by a
38508 character indicating its type (at least register, memory, and trace
38509 state variable). The data in this section is raw binary, not a
38510 hexadecimal or other encoding; its endianness matches the target's
38511 endianness.
38512
38513 @c FIXME bi-arch may require endianness/arch info in description section
38514
38515 @table @code
38516 @item R @var{bytes}
38517 Register block. The number and ordering of bytes matches that of a
38518 @code{g} packet in the remote protocol. Note that these are the
38519 actual bytes, in target order and @value{GDBN} register order, not a
38520 hexadecimal encoding.
38521
38522 @item M @var{address} @var{length} @var{bytes}...
38523 Memory block. This is a contiguous block of memory, at the 8-byte
38524 address @var{address}, with a 2-byte length @var{length}, followed by
38525 @var{length} bytes.
38526
38527 @item V @var{number} @var{value}
38528 Trace state variable block. This records the 8-byte signed value
38529 @var{value} of trace state variable numbered @var{number}.
38530
38531 @end table
38532
38533 Future enhancements of the trace file format may include additional types
38534 of blocks.
38535
38536 @node Index Section Format
38537 @appendix @code{.gdb_index} section format
38538 @cindex .gdb_index section format
38539 @cindex index section format
38540
38541 This section documents the index section that is created by @code{save
38542 gdb-index} (@pxref{Index Files}). The index section is
38543 DWARF-specific; some knowledge of DWARF is assumed in this
38544 description.
38545
38546 The mapped index file format is designed to be directly
38547 @code{mmap}able on any architecture. In most cases, a datum is
38548 represented using a little-endian 32-bit integer value, called an
38549 @code{offset_type}. Big endian machines must byte-swap the values
38550 before using them. Exceptions to this rule are noted. The data is
38551 laid out such that alignment is always respected.
38552
38553 A mapped index consists of several areas, laid out in order.
38554
38555 @enumerate
38556 @item
38557 The file header. This is a sequence of values, of @code{offset_type}
38558 unless otherwise noted:
38559
38560 @enumerate
38561 @item
38562 The version number, currently 5. Versions 1, 2 and 3 are obsolete.
38563 Version 4 differs by its hashing function.
38564
38565 @item
38566 The offset, from the start of the file, of the CU list.
38567
38568 @item
38569 The offset, from the start of the file, of the types CU list. Note
38570 that this area can be empty, in which case this offset will be equal
38571 to the next offset.
38572
38573 @item
38574 The offset, from the start of the file, of the address area.
38575
38576 @item
38577 The offset, from the start of the file, of the symbol table.
38578
38579 @item
38580 The offset, from the start of the file, of the constant pool.
38581 @end enumerate
38582
38583 @item
38584 The CU list. This is a sequence of pairs of 64-bit little-endian
38585 values, sorted by the CU offset. The first element in each pair is
38586 the offset of a CU in the @code{.debug_info} section. The second
38587 element in each pair is the length of that CU. References to a CU
38588 elsewhere in the map are done using a CU index, which is just the
38589 0-based index into this table. Note that if there are type CUs, then
38590 conceptually CUs and type CUs form a single list for the purposes of
38591 CU indices.
38592
38593 @item
38594 The types CU list. This is a sequence of triplets of 64-bit
38595 little-endian values. In a triplet, the first value is the CU offset,
38596 the second value is the type offset in the CU, and the third value is
38597 the type signature. The types CU list is not sorted.
38598
38599 @item
38600 The address area. The address area consists of a sequence of address
38601 entries. Each address entry has three elements:
38602
38603 @enumerate
38604 @item
38605 The low address. This is a 64-bit little-endian value.
38606
38607 @item
38608 The high address. This is a 64-bit little-endian value. Like
38609 @code{DW_AT_high_pc}, the value is one byte beyond the end.
38610
38611 @item
38612 The CU index. This is an @code{offset_type} value.
38613 @end enumerate
38614
38615 @item
38616 The symbol table. This is an open-addressed hash table. The size of
38617 the hash table is always a power of 2.
38618
38619 Each slot in the hash table consists of a pair of @code{offset_type}
38620 values. The first value is the offset of the symbol's name in the
38621 constant pool. The second value is the offset of the CU vector in the
38622 constant pool.
38623
38624 If both values are 0, then this slot in the hash table is empty. This
38625 is ok because while 0 is a valid constant pool index, it cannot be a
38626 valid index for both a string and a CU vector.
38627
38628 The hash value for a table entry is computed by applying an
38629 iterative hash function to the symbol's name. Starting with an
38630 initial value of @code{r = 0}, each (unsigned) character @samp{c} in
38631 the string is incorporated into the hash using the formula depending on the
38632 index version:
38633
38634 @table @asis
38635 @item Version 4
38636 The formula is @code{r = r * 67 + c - 113}.
38637
38638 @item Version 5
38639 The formula is @code{r = r * 67 + tolower (c) - 113}.
38640 @end table
38641
38642 The terminating @samp{\0} is not incorporated into the hash.
38643
38644 The step size used in the hash table is computed via
38645 @code{((hash * 17) & (size - 1)) | 1}, where @samp{hash} is the hash
38646 value, and @samp{size} is the size of the hash table. The step size
38647 is used to find the next candidate slot when handling a hash
38648 collision.
38649
38650 The names of C@t{++} symbols in the hash table are canonicalized. We
38651 don't currently have a simple description of the canonicalization
38652 algorithm; if you intend to create new index sections, you must read
38653 the code.
38654
38655 @item
38656 The constant pool. This is simply a bunch of bytes. It is organized
38657 so that alignment is correct: CU vectors are stored first, followed by
38658 strings.
38659
38660 A CU vector in the constant pool is a sequence of @code{offset_type}
38661 values. The first value is the number of CU indices in the vector.
38662 Each subsequent value is the index of a CU in the CU list. This
38663 element in the hash table is used to indicate which CUs define the
38664 symbol.
38665
38666 A string in the constant pool is zero-terminated.
38667 @end enumerate
38668
38669 @include gpl.texi
38670
38671 @node GNU Free Documentation License
38672 @appendix GNU Free Documentation License
38673 @include fdl.texi
38674
38675 @node Index
38676 @unnumbered Index
38677
38678 @printindex cp
38679
38680 @tex
38681 % I think something like @colophon should be in texinfo. In the
38682 % meantime:
38683 \long\def\colophon{\hbox to0pt{}\vfill
38684 \centerline{The body of this manual is set in}
38685 \centerline{\fontname\tenrm,}
38686 \centerline{with headings in {\bf\fontname\tenbf}}
38687 \centerline{and examples in {\tt\fontname\tentt}.}
38688 \centerline{{\it\fontname\tenit\/},}
38689 \centerline{{\bf\fontname\tenbf}, and}
38690 \centerline{{\sl\fontname\tensl\/}}
38691 \centerline{are used for emphasis.}\vfill}
38692 \page\colophon
38693 % Blame: doc@cygnus.com, 1991.
38694 @end tex
38695
38696 @bye